summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes3
-rw-r--r--33939-8.txt8474
-rw-r--r--33939-8.zipbin0 -> 149518 bytes
-rw-r--r--33939-h.zipbin0 -> 455732 bytes
-rw-r--r--33939-h/33939-h.htm10750
-rw-r--r--33939-h/images/cover.jpgbin0 -> 118225 bytes
-rw-r--r--33939-h/images/frontis.jpgbin0 -> 178316 bytes
-rw-r--r--33939.txt8474
-rw-r--r--33939.zipbin0 -> 149499 bytes
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
11 files changed, 27714 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6833f05
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+* text=auto
+*.txt text
+*.md text
diff --git a/33939-8.txt b/33939-8.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f219726
--- /dev/null
+++ b/33939-8.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,8474 @@
+The Project Gutenberg EBook of Sturdy and Strong, by G. A. Henty
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+Title: Sturdy and Strong
+ How George Andrews Made His Way
+
+Author: G. A. Henty
+
+Release Date: October 7, 2010 [EBook #33939]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1
+
+*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK STURDY AND STRONG ***
+
+
+
+
+Produced by David Edwards and the Online Distributed
+Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This file was
+produced from images generously made available by The
+Internet Archive)
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ STURDY AND STRONG
+
+ G. A. HENTY
+
+
+ [Illustration: "SURLY JOE SAT WITH A CHILD ON EITHER SIDE,
+ TELLING THEM SEA STORIES."--_Frontispiece._
+ _Sturdy and Strong._]
+
+
+
+ STURDY AND STRONG
+ OR
+ _How George Andrews Made His Way_
+
+ BY
+ G. A. HENTY
+
+ AUTHOR OF "THE YOUNG CARTHAGINIAN," "WITH CLIVE IN INDIA,"
+ "IN FREEDOM'S CAUSE," "THE LION OF THE NORTH," "FACING DEATH,"
+ ETC., ETC., ETC.
+
+
+ NEW YORK
+ THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY
+ PUBLISHERS
+
+
+
+
+PREFACE.
+
+
+Whatever may be said as to distinction of classes in England, it is
+certain that in no country in the world is the upward path more open
+to those who brace themselves to climb it than in our own. The
+proportion of those who remain absolutely stationary is comparatively
+small. We are all living on a hillside, and we must either go up or
+down. It is easier to descend than to ascend; but he who fixes his
+eyes upwards, nerves himself for the climb, and determines with all
+his might and power to win his way towards the top, is sure to find
+himself at the end of his day at a far higher level than when he
+started upon his journey. It may be said, and sometimes foolishly is
+said, that luck is everything; but in nineteen cases out of twenty
+what is called luck is simply a combination of opportunity, and of the
+readiness and quickness to turn that opportunity to advantage. The
+voyager must take every advantage of wind, tide, and current, if he
+would make a favorable journey; and for success in life it is
+necessary not only to be earnest, steadfast, and true, but to have the
+faculty of turning every opportunity to the best advantage; just as a
+climber utilizes every tuft of grass, every little shrub, every
+projecting rock, as a hold for his hands or feet. George Andrews had
+what may be called luck--that is, he had opportunities and took
+advantage of them, and his rise in life was consequently far more
+rapid than if he had let them pass without grasping them; but in any
+case his steadiness, perseverance, and determination to get on would
+assuredly have made their way in the long run. If similar qualities
+and similar determinations are yours, you need not despair of similar
+success in life.
+
+ G. A. HENTY.
+
+
+
+
+CONTENTS.
+
+
+ STURDY AND STRONG: PAGE
+ I. ALONE, 1
+ II. TWO FRIENDS, 25
+ III. WORK, 48
+ IV. HOME, 74
+ V. AN ADVENTURE, 97
+ VI. FIRE! 117
+ VII. SAVED! 142
+ DO YOUR DUTY, 165
+ SURLY JOE, 231
+ A FISH-WIFE'S DREAM, 257
+
+
+
+
+STURDY AND STRONG.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I.
+
+ALONE.
+
+
+"You heard what he said, George?"
+
+"Oh, mother, mother!"
+
+"Don't sob so, my boy; he is right. I have seen it coming a long time,
+and, hard as it seems, it will be better. There is no disgrace in it.
+I have tried my best, and if my health had not broken down we might
+have managed, but you see it was not to be. I shall not mind it, dear;
+it is really only for your sake that I care about it at all."
+
+The boy had ceased sobbing, and sat now with a white set face.
+
+"Mother, it will break my heart to think that I cannot keep you from
+this. If we could only have managed for a year or two I could have
+earned more then; but to think of you--you in the workhouse!"
+
+"In a workhouse infirmary, my boy," his mother said gently. "You see it
+is not as if it were from any fault of ours. We have done our best. You
+and I have managed for two years; but what with my health and my eyes
+breaking down we can do so no longer. I hope it will not be for long,
+dear. You see I shall have rest and quiet, and I hope I shall soon be
+able to be out again."
+
+"Not soon, mother. The doctor said you ought not to use your eyes for
+months."
+
+"Even months pass quickly, George, when one has hope. I have felt this
+coming so long that I shall be easier and happier now it has come. After
+all, what is a workhouse infirmary but a hospital, and it would not seem
+so very dreadful to you my going into a hospital; the difference is only
+in name; both are, after all, charities, but the one is kept up out of
+subscriptions, the other from the rates."
+
+His mother's words conveyed but little comfort to George Andrews. He had
+just come in from his work, and had heard what the parish doctor had
+told his mother.
+
+"I can do nothing for you here, Mrs. Andrews. You must have rest and
+quiet for your eyes, and not only that, but you must have strengthening
+food. It is no use my blinking the truth. It is painful for you, I know.
+I can well understand that; but I see no other way. If you refuse to go
+I won't answer for your life."
+
+"I will go, doctor," she had answered quietly. "I know that it will be
+best. It will be a blow to my boy, but I see no other way."
+
+"If you don't want your boy to be alone in the world, ma'am, you will do
+as I advise you. I will go round in the morning and get you the order of
+admission, and as I shall be driving out that way I will, if you like,
+take you myself."
+
+"Thank you, doctor; you are very good. Yes, I will be ready in the
+morning, and I thank you for your offer."
+
+"Very well, then, that's settled," the doctor said briskly. "At ten
+o'clock I will be here."
+
+Although a little rough in manner, Dr. Jeffries was a kind-hearted and
+humane man.
+
+"Poor woman," he said to himself as he went downstairs, "it is hard for
+her. It is easy to see that she is a lady, and a thorough lady too; but
+what can I do for her! I might get her a little temporary help, but that
+would be of no use--she is completely broken down with anxiety and
+insufficient food, and unless her eyes have a long holiday she will lose
+her sight. No, there's nothing else for it, but it is hard."
+
+It was hard. Mrs. Andrews was, as the doctor said, a lady. She had lost
+both her parents while she was at school. She had no near relations, and
+as she was sixteen when her mother died she had remained at school
+finishing her education and teaching the younger children. Then she had
+obtained a situation as governess in a gentleman's family, and two years
+afterwards had married a young barrister who was a frequent visitor at
+the house.
+
+Mr. Andrews was looked upon as a rising man, and for the first seven or
+eight years of her marriage his wife's life had been a very happy one.
+Then her husband was prostrated by a fever which he caught in one of the
+midland towns while on circuit, and although he partially recovered he
+was never himself again. His power of work seemed to be lost; a languor
+which he could not overcome took possession of him. A troublesome cough
+ere long attacked him, and two years later Mrs. Andrews was a widow, and
+her boy, then nine years old, an orphan.
+
+During the last two years of his life Mr. Andrews had earned but
+little in his profession. The comfortable house which he occupied had
+been given up, and they had removed to one much smaller. But in spite
+of this, debts mounted up, and when, after his death, the remaining
+furniture was sold and everything settled, there remained only about
+two hundred pounds. Mrs. Andrews tried to get some pupils among her
+late husband's friends, but during the last two years she had lost
+sight of many of these, and now met with but poor success among the
+others. She was a quiet and retiring woman, and shrank from continuous
+solicitations, and at the end of three years she found her little
+store exhausted.
+
+Hitherto she had kept George at school, but could no longer do so,
+and, giving up her lodging in Brompton, went down to Croydon, where
+someone had told her that they thought she would have a better chance
+of obtaining pupils, but the cards which some of the tradesmen allowed
+her to put in the window led to no result, and finding this to be the
+case she applied at one of the milliner's for work. This she obtained,
+and for a year supported herself and her boy by needlework.
+
+From the time when George left school she had gone on teaching him his
+lessons; but on the day when he was thirteen years old he declared
+that he would no longer submit to his mother working for both of them,
+and, setting out, called at shop after shop inquiring if they wanted
+an errand-boy. He succeeded at last in getting a place at a grocer's
+where he was to receive three shillings a week and his meals, going
+home to sleep at night in the closet-like little attic adjoining the
+one room which his mother could now afford.
+
+For a while they were more comfortable than they had been for some
+time; now that his mother had no longer George to feed, her earnings
+and the three shillings he brought home every Saturday night enabled
+them to live in comparative ease, and on Sunday something like a feast
+was always prepared. But six months later Mrs. Andrews felt her
+eyesight failing, the lids became inflamed, and a dull aching pain
+settled in the eyeballs. Soon she could only work for a short time
+together, her earnings became smaller and smaller, and her employers
+presently told her that she kept the work so long in hand that they
+could no longer employ her. There was now only George's three
+shillings a week to rely upon, and this was swallowed up by the rent.
+In despair she had applied to the parish doctor about her eyes. For a
+fortnight he attended her, and at the end of that time had
+peremptorily given the order of which she had told her son.
+
+To her it was a relief; she had seen that it must come. Piece by piece
+every article of clothing she possessed, save those she wore, had been
+pawned for food, and every resource was now exhausted. She was worn
+out with the struggle, and the certainty of rest and food overcame her
+repugnance to the house. For George's sake too, much as she knew he
+would feel her having to accept such a refuge, she was glad that the
+struggle was at an end. The lad had for the last six months suffered
+greatly for her sake. Every meal to which he sat down at his
+employer's seemed to choke him as he contrasted it with the fare to
+which she was reduced, although, as far as possible, she had concealed
+from him how sore was her strait.
+
+George cried himself to sleep that night, and he could scarce speak
+when he said good-by to his mother in the morning, for he could not
+tell when he should see her again.
+
+"You will stop where you are, my boy, will you not?"
+
+"I cannot promise, mother. I don't know yet what I shall do; but
+please don't ask me to promise anything. You must let me do what I
+think best. I have got to make a home for you when you are cured. I am
+fourteen now, and am as strong as most boys of my age. I ought to be
+able to earn a shilling a day somehow, and with seven shillings a
+week, mother, and you just working a little, you know, so as not to
+hurt your eyes, we ought to be able to do. Don't you bother about me,
+mother. I want to try anyhow what I can do till you come out. When you
+do, then I will do whatever you tell me; that's fair, isn't it?"
+
+Mrs. Andrews would have remonstrated, but he said:
+
+"Well, mother, you see at the worst I can get a year's character from
+Dutton, so that if I can't get anything else to do I can get the same
+sort of place again, and as I am a year older than I was when he took
+me, and can tie up parcels neatly now, I ought to get a little more
+anyhow. You see I shall be safe enough, and though I have never
+grumbled, you know, mother--have I?--I think I would rather do
+anything than be a grocer's boy. I would rather, when I grow up, be a
+bricklayer's laborer, or a plowman, or do any what I call man's work,
+than be pottering about behind a counter, with a white apron on,
+weighing out sugar and currants."
+
+"I can't blame you, George," Mrs. Andrews said with a sigh. "It's
+natural, my boy. If I get my eyesight and my health again, when you
+grow up to be a man we will lay by a little money, and you and I will
+go out together to one of the colonies. It will be easier to rise
+again there than here, and with hard work both of us might surely hope
+to get on. There must be plenty of villages in Australia and Canada
+where I could do well with teaching, and you could get work in
+whatever way you may be inclined to. So, my boy, let us set that
+before us. It will be something to hope for and work for, and will
+cheer us to go through whatever may betide us up to that time."
+
+"Yes, mother," George said. "It will be comfort indeed to have
+something to look forward to. Nothing can comfort me much to-day; but
+if anything could it would be some such plan as that."
+
+The last words he said to his mother as, blinded with tears, he kissed
+her before starting to work, were:
+
+"I shall think of our plan every day, and look forward to that more
+than anything else in the world--next to your coming to me again."
+
+At ten o'clock Dr. Jeffries drove up to Mrs. Andrews' humble lodging
+in a brougham instead of his ordinary gig, having borrowed the
+carriage from one of the few of his patients who kept such a vehicle,
+on purpose to take Mrs. Andrews, for she was so weak and worn that he
+was sure she would not be able to sit upright in a gig for the three
+miles that had to be traversed. He managed in the course of his rounds
+to pass the workhouse again in the afternoon, and brought George,
+before he left work, a line written in pencil on a leaf torn from his
+pocketbook:
+
+ "My darling, I am very comfortable. Everything is clean and
+ nice, and the doctor and people kind. Do not fret about
+ me.--Your loving mother."
+
+Although George's expressed resolution of leaving his present
+situation, and seeking to earn his living in some other way, caused
+Mrs. Andrews much anxiety, she had not sought strongly to dissuade him
+from it. No doubt it would be wiser for him to stay in his present
+situation, where he was well treated and well fed, and it certainly
+seemed improbable to her that he would be able to get a better living
+elsewhere. Still she could not blame him for wishing at least to try.
+She herself shared to some extent his prejudice against the work in
+which he was employed. There is no disgrace in honest work; but she
+felt that she would rather see him engaged in hard manual labor than
+as a shop boy. At any rate, as he said, if he failed he could come
+back again to Croydon, and, with a year's character from his present
+employer, would probably be able to obtain a situation similar to that
+which he now held. She was somewhat comforted, too, by a few words
+the doctor had said to her during their drive.
+
+"I think you are fortunate in your son, Mrs. Andrews. He seems to me a
+fine steady boy. If I can, in any way, do him a good turn while you
+are away from him, I will."
+
+George remained for another month in his situation, for he knew that
+it would never do to start on his undertaking penniless. At the end of
+that time, having saved up ten shillings, and having given notice to
+his employer, he left the shop for the last time, and started to walk
+to London. It was not until he began to enter the crowded streets that
+he felt the full magnitude of his undertaking. To be alone in London,
+a solitary atom in the busy mass of humanity, is a trying situation
+even for a man; to a boy of fourteen it is terrible. Buying a penny
+roll, George sat down to eat it in one of the niches of a bridge over
+the river, and then kneeling up watched the barges and steamers
+passing below him.
+
+Had it not been for his mother, his first thought, like that of most
+English boys thrown on the world, would have been to go to sea; but
+this idea he had from the first steadily set aside as out of the
+question. His plan was to obtain employment as a boy in some
+manufacturing work, for he thought that there, by steadiness and
+perseverance, he might make his way.
+
+On one thing he was resolved. He would make his money last as long as
+possible. Three penny-worth of bread a day would, he calculated, be
+sufficient for his wants. As to sleeping, he thought he might manage
+to sleep anywhere; it was summer time and the nights were warm. He had
+no idea what the price of a bed would be, or how to set about getting
+a lodging. He did not care how roughly he lived so that he could but
+make his money last. The first few days he determined to look about
+him. Something might turn up. If it did not he would set about getting
+a place in earnest. He had crossed Waterloo Bridge, and, keeping
+straight on, found himself in Covent Garden, where he was astonished
+and delighted at the quantities of fruit, vegetables, and flowers.
+
+Although he twice set out in different directions to explore the
+streets, he each time returned to Covent Garden. There were many lads
+of his own age playing about there, and he thought that from them he
+might get some hints as to how to set about earning a living. They
+looked ragged and poor enough, but they might be able to tell him
+something--about sleeping, for instance. For although before starting
+the idea of sleeping anywhere had seemed natural enough, it looked
+more formidable now that he was face to face with it.
+
+Going to a cook-shop in a street off the market he bought two slices
+of plum-pudding. He rather grudged the twopence which he paid; but he
+felt that it might be well laid out. Provided with the pudding he
+returned to the market, sat himself down on an empty basket, and began
+to eat slowly and leisurely.
+
+In a short time he noticed a lad of about his own age watching him
+greedily.
+
+He was far from being a respectable-looking boy. His clothes were
+ragged, and his toes could be seen through a hole in his boot. He wore
+neither hat nor cap, and his hair looked as if it had not been combed
+since the day of his birth. There was a sharp, pinched look on his
+face. But had he been washed and combed and decently clad he would not
+have been a bad-looking boy. At any rate George liked his face better
+than most he had seen in the market, and he longed for a talk with
+someone. So he held out his other slice of pudding, and said:
+
+"Have a bit?"
+
+"Oh, yes!" the boy replied "Walker, eh?"
+
+"No, I mean it, really. Will you have a bit?"
+
+"No larks?" asked the boy.
+
+"No; no larks. Here you are."
+
+Feeling assured now that no trick was intended the boy approached,
+took without a word the pudding which George held out, and, seating
+himself on a basket close to him, took a great bite.
+
+"Where do you live?" George asked, when the slice of pudding had half
+disappeared.
+
+"Anywheres," the boy replied, waving his hand round.
+
+"I mean, where do you sleep?"
+
+The boy nodded, to intimate that his sleeping-place was included in
+the general description of his domicile.
+
+"And no one interferes with you?" George inquired.
+
+"The beaks, they moves you on when they ketches you; but ef yer get
+under a cart or in among the baskets you generally dodges 'em."
+
+"And suppose you want to pay for a place to sleep, where do you go and
+how much do you pay?"
+
+"Tuppence," the boy said; "or if yer want a first-rate, fourpence.
+Does yer want to find a crib?" he asked doubtfully, examining his
+companion.
+
+"Well, yes," George said. "I want to find some quiet place where I can
+sleep, cheap, you know."
+
+"Out of work?" the boy inquired.
+
+"Yes. I haven't got anything to do at present. I am looking for a
+place, you know."
+
+"Don't know no one about?"
+
+"No; I have just come in from Croydon."
+
+The boy shook his head.
+
+"Don't know nothing as would suit," he said. "Why, yer'd get them
+clothes and any money yet had walked off with the wery fust night."
+
+"I should not get a room to myself, I suppose, even for fourpence?"
+George asked, making a rapid calculation that this would come to two
+and fourpence per week, as much as his mother had paid for a
+comparatively comfortable room in Croydon.
+
+The boy opened his eyes in astonishment at his companion requiring a
+room for himself.
+
+"Lor' bless yer, yer'd have a score of them with yer!"
+
+"I don't care about a bed," George said. "Just some place to sleep in.
+Just some straw in any quiet corner."
+
+This seemed more reasonable to the boy, and he thought the matter
+over.
+
+"Well," he said at last, "I knows of a place where they puts up the
+hosses of the market carts. I knows a hostler there. Sometimes when
+it's wery cold he lets me sleep up in the loft. Aint it warm and
+comfortable just! I helps him with the hosses sometimes, and that's
+why. I will ax him if yer likes."
+
+George assented at once. His ideas as to the possibility of sleeping
+in the open air had vanished when he saw the surroundings, and a bed
+in a quiet loft seemed to him vastly better than sleeping in a room
+with twenty others.
+
+"How do you live?" he asked the lad, "and what's your name?"
+
+"They calls me the Shadder," the boy said rather proudly; "but my real
+name's Bill."
+
+"Why do they call you the Shadow?" George asked.
+
+"'Cause the bobbies finds it so hard to lay hands on me," Bill
+replied.
+
+"But what do they want to lay hands on you for?" George asked.
+
+"Why, for bagging things, in course," Bill replied calmly.
+
+"Bagging things? Do you mean stealing?" George said, greatly shocked.
+
+"Well, not regular prigging," the Shadow replied; "not wipes, yer
+know, nor tickers, nor them kind of things. I aint never prigged
+nothing of that kind."
+
+"Well, what is it then you do--prig?" George asked, mystified.
+
+"Apples or cabbages, or a bunch of radishes, onions sometimes, or
+'taters. That aint regular prigging, you know."
+
+"Well, it seems to me the same sort of thing," George said, after a
+pause.
+
+"I tell yer it aint the same sort of thing at all," the Shadow said
+angrily. "Everyone as aint a fool knows that taters aint wipes, and no
+one can't say as a apple and a ticker are the same."
+
+"No, not the same," George agreed; "but you see one is just as much
+stealing as the other."
+
+"No, it aint," the boy reasserted. "One is the same as money and
+t'other aint. I am hungry and I nips a apple off a stall. No one aint
+the worse for it. You don't suppose as they misses a apple here? Why,
+there's wagon-loads of 'em, and lots of 'em is rotten. Well, it aint
+no more if I takes one than if it was rotten. Is it now?"
+
+George thought there was a difference, but he did not feel equal to
+explaining it.
+
+"The policemen must think differently," he said at last, "else they
+wouldn't be always trying to catch you."
+
+"Who cares for the bobbies?" Bill said contemptuously. "I don't; and I
+don't want no more jaw with you about it. If yer don't likes it, yer
+leaves it. I didn't ask for yer company, did I? So now then."
+
+George had really taken a fancy to the boy, and moreover he saw that
+in the event of a quarrel his chance of finding a refuge for the night
+was small. In his sense of utter loneliness in the great city he was
+loath to break with the only acquaintance he had made.
+
+"I didn't mean to offend you, Bill," he said; "only I was sorry to
+hear you say you took things. It seems to me you might get into
+trouble; and it would be better after all to work for a living."
+
+"What sort of work?" Bill said derisively. "Who's agoing to give me
+work? Does yer think I have only got to walk into a shop and ask for
+'ployment? They wouldn't want to know nothing about my character, I
+suppose? nor where I had worked before? nor where my feyther lived?
+nor nothing? Oh, no, of course not! It's blooming easy to get work
+about here; only got to ax for it, that's all. Good wages and all
+found, that's your kind."
+
+"I don't suppose it's easy," George said; "but it seems to me people
+could get something to do if they tried."
+
+"Tried!" the boy said bitterly. "Do yer think we don't try! Why, we
+are always trying to earn a copper or two. Why, we begins at three
+o'clock in the morning when the market-carts come in, and we goes on
+till they comes out of that there theater at night, just trying to
+pick up a copper. Sometimes one does and sometimes one doesn't. It's a
+good day, I tell you, when we have made a tanner by the end of it.
+Don't tell me! And now as to this ere stable; yer means it?"
+
+"Yes," George said; "certainly I mean it."
+
+"Wery well then, you be here at this corner at nine o'clock. I will go
+before that and square it with Ned. That's the chap I was speaking
+of."
+
+"I had better give you something to give him," George said. "Will a
+shilling do?"
+
+"Yes, a bob will do for three or four nights. Are you going to trust
+me with it?"
+
+"Of course I am," George replied. "I am sure you wouldn't be so mean
+as to do me out of it; besides, you told me that you never stole money
+and those sort of things."
+
+"It aint everyone as would trust me with a bob for all that," Bill
+replied; "and yer are running a risk, yer know, and I tells yer if yer
+goes on with that sort of game yer'll get took in rarely afore yer've
+done. Well, hand it over. I aint a-going to bilk yer."
+
+The Shadow spoke carelessly, but this proof of confidence on the part
+of his companion really touched him, and as he went off he said to
+himself, "He aint a bad sort, that chap, though he is so precious
+green. I must look arter him a bit and see he don't get into no
+mischief."
+
+George, on his part, as he walked away down into the Strand again,
+felt that he had certainly run a risk in thus intrusting a tenth of
+his capital to his new acquaintance; but the boy's face and manner had
+attracted him, and he felt that, although the Shadow's notions of
+right and wrong might be of a confused nature, he meant to act
+straight toward him.
+
+George passed the intervening hours before the time named for his
+meeting in Covent Garden in staring into the shop windows in the
+Strand, and in wondering at the constant stream of vehicles and foot
+passengers flowing steadily out westward. He was nearly knocked under
+the wheels of the vehicles a score of times from his ignorance as to
+the rule of the road, and at last he was so confused by the jostling
+and pushing that he was glad to turn down a side street and to sit
+down for a time on a doorstep.
+
+When nine o'clock approached he went into a baker's shop and bought a
+loaf, which would, he thought, do for supper and breakfast for himself
+and his companion. Having further invested threepence in cheese, he
+made his way up to the market.
+
+The Shadow was standing at the corner whistling loudly.
+
+"Oh, here yer be! That's all right; come along. I have squared Ned,
+and it's all right."
+
+He led the way down two or three streets and then stopped at a
+gateway.
+
+"You stop here," he said, "and I will see as there aint no one but Ned
+about."
+
+He returned in a minute.
+
+"It's all clear! Ned, he's a-rubbing down a hoss; he won't take no
+notice of yer as yer pass. He don't want to see yer, yer know, 'cause
+in case anyone comed and found yer up there he could swear he never
+saw yer go in, and didn't know nothing about yer. I will go with yer
+to the door, and then yer will see a ladder in the corner; if yer whip
+up that yer'll find it all right up there."
+
+"But you are coming too, aint you?" George asked.
+
+"Oh, no, I aint a-coming. Yer don't want a chap like me up there. I
+might pick yer pocket, yer know; besides I aint your sort."
+
+"Oh, nonsense!" George said. "I should like to have you with me, Bill;
+I should really. Besides, what's the difference between us? We have
+both got to work for ourselves and make our way in the world."
+
+"There's a lot of difference. Yer don't talk the way as I do; yer have
+been brought up different. Don't tell me."
+
+"I may have been brought up differently, Bill. I have been fortunate
+there; but now, you see, I have got to get my living in the best way I
+can, and if I have had a better education than you have, you know ever
+so much more about London and how to get your living than I do, so
+that makes us quits."
+
+"Oh, wery well," Bill said; "it's all the same to this child. So if
+yer aint too proud, here goes."
+
+He led the way down a stable yard, past several doors, showing the
+empty stalls which would be all filled when the market carts arrived.
+At the last door on the right he stopped. George looked in. At the
+further end a man was rubbing down a horse by the faint light of a
+lantern, the rest of the stable was in darkness.
+
+"This way," Bill whispered.
+
+Keeping close behind him, George entered the stable. The boy stopped
+in the corner.
+
+"Here's the ladder. I will go up fust and give yer a hand when yer
+gets to the top."
+
+George stood quiet until his companion had mounted, and then ascended
+the ladder, which was fixed against the wall. Presently a voice
+whispered in his ear:
+
+"Give us your hand. Mind how yer puts your foot."
+
+In a minute he was standing in the loft. His companion drew him along
+in the darkness, and in a few steps arrived at a pile of hay.
+
+"There yer are," Bill said in a low voice; "yer 'ave only to make
+yourself comfortable there. Now mind you don't fall down one of the
+holes into the mangers."
+
+"I wish we had a little light," George said, as he ensconced himself
+in the hay.
+
+"I will give you some light in a minute," Bill said, as he left his
+side, and directly afterwards a door opened and the light of a
+gaslight in the yard streamed in.
+
+"That's where they pitches the hay in," Bill said as he rejoined him.
+"I shuts it up afore I goes to sleep, 'cause the master he comes out
+sometimes when the carts comes in, and there would be a blooming row
+if he saw it open; but we are all right now."
+
+"That's much nicer," George said. "Now here's a loaf I brought with
+me. We will cut it in half and put by a half for the morning, and eat
+the other half between us now, and I have got some cheese here too."
+
+"That's tiptop!" the boy said. "Yer're a good sort, I could see that,
+and I am pretty empty, I am, for I aint had nothing except that bit
+of duff yer gave me since morning, and I only had a crust then. 'Cept
+for running against you I aint been lucky to-day. Couldn't get a job
+nohows, and it aint for want of trying neither."
+
+For some minutes the boys ate in silence. George had given much the
+largest portion to his companion, for he himself was too dead tired to
+be very hungry. When he had finished, he said:
+
+"Look here, Bill; we will talk in the morning. I am so dead beat I can
+scarcely keep my eyes open, so I will just say my prayers and go off
+to sleep."
+
+"Say your prayers!" Bill said in astonishment. "Do yer mean to say as
+yer says prayers!"
+
+"Of course I do," George replied; "don't you?"
+
+"Never said one in my life," Bill said decidedly; "don't know how,
+don't see as it would do no good ef I did."
+
+"It would do good, Bill," George said. "I hope some day you will think
+differently, and I will teach you some you will like."
+
+"I don't want to know none," Bill said positively. "A missionary chap,
+he came and prayed with an old woman I lodged with once. I could not
+make head nor tail of it, and she died just the same, so you see what
+good did it do her?"
+
+But George was too tired to enter upon a theological argument. He was
+already half asleep, and Bill's voice sounded a long way off.
+
+"Good-night," he muttered; "I will talk to you in the morning," and in
+another minute he was fast asleep.
+
+Bill took an armful of hay and shook it lightly over his companion;
+then he closed the door of the loft and threw himself on the hay, and
+was soon also sound asleep. When George woke in the morning the
+daylight was streaming in through the cracks of the door. His
+companion was gone. He heard the voices of several men in the yard,
+while a steady champing noise and an occasional shout or the sound of
+a scraping on the stones told him the stalls below were all full now.
+
+George felt that he had better remain where he was. Bill had told him
+the evening before that the horses and carts generally set out again
+at about nine o'clock, and he thought he had better wait till they had
+gone before he slipped down below. Closing his eyes he was very soon
+off to sleep again. When he woke, Bill was sitting by his side looking
+at him.
+
+"Well, you are a oner to sleep," the boy said. "Why, it's nigh ten
+o'clock, and it's time for us to be moving. Ned will be going off in a
+few minutes, and the stables will be locked up till the evening."
+
+"Is there time to eat our bread and cheese?" George asked.
+
+"No, we had better eat it when we get down to the market; come
+along."
+
+George at once rose, shook the hay off his clothes, and descended the
+ladder, Bill leading the way. There was no one in the stable, and the
+yard was also empty. On reaching the market they sat down on two empty
+baskets, and at once began to eat their bread and cheese.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II.
+
+TWO FRIENDS.
+
+
+"I did wake before, Bill," George said after he had eaten a few
+mouthfuls; "but you were out."
+
+"Yes, I turned out as soon as the carts began to come in," Bill said,
+"and a wery good morning I have had. One old chap gave me twopence for
+looking arter his hoss and cart while he went into the market with his
+flowers. But the best move was just now. A chap as was driving off
+with flowers, one of them swell West-end shops, I expect, by the look
+of the trap, let his rug fall. He didn't see it till I ran after him
+with it, then he gave me a tanner; that was something like. Have yer
+finished yer bread and cheese?"
+
+"Yes," George said, "and I could manage a drink of water if I could
+get one."
+
+"There's a fountain handy," Bill said; "but you come along with me, I
+am agoing to stand two cups of coffee if yer aint too proud to take
+it;" and he looked doubtfully at his companion.
+
+"I am not at all too proud," George said, for he saw that the
+slightest hesitation would hurt his companion's feelings.
+
+"It aint fust-rate coffee," Bill said, as with a brightened look on
+his face he turned and led the way to a little coffee-stall; "but it's
+hot and sweet, and yer can't expect more nor that for a penny."
+
+George found the coffee really better than he had expected, and Bill
+was evidently very much gratified at his expression of approval.
+
+"Now," he said, when they had both finished, "for a draw of 'baccy,"
+and he produced a short clay pipe. "Don't yer smoke?"
+
+"No, I haven't begun yet."
+
+"Ah! ye don't know what a comfort a pipe is," Bill said. "Why, when
+yer are cold and hungry and down on your luck a pipe is a wonderful
+thing, and so cheap; why, a ounce of 'baccy will fill yer thirty pipes
+if yer don't squeeze it in too hard. Well, an ounce of 'baccy costs
+threepence halfpenny, so, as I makes out, yer gets eight pipes for a
+penny; and now," he went on when he had filled and lit his pipe,
+"let's know what's yer game."
+
+"You mean what am I going to do?" George asked.
+
+Bill nodded.
+
+"I want to get employment in some sort of works. I have been an
+errand-boy in a grocer's for more than a year, and I have got a
+written character from my master in my pocket; but I don't like the
+sort of thing; I would rather work with my own hands. There are plenty
+of works where they employ boys, and you know one might get on as one
+gets older. The first thing is to find out whereabouts works of that
+sort are."
+
+"There are lots of works at the East End, I have heard tell," Bill
+said; "and then there's Clerkenwell and King's Cross, they aint so far
+off, and there are works there, all sorts of works, I should say; but
+I don't know nuffin' about that sort of work. The only work as I have
+done is holding hosses and carrying plants into the market, and
+sometimes when I have done pretty well I goes down and lays out what I
+got in _Echoes_, or _Globes_, or _Evening Standards_; that pays yer,
+that does, for if yer can sell them all yer will get a bob for eight
+penn'orth of papers, that gives yer fourpence for an hour's work, and
+I calls that blooming good, and can't yer get a tuck-out for a bob!
+Oh, no, I should think not! Well, what shall it be? I knows the way
+out to Whitechapel and to Clerkenwell, so whichever yer likes I can
+show yer."
+
+"If Clerkenwell's the nearest we may as well try that first," George
+said, "and I shall be much obliged to you for showing the way."
+
+The two boys spent the whole day in going from workshop to workshop
+for employment; but the answers to his application were unvarying:
+either he was too young or there was no place vacant. George took the
+disappointment quietly, for he had made up his mind that he would have
+difficulty in getting a place; but Bill became quite angry on behalf
+of his companion.
+
+"This is worse nor the market," he said. "A chap can pick up a few
+coppers there, and here we have been a-tramping about all day and aint
+done nothing."
+
+Day after day George set out on his quest, but all was without
+success. He and Bill still slept in the loft, and after the first day
+he took to getting up at the same time as his companion, and going out
+with him to try and pick up a few pence from the men with the
+market-carts. Every other morning they were able to lie later, as
+there were only regular marketdays three mornings a week.
+
+On market mornings he found that he earned more than Bill, his better
+clothes giving him an advantage, as the men were more willing to trust
+their carts and rugs to the care of a quiet, respectable-looking boy
+than to that of the arabs who frequented the Garden. But all that was
+earned was laid out in common between the two boys, and George found
+himself seldom obliged to draw above a few pence on his private stock.
+He had by this time told the Shadow exactly how much money he had, and
+the boy, seeing the difficulty that George found in getting work, was
+most averse to the store being trenched upon, and always gave his vote
+against the smallest addition to their ordinary fare of bread and
+cheese being purchased, except from their earnings of the day. This
+George felt was the more creditable on Bill's part, inasmuch as the
+latter had, in deference to his prejudices, abstained from the petty
+thefts of fruit with which before he had seasoned his dry crusts.
+
+George had learned now what Bill knew of his history, which was little
+enough. He supposed he had had a father, but he knew nothing of him;
+whether he had died, or whether he had cut away and left mother, Bill
+had no idea. His mother he remembered well, though she had died when
+he was, as he said, a little chap. He spoke of her always in a hushed
+voice, and in a tone of reverence, as a superior being.
+
+"We was poor, you know," he said to George, "and I know mother was
+often short of grub, but she was just kind. I don't never remember her
+whacking me; always spoke soft and low like; she was good, she was.
+She used to pray, you know, and what I remember most is as the night
+afore she was took away to a hospital she says, 'Try and live honest,
+Bill; it will be hard, but try, my boy. Don't you take to stealing,
+however poor you may be;' and I aint," Bill said earnestly over and
+over again. "When I has seed any chap going along with a ticker handy,
+which I could have boned and got away among the carts as safe as
+ninepence, or when I has seed a woman with her purse a-sticking out of
+them outside pockets, and I aint had a penny to bless myself with, and
+perhaps nothing to eat all day, I have felt it hard not to make a
+grab; but I just thought of what she said, and I aint done it. As I
+told yer, I have often nabbed things off the stalls or out of the
+baskets or carts. It didn't seem to me as that was stealing, but as
+you says it is, I aint going to do so no more. Now look yer here,
+George; they tells me as the parsons says as when people die and they
+are good they goes up there, yer know."
+
+George nodded, for there was a question in his companion's tone.
+
+"Then, of course," Bill went on, "she is up there. Now it aint likely
+as ever I should see her again, 'cause, you know, there aint nothing
+good about me; but if she was to come my way, wherever I might be, and
+was to say to me, 'Bill, have you been a-stealing?' do yer think she
+would feel very bad about them 'ere apples and things?"
+
+"No, Bill, I am sure she would not. You see you didn't quite know that
+was stealing, and you kept from stealing the things that you thought
+she spoke of, and now that you see it is wrong taking even little
+things you are not going to take them any more."
+
+"That I won't, so help me bob!" the boy said; "not if I never gets
+another apple between my teeth."
+
+"That's right, Bill. You see you ought to do it, not only to please
+your mother, but to please God. That's what my mother has told me over
+and over again."
+
+"Has she now?" Bill said with great interest, "and did you use to prig
+apples and sichlike sometimes?"
+
+"No," George said, "not that sort of thing; but she was talking of
+things in general. Of doing things that were wrong, such as telling
+lies and deceiving, and that sort of thing."
+
+"And your mother thinks as God knows all about it?"
+
+George nodded.
+
+"And that he don't like it, eh, when things is done bad?"
+
+George nodded again.
+
+"Lor', what a time he must have of it!" Bill said in solemn wonder.
+"Why, I heard a woman say last week as six children was enough to
+worrit anyone into the grave; and just to think of all of us!" and
+Bill waved his arm in a comprehensive way and repeated, "What a time
+he must have of it!"
+
+For a time the boys sat silent in their loft, Bill wondering over the
+problem that had presented itself to him, and George trying to find
+some appropriate explanation in reply to the difficulty Bill had
+started. At last he said:
+
+"I am afraid, Bill, that I can't explain all this to you, for I am not
+accustomed to talk about such things. My mother talks to me sometimes,
+and of course I went to church regularly; but that's different from my
+talking about it; but you know what we have got to do is to try and
+please God, and love him because he loves us."
+
+"That's whear it is," Bill said; "that's what I've heard fellows say
+beats 'em. If he loves a chap like me how is it he don't do something
+for him? why don't he get you a place, for instance? You aint been
+a-prigging apples or a-putting him out. That's what I wants to know."
+
+"Yes, Bill, but as I have heard my mother say, it would be very hard
+to understand if this world were the only one; but you see we are only
+here a little time, and after that there's on and on and on, right up
+without any end, and what does it matter if we are poor or unhappy in
+this little time if we are going to be ever so happy afterwards? This
+is only a sort of little trial to see how we behave, as it were, and
+if we do the best we can, even though that best is very little, then
+you see we get a tremendous reward. For instance, you would not think
+a man was unkind who kept you five minutes holding his horse on a cold
+day, if he were going to give you enough to get you clothes and good
+lodging for the rest of your life."
+
+"No, I should think not," Bill said fervently; "so it's like that, is
+it?"
+
+George nodded. "Like that, only more."
+
+"My eye!" Bill murmured to himself, lost in astonishment at this new
+view of things.
+
+After that there were few evenings when, before they nestled
+themselves down in the hay, the boys did not talk on this subject. At
+first George felt awkward and nervous in speaking of it, for like the
+generality of English boys, however earnest their convictions may be,
+he was shy of speaking what he felt; but his companion's eagerness to
+know more of this, to him, new story encouraged him to speak, and
+having in his bundle a small Bible which his mother had given him, he
+took to reading to Bill a chapter or two in the mornings when they had
+not to go out to the early market.
+
+It is true that Bill's questions frequently puzzled him. The boy saw
+things in a light so wholly different from that in which he himself
+had been accustomed to regard them that he found a great difficulty in
+replying to them.
+
+George wrote a letter to his mother, telling her exactly what he was
+doing, for he knew that if he only said that he had not yet succeeded
+in getting work she would be very anxious about him, and although he
+had nothing satisfactory to tell her, at least he could tell her that
+he had sufficient to eat and as much comfort as he cared for. Twice he
+received replies from her, directed to him at a little coffee-house,
+which, when they had had luck, the boys occasionally patronized. As
+time went on without his succeeding in obtaining employment George's
+hopes fell, and at last he said to his mate; "I will try for another
+fortnight, Bill, and if at the end of that time I don't get anything
+to do I shall go back to Croydon again."
+
+"But yer can earn yer living here!" Bill remonstrated.
+
+"I can earn enough to prevent me from starving, but that is all,
+Bill. I came up to London in hopes of getting something to do by which
+I might some day make my way up; if I were to stop here like this I
+should be going down, and a nice sight I should be to mother if, when
+she gets well enough to come out of the infirmary, I were to go back
+all in rags."
+
+"What sort of a place is Croydon?" Bill asked. "Is there any chance of
+picking up a living there? 'cause I tells yer fair, if yer goes off I
+goes with yer. I aint a-thinking of living with yer, George; but we
+might see each other sometime, mightn't we? Yer wouldn't mind that?"
+
+"Mind it! certainly not, Bill! You have been a good friend to me, and
+I should be sorry to think of you all alone here."
+
+"Oh, blow being a good friend to yer!" Bill replied. "I aint done
+nothing except put yer in the way of getting a sleeping-place, and as
+it's given me one too I have had the best of that job. It's been good
+of yer to take up with a chap like me as don't know how to read or
+write or nothing, and as aint no good anyway. But you will let me go
+with yer to Croydon, won't yer?"
+
+"Certainly I will, Bill; but you won't be able to see much of me. I
+shall have to get a place like the last. The man I was with said he
+would take me back again if I wanted to come, and you know I am all
+day in the shop or going out with parcels, and of course you would
+have to be busy too at something."
+
+"What sort of thing do yer think, George? I can hold a hoss, but that
+aint much for a living. One may go for days without getting a chance."
+
+"I should say, Bill, that your best chance would be to try and get
+work either in a brickfield or with a market-gardener. At any rate we
+should be able to get a talk for half an hour in the evening. I was
+always done at nine o'clock, and if we were both in work we could take
+a room together."
+
+Bill shook his head.
+
+"That would be wery nice, but I couldn't have it, George. I knows as I
+aint fit company for yer, and if yer was with a shop-keeping bloke he
+would think yer was going to run off with the money if he knew yer
+kept company with a chap like me. No, the 'greement must be as yer
+goes yer ways and I goes mine; but I hopes as yer will find suffin to
+do up here, not 'cause as I wouldn't like to go down to this place of
+yourn, but because yer have set yer heart on getting work here."
+
+A week later the two boys were out late in Covent Garden trying to
+earn a few pence by fetching up cabs and carriages for people coming
+out from a concert in the floral hall. George had just succeeded in
+earning threepence, and had returned to the entrance to the hall, and
+was watching the people come out, and trying to get another job.
+Presently a gentleman, with a girl of some nine or ten years old, came
+out and took their place on the footpath.
+
+"Can I call you a carriage, sir?" George asked.
+
+"No, thank you, lad, a man has gone for it."
+
+George fell back and stood watching the girl, who was in a white
+dress, with a little hood trimmed with swansdown over her head.
+
+Presently his eye fell on something on which the light glittered as it
+hung from her neck. Just as he was looking a hand reached over her
+shoulder, there was a jerk, and a sudden cry from the child, then a
+boy dived into the crowd, and at the same moment George dashed after
+him. There was a cry of "Stop, thief!" and several hands made a grab
+at George as he dived through the crowd; but he slipped through them
+and was soon in the roadway.
+
+Some twenty yards ahead of him he saw the boy running. He turned up
+Bow Street and then dashed down an alley. He did not know that he was
+followed until suddenly George sprang upon his back, and the two fell
+with a crash, the young thief undermost. George seized his right hand,
+and kneeling upon him, twisted it behind his back and forced him to
+open his fingers, the boy, taken by surprise, and not knowing who was
+his assailant, making but slight resistance.
+
+George seized the gold locket and dashed back at full speed into the
+market, and was soon in the thick of the crowd round the entrance. The
+gentleman was standing talking to a policeman, who was taking a note
+of the description of the lost trinket. The girl was standing by
+crying.
+
+"Here is your locket," George said, putting it into her hand. "I saw
+the boy take it, and have got it from him."
+
+"Oh, papa! papa!" the girl cried. "Here is my locket again."
+
+"Why, where did you get it from?" her father asked in astonishment.
+
+"This boy has just given it to me," she replied. "He says he took it
+from the boy who stole it."
+
+"Which boy, Nellie? Which is the boy who brought it back?"
+
+The girl looked round, but George was gone.
+
+"Why didn't you stop him, my dear?" her father said. "Of course I
+should wish to thank and reward him, for the locket was a very
+valuable one, and the more so to us from its having belonged to your
+mother. Did you notice the boy, policeman?"
+
+"No, sir, I did not see him at all."
+
+"Was he a poor boy, Nellie?"
+
+"Not a very, very poor boy, father," the girl replied. "At least I
+don't think so; but I only looked at his face. He didn't speak like a
+poor boy at all."
+
+"Would you know him again?"
+
+"Oh, yes, I am sure I should. He was a good-looking boy with a nice
+face."
+
+"Well, I am very sorry he has gone away, my dear. Evidently he does
+not want a reward, but at any rate I should have liked to thank him.
+Are you always on this beat, policeman?"
+
+"I am on night duty, sir, while the concerts are on."
+
+"At any rate, I dare say you know the constables who are about here in
+the daytime. I wish you would mention the fact to them, and ask them
+if they get any clew to the boy who has rendered me this service, to
+let me know. Here is a card with my name and address."
+
+After restoring the locket George made his way to the entrance to the
+stables, where he generally met Bill after the theater had closed and
+there was no farther chance of earning money. It was not till half an
+hour later that the boy came running up.
+
+"I have got eightpence," he said. "That is something like luck. I got
+three jobs. One stood me fourpence, the other two gave me tuppence
+each. What do yer say? Shall we have a cup of coffee afore we turns
+in?"
+
+"I think we had better not, Bill. I have got sixpence. We will put
+that by, with the sixpence we saved the other day, for the hostler. We
+haven't given him anything for some time. Your eightpence will get us
+a good breakfast in the morning."
+
+When they had comfortably nestled themselves in the hay George told
+his companion how he had rescued and restored the locket.
+
+"And he didn't give yer nuffin! I never heerd tell of such a scaly
+trick as that. I should ha' said it ought to have been good for a bob
+anyway."
+
+"I did not wait to see, Bill. Directly I had given the little girl her
+locket I bolted."
+
+"Well, that were soft. Why couldn't yer have waited to have seen what
+the bloke meant to give yer?"
+
+"I did not want to be paid for such a thing as that," George replied.
+"I don't mind being paid when I have done a job for anyone; but this
+was different altogether."
+
+Bill meditated for a minute or two.
+
+"I can't see no difference, nohow," he said at last. "Yer did him a
+good turn, and got the thing back. I dare say it were worth five bob."
+
+"A good deal more than that, Bill."
+
+"More nor that! Well, then, he ought to have come down handsome.
+Didn't yer run like winking, and didn't yer jump on the chap's back
+and knock him down, and didn't yer run back again? And warn't there a
+chance, ef one of the bobbies had got hold of yer collar and found it
+in yer hand, of yer being had up for stealing it? And then yer walks
+off and don't give him a chance of giving yer nuffin. My eye, but yer
+are a flat!"
+
+"I don't suppose you will quite understand, Bill. But when people do a
+thing to oblige somebody, and not as a piece of regular work, they
+don't expect to be paid. I shouldn't have liked it if they had offered
+me money for such a thing."
+
+"Well, ef yer says so, no doubt it's right," Bill rejoined; "but it
+seems a rum sort of notion to me. When people loses things they
+expects to pay to get 'em back. Why, don't yer see outside the p'lice
+station, and in the shop winders, papers offering so much for giving
+back things as is lost. I can't read 'em myself, yer know; but chaps
+have read 'em to me. Why, I've heerd of as much as five quid being
+offered for watches and sichlike as was lost by ladies coming out of
+theayters, and I have often thought what a turn of luck it would be to
+light on one of 'em. And now yer says as I oughtn't to take the money
+ef I found it."
+
+"No, I don't say that, Bill. If you found a thing and saw a reward
+offered, and you wanted the money, you would have good right to take
+it. But, you see, in this case I saw how sorry the girl was at losing
+her locket, and I went after it to please her, and I was quite content
+that I got it back for her."
+
+Bill tried again to think the matter over in his mind, but he was
+getting warm and sleepy, and in a few minutes was sound off.
+
+Two or three days later the lads had, to their great satisfaction,
+obtained a job. Walnuts were just coming in, and the boys were engaged
+to take off the green shucks. Bill was particularly pleased, for he
+had never before been taken on for such a job, and he considered it a
+sort of promotion. Five or six women were also employed, and as the
+group were standing round some great baskets Bill suddenly nudged his
+friend:
+
+"I say, my eye, aint that little gal pretty?"
+
+George looked up from his work and at once recognized the girl to whom
+he had restored the locket. Her eye fell on him at the same moment.
+
+"There, papa!" she exclaimed. "I told you if you brought me down to
+the market I felt sure I should know the boy again if I saw him.
+That's him, the one looking down into the basket. But he knew me
+again, for I saw him look surprised when he noticed me."
+
+The gentleman made his way through the women to George.
+
+"My lad, are you the boy who restored the locket to my daughter three
+evenings ago?"
+
+"Yes, sir," George said, coloring as he looked up. "I was standing
+close by when the boy took it, so I gave chase and brought it back,
+and that's all."
+
+"You were off again in such a hurry that we hadn't time to thank you.
+Just come across to my daughter. I suppose you can leave your work for
+a minute?"
+
+"Yes, sir. We are working by the job," George said, and looking rather
+shamefaced he followed the gentleman to the sidewalk.
+
+"This is your boy, as you call him, Nellie."
+
+"I was sure I should know him again," the child said, "though I only
+saw him for a moment. We are very much obliged to you, boy, papa and
+me, because it had been mamma's locket, and we should have been very
+sorry to have lost it."
+
+"I am glad I was able to get it back for you," George said; "but I
+don't want to be thanked for doing it; and I don't want to be paid
+either, thank you, sir," he said, flushing as the gentleman put his
+hand into his pocket.
+
+"No! and why not?" the gentleman said in surprise. "You have done me a
+great service, and there is no reason why I should not pay you for it.
+If I had lost it I would gladly have paid a reward to get it back."
+
+"Thank you, sir," George said quietly; "but all the same I would
+rather not be paid for a little thing like that."
+
+"You are a strange fellow," the gentleman said again. "One does not
+expect to find a boy in the market here refusing money when he has
+earned it."
+
+"I should not refuse it if I had earned it," George said; "but I don't
+call getting back a locket for a young lady who has lost it earning
+money."
+
+"How do you live, lad? You don't speak like a boy who has been brought
+up in the market here."
+
+"I have only been here three months," George said. "I came up to
+London to look for work, but could not get any. Most days I go about
+looking for it, and do what odd jobs I can get when there's a chance."
+
+"What sort of work do you want? Have you been accustomed to any work?
+Perhaps I could help you."
+
+"I have been a year as an errand-boy," George answered; "but I didn't
+like it, and I thought I would rather get some sort of work that I
+could work at when I got to be a man instead of sticking in a shop."
+
+"Did you run away from home, then?" the gentleman asked.
+
+"No, sir. My mother was ill and went into an infirmary, and so as I
+was alone I thought I would come to London and try to get the sort of
+work I liked; but I have tried almost all over London."
+
+"And are you all alone here?"
+
+"No, sir, not quite alone. I found a friend in that boy there, and we
+have worked together since I came up."
+
+"Well, lad, if you really want work I can give it you."
+
+"Oh, thank you, sir!" George exclaimed fervently.
+
+"And your friend too, if he likes. I have some works down at Limehouse
+and employ a good many boys. Here is the address;" and he took a card
+from his pocket, wrote a few words on the back of it, and handed it to
+George.
+
+"Ask for the foreman, and give him that, and he will arrange for you
+to begin work on Monday. Come along, Nellie; we have got to buy the
+fruit for to-morrow, you know."
+
+So saying he took his daughter's hand, and George, wild with delight,
+ran off to tell Bill that he had obtained work for them both.
+
+"Well, Nellie, are you satisfied?"
+
+"Yes, I am glad you could give him work, papa; didn't he look pleased?
+Wasn't it funny his saying he wouldn't have any money?"
+
+"Yes; I hardly expected to have met with a refusal in Covent Garden;
+but you were right, child, and you are a better judge of character
+than I gave you credit for. You said he was a nice-looking lad, and
+spoke like a gentleman, and he does. He is really a very good style of
+boy. Of course he is shabby and dirty now, and you see he has been an
+errand-boy at a grocer's; but he must have been better brought up than
+the generality of such lads. The one he called his friend looked a
+wild sort of specimen, altogether a different sort of boy. I should
+say he was one of the regular arabs hanging about this place. If so, I
+expect a very few days' work will sicken him; but I shouldn't be
+surprised if your boy, as you call him, sticks to it."
+
+The next morning the two boys presented themselves at Mr. Penrose's
+works at Limehouse. These were sawing and planing works, and the sound
+of many wheels, and the hoarse rasping sound of saws innumerable, came
+out through the open windows of the building as they entered the yard.
+
+"Now what do you boys want?" a workman said as he appeared at one of
+the doors.
+
+"We want to see the foreman," George said. "I have a card for him from
+Mr. Penrose."
+
+"I will let him know," the man replied.
+
+Two minutes later the foreman came out, and George handed him the
+card. He read what Mr. Penrose had written upon it and said:
+
+"Very well, you can come in on Monday; pay, eight shillings a week;
+seven o'clock; there, that will do. Oh, what are your names?" taking
+out a pocket-book. "George Andrews and William Smith;" and then, with
+a nod, he went back into his room, while the boys, almost bewildered
+at the rapidity with which the business had been arranged, went out
+into the street again.
+
+"There we are, Bill, employed," George said in delight.
+
+"Yes, there we is," Bill agreed, but in a more doubtful tone; "it's a
+rum start, aint it? I don't expect I shall make much hand of it, but I
+am wery glad for you, George."
+
+"Why shouldn't you make much hand of it? You are as strong as I am."
+
+"Yes; but then, you see, I aint been accustomed to work regular, and I
+expect I shan't like it--not at first; but I am going to try. George,
+don't yer think as I aint agoing to try. I aint that sort; still I
+expects I shall get the sack afore long."
+
+"Nonsense, Bill! you will like it when you once get accustomed to it,
+and it's a thousand times better having to draw your pay regularly at
+the end of the week than to get up in the morning not knowing whether
+you are going to have breakfast or not. Won't mother be pleased when I
+write and tell her I have got a place! Last time she wrote she said
+that she was a great deal better, and the doctor thought she would be
+out in the spring, and then I hope she will be coming up here, and
+that will be jolly."
+
+"Yes, that's just it," Bill said; "that's whear it is; you and I will
+get on fust-rate, but it aint likely as your mother would put up with
+a chap like me."
+
+"My mother knows that you have been a good friend to me, Bill, and
+that will be quite enough for her. You wait till you see her."
+
+"My eye, what a lot of little houses there is about here!" Bill said,
+"just all the same pattern; and how wide the streets is to what they
+is up Drury Lane!"
+
+"Yes, we ought to have no difficulty in getting a room here, Bill, now
+that we shall have money to pay for it; only think, we shall have
+sixteen shillings a week between us!"
+
+"It's a lot of money," Bill said vaguely. "Sixteen bob! My eye, there
+aint no saying what it will buy! I wish I looked a little bit more
+respectable," he said, with a new feeling as to the deficiencies of
+his attire. "It didn't matter in the Garden; but to go to work with a
+lot of other chaps, these togs aint what you may call spicy."
+
+"They certainly are not, Bill," George said with a laugh. "We must see
+what we can manage."
+
+George's own clothes were worn and old, but they looked respectable
+indeed by the side of those of his companion. Bill's elbows were both
+out, the jacket was torn and ragged, he had no waistcoat, and his
+trousers were far too large for him, and were kept up by a single
+brace, and were patched in a dozen places.
+
+When George first met him he was shoeless, but soon after they had set
+up housekeeping together George had bought from a cobbler's stall a
+pair of boots for two shillings, and these, although now almost
+falling to pieces, were still the best part of Bill's outfit.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III.
+
+WORK.
+
+
+The next morning George went out with the bundle containing his Sunday
+clothes, which had been untouched since his arrival in town, and going
+to an old-clothes shop he exchanged them for a suit of working clothes
+in fair condition, and then returning hid his bundle in the hay and
+rejoined Bill, who had from early morning been at work shelling
+walnuts. Although Bill was somewhat surprised at his companion not
+beginning work at the usual time he asked no questions, for his faith
+in George was so unbounded that everything he did was right in his
+eyes.
+
+"There is our last day's work in the market, Bill," George said as
+they reached their loft that evening.
+
+"It's your last day's work, George, I aint no doubt; but I expects it
+aint mine by a long way. I have been a-thinking over this 'ere go, and
+I don't think as it will act nohow. In the first place I aint fit to
+go to such a place, and they are sure to make it hot for me."
+
+"That's nonsense, Bill; there are lots of roughish sort of boys in
+works of that sort, and you will soon be at home with the rest."
+
+"In the next place," Bill went on, unheeding the interruption, "I
+shall be getting into some blooming row or other afore I have been
+there a week, and they will like enough turn you out as well as me.
+That's what I am a-thinking most on, George. If they chucks me the
+chances are as they chucks you too; and if they did that arter all the
+pains you have had to get a place I should go straight off and make a
+hole in the water. That's how I looks at it."
+
+"But I don't think, Bill, that there's any chance of your getting into
+a row. Of course at first we must both expect to be blown up
+sometimes, but if we do our best and don't answer back again we shall
+do as well as the others."
+
+"Oh, I shouldn't cheek 'em back," Bill said. "I am pretty well used to
+getting blown up. Every one's always at it, and I know well enough as
+it don't pay to cheek back, not unless you have got a market-cart
+between you and a clear road for a bolt. I wasn't born yesterday.
+Yer've been wery good to me, you have, George, and before any harm
+should come to yer through me, s'help me, I'd chuck myself under a
+market-wagon."
+
+"I know you would, Bill; but, whatever you say, you have been a far
+greater help to me than I have to you. Anyhow we are not going to part
+now. You are coming to work with me to start with, and I know you will
+do your best to keep your place. If you fail, well, so much the worse,
+it can't be helped; but after our being sent there by Mr. Penrose I
+feel quite sure that the foreman would not turn me off even if he had
+to get rid of you."
+
+"D'yer think so?"
+
+"I do, indeed, Bill."
+
+"Will yer take yer davey?"
+
+"Yes, if it's any satisfaction to you, Bill, I will take my davey that
+I do not think that they would turn me off even if they sent you
+away."
+
+"And yer really wants me to go with yer, so help yer?"
+
+"Really and truly, Bill."
+
+"Wery well, George, then I goes; but mind yer, it's 'cause yer wishes
+me."
+
+So saying, Bill curled himself up in the hay, and George soon heard by
+his regular breathing that he was sound asleep.
+
+The next morning, before anyone was stirring, they went down into the
+yard, as was their custom on Sunday mornings, for a good wash,
+stripping to the waist and taking it by turns to pump over each other.
+Bill had at first protested against the fashion, saying as he did very
+well and did not see no use in it; but seeing that George really
+enjoyed it he followed his example. After a morning or two, indeed,
+and with the aid of a piece of soap which George had bought, Bill got
+himself so bright and shiny as to excite much sarcastic comment and
+remark from his former companions, which led to more than one
+pugilistic encounter.
+
+That morning George remained behind in the loft for a minute or two
+after Bill had run down, attired only in his trousers. When Bill went
+up the ladder after his ablutions he began hunting about in the hay.
+
+"What are you up to, Bill?"
+
+"Blest if I can find my shirt. Here's two of yourn knocking about, but
+I can't see where's mine, nor my jacket neither."
+
+"It's no use your looking, Bill, for you won't find them, and even if
+you found them you couldn't put 'em on. I have torn them up."
+
+"Torn up my jacket!" Bill exclaimed in consternation. "What lark are
+yer up to now, George?"
+
+"No lark at all. We are going together to work to-morrow, and you
+could not go as you were; so you put on that shirt and those things,"
+and he threw over the clothes he had procured the day before.
+
+Bill looked in astonishment.
+
+"Why, where did yer get 'em, George? I knows yer only had four bob
+with what we got yesterday. Yer didn't find 'em, and yer didn't--no,
+in course yer didn't--nip 'em."
+
+"No, I didn't steal them certainly," George said, laughing. "I swapped
+my Sunday clothes for them yesterday. I can do without them very well
+till we earn enough to get another suit. There, don't say anything
+about it, Bill, else I will punch your head."
+
+Bill stared at him with open eyes for a minute, and then threw
+himself down in the hay and burst into tears.
+
+"Oh, I say, don't do that!" George exclaimed. "What have you to cry
+about?"
+
+"Aint it enough to make a cove cry," Bill sobbed, "to find a chap
+doing things for him like that? I wish I may die if I don't feel as if
+I should bust. It's too much, that's what it is, and it's all on one
+side; that's the wust of it."
+
+"I dare say you will make it even some time, Bill; so don't let's say
+anything more about it, but put on your clothes. We will have a cup of
+coffee each and a loaf between us for breakfast, and then we will go
+for a walk into the park, the same as we did last Sunday, and hear the
+preaching."
+
+The next morning they were up at their accustomed hour and arrived at
+the works at Limehouse before the doors were opened. Presently some
+men and boys arrived, the doors were opened, and the two boys followed
+the others in.
+
+"Hallo! who are you?" the man at the gate asked.
+
+George gave their names, and the man looked at his time-book.
+
+"Yes, it's all right; you are the new boys. You are to go into that
+planing-shop," and he pointed to one of the doors opening into the
+yard.
+
+The boys were not long before they were at work. Bill was ordered to
+take planks from a large pile and to hand them to a man, who passed
+them under one of the planing-machines. George was told to take them
+away as fast as they were finished and pile them against a wall. When
+the machines stopped for any adjustment or alteration both were to
+sweep up the shavings and ram them into bags, in which they were
+carried to the engine-house.
+
+For a time the boys were almost dazzled by the whirl of the machinery,
+the rapid motion of the numerous wheels and shafting overhead, and of
+the broad bands which carried the power from them to the machinery on
+the floor, by the storm of shavings which flew from the cutters, and
+the unceasing activity which prevailed around them. Beyond receiving
+an occasional order, shouted in a loud tone--for conversation in an
+ordinary voice would have been inaudible--nothing occurred till the
+bell rang at half-past eight for breakfast. Then the machinery
+suddenly stopped, and a strange hush succeeded the din which had
+prevailed.
+
+"How long have we got now?" George asked the man from whose bench he
+had been taking the planks.
+
+"Half an hour," the man said as he hurried away.
+
+"Well, what do you think of it, Bill?" George asked when they had got
+outside.
+
+"Didn't think as there could be such a row," Bill replied. "Why, talk
+about the Garden! Lor', why it aint nothing to it. I hardly knew what
+I was a-doing at first."
+
+"No more did I, Bill. You must mind what you do and not touch any of
+those straps and wheels and things. I know when I was at Croydon there
+was a man killed in a sawmill there by being caught in the strap; they
+said it drew him up and smashed him against the ceiling. And now we
+had better look out for a baker's."
+
+"I suppose there aint a coffee-stall nowhere handy?"
+
+"I don't suppose there is, Bill; at any rate we have no time to spare
+to look for one. There's a pump in the yard, so we can have a drink of
+water as we come back. Well, the work doesn't seem very hard, Bill,"
+George said as they ate their bread.
+
+"No, it aint hard," Bill admitted, "if it weren't for all them
+rattling wheels. But I expect it aint going to be like that regular.
+They've just gived us an easy job to begin with. Yer'll see it will be
+worse presently."
+
+"We shall soon get accustomed to the noise, Bill, and I don't think we
+shall find the work any harder. They don't put boys at hard work, but
+just jobs like we are doing, to help the men."
+
+"What shall we do about night, George?"
+
+"I think that at dinner-time we had better ask the man we work for. He
+looks a good-natured sort of chap. He may know of someone he could
+recommend us to."
+
+They worked steadily till dinner-time; then as they came out George
+said to the man with whom they were working:
+
+"We want to get a room. We have been lodging together in London, and
+don't know anyone down here. I thought perhaps you could tell us of
+some quiet, respectable people who have a room to let?"
+
+The man looked at George more closely than he had hitherto done.
+
+"Well, there aint many people as would care about taking in two boys,
+but you seem a well-spoken young chap and different to most of 'em. Do
+you think you could keep regular hours, and not come clattering in and
+out fifty times in the evening, and playing tom-fools' tricks of all
+sorts?"
+
+"I don't think we should be troublesome," George said; "and I am quite
+sure we shouldn't be noisy."
+
+"You would want to be cooked for, in course?"
+
+"No, I don't think so," George said. "Beyond hot water for a cup of
+tea in the evening, we should not want much cooking done, especially
+if there is a coffee-stall anywhere where we could get a cup in the
+morning."
+
+"You haven't got any traps, I suppose?"
+
+George looked puzzled.
+
+"I mean bed and chairs, and so on."
+
+George shook his head.
+
+"We might get them afterwards, but we haven't any now."
+
+"Well, I don't mind trying you young fellows. I have got a bedroom in
+my place empty. A brother of mine who lodged and worked with me has
+just got a job as foreman down in the country. At any rate I will try
+you for a week, and if at the end of that time you and my missis don't
+get on together you must shift. Two bob a week. I suppose that will
+about suit you?"
+
+George said that would suit very well, and expressed his thanks to the
+man for taking them in.
+
+They had been walking briskly since they left the works, and now
+stopped suddenly before the door of a house in a row. It was just like
+its neighbor, except that George noticed that the blinds and windows
+were cleaner than the others, and that the door had been newly painted
+and varnished.
+
+"Here we are," the man said. "You had best come in and see the missis
+and the room. Missis!" he shouted, and a woman appeared from the
+backroom. "I have let Harry's room, mother," he said, "and these are
+the new lodgers."
+
+"My stars, John!" she exclaimed; "you don't mean to say that you let
+the room to them two boys. I should have thought you had better sense.
+Why, they will be trampling up and down the stairs like young hosses,
+wear out the oil cloth, and frighten the baby into fits. I never did
+hear such a thing!"
+
+"I think they are quiet boys, Bessie, and won't give much trouble. At
+any rate I have agreed to try them for a week, and if you don't get
+on with them at the end of that time, of course they must go. They
+have only come to work at the shop to-day; they work with me, and as
+far as I can see they are quiet young chaps enough. Come along, lads,
+I will show you your room."
+
+It was halfway up the stairs, at the back of the house, over the
+kitchen, which was built out there. It was a comfortable little room,
+not large, but sufficiently so for two boys. There was a bed, a chest
+of drawers, two chairs, and a dressing-table, and a strip of carpet
+ran alongside the bed, and there was, moreover, a small fireplace.
+
+"Will that do for you?" the man asked.
+
+"Capitally," George said; "it could not be nicer;" while Bill was so
+taken aback by its comfort and luxury that he was speechless.
+
+"Well, that's settled, then," the man said. "If you have got any
+things you can bring 'em in when you like."
+
+"We have not got any to speak of," George said, flushing a little. "I
+came up from the country three months ago to look for work, and beyond
+odd jobs I have had nothing to do since, so that everything I had is
+pretty well gone; but I can pay a week's rent in advance," he said,
+putting his hand in his pocket.
+
+"Oh, you needn't mind that!" the man said; "as you work in the shop
+it's safe enough. Now I must get my dinner, else I shall be late for
+work."
+
+"Well, Bill, what do you think of that?" George asked as they left the
+house.
+
+"My eye," Bill exclaimed in admiration; "aint it nice just! Why, yer
+couldn't get a room like that, not furnished, anywhere near the
+market, not at four bob a week. Aint it clean just; so help me if the
+house don't look as if it has been scrubbed down every day! What a
+woman that must be for washing!"
+
+"Yes; we shall have to rub our feet well, Bill, and make as little
+mess as we can in going in and out."
+
+"I should think so," Bill said. "It don't seem to me as if it could be
+true as we're to have such a room as that to ourselves, and to walk
+into a house bold without being afraid as somebody would have his eye
+on you, and chivey you; and eight bob a week for grub regular."
+
+"Well, let's get some bread and cheese, Bill; pretty near half our
+time must be gone, and mind we must be very saving at first. There
+will be several things to get; a kettle and a teapot, and a coffeepot,
+and some cups and saucers, and we shall want a gridiron for frying
+rashers of bacon upon."
+
+"My eye, won't it be prime!" Bill broke in.
+
+"And we shall want some towels," George went on with his enumeration.
+
+"Towels!" repeated Bill. "What are they like?"
+
+"They are cloths for wiping your hands and face after you have
+washed."
+
+"Well, if yer says we wants 'em, George, of course we must get 'em;
+but I've always found my hands dried quick enough by themselves,
+especially if I gived 'em a rub on my trousers."
+
+"And then, Bill, you know," George went on, "I want to save every
+penny we can, so as to get some things to furnish two rooms by the
+time mother comes out."
+
+"Yes, in course we must," Bill agreed warmly, though a slight shade
+passed over his face at the thought that they were not to be always
+alone together. "Well, yer know, George, I am game for anythink. I can
+hold on with a penn'orth of bread a day. I have done it over and over,
+and if yer says the word I am ready to do it again."
+
+"No, Bill, we needn't do that," George laughed. "Still, we must live
+as cheap as we can. We will stick to bread for breakfast, and bread
+and cheese for dinner, and bread for supper, with sometimes a rasher
+as a great treat. At any rate we will try to live on six shillings a
+week."
+
+"Oh! we can do that fine," Bill said confidently; "and then two
+shillings for rent, and that will leave us eight shillings a week to
+put by."
+
+"Mother said that the doctor didn't think she would be able to come
+out 'til the spring. We are just at the beginning of November, so if
+she comes out the first of April, that's five months, say twenty-two
+weeks. Twenty-two weeks at eight shillings, let me see. That's eight
+pounds in twenty weeks, eight pounds sixteen altogether, that would
+furnish two rooms very well, I should think."
+
+"My eye, I should think so!" Bill exclaimed, for to his mind eight
+pound sixteen was an almost unheard-of sum, and the fact that his
+companion had been able to calculate it increased if possible his
+admiration for him.
+
+It needed but two or three days to reconcile Mrs. Grimstone to her new
+lodgers.
+
+"I wouldn't have believed," she said at the end of the week to a
+neighbor, "as two boys could have been that quiet. They comes in after
+work as regular as the master. They rubs their feet on the mat, and
+you can scarce hear 'em go upstairs, and I don't hear no more of 'em
+till they goes out agin in the morning. They don't come back here to
+breakfast or dinner. Eats it, I suppose, standing like."
+
+"But what do they do with themselves all the evening, Mrs. Grimstone?"
+
+"One of 'em reads to the other. I think I can hear a voice going
+regular over the kitchen."
+
+"And how's their room?"
+
+"As clean and tidy as a new pin. They don't lock the door when they
+goes out, and I looked in yesterday, expecting to find it like a
+pigsty; but they had made the bed afore starting for work, and set
+everything in its place, and laid the fire like for when they come
+back."
+
+Mrs. Grimstone was right. George had expended six pence in as many
+old books at a bookstall. One of them was a spelling-book, and he had
+at once set to work teaching Bill his letters. Bill had at first
+protested. "He had done very well without reading, and didn't see much
+good in it." However, as George insisted he gave way, as he would have
+done to any proposition whatever upon which his friend had set his
+mind. So for an hour every evening after they had finished tea Bill
+worked at his letters and spelling, and then George read aloud to him
+from one of the other books.
+
+"You must get on as fast as you can this winter, Bill," he said;
+"because when the summer evenings come we shall want to go for long
+walks."
+
+They found that they did very well upon the sum they agreed on. Tea
+and sugar cost less than George had expected. Mrs. Grimstone took in
+for them regularly a halfpenny-worth of milk, and for tea they were
+generally able to afford a bloater between them, or a very thin rasher
+of bacon. Their enjoyment of their meals was immense. Bill indeed
+frequently protested that they were spending too much money; but
+George said as long as they kept within the sum agreed upon, and paid
+their rent, coal, candles, and what little washing they required out
+of the eight shillings a week, they were doing very well.
+
+They had by this time got accustomed to the din of the machinery, and
+were able to work in comfort. Mr. Penrose had several times come
+through the room, and had given them a nod. After they had been there
+a month he spoke to Grimstone.
+
+"How do those boys do their work?"
+
+"Wonderful well, sir; they are the two best boys we have ever had. No
+skylarking about, and I never have to wait a minute for a plank. They
+generally comes in a few minutes before time and gets the bench
+cleared up. They are first-rate boys. They lodge with me, and two
+quieter and better-behaved chaps in a house there never was."
+
+"I am glad to hear it," Mr. Penrose said. "I am interested in them,
+and am pleased to hear so good an account."
+
+That Saturday, to their surprise, when they went to get their money
+they received ten shillings apiece.
+
+"That's two shillings too much," George said as the money was handed
+to them.
+
+"That's all right," the foreman said. "The governor ordered you both
+to have a rise."
+
+"My eye!" Bill said as they went out. "What do you think of that,
+George? Four bob a week more to put by regularly. How much more will
+that make by the time your mother comes?"
+
+"We won't put it all by, Bill. I think the other will be enough. This
+four shillings a week we will put aside at present for clothes. We
+want two more shirts apiece, and some more stockings, and we shall
+want some shoes before long, and another suit of clothes each. We must
+keep ourselves decent, you know."
+
+From the time when they began work the boys had gone regularly every
+Sunday morning to a small iron church near their lodging, and they
+also went to an evening service once a week. Their talk, too, at home
+was often on religion, for Bill was extremely anxious to learn, and
+although his questions and remarks often puzzled George to answer, he
+was always ready to explain things as far as he could.
+
+February came, and to George's delight he heard, from his mother that
+she was so much better that the doctor thought that when she came out
+at the end of April she would be as strong as she had ever been. Her
+eyes had benefited greatly by her long rest, and she said that she was
+sure she should be able to do work as before. She had written several
+times since they had been at Limehouse, expressing her great pleasure
+at hearing that George was so well and comfortable. At Christmas, the
+works being closed for four days, George had gone down to see her, and
+they had a delightful talk together. Christmas had indeed been a
+memorable occasion to the boys, for on Christmas Eve the carrier had
+left a basket at Grimstone's directed "George Andrews." The boys had
+prepared their Christmas dinner, consisting of some fine rashers of
+bacon and sixpenny-worth of cold plum pudding from a cook-shop, and
+had already rather lamented this outlay, for Mrs. Grimstone had that
+afternoon invited them to dine downstairs. George was reading from a
+book which he bought for a penny that morning when there was a knock
+at the door, and Mrs. Grimstone said:
+
+"Here is a hamper for you, George."
+
+"A hamper for me!" George exclaimed in astonishment, opening the door.
+"Why, whoever could have sent a hamper for me! It must be a mistake."
+
+"That's your name on the direction, anyhows," Mrs. Grimstone said.
+
+"Yes, that's my name, sure enough," George agreed, and at once began
+to unknot the string which fastened down the lid.
+
+"Here is a Christmas card at the top!" he shouted. He turned it over.
+On the back were the words:
+
+"With all good wishes, Helen Penrose."
+
+"Well, that is kind," George said in rather a husky voice; and indeed
+it was the kindness that prompted the gift rather than the gift itself
+that touched him.
+
+"Now, then, George," Bill remonstrated; "never mind that there card,
+let's see what's inside."
+
+The hamper was unpacked, and was found to contain a cold goose, a
+Christmas pudding, and some oranges and apples. These were all placed
+on the table, and when Mrs. Grimstone had retired Bill executed a
+war-dance in triumph and delight.
+
+"I never did see such a game," he said at last, as he sat down
+exhausted. "There's a Christmas dinner for yer! Why, it's like them
+stories of the genii you was a-telling me about--chaps as come
+whenever yer rubbed a ring or an old lamp, and brought a tuck-out or
+whatever yer asked for. Of course that wasn't true; yer told me it
+wasn't, and I shouldn't have believed it if yer hadn't, but this 'ere
+is true. Now I sees, George, as what yer said was right and what I
+said was wrong. I thought yer were a flat 'cause yer wouldn't take
+nothing for getting back that there locket, and now yer see what's
+come of it, two good berths for us and a Christmas dinner fit for a
+king. Now what are we going to do with it, 'cause yer know we dines
+with them downstairs to-morrow?"
+
+"The best thing we can do, I think," George answered, "will be to
+invite all of them downstairs, Bob Grimstone, his wife, and the three
+young uns, to supper, not to-morrow night nor the night after, because
+I shan't be back from Croydon till late, but say the evening after."
+
+"But we can't hold them all," Bill said, looking round the room.
+
+"No, we can't hold them here, certainly, but I dare say they will let
+us have the feed in their parlor. There will be nothing to get, you
+know, but some bread and butter, and some beer for Bob. Mrs. Grimstone
+don't take it, so we must have plenty of tea."
+
+"I should like some beer too, just for once, George, with such a
+blow-out as that."
+
+"No, no, Bill, you and I will stick to tea. You know we agreed that we
+wouldn't take beer. If we begin it once we shall want it again, so we
+are not going to alter from what we agreed to. We see plenty of the
+misery which drink causes all round and the way in which money is
+wasted over it. I like a glass of beer as well as you do, and when I
+get to be a man I dare say I shall take a glass with my dinner
+regularly, though I won't do even that if I find it makes me want to
+take more; but anyhow at present we can do without it."
+
+Bill agreed, and the dinner-party downstairs and the supper two nights
+afterwards came off in due course, and were both most successful.
+
+The acknowledgment of the gift had been a matter of some trouble to
+George, but he had finally bought a pretty New Year's card and had
+written on the back, "with the grateful thanks of George Andrews," and
+had sent it to the daughter of his employer.
+
+At the beginning of April George had consulted Grimstone and his wife
+as to the question of preparing a home for his mother.
+
+"How much would two rooms cost?" he had asked; "one a good-sized one
+and the other the same size as ours."
+
+"Four shillings or four and sixpence," Mrs. Grimstone replied.
+
+"And supposing we had a parlor and two little bedrooms?"
+
+"Five and sixpence or six shillings, I should say," Mrs. Grimstone
+replied.
+
+"And how much for a whole house?"
+
+"It depends upon the size. We pay seven shillings a week, but you
+might get one without the kitchen and bedroom over it behind for six
+shillings."
+
+"That would be much the nicest," George said, "only it would cost such
+a lot to furnish it."
+
+"But you needn't furnish it all at once," Mrs. Grimstone suggested.
+"Just a kitchen and two bedrooms for a start, and you can put things
+into the parlor afterwards. That's the way we did when we first
+married. But you must have some furniture."
+
+"And how much will it cost for the kitchen and two bedrooms?"
+
+"Of course going cheaply to work and buying the things secondhand, I
+should say I could pick up the things for you, so that you could do
+very well," Mrs. Grimstone said, "for six or seven pounds."
+
+"That will do capitally," George said, "for by the end of this month
+Bill and I will have more than ten pounds laid by."
+
+"What! since you came here?" Grimstone exclaimed in astonishment. "Do
+you mean to say you boys have laid by five pounds apiece?"
+
+"Yes, and bought a lot of things too," his wife put in.
+
+"Why, you must have been starving yourselves!"
+
+"We don't look like it," George laughed. "I am sure Bill is a stone
+heavier than when he came here."
+
+"Well, young chap, it does you a lot of credit," Bob Grimstone said.
+"It isn't every boy, by a long way, would stint himself as you must
+have done for the last five months to make a comfortable home for his
+mother, for I know lots of men who are earning their two quid a week
+and has their old people in the workhouse. Well, all I can say is that
+if I or the missis here can be of any use to you in taking a house we
+shall be right down glad."
+
+"Thank you," George said. "We will look about for a house, and when we
+have fixed on one if you or Mrs. Grimstone will go about it for us I
+shall be much obliged, for I don't think landlords would be inclined
+to let a house to two boys."
+
+"All right, George! we will do that for you with pleasure. Besides,
+you know, there are things, when you are going to take a house, that
+you stand out for; such as papering and painting, or putting in a new
+range, and things of that sort."
+
+After their dinner on the following Sunday the two boys set out
+house-hunting.
+
+"If it's within a mile that will do," George said. "It doesn't matter
+about our going home in the breakfast time. We can bring our grub in a
+basket and our tea in a bottle, as several of the hands do; but if
+it's over a mile we shall have to hurry to get there and back for
+dinner. Still there are plenty of houses in a mile."
+
+There were indeed plenty of houses, in long regular rows, bare and
+hard-looking, but George wanted to find something more pleasant and
+homelike than these. Late in the afternoon he came upon what he
+wanted. It was just about a mile from the works and beyond the lines
+of regular streets. Here he found a turning off the main road with but
+eight houses in it, four on each side. It looked as if the man who
+built them had intended to run a street down for some distance, but
+had either been unable to obtain enough ground or had changed his
+mind.
+
+They stood in pairs, each with its garden in front, with a bow-window
+and little portico. They appeared to be inhabited by a different class
+to those who lived in the rows, chiefly by city clerks, for the
+gardens were nicely kept, the blinds were clean and spotless, muslin
+curtains hung in the windows, and fancy tables with pretty ornaments
+stood between them. Fortunately one of them, the last on the left-hand
+side, was to let.
+
+"What do you think of this, Bill?"
+
+"It seems to be just the thing; but how about the rent, George? I
+should think they were awful dear."
+
+"I don't suppose they are any more than the houses in the rows, Bill.
+They are very small, you see, and I don't suppose they would suit
+workmen as well as the others; at any rate we will see."
+
+Whereupon George noted down on a scrap of paper the name of the agent
+of whom inquiry was to be made.
+
+"No. 8," he said; "but what's the name of the street? Oh, there it is.
+Laburnum Villas. No. 8 Laburnum Villas; that sounds first-rate,
+doesn't it? I will get Mrs. Grimstone to go round to the agent
+to-morrow."
+
+This Mrs. Grimstone agreed to do directly she was asked. After
+speaking to her husband she said, "I will get the key from the agent's
+and will be there just after twelve to-morrow, so if you go there
+straight when you get out you will be able to see the rooms and what
+state it's in."
+
+"But how about Bob's dinner?" George asked.
+
+"Oh, he will have it cold to-morrow, and I will set it out for him
+before I start."
+
+"That is very kind, Mrs. Grimstone, thank you very much. It would be
+just the thing."
+
+Accordingly, at ten minutes past twelve on the following day the two
+boys arrived breathless at No. 8 Laburnum Villas.
+
+"Hurrah!" George shouted, "there is Mrs. Grimstone at the window."
+
+The door was opened and they rushed in.
+
+"It's a tidy little place," Mrs. Grimstone said; "and it's in good
+order and won't want any money laying out upon it."
+
+The house was certainly small, but the boys were delighted with it. On
+the ground-floor were two little rooms opening with folding doors,
+and a little kitchen built out behind. There was a room over this, and
+two rooms above the sitting rooms.
+
+"That's just the right number," George said, "a bedroom each for us;
+it couldn't be nicer; and what pretty paper!"
+
+"And there is a good long slip of garden behind," Mrs. Grimstone said,
+"where you could grow lots of vegetables. Of course in the front you
+would have flowers."
+
+"And how much do they want for it?"
+
+"Seven and sixpence a week, including rates and taxes. I call it dear
+for its size, but then of course it's got the garden and it looks
+pretty and nice. The agent says it's been painted and papered from top
+to bottom since the last people left, but he says the owner won't let
+it unless somebody comes who is likely to stop, and he will want
+references of respectability."
+
+"All right!" George said; "I can manage that," for he had already been
+thinking of the question in his mind; "and we can manage seven and
+sixpence a week; can't we, Bill?"
+
+"We will try, anyhow," Bill said stoutly, for he was as much pleased
+with the cottage as George was.
+
+They explored the garden behind the house. This was about a hundred
+feet long by twenty-five wide. Half of it was covered with stumps of a
+plantation of cabbages, the other half was empty and had evidently
+been dug up by the last tenants ready for planting.
+
+"Why, I should think we shall be able to grow all our own potatoes
+here!" George exclaimed in delight.
+
+Mrs. Grimstone was a country woman, and she shook her head.
+
+"You wouldn't be able to do that, George, not if you gave it all up to
+potatoes; but if you planted the further end with potatoes you might
+get a good many, and then, you know, at this end you might have three
+or four rows of peas and French beans, and lettuces and such like, but
+you will have to get some manure to put in. Things won't grow without
+manure even in the country, and I am sure they won't here; and then
+you know you can have flowers in the front of the house. But it's time
+for you to be off, else you will be late at the works. I am sure it's
+more than half an hour since you came in. I will take the key back and
+tell them they shall have an answer by Wednesday or Thursday."
+
+George did not think they could have been a quarter of an hour;
+however, he and Bill started at a trot, which they increased into a
+run at the top of their speed when the first clock they saw pointed to
+seven minutes to one. The bell was ringing as they approached the
+works; it stopped when they were within fifty yards, and the gate was
+just closing as they rushed up.
+
+"Too late," the man said.
+
+"Oh, do let us through," George panted out; "it's the first time we
+have ever been late, and we have run a mile to be here in time!"
+
+"Oh, it's you, is it?" the man said, opening the gate a few inches to
+look through. "Ah, well I will let you in this time, 'cause you are
+well-behaved young chaps; but don't you run it so close another time,
+else you will have to lose your hour."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV.
+
+HOME.
+
+
+That evening George wrote a letter to Dr. Jeffries at Croydon, saying
+that he had taken a little house for his mother to come to when she
+came out of the infirmary, and as he had kindly said that he would
+render her help if he could, would he be good enough to write to the
+agent whose address he gave, saying that Mrs. Andrews, who was about
+taking No. 8 Laburnum Villas, was a person of respectability.
+
+The following evening he received a letter from the doctor saying that
+he had written to the agent, and that he was glad indeed to hear that
+George was getting on so well that he was able to provide a home for
+his mother.
+
+On Wednesday at dinner-time Mrs. Grimstone handed George a key.
+
+"There you are, George. You are master of the house now. The agent
+said the reference was most satisfactory; so I paid him the seven and
+sixpence you gave me for a week's rent in advance, and you can go in
+when you like. We shall be sorry to lose you both, for I don't want
+two better lodgers. You don't give no trouble, and all has been quiet
+and pleasant in the house; and to think what a taking I was in that
+day as Bob brought you here for the first time, to think as he had let
+the room to two boys. But there, one never knows, and I wouldn't have
+believed it as boys could be so quiet in a house."
+
+"Now we must begin to see about furniture," Bob Grimstone said. "The
+best plan, I think, will be for you two to go round of an evening to
+all the shops in the neighborhood, and mark off just what you think
+will suit you. You put down the prices stuck on them, and just what
+they are, and then the missis can go in the morning and bargain for
+them. She will get them five shillings in the pound cheaper than you
+would. It's wonderful how women do beat men down, to be sure. When a
+man hears what's the price of a thing he leaves it or takes it just as
+he likes, but a woman begins by offering half the sum. Then the chap
+says no, and she makes as if she was going away; he lets her go a
+little way and then he hollers after her, and comes down a goodish bit
+in the price. Then she says she don't particularly want it and
+shouldn't think of giving any such price as that. Then he tries again,
+and so they gets on till they hit on a figure as suits them both. You
+see that little tea-caddy in the corner? My wife was just three weeks
+buying that caddy. The chap wanted seven and six for it, and she
+offered him half a crown. He came down half a crown at the end of the
+first week, and at last she got it for three and nine. Now, the first
+thing you have got to do is to make out a list. First of all you have
+got to put down the things as you must have, and then the things you
+can do without, though you will get them if you can afford it. Mother
+will help you at that."
+
+So Mrs. Grimstone and George sat down with paper and a pencil, and
+George was absolutely horrified at the list of things which Mrs.
+Grimstone declared were absolutely indispensable. However, after much
+discussion, some few items were marked as doubtful. When the list was
+finished the two boys started on an exploring expedition, and the next
+week all their evenings were fully occupied. In ten days after they
+began the three bedrooms and the kitchen were really smartly
+furnished, Mrs. Grimstone proving a wonderful hand at bargaining, and
+making the ten pounds go farther than George had believed possible. On
+the Sunday Bob went with his wife and the boys to inspect the house.
+
+"It's a very comfortable little place," he said, "and that front
+bedroom with the chintz curtains the missis made up is as nice a
+little room as you want to see. As to the others they will do well
+enough for you boys."
+
+The only articles of furniture in the sitting room were two long
+muslin curtains, which Mrs. Grimstone had bought a bargain at a shop
+selling off; for it was agreed that this was necessary to give the
+house a furnished appearance. Bob Grimstone was so much pleased at
+what had been done that he shared George's feeling of regret that one
+of the sitting rooms could not also be furnished, and on the walk home
+said:
+
+"Look here, George. I know you would like to have the house nice for
+your mother. You couldn't make one of those sitting rooms comfortable
+not under a five-pound note, not even with the missis to market for
+you, but you might for that. I have got a little money laid by in the
+savings-bank, and I will lend you five pounds, and welcome, if you
+like to take it. I know it will be just as safe with you as it will be
+there."
+
+"Thank you very much, Bob--thank you very much, but I won't take it.
+In the first place, I should like mother to know that the furniture is
+all ours, bought out of Bill's savings and mine; and in the next
+place, I should find it hard at first to pay back anything. I think we
+can just manage on our money, but that will be all. I told you mother
+does work, but she mayn't be able to get any at first, so we can't
+reckon on that. When she does, you know, we shall be able gradually to
+buy the furniture."
+
+"Well, perhaps you are right, George," the man said after a pause.
+"You would have been welcome to the money: but perhaps you are right
+not to take it. I borrowed a little money when I first went into
+housekeeping, and it took a wonderful trouble to pay off, and if
+there's illness or anything of that sort it weighs on you. Not that I
+should be in any hurry about it. It wouldn't worry me, but it would
+worry you."
+
+A week later Mrs. Andrews was to leave the infirmary, and on Saturday
+George asked for a day off to go down to fetch her. Every evening
+through the week he and Bill had worked away at digging up the garden.
+Fortunately there was a moon, for it was dark by the time they came
+out from the works. Bill was charged with the commission to lay in the
+store of provisions for the Sunday, and he was to be sure to have a
+capital fire and tea ready by four o'clock, the hour at which George
+calculated he would be back.
+
+Very delighted was George as in his best suit--for he and Bill had two
+suits each now--he stepped out of the train at Croydon and walked to
+the workhouse. His mother had told him that she would meet him at the
+gate at half-past two, and punctually at the time he was there. A few
+minutes later Mrs. Andrews came out, not dressed as he had seen her at
+Christmas, in the infirmary garb, but in her own clothes. George gave
+a cry of delight as he ran forward to meet her.
+
+"My darling mother! and you are looking quite yourself again."
+
+"I am, thank God, George. It has seemed a long nine months, but the
+rest and quiet have done wonders for me. Everyone has been very kind;
+and of course the knowledge, dear boy, that you had got work that you
+liked helped me to get strong again. And you are looking well too; and
+your friend, I hope he is well?"
+
+"Quite well, mother, but in a great fright about you. He is glad you
+are coming because I am glad; but the poor fellow has quite made up
+his mind that you won't like him and you won't think him a fit
+companion for me. I told him over and over again that you are not that
+sort; but nothing can persuade him. Of course, mother, he doesn't talk
+good grammar, and he uses some queer expressions; but he is very much
+changed in that way since I first knew him, and he tries very hard,
+and don't mind a bit how often I correct him, and he is beginning to
+read easy words quite well; and he is one of the best-hearted fellows
+in the world."
+
+"If he is kind to you, George, and fond of you, that's enough for me,"
+Mrs. Andrews said; "but I have no doubt I shall soon like him for
+himself. You could not like him as much as you do if there were not
+something nice about him. And you have succeeded in getting a room for
+me in the house in which you lodge?" for George had never mentioned a
+word in his letter about taking a house, and had asked Dr. Jeffries if
+he should see his mother to say nothing to her about his application
+to him.
+
+"Yes, that's all right, mother," he replied briskly.
+
+"And you have got some new clothes since I saw you last, George. You
+wanted them; yours were getting rather shabby when I saw you at
+Christmas."
+
+"Yes, mother, they were."
+
+"I suppose you had to part with your best suit while you were so long
+out of work?"
+
+"That was it, mother; but you see I have been able to get some more
+things. They are only cheap ones, you know, but they will do very well
+until I can afford better ones. I am not walking too fast for you, am
+I? But we shall just catch the train. Or look here, would you mind
+going straight by yourself to the railway station? Then you can walk
+slowly. I will go round and get your box. I went into our old place as
+I came along, and Mrs. Larkins said she would bring it downstairs for
+me as I came back."
+
+"No, I would rather go round with you, George. I want to thank her for
+having kept it for me so long. Even if we do miss the train it will
+not matter much, as it will make no difference whether we get in town
+an hour earlier or later."
+
+As George could not explain his special reason for desiring to catch
+that train he was obliged to agree, and they stopped a quarter of an
+hour at their old lodging, as Mrs. Larkins insisted upon their having
+a cup of tea which she had prepared for them. However, when they
+reached the station they found that a train was going shortly, and
+when they reached town they were not so very much later than George
+had calculated upon.
+
+They took a cab, for although Mrs. Andrews' box was not heavy, it was
+too much for George to carry that distance; besides, Mrs. Andrews
+herself was tired from her walk to the station from the infirmary,
+having had no exercise for so long. When they got into the
+neighborhood of Limehouse George got outside to direct the cabman. It
+was just a quarter past four when the cab drew up at No. 8 Laburnum
+Villas.
+
+"Why, is this the house?" Mrs. Andrews asked in surprise as George
+jumped down and opened the door. "Why, you told me in one of your
+letters it was a house in a row. What a pretty little place! It is
+really here, George?"
+
+"It is here, mother; we moved the other day. There is Bill at the
+door;" but Bill, having opened the door, ran away out into the garden,
+and George, having paid the cabman, carried his mother's box in and
+entered the house with her.
+
+"Straight on, mother, into the little room at the end."
+
+"What a snug little kitchen!" Mrs. Andrews said as she entered it;
+"and tea all laid and ready! What, have they lent you the room for
+this evening?"
+
+"My dear mother," George said, throwing his arms round her neck,
+"this is your kitchen and your house, all there is of it, only the
+sitting room isn't furnished yet. We must wait for that, you know."
+
+"What! you have taken a whole house, my boy! that is very nice; but
+can we afford it, George? It seems too good to be true."
+
+"It is quite true, mother, and I think it's a dear little house, and
+will be splendid when we have got it all furnished. Now come up and
+see the bedrooms. This is Bill's, you know," and he opened the door on
+the staircase, "and this is mine, and this is yours."
+
+"Oh, what a pretty little room!" Mrs. Andrews said: "but, my dear
+George, the rent of this house and the hire of the furniture will
+surely be more than we can afford to pay. I know what a good manager
+you are, my boy, but I have such a horror of getting into debt that it
+almost frightens me."
+
+"The rent of the house is seven and sixpence a week, mother, with
+rates and taxes, and we can afford that out of Bill's earnings and
+mine, even if you did not do any work at all; and as to the furniture,
+it is every bit paid for out of our savings since we went to work."
+
+On hearing which Mrs. Andrews threw her arms round George's neck and
+burst into tears of happiness. She was not very strong, and the
+thought of the sacrifices these two boys must have made to get a
+house together for her completely overpowered her.
+
+"It seems impossible, George," she said when she had recovered
+herself. "Why, you have only been earning ten shillings a week each,
+and you have had to keep yourselves and get clothes and all sorts of
+things; it seems impossible."
+
+"It has not cost so much as you think, mother, and Bill and I had both
+learned to live cheap in Covent Garden; but now let us go downstairs;
+you have not seen Bill yet, and I know tea will be ready."
+
+But Bill had not yet come in, and George had to go out into the garden
+to fetch him.
+
+"Come on, Bill; mother is delighted with everything. She won't eat
+you, you know."
+
+"No, she won't eat me, George; but she will think me an out-and-out
+sort of 'ottentot," which word had turned up in a book the boys had
+been reading on an evening previously.
+
+"Well, wait till she says so; come along."
+
+So linking his arm in Bill's, George drew him along, and brought him
+shamefaced and bashful into the kitchen.
+
+"This is Bill, mother."
+
+"I am glad to see you, Bill," Mrs. Andrews said, holding out her hand.
+"I have heard so much of you from George that I seem to know you quite
+well."
+
+Bill put his hand out shyly.
+
+"I am sure we shall get on well together," Mrs. Andrews went on. "I
+shall never forget that you were a friend to my boy when he was
+friendless in London."
+
+"It's all the t'other way, ma'am," Bill said eagerly; "don't you go
+for to think it. Why, just look what George has done for me! There was
+I, a-hanging about the Garden, pretty nigh starving, and sure to get
+quadded sooner or later; and now here I am living decent, and earning
+a good wage; and he has taught me to read, ma'am, and to know about
+things, and aint been ashamed of me, though I am so different to what
+he is. I tell you, ma'am, there aint no saying what a friend he's been
+to me, and I aint done nothing for him as I can see."
+
+"Well, Bill, you perhaps both owe each other something," Mrs. Andrews
+said: "and I owe you something as well as my son, for George tells me
+that it is to your self-denial as well as to his own that I owe this
+delightful surprise of finding a home ready for me; and now," she went
+on, seeing how confused and unhappy Bill looked, "I think you two
+ought to make tea this evening, for you are the hosts, and I am the
+guest. In future it will be my turn."
+
+"All right, mother! you sit down in this armchair; Bill, you do the
+rashers, and I will pour the water into the pot and then toast the
+muffins."
+
+Bill was at home now; such culinary efforts as they had hitherto
+attempted had generally fallen to his share, as he had a greater
+aptitude for the work than George had, and a dish of bacon fried to a
+turn was soon upon the table.
+
+Mrs. Andrews had been watching Bill closely, and was pleased with the
+result of her observation. Bill was indeed greatly improved in
+appearance since he had first made George's acquaintance. His cheeks
+had filled out, and his face had lost its hardness of outline; the
+quick, restless, hunted expression of his eyes had nearly died out,
+and he no longer looked as if constantly on the watch to dodge an
+expected cuff; his face had always had a large share of that merriment
+and love of fun which seem the common portion of the London arabs, and
+seldom desert them under all their hardships; but it was a happier and
+brighter spirit now, and had altogether lost its reckless character. A
+similar change is always observable among the waifs picked up off the
+streets by the London refuges after they have been a few months on
+board a training ship.
+
+When all was ready the party sat down to their meal. Mrs. Andrews
+undertook the pouring out of the tea, saying that although she was a
+guest, as the only lady present she should naturally preside. George
+cut the bread, and Bill served the bacon. The muffins were piled on a
+plate in the front of the fire as a second course.
+
+It was perhaps the happiest meal that any of the three had ever sat
+down to. Mrs. Andrews was not only happy at finding so comfortable a
+home prepared for her, but was filled with a deep feeling of pride and
+thankfulness at the evidence of the love, steadiness, and
+self-sacrifice of her son. George was delighted at having his mother
+with him again, and at seeing her happiness and contentment at the
+home he had prepared for her. Bill was delighted because George was
+so, and he was moreover vastly relieved at finding Mrs. Andrews less
+terrible than he had depicted her.
+
+After tea was cleared away they talked together for a while, and then
+Bill--feeling with instinctive delicacy that George and his mother
+would like to talk together for a time--said he should take a turn for
+an hour, and on getting outside the house executed so wild a war-dance
+of satisfaction that it was fortunate it was dark, or Laburnum Villas
+would have been astonished and scandalized at the spectacle.
+
+"I like your friend Bill very much," Mrs. Andrews said when she was
+alone with George. "I was sure from what you told me that he must be a
+good-hearted lad; but brought up as he has been, poor boy, I feared a
+little that he would scarcely be a desirable companion in point of
+manners. Of course, as you say, his grammar is a little peculiar; but
+his manners are wonderfully quiet and nice, considering all."
+
+"Look what an example he's had, mother," George laughed; "but really
+he has taken great pains ever since he knew that you were coming
+home. He has been asking me to tell him of anything he does which is
+not right, especially about eating and that sort of thing. You see he
+had never used a fork till we came down here, and he made me show him
+directly how it should be held and what to do with it. It has been
+quite funny to me to see him watching me at meals, and doing exactly
+the same."
+
+"And you have taught him to read, George?"
+
+"Yes, mother."
+
+"And something of better things, George?" she asked.
+
+"Yes, mother, as much as I could. He didn't know anything when I met
+him; but he goes to church with me now regularly, and says his prayers
+every night, and I can tell you he thinks a lot of it. More, I think,
+than I ever did," he added honestly.
+
+"Perhaps he has done you as much good as you have done him, George."
+
+"Perhaps he has, mother; yes, I think so. When you see a chap so very
+earnest for a thing you can't help being earnest yourself; besides,
+you know, mother," he went on a little shyly, for George had not been
+accustomed to talk much of these matters with his mother--"you see
+when one's down in the world and hard up, and not quite sure about the
+next meal, and without any friend, one seems to think more of these
+things than one does when one is jolly at school with other fellows."
+
+"Perhaps so, George, though I do not know why it should be so, for the
+more blessings one has the more reason for love and gratitude to the
+giver. However, dear, I think we have both reason to be grateful now,
+have we not?"
+
+"That we have, mother. Only think of the difference since we said
+good-by to each other last summer! Now here you are strong and well
+again, and we are together and don't mean to be separated, and I have
+got a place I like and have a good chance of getting on in, and we
+have got a pretty little house all to ourselves, and you will be able
+to live a little like a lady again,--I mean as you were accustomed
+to,--and everything is so nice. Oh, mother, I am sure we have every
+reason to be grateful!"
+
+"We have indeed, George, and I even more than you, in the proofs you
+have given me that my son is likely to turn out all that even I could
+wish him."
+
+Bill's hour was a very long one.
+
+"You must not go out of an evening, Bill, to get out of our way," Mrs.
+Andrews said when he returned, "else I shall think that I am in your
+way. It was kind of you to think of it the first evening, and George
+and I are glad to have had a long talk together, but in future I hope
+you won't do it. You see there will be lots to do of an evening. There
+will be your lessons and George's, for I hope now that he's settled he
+will give up an hour or two every evening to study. Not Latin and
+Greek, George," she added, smiling, seeing a look of something like
+dismay in George's face, "that will be only a waste of time to you
+now, but a study of such things as may be useful to you in your
+present work and in your future life, and a steady course of reading
+really good books by good authors. Then perhaps when you have both
+done your work, you will take it by turns to read out loud while I do
+my sewing. Then perhaps some day, who knows, if we get on very
+flourishingly, after we have furnished our sitting room, we may be
+able to indulge in the luxury of a piano again and have a little music
+of an evening."
+
+"That will be jolly, mother. Why, it will be really like old times,
+when you used to sing to me!"
+
+Mrs. Andrews' eyes filled with tears at the thought of the old times,
+but she kept them back bravely, so as not to mar, even for a moment,
+the happiness of this first evening. So they chatted till nine
+o'clock, when they had supper. After it was over Mrs. Andrews left the
+room for a minute and went upstairs and opened her box, and returned
+with a Bible in her hand.
+
+"I think, boys," she said, "we ought to end this first happy evening
+in our new home by thanking God together for his blessings."
+
+"I am sure we ought, mother," George said, and Bill's face expressed
+his approval.
+
+So Mrs. Andrews read a chapter, and then they knelt and thanked God
+for his blessings, and the custom thus begun was continued henceforth
+in No. 8 Laburnum Villas.
+
+Hitherto George and his companion had found things much more pleasant
+at the works than they had expected. They had, of course, had
+principally to do with Bob Grimstone; still there were many other men
+in the shop, and at times, when his bench was standing idle while some
+slight alterations or adjustment of machinery were made, they were set
+to work with others. Men are quick to see when boys are doing their
+best, and, finding the lads intent upon their work and given neither
+to idleness nor skylarking, they seldom had a sharp word addressed to
+them. But after Mrs. Andrews had come home they found themselves
+addressed in a warmer and more kindly manner by the men. Bob Grimstone
+had told two or three of his mates of the sacrifices the boys had made
+to save up money to make a home for the mother of one of them when she
+came out of hospital. They were not less impressed than he had been,
+and the story went the round of the workshops and even came to the
+ears of the foreman, and there was not a man there but expressed
+himself in warm terms of surprise and admiration that two lads should
+for six months have stinted themselves of food in order to lay by half
+their pay for such a purpose.
+
+"There's precious few would have done such a thing," one of the older
+workmen said, "not one in a thousand; why, not one chap in a hundred,
+even when he's going to be married, will stint himself like that to
+make a home for the gal he is going to make his wife, so as to start
+housekeeping out of debt; and as to doing it for a mother, where will
+you find 'em? In course a man ought to do as much for his mother as
+for the gal who is agoing to be his wife, seeing how much he owes her;
+but how many does it, that's what I says, how many does it?"
+
+So after that the boys were surprised to find how many of the men,
+when they met them at the gate, would give them a kindly nod or a
+hearty, "Good-morning, young chaps!"
+
+A day or two after Mrs. Andrews had settled in Laburnum Villas she
+went up to town and called upon a number of shops, asking for work. As
+she was able to give an excellent reference to the firm for whom she
+had worked at Croydon she succeeded before the end of the week in
+obtaining millinery work for a firm in St. Paul's Churchyard, and as
+she had excellent taste and was very quick at her needle she was soon
+able to earn considerably more than she had done at Croydon.
+
+The three were equally determined that they would live as closely as
+possible until the sitting-rooms were furnished, and by strict
+management they kept within the boys' pay, Mrs. Andrews' earnings
+being devoted to the grand purpose. The small articles were bought
+first, and each week there was great congratulation and pleasure as
+some new article was placed in the rooms. Then there was a pause for
+some time, then came the chairs, then after an interval a table, and
+lastly the carpet. This crowning glory was not attained until the end
+of July. After this they moved solemnly into the sitting-room,
+agreeing that the looking-glass, chiffonier, and sofa could be added
+at a more gradual rate, and that the whole of Mrs. Andrews' earnings
+need no longer be devoted.
+
+"Now, boys," Mrs. Andrews said on that memorable evening, "I want you
+in future, when you come in, to change your working clothes before you
+come in here to your teas. So long as we lived in the kitchen I have
+let things go on, but I think there's something in the old saying,
+'Company clothes, company manners,' and I think it is good when boys
+come in that they should lay aside their heavy-nailed shoes and their
+working clothes. Certainly such boots and clothes are apt to render
+people clumsy in their movements, and the difference of walk which you
+observe between men of different classes arises very greatly from the
+clumsy, heavy boots which workingmen must wear."
+
+"But what does it matter, mother?" George urged, for it seemed to him
+that it would be rather a trouble to change his clothes every day.
+"These little things don't make any real difference to a man."
+
+"Not any vital difference, George, but a real difference for all
+that. Manners make the man, you know! that is, they influence
+strangers and people who only know him in connection with business. If
+two men apply together for a place the chances are strongly in favor
+of the man with the best manners getting it. Besides, my boy, I think
+the observance of little courtesies of this kind make home pleasanter
+and brighter. You see I always change my dress before tea, and I am
+sure you prefer my sitting down to the table tidy and neat with a
+fresh collar and cuffs, to my taking my place in my working dress with
+odds and ends of threads and litter clinging to it."
+
+"Of course I do, mother, and I see what you mean now. Certainly I will
+change my things in future. You don't mind, do you, Bill?"
+
+Bill would not have minded in the least any amount of trouble by which
+he could give the slightest satisfaction to Mrs. Andrews, who had now
+a place in his affections closely approximating to that which George
+occupied.
+
+During the summer months the programme for the evening was not carried
+out as arranged, for at the end of April Mrs. Andrews herself declared
+that there must be a change.
+
+"The evenings are getting light enough now for a walk after tea, boys,
+and you must therefore cut short our reading and studies till the days
+close in again in the autumn. It would do you good to get out in the
+air a bit."
+
+"But will you come with us, mother?"
+
+"No, George. Sometimes as evenings get longer we may make little
+excursions together: go across the river to Greenwich and spend two or
+three hours in the park, or take a steamer and go up the river to Kew;
+but as a general thing you had better take your rambles together. I
+have my front garden to look after, the vegetables are your work, you
+know, and if I like I can go out and do whatever shopping I have to do
+while you two are away."
+
+So the boys took to going out walks, which got longer and longer as
+the evenings drew out, and when they were not disposed for a long
+ramble they would go down to a disused wharf and sit there and watch
+the barges drifting down the river or tacking backwards and forwards,
+if there was a wind, with their great brown and yellow sails hauled
+tautly in, and the great steamers dropping quietly down the river, and
+the little busy tugs dragging great ships after them. There was an
+endless source of amusement in wondering from what ports the various
+craft had come or what was their destination.
+
+"What seems most wonderful to me, George," Bill said one day, "when
+one looks at them big steamers----"
+
+"Those," George corrected.
+
+"Thank ye--at those big steamers, is to think that they can be tossed
+about, and the sea go over them, as one reads about, just the same
+way as the wave they make when they goes down----"
+
+"Go down, Bill."
+
+"Thank ye--go down the river, tosses the little boats about; it don't
+seem possible that water can toss itself about so high as that, does
+it?"
+
+"It does seem extraordinary, Bill; we know that it is so because there
+are constantly wrecks; but looking at the water it does not seem
+possible that it should rise up into waves large enough to knock one
+of those great steamers in pieces. Some day, Bill, not this year, of
+course, because the house isn't finished, but next year, I hope we
+shall be able all of us to go down for a trip to the sea. I have seen
+it stuck up you can go to Margate and back for three or four
+shillings; and though Bob Grimstone says that isn't regular sea, it
+would be enough to show us something of what it's like."
+
+The garden occupied a good deal of the boys' time. Bill's long
+experience in the market had given him an interest in vegetables, and
+he was always ready for an hour's work in the garden after tea. The
+results of much labor and plenty of manure were not unsatisfactory,
+and Mrs. Andrews was delighted with her regular supply of fresh
+vegetables. Bill's anticipation, however, of the amount that could be
+grown in a limited space were by no means fulfilled, and seeing the
+small amount which could be daily gathered, and recalling the
+countless piled-up wagons which he had been accustomed to see in
+Covent Garden, he was continually expressing his astonishment at the
+enormous quantity of ground which must be employed in keeping up the
+supply of the market.
+
+They did not that year get the trip to Margate; but in the autumn,
+after the great work of furnishing was finished, they did get several
+long jaunts, once out to Epping Forest on an omnibus, once in a
+steamer up to Kew, and several times across to Greenwich Park. Mrs.
+Andrews found it a very happy summer, free from the wear of anxiety,
+which, more even than the work, had brought on her long illness. She
+grew stronger and better than she had ever expected to be again, and
+those who had only known the pale, harassed-looking needlewoman of
+Croydon would not have recognized her now; indeed, as George said
+sometimes, his mother looked younger and younger every day. She had
+married very young, and was still scarcely five-and-thirty, and
+although she laughed and said that George was a foolish boy when he
+said that people always took her for his sister, she really looked
+some years younger than she was. Her step had regained its elasticity,
+and there was a ring of gladness and happiness in her voice which was
+very attractive, and even strangers sometimes looked round as they
+passed the bright, pleasant-looking woman chatting gayly with the two
+healthy, good-looking young fellows.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V.
+
+AN ADVENTURE.
+
+
+In August the annual outing, or, as it was called, the bean-feast, at
+the works took place. Usually the men went in vans down into Epping
+Forest; but this year it was determined that a steamer should be
+engaged to take the whole party with their wives and families down to
+Gravesend. They were to make an early start, and on arriving there all
+were to do as they pleased until they assembled to dine in a pavilion
+at one of the hotels. After this they were to go to the gardens and
+amuse themselves there until the steamer started in the evening. The
+party embarked at Blackwell at ten o'clock in the morning. George and
+Bill got together up in the bow of the steamer, and were delighted
+with their voyage down, their only regret being that Mrs. Andrews had
+declined to accompany them, saying that she would far rather go with
+them alone than with so large a party.
+
+"What shall we do, Bill?" George said, when they landed. "We are not
+to dine till two, so we have two good hours before us. I vote we hire
+a boat and go out. It will be ten times as jolly here as up in that
+crowded river by London."
+
+This was said in reference to various short rows which they had had
+in boats belonging to barges which had been sometimes lent them for
+half an hour of an evening by a good-natured bargeman as they hung
+about the wharves.
+
+"I suppose you can row, young chaps?" the waterman, whom they hired
+the boat of, said.
+
+"Oh, yes, we can row!" George replied with the confidence of youth.
+
+"Mind the tide is running out strong," the waterman said.
+
+"All right, we will mind," George answered, scarce heeding his words;
+and getting out the oars they pushed off.
+
+For some little time they rowed among the anchored vessels, both being
+especially filled with delight at the yachts moored opposite the
+clubhouses. These were new craft to them, and the beauty and neatness
+of everything struck them with surprise and admiration. Tide had only
+turned a short time before they got into their boat, and while keeping
+near the shore they had no difficulty in rowing against it.
+
+Presently they determined to have a look at a fine East-Indiaman
+moored well out in the stream a short distance below Gravesend. They
+ceased rowing when they approached her, and sat idly on their oars
+talking over the distant voyage on which she was probably about to
+start, and the country she might visit, George was telling his
+companion the ports she would touch if her destination was China, and
+absorbed in their conversation they paid no attention to anything
+else, until George gave a sudden exclamation.
+
+"Good gracious, Bill! Why, the ship is ever so far behind. It is two
+miles, I should think, from the town. We must set to work or we shan't
+be back in time for dinner."
+
+The boys' knowledge of the navigation of the Thames was not sufficient
+to tell them that to row against tide it is necessary to keep close
+inshore, and turning the boat's head they set to work to row back in
+the middle of the river. Their knowledge of rowing was but slight, and
+the mere operation of their oars took up all their attention. They
+rowed away till their hands burned and the perspiration ran down their
+faces.
+
+After half an hour of this George looked round, thinking that he ought
+to be near to the vessel by this time. He uttered an exclamation of
+surprise and dismay. Neither the ship nor Gravesend were visible.
+Their puny efforts had availed nothing against the sweeping tide. They
+had already, without knowing it, swept round the turn in the river,
+and were now entering Sea Reach.
+
+"My goodness, Bill! what are we to do? Just look at that buoy; we are
+going past it as fast as a horse could trot. Look what a width the
+river is. What on earth are we to do?"
+
+"I have no idea," Bill replied. "Where shall we go to if we go on like
+this?"
+
+"Right out to sea, I should think," George said. "I do not know how
+far it is; but the river seems to get wider and wider in front."
+
+"Perhaps," Bill suggested, "the tide will turn again and take us
+back."
+
+"Not it," George said. "It was against us, you know, all the way down,
+and could only have turned a little while before we got in the boat.
+Look at that line of barges sailing down on the right-hand side. I
+vote we pull to them and ask the men what we had better do. Anyhow we
+could row to the land and get out there and wait till tide turns. It
+turned at about eleven, so that it will turn again somewhere about
+five. The steamer is not to start till eight, so we shall be back in
+plenty of time to catch it. We shall lose the dinner and the fun in
+the gardens, but that can't be helped."
+
+"That don't make no odds," Bill said cheerfully; "this is a regular
+venture, this is; but I say, shan't we have to pay a lot for the
+boat?"
+
+"Yes," George assented mournfully; "but perhaps the man will let us
+off cheap when he sees we couldn't help it. He looked a good-tempered
+sort of chap. Come, let us set to work. Every minute it is taking us
+further away."
+
+They set steadily to work. The boat was a large and heavy one, and
+their progress was by no means rapid.
+
+"How thick it's getting!" George exclaimed suddenly.
+
+"Aint it just!" Bill assented. "My eye, George, I can't see the
+barges!"
+
+Unobserved by them a fog had been steadily creeping up the river. They
+were just at its edge when they made the discovery. Another two
+minutes and it rolled thickly over them, and they could not see ten
+yards away. They looked at each other in silent bewilderment.
+
+"What's to be done, George?" Bill said at length in awe-struck tones.
+
+"I don't know, Bill; I haven't an idea. It's no use rowing, that I
+see, for we don't know which way the boat's head is pointing."
+
+"Well, it can't be helped," Bill said philosophically. "I am going to
+have a pipe. Oh, I say, aint my hands blistered!"
+
+"All right, you can have your pipe, Bill, but keep your oar in your
+hand to be ready to row."
+
+"What for?" Bill demanded. "I thought you said it warn't no use
+rowing!"
+
+"No more it is, Bill; but we must look out for those big buoys. If the
+tide were to sweep us against one of them we should capsize to a
+certainty. That must have been a big steamer," he went on, as the boat
+rolled suddenly. "It's lucky we were pretty well over towards the side
+of the river, before the fog came on. Listen--there's another. I can
+hear the beat of her engines. I have an idea, Bill!" he exclaimed
+suddenly. "We know the steamers were passing to the left of us when
+the fog came on. If we listen to their whistles and the sound of their
+paddles, and then row to the right, we shall get to the bank at last."
+
+"Yes, that's a good idea," Bill agreed, laying down the pipe he had
+just lighted. "There's a whistle over there."
+
+"Yes, and another the other way," George said, puzzled. "Why, how can
+that be! Oh, I suppose one is coming up the river and one down, but
+it's awfully confusing."
+
+It was so, but by dint of listening intently the boys gained some idea
+of the proper direction; but they could only row a few strokes at a
+time, being obliged to stop continually to listen for fresh guidance.
+
+Fortunately for them the fog lay low on the water, and the upper spars
+of the steamers were above it, and men placed there were able to
+direct those on deck as to their course. Had it not been for this the
+steamers must all have anchored. As it was they proceeded slowly and
+cautiously on their way, whistling freely to warn any small craft,
+that might be hidden in the fog, of their coming.
+
+Half an hour's rowing and the boys gave a simultaneous exclamation.
+The boat had quietly grounded on the edge of a mud flat. They could
+not see the bank, and had no idea how far distant it was. Bill at once
+offered to get overboard and reconnoiter, but George would not hear of
+it.
+
+"You might not be able to find your way back, Bill, or you might sink
+in the mud and not be able to get out again. No, we won't separate;
+and, look here, we must keep the boat afloat just at the edge of the
+mud. If we were to get left here we should not float again till tide
+comes up to us, and that wouldn't be till about two hours before high
+tide, and it won't be high, you know, until twelve o'clock at night."
+
+"I wish this fog would clear off!" Bill said, looking round at the
+wall of white vapor which surrounded them. "It regular confuses a
+chap. I say, I expect they are just sitting down to dinner at present.
+I feel awfully hungry."
+
+"It's no use thinking about that, Bill. We shall be a good deal more
+hungry before we are done; but I am so glad we have found the land and
+stopped going out to sea that I don't mind being hungry."
+
+"But I say, George, if this fog keeps on how are we to find our way
+back to Gravesend?"
+
+"The only way will be, Bill, to keep quite close to the edge of the
+mud--just as close as the boat will swim. That way, you know, we must
+come to Gravesend at last."
+
+"So we must. I didn't think of that. You have got a good head, George,
+you have. I should never have thought about the way to find the bank
+if it hadn't been for you, and might have gone on floating and
+floating till we was starved."
+
+"This fog can't last forever, Bill."
+
+"No, but I have known them last a week in London."
+
+"Yes, but not in August, Bill."
+
+"No, not in August," Bill assented; "but you see these here fogs may
+last just as long down here in August as they do in London in
+November."
+
+"I don't think so, Bill. Anyhow it doesn't matter to us; we have got
+the land for a guide, and I hope we shall be back in Gravesend before
+it's quite dark."
+
+"But if we don't, George?"
+
+"Well, if we don't we must run her ashore before it gets too dark, and
+wait till it is morning. We shall be all right if we keep quite cool
+and use our senses. If we had something to eat I shouldn't mind a bit,
+except that mother will be getting anxious about us. It's a regular
+adventure, and we shall have something to talk about for a long time.
+Look out, Bill, we must push her further off--she's getting aground!"
+
+For an hour they sat and chatted.
+
+"Hullo! what's that?" Bill exclaimed at last. "That's the rattle of a
+chain. I expect it's a barge anchoring somewhere near. Listen; I can
+hear voices. I vote we hollo."
+
+George lifted up his voice in a lusty shout. The shout was repeated
+not very far off, and was followed by the shout of "Who are you?"
+
+"We have drifted down from Gravesend and lost our way," George
+shouted back. "We will come on board if you will let us."
+
+"All right!" the voice replied; "I will go on shouting and you row to
+my voice."
+
+It was but a hundred yards, and then a voice close at hand said
+sharply:
+
+"Row bow hard or you will be across the chain."
+
+Bill rowed hard, and George, looking round, saw that they were close
+to the bows of a barge. Half a dozen more strokes and they were
+alongside. Bill seized a hand-rope and sprang onto the barge, and the
+boat was soon towing astern.
+
+"Well, young men, however did you manage to get here?" one of the
+bargemen asked. "It's lucky for you you weren't taken out to sea with
+the tide."
+
+George related the history of their voyage and how they had managed to
+reach the shore.
+
+"Well, you are good-plucked uns anyhow," the man said; "aint they,
+Jack? Most chaps your age would just have sat in the boat and howled,
+and a good many longshoremen too. You have done the best thing you
+could under the circumstances."
+
+"Where are we?" George asked.
+
+"You are on board the _Sarah and Jane_ topsail barge, that's where you
+are, about three parts down Sea Reach. We know our way pretty well
+even in a fog, but we agreed it was no use trying to find the Swashway
+with it as thick as this, so we brought up."
+
+"Where is the Swashway?" George asked.
+
+"The Swashway is a channel where the barges go when they are making
+for Sheerness. It's well buoyed out and easy enough to follow with the
+help of Sheerness lights on a dark night; but these fogs are worse
+than anything. It aint no use groping about for the buoy when you
+can't see ten yards ahead, and you might find yourself high and dry on
+the mud and have to wait till next tide. Mayhap this fog will clear
+off before evening, and we shall be able to work in; and now I expect
+you two young uns would like some grub. Come below."
+
+The two boys joyfully followed into the little cabin, and were soon
+satisfying their hunger on bread and cold meat. The bargee drew a jug
+of water from the breaker and placed it before them.
+
+"The fire has gone out," he said, "or I would give yer a cup of
+tea--that's our tipple; we don't keep spirits on board the _Sarah and
+Jane_. I like a drop on shore, but it aint stuff to have on a barge,
+where you wants your senses handy at all times. And now what are you
+thinking of doing?" he asked when the boys had finished.
+
+"What we had made up our minds to do was to lie where we were at the
+edge of the mud till tide turned, and then to keep as close to the
+shore as we could until we got back to Gravesend. The steamer we came
+by does not go back till late, and we thought we should be back by
+that time."
+
+"No, you wouldn't," the man said. "Out in the middle of the stream you
+would be back in two hours easy, but not close inshore. The tide
+don't help you much there, and half your time you are in eddies and
+back-currents. No, you wouldn't be back in Gravesend by eight noway."
+
+"Then what would you advise us to do?"
+
+"Well, just at present I won't give no advice at all. We will see how
+things are going after a bit. Now let's take a look round."
+
+So saying he climbed the ladder to the deck, followed by the boys. The
+white fog still shut the boat in like a curtain.
+
+"What do you think of it, Jack?"
+
+"Don't know," the other replied. "Thought just now there was a puff of
+air coming down the river. I wish it would, or we shan't make
+Sheerness to-night, much less Rochester. Yes, that's a puff sure
+enough. You are in luck, young uns. Like enough in half an hour there
+will be a brisk wind blowing, driving all this fog out to sea before
+it."
+
+Another and another puff came, and tiny ripples swept across the
+oil-like face of the water.
+
+"It's a-coming, sure enough," the bargeman said. "I'd bet a pot of
+beer as the fog will have lifted in a quarter of an hour."
+
+Stronger and stronger came the puffs of wind.
+
+The fog seemed as if stirred by an invisible hand. It was no longer a
+dull, uniform whitish-gray; dark shadows seemed to flit across it, and
+sometimes the view of the water extended here and there.
+
+"There's the shore!" Bill exclaimed suddenly, but ere George could
+turn round to look it was gone again.
+
+"I shall have the anchor up directly, lads. Now I tell you what will
+be the best thing for you if the wind holds, as I expect it will. We
+shall be at Sheerness in little over an hour--that will make it four
+o'clock," he added, consulting his watch, "and the young flood will be
+coming up soon afterwards, and I shall go up with the first of it to
+Rochester. We shall get there maybe somewhere about seven o'clock. Now
+the best thing I can do for you is to tow that ere boat up to
+Rochester with me, and you can get a train there that will take you up
+to town in goodish time."
+
+"You are very kind," George said; "but what are we to do about the
+boat?"
+
+"I shall be going back to-morrow night, or more likely next morning,
+and I will take her along and hand her over to her rightful owner at
+Gravesend."
+
+"James Kitson."
+
+"Yes, I know him."
+
+"But how about paying for it?" George said. "I am afraid he will
+expect a great deal of money, for it has been away all the time, and
+we have only got six shillings between us."
+
+"You will want that to get up to town. Never mind about the boat. I
+will put that square for you. I will tell Kitson as how you have been
+shipwrecked, and he will think himself precious lucky in getting the
+boat without being damaged. If I take the trouble to tow it up to
+Rochester and back, he needn't grumble about getting no fare."
+
+"I would rather pay something," George said; "though, you see, we
+can't afford to pay much."
+
+"Well, then, you send him a post-office order for five bob. I will
+tell him you are going to send him that, and he will thank his stars
+he has got so well out of it. If you had drifted out to sea, as he
+expects you have by this time, and the boat didn't get smashed by a
+steamer, you would likely enough have been taken off by one of them;
+but the captain wouldn't have troubled himself about that old tub. I
+looks upon Kitson as being in luck this job, so don't you worry about
+him. There, the mist's driving off fast. We will up with the kedge."
+
+The boys lent a hand at the windlass, and the anchor was soon hanging
+from the bow. Then the brail of the mainsail was loosed, and the great
+sail shaken out. The foresail was hoisted, and in a few minutes the
+_Sarah and Jane_ was running before a brisk wind down Sea Reach.
+
+The fog had rolled off now, and it was clear astern, though a thick
+bank still hung over the river ahead, but this was rapidly melting
+away; and the bargeman, who told them his name was Will Atkins,
+pointed out a large building low down on the water ahead.
+
+"That's Sheerness Fort," he said. "You can lend Jack a hand to get up
+the topsail. The wind is rising every minute, and we shall soon be
+bowling along hand over hand."
+
+Both ahead and astern of them were a line of barges, which had, like
+the _Sarah and Jane_, anchored when the fog was thickest, and were,
+like her, making their way to Sheerness. The wind was blowing briskly
+now, and the barge made her way through the water at a rate which
+surprised the boys.
+
+"I had no idea that barges sailed so fast," George said.
+
+"There are not many craft can beat them," Atkins replied. "With a
+breeze so strong that they can only just carry their topsails, they
+will hold their own with pretty nigh anything afloat. There are mighty
+few yachts can keep alongside us when we are doing our best."
+
+As Atkins had predicted, in little over an hour they brought up just
+inside the mouth of the Medway, and dropped the anchor to wait till
+the tide turned to help them up to Rochester. At six o'clock they were
+again under way. The wind had fortunately veered round somewhat to the
+north of west, and they were able for the most part to lay their
+course, so that soon after seven they were abreast of the dockyard,
+and a few minutes later dropped anchor off Rochester.
+
+"Jump into the boat, boys," the good-natured bargeman said; "I will
+put you ashore at once. There is the station close to the end of the
+bridge."
+
+With many very hearty thanks for his kindness the lads jumped ashore
+and hurried up to the station. They found that there would be a train
+in half an hour, and by nine o'clock they arrived in town.
+
+Before they had landed the bargeman had scrawled on a piece of paper,
+"Your boat was picked up by the _Sarah and Jane_. Will bring her back
+on return trip. No damage done. William Atkins." This he had handed to
+the boys, and they now got an envelope and directed it to "James
+Kitson, Waterman, Gravesend," and posted it, and then set out to walk
+home.
+
+"It's not been the sort of day we expected," George said; "but it's
+been good fun, hasn't it?"
+
+"Grand!" Bill agreed. "But I didn't think so when we were in the
+middle of that fog listening to them whistles and trying to find out
+the way. I didn't say much, George, but I felt downright funky."
+
+"I didn't like it either, Bill. There was such a horribly lonely
+feeling, lost in the fog there; but it was all right as soon as we
+touched the mouth, and got an idea where we were. I was worrying most
+about mother getting anxious if we did not get back to-night, and a
+little about what we should have to pay for the boat. It was lucky
+that bargeman took the matter in his hands for us. I expect we should
+have had to pay over a pound. He was an awfully good fellow, wasn't
+he?"
+
+"I should just think he was," Bill said. "He was a good un, and no
+mistake. It aint cost us so very much either, considering."
+
+"That it hasn't, Bill. Two and threepence apiece railway fare, that's
+four and sixpence, and five bob we are to send down for the boat, nine
+shillings and sixpence. Well, we should have paid two shillings for
+the boat anyhow, and I expect we should have spent another shilling
+apiece in things at the gardens, perhaps more; that would make four
+shillings anyhow, so we have only spent about five shillings more than
+we calculated. And haven't we got a lot to talk about! It's been a
+regular adventure."
+
+"It has," Bill said doubtfully; "but I don't think I want many more of
+them kind of adventures. It's all right now, you know, but it wasn't
+jolly at the time. I always thought as adventures was jolly; but that
+didn't seem to me to have no jolliness about it, not when we was out
+there. It's all very well to hear tell of shipwrecks and fights with
+savages, but I expect there aint no larks about it at the time. I
+suppose you will send that five bob off to-morrow, and get it off your
+mind?"
+
+"No. Atkins said we had better not send it for another three or four
+days. The man will have got his boat back all right then, and the five
+bob would come upon him unexpectedly. He was going to tell Kitson that
+he had arranged with us that was what we were to pay, as we couldn't
+afford more; but he will never expect to get it, so when it comes he
+will be only too glad to receive it."
+
+They were met at the door of the house by Bob Grimstone, who was just
+coming out.
+
+"Why, what have you boys been up to?" he said angrily. "I have been
+wondering all day what has become of you, and the missis has done
+nothing but worry and fidget. It's regular spoilt the day. What have
+you been up to? I haven't seen you since we got ashore at Gravesend,
+and I have just come round to ask your mother if she has heard of
+you."
+
+"I am very sorry, Bob, but it wasn't our fault, at least it was not
+altogether our fault. We went for a row, and the tide took us down,
+and then the fog came on and we got lost."
+
+"I expected better of you," Grimstone said angrily. "Foggy, indeed!
+I've been anxious and worried all day. I did think as you warn't like
+other boys, but could be trusted, and then you go and play such a
+prank as this. Well, go in; your mother is in a nice taking about
+you."
+
+"My dear mother," George said as he ran in, "I am so sorry you have
+been uneasy about us, awfully sorry; but really it hasn't been our
+fault altogether."
+
+"Never mind that now, George," Mrs. Andrews said, throwing her arms
+round his neck. "Fortunately I did not know anything about it till Mr.
+Grimstone came in a few minutes ago. I had been expecting you in for
+some little time, but I supposed the steamer was late, and I was not
+at all uneasy till Mr. Grimstone came in and said that he had not
+seen either of you since the steamer got to Gravesend, and that you
+had not come back with the rest. Is Bill with you?"
+
+"Yes, mother; he is at the door talking to Bob."
+
+"Ask Mr. Grimstone to come in again," Mrs. Andrews said. "He has been
+most kind, and he had promised to go down to Gravesend by the first
+train in the morning if you did not come home to-night, and to make
+inquiries about you there. He tried to cheer me up by saying that as
+you were together nothing could very well happen to you and that
+probably you had only got into some boyish scrape--perhaps, he
+suggested, only gone out into the country and had helped yourselves to
+some apples, and had so got locked up."
+
+Bob, however, would not come in again, but went off saying he would
+hear all about it in the morning, but would go off to tell his wife at
+once that they had returned safely, for "that she was in such a worry
+as never was."
+
+Hearing that the boys had had nothing to eat since two o'clock, Mrs.
+Andrews at once laid the table for supper; and when they had finished
+it listened to George's account of their adventure.
+
+"You had a very narrow escape, boys," she said when they had finished.
+"You might have been swept out to sea, or run down by a steamer in the
+fog. I hope to-night that you will neither of you forget to thank God
+for his protection through the danger you have run; and I do hope, my
+dear boys, that you will be more careful in future."
+
+The next evening, after work was over, George went in to Bob
+Grimstone's and told them all that had happened. When the story was
+told, Bob agreed that after all it was not altogether their fault, and
+that, indeed, they had, in some respects, justified his opinion of
+them. Mrs. Grimstone, however, was not so easily pacified. They had
+come back, she said; but it was more than likely that they wouldn't
+have come back at all, but might have been drifting out far at sea,
+perhaps cutting each other's throats and eating each other alive,
+which was, as the good woman said, what she had heard happened when
+boats were lost at sea.
+
+Two days later they sent off the money to the waterman, and received
+in reply a letter from him saying that the boat had been brought
+safely back by the _Sarah and Jane_ and that he was glad to get the
+five shillings.
+
+"Bill Atkins told me as you said you would send it; but knowing what
+boys is, I say fair as I didn't expect to see the color of your money.
+It aint everyone as would have paid up when they got safe away, and I
+consider as you have behaved handsome."
+
+They had heard from Atkins of the wharf off which the _Sarah and Jane_
+might generally be found moored, between her cruises, and after one or
+two ineffectual attempts they one day found the barge there when they
+rowed up to the spot. She had but just returned from a trip to
+Rochester and Bill Atkins was still on board. He was very glad to see
+the boys, but they had great difficulty in persuading him to accept a
+pound of tobacco which their mother had sent off to him with her
+compliments as a token of gratitude for his kindness to them.
+
+"Well, young chaps, I didn't look for nothing of the sort, but seeing
+as your mother has got it for me it wouldn't be manners to say no.
+Well, look here, any time as you are disposed for a sail down to
+Rochester and back you're free of the _Sarah and Jane_, and heartily
+glad shall I be to have you with me."
+
+The boys thanked him for the offer, but said as they were still at
+work there was but small chance of their being able to accept it, but
+that they should be glad to come and have a chat with him sometimes
+when he was in the Pool.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI.
+
+FIRE!
+
+
+One Saturday evening early in October the boys had been for a long
+walk down among the marshes. They had told Mrs. Andrews they would be
+late, and it was past eight o'clock when they came along past the
+works.
+
+"We shan't get home at this hour again for some time, I expect,"
+George said, "for they say that we are going to begin to work overtime
+on Monday, and that the orders are so heavy that it will very likely
+have to be kept up all through the winter."
+
+"I am glad it didn't begin earlier," Bill replied; "it would have been
+horrid if we had lost all our walks while the weather was fine. How
+dark the place looks how it's shut up, and how quiet and still it is
+after the rattle we are accustomed to!"
+
+"Stop a moment," George said, putting his hand on his arm.
+
+"What is it, George?"
+
+"I don't know. It seemed to me, for a moment, as if I saw the big
+stack clearly and then it was dark again."
+
+"How could that be, George?"
+
+"I don't know; it looked to me as if it was a reflection of light
+from one of the windows at the back there. There it is again."
+
+"Yes, I saw it," Bill agreed. "What can it be?"
+
+"I don't know, Bill; let's run around to the back. There might
+be--it's awful to think of--but there might be a fire."
+
+The boys ran down a narrow lane by the side of the works onto a piece
+of waste ground behind.
+
+"Look, Bill, look at the glare in the molding-room. There must be
+fire. Here, help to put this bit of old timber against the wall."
+
+The piece of wood was placed into position, the two lads climbed up it
+onto the wall, and dropped into the yard within. Just as they did so
+there was a clatter of falling glass, followed by a glare of light as
+a body of flame burst out from one of the windows.
+
+"Let's ring the dinner-bell, Bill; that will call people's attention,
+and then we must do the best we can."
+
+They ran along until they reached the front gate, and then, seizing
+the bell-rope, rang it violently.
+
+In a minute or two there was a clatter of feet outside, and shouts of
+"What's the matter?"
+
+"There is a fire in the molding-room," George shouted; "run for the
+engines, someone, and break the gate open. Now come on, Bill."
+
+The two boys ran towards that part of the building where the flames
+had been seen, broke a window, and climbed in. There was an almost
+stifling smell of burning wood and at a door at the end of the
+planing-room they could see a light flame flickering through the
+cracks of the door leading into the molding-room, which was next to
+it.
+
+"Quick, Bill, screw that leather pipe onto the hydrant. We must stop
+it from getting through here till the engines come."
+
+The hydrant communicated with the great tank at the top of the
+building, and as soon as the hose was screwed on and Bill stood with
+the nozzle directed towards the burning door, George turned the cock
+and volumes of water flew out.
+
+The first result seemed disastrous. The door was already nearly burned
+through, and, as the powerful jet flew against it, it seemed to
+crumble away and a mass of flame darted out from the molding-room. The
+joists and timbers supporting the floor above the planing-room would
+have caught at once, but the boys deluged them with water, as also the
+framework of the door, and then, throwing the stream of water into the
+blazing workshop, they kept down the flames near the door. The smoke
+was stifling.
+
+"We shall be choked, George!" Bill gasped.
+
+"Lie down, Bill. I have heard the air is always better near the
+ground."
+
+This they found to be the case, and they were still able to direct the
+jet of water. But three or four minutes had elapsed when the outer
+door of the planing-house was unlocked and Bob Grimstone and several
+other men rushed in, but were at once driven back by the smoke. George
+had recognized Grimstone's voice, and shouted:
+
+"This way, Bob, the fire hasn't got through yet. Come and lend a hand,
+for it's gaining on us in spite of the water. You can breathe if you
+kneel down."
+
+Grimstone, with two or three of the men, crawled in and joined the
+boys.
+
+"What! is it you, George? How on earth did you get here?" Bob
+exclaimed.
+
+"We saw a light as we were passing, and got in from behind. When we
+saw what it was we rang the alarm-bell, and then came on here to do
+what we could till help came."
+
+"You are good-plucked, you are," Grimstone said admiringly; "but I am
+afraid it's not much good."
+
+"You take the hose, Bob, and keep the rafters drenched there. Bill and
+I will crawl forward and clear the shavings out of the way if we can.
+They have caught half a dozen times already."
+
+The two boys crawled forward, and although the heat was tremendous
+they managed to clear away the shavings for a considerable distance.
+The smoke and heat were so great that they were obliged to crawl back
+into the outer air, where for a while they lay almost insensible.
+There were crowds of men in the yard now, but most of them were round
+at the back, powerless to aid at present, and only watching the
+flames as they roared through the whole of the windows of the
+molding-room.
+
+Men were hurrying past with buckets of water, and one of them, seeing
+the condition of the boys, dashed some over their heads and faces, and
+they presently staggered to their feet. It was now a quarter of an
+hour since they had first given the alarm, and they were just about to
+re-enter the planing-shop to rejoin Bill when they met him and his
+comrades coming out.
+
+"All the water's gone," he said; "if the engines aint here in a minute
+or two it will be too late."
+
+But just at that moment there was a cheer outside, and immediately
+afterwards a fire-engine dashed through the gate. Grimstone ran up to
+the firemen as they leaped off.
+
+"The great thing," he said, "is to prevent it spreading from that shop
+into this. We have been keeping it back till now, but the tank has
+just run dry."
+
+While the other firemen were fitting the hose to the fire-plug just
+outside the gates one of them made his way into the planing-room to
+ascertain the exact position of affairs.
+
+"Quick, lads," he said; "there's no time to be lost; the fire is
+making its way through. Another five minutes and we should have been
+too late to save any of this block. Is there any communication through
+the upper floors?" he asked Grimstone.
+
+"Yes, there is a door on each floor,"
+
+"Have you got any empty sacks about the place?"
+
+"Yes, there is a pile of them in there."
+
+The fireman gave instructions to one of his comrades, while he himself
+made his way into the planing-room with the hose; the other got out
+the sacks, and assisted by Grimstone and some of the hands drenched
+them with water, and then proceeding to the door on the first floor
+piled them against it.
+
+"It is hot already," he said as he laid his hand upon it. "Now, do you
+men bring me buckets of water. Keep the sacks drenched till another
+engine comes up."
+
+George and Bill, finding they could be of no more use, made their way
+out to the back and joined the crowd watching the flames, which had
+already spread to the first floor. They were, however, with the rest
+of the lookers-on, speedily turned out of the yard by the police, who,
+having now arrived in sufficient strength, proceeded at once to clear
+the premises of all save a score or two of men who were engaged in
+assisting the firemen.
+
+As the boys went out through the front gate another engine dashed up
+at full speed, dropping lighted cinders on its way.
+
+"Hurray!" Bill said; "this is a steamer. I expect they will do now."
+
+Then the boys made their way round again to the back, and by means of
+the pieces of timber established themselves on the wall, where they
+were soon joined by a number of others, and watched the struggle with
+the flames.
+
+In half an hour six engines were on the spot; but even this force had
+no visible effect upon the flames in that portion of the building in
+which they had taken possession, and the firemen turned the whole of
+their efforts to prevent it from spreading.
+
+The party wall dividing it from the main building was a very strong
+one; but so hot had it become that the floor boards touching it were
+over and over again in flames.
+
+A score of men with saws and axes cut away the flooring adjoining the
+doors on the first and second stories. The planing-room was
+fortunately not boarded. While a portion of the fire brigade worked
+unceasingly in preventing the spread of the flames in this direction,
+the rest turned their attention to the great wood piles, which were
+repeatedly ignited by the fragments of burning wood.
+
+Presently the roof fell in, and the flames shot up high into the air,
+but grand as the sight was, the boys did not wait any longer looking
+on. Their faces smarted severely from the heat to which they had been
+exposed; their hands had been a good deal burned by the shavings;
+their hair, eyebrows, and eyelashes were singed, and the eyeballs
+ached with the glare.
+
+"I will run home now, Bill; mother will likely enough hear of the
+fire, and as we said we should be back soon after eight she will be
+getting anxious."
+
+"I will go and tell her it's all right; you stop and see the end of it
+here."
+
+But this George would not hear of.
+
+"Very well, then, I will go with you. I must get some grease or
+something to put on my face and hands; they are smarting awfully."
+
+Mrs. Andrews gave an exclamation of surprise and alarm as the boys
+entered. The irritation of the wood smoke had so much inflamed their
+eyes that they could scarcely see out of them, and their faces looked
+like pieces of raw beef.
+
+"Whatever has happened, boys?" she exclaimed.
+
+"There's a great fire at Penrose's, mother; it broke out just as we
+were passing, so we stopped to help for a bit, and then came home to
+tell you, thinking that you might be anxious."
+
+"A fire at the works!" Mrs. Andrews exclaimed; "that is dreadful.
+Dreadful for Mr. Penrose, and for all of you who work there; more,
+perhaps, for you than for him, for no doubt he is insured, and you may
+be out of work for months. Thank God I have plenty of work, so I dare
+say we shall be able to tide it over."
+
+"It is not all burned, mother; only the molding-shop and the floors
+above it are on fire at present, and as there are six fire-engines at
+work, and they keep on arriving every minute, I hope they will save
+the rest; and now, mother, what can we do to our faces and hands, they
+are smarting awfully?"
+
+"Dear me, George, are you burnt? I thought you were only dreadfully
+hot."
+
+"We feel hot, mother, just as if our faces were being roasted."
+
+"I will get some oil, that will be the best thing," Mrs. Andrews said,
+hurrying away to the kitchen, and coming back with a piece of
+cotton-wool, and some olive-oil in a cup.
+
+"You are burned, George. Why, child, your hair is all singed, and your
+eyebrows and eyelashes. Why, what have you been doing to yourselves?
+There could have been no occasion to put your heads into the flames
+like that. Why, your hands are worse still; they are quite blistered.
+I had better wrap them up in cotton-wool."
+
+"It's the inside that's the worst, mother; perhaps if you put a bit of
+cotton-wool there and tie it round the back it will do; we can't go
+out with our hands all swaddled round like that. And now, please,
+directly you have done we want to go down again to see the fire. Just
+you go up to the road corner, mother. It's a grand sight, I can tell
+you."
+
+"We will have tea first," Mrs. Andrews said decidedly; "everything has
+been ready except pouring the water in since eight o'clock, and it's a
+quarter past nine now. After we have done I will put on my bonnet and
+walk down with you as near as I can get. I am not going to lose you
+out of my sight again."
+
+So after their meal they went down together, but could not get
+anywhere near the works, all the approaches now being guarded by the
+police. It was a grand sight, but the worst was over, and there was a
+general feeling of confidence in the crowd that it would spread no
+further. A dozen engines were at work now. Some of the firemen were on
+the roof, some on the stacks of timber, which looked red-hot from the
+deep glow from the fire. The flames were intermittent now, sometimes
+leaping up high above the shell of the burned-out buildings, then
+dying down again.
+
+"Thank God it's no worse!" Mrs. Andrews said fervently. "It would have
+been a bad winter for a great many down here if the fire had spread;
+as it is, not a quarter of the buildings are burned."
+
+"No, nothing like that, mother; not above a tenth, I should say. It's
+lucky that there was a strong wall between that and the next shops, or
+it must all have gone. I have heard them say that part was added on
+five or six years ago, so that the wall at the end of the planing-shop
+was an outside wall before; that accounts for its being so thick."
+
+After looking on for about half an hour they went back home. But
+neither of the boys got much sleep that night, the excitement they had
+gone through and the pain of their burns keeping them wide awake till
+nearly morning. As Mrs. Andrews heard no movement in their
+rooms--whereas they were usually up and about almost as early on
+Sundays as on other days, being unable to sleep after their usual
+hour for rising--she did not disturb them. George was the first to
+awake, and looking out of the window felt sure by the light that it
+was later than usual. He put his head out of the door and shouted:
+
+"Bill, are you up?" There was no answer. "Mother, are you up; what
+o'clock is it?"
+
+"Up! hours ago, George. Why, it's past eleven!"
+
+George gave an exclamation of astonishment and rushed into Bill's
+room. The latter had woke at his shout.
+
+"It's past eleven, Bill, and mother has been up for hours;" and he
+dashed off again to his room to dress. It was but a few minutes before
+they came downstairs just at the same moment.
+
+"Why didn't you wake us, mother?"
+
+"Because I thought it better to let you sleep on, George. I guessed
+that your burns had kept you awake for some time."
+
+"That they did. I thought I was never going to get to sleep," George
+said; and Bill gave a similar account of himself. "Still, mother, a
+short night does no harm for once, and you haven't been able to get to
+church."
+
+"It does not matter for once, George. What figures you both are!"
+
+"We are figures," George said ruefully. "I hardly knew myself when I
+looked in the glass. My eyes are almost shut up, and the skin is
+peeling off my nose, and my hair is all rough and scrubby; and Bill
+looks as bad as I do. You are a figure, Bill!" and George burst into a
+fit of laughter.
+
+"He's no worse than you, George; but come along, breakfast is
+waiting."
+
+"You haven't waited breakfast for us, I hope, mother?"
+
+"I made myself a cup of tea the first thing, boys, and had a slice of
+bread and butter, for I thought you might not be down for some time;
+but I am quite ready to join you; we have got fish. I put them down
+directly you called."
+
+"Well, I am glad you are not starving, mother; and I am glad too you
+didn't have your regular breakfast. It would have been horrid to sit
+down on Sunday morning without you, when it's the only regular
+breakfast we get in the week."
+
+Just as they had finished their meal there was a knock at the door. It
+was Bob Grimstone. Bill opened the door.
+
+"Well, how are you to-day, lad? I thought I would just come round and
+see. You look pretty badly burned; and so do you, George," he added,
+as he followed Bill into the sitting room.
+
+"Good-day, Mrs. Andrews."
+
+"Good-morning, Mr. Grimstone," Mrs. Andrews said. Since her coming the
+Grimstones had several times come in on Sunday afternoon to Laburnum
+Villas. Mrs. Andrews would, indeed, have wished them to come in more
+frequently, for she felt much indebted to them for their kindness to
+George, and, moreover, liked them for themselves, for both were good
+specimens of their class.
+
+"I see you were busy last night too, Mr. Grimstone; your face looks
+scorched; but you did not manage to get yourself burned as these silly
+boys did. What a blessing it is for us all that the fire did not
+spread!"
+
+"Well, Mrs. Andrews, I don't think those two lads can have told you
+what they did, for if they had you would hardly call them silly boys."
+
+Mrs. Andrews looked surprised.
+
+"They told me they lent a hand to put out the fire--I think those were
+George's words--but they did not tell me anything else."
+
+"They saved the building, ma'am. If it hadn't been for them there
+would not have been a stick or stone of Penrose's standing now; the
+shops and the wood piles would all have gone, and we should all have
+been idle for six months to come; there is no doubt about that at
+all."
+
+"Why, how was that, Mr. Grimstone? How was it they did more than
+anyone else?"
+
+"In the first place they discovered it, ma'am, and rung the
+alarm-bell; it mightn't have been found out for another five minutes,
+and five minutes would have been enough for the fire. In the next
+place, when they had given the alarm they did the only thing that
+could have saved the place: they got into the planing-shop and turned
+on the hose there, and fought the fire from spreading through the
+door till we got in seven or eight minutes later. It was all we could
+do to stop it then; but if they hadn't done what they did the
+planing-shop would have been alight from end to end, and the floors
+above it too, before the first engine arrived, and then nothing could
+have saved the whole lot. I can tell you, Mrs. Andrews, that there
+isn't a man on the works, nor the wife of a man, who doesn't feel that
+they owe these two lads their living through the winter. I don't know
+what Mr. Penrose will say about it, but I know what we all feel."
+
+"Why, George," Mrs. Andrews said, while her eyes were filled with
+happy tears at the praises of her son, "why did you not tell me about
+it?"
+
+"Why, mother, there was not anything to tell," George said, "and Bob
+has made a great fuss about nothing. As I told you, we saw a light as
+we came along and when we went round behind and got on the wall we saw
+the place was on fire, so we rang the alarm-bell, and then turned on
+the hose and flooded the place with water till Bob and some more came
+to help us."
+
+"It sounds very simple, Mrs. Andrews, but I can tell you it wasn't so.
+When we opened the door of the planing-shop it was so full of smoke
+that it didn't seem as if anyone could breathe there for a minute, and
+as we could see the glare of the flames at the other end we thought
+the place was gone. We should have gone out and waited for the engines
+if we hadn't heard the boys sing out that they were there; and even
+though we knelt down and crawled in, as they shouted to us to do, we
+were pretty nearly stifled. When we took the hose they crawled forward
+and got the shavings cleared away; that was how they burned their
+hands, I expect; and I hear they tumbled down insensible when they got
+out. Now, ma'am, they may make light of it, but if ever two young
+chaps behaved like heroes they did, and you have every right to be
+proud of them--I say of them, because although Bill's no son of yours
+I know he is what you and your boy have made him. He was telling me
+about it one day."
+
+"Will work go on to-morrow as usual, Bob?" George asked, in order to
+change the subject.
+
+"In some of the shops it will, no doubt," Bob said; "but in our shop
+and the floors above it it will take a day or two to clear up. I saw
+the foreman just now, and he tells me that a strong gang of carpenters
+will be put on, for both the floors are burned away at the end of the
+wall and pretty near twenty feet of the roof are charred. Two
+surveyors are coming down this afternoon to examine the wall and say
+whether it is safe. The walls of the shops that are burned out must
+come down, of course. The surveyor says that if the wall at the end of
+the planing-room looks pretty strong they will build up another wall
+against it as soon as it gets cold enough and the rubbish is cleared
+away for men to work; that will make a strong job of it, and there
+won't be any loss of time. Of course if the old one has to come down
+there can't be much work done in the shops till it's finished. The
+governor got down about ten o'clock last night. A messenger went up to
+him almost directly after the fire broke out, but he was out at
+dinner, and by the time he got down here all danger of it spreading
+was over. He had a talk with the foreman and arranged about the wall
+with him. He is as anxious as we are that there should be no delay,
+for there are some heavy orders in, and, of course, he doesn't want
+them taken anywhere else."
+
+"Will you look at their hands, Mr. Grimstone. I don't know much about
+it, but they seem to be badly burned."
+
+"That they are, ma'am," Mr. Grimstone said when he had examined them;
+"pretty nigh raw. If I might give an opinion, I should say as the
+doctor had better see them; they are precious painful, aint they,
+George?"
+
+"They do feel as if they were on fire, Bob, but I don't see any use in
+a doctor. I don't suppose he can do more than mother has."
+
+"Perhaps not, George, but he had better see them for all that; he may
+give you some cooling lotion for them, and I can tell you burns on the
+hand are apt to be serious matters, for the muscles of the fingers may
+get stiffened. I have known two or three cases like that. You had
+better go at once to Dr. Maxwell; he always attends if there are any
+accidents at the works. You know the house, George; it is about
+halfway between this and the works."
+
+"Yes, you had better go at once, boys," Mrs. Andrews said; "there, put
+on your hats and be off."
+
+"I will walk with them. I must be off anyway, for the missis will be
+waiting dinner for me."
+
+"Are we to pay, mother?"
+
+"No, not till you have done, George. I dare say you will have to have
+your hands dressed several times."
+
+"There won't be any occasion to pay him, Mrs. Andrews. The firm always
+pays the doctor in case of accidents, and you may be very sure that in
+this case they will be only too glad."
+
+"Well, in any case, George," Mrs. Andrews said, "you can tell the
+doctor that you will pay when he says that you need not come to him
+again. If Mr. Penrose hears about it and chooses to pay I should not
+think of refusing, as you have been burned in his service; but
+certainly I should not assume that he will do so."
+
+"Shall I go in with you, boys?" Bob asked when they reached the door.
+"I know the doctor; he attended me two years ago when I pretty nigh
+had my finger taken off by one of the cutters."
+
+"Yes, please, Bob, I wish you would."
+
+They were shown into the surgery, where the doctor soon joined them.
+
+"I've brought these two young chaps for you to look at their hands,
+Dr. Maxwell. They got them burnt last night at the fire. Mrs.
+Andrews, the mother of this lad, wished me to say that she would pay
+the charges when you have done with them; but as if it hadn't been for
+them the works would have been burnt down as sure as you are standing
+there, I expect the firm will take the matter in their own hands."
+
+"Yes, they are nasty burns," the doctor said, examining the boys'
+hands. "Can you open and shut them, boy?"
+
+"I think I could if tried, sir," George said, "but I shouldn't like to
+try, for if I move my fingers at all it hurts them awfully."
+
+"I see you have had oil and cotton-wool on your hands."
+
+"Yes."
+
+"The best thing you can do, boys, is to put on some soothing
+poultices. Tell your mother to get some linseed and mix it with
+olive-oil. I will give you a bottle of laudanum. Let her put about
+twenty drops of that into the oil before she mixes it with the
+linseed. Every four or five hours change the poultices. I think you
+will find that will relieve the pain a good deal. I see your faces are
+scorched too. You can do nothing better than keep them moistened with
+sweet-oil. I should advise you to keep as quiet as possible for three
+or four days."
+
+"But we shall want to get to work, sir," George said.
+
+"Nonsense! You will be very lucky if you can use your hands in
+another fortnight. I will send in the usual certificate to the works."
+
+"Will you tell the foreman, Bob," George said when they left the
+doctor's, "how it is we can't come to work? You tell him we wanted to,
+and that we hope to come back as soon as our hands are all right;
+because, you see, the men and boys at the shops which have been burnt
+down will be all out of work, and it would be awful if we found our
+places filled up when we went to work again."
+
+"Don't you be afraid, George; there is no fear of your being out of
+work after what you have done."
+
+"Well, what did the doctor say?" was Mrs. Andrews' first question when
+they returned home.
+
+"He didn't say much, mother, except that we must not think of going to
+work for a fortnight anyhow, and we are to have poultices made with
+linseed mixed with oil, and twenty drops of laudanum from this bottle,
+and it must be put on fresh every three or four hours. I am afraid it
+will be an awful trouble."
+
+"The trouble won't matter," Mrs. Andrews said brightly. "Did he say
+you were to go to bed?"
+
+"No, mother; but we were to keep as quiet as we could."
+
+"Then in that case, George, I think you had better go to bed."
+
+"No; I am sure we had better not," George said. "I should toss and
+fidget about there horridly. The best thing will be for us to sit
+here, and then we shall be all together. And if you talk to us, and
+perhaps read to us, we shan't feel it half so much. What are you going
+to do, mother?" he asked five minutes afterwards, as Mrs. Andrews came
+down with her bonnet on.
+
+"I am going to get some linseed, George, of course. I haven't got any
+in the house."
+
+"But it's Sunday, mother, and the shops will be shut."
+
+"I shall get it at the chemist's, George. They will always supply
+things that are needed even on Sunday. People are ill on Sunday as
+well as any other day, you know. I shan't be gone more than a quarter
+of an hour. You must keep very quiet till I come back."
+
+The boys found a good deal of relief from the effect of the poultices,
+and were very much better after a good night's rest. At ten o'clock
+the next morning, as Mrs. Andrews was sitting at her work, with the
+boys both on the hearthrug in front of the fire, there was a knock at
+the door. It was a loud double knock, quite unlike the ordinary
+summons of the baker's boy, who was the only regular caller. The boys
+jumped up in surprise.
+
+"Who can that be, mother?"
+
+"We shall soon see," Mrs. Andrews said quietly.
+
+She was not surprised, on opening the door, to see a gentleman
+standing there, whom, by the description the boys had given of him,
+she guessed to be their employer. A little girl was standing by his
+side.
+
+"Is this Mrs. Andrews?" the gentleman asked.
+
+"I am Mrs. Andrews," the lady answered quietly.
+
+"My name is Penrose. I have called with my daughter to inquire after
+the two lads--one of them your son, I believe--who so gallantly saved
+my place from being burned down on Saturday evening. I only heard
+about it late yesterday evening, when I came down to arrange about
+some matters with the foreman. He did not know the facts of the case
+on Saturday night, but had learned them yesterday, and there can be no
+doubt whatever, from what he says, that had it not been for the
+presence of mind and bravery of these two lads nothing could have
+saved the entire works and all the wood piles from destruction. I told
+my daughter this morning, and she insisted on coming down with me. You
+know she is already indebted to your son for saving a locket which we
+both greatly valued."
+
+"Will you walk in, sir?" and Mrs. Andrews showed them into the sitting
+room.
+
+Mr. Penrose had been somewhat surprised by Mrs. Andrews' manner,
+although the foreman, in telling him of the boys' conduct, had also
+stated what he knew about them.
+
+"They are out-of-the-way sort of boys, sir," he said. "There was quite
+a talk about them in the shops in the spring. They lodged with
+Grimstone, and it seems that after they had been here at work five
+months Andrews' mother, who had been ill, was coming to them, and they
+got Grimstone to take a house for them, and it turned out that ever
+since they had been at work here they had been putting by half their
+wages to furnish a place for her, so they must have lived on about
+five shillings a week each and got clothes for themselves out of it.
+Now, sir, boys as would do that aint ordinary boys, and there was
+quite a talk among the men about it. I hear from Grimstone that Mrs.
+Andrews is a superior sort of person, he says quite a lady. She does
+work, I believe, for some London shop."
+
+Mr. Penrose, therefore, was prepared to find the boys in a more
+comfortable abode than usual, and their mother what the foreman called
+a superior sort of woman; but he perceived at once by her address that
+Grimstone's estimate had been a correct one, and that she was indeed a
+lady. The prettiness of the little sitting room, with its comfortable
+furniture, its snowy curtains and pretty belongings, heightened this
+feeling.
+
+"I have come to see you, boys," he said, "and to tell you how indebted
+I feel to you for your exertions on Saturday. There is no doubt that
+had it not been for you the place would have been entirely burned. It
+was fully insured, but it would have been a serious matter for me, as
+I should have lost four or five months' work, and it would have been
+still more serious for the men to have been thrown out of employment
+at this time of the year, so we all feel very much indebted to you. I
+hope you are not much burned."
+
+"Oh, no, sir! our hands are burned a bit, but they will be all right
+in a few days. Bill and I are very glad, sir, that we happened to be
+passing, and were able to give the alarm and do something to stop the
+flames till the others came up; but we don't feel that it was anything
+out of the way. It was just a piece of fun and excitement to us."
+
+"They didn't say anything about it, Mr. Penrose, when they came home,
+and it was only when one of the men came in next day to ask after them
+that I heard that they had really been of use."
+
+"It is all very well to say so, lads," Mr. Penrose replied; "but there
+is no doubt you showed a great deal of courage, as well as presence of
+mind, and you may be sure that I shall not forget it. And now, Mrs.
+Andrews," he said, turning round to her, "I feel rather in a false
+position. I came round to see the lads, who, when I last saw them,
+were not in very flourishing circumstances, and I was going to make
+them a present for the service they had done me, and my daughter has
+brought them a basket with some wine, jelly, and other things such as
+are good for sick boys. Finding them as I find them, in your care and
+in such a home, you see I feel a difficulty about it altogether."
+
+"Thank you, sir," Mrs. Andrews said, "for the kindness of your
+intention; but my boys--for although one is in no way related to me I
+feel towards him as if he were my own--would not like to take money
+for doing their duty towards their employer."
+
+"No, indeed!" George and Bill exclaimed simultaneously.
+
+"As you see, sir, thanks to the work you were good enough to give the
+boys and to my needle,"--and she glanced towards the articles on the
+table,--"we are very comfortable; but I am sure the boys will be very
+glad to accept the things which your daughter has been so kind as to
+bring down for them, and will feel very much obliged for her
+thoughtfulness."
+
+"That is right," Mr. Penrose said, relieved. "Nelly, you may as well
+leave the basket as it is. I am sure you don't want to carry it back
+again?"
+
+"No, papa," Nelly said; and indeed even the empty basket would have
+been more than the child could well have carried. It had come on the
+top of the carriage to the railway-station, and a porter had
+accompanied Mr. Penrose with it to Laburnum Villas.
+
+"You would have hardly known your young friend. Would you, Nelly?"
+
+"I don't think I should," she said, shaking her head. "He looks
+dreadfully burned, and his hair is all funny and frizzled."
+
+"It will soon grow again," George said, smiling. "The doctor says our
+faces will be all right when the skin is peeled off. Thank you very
+much, Miss Penrose, for all the nice things. It was a fortunate day
+indeed for us when I caught that boy stealing your locket."
+
+"And it was a fortunate day for us too," Mr. Penrose responded. "Now,
+Mrs. Andrews, we will say good-by. You will not mind my calling again
+to see how the boys are getting on?"
+
+"It will be very kind of you, sir, and we shall be glad to see you,"
+Mrs. Andrews replied; "but I hope in a few days they will both be out
+of the doctor's hands."
+
+"I can't shake hands with you," Mr. Penrose said, patting the boys on
+the shoulder, "but I hope next time I see you to be able to do so.
+Good-morning, Mrs. Andrews."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII.
+
+SAVED!
+
+
+"Now let us have a look at the basket, mother," George said as Mrs.
+Andrews returned into the room after seeing her two visitors off.
+"It's very kind of him, isn't it? and I am glad he didn't offer us
+money; that would have been horrid, wouldn't it?"
+
+"I am glad he did not, too, George. Mr. Penrose is evidently a
+gentleman of delicacy and refinement of feeling, and he saw that he
+would give pain if he did so."
+
+"You see it too, don't you, Bill?" George asked. "You know you thought
+I was a fool not to take money when he offered it for getting back the
+locket; but you see it in the same way now, don't you?"
+
+"Yes; I shouldn't have liked to take money," Bill said. "I sees----"
+
+"See," Mrs. Andrews corrected.
+
+"Thank you. I see things different--differently," he corrected
+himself, seeing that George was about to speak, "to what I did then."
+
+"Now, mother," George said, "let us open the basket; it's almost as
+big as a clothes-basket, isn't it?"
+
+The cover was lifted and the contents, which had after much thought
+been settled by Nelly herself, were disclosed. There were two bottles
+of port-wine, a large mold of jelly, a great cake, two dozen oranges,
+some apples, a box of preserved fruit, some almonds and raisins, two
+packets of Everton toffee, a dozen mince-pies, and four pots of
+black-currant jelly, on the cover of one of which was written in a
+sprawling hand, "Two teaspoonfuls stirred up in a tumbler of water for
+a drink at night."
+
+"This will make a grand feast, mother; what a jolly collection, isn't
+it? I think Miss Penrose must have chosen it herself, don't you?"
+
+"It certainly looks like it, George," Mrs. Andrews replied, smiling.
+"I do not think any grownup person would have chosen mince-pies and
+toffee as appropriate for sick boys."
+
+"Yes; but she must have known we were not badly burned, mother; and
+besides, you see, she put in currant-jelly to make drinks, and there
+are the oranges too. I vote that we have an orange and some toffee at
+once, Bill."
+
+"I have tasted oranges," Bill said, "lots of them in the market, but I
+never tasted toffee."
+
+"It's first-rate, I can tell you."
+
+"Why, they look like bits of tin," Bill said as the packet was opened.
+
+George burst into a laugh.
+
+"That's tin-foil, that's only to wrap it up; you peel that off, Bill,
+and you will find the toffee inside. Now, mother, you have a glass of
+wine and a piece of cake."
+
+"I will have a piece of cake, George; but I am not going to open the
+wine. We will put that by in case of illness or of any very
+extraordinary occasion."
+
+"I am glad the other things won't keep, mother, or I expect you would
+be wanting to put them all away. Isn't this toffee good, Bill?"
+
+"First-rate," Bill agreed. "What is it made of?"
+
+"Sugar and butter melted together over the fire."
+
+"You are like two children," Mrs. Andrews laughed, "instead of boys
+getting on for sixteen years old. Now I must clear this table again
+and get to work; I promised these four bonnets should be sent in
+to-morrow morning, and there's lots to be done to them yet."
+
+It was three weeks before the boys were able to go to work again. The
+foreman came round on Saturdays with their wages. Mr. Penrose called
+again; this time they were out, but he chatted for some time with Mrs.
+Andrews.
+
+"I don't wish to pry into your affairs, Mrs. Andrews," he said, after
+asking about the boys; "but I have a motive for asking if your son
+has, as I suppose he has, from his way of speaking, had a fair
+education."
+
+"He was at school up to the age of twelve," Mrs. Andrews said quietly;
+"circumstances at that time obliged me to remove him; but I have
+since done what I could myself towards continuing his education, and
+he still works regularly of an evening."
+
+"Why I ask, Mrs. Andrews, was that I should like in time to place him
+in the counting-house. I say in time, because I think it will be
+better for him for the next two or three years to continue to work in
+the shops. I will have him moved from shop to shop so as to learn
+thoroughly the various branches of the business. That is what I should
+do had I a son of my own to bring into the business. It will make him
+more valuable afterwards, and fit him to take a good position either
+in my shops or in any similar business should an opening occur."
+
+"I am greatly obliged to you, sir," Mrs. Andrews said gratefully;
+"though I say it myself, a better boy never lived."
+
+"I am sure he is by what I have heard of him, and I shall be only too
+glad, after the service he has rendered me, to do everything in my
+power to push him forward. His friend, I hear, has not had the same
+advantages. At the time I first saw him he looked a regular young
+arab."
+
+"So he was, sir; but he is a fine young fellow. He was very kind to my
+boy when he was alone in London, and gave up his former life to be
+with him. George taught him to read before I came here, and he has
+worked hard ever since. No one could be nicer in the house than he is,
+and had I been his own mother he could not be more dutiful or anxious
+to please. Indeed I may say that I am indebted for my home here as
+much to him as to my own boy."
+
+"I am glad to hear you say so, Mrs. Andrews, for of course I should
+wish to do something for him too. At any rate, I will give him, like
+your son, every opportunity of learning the business, and he will in
+time be fit for a position of foreman of a shop--by no means a bad one
+for a lad who has had such a beginning as he has had. After that, of
+course, it must depend upon himself. I think, if you will allow me to
+suggest, it would be as well that you should not tell them the nature
+of our conversation. Of course it is for you to decide; but, however
+steady boys they are, it might make them a little less able to get on
+well with their associates in a shop if they know that they are going
+to be advanced."
+
+"I don't think it would make any difference to them, sir; but at the
+same time I do think it would be as well not to tell them."
+
+One day Bill was out by himself as the men were coming out of the
+shop, and he stopped to speak to Bob Grimstone.
+
+"Oh! I am glad to find you without George," Bob said; "'cause I want
+to talk to you. Look here! the men in all the shops have made a
+subscription to give you and George a present. Everyone feels that
+it's your doing that we have not got to idle all this winter, and when
+someone started the idea there wasn't a man in the two shops that
+didn't agree with him. I am the treasurer, I am, and it's come to
+just thirty pounds. Now I don't know what you two boys would like,
+whether you would like it in money, or whether you would like it in
+something else, so I thought I would ask you first. I thought you
+would know what George would like, seeing what friends you are, and
+then you know it would come as a surprise to him. Now, what do you
+say?"
+
+"Its very kind of you," Bill said. "I am sure George would like
+anything better than money, and so should I."
+
+"Well, you think it over, Bill, and let me know in a day or two. We
+were thinking of a watch for each of you, with an inscription, saying
+it was presented to you by your shopmates for having saved the
+factory, and so kept them at work for months just at the beginning of
+winter. That's what seemed to me that you would like; but if there is
+anything you would like better, just you say so. You come down here
+to-morrow or next day, when you have thought it over, and give me an
+answer. Of course you can consult George if you think best."
+
+Bill met Bob Grimstone on the following day.
+
+"I have thought it over," he said, "and I know what George and me
+would like better than any possible thing you could get."
+
+"Well, what is it, Bill?"
+
+"Well, what we have set our minds on, and what we were going to save
+up our money to get, was a piano for George's mother. I heard her say
+that we could get a very nice one for about thirty pounds, and it
+would be splendid if you were all to give it her."
+
+"Very well, Bill, then a piano it shall be. I know a chap as works at
+Kirkman's, and I expect he will be able to give us a good one for the
+money."
+
+Accordingly on the Saturday afternoon before the boys were going to
+work again, Mrs. Andrews and George were astonished at seeing a cart
+stop before the house, and the foreman, Bob Grimstone, and four other
+men coming up to the door.
+
+Bill ran and opened the door, and the men entered. He had been
+apprised of the time that they might be expected, and at once showed
+them in.
+
+"Mrs. Andrews," the foreman said, "I and my mates here are a
+deputation from the hands employed in the shop, and we have come to
+offer you a little sort of testimonial of what we feel we owe your son
+and Bill Smith for putting out the fire and saving the shops. If it
+hadn't been for them it would have been a bad winter for us all. So
+after thinking it over and finding out what form of testimonial the
+lads would like best, we have got you a piano, which we hope you may
+live long to play on and enjoy. We had proposed to give them a watch
+each; but we found that they would rather that it took the form of a
+piano."
+
+"Oh, how good and kind of you all!" Mrs. Andrews said, much affected.
+"I shall indeed be proud of your gift, both for itself and for the
+kind feeling towards my boys which it expresses."
+
+"Then, ma'am, with your permission we will just bring it in;" and the
+deputation retired to assist with the piano.
+
+"Oh, boys, how could you do it without telling me!" Mrs. Andrews
+exclaimed.
+
+George had hitherto stood speechless with surprise.
+
+"But I didn't know anything about it, mother. I don't know what they
+mean by saying that we would rather have it than watches. Of course we
+would, a hundred times; but I don't know how they knew it."
+
+"Then it must have been your kind thought, Bill."
+
+"It wasn't no kind thought, Mrs. Andrews, but they spoke to me about
+it, and I knew that a piano was what we should like better than
+anything else, and I didn't say anything about it, because Bob
+Grimstone thought that it would be nicer to be a surprise to George as
+well as to you."
+
+"You are right, old boy," George said, shaking Bill by the hand; "why,
+there never was such a good idea; it is splendid, mother, isn't it?"
+
+The men now appeared at the door with the piano. This was at once
+placed in the position which had long ago been decided upon as the
+best place for the piano when it should come. Mrs. Andrews opened it,
+and there on the front was a silver plate with the inscription:
+
+"To Mrs. Andrews from the Employees at Messrs. Penrose & Co., in token
+of their gratitude to George Andrews and William Smith for their
+courage and presence of mind, by which the factory was saved from
+being destroyed by fire on Saturday the 23d of October, 1857."
+
+The tears which stood in Mrs. Andrews' eyes rendered it difficult for
+her to read the inscription.
+
+"I thank you, indeed," she said. "Now, perhaps you would like to hear
+its tones." So saying she sat down and played "Home, Sweet Home." "It
+has a charming touch," she said as she rose, "and, you see, the air
+was an appropriate one, for your gift will serve to make home even
+sweeter than before. Give, please, my grateful thanks, and those of my
+boys, to all who have subscribed."
+
+The inhabitants of No. 8 Laburnum Villas had long been a subject of
+considerable discussion and interest to their neighbors, for the
+appearance of the boys as they came home of an evening in their
+working clothes seemed altogether incongruous with that of their
+mother and with the neatness and prettiness of the villa, and was,
+indeed, considered derogatory to the respectability of Laburnum Villas
+in general. Upon this evening they were still further mystified at
+hearing the notes of a female voice of great power and sweetness,
+accompanied by a piano, played evidently by an accomplished musician,
+issuing from the house. As to the boys, they thought that, next only
+to that of the home-coming of Mrs. Andrews, never was such a happy
+evening spent in the world.
+
+I do not think that in all London there was a household that enjoyed
+that winter more than did the inmates of No. 8 Laburnum Villas. Their
+total earnings were about thirty-five shillings a week, much less than
+that of many a mechanic, but ample for them not only to live, but to
+live in comfort and even refinement. No stranger, who had looked into
+the pretty drawing room in the evening, would have dreamed that the
+lady at the piano worked as a milliner for her living, or that the
+lads were boys in a manufactory.
+
+When spring came they began to plan various trips and excursions which
+could be taken on bank holidays or during the long summer evenings,
+when an event happened which, for a time, cut short all their plans.
+The word had been passed round the shops the first thing in the
+morning that Mr. Penrose was coming down with a party of ladies and
+gentlemen to go over the works, and that things were to be made as
+tidy as possible.
+
+Accordingly there was a general clearing up, and vast quantities of
+shavings and sawdust were swept up from the floors, although when the
+machines had run again for a few hours no one would have thought that
+a broom had been seen in the place for weeks.
+
+George was now in a shop where a number of machines were at work
+grooving, mortising, and performing other work to prepare the wood for
+builders' purposes. The party arrived just as work had recommenced
+after dinner.
+
+There were ten or twelve gentlemen and as many ladies. Nelly Penrose,
+with two girls about her own age, accompanied the party. They stopped
+for a time in each shop while Mr. Penrose explained the nature of the
+work and the various points of the machinery.
+
+They had passed through most of the other rooms before they entered
+that in which George was engaged, and the young girls, taking but
+little interest in the details of the machinery, wandered somewhat
+away from the rest of the party, chatting among themselves. George had
+his eye upon them, and was wishing that Mr. Penrose would turn round
+and speak to them, for they were moving about carelessly and not
+paying sufficient heed to the machinery.
+
+Suddenly he threw down his work and darted forward with a shout; but
+he was too late, a revolving-band had caught Nelly Penrose's dress. In
+an instant she was dragged forward and in another moment would have
+been whirled into the middle of the machinery.
+
+There was a violent scream, followed by a sudden crash and a harsh
+grating sound, and then the whole of the machinery on that side of the
+room came to a standstill. For a moment no one knew what had
+happened. Mr. Penrose and some of his friends rushed forward to raise
+Nelly. Her hand was held fast between the band and the pulley, and the
+band had to be cut to relieve it.
+
+"What an escape! what an escape!" Mr. Penrose murmured, as he lifted
+her. "Another second and nothing could have saved her. But what
+stopped the machinery?" and for the first time he looked round the
+shop. There was a little group of men a few yards away, and, having
+handed Nelly, who was crying bitterly, for her hand was much bruised,
+to one of the ladies, he stepped towards them. The foreman came
+forward to meet him.
+
+"I think, sir, you had better get the ladies out of the shop. I am
+afraid young Andrews is badly hurt."
+
+"How is it? What is the matter?" Mr. Penrose asked.
+
+"I think, sir, he saw the danger your daughter was in, and shoved his
+foot in between two of the cog-wheels."
+
+"You don't say so!" Mr. Penrose exclaimed, as he pushed forward among
+the men.
+
+Two of them were supporting George Andrews, who, as pale as death, lay
+in their arms. One of his feet was jammed in between two of the
+cog-wheels. He was scarcely conscious.
+
+"Good Heavens," Mr. Penrose exclaimed in a low tone, "his foot must be
+completely crushed! Have you thrown off the driving belt, Williams?"
+
+"Yes, sir, I did that first thing."
+
+"That's right; now work away for your lives, lads." This was said to
+two men who had already seized spanners and were unscrewing the bolts
+of the bearings in order to enable the upper shafting to be lifted and
+the cog-wheel removed. Then Mr. Penrose returned to his friends.
+
+"Pray leave the shop," he said, "and go down into the office. There's
+been a bad accident; a noble young fellow has sacrificed himself to
+save Nelly's life, and is, I fear, terribly hurt. Williams, send off a
+man instantly for the surgeon. Let him jump into one of the cabs he
+will find waiting at the gate, and tell the man to drive as hard as he
+can go. If Dr. Maxwell is not at home let him fetch someone else."
+
+George had indeed sacrificed himself to save Nelly Penrose. When he
+saw the band catch her dress he had looked round for an instant for
+something with which to stop the machinery, but there was nothing at
+hand, and without an instant's hesitation he had thrust his foot
+between the cog-wheels. He had on very heavy, thickly nailed working
+boots, and the iron-bound sole threw the cogs out of gear and bent the
+shaft, thereby stopping the machinery. George felt a dull, sickening
+pain, which seemed to numb and paralyze him all over, and he
+remembered little more until, on the shafting being removed, his foot
+was extricated and he was laid gently down on a heap of shavings. The
+first thing he realized when he was conscious was that someone was
+pouring some liquid, which half-choked him, down his throat.
+
+When he opened his eyes, Mr. Penrose, kneeling beside him, was
+supporting his head, while on the other side knelt Bill Smith, the
+tears streaming down his cheeks and struggling to suppress his sobs.
+
+"What is it, Bill? What's the matter?" Then the remembrance of what
+had passed flashed upon him.
+
+"Is she safe; was I in time?"
+
+"Quite safe, my dear boy. Thank God, your noble sacrifice was not in
+vain," Mr. Penrose answered with quivering lips, for he too had the
+greatest difficulty in restraining his emotion.
+
+"Am I badly hurt, sir?" George asked after a pause, "because, if so,
+will you please send home for mother? I don't feel in any pain, but I
+feel strange and weak."
+
+"It is your foot, my boy. I fear that it is badly crushed, but
+otherwise you are unhurt. Your boot threw the machinery out of gear."
+
+In ten minutes the doctor arrived. He had already been informed of the
+nature of the accident.
+
+"Is it any use trying to cut the boot off?" Mr. Penrose asked in a low
+voice as Dr. Maxwell stooped over George's leg.
+
+"Not the slightest," the doctor answered in the same tone. "The foot
+is crushed to a pulp. It must come off at the ankle. Nothing can save
+it. He had better be taken home at once. You had best send to Guy's
+and get an operating surgeon for him. I would rather it were done by
+someone whose hand is more used than mine to this sort of work."
+
+"I am a governor of Guy's," Mr. Penrose said, "and will send off at
+once for one of their best men. You are not afraid of the case, I
+hope, Dr. Maxwell?"
+
+"Not of the local injury," Dr. Maxwell replied; "but the shock to the
+system of such a smash is very severe. However, he has youth,
+strength, and a good constitution, so we must hope for the best. The
+chances are all in his favor. We are thinking of taking you home, my
+boy," he went on, speaking aloud to George. "Are you in any great
+pain?"
+
+"I am not in any pain, sir; only I feel awfully cold, and, please,
+will someone go on before and tell mother. Bill had better not go; he
+would frighten her to death and make her think it was much worse than
+it is."
+
+"I will go myself," Mr. Penrose replied. "I will prepare her for your
+coming."
+
+"Drink some more of this brandy," the doctor said; "that will warm you
+and give you strength for your journey."
+
+There was a stretcher always kept at the works in case of emergency,
+and George was placed on this and covered with some rugs. Four of the
+men raised it onto their shoulders and set out, Mr. Penrose at once
+driving on to prepare Mrs. Andrews.
+
+Bill followed the procession heart-broken. When it neared home he
+fell behind and wandered away, not being able to bring himself to
+witness the grief of Mrs. Andrews. For hours he wandered about,
+sitting down in waste places and crying as if his heart would break.
+"If it had been me it wouldn't have mattered," he kept on
+exclaiming--"wouldn't have mattered a bit. It wouldn't have been no
+odds one way or the other. There, we have always been together in the
+shops till this week, and now when we get separated this is what comes
+of it. Here am I, walking about all right, and George all crushed up,
+and his mother breaking her heart. Why, I would rather a hundred times
+that they had smashed me up all over than have gone and hurt George
+like that!"
+
+It was dark before he made his way back, and, entering at the back
+door, took off his boots, and was about to creep upstairs when Mrs.
+Andrews came out of the kitchen.
+
+"Oh, Mrs. Andrews!" he exclaimed, and the tears again burst from him.
+
+"Do not cry, Bill; George is in God's hands, and the doctors have
+every hope that he will recover. They are upstairs with him now, with
+a nurse whom Mr. Penrose has fetched down from the hospital. He will
+have to lose his foot, poor boy," she added with a sob that she could
+not repress, "but we should feel very thankful that it is no worse
+after such an accident as that. The doctor says that his thick boots
+saved him. If it hadn't been for that his whole leg would have been
+drawn into the machinery, and then nothing could have saved him. Now I
+must go upstairs, as I only came down for some hot water."
+
+"May I go up to him, Mrs. Andrews?"
+
+"I think, my boy, you had better stop down here for the present for
+both your sakes. I will let you know when you can go up to him."
+
+So Bill crouched before the fire and waited. He heard movements
+upstairs and wondered what they were doing and why they didn't keep
+quiet, and when he would be allowed to go up. Once or twice the nurse
+came down for hot water, but Bill did not speak to her; but in half an
+hour Mrs. Andrews herself returned, looking, Bill thought, even paler
+than before.
+
+"I have just slipped down to tell you, my boy, that it's all over.
+They gave him chloroform, and have taken his foot off."
+
+"And didn't it hurt it awful?" Bill asked in an awed voice.
+
+"Not in the least. He knew nothing about it, and the first thing he
+asked when he came to was when they were going to begin. They will be
+going away directly, and then you can come up and sit quietly in his
+room if you like. The doctors say he will probably drop asleep."
+
+Bill was obliged to go outside again and wrestle with himself before
+he felt that he was fit to go up into George's room. It was a long
+struggle, and had George caught his muttered remonstrances to himself
+he would have felt that Bill had suffered a bad relapse into his
+former method of talking. It came out in jerks between his sobs.
+
+"Come, none of that now. Aint yer ashamed of yerself, a-howling and
+a-blubbering like a gal! Call yerself a man!--you are a babby, that's
+what you are. Now, dry up, and let's have no more of it."
+
+But it was a long time before he again mastered himself; then he went
+to the scullery and held his head under the tap till the water took
+away his breath, then polished his face till it shone, and then went
+and sat quietly down till Mrs. Andrews came in and told him that he
+could go upstairs to George. He went up to the bedside and took
+George's hand, but he could not trust himself to speak.
+
+"Well, Bill, old boy," George said cheerily, but in a somewhat lower
+voice than usual, "this is a sudden go, isn't it?"
+
+Bill nodded. He was still speechless.
+
+"Don't you take it to heart, Bill," George said, feeling that the lad
+was shaking from head to foot. "It won't make much odds, you know. I
+shall soon be about again all right. I expect they will be able to put
+on an artificial foot, and I shall be stumping about as well as ever,
+though I shouldn't be much good at a race."
+
+"I wish it had been me," Bill broke out. "I would have jammed my head
+in between them wheels cheerful, that I would, rather than you should
+have gone and done it."
+
+"Fortunately there was no time," George said with a smile. "Don't you
+fret yourself, Bill; one can get on well enough without a foot, and it
+didn't hurt me a bit coming off. No, nor the squeeze either, not
+regular hurting; it was just a sort of scrunch, and then I didn't feel
+anything more. Why, I have often hurt myself ten times as much at play
+and thought nothing of it. I expect it looked much worse to you than
+it felt to me."
+
+"We will talk of it another time," Bill said huskily. "Your mother
+said I wasn't to talk, and I wasn't to let you talk, but just to sit
+down here quiet, and you are to try to go off to sleep." So saying he
+sat down by the bedside. George asked one or two more questions, but
+Bill only shook his head. Presently George closed his eyes, and a
+short time afterwards his quiet regular breathing showed that he was
+asleep.
+
+The next six weeks passed pleasantly enough to George. Every day
+hampers containing flowers and various niceties in the way of food
+were sent down by Mr. Penrose, and that gentleman himself very
+frequently called in for a chat with him. As soon as the wound had
+healed an instrument-maker came down from town to measure him for an
+artificial foot, but before he was able to wear this he could get
+about on crutches.
+
+The first day that he was downstairs Mr. Penrose brought Nelly down
+to see him. The child looked pale and awed as he came in.
+
+"My little girl has asked me to thank you for her, George," Mr.
+Penrose said as she advanced timidly and placed her hand in his. "I
+have not said much to you about my own feelings and I won't say much
+about hers; but you can understand what we both feel. Why, my boy, it
+was a good Providence, indeed, which threw you in my way! I thought so
+when you saved the mill from destruction. I feel it tenfold more now
+that you have saved my child. The ways of God are, indeed, strange.
+Who would have thought that all this could have sprung from that boy
+snatching the locket from Helen as we came out of the theater! And now
+about the future, George. I owe you a great debt, infinitely greater
+than I can ever repay; but what I can do I will. In the future I shall
+regard you as my son, and I hope that you will look to me as to a
+father. I have been talking to your mother, and she says that she
+thinks your tastes lie altogether in the direction of engineering. Is
+that so?"
+
+"Yes, sir. I have often thought I would rather be an engineer than
+anything else, but I don't like----"
+
+"Never mind what you like and what you don't like," Mr. Penrose said
+quietly. "You belong to me now, you know and must do as you are told.
+What I propose is this, that you shall go to a good school for
+another three years, and I will then apprentice you to a first-class
+engineer, either mechanical or civil as you may then prefer, and when
+you have learned your business I will take good care that you are
+pushed on. What do you say to that?"
+
+"I think it is too much altogether," George said.
+
+"Never mind about that," Mr. Penrose said, "that is my business. If
+that is the only objection we can imagine it settled. There is another
+thing. I know how attached you are to your friend Bill, and I am
+indebted to him, too, for the part he played at the fire, so I
+propose, if he is willing, to put him to a good middle-class school
+for a bit. In the course of a couple of years he will get a sufficient
+education to get on fairly with, and then I propose, according as you
+may choose to be a civil or mechanical engineer, to place him with a
+mason or smith; then by the time that you are ready to start in
+business he will be ready to take a place under you, so that you may
+again work together."
+
+"Oh, thank you, sir!" George exclaimed, even more pleased at the news
+relating to Bill than at his own good fortune, great as was the
+delight which the prospect opened by Mr. Penrose's offer caused him.
+
+As soon as George could be moved, Mr. Penrose sent him with his mother
+and Bill down to the seaside. Here George rapidly regained strength,
+and when, after a stay there of two months, he returned to town, he
+was able to walk so well with his artificial foot that his loss would
+not have been noticed by a stranger.
+
+The arrangements settled by Mr. Penrose were all in due time carried
+out. George went for three years to a good school, and was then
+apprenticed to one of the leading civil engineers. With him he
+remained five years and then went out for him to survey a railroad
+about to be constructed in Brazil, and remained there as one of the
+staff who superintended its construction. Bill, who was now a clever
+young mason, accompanied him, and through George's interest with the
+contractor obtained the sub-contract for the masonry of some of the
+bridges and culverts.
+
+This was ten years ago, and George Andrews is now one of the most
+rising engineers of the day, and whatever business he undertakes his
+friend Bill is still his right-hand man. Mr. Penrose has been in all
+respects as good as his word, and has been ready to assist George with
+his personal influence in all his undertakings, and in all respects
+has treated him as a son, while Nelly has regarded him with the
+affection of a sister.
+
+Both George and Bill have been married some years, and Mrs. Andrews
+the elder is one of the proudest and happiest of mothers. She still
+lives with her son at the earnest request of his wife, who is often
+left alone during George's frequent absence abroad on professional
+duties. As for Bill, he has not even yet got over his wonder at his
+own good fortune, and ever blesses the day when he first met George in
+Covent Garden.
+
+
+
+
+DO YOUR DUTY.
+
+
+Early in the month of March, 1801, an old sailor was sitting on a
+bench gazing over the stretch of sea which lies between Hayling Island
+and the Isle of Wight. The prospect was a lively one, for in those
+days ships of war were constantly running in and out, and great
+convoys of merchantmen sailed under the protection of our cruisers;
+and the traffic between Spithead and Portsmouth resembled that of a
+much frequented road.
+
+Peter Langley had been a boatswain in the king's service, and had
+settled down in his old age on a pension, and lived in a small cottage
+near the western extremity of Hayling Island. Here he could see what
+was going on at Spithead, and when he needed a talk with his old
+"chums" could get into his boat, which was lying hauled up on the
+sand, and with a good wind arrive in an hour at the Hard. He was
+sitting at present on a portion of a wreck thrown up by a very high
+tide on the sandy slope, when his meditations were disturbed by a
+light step behind him, and a lad in a sailor's dress, some fifteen
+years of age, with a bright honest face, came running down behind him.
+
+"Hallo, dad!"
+
+"Hallo, my boy! Bless me, who'd ha' thought o' seeing you!" and the
+old man clasped the boy in his arms in a way that showed the close
+relationship between the two. "I didn't expect you for another week."
+
+"No! we've made a quick passage of it," the boy said; "fine wind all
+the way up, with a gale or two in the right quarter. We only arrived
+in the river on Monday, and as soon as we were fairly in dock I got
+leave to run down to see you."
+
+"What were you in such a hurry for?" the old sailor said. "It's the
+duty of every hand to stop by the ship till she's cleared out."
+
+"I have always stayed before till the crew were paid off; but no
+sooner had we cast anchor than one of the owners came on board, and
+told the captain that another cargo was ready, that the ship was to be
+unloaded with all speed, and to take in cargo and sail again in a
+fortnight at the utmost, as a fleet was on the point of sailing for
+the West Indies under a strong convoy."
+
+"A fortnight! That's sharp work," the old sailor said. "And the goods
+will have to be bundled out and in again with double speed. I know
+what it will be. You will be going out with the paint all wet, and
+those lubbers the stevedores will rub it off as fast as it's put on.
+Well, a few days at sea will shake all down into its place. But how
+did you get leave?"
+
+"I am rather a favorite with the first officer," the lad said. "The
+men who desired to leave were to be discharged at once and a fresh
+gang taken on board, so I asked him directly the news came round if I
+might have four days away. He agreed at once, and I came down by the
+night coach; and here I am for eight-and-forty hours."
+
+"It's a short stay," the old sailor said, "after more than a year
+away, but we mustn't waste the time in regretting it. You've grown,
+Harry, and are getting on fast. In another couple of years you'll be
+fit to join a king's ship. I suppose you've got over your silly idea
+about sticking to the merchant service. It's all very well to learn
+your business there as a boy, and I grant that in some things a
+merchantman is a better school than a king's ship. They have fewer
+hands, and each man has to do more and to learn to think for himself.
+Still, after all, there's no place like a saucy frigate for excitement
+and happiness."
+
+"I don't know, dad," the boy said. "I have been learning a little
+navigation. The first officer has been very kind to me, and I hope in
+the course of two or three years to pass and get a berth as a third
+mate. Still, I should like three or four years on board a man-of-war."
+
+"I should think so," the old sailor said, "for a man ought to do his
+duty to his country."
+
+"But there are plenty of men to do their duty to their country," the
+boy said.
+
+"Not a bit of it!" the sailor exclaimed. "There's a great difficulty
+in finding hands for the navy. Everyone wants to throw their duty upon
+everyone else. They all hanker after the higher wages and loafing life
+on board a merchantman, and hate to keep themselves smart and clean as
+they must do in a king's ship. If I had my way, every tar should serve
+at least five years of his life on board a man-of-war. It is above all
+things essential, Harry, that you should do your duty."
+
+"I am ready to do my duty, dad," the boy said, "when the time comes. I
+do it now to the best of my power, and I have in my pocket a letter
+from the first officer to you. He told you when you went down with me
+to see me off on my last voyage that he would keep an eye upon me, and
+he has done so."
+
+"That's right," the old man said. "As you say, Harry, a man may do his
+duty anywhere; still, for all that, it is part of his duty, if he be a
+sailor, to help his majesty, for a time at least, against his enemies.
+Look at me. Why, I served man and boy for nigh fifty years, and was in
+action one way and another over a hundred times, and here I am now
+with a snug little pension, and as comfortable as his gracious majesty
+himself. What can you want more than that?"
+
+"I don't know that I can want more," the boy said, "in its way, at
+least; but there are other ways in the merchant service. I might
+command a ship by the time I am thirty, and be my own master instead
+of being a mere part of a machine. I have heard the balls flying too,"
+he said, laughing.
+
+"What! did you have a brush with Mounseer?" the old tar said, greatly
+interested.
+
+"Yes; we had a bit of a fight with a large privateer off the coast of
+Spain. Fortunately the old bark carries a long eighteen, as well as
+her twelves, and when the Frenchman found that we could play at long
+bowls as well as himself he soon drew off, but not before we had
+drilled a few holes in his sails and knocked away a bit of his
+bulwarks."
+
+"Were you hit, Harry?"
+
+"Yes, two or three shots hulled her, but they did little damage beyond
+knocking away a few of the fittings and frightening the lady
+passengers. We had a strong crew, and a good many were sorry that the
+skipper did not hide his teeth and let the Frenchman come close before
+he opened fire. We should like to have towed him up the river with our
+flag over the tricolor."
+
+"There, you see, Harry," the old sailor said, "you were just as ready
+to fight as if you had been on a man-of-war; and while in a sailing
+ship you only get a chance if one of these privateers happens to see
+you, in a king's ship you go looking about for an enemy, and when you
+see one the chances are he is bigger, instead of smaller, than
+yourself."
+
+"Ah! well, dad, we shall never quite agree on it, I expect," the boy
+said; "but for all that, I do mean to serve for a few years in a
+man-of-war. I expect that we may have a chance of seeing some
+fighting in the West Indies. There are, they say, several French
+cruisers in that direction, and although we shall have a considerable
+convoy the Frenchmen generally have the legs of our ships. I believe
+that some of the vessels of the convoy are taking out troops, and that
+we are going to have a slap at some of the French islands. Has there
+been any news here since I went?"
+
+"Nothing beyond a few rows with the smugglers. The revenue officers
+have a busy time here. There's no such place for smuggling on the
+coast as between Portsmouth and Chichester. These creeks are just the
+places for smugglers, and there's so much traffic in the Channel that
+a solitary lugger does not attract the attention of the coastguard as
+it does where the sea's more empty. However, I don't trouble myself
+one way or the other about it. I may know a good deal of the
+smuggling, or I may not, but it's no business of mine. If it were my
+duty to lend a hand to the coast-guard, I should do it; but as it
+isn't, I have no ill-will to the smugglers, and am content enough to
+get my spirits cheap."
+
+"But, dad, surely it's your duty to prevent the king being cheated?"
+Harry said with a smile.
+
+"If the king himself were going to touch the money," the old sailor
+said sturdily, "I would lend a hand to see that he got it, but there's
+no saying where this money would have gone. Besides, if the spirits
+hadn't been run, they would not have been brought over here at all,
+so after all the revenue is none the worse for the smuggling."
+
+The boy laughed. "You can cheat yourself, dad, when you like, but you
+know as well as I do that smuggling's dishonest, and that those who
+smuggle cheat the revenue."
+
+"Ah, well!" the sailor said, "it may be so, but I don't clearly see
+that it's my duty to give information in the matter. If I did feel as
+it were going to be my duty, I should let all my neighbors know it,
+and take mighty good care that they didn't say anything within earshot
+of me, that I might feel called on to repeat. And now, let's go up to
+the cottage and see the old woman."
+
+"I looked in there for a moment," Harry said, "as I passed. Mother
+looks as hale and hearty as she did when I left, and so do you, dad."
+
+"Yes, we have nothing to complain of," the old man said. "I have been
+so thoroughly seasoned with salt water that it would take a long time
+for me to decay."
+
+When they got up to the cottage they found that Jane Langley had got
+breakfast prepared. Rashers of bacon were smoking on the table, and a
+large tankard of beer stood by, for in those days the use of tea had
+not become general in this country.
+
+"Have you heard, mother," Peter Langley said, "that the boy is to
+leave us again in forty-eight hours?"
+
+"No, indeed," the old woman said; "but this is hard news. I had hoped
+that you would be with us for a bit, my boy, for we're getting on fast
+in life, and may not be here when you return."
+
+"Oh, mother! we will not think of such a thing as that," Harry said.
+"Father was just saying that he's so seasoned that even time cannot
+make much of such a tough morsel; and you seem as hearty as he is."
+
+"Aye, boy," Peter said, "that be true, but when old oak does come
+down, he generally falls sudden. However, we won't make our first meal
+sad by talking of what might be."
+
+Gayly during the meal they chatted over the incidents of Harry's
+voyage to India and back. It was his second trip. The lad had had a
+much better education than most boys in his rank of life at that time,
+the boatswain having placed him at the age of ten in charge of a
+schoolmaster at Portsmouth. When Harry had reached that age Peter had
+retired from the service, and had settled down at Hayling, but for two
+years longer he had kept Harry at school. Then he had apprenticed him
+to a firm of shipowners in London, and one of the officers under whom
+Peter had served had spoken to the heads of the firm, so that the boy
+was put in a ship commanded by a kind and considerate officer, and to
+whose charge he was specially recommended. Thus he had not forgotten
+what he had learned at school, as is too often the case with lads in
+his position. His skipper had seen that he not only kept up what he
+knew, but that he studied for an hour or so each day such subjects as
+would be useful to him in his career.
+
+After breakfast the pair again went out onto the sandhills, Peter, as
+usual, carrying a huge telescope with him, with which he was in the
+habit of surveying every ship as she rounded the west of the island
+and came running in through the channel to Portsmouth. Most of the
+men-of-war he knew in an instant, and the others he could make a
+shrewd guess at. Generally when alone with Harry he was full of talk
+of the sea, of good advice as to the lad's future bearing, and of
+suggestions and hints as to the best course to be adopted in various
+emergencies. But to-day he appeared unusually thoughtful, and smoked
+his pipe, and looked out in silence over the sea, scarcely even
+lifting his telescope to his eye.
+
+"I've been thinking, Harry," he said at last, "that as you are going
+away again, and, as the old woman says, you may not find us both here
+when you come back, it is right that I should tell you a little more
+about yourself. I once told you, years ago, that you were not my son,
+and that I would give you more particulars some day."
+
+The lad looked anxiously up at the old sailor. It was a matter which
+he had often thought over in his mind, for although he loved the
+honest tar and his good wife as much as he could have done his natural
+parents, still, since he had known that he was their adopted son only,
+he had naturally wondered much as to who his parents were, and what
+was their condition in life.
+
+"I thought it as well," the old sailor began, "not to tell you this
+here yarn until you were getting on. Boys' heads get upset with a
+little breeze, especially if they have no ballast, and though it isn't
+likely now that you will ever get any clew as to your birth, and it
+will make no difference whether it was a duke or a ship's caulker who
+was your father, still it's right that you should know the facts, as
+no one can say when they start on a voyage in life what craft they may
+fall aboard before they've done. It may be, Harry, that as you intends
+to stick to the merchant service--saving, of course, that little time
+you mean to serve on board a king's ship--you may rise to be a
+skipper, and perhaps an owner. It may be, boy, that as a skipper you
+may fall in love with some taut craft sailing in your convoy. I've
+seen such things before now, and then the fact that you might be, for
+aught you know, the son of a marquis instead of being that of a
+boatswain, might score in your favor. Women have curious notions, and
+though, for my part, I can't see that it makes much difference where
+the keel of a craft was laid as long as it's sound and well-built,
+there are those who thinks different.
+
+"Well, to tell you the yarn. It were nigh fourteen years ago that I
+was boatswain aboard the _Alert_ frigate, as taut a craft as ever
+sailed. We had a smart captain and as good a crew as you'd want to
+see. We were cruising in the West Indies, and had for months been,
+off and on, in chase of a craft that had done much damage there. She
+carried a black flag, and her skipper was said to be the biggest
+villain that ever even commanded a pirate. Scarce a week passed but
+some ship was missing. It mattered little to him whether she sailed
+under the English, the French, or the Spanish flag; all was fish to
+him. Many and many a vessel sailed laden that never reached Europe.
+Sometimes a few charred timbers would be thrown up on the shore of the
+islands, showing that the ship to which they belonged had been taken
+and burned before she had gone many days on her way. Often and often
+had the pirate been chased. She was bark-rigged, which was in itself a
+very unusual thing with pirates--indeed, I never knew of one before.
+But she had been, I believe, a merchantman captured by the pirate, and
+was such a beauty that he hoisted his flag on her, and handed his own
+schooner over to his mate. Somehow or other he had altered her
+ballast, and maybe lengthened her a bit, for those pirates have a
+rendezvous in some of the islands, where they are so strong that they
+can, if need be, build a ship of their own. Anyhow, she was the
+fastest ship of her class that ever was seen on those seas, and though
+our cruisers had over and over again chased her, she laughed at them,
+and would for a whole day keep just out of reach of their bow-chasers
+with half her sails set, while the cruisers were staggering under
+every rag they could put on their masts. Then when she was tired of
+that game she would hoist her full canvas and leave the king's vessel
+behind as if she was standing still. Once or twice she nearly got
+caught by cruisers coming up in different directions, but each time
+she managed to slip away without ever having a rope or stay started by
+a shot. We in the _Alert_ had been on her footsteps a dozen times, but
+had had no more luck than the rest of them, and the mere name of the
+_Seamew_ was sufficient to put any one of us into a passion. There
+wasn't one of the ship's company, from the captain down to the
+powder-monkey, who wouldn't have cheerfully given a year's pay to get
+alongside the _Seamew_. The _Alert_ carried thirty-two guns, and our
+crew was stronger than usual in a vessel of that size, for there was a
+good deal of boat service, and it was considered that at any moment
+'Yellow Jack' might lay a good many hands up--or down, as the case may
+be. Well, one night we were at anchor in Porto Rico, and the first
+lieutenant had strolled up with two of the middies to the top of a
+hill just before the sun went down. He had taken a glass with him.
+Just as the night was falling, a middy on our quarter-deck, who was
+looking at the shore with a glass, said to the second lieutenant, who
+was on watch:
+
+"'Look, sir; here comes Mr. Jones with Keen and Hobart down that hill
+as if he were running a race. He isn't likely to be racing the
+middies. What can he be after?'
+
+"'No,' the second lieutenant said, with a smile; 'Mr. Jones is hardly
+likely to be racing the middies'; which, indeed, was true enough, for
+the first lieutenant was as stiff as a ramrod--a good officer, but as
+strict a martinet as ever I sailed under.
+
+"The second lieutenant took the glasses, and saw that, whatever the
+reason might be, it was as the midshipman had said. The news that Mr.
+Jones was coming down the hill, running as if Old Nick was after him,
+soon spread, and there was quite an excitement on the quarter-deck as
+to what could be the matter.
+
+"Ten minutes afterwards the gig was seen coming off to the ship, and
+it was evident, by the way the spray was flying and the oars bending,
+that the men were pulling as if for life or death. By this time the
+news had spread through the ship, and the captain himself was on the
+quarter-deck.
+
+"'Give me the speaking-trumpet,' he said, and as the boat came within
+call he shouted, 'What's the matter, Mr. Jones? Is anything wrong?'
+
+"'I've sighted,' the lieutenant said, standing up and making a trumpet
+with his two hands, 'two craft together round the point of the island
+some fifteen miles at sea. They're low down on the sea-line, but by
+their look I think that one is the _Seamew_ and the other a
+merchantman she has captured.'
+
+"Not a moment was lost. The captain gave the orders sharp and quick.
+The men, who were all standing about, were in a minute clustering on
+the yards, and never was canvas got on a ship faster than it was on
+the _Alert_ that evening. Before the boat was fairly run up to the
+davits the anchor was at the cat-head, and the _Alert's_ bows were
+pointing seawards. Five minutes afterwards, with every stitch of
+canvas set, we were running out of the harbor. The first lieutenant
+had taken the bearings pretty accurately, and as there was a brisk
+evening breeze blowing we spun along at a famous rate. By this time it
+was dark, and we had every hope that we might come upon the pirate
+before she had finished transferring the cargo of her prize under her
+own hatches. Not a light was shown, and as the moon was not up we
+hoped to get within gunshot before being seen, as the pirate, seeing
+no craft within sight before the sun went down, would not suspect that
+the _Alert_ could be on his traces. We had to sail close to the wind
+till we were round the point of the island, and then to run nearly
+before it towards the spot where the vessels had been seen. In two
+hours from the time of starting we reckoned that we must be getting
+close to them if they still remained hove-to.
+
+"All of a sudden, some two miles ahead, a point or two off the
+starboard bow, a great flame shot up. Every moment it grew and grew
+until we could see a large ship in flames, while another lay about a
+quarter of a mile distant. Three or four boats were pulling from the
+ship in flames towards the other, and as this was a bark we had no
+doubt that we had caught the _Seamew_ at her villainous work. The
+pirate was lying between us and the burning merchantman, so that while
+her spars stood out clear and distinct against the glare of light we
+must have been invisible to her. The word was passed quickly forward
+for the men to go to quarters. Every gun was double-shotted and run
+out, and then, all being ready for the fight, the men stripped to
+their waists, cutlasses and boarding-pikes ready to hand, we waited
+with breathless anxiety. We were already within range of our
+bow-chasers, and as yet there was no sign that the pirate was
+conscious of our presence. The boats were now near him, and no doubt
+those on board were looking rather in their direction than to
+windward. Rapidly the _Alert_ tore through the water, the sail
+trimmers were all ready to take in her light canvas at a moment's
+notice. The officers clustered on the quarter-deck, and the men stood
+by their guns with every eye strained at the pirate. Nearer and nearer
+we came, and our hopes rose higher and higher. We were within a mile
+now, when suddenly a great movement was seen on board the pirate. The
+breeze was steady, and the sea quiet, and loud words of command could
+be heard shouted as a swarm of men ran up the rattlins. It was clear
+we were seen. There was no further need of concealment, and the
+captain gave word for the bow-chasers to open. Quickly as the pirate
+got her canvas spread--and I do think that sharp as we had been on
+board the _Alert_, the _Seamew_ was even quicker in getting under
+canvas--we were scarce a quarter of a mile from her when she got
+fairly under way. Up to this moment not a gun had spoken save the two
+bow-chasers, as the captain would not yaw her until the last moment
+Then round she came and poured a broadside into the _Seamew_. Orders
+had been given to fire high, and every man was on his mettle. The
+maintop-mast of the _Seamew_ fell, snapped at the cap; the peak
+halyards of the mizzen were shot away, and a number of holes were
+drilled through her sails. A loud cheer broke from our men. Fast as
+the _Seamew_ was she was sufficiently crippled now to prevent her
+getting away, and at last she was to show whether she could fight as
+well as run, and I must say for her she did.
+
+"She carried but twenty guns against our thirty-two, but they were of
+far heavier metal, and after ten minutes the _Alert_ was as much
+bruised and battered as if she had been fighting a Frenchman of equal
+size for an hour. However, we had not been idle, and as our shot had
+been principally directed against the enemy's rigging, as our great
+object was to cripple her and so prevent her from getting away, she
+was by this time a mere wreck above, although her sides were scarcely
+touched; whereas two of our ports had been knocked into one, and some
+thirty of our men had been struck down either by shot or by splinters.
+Pouring a last broadside into her, the captain ordered the _Alert_ to
+be brought alongside the _Seamew_. There was no need to call upon the
+boarders to be ready. Every man was prepared, and as the vessels came
+alongside our men rushed to the assault. But the crew of the _Seamew_
+were as eager to board us as we were them, and upon the very bulwarks
+a desperate combat ensued. Strong as we were, the _Seamew_ carried
+fully as many hands, and as they were fighting with halters round
+their necks it's little wonder that they fought so well.
+
+"I've been in a good many fights, but never did I see one like that.
+Each man hacked, and hewed, and wielded his boarding-pike as if the
+whole fight depended upon his single exertions. Gradually the men
+whose places were at the guns on the starboard side left their places
+and joined in the fight, while those on the port side continued to
+pour a fire of grape into the enemy. It was near half an hour before
+we got a fair footing on the pirate's deck, and then steadily and
+gradually we fought our way forward. But it was another half-hour
+after the pirate captain and all his officers had been killed, and
+fully half the crew cut down, that the rest surrendered.
+
+"On board the _Alert_ we had fully one-third of our complement killed
+or wounded. Mr. Jones had been shot through the head; the second and
+third lieutenants were both badly wounded, and the captain himself had
+had his jaw broken by a pistol fired in his face. I got this scar on
+my cheek, which spoiled my beauty for the rest of my life, but as I
+had been over thirty years married to the old woman that made but
+little difference. Never were a crew more glorious than we were that
+night. Even the wounded felt that the victory had been cheaply
+purchased. We had captured the scourge of these seas, which had for
+ten years laughed at all the fastest cruisers of our navy, and we felt
+as proud as if we had captured a French first-rate.
+
+"All hands were at work next day in repairing damages. I was up aloft
+seeing to the fitting of fresh gear to the topgallant-mast when I saw
+something floating at sea which took my attention. It seemed to me
+like a box, and an empty one, for it floated high on the water. Its
+lid seemed to be open, and I thought once or twice that I saw
+something inside. I slid down to the quarter-deck and reported what I
+had seen. The third lieutenant, who was doing duty with his arm in a
+sling, was not disposed to take the men off their work to lower a
+boat; but as I pointed out that the box might have belonged to the
+merchantman which had been burned overnight, and that it might afford
+some clew as to the name of the ship, he consented, and with four
+hands I was soon rowing towards the box.
+
+"I don't know what I had expected to see, but I was never more
+surprised than when, getting there, I found that it was a trunk, and
+that in it, sitting up, was a child about eighteen months old. That
+was you, Harry. In the bottom of the trunk were a locket with a
+woman's likeness in it, a curious Indian bangle, and a few other
+articles of jewelry. How you got there we never knew, but the
+supposition was that when the pirate was overhauling the merchantman,
+and her true nature was ascertained, some mother, knowing the fate
+that awaited all on board, had put you in an open trunk, had thrown in
+what ornaments she had about her, and had dropped the trunk overboard,
+in hopes that it might drift away and be picked up by some passing
+ship. It was a wild venture, with a thousand to one against its
+success, but the Lord had watched over it, and there you were as snug
+and comfortable as if you had been laying in your own cot, though, by
+the way, you were squalling as loud as a litter of kittens, and I
+expect had missed your breakfast considerably. You were sitting up,
+and it was lucky that you were backward of your age, for, although by
+your size we guessed you to be eighteen months, you were still unable
+to walk. If you had been as active as some chaps of that age you would
+have scrambled onto your feet, and no doubt capsized your boat.
+
+"Well, we brought you on board, and there was a great talk as to what
+was to be done with you; but as I was your discoverer I claimed you as
+a lawful prize, and I thought you would amuse the old woman while I
+was at sea, and perhaps be a comfort to me when I got laid up in
+ordinary, as indeed you have been. So that's all I know, Harry. Every
+inquiry was made, but we never heard of any ship which exactly
+answered to the description. You see, beyond the fact that she was a
+square-rigged ship we could say but little about her. The ornaments
+found in the box seemed to show that she had come from the East
+Indies, but of course that could not be, for what would she be doing
+there? But at any rate the person who put you into the trunk, and who
+was no doubt your mother, had been to the East Indies, or at least had
+been given those ornaments by someone who had, for there was no doubt
+where they were turned out.
+
+"Well, on board the _Alert_ everyone got promoted. There was enough
+valuable property found on board the _Seamew_ to give us a handsome
+sum all round, and it was my share of the prize-money that enabled me
+to buy this little cottage, and went no small way towards paying for
+your schooling and board. As no one else claimed you, and your friends
+could not be heard of, no one disputed my right to your guardianship;
+and so, my boy, here you have been cruising about the world as Harry
+Langley ever since."
+
+The old sailor was silent, and Harry was some time before he spoke.
+
+"Well, dad, you may not have been my real father, but no one could
+have been a better father to me than you have, and as it isn't likely
+now that I shall ever hit upon a clew which could lead me to discover
+who I am, I shall continue to regard you as my real father. Still, as
+you say, it may perhaps in life be some advantage to me to be able to
+claim that I am the son of a marquis;" and he laughed merrily. They
+talked the matter over for some time, and then Harry changed the
+subject.
+
+"Are all our friends well?" Harry asked.
+
+"All except poor Tom Hardy. He slipped his cable six months since, and
+his wife, poor old soul, is gone to some friends near Winchester."
+
+"Who's living in the cottage?"
+
+"Black Jack has taken it."
+
+"What! has he moved from his old place, then?"
+
+"No, it is said that he's taken it for a Frenchy, who comes down off
+and on. They say he's in the smuggling business with Black Jack, and
+that he disposes of the silks and wines that are brought over in the
+_Lucy_, and that Jack trades over in France with his friends. The
+lieutenant at the coast-guard station has his eye upon him, and I
+believe that some day they will catch Black Jack as he runs his cargo;
+but he's a slippery customer. It would be a good day for Hayling if
+they could do so, for he and his crew do a lot of harm to the place.
+They look more like men who have belonged to the _Seamew_ I was
+talking to you about than honest English fishermen."
+
+"It is a curious thing, dad, that the Frenchman should be coming
+backwards and forwards here, and I wonder that the revenue people
+don't inquire into it."
+
+"I don't suppose that they know very much about it, Harry. He comes
+off and on, generally arriving at night, and leaving a few hours
+afterwards. I hear about these things because everyone knows that old
+Peter Langley is not the chap to put his nose into other people's
+business. I don't like these goings on, I must say, and consider they
+will end badly. However, it is no business of ours, lad. We get our
+brandy cheap in Hayling--nowhere cheaper, I should say--and that,
+after all, is the matter that concerns us most. The wind's rising
+fast; I think we're in for a gale."
+
+It was as Peter said. The clouds were rising fast behind the island,
+the waves were breaking with a short, sharp sound upon the beach,
+white heads were beginning to show themselves out at sea, the fishing
+craft were running in towards Portsmouth under reefed sails, the
+men-of-war at Spithead could be seen sending down their topmasts, and
+everything betokened that it would be a nasty night.
+
+"What time must you leave, Harry?"
+
+"I shall go off at three to-morrow morning; shall cross the ferry, and
+catch the coach as it goes along at eight. I promised that I would be
+back on the following morning, and I would not fail in keeping my
+appointment, for as the captain has been so good I should be sorry
+that he should think that I had broken my word."
+
+In the course of the day Harry went over to the village and saw many
+of his boy friends. Bill Simpkins, however, his great chum, happened
+to be away, but his parents said that he would be back at nine in the
+evening. He had gone over to Winchester to see a brother who was in a
+regiment quartered there. Accordingly, soon after nine o'clock Harry
+said to his father that he would just walk over to have a chat with
+his friend, and be back in an hour or so.
+
+"Thou had best stop at home and go to bed at once," Jane Langley said;
+"if thou hast to start at three o'clock, it were time thou wert in bed
+now."
+
+"I am accustomed to short nights," Harry said, laughing, "and I shall
+be able to sleep long to-morrow."
+
+Putting on his hat, he nodded to the old couple, and went off at a run
+into the darkness.
+
+The road was a wide one, and but little frequented, and the grass grew
+thick over a considerable portion of the sides, therefore as he ran
+along with a light, springy tread the sound of his footsteps was
+deadened. As he came along by the cottage of which he had been
+speaking to Peter Langley he heard the sound of voices within. Being
+curious to see what this mysterious Frenchman was like, Harry paused,
+lightly lifted the latch of the gate, and entered the little garden.
+He had intended to peep in at the window, and having satisfied his
+curiosity to be off; but just as he reached the door the latter opened
+suddenly, and Harry had only time to draw back behind the little porch
+before two men came out. In one Harry recognized by his voice the
+smuggler Black Jack; the other was by his halting English evidently
+the foreigner. They stopped for a moment, looking out into the night.
+
+"I tell you," the smuggler said, "it's going to be a storm, and no
+mistake. The _Lucy_ is a tight craft, and has weathered gales when
+many a bigger ship has gone down. Still, I don't like running out into
+it without necessity."
+
+"Necezity," said the Frenchman. "I sould have sought zat ze earning of
+five hundred pounds was as urgent a necezity as was wanted."
+
+"Aye, the money will be handy enough," the smuggler said, "though one
+does put one's head into the noose to earn it. However, the sum is
+bigger than usual, and, as you say, the affair is important."
+
+"Bah!" the Frenchman said, "what does it matter about ze nooze? It
+hasn't got over your zick neck or my zin one, and till it does we
+needn't trouble about it. I tell you zis is ze most important dispatch
+we have ever sent, and if it gets safe to hand zey cannot grudge us
+double pay. I have ridden from London wizout stopping, and have killed
+a horse worth fifty of your guineas. However, zat matters not. Zis
+letter should fetch us ze money to pay for a dozen horses and a dozen
+of your _Lucys_."
+
+"All right!" the smuggler said; "in an hour we will be off. Letters
+like that in your pocket are best not kept on hand. You are sure that
+the _Chasse Marée_ will put out to meet us in such weather as we are
+likely to have?"
+
+"She will put out if a hurricane's blowing," the Frenchman said. "Zey
+know ze importance of ze news, which is expected, and which I am
+bringing zem. _Mon Dieu!_ what sums have been paid to get ze news
+zat's in zis little dispatch!"
+
+"Do you know what it is?" the smuggler said.
+
+"Not for certain," the Frenchman replied, "but I believe it is ze
+orders zat are to be sent to ze British fleet, and zat zey are about
+to strike a great blow zomewhere."
+
+"Well," the smuggler said, "I will go round and tell the boys. I
+warned them to be in readiness, and I will send them straight down to
+the beach. In a quarter of an hour I will return for you."
+
+While this conversation had been going on Harry had been standing
+against the porch, the sides of which were filled with latticework
+over which a creeper grew. He had been frightened at the importance of
+the secret that he was hearing, and had been rapidly meditating in his
+mind how this all-portant information which was about to be conveyed
+to the enemy could be stopped. He had made up his mind that the
+instant the smuggler moved out he would make his way down to the
+village, tell the tale to half a dozen men, and have the Frenchman
+seized. He saw at once that it would be difficult, for the smuggler
+and his gang were not men to be attacked with impunity, and the
+fishers of the village would hesitate in taking part in such a
+struggle merely on the information of a boy. However, Harry saw that
+it was the only chance.
+
+In his anxiety to stand close to the lattice and so hide himself from
+the view of the two men who were standing on the little garden-path in
+front, he pressed too hard against it. The woodwork was rotten with
+age, and suddenly with a crash it gave way.
+
+With an oath the smuggler turned round, and he and the Frenchman
+dashed to the spot, and in an instant had collared the lad. In a
+moment he was dragged into the room.
+
+"We must cut his throat, mounseer," the smuggler said, with a terrible
+imprecation. "The scoundrel has heard what we've said, and our lives
+won't be worth a minute's purchase if he were to be let free. Stand by
+and I'll knock out his brains;" and he seized a heavy poker from the
+side of the hearth.
+
+"No, no," the Frenchman said, "don't let us have blood. Zere might be
+inquiries, and zese sings will sometimes be found. Better take him to
+sea wis you in ze _Lucy_, and hand him over to ze _Chasse Marée_. Zey
+will take care zat he does not come back again."
+
+"I will take care myself," the smuggler said. "I'm not going to risk
+my neck on the chance of his blabbing. It's better, as you say, to
+have no blood, but as soon as the _Lucy's_ at sea overboard he goes."
+
+"We can talk of it," the Frenchman said. "I'm wis you zat he must be
+silenced, but it may be better--my plan zan yours. Zis boy belongs, I
+suppose, to ze village?"
+
+"Yes," the smuggler said, "I know him by sight. He's the son of an
+old man-of-war's man who lives half a mile away."
+
+"Well, you see, some of your men might some day, if they quarreled wis
+you, or in zeir drink, drop some words which might lead to inquiries.
+Better put him on board ze _Chasse Marée_. I will see ze matter is
+settled."
+
+Harry had spoken no word from the time he was grasped. He felt in an
+instant that his life was forfeited, and was surprised that he had not
+been instantly killed. He had not raised his voice to hallo, for he
+knew that no cottagers were near, and was sure that an attempt to give
+the alarm would insure his instant death. To struggle would have been
+useless. He was unarmed, and although a stout lad, was but a child in
+the grasp of a powerful man like the smuggler. He saw, too, that on
+the instant the Frenchman had drawn a dagger from his breast, and
+though more quiet than the smuggler he felt by the tone of his voice
+that he was as determined as his colleague that his silence should be
+secured by death.
+
+In another minute he was bound and thrown into a corner. The Frenchman
+then took his seat near him, assuring him in a low tone that he would
+at his first movement plant his dagger in his heart. The smuggler
+strolled off to summon his crew, and for a quarter of an hour silence
+reigned in the cottage.
+
+"You are one fool," the Frenchman said at last, as if he had been
+thinking the matter over--"one meddlesome fool. Why you want to listen
+at people's doors and learn zeir secrets? I don't want to kill you,
+but what are we to do? You make us kill you. You push your own head
+into ze trap. Zat is ze way wis boys. Zey are forever meddling in
+affairs zat concern zem not, and zen we have ze trouble to kill zem. I
+would give a hundred pounds if zis had not happened; but what can I
+do? It is my life against yours, and alzough I am sorry to have to do
+it--_parbleu!_ my life is of much more value zan zat of a fishing boy.
+Bah! you are one meddlesome fool."
+
+So exasperated was the Frenchman at the trouble which the prying of
+this lad had brought upon him that he got up and angrily gave him a
+kick. A few minutes later the smuggler returned.
+
+"The men have all gone down to the boat," he said briefly. "Come
+along, mounseer. Bring that tin case with you, and those pistols."
+
+"Zere is no fear zat I forget ze tin case," the Frenchman said. "As to
+ze pistols--zey are not of much use. However, I will take zem;" and he
+thrust them into the pockets of his coat.
+
+The smuggler stooped, picked up Harry, threw him onto a sail which he
+had laid on the ground, wrapped this round him, and then cast him over
+his shoulder.
+
+"I'm not likely to meet anyone on my way to the boat," he said, "but
+should I do so I'm taking the mainsail of the _Lucy_ down to her."
+
+In another minute Harry heard the door slam, and then he felt himself
+being carried steadily along, his weight being as nothing to the
+smuggler. Not a word was spoken between the two men on their way down
+to the shore. Presently Harry felt by the deadened sound of the
+footsteps, and by the more uneven motion, that he was being carried
+over the sandy slopes down to the edge of the sea, and through the
+canvas he could hear the loud roar of the waves, which were now
+breaking violently.
+
+Presently he was flung roughly down on the sands. A minute later he
+was lifted by the head and feet, and swung into a boat. Not a word was
+spoken as it was shoved off through the breakers, and after ten
+minutes' hard rowing he felt a shock, and knew that they were
+alongside of the _Lucy_. He was hauled up on deck. He heard a few
+words of command, and then felt the vessel was on her way. A minute or
+two later the covering was unloosed. His cords were cut, and the
+smuggler said to him, "You can't get away now, and may as well make
+yourself handy for the present. Give a haul on that rope."
+
+The _Lucy_ was, in fact, short-handed, two of the six men who composed
+her crew being absent. She was a lugger of some twenty-five tons'
+burden, built something like an ordinary fishing-boat, but longer and
+lower, and was, in fact, used for fishing when her crew were not
+engaged upon other adventures. She was a remarkably fast craft, and
+had more than once showed her heels with success when chased by the
+revenue cutters. She owed her immunity from capture, however, chiefly
+to her appearance, as from her size and build she generally passed
+unsuspected as an innocent fisherman.
+
+The storm increased in violence, and the little lugger, although a
+good sea-boat, had difficulty in making her way almost in the teeth of
+the gale. She was bound, Harry gained from a word or two dropped by
+the captain, for the mouth of the Loire, off which she was to be met
+by the _Chasse Marée_. Long before morning the coast of England was
+out of sight, and the lugger was struggling down Channel bravely
+holding her way in the sou'westerly gale.
+
+"Will she be zere true to her time?" the Frenchman asked the smuggler.
+
+"Aye, she will do it," Black Jack said, "if the wind holds as at
+present. Two o'clock in the morning is the time named, and if your
+people are as punctual as I shall be, the five hundred pounds will be
+gained. There's one thing--in such a gale as is blowing to-day none of
+our cruisers who may be off the coast are likely to trouble themselves
+about a boat like ours. They may wonder what we are doing at sea, but
+are scarcely likely to chase us."
+
+Once or twice in the course of the day large vessels were seen in the
+distance, which Harry knew, by the cut of their sails, to be English
+cruisers. All were, however, lying-to under the smallest canvas, and
+Harry knew that any assistance from them was out of the question.
+Towards evening the gale moderated, but the sea was still very high.
+During the day Harry had turned over in his mind every possible plan
+by which he might destroy the tin case which contained, as he knew,
+such important documents. From what he had gathered he learned that
+the success of some great undertaking upon which the British fleet
+were about to embark would be marred if these papers were to find
+their way into the hands of the French authorities. His own life he
+regarded as absolutely forfeited, for he was sure that no sooner was
+he fairly on board the French _Chasse Marée_ than he would, at the
+orders of the French spy, be thrown overboard, and that his life had
+been so preserved, not from any feeling of mercy, but in order that
+his death might be accomplished with less risk to those whose safety
+demanded it.
+
+He was determined, if opportunity presented, to seize the little case
+and to leap overboard with it. The French spy never for one moment put
+it down. It was a small tin case, with a handle at the top, and some
+eight inches long by three inches wide, and the same deep. Sometimes
+the Frenchman put it in his pocket, beyond which it projected, but
+even then he took the precaution always to keep his hand upon it.
+During the day Harry was constantly employed in work on board the
+lugger, hauling at ropes and acting as if he were one of the regular
+crew. He had shared in the meals with the men, but beyond a curse now
+and then not a word had been addressed to him by any on board. The
+night came on; the wind was still going down, but the sea was very
+heavy. From the occasional rifts in the clouds the stars could be seen
+shining brightly, and once or twice the moon broke through and spread
+a light over the angry sea. As time went on the smuggler became
+anxious, and kept a keen lookout ahead.
+
+"It is past two," he exclaimed presently to the Frenchman, "and we are
+nearly off the mouth of the river. When the moon shone out just now I
+thought I caught sight of a vessel coming out, and I believe to
+windward an English cruiser is lying. However, I will get ready the
+lanterns."
+
+The next time the moon came out a vessel was clearly seen. The
+smuggler raised the lantern above the bulwarks, held it there for half
+a minute, and then lowered it. This he repeated three times. A moment
+later a similar signal was made on the bows of the vessel.
+
+"That's her," the smuggler exclaimed exultingly, "and the five hundred
+pounds is as good as in my pocket!"
+
+As he spoke a bright flash was seen to windward.
+
+"Confound it!" the smuggler said, "that cruiser has caught sight of
+the Frenchman. However, we shall be on board in plenty of time, and
+whether she gets safe to shore or not matters not much to me. I shall
+have done my part of the work, and you, mounseer, will give me the
+order for payment on London."
+
+"It's done, my friend," the Frenchman said; "you've done your work
+well. Here's the order."
+
+By this time the French craft was within a distance of a quarter of a
+mile, running down at a great pace under her reefed sails.
+
+"It'll be no easy matter to get on board," the smuggler said, "for the
+sea is running tremendously. They will have to throw a rope, and you
+will have to catch it, mounseer, and jump overboard. I suppose your
+dispatch-box is water-tight?"
+
+"And the boy?" the Frenchman asked.
+
+"Let them throw another rope," the smuggler said, "and you can haul
+him on board too. It won't make much matter whether I slip the noose
+round his body or his neck. The last will be the easiest plan perhaps,
+for then, if he happens not to be alive when you pull him out, it
+would be an accident; and even if anyone chooses to peach, they can't
+swear that it was purposely done."
+
+Harry was standing near, and heard the words. He was close to the helm
+at the time, and watched with intense anxiety as the _Chasse Marée_
+ran rapidly down to them. It was clear that what had to be done must
+be done quickly, for another flash came up from the cruiser; and
+although in the din of the wind and the toss of the waves it could not
+be seen where her shot had fallen, the brightness of the flash showed
+that she had come up since the last shot was discharged. The _Chasse
+Marée_ ran down, and as she came her captain stood upon the bulwarks
+and shouted at the top of his voice "Keep her steady, and as I run
+past I will throw a rope."
+
+"Throw two," Black Jack shouted. "There are two to come on board."
+
+The course taken by the _Chasse Marée_ would bring her along at a
+distance of some ten yards from the side of the lugger. At the moment
+a squall came, and the lugger's head turned a little towards the
+approaching craft. When she was just upon them Harry saw that his one
+chance of escape had come. With a sudden rush he knocked the man at
+the helm from his footing, and put the tiller up hard. The lugger paid
+off instantly. Black Jack, with an oath, turned round and sprang at
+Harry. The lad leaped beneath his uplifted hand, sprang at the
+Frenchman, who was standing with his back to him, and snatching the
+tin box from his hand leaped overboard.
+
+Momentary as had been his hold upon the tiller it had been sufficient.
+The vessel had paid off from the wind, and before the helmsman could
+regain his feet, or Black Jack could seize the tiller, she lay across
+the course of the _Chasse Marée_; and in another moment the French
+craft plunged down upon her, and with a crash the _Lucy_ sank under
+her bows, and went down with all on board.
+
+As Harry sank beneath the waves he heard a shout of dismay from those
+on board the _Lucy_. When he came up a minute later he saw the _Chasse
+Marée_ plowing her way from him, but no sign of the _Lucy_ was to be
+seen. Harry was a good swimmer, and fortunately the dispatch-box which
+he grasped was water-tight, and buttoning it within his jacket he felt
+that it kept his head easily above the water. He swam as well as he
+could away from the spot where the Lucy had disappeared, for he knew
+that if Black Jack or the Frenchman had escaped being run down and
+should see him, his death was certain--not indeed that his chances
+were in any case good, but with the natural hopefulness of boyhood he
+clung to life, and resolved to make a fight for it as long as
+possible. Had it not been for the dispatch-box he must have speedily
+succumbed, for in so heavy a sea it was difficult in the extreme to
+swim. However, after a short time he turned his back to the wind, and
+suffered himself quietly to drift.
+
+Hour passed after hour, and at last, to his intense delight, morning
+began to break. He saw on his right the low shores of the French
+coast, and looking round beheld seaward the British cruiser which had
+fired at the _Chasse Marée_. She was running quietly along the coast,
+and was evidently on guard at the mouth of the river. The sea had now
+gone down much, and the sun rose bright in an almost cloudless sky.
+
+Invigorated by the sight of the vessel Harry at once swam towards her.
+She was farther out by a mile than the spot where he was swimming, and
+was some two miles astern of him. She was sailing but slowly, and he
+hoped that by the time she came along he would be able to get within
+a distance whence he might be seen. His fear was that she might run
+back before she reached the spot where she would be nearer to him.
+
+With all his strength he swam steadily out, keeping his eye fixed
+steadily on the ship. Still she came onward, and was within half a
+mile when she was abreast of him. Then raising himself as high as he
+could from the water, he shouted at the top of his voice. Again and
+again he splashed with his hands to make as much spray and commotion
+as possible in order to attract attention. His heart almost stood
+still with joy as he heard an answering hail, and a moment later he
+saw the vessel come round into the wind, and lay there with her sails
+back. Then a boat was lowered, and five minutes later he was hauled
+in, his senses almost leaving him now that the time for exertion had
+passed. It was not until he had been lifted onto the deck of the
+_Viper_, and brandy had been poured down his throat, that he was able
+to speak. As soon as he was sufficiently recovered he was sent for to
+the captain's cabin.
+
+"And who are you, boy, and whence do you come?" the captain asked. "Do
+you belong to the _Chasse Marée_, which we chased in the night?"
+
+The officer spoke in French, supposing that Harry had fallen overboard
+from that craft.
+
+"I am English, sir," Harry said, "and escaped from a lugger which was
+run down by the French craft just as you were firing at her."
+
+"I thought," exclaimed the captain, "that my eyes had not been wrong.
+I was sure that I saw a small fishing-boat close to the _Chasse
+Marée_. We lost sight of her when a cloud came over the moon, and
+thought we must have been mistaken. How came you there in an English
+fishing-boat?"
+
+Harry modestly told the story, and produced the dispatch-box.
+
+"This is important news indeed," the officer said, "and your conduct
+has been in every way most gallant. What is your name, lad?"
+
+"Harry Langley," he replied. "I am an apprentice on board the Indiaman
+_Dundas Castle_, and was to have sailed this week in the convoy for
+the West Indies."
+
+"You will not be able to do that now," the captain said. "This is most
+important. However, the steward will take charge of you, and I will
+talk to you again presently."
+
+The steward was called, and was told to put Harry into a cot slung for
+him, and to give him a bowl of warm soup; and in a few minutes the lad
+was asleep.
+
+The _Viper_ shortly afterwards hauled her wind, and ran down to a
+consort who was keeping watch with her over the mouth of the Loire.
+The captain repaired on board the other ship, whose commander was his
+senior officer, and a consultation was held between them, after which
+the _Viper_ was again got under sail and shaped her course for
+Portsmouth.
+
+The wind was fair, and the next morning the _Viper_ passed through
+the Needles, and soon afterwards anchored at Spithead. Here a large
+number of men-of-war and frigates were at anchor, and above two of the
+largest floated the flags of admirals. The _Viper_ had made her signal
+as she came in sight of the fleet, and a reply was instantly run up
+from the masthead of the admiral's ship, directing the captain to come
+on board immediately the anchor was dropped. The moment this was done
+the captain's gig was lowered, and calling to Harry to follow him the
+captain took his seat in the stern-sheets, and rowed for the admiral's
+ship. Directing the lad to remain on deck, the captain at once entered
+the admiral's cabin, and a few minutes later the admiral's orderly
+summoned Harry to enter.
+
+Admiral Sir Hyde Parker had evidently had a breakfast party, for a
+number of naval officers, including Admiral Nelson and most of the
+captains of the men-of-war, were seated round the table. The admiral
+turned to Harry.
+
+"So you are the lad who has brought this box of dispatches?"
+
+"Yes, sir," Harry said modestly.
+
+"Tell us your story over again," the admiral said. "It's a strange
+one."
+
+Harry again repeated the account of his adventures from the time of
+leaving his father's cottage. When he had done Admiral Nelson
+exclaimed:
+
+"Very well, my lad. You could not have acted with more presence of
+mind had you been a captain of the fleet. You showed great bravery
+and did your duty nobly."
+
+"There wasn't much bravery, sir," Harry said modestly, "for I knew
+that they were going to kill me anyhow, so that it made no difference.
+But I was determined, if possible, that the dispatches should be
+destroyed."
+
+The admiral smiled. He was not accustomed to hear his dicta even so
+slightly questioned by a lad.
+
+"You are an apprentice in the merchant service, Captain Skinner tells
+me," Sir Hyde Parker said, "and have been two years at sea."
+
+"Yes, sir," Harry said.
+
+"Would you like to be on the quarter-deck of one of his majesty's
+vessels, instead of that of a merchantman?"
+
+Harry's eyes glistened at the question.
+
+"I should indeed, sir," he said.
+
+"Then you shall be, my boy," the admiral answered. "Have any of you
+gentlemen a vacancy in the midshipmen's berth? If not, I'll have him
+ranked as a supernumerary on board my ship."
+
+"I am short of a midshipman, Sir Hyde," one of the captains said.
+"Poor little De Lisle fell overboard the night before last as we came
+round from Plymouth. He was about the size of this lad, and I'll
+arrange for him to have his togs. I like his look, and I should be
+glad to have him with me. I am sure he will be a credit to the
+service."
+
+"That's settled, then," the admiral said. "You are now, sir," he said,
+turning to Harry again, "an officer in his majesty's service, and, as
+Captain Ball remarks, I am sure you will do credit to the service. A
+lad who does his duty when death is staring him in the face, and
+without a hope that the act of devotion will ever be known or
+recognized, is sure to make a brave and worthy officer."
+
+Harry's new captain wrote a few words on a piece of paper, and said to
+the admiral's servant, "Will you tell the midshipman of my gig to come
+here?"
+
+A minute afterwards the midshipman entered. The captain gave him the
+slip of paper and said, "Take this young gentleman on board the ship
+with you at once, and present him to Mr. Francis, and with him give
+this note. He will be your shipmate in future. See that he's made
+comfortable."
+
+The midshipman then beckoned to Harry to follow him, gazing askance,
+and with no slight astonishment in his face, at the appearance of his
+new messmate. Harry's attire, indeed, was not in accordance with the
+received ideas of that of a midshipman freshly joining a ship. His
+clothes were all so much shrunk that his ankles showed below his
+trousers, and his wrists below his coat-sleeves. Without a word the
+midshipman took his place in the stern-sheets, and beckoned Harry to
+sit beside him.
+
+"Where have you sprung from?" he said shortly.
+
+"I hail last from the admiral's cabin," Harry said with a laugh.
+"Before that from his majesty's ship _Viper_, and before that from the
+sea."
+
+"You look like the sea," said the midshipman. "But what have you been
+doing? Have you served before?"
+
+"Not in a king's ship," Harry said; "I have only just been appointed."
+
+The midshipman was too surprised at Harry's appearance to question him
+further. He felt that there was some mystery in the affair, and that
+it would be better for him to wait until he saw the footing upon which
+Harry was placed. He had little doubt from the fact of his appointment
+being made under such circumstances that there must be something at
+once singular and noteworthy about it.
+
+Upon reaching the ship Harry's new messmate at once led him up to the
+first lieutenant, and presented the captain's note. The lieutenant
+opened it and glanced at the contents. They were brief:
+
+"Harry Langley has been appointed midshipman on board the _Cæsar_, and
+has been promoted by Sir Hyde Parker himself. He has performed a most
+gallant action, and one of the greatest importance. Make him at home
+at once, and let him have poor De Lisle's kit. I will arrange about
+it."
+
+The senior midshipman was at once sent for by Mr. Francis, and Harry
+handed over to him. The first lieutenant intimated to him briefly the
+contents of the captain's letter, telling the midshipman to make him
+as comfortable as possible.
+
+Harry was led below to the cockpit, where his arrival was greeted with
+a storm of questions, as his appearance on the quarter-deck had
+naturally excited a great deal of observation. The midshipman who had
+come with him could, of course, furnish no information, and beyond the
+brief fact mentioned by the captain and repeated by the first
+lieutenant, his new conductor could say no more.
+
+"Just wait," the midshipman said, "till he's got into his new clothes
+and looks presentable. He's in my charge, and I am to make him
+comfortable. As he has been put on the quarter-deck by Sir Hyde
+himself you may be sure he has done something out of the way."
+
+In a few minutes Harry was rigged out in full midshipman's dress, and
+being a very good-looking and gentlemanly lad, his appearance
+favorably impressed his new messmates, who had at first been disposed
+to resent the intrusion among themselves of a youngster whose
+appearance was at least the reverse of reputable.
+
+"Now," said one of the passed mates, "this meeting will resolve itself
+into a committee. Let everyone who can, sit down; and let those who
+can't, stand quiet. I am the president of the court. Now, prisoner at
+the bar," he said, "what is your name?"
+
+"Harry Langley."
+
+"And how came you here?"
+
+"I was brought in the captain's gig."
+
+"No equivocation, prisoner. I mean what brought you onto the
+quarter-deck?"
+
+"I had the good luck," Harry said, "to prevent a very important
+dispatch falling into the hands of the French."
+
+"The deuce you had!" the president said; "and how was that? That is to
+say," he said, "if there's no secret about it?"
+
+"None at all," Harry said, "the matter was very simple;" and for the
+second time that morning he told the story.
+
+When he had done there was a general exclamation of approval among
+those present, and the midshipmen crowded round him, shaking his hand,
+patting him on the back, and declaring that he was a trump.
+
+"The prisoner is acquitted," the president said, "and is received as a
+worthy member of this noble body. Boy!"
+
+"Yes, sir."
+
+"Go to the purser and ask him to send in two bottles of rum for this
+honorable mess to drink the health of a new comrade."
+
+Presently the boy returned.
+
+"The purser says, sir, who is going to pay for the rum?"
+
+There was a roar of laughter among the middies, for the master's mate,
+who had acted as president, was notoriously in the purser's books to
+the full amount of his credit. However, a midshipman, who happened
+that morning to have received a remittance, undertook to stand the
+liquor to the mess, and Harry's health was drunk with all honors.
+
+"I suppose," one of the midshipmen said, "that the contents of the
+dispatch were with reference to the point to which we are all bound. I
+wonder where it can be?"
+
+Here an animated discussion arose as to the various points against
+which the attack of the fleet, now rapidly assembling at Spithead,
+might be directed. So far no whisper of its probable course had been
+made public, and it was believed indeed that even the captains of the
+fleet were ignorant of its object.
+
+Upon the following day Harry at once obtained leave to go on shore for
+twenty-four hours. Immediately he reached the Head he chartered a
+wherry, and was on the point of sailing when he heard a well-known
+voice among a group of sailors standing near him.
+
+"I can't make head or tail of it," Peter Langley said. "My boy left me
+merely to go down to the village, and was to have returned the first
+thing in the morning to join his ship in London. Well, he never came
+back no more. What he did with himself, unless he sailed in a
+smuggling lugger which put out an hour or two afterwards, I can't make
+out. The boy would never have shipped in that craft willingly, and I
+can see no reason why he should have gone otherwise. He didn't cross
+the ferry, and I can't help suspecting there was some foul play. When
+Black Jack returns I will have it out of him if I kill him for it. He
+has a strong party there, and I want half a dozen good tight hands to
+come with me to Hayling. He will probably be back in a couple of days,
+and if we tackle him directly he lands we may find out something about
+him. Who will go with me?"
+
+Half a dozen voices exclaimed that they were willing to assist their
+old mate, when suddenly Harry stepped in among them, saying, "There's
+no occasion for that. I can tell them all about him."
+
+Peter Langley stepped backwards in his astonishment, and stared
+open-mouthed at Harry.
+
+"Dash my buttons!" he exclaimed; "why, if it isn't Harry himself, and
+in a midshipman's rig. What means this, my boy?"
+
+"It means, father, that I am a midshipman on board his majesty's ship
+_Cæsar_."
+
+Peter stood for a moment as one stupefied with astonishment, and then
+threw his tarpaulin high in the air with a shout of delight. It fell
+into the water, and the tide carried it away; Peter gave it no further
+thought, but, seizing Harry's hand, wrung it with enthusiastic
+delight.
+
+"This is news indeed, my boy," he said. "To think of seeing you on the
+quarter-deck, and that so soon!"
+
+It was some minutes before Harry could shake himself free from his
+friends, all of whom were old chums of the boatswain, and had known
+him in his childhood. Drawing Peter aside at last he took him to a
+quiet hotel, and there, to the intense astonishment of the veteran, he
+related to him the circumstances which had led to his elevation. The
+old sailor was alternately filled with wrath and admiration, and it
+was only the consideration that beyond doubt Black Jack and the
+Frenchman had both perished in the _Lucy_ that restrained him from
+instantly rushing off to take vengeance upon them.
+
+An hour later the pair took a wherry and sailed to Hayling, where the
+joy of Peter was rivaled by that of Harry's foster-mother. That
+evening Peter went out and so copiously ordered grog for all the
+seafaring population in honor of the event that the village was a
+scene of rejoicing and festivity such as was unknown in its quiet
+annals.
+
+The next day Harry rejoined his ship, and commenced his regular duties
+as a midshipman on board.
+
+A week later the whole of the ships destined to take part in it had
+arrived. The "Blue Peter" was hoisted at the ship's head, and on a gun
+firing from the admiral's ship the anchors were weighed, and the fleet
+soon left Spithead behind them. It consisted of eighteen sail of the
+line, with a number of frigates and gunboats. The expedition was
+commanded by Sir Hyde Parker, with Admiral Nelson second in command.
+Contrary to the general expedition they sailed eastward instead of
+passing through the Solent, and, coasting along the south of England,
+passed through the Straits of Dover and stood out into the North Sea.
+
+Harry had had an interview with his captain four days after he had
+joined. The latter told him that the dispatch-box which he had taken
+had been sent up to London, and that its contents proved to be of the
+highest importance, and that the Lords of the Admiralty had themselves
+written to the admiral expressing their extreme satisfaction at the
+capture, saying that the whole of their plans would have been
+disconcerted had the papers fallen into the hands of the enemy. They
+were pleased to express their strong approval of the conduct of Harry
+Langley, and gave their assurance that when the time came his claim
+for promotion should not be ignored.
+
+"So, my lad," the captain said, "you may be sure that when you have
+passed your cadetship you will get your epaulette without loss of
+time, and if you are steady and well conducted you may look out for a
+brilliant position. It is not many lads who enter the navy under such
+favorable conditions. I should advise you to study hard in order to
+fit yourself for command when the time should come. From what you tell
+me your education has not been neglected, and I have no doubt you know
+as much as the majority of my midshipmen as to books. But books are
+not all. An officer in his majesty's service should be a gentleman.
+That you are that in manner, I am happy to see. But it is desirable
+also that an officer should be able in all society to hold his own in
+point of general knowledge with other gentlemen. Midshipmen, as a
+class, are too much given to shirking their studies, and to think that
+if an officer can handle and fight a ship it is all that is required.
+It may be all that is absolutely necessary, but you will find that the
+men who have most made their mark are all something more than rough
+sailors. I need say nothing to you as to the necessity of at all times
+and hazards doing your duty. That is a lesson that you have clearly
+already learned."
+
+As the fleet still kept east, expectation rose higher and higher as to
+the object of the expedition. Some supposed that a dash was to be made
+on Holland. Others conceived that the object of the expedition must be
+one of the North German or Russian forts, and the latter were
+confirmed in their ideas when one fine morning the fleet were found to
+be entering the Sound. Instead of passing through, however, the fleet
+anchored here, out of gunshot of the forts of Copenhagen; and great
+was the astonishment of the officers and men alike of the fleet when
+it became known that an ultimatum had been sent on shore, and that the
+Danes (who had been regarded as a neutral power) were called upon at
+once to surrender their fleet to the English.
+
+Upon the face of facts known to the world at large, this was indeed a
+most monstrous breach of justice and right. The Danes had taken no
+part in the great struggle which had been going on, and their
+sympathies were generally supposed to be with the English rather than
+the French. Thus, for a fleet to appear before the capital of Denmark,
+and to summon its king to surrender his fleet, appeared a high-handed
+act of brute force.
+
+In fact, however, the English government had learned that negotiations
+had been proceeding between the Danish government and the French; and
+that a great scheme had been agreed upon, by which the Danes should
+join the French at a given moment, and the united fleets being
+augmented by ships of other powers, a sudden attack would be made upon
+England. Had this secret confederation not been interfered with, the
+position of England would have been seriously threatened. The fleet
+which the allies would have been able to put onto the scene would have
+greatly exceeded that which England could have mustered to defend her
+coast, and although peace nominally prevailed between England and
+Denmark the English ministry considered itself justified--and
+posterity has agreed in the verdict--in taking time by the forelock,
+and striking a blow before their seeming ally had time to throw off
+the mask and to join in the projected attack upon them.
+
+It was the news of this secret resolve on the part of the cabinet
+that, having in some way been obtained by a heavy bribe from a
+subordinate in the admiralty, was being carried over in cipher to
+France in the _Lucy_, and had it reached its destination the Danes
+would have been warned in time, and the enterprise undertaken by
+Parker and Nelson would have been impossible, for the forts of
+Copenhagen, aided by the fleet in the harbor, were too strong to have
+been attacked had they been thoroughly prepared for the strife. As all
+these matters were unknown to the officers of the fleet, great was the
+astonishment when the captains of the ships assembled in the admiral's
+cabin, and each received orders as to the position which his vessel
+was to take up, and the part it was to bear in the contest. This being
+settled, the captains returned to their respective ships.
+
+Several days were spent in negotiations, but as the Danes finally
+refused compliance with the English demands the long-looked-for signal
+was hoisted and the fleet stood in through the Sound. It was a fine
+sight as the leading squadron, consisting of twelve line-of-battle
+ships and a number of frigates under Admiral Nelson, steered on
+through the Sound, followed at a short distance by Sir Hyde Parker
+with the rest of the fleet. The Danish forts on the Sound cannonaded
+them, but their fire was very ineffectual, and the fleet without
+replying steered on until they had attained the position intended for
+them. The Danes were prepared for action. Their fleet of thirteen
+men-of-war and a number of frigates, supported by floating batteries
+mounting seventy heavy guns, was moored in a line four miles long in
+front of the town, and was further supported by the forts on shore.
+
+This great force was to be engaged by the squadron of Admiral Nelson
+alone, as that of Sir Hyde Parker remained outside menacing the
+formidable Crown Batteries and preventing these from adding their fire
+to that of the fleet and other shore batteries upon Nelson's squadron.
+
+The _Cæsar_, the leading ship of the fleet, had been directed to sail
+right past the line of ships and to operate against a detached fort
+standing on a spit of land on the right flank of the Danish position.
+This fort mounted many guns, much superior to those of the Cæsar in
+weight, but the crew were in high spirits at the prospect of a fight,
+little as they understood the cause for which they were engaged.
+Stripping to the waist, they clustered round the guns, each officer at
+his post, Harry, with two other midshipmen, being upon the
+quarter-deck near the captain to carry orders from him as might be
+required to different parts of the ship. As the _Cæsar_ passed along
+the line of ships to take up her position she was saluted by a storm
+of fire from the Danish vessels, to which she made no reply. She
+suffered, however, but little injury, although shot and shell whistled
+between the masts and struck the water on all sides of her, several
+striking the hull with a dull, crashing sound, while her sails were
+pierced with holes. Harry felt that he was rather pale, and was
+disgusted with himself at the feeling of discomfort which he
+experienced. But there is nothing that tries the nerves more than
+standing the fire of an enemy before it is time to set to work to
+reply. As soon as orders were given for the _Cæsar's_ fire to be
+opened, directly the guns could be brought to bear, and the roar of
+her cannon answered those of the fort, the feeling of uneasiness on
+Harry's part disappeared, and was succeeded by that of the excitement
+of battle. The din was prodigious. Along the whole line the British
+fleet was engaged, and the boom of the heavy guns of the ships, forts,
+and batteries, and the rattle of musketry from the tops of the ships,
+kept up a deep roar like that of incessant thunder.
+
+"The water is very shallow, sir," the first lieutenant reported to the
+captain. "There are but two fathoms under her foot. The wind, too, is
+dropping so much that we have scarcely steerage-way, and the current
+is sweeping us along fast."
+
+"Prepare to anchor, Mr. Francis," the captain said.
+
+He had scarcely spoken, however, when there was a slight shivering
+sensation in the ship, and it was known by all on board that she was
+aground, and that on a falling tide. While the starboard guns were
+kept at work the men were called off from those of the port side,
+boats were lowered and hawsers were got out, and every effort was made
+to tow the ship off the shoal. The sailors pulled hard in spite of the
+storm of shot and shell which fell round them from the fort and the
+nearest Danish ships. But the _Cæsar_ was fast. Calling the men on
+board again, the captain requested the first lieutenant to go aloft
+and see what was going on in other parts of the line. He returned with
+the news that four or five other ships were plainly aground, and that
+things appeared to be going badly. In the meantime the _Cæsar_ was
+suffering heavily. The fire of the fort was well directed, and the
+gunners, working their pieces under comparative shelter, were able to
+pour their fire steadily into the _Cæsar_, while a floating battery
+and two frigates also kept up an incessant fire.
+
+The number of killed and wounded was already large, but as only the
+guns of the starboard side could be worked the fire was kept up with
+unabated zeal, and the fort bore many signs of the accuracy of the
+fire. The parapet was in many places shot away and several of the guns
+put out of action. But the _Cæsar_ was clearly overmatched, and the
+captain hastily wrote a note to the admiral, stating that the ship was
+aground and was altogether overmatched, and begging that another
+vessel might be dispatched to his aid, if one could be spared, in
+order to partially relieve her of the enemy's fire.
+
+"Here, Mr. Langley, take the gig and row off to the flagship
+instantly."
+
+Harry obeyed orders. Through the storm of shot and shell which was
+flying, striking up the water in all directions, he made his way to
+the admirals ship, which was lying nearly a mile away.
+
+Admiral Nelson opened the note and read it through.
+
+"Tell Captain Ball," he said, "that I haven't a ship to spare.
+Several are aground, and all hard pressed. He must do the best he can.
+Ah! you are the lad whom I saw in Sir Hyde Parker's cabin, are you
+not?"
+
+"Yes, sir."
+
+The Admiral nodded in token of approval, and Harry prepared to leave.
+Suddenly a thought struck him, and running into the captain's cabin he
+asked the steward for a small tablecloth.
+
+"What on earth d'you want it for?" he exclaimed.
+
+"Never mind. Give it me at once."
+
+Seizing the tablecloth he ran down into the boat. As they returned
+towards the _Cæsar_ they could see how hardly matters were going with
+her. One of her masts was down. Her sides were battered and torn, and
+several of her port-holes were knocked into one. Still her fire
+continued unabated, but it was clear that she could not much longer
+resist.
+
+"Do you think she must haul down her flag?" Harry said to the coxswain
+of the boat.
+
+"Aye, aye, sir," the coxswain said. "Wood and iron can't stand such a
+pounding as that much longer. Most captains would have hauled down the
+flag long before this, and even our skipper can't stand out much
+longer. There won't be a man alive to fight her."
+
+"Will you do as I order?" Harry said.
+
+"Aye, sir," the coxswain said in surprise, "I will do what you like;"
+for the story of the conduct by which Harry had gained his
+midshipman's promotion had been repeated through the ship, and the men
+were all proud of the lad who had behaved so pluckily.
+
+"At least," Harry said, "it may do good, and it can't do harm. Where's
+the boat-hook? Fasten this tablecloth to it and pull for the fort."
+
+The coxswain gave an exclamation of surprise, but did as Harry told
+him, and with the white flag flying the boat pulled straight towards
+the fort. As he was seen to do so the fire of the latter, which had
+been directed towards the boat, ceased, although the duel between the
+battery and the _Cæsar_ continued with unabated vigor. Harry steered
+direct to the steps on the sea face and mounted to the interior of the
+fort, where, on saying that he brought a message from the captain, he
+was at once conducted to the commandant.
+
+"I am come, sir," Harry said, "from the captain to beg of you to
+surrender at once. Your guns have been nobly fought, but two more
+ships are coming down to engage with you, and the captain would fain
+save further effusion of life. You have done all that brave men could
+do, but the fight everywhere goes against you, and further resistance
+is vain. In a quarter of an hour a fire will be centered upon your
+guns that will mean annihilation, and the captain therefore begs you
+to spare the brave men under your orders from further sacrifice."
+
+Taken by surprise by this sudden demand, which was fortunately at the
+moment backed up by two ships of the squadron which had hitherto taken
+no part in the action being seen sailing in, the governor, after a
+hasty consultation with his officers, resolved to surrender, and two
+minutes afterwards the Danish flag was hauled down in the fort and the
+white flag run up. One of the Danish officers was directed to return
+with Harry to the ship to notify the captain of the surrender of the
+fort.
+
+The astonishment of Captain Ball at seeing the course of his boat
+suddenly altered, a white flag hoisted, and the gig proceeding direct
+to the fort, had been extreme, and he could only suppose that Harry
+had received some orders direct from the admiral and that a general
+cessation of hostilities was ordered. His surprise became astonishment
+when he saw the Danish flag disappear and the white flag hoisted in
+its place; and a shout of relief and exultation echoed from stem to
+stern of the _Cæsar_, for all had felt that the conflict was hopeless
+and that in a few minutes the _Cæsar_ must strike her flag. All sorts
+of conjectures were rife as to the sudden and unexpected surrender of
+the fort, and expectation was at its highest when the gig was seen
+rowing out again with a Danish officer by the side of the midshipman.
+
+On reaching the ship's side Harry ascended the ladder with the Danish
+officer, and advancing to Captain Ball said:
+
+"This officer, sir, has, in compliance with the summons which I took
+to the commander of the fort in your name, come off to surrender."
+
+The Danish officer advanced and handed his sword to the captain,
+saying:
+
+"In the name of the commander of the fort I surrender."
+
+The captain handed him back his sword, and ordering Harry to follow
+him at once entered his cabin. His astonishment was unbounded when the
+latter informed him what he had done, with many apologies for having
+taken the matter into his own hands.
+
+"I saw," he said, "that the _Cæsar_ was being knocked to pieces, and
+the coxswain told me that it was impossible she could much longer
+resist. I therefore thought that I could do no harm by calling upon
+the governor to surrender, and that it was possible that I might
+succeed, as you see that I have."
+
+"You certainly have saved the _Cæsar_," Captain Ball said warmly, "and
+we are all indeed indebted to you. It was a piece of astounding
+impudence indeed for a midshipman to convey a message with which his
+captain had not charged him; but success in the present case a
+thousand times condones the offense. You have indeed done well, young
+sir, and I and the ship's company are vastly indebted to you. I will
+report the matter to the admiral."
+
+A hundred men speedily took their places in the boats. Lieutenant
+Francis was sent ashore to take possession, and a few minutes later
+the British flag was flying upon the fort.
+
+Ordering Harry to accompany him, Captain Ball at once took his place
+in his gig and rowed to the flagship. The battle was still raging, and
+to the practiced eye there was no doubt that the English fleet was
+suffering very severely. Captain Ball mounted the quarter-deck, and
+saluting the admiral reported that the fort with which he was engaged
+had struck, but that the _Cæsar_ being aground was unable to render
+any assistance to the general attack.
+
+"A good many of us are aground, Ball," Admiral Nelson said, "but I
+congratulate you on having caused the fort to haul down its colors.
+Several of the Danish men-of-war have struck, but we cannot take
+possession, and fresh boat-loads of men came off from shore, and their
+fire has reopened. Our position is an unpleasant one. Sir Hyde Parker
+has signaled to me to draw off, but so far I have paid no attention. I
+fear that we shall have to haul off and leave some four or five ships
+to the enemy."
+
+"The fact is," Captain Ball said, "it wasn't I who made the fort haul
+down its flag, but this midshipman of mine."
+
+"Ha!" said the admiral, glancing at Harry, who, at Captain Ball's
+order, had left the boat and was standing a short distance off. "How
+on earth did he do that?"
+
+"When you told him, sir, that you could give us no aid he took upon
+himself, instead of returning to the ship, to row straight to the
+fort with one of your tablecloths fastened to the boat-hook, and
+summoned the commander in my name to surrender at once so as to save
+all further effusion of life, seeing that more ships were bearing down
+and that he had done all that a brave man could, and should now think
+of the lives of his troops."
+
+"An impudent little rascal!" the admiral exclaimed. "Midshipmen were
+impudent enough in my days, but this boy beats everything. However,
+his idea was an excellent one, and, by Jupiter! I will adopt it
+myself. A man should never be above learning, and we are in such a
+sore strait that one catches at a straw."
+
+So saying, the admiral, calling to his own captain, entered his cabin,
+and at once indited a letter to the King of Denmark begging him to
+surrender in order to save the blood of his subjects, expressing
+admiration at the way in which they had fought, and saying that they
+had done all that was possible to save honor, and might now surrender
+with a full consciousness of having done their duty. This missive was
+at once dispatched to shore, and the admiral awaited with anxiety its
+result.
+
+A half-hour elapsed, the firing continuing with unabated fury.
+
+"By Jove, Ball," the admiral suddenly exclaimed, "there's the white
+flag!" and a tremendous cheer broke along the whole of the British
+ships as the flag of truce waved over the principal fort of
+Copenhagen. Instantly the fire on both sides ceased. Boats passed
+between the shore and the flagship with the proposals for surrender
+and conditions. Nelson insisted that the Danish fleet should be
+surrendered, in so firm and decisive a tone as to convince the king
+that he had it in his power completely to destroy the town, and had
+only so far desisted from motives of humanity. At length, to the
+intense relief of the admiral and his principal officers, who knew how
+sore the strait was, and to the delight of the sailors, the
+negotiations were completed, and the victory of Copenhagen won.
+
+"Where's that boy?" the admiral asked.
+
+"That boy" was unfortunately no longer on the quarter-deck. One of the
+last shots fired from the Danish fleet had struck him above the knee,
+carrying away his leg. He had at once been carried down to the
+cockpit, and was attended to by the surgeons of the flagship. In the
+excitement of an action men take but little heed of what is happening
+around them, and the fall of the young midshipman was unnoticed by his
+captain. Now, however, that the battle was over, Captain Ball looked
+round for his midshipman, and was filled with sorrow upon hearing what
+had happened. He hurried below to the wounded boy, whose leg had
+already been amputated, above the point at which the ball had severed
+it, by the surgeon.
+
+"The white flag has been hoisted, my lad," he said, "and Copenhagen
+has been captured, and to you more than to anyone is this great
+victory due. I am sorry, indeed, that you should have been shot."
+
+Harry smiled faintly.
+
+"It is the fortune of war, sir. My career in the navy has not been a
+long one. It is but a fortnight since I got my commission, and now I
+am leaving it altogether."
+
+"Leaving the navy, perhaps," the captain said cheerfully, "but not
+leaving life, I hope. I trust there's a long one before you; but
+Admiral Nelson will, I am sure, be as grieved as I am that the career
+of a young officer, who promised to rise to the highest honors of his
+profession and be a credit and glory to his country, has been cut
+short."
+
+A short time later the admiral himself came down and shook hands with
+the boy, and thanked him for his services, and cheered him up by
+telling him that he would take care that his presence of mind and
+courage should be known.
+
+For some days Harry lay between life and death, but by the time that
+the ship sailed into Portsmouth harbor the doctors had considerable
+hope that he would pull round. He was carried at once to the Naval
+Hospital, and a few hours later Peter Langley was by his bedside. His
+captain frequently came to see him, and upon one occasion came while
+his foster-father was sitting by his bedside.
+
+"Ah, Peter, is it you?" he said. "Your son told me that you had served
+his majesty; but I didn't recognize the name as that of my old
+boatswain on board the _Cleopatra_."
+
+"I am glad to see your honor," Peter said; "but I wish it had been on
+any other occasion. However, I think that the lad will not slip his
+wind this time; but he's fretting that his career on blue water is at
+an end."
+
+"It is sad that it should be so," Captain Ball said; "but there are
+many men who may live to a good age and will have done less for their
+country than this lad in the short time he was at sea. First, he
+prevented the dispatch, which would have warned the enemy of what was
+coming, from reaching them; and, in the second place, his sharpness
+and readiness saved no small portion of Admiral Nelson's fleet, and
+converted what threatened to be a defeat into a victory. You must be
+proud of your son, old salt."
+
+"Has not the boy told you, sir, that he's not my son?" the boatswain
+said.
+
+"No, indeed!" Captain Ball exclaimed, surprised; "on the contrary, he
+spoke of you as his father."
+
+In a few words Peter Langley related the circumstances of the finding
+of Harry when a baby. Captain Ball was silent for a while, and then
+said, "Do you know, Peter, that I have been greatly struck by the
+resemblance of that lad to an old friend and school-fellow of mine, a
+Mr. Harper? They are as like as two peas--that is, he is exactly what
+my friend was at his age. My friend never was married; but I remember
+hearing a good many years ago--I should say some fifteen years ago,
+which would be about in accordance with this lad's age--that he had
+lost a sister at sea. The ship she was in was supposed to have
+foundered, and was never heard of again. She was the wife of the
+captain, and was taking her first voyage with him. Of course it may be
+a mere coincidence; still the likeness is so strong that it would be
+worth while making some inquiries. Have you anything by which the
+child can be identified?"
+
+"There are some trinkets, sir, of Indian workmanship for the most
+part, and a locket. I will bring them over to your honor to-morrow if
+you will let me."
+
+"Do so," Captain Ball said; "I am going up to London to-morrow, and
+shall see my friend. Don't speak to the boy about it, for it's a
+thousand to one against its being more than a coincidence. Still I
+hope sincerely for his sake that it may be so."
+
+The next evening Captain Ball went up by coach to London, and the
+following day called upon his friend, who was a rich retired
+East-Indian director. He told the story as Peter had told it to him.
+
+"The dates answer," he said; "and, curiously, although the ship was
+lost in the West Indies, it's likely enough that the ornaments of my
+poor sister would have been Indian, as I was in the habit of often
+sending her home things from Calcutta."
+
+"I have them with me," Captain Ball said, and produced the little
+packet which Peter had given him.
+
+The old gentleman glanced at the ornaments, and then, taking the
+locket, pressed the spring. He gave a cry as he saw the portrait
+within it, and exclaimed, "Yes, that's the likeness of my sister as
+she was when I last saw her! What an extraordinary discovery! Where is
+the lad of whom you have been speaking? for surely he is my nephew,
+the son of my sister Mary and Jack Peters."
+
+Captain Ball then related the story of Harry's doings from the time he
+had known him, and the old gentleman was greatly moved at the tale of
+bravery. The very next day he went down to Portsmouth with Captain
+Ball, and Harry, to his astonishment, found himself claimed as nephew
+by the friend of his captain.
+
+When Harry was well enough to be moved he went up to London with his
+uncle, and a fortnight later received an official letter directing him
+to attend at the Board of Admiralty.
+
+Donning his midshipman uniform he proceeded thither in his uncle's
+carriage, and walked with crutches--for his wound was not as yet
+sufficiently healed to allow him to wear an artificial leg--to the
+board-room. Here were assembled the first lord and his colleagues.
+Admiral Nelson was also present, and at once greeted him kindly.
+
+A seat was placed for him, and the first lord then addressed him. "Mr.
+Peters, Admiral Nelson has brought to our notice the clever stratagem
+by which, on your own initiation and without instruction, you obtained
+the surrender of the Danish fort, and saved the _Cæsar_ at a time when
+she was aground and altogether overmatched. Admiral Nelson has also
+been good enough to say that it was the success which attended your
+action which suggested to him the course that he took which brought
+the battle to a happy termination. Thus we cannot but feel that the
+victory which has been won is in no small degree due to you. Moreover,
+we are mindful that it was your bravery and quickness which prevented
+the news of the intended sailing of the fleet from reaching the
+Continent, in which case the attack could not have been carried out.
+Under such extraordinary and exceptional circumstances we feel that an
+extraordinary and exceptional acknowledgment is due to you. We all
+feel very deep regret that the loss of your leg will render you unfit
+for active service at sea, and has deprived his majesty of the loss of
+so meritorious and most promising a young officer. We are about,
+therefore, to take a course altogether without precedent. You will be
+continued on the full-pay list all your life, you will at once be
+promoted to the rank of lieutenant, three years hence to that of
+commander, and again in another three years to the rank of post
+captain. The board are glad to hear from Captain Ball that you are in
+good hands, and wish you every good fortune in life."
+
+Harry was so overcome with pleasure that he could only stammer a word
+or two of thanks, and the first lord, his colleagues, and Admiral
+Nelson having warmly shaken hands with him, he was taken back to the
+carriage, still in a state of bewilderment at the honor which had been
+bestowed upon him.
+
+There is little more to tell. Having no other relations his uncle
+adopted him as his heir, and the only further connection that Harry
+had with the sea was that when he was twenty-one he possessed the
+fastest and best-equipped yacht which sailed out of an English port.
+Later on he sat in Parliament, married, and to the end of his life
+declared that, after all, the luckiest point in his career was the
+cutting off of his leg by the last shot fired by the Danish batteries,
+for that, had this not happened, he should never have known who he
+was, would never have met the wife whom he dearly loved, and would
+have passed his life as a miserable bachelor. Peter Langley, when not
+at sea with Harry in his yacht, lived in a snug cottage at Southsea,
+and had never reason to the end of his life to regret the time when he
+sighted the floating box from the tops of the _Alert_.
+
+
+
+
+SURLY JOE.
+
+
+"You wonder why I am called Surly Joe, sir? No, as you say, I hope I
+don't deserve the title now; but I did once, and a name like that
+sticks to a man for life. Well, sir, the fish are not biting at
+present, and I don't mind if I tell you how I got it."
+
+The speaker was a boatman, a man some fifty years old, broad and
+weather-beaten; he had but one arm. I had been spending a month's
+well-earned holiday at Scarborough, and had been making the most of
+it, sailing or fishing every day. Upon my first arrival I had gone out
+with the one-armed boatman, and as he was a cheery companion, and his
+boat, the _Grateful Mary_, was the best and fastest on the strand, I
+had stuck to him throughout. The boatmen at our watering-places soon
+learn when a visitor fixes upon a particular boat, and cease to
+importune him with offers of a sail; consequently it became an
+understood thing after a day or two that I was private property, and
+as soon as I was seen making my way across the wet, soppy sand, which
+is the one drawback to the pleasure of Scarborough, a shout would at
+once be raised for Surly Joe. The name seemed a singularly
+inappropriate one; but it was not until the very day before I was
+returning to town that I made any remark on the subject. By this time
+we had become great allies; for what with a bathe in the morning
+early, a sail before lunch, and a fishing expedition afterwards, I had
+almost lived on board the _Grateful Mary_. The day had been too clear
+and bright for fishing; the curly-headed, barefooted boy who assisted
+Joe had grown tired of watching us catch nothing, and had fallen
+asleep in the bow of the boat; and the motion, as the boat rose and
+fell gently on the swell, was so eminently provocative of sleep that I
+had nodded once or twice as I sat with my eyes fixed on my line. Then
+the happy idea had occurred to me to remark that I wondered why my
+companion was called by a nickname which seemed so singularly
+inappropriate. Joe's offer to tell me how he obtained it woke me at
+once. I refilled my pipe,--an invariable custom, I observe, with
+smokers when they are sitting down to listen to a story,--passed my
+pouch to Joe, who followed my example; and when we had "lighted up"
+Joe began:
+
+"Well, sir, it's about twelve years ago. I was a strong, active chap
+then--not that I aint strong now, for I can shove a boat over the
+sandbar with any man on the shore--but I aint as active as I were. I
+warn't called Surly Joe then, and I had my two arms like other men. My
+nickname then was Curly; 'cause, you see, my hair won't lay straight
+on my head, not when it gets as wet as seaweed. I owned my own boat,
+and the boys that worked with me warn't strangers, like Dick there,
+but they were my own flesh and blood. I was mighty proud of the two
+boys: fine straight tough-built lads was they, and as good-plucked uns
+as any on the shore. I had lost their mother ten years, maybe, before
+that, and I never thought of giving them another. One of 'em was about
+twelve, just the size of Dick there; the other was a year older. Full
+of tricks and mischief they was, but good boys, sir, and could handle
+the boat nigh as well as I could. There was one thing they couldn't
+do, sir--they couldn't swim. I used to tell 'em they ought to learn;
+but there, you see, I can't swim myself, and out of all the men and
+boys on this shore I don't suppose one in twenty on 'em can swim. Rum,
+aint it, sir? All their lives in the water or on the water, seeing all
+these visitors as comes here either swimming or learning to swim, and
+yet they won't try. They talks about instinks; I don't believe in
+instinks, else everybody who's got to pass his life on the water would
+learn to swim, instead of being just the boys as never does learn.
+That year, sir, I was doing well. There was a gentleman and his wife
+and darter used to use my boat regular; morning and afternoon they'd
+go out for a sail whenever it warn't too rough for the boat to put
+out. I don't think the old gentleman and lady cared so much for it;
+but they was just wrapped up in the girl, who was a pale, quiet sort
+o' girl, who had come down to the sea for her health. She was
+wonderful fond of the sea, and a deal o' good it did her; she warn't
+like the same creature after she had been here two months.
+
+"It was a roughish sort of afternoon, with squalls from the east, but
+not too rough to go out: they was to go out at four o'clock, and they
+came down punctual; but the gentleman says, when he gets down:
+
+"'We have just got a telegram, Joe, to say as a friend is coming down
+by the five-o'clock train, and we must be at the station to meet her,
+she being an invalid; but I don't want Mary to lose her sail, so will
+trust her with you.'
+
+"'You'll take great care of her, Joe, and bring her back safe,' the
+mother says, half laughing like; but I could see she were a little
+anxious about lettin' her go alone, which had never happened before.
+
+"'I'll take care of her, ma'am,' I says; 'you may take your oath I'll
+bring her back if I comes back myself.'
+
+"'Good-by, mamma,' the girl says as she steps on the plank; 'don't you
+fidget: you know you can trust Joe; and I'll be back at half-past six
+to dinner.'
+
+"Well, sir, as we pushed off I felt somehow responsible like, and
+although I'd told the boys before that one reef would be enough, I
+made 'em put in another before I hoisted the sail. There warn't many
+boats out, for there was more sea on than most visitors care to face;
+but once fairly outside we went along through it splendid. When we got
+within a mile of Fley, I asks her if we should turn, or go on for a
+bit farther.
+
+"'We shall go back as quick as we've come, shan't we, Joe?'
+
+"'Just about the same, miss; the wind's straight on the shore.'
+
+"'We haven't been out twenty minutes,' she says, looking at her watch;
+'I'd rather go a bit farther.'
+
+"Well, sir, we ran till we were off the brig. The wind was freshening,
+and the gusts coming down strong; it was backing round rather to the
+north too, and the sea was getting up.
+
+"'I a'most think, miss, we'd better run into Filey,' I says; 'and you
+could go across by the coach.'
+
+"'But there's no danger, is there, Joe?'
+
+"'No, miss, there aint no danger; but we shall get a ducking before we
+get back; there's rain in that squall to windward.'
+
+"'Oh, I don't care a bit for rain, Joe; and the coach won't get in
+till half-past seven, and mamma would be in a dreadful fright. Oh, I'd
+so much rather go on!'
+
+"I did not say no more, but I put her about, and in another few
+minutes the squall was down upon us. The rain came against us as if it
+wanted to knock holes in the boat, and the wind just howled again. A
+sharper squall I don't know as ever I was put in. It was so black you
+couldn't have seen two boats' length. I eased off the sheet, and put
+the helm up; but something went wrong, and--I don't know rightly how
+it was, sir. I've thought it over hundreds and hundreds of times, and
+I can't reason it out in any sort of form. But the 'sponsibility of
+that young gal weighed on me, I expect, and I must somehow ha' lost my
+head--I don't know, I can't account for it; but there it was, and in
+less time than it takes me to tell you we were all in the water.
+Whatever I'd ha' been before, I was cool enough now. I threw one arm
+round the gal, as I felt her going, and with the other I caught hold
+of the side of the boat. We was under water for a moment, and then I
+made shift to get hold of the rudder as she floated bottom upwards.
+The boys had stuck to her too, but they couldn't get hold of the keel;
+for you know how deep them boats are forward, drawing nigh a foot of
+water there more than they does astern. However, after a bit, they
+managed to get down to'rds the stern, and get a hand on the keel about
+halfway along. They couldn't come no nigher, because, as you know, the
+keel of them boats only runs halfway along. 'Hould on, lads!' I
+shouted; 'hould on for your lives! They'll have seen us from the
+cliff, and 'll have a lugger out here for us in no time.'
+
+"I said so to cheer them up; but I knew in my heart that a lugger, to
+get out with that wind on, would have to run right into t'other side
+o' the bay before she could get room enough to weather the brig. The
+girl hadn't spoken a word since the squall struck us, except that she
+gave a little short cry as the boat went over; and when we came up she
+got her hands on the rudder, and held on there as well as she could
+with my help. The squall did not last five minutes; and when it
+cleared off I could look round and judge of our chances. They weren't
+good. There was a party of people on the cliff, and another on the
+brig, who were making their way out as far as they could on the brig,
+for it were about half-tide. They must have seen us go over as we went
+into the squall, for as we lifted I could see over the brig, and there
+was a man galloping on horseback along the sands to'rds Filey as hard
+as he could go. We were, maybe, a quarter of a mile off the brig, and
+I saw that we should drift down on it before a boat could beat out of
+the bay and get round to us. The sea was breaking on it, as it always
+does break if there's ever so little wind from the east, and the spray
+was flying up fifty feet in places where the waves hit the face of the
+rock. There aint a worse place on all the coast than this, running as
+it do nigh a mile out from the head, and bare at low water. The waves
+broke over the boat heavy, and I had as much as I could do to hold on
+by one hand to the rudder, which swung backwards and forwards with
+every wave. As to the boys, I knew they couldn't hold on if they
+couldn't get onto the bottom of the boat; so I shouted to 'em to try
+to climb up. But they couldn't do it, sir; they'd tried already, over
+and over again. It would ha' been easy enough in calm water; but with
+the boat rolling and such waves going over her, and knocking them back
+again when they'd half got up, it was too much for 'em. If I'd ha'
+been free I could have got 'em up by working round to the side
+opposite 'em, and given them a hand to haul them up; but as it was,
+with only one hand free, it took me all my time to hold on where I
+was. The girl saw it too, for she turned her face round to me, and
+spoke for the first time.
+
+"'Let me go, please,' says she, 'and help your boys.'
+
+"'I can't do it,' said I. 'I've got to hold you till we're both
+drowned together.'
+
+"I spoke short and hard, sir; for, if you'll believe me, I was
+actually beginning to hate that gal. There was my own two boys
+a-struggling for their lives, and I couldn't lend a hand to help 'em,
+because I was hampered by that white-faced thing. She saw it in my
+face, for she gave a sort of little cry, and said:
+
+"'Oh, do--do let me go!'
+
+"I didn't answer a word, but held on all the harder. Presently
+Bill--he was my youngest boy--sang out:
+
+"'Father, can't you get round and lend us a hand to get up? I can't
+hold on much longer.'
+
+"'I can't help you, Bill,' says I. 'I've given my promise to take this
+young woman back, and I must keep my word. Her life's more precious to
+her father than yours is to me, no doubt, and she's got to be saved.'
+
+"It was cruel of me, sir, and altogether unjust, and I knew it was
+when I said it, but I couldn't help it. I felt as if I had a devil in
+me. I was just mad with sorrow and hopelessness, and yet each word
+seemed to come as cold and hard from me as if it was frozen. For a
+moment she didn't move, and then, all of a sudden like, she gave a
+twist out of my arms and went straight down. I grabbed at her, and
+just got hold of her cloak and pulled her up again. She never moved
+after that, but just lay quiet on my arm as if she was dead. Her head
+was back, half in, half out of the water; and it was only by the tears
+that run down sometimes through her eyelids, and by a little sob in
+her breast, that I knew that she was sensible.
+
+"Presently Bill says, 'Good-by, father. God bless you!' and then he
+let go his hold and went down. Five minutes afterwards, maybe, though
+it seemed a week to me, Jack did the same.
+
+"There we was--the girl and I--alone.
+
+"I think now, sir, looking back upon it, as I was mad then. I felt
+somehow as that the gal had drowned my two boys; and the devil kept
+whispering to me to beat her white face in, and then to go with her to
+the bottom. I should ha' done it too, but my promise kept me back. I
+had sworn she should get safe to shore if I could, and it seemed to me
+that included the promise that I would do my best for us both to get
+there. I was getting weak now, and sometimes I seemed to wander, and
+my thoughts got mixed up, and I talked to the boys as if they could
+hear me. Once or twice my hold had slipped, and I had hard work enough
+to get hold again. I was sensible enough to know as it couldn't last
+much longer, and, talking as in my sleep, I had told the boys I would
+be with 'em in a minute or two, when a sound of shouting quite close
+roused me up sudden.
+
+"Then I saw we had drifted close to the brig. Some men had climbed
+along, taking hold hand-in-hand when they passed across places where
+the sea was already breaking over, and bringing with them the rope
+which, as I afterwards heard, the man on horseback had brought back
+from Filey. It was a brave deed on their part, sir, for the tide was
+rising fast. When they saw I lifted my head and could hear them they
+shouted that they would throw me the rope, and that I must leave go of
+the boat, which would have smashed us to pieces, as I knew, if she had
+struck the rocks with us. Where they were standing the rock was full
+six feet above the sea; but a little farther it shelved down, and each
+wave ran three feet deep across the brig. They asked me could I swim;
+and when I shook my head, for I was too far gone to speak now, one of
+'em jumped in with the end of the rope. He twisted it round the two of
+us, and shouted to his friends to pull. It was time, for we weren't
+much above a boat's length from the brig. Three of the chaps as had
+the rope run down to the low part of the rock and pulled together,
+while another two kept hold of the end of the rope and kept on the
+rock, so as to prevent us all being washed across the brig together. I
+don't remember much more about it. I let go the boat, sank down at
+once, as if the girl and I had been lead, felt a tug of the rope, and
+then, just as the water seemed choking me, a great smash, and I
+remember nothing else. When I came to my right senses again I was in a
+bed at Filey. I had had a bad knock on the head, and my right arm,
+which had been round the girl, was just splintered. They took it off
+that night. The first thing as they told me when I came round was that
+the gal was safe. I don't know whether I was glad or sorry to hear it.
+I was glad, because I had kept my promise and brought her back alive.
+I was sorry, because I hated her like pison. Why should she have been
+saved when my two boys was drowned? She was well-plucked, was that
+gal, for she had never quite lost her senses; and the moment she had
+got warm in bed with hot blankets, and suchlike she wanted to get dry
+clothes and to go straight on to Scarborough in a carriage. However,
+the doctor would not hear of it, and she wrote a little letter saying
+as she was all right; and a man galloped off with it on horseback, and
+got there just as they had got a carriage to the door to drive over to
+Filey to ask if there was any news there about the boat. They came
+over and slept there, and she went back with them next day. I heard
+all this afterwards, for I was off my head, what with the blow I had
+got and one thing and another, before I had been there an hour. And I
+raved and cussed at the girl, they tell me, so that they wouldn't let
+her father in to see me.
+
+"It was nigh a fortnight before I came to myself, to find my arm gone,
+and then I was another month before I was out of bed. They came over
+to Filey when I was sensible, and I hear they had got the best doctor
+over from Scarborough to see me, and paid everything for me till I was
+well, but I wouldn't see them when they came. I was quite as bitter
+against her as I had been when I was in the sea drowning; and I was so
+fierce when they talked of coming in that the doctor told them it
+would make me bad again if they came. So they went up to London, and
+when I could get about they sent me a letter, the gal herself and her
+father and mother, thanking me, I suppose; but I don't know, for I
+just tore 'em into pieces without reading them. Then a lawyer of the
+town here came to me and said he'd 'struction to buy me a new boat,
+and to buy a 'nuity for me. I told him his 'nuity couldn't bring my
+boys back again, and that I warn't going to take blood-money; and as
+to the boat, I'd knock a hole in her and sink her if she came. A year
+after that lawyer came to me again, and said he'd more 'structions;
+and I told him though I'd only one arm left I was man enough still to
+knock his head off his shoulders, and that I'd do it if he came to me
+with his 'structions or anything else.
+
+"By this time I'd settled down to work on the shore, and had got the
+name of Surly Joe. Rightly enough, too. I had one of them planks with
+wheels that people use to get in and out of the boats; and as the
+boatmen on the shore was all good to me, being sorry for my loss, and
+so telling my story to people as went out with them, I got enough to
+live on comfortable, only there was nothing comfortable about me. I
+wouldn't speak a word, good or bad, to a soul for days together,
+unless it was to swear at anyone as tried to talk to me. I hated
+everyone, and myself wuss nor all. I was always cussing the rocks that
+didn't kill me, and wondering how many years I'd got to go on at this
+work before my turn came. Fortunately I'd never cared for drink; but
+sometimes I'd find my thoughts too hard for me, and I'd go and drink
+glass after glass till I tumbled under the table.
+
+"At first my old mates tried to get me round, and made offers to me to
+take a share in their boats, or to make one in a fishing voyage; but I
+would not hear them, and in time they dropped off one by one, and left
+me to myself, and for six years there wasn't a surlier,
+wuss-conditioned, lonelier chap, not in all England, than I was. Well,
+sir, one day--it was just at the beginning of the season, but was too
+rough a day for sailing--I was a-sitting down on the steps of a
+machine doing nothing, just wondering and wondering why things was as
+they was, when two little gals cum up. One was, maybe, five, and the
+other a year younger. I didn't notice as they'd just cum away from the
+side of a lady and gentleman. I never did notice nothing that didn't
+just concern me; but I did see that they had a nurse not far off. The
+biggest girl had great big eyes, dark and soft, and she looked up into
+my face, and held out a broken wooden spade and a bit of string, and
+says she, 'Sailor-man, please mend our spade.' I was struck all of a
+heap like; for though I had been mighty fond of little children in the
+old days, and was still always careful of lifting them into boats, my
+name and my black looks had been enough, and none of them had spoken
+to me for years. I felt quite strange like when that child spoke out
+to me, a'most like what I've read Robinson Crusoe, he as was wrecked
+on the island, felt when he saw the mark of a foot.
+
+"I goes to hold out my hand, and then I draws it back, and says,
+gruff, 'Don't you see I aint got but one hand? Go to your nurse.'
+
+"I expected to see her run right off; but she didn't, but stood as
+quiet as may be, with her eyes looking up into my face.
+
+"'Nurse can't mend spade; break again when Nina digs. Nina will hold
+spade together, sailor-man tie it up strong.'
+
+"I didn't answer at once; but I saw her lip quiver, and it was plain
+she had been crying just before; so I put my hand into my pocket and
+brings out a bit of string, for the stuff she'd got in her hand was
+of no account; and I says, in a strange sort of voice, as I hardly
+knew as my own, 'All right, missy, I'll tie it.'
+
+"So she held the broken pieces together, and I ties 'em up with the
+aid of my hand and my teeth, and makes a strong, ship-shape job of it.
+I did it sitting on the bottom step, with a child standing on each
+side watching me. When I had done it the eldest took it, and felt it.
+
+"'That is nice and strong,' she said; 'thank you. Annie, say thank
+you.'
+
+"'T'ank you,' she said; and, with a little pat on my arm as a good-by,
+the little ones trotted away to a nurse sitting some little distance
+off.
+
+"It may seem a little thing to you, sir, just a half-minute's talk to
+a child; but it warn't a little thing to me. It seemed regularly to
+upset me like; and I sat there thinking it over and wondering what was
+come over me, till an hour afterwards they went past me with their
+nurse; and the little things ran up to me and said, 'The spade's quite
+good now--good-by, sailor-man!' and went on again. So I shook it off
+and went to my work; for as the tide rose the wind dropped, and a few
+boats went out; and thinking what a fool I was, was gruffer and
+surlier than ever.
+
+"Next morning I was lending a mate a hand painting a boat, when I saw
+the two children coming along the sand again, and I wondered to
+myself whether they would know me again, or think any more of me, and
+though I wanted them to do so I turned my back to the way they was
+coming, and went on with my painting. Somehow I felt wonderful glad
+when I heard their little feet come, pattering along the sand, and
+they sang out:
+
+"'Good-morning, sailor-man!'
+
+"'Good-morning!' says I, short-like, as if I didn't want no talk; and
+I goes on with my work without turning round.
+
+"Just then one of the men at the boats hails me.
+
+"'Joe, there's a party coming down.'
+
+"'I'm busy,' shouts I back; 'shove the plank out yourself.'
+
+"The children stopped quiet by me for a minute or two, watching me at
+work, and then the eldest says:
+
+"'May we get inside the boat, Joe? we've never been inside a boat, and
+we do want to so much.'
+
+"'My hand is all covered with paint,' says I, making a fight with
+myself against giving in.
+
+"Then the little one said:
+
+"'Oo stoop down, Joe; sissy and me take hold round oor neck; then oo
+stand up and we det in.'
+
+"Well, sir, the touch of their little arms and those soft little faces
+against my cheeks as they got in fairly knocked me over, and it was
+some time before I could see what I was doing.
+
+"Once in, they never stopped talking. They asked about everything, and
+I had to answer them; and as I got accustomed to it the words came
+freer, till I was talking away with them as if I had known 'em all my
+life. Once I asked them didn't their papa and mamma ever take 'em out
+for a sail, and they shook their heads and said mammy hated the sea,
+and said it was a cruel sea; by which I judged as she must have lost
+someone dear to her by it.
+
+"Well, sir, I must cut a long story short. Those children used to come
+every day down to talk with me, and I got to look for it regular; and
+if it was a wet day and they couldn't come I'd be regular put out by
+it; and I got to getting apples and cakes in my pockets for them.
+After a fortnight I took to carrying them across the wet sands and
+putting them on the stand as I wheeled it out and back with people to
+the boats. I didn't do it till they'd asked their mother, and brought
+back the message that she knew she could trust them with me.
+
+"All this time it never once struck me as strange that their nurse
+should sit with a baby-brother of theirs at a distance, and let them
+play with me by the hour together, without calling them away, for I
+wondered so much at myself, and to find myself telling stories to 'em
+just as I'd do with children who came out sailing with me in the old
+time, and in knowing as I was so wrapped up in 'em that I couldn't
+wonder at anything else. Natural like, I changed a good deal in other
+respects, and I got to give a good-morning to mates as I had scarce
+spoken with for years; and the moment the children turned down onto
+the sands there'd be sure to be a shout of 'There's your little
+ladies, Joe.'
+
+"I don't know why my mates should ha' been pleased to see me coming
+round, for I had made myself onpleasant enough on the shore; but
+they'd made 'lowances for me, and they met me as kindly as if I'd cum
+back from a vyage. They did it just quiet like, and would just say,
+natural, 'Lend us a hand here, Joe, boy,' or 'Give us a shoulder over
+the bank, Joe,' and ask me what I thought o' the weather. It was a
+hard day for me when, after staying nigh two months, the little ladies
+came to say good-by. It warn't as bad as might have been, though, for
+they were going to stay with some friends near York, and were to come
+back again in a fortnight before they went back to London. But they
+kissed me, and cried, and gave me a pipe and a lot o' 'bacca, and I
+was to think of them whenever I smoked it, and they would be sure to
+think of me, for they loved me very much.
+
+"That very afternoon, sir, as I was standing by my stage, Jim
+Saunders--he'd been mate with me before I owned a boat of my own--says
+out loud:
+
+"'Lor', here's my party a-coming down, and I've jammed my hand so as I
+can't hoist a sail. Who'll come out and lend me a hand?'
+
+"Well, everyone says they were busy, and couldn't come; but I believe
+now as the whole thing was a got-up plan to get me afloat again; and
+then Jim turns to me as if a sudden idea had struck him.
+
+"'Come, Joe, lend us a hand for the sake o' old times; come along, old
+chap.'
+
+"I was taken aback like, and could only say something about my stage;
+but half a dozen chaps volunteers to look after my stage, and afore I
+scarce knew what I was after I was bundled aboard the boat; and as the
+party got in I'm blest if I don't think as every chap on the shore
+runs in to help shove her off, and a score of hands was held out just
+to give me a shake as we started.
+
+"I don't think I was much good on that vyage, for I went and sat up in
+the bow, with my back to the others, and my eyes fixed far ahead.
+
+"I needn't tell you, sir, when I'd once broken the ice I went regular
+to the sea again, and handed my stage over to a poor fellow who had
+lost his craft and a leg the winter before.
+
+"One day when I came in from a sail I saw two little figures upon the
+sands, and it needed no word from anyone to tell me my little ladies
+had come back. They jumped and clapped their hands when they saw me,
+and would have run across the water to meet me hadn't I shouted to
+them to wait just a minute till I should be with them.
+
+"'We've been waiting a long time, Joe. Where have you been?'
+
+"'I've been out sailing, missy.'
+
+"'Joe, don't you know it's wicked to tell stories? You told us you
+should never go on sea any more.'
+
+"'No more I didn't think I should, missy; and I don't suppose I ever
+should if I hadn't met you, though you won't understand that. However,
+I've give up the stage, and have taken to the sea again.'
+
+"'I'm glad of that, Joe,' the eldest said, 'and mamma will be glad
+too.'
+
+"'Why should mamma be glad, little one?' I asked.
+
+"'Mamma will be glad,' she said positively. 'I know she will be glad
+when I tells her.'
+
+"We'd sat down by this time, and I began to talk to them about their
+mamma. Mamma very good, very kind, very pretty, they both agreed; and
+then they went on telling me about their home in London, and their
+carriage and amusements. Presently they stopped, and I could see the
+eldest wanted to say something particular, for she puckered up her
+forehead as she always did when she was very serious; and then she
+said, with her hands folded before her, almost as if she was saying a
+lesson:
+
+"'Mamma very happy woman. She's got two little girls and baby-brother,
+and papa love her so much; but there's one thing keeps her from being
+quite happy.'
+
+"'Is there, missy?' I asked. 'She ought to be happy with all these
+things. What is it?'
+
+"'Mamma once had someone do a great thing for her. If it hadn't been
+for him Nina and sissy and little baby-brother could never have been
+born, and papa would never have had dear mamma to love; but it cost
+the man who did it a great deal--all he cared for; and now he won't
+let mamma and papa and us love him and help him; and it makes mamma
+unhappy when she thinks of it.'
+
+"Here she had evidently finished what she had heard her mamma say, for
+her forehead got smooth again, and she began to fill my pockets with
+sand.
+
+"'It don't sound likely, missy, that doesn't,' I says. 'It don't stand
+to reason nohow. You can't have understood what mamma said.'
+
+"'Mamma said it over and over again, lots of time,' Nina said. 'Nina
+quite sure she said right.'
+
+"We didn't say no more about it then, though after the children had
+gone I wondered to myself how a chap could go on so foolish as that.
+Well, sir, three days after come round from Whitby this very boat, the
+_Grateful Mary_. She was sent care of Joe Denton; and as that was me,
+I had her hauled up on the beach till I should hear whose she was.
+Several visitors that had been out with me had said, promiscuous like,
+that they should like to have a boat of their own, and I supposed they
+had bought her at Whitby and sent her down, though why they should
+have sent her to my care I couldn't quite see.
+
+"Two days afterwards them children come down, and says:
+
+"'We want you to go through the town to the other cliff with us, Joe.'
+
+"'I can't,' says I. 'I'm all right talking to you here, missies; but I
+shouldn't be a credit to you in the town, and your pa wouldn't be
+best pleased if he was to see you walking about in the streets with a
+boatman.'
+
+"'Papa said we might ask you, Joe.'
+
+"I shook my head, and the little ladies ran off to their nurse, who
+come back with them and says:
+
+"'Master told me to say he should be pertickler glad if you would go
+with the young ladies.'
+
+"'Oh, very well,' I says; 'if their pa don't object, and they wishes
+it, I'd go with 'em anywheres. You wait here a quarter of an hour,
+while I goes and cleans myself, and I'll go with you.'
+
+"When I comes back the youngest takes my hand, and the oldest holds by
+my jacket, and we goes up into High Street, and across to the other
+cliff. We goes along till we comes to a pretty little cottage looking
+over the sea. There was a garden in front, new planted with flowers.
+
+"'Are you sure you are going right?' says I, when they turned in.
+
+"They nodded, and ran up to the door and turned the handle.
+
+"'Come in, Joe,' they said; and they dragged me into a parlor, where a
+lady and gentleman was sitting.
+
+"The gentleman got up.
+
+"'My little girls have spoken so much to me about you, Joe, that I
+feel that we know each other already.'
+
+"'Yes, sir, surely,' says I.
+
+"'Well, Joe, do you know that I owe you a great deal as to these
+little girls?'
+
+"'Bless you, sir, it's I as owe a great deal to the little missies;
+they have made a changed man of me, they have; you ask anyone on the
+shore.'
+
+"'I hope they have, Joe; for had they not got round your heart, and
+led you to your better self, I could never have done what I have done,
+for you would have rendered it useless.'
+
+"I didn't say nothing, sir, for I could make neither head nor tail of
+what he was saying, and, I dessay, looked as surprised as might be.
+Then he takes a step forward, and he puts a hand on my shoulder, and
+says he:
+
+"'Joe, have you never guessed who these little girls were?'
+
+"I looked first at the children, and then at him, and then at the
+lady, who had a veil down, but was wiping her eyes underneath it. I
+was downright flummuxed.
+
+"'I see you haven't,' the gentleman went on. 'Well, Joe, it is time
+you should know now. I owe to you all that is dear to me in this
+world, and our one unhappiness has been that you would not hear us,
+that you had lost everything and would not let us do anything to
+lighten your blow.'
+
+"Still, sir, I couldn't make out what he meant, and began to think
+that I was mad, or that he was. Then the lady stood up and threw back
+her veil, and come up in front of me with the tears a-running down
+her face; and I fell back a step, and sits down suddenly in a chair,
+for, sure enough, it was that gal. Different to what I had seen her
+last, healthy-looking and well--older, in course; a woman now, and the
+mother of my little ladies.
+
+"She stood before me, sir, with her hands out before her, pleading
+like.
+
+"'Don't hate me any more, Joe. Let my children stand between us. I
+know what you have suffered, and, in all my happiness, the thought of
+your loneliness has been a trouble, as my husband will tell you. I so
+often thought of you--a broken, lonely man. I have talked to the
+children of you till they loved the man that saved their mother's
+life. I cannot give you what you have lost, Joe--no one can do that;
+but you may make us happy in making you comfortable. At least, if you
+cannot help hating me, let the love I know you bear my children weigh
+with you.'
+
+"As she spoke the children were hanging on me; and when she stopped
+the little one said:
+
+"'Oh, Joe, oo must be dood; oo mustn't hate mamma, and make her cry!'
+
+"Well, sir, I know as I need tell you more about it. You can imagine
+how I quite broke down, like a great baby, and called myself every
+kind of name, saying only that I thought, and I a'most think so now,
+that I had been somehow mad from the moment the squall struck the
+_Kate_ till the time I first met the little girls.
+
+"When I thought o' that, and how I'd cut that poor gal to her drowning
+heart with my words, I could ha' knelt to her if she'd ha' let me. At
+last, when I was quiet, she explained that this cottage and its
+furniture and the _Grateful Mary_ was all for me; and we'd a great
+fight over it, and I only gave in when at last she says that if I
+didn't do as she wanted she'd never come down to Scarborough with the
+little ladies no more; but that if I 'greed they'd come down regular
+every year, and that the little girls should go out sailing with me
+regular in the _Grateful Mary_.
+
+"Well, sir, there was no arguing against that, was there? So here I
+am; and next week I expect Miss Mary that was, with her husband, who's
+a Parliament man, as she was engaged to be married to at the time of
+the upset, and my little ladies, who is getting quite big girls too.
+And if you hadn't been going away I'd ha' sailed round the castle
+tower, and I'd ha' pointed out the cottage to you. Yes, sir, I see
+what you are going to ask. I found it lonely there; and I found the
+widow of a old mate of mine who seemed to think as how she could make
+me comfortable; and comfortable I am, sir--no words could say how
+comfortable I am; and do you know, sir, I'm blest if there aint a Joe
+up there at this identical time, only he's a very little one, and has
+got both arms. So you see, sir, I have got about as little right as
+has any chap in this mortial world to the name of Surly Joe."
+
+
+
+
+A FISH-WIFE'S DREAM.
+
+
+Falmouth is not a fashionable watering-place. Capitalists and
+speculative builders have somehow left it alone, and, except for its
+great hotel, standing in a position, as far as I know, unrivaled,
+there have been comparatively few additions to it in the last quarter
+of a century. Were I a yachtsman I should make Falmouth my
+headquarters: blow high, blow low, there are shelter and plenty of
+sailing room, while in fine weather there is a glorious coast along
+which to cruise--something very different from the flat shores from
+Southampton to Brighton. It is some six years since that I was lying
+in the harbor, having sailed round in a friend's yacht from Cowes.
+Upon the day after we had come in my friend went into Truro, and I
+landed, strolled up, and sat down on a bench high on the seaward face
+of the hill that shelters the inner harbor.
+
+An old coastguardsman came along. I offered him tobacco, and in five
+minutes we were in full talk.
+
+"I suppose those are the pilchard boats far out there?"
+
+"Aye, that's the pilchard fleet."
+
+"Do they do well generally?"
+
+"Sometimes they do, sometimes they don't; it's an uncertain fish the
+pilchard, and it's a rough life is fishing on this coast. There aint a
+good harbor not this side of the Lizard; and if they're caught in a
+gale from the southeast it goes hard with them. With a southwester
+they can run back here."
+
+"Were you ever a fisherman yourself?"
+
+"Aye, I began life at it; I went a-fishing as a boy well-nigh fifty
+year back, but I got a sickener of it, and tramped to Plymouth and
+shipped in a frigate there, and served all my time in queen's ships."
+
+"Did you get sick of fishing because of the hardships of the life, or
+from any particular circumstance?"
+
+"I got wrecked on the Scillys. There was fifty boats lost that night,
+and scarce a hand was saved. I shouldn't have been saved myself if it
+had not been for a dream of mother's."
+
+"That's curious," I said. "Would you mind telling me about it?"
+
+The old sailor did not speak for a minute or two; and then, after a
+sharp puff at his pipe, he told me the following story, of which I
+have but slightly altered the wording:
+
+I lived with mother at Tregannock. It's a bit of a village now, as it
+was then. My father had been washed overboard and drowned two years
+before. I was his only son. The boat I sailed in was mother's, and
+four men and myself worked her in shares. I was twenty-one, or maybe
+twenty-two, years old then. It was one day early in October. We had
+had a bad season, and times were hard. We'd agreed to start at eight
+o'clock in the morning. I was up at five, and went down to the boats
+to see as everything was ready. When I got back mother had made
+breakfast; and when we sat down I saw that the old woman had been
+crying, and looked altogether queer like.
+
+"My boy," says she, "I want you not to go out this trip."
+
+"Not go out!" said I; "not go out, mother! Why? What's happened? Your
+share and mine didn't come to three pounds last month, and it would be
+a talk if I didn't go out in the _Jane_. Why, what is it?"
+
+"My boy," says she, "I've had a dream as how you was drowned."
+
+"Drowned!" said I; "I'm not going to be drowned, mother."
+
+But what she said made me feel creepy like, for us Cornishmen goes a
+good deal on dreams and tokens; and sure enough mother had dreamed
+father was going to be drowned before he started on that last trip of
+his.
+
+"That's not all, Will," she said. "I dreamed of you in bed, and a chap
+was leaning over you cutting your throat."
+
+I didn't care much for going on with my breakfast after that; but in a
+minute or two I plucks up and says:
+
+"Well, mother, you're wrong, anyhow; for if I be drowned no one has no
+call to cut my throat."
+
+"I didn't see you downright drowned in my dream," she said. "You was
+in the sea--a terribly rough sea--at night, and the waves were
+breaking down on you."
+
+"I can't help going, mother," I says, after a bit. "It's a fine day,
+and it's our boat. All the lads and girls in the village would laugh
+at me if I stayed at home."
+
+"That's just what your father said; and he went to his death."
+
+And my mother, as she says this, puts her apron over her head and
+began to cry again. I'd more than half a mind to give way; but you
+know what young chaps are. The thought of what the girls of the place
+would say about my being afraid to go was too much for me.
+
+At last, when mother saw I was bent on going, she got up and said:
+
+"Well, Will, if my prayers can't keep you back, will you do something
+else I ask you?"
+
+"I will, mother," said I--"anything but stay back."
+
+She went off without a word into her bedroom, and she came back with
+something in her arms.
+
+"Look here, Will, I made this for your father, and he wouldn't have
+it; now I ask you to take it, and put it on if a storm comes on. You
+see, you can put it on under your dreadnaught coat, and no one will
+be any the wiser."
+
+The thing she brought in was two flat Dutch spirit-bottles, sewn
+between two pieces of canvas. It had got strings sewed on for tying
+round the body, and put on as she did to show me how, one bottle each
+side of the chest, it lay pretty flat.
+
+"Now, Will, these bottles will keep you up for hours. A gentleman who
+was staying in the village before you was born was talking about
+wrecks, and he said that a couple of empty bottles, well corked, would
+keep up a fair swimmer for hours. So I made it; but no words could get
+your father to try it, though he was willing enough to say that it
+would probably keep him afloat. You'll try it, won't you, Will?"
+
+I didn't much like taking it, but I thought there wasn't much chance
+of a storm, and that if I put it under my coat and hid it away down in
+the forecastle, no one would see it; and so to please her I said I'd
+take it, and that if a bad storm came on I would slip it on.
+
+"I will put a wineglass of brandy into one of the bottles," mother
+said. "It may be useful to you; who can say?"
+
+I got the life-preserver, as you call it nowadays, on board without
+its being seen, and stowed it away in my locker. I felt glad now I'd
+got it, for mother's dream had made me feel uneasy; and on my way down
+old Dick Tremaine said to me:
+
+"I don't like the look of the sky, lad."
+
+"No!" says I; "why, it looks fine enough."
+
+"Too fine, lad. I tell ye, boy, I don't like the look of it. I think
+we're going to have a bad blow."
+
+I told the others what he had said; but they didn't heed much. Two
+boats had come in that morning with a fine catch, and after the bad
+time we'd been having it would have taken a lot to keep them in after
+that.
+
+We thought no more about it after we had once started. The wind was
+light and puffy; but we had great luck, and were too busy to watch the
+weather. What wind there was, was northerly; but towards sunset it
+dropped suddenly, and as the sails flapped we looked round at the sky.
+
+"I fear old Dick was right, lads," Jabez Harper, who was skipper,
+said, "and I wish we had taken more heed to his words. That's about as
+wild a sunset as may be; and look how that drift is nearing our boat."
+
+Even I, who was the youngest of them, was old enough to read the signs
+of a storm--the heavy bank of dark clouds, the pale-yellow broken
+light, the horse-tails high up in the sky, and the small broken
+irregular masses of cloud that hurried across them. Instinctively we
+looked round towards the coast. It was fully fifteen miles away, and
+we were to the east of it. The great change in the appearance of the
+sky had taken place in the last half-hour; previous to that time there
+had been nothing which would have struck any but a man grown old upon
+the coast like Dick Tremaine.
+
+"Reef the mainsail," Jabez said, "and the foresail too; take in the
+mizzen. Like enough it will come with a squall, and we'd best be as
+snug as may be. What do you say? shall we throw over some of the
+fish?"
+
+It was a hard thing to agree to; but every minute the sky was
+changing. The scud was flying thicker and faster overhead, and the
+land was lost in a black cloud that seemed to touch the water.
+
+"We needn't throw 'em all out," Jabez said; "if we get rid of half
+she'll be about in her best trim; and she's as good a sea-boat as
+there is on the coast. Come, lads, don't look at it."
+
+It was, as he said, no use looking at it, and in five minutes half our
+catch of the day was overboard. The _Jane_ was a half-decked boat,
+yawl-rigged; she wasn't built in our parts, but had been brought round
+from somewhere east by a gentleman as a fishing-craft. He had used her
+for two years, and had got tired of the sport, and my father had
+bought her of him. She wasn't the sort of boat generally used about
+here, but we all liked her, and swore by her.
+
+"It will be a tremendous blow for the first few minutes, I reckon,"
+Jabez said after a while. "Lower down her sails altogether; get her
+head to it with a sweep. I'll take the helm; Harry, you stand ready to
+hoist the foresail a few feet; and, Will, you and John stand by the
+hoists of the mainsail. We must show enough to keep her laying-to as
+long as we can. You'd best get your coats out and put 'em on, and
+batten down the hatch."
+
+I let the others go down first, and when they came up I went in, tied
+the life-belt round me, and put on my oilskin. I fetched out a bottle
+of hollands from my locker, and then came out and fastened the hatch.
+
+"Here comes the first puff," Jabez said.
+
+I stowed away the bottle among some ropes for our future use, and took
+hold of the throat halyard.
+
+"Here it comes," Jabez said, as a white line appeared under the cloud
+of mist and darkness ahead, and then with a roar it was upon us.
+
+I have been at sea, man and boy, for forty years, and I never remember
+in these latitudes such a squall as that. For a few minutes I could
+scarcely see or breathe. The spray flew in sheets over us, and the
+wind roared so that you wouldn't have heard a sixty-eight-pounder ten
+yards off. At first I thought we were going down bodily. It was lucky
+we had taken every stitch of canvas off her, for, as she spun round,
+the force of the wind against the masts and rigging all but capsized
+her. In five minutes the first burst was over, and we were running
+before it under our close-reefed foresail only. There was no occasion
+for us to stand by the halyards now, and we all gathered in the stern,
+and crouched down in the well. Although the sun had only gone down
+half an hour it was pitch-dark, except that the white foam round us
+gave a sort of dim light that made the sky look all the blacker. The
+sea got up in less time than it takes in telling, and we were soon
+obliged to hoist the foresail a bit higher to prevent the waves from
+coming in over the stern. For three hours we tore on before the gale,
+and then it lulled almost as suddenly as it had come on. There had
+scarcely been a word spoken between us during this time. I was half
+asleep in spite of the showers of spray. Jim Hackers, who was always
+smoking, puffed away steadily; Jabez was steering still, and the
+others were quite quiet. With the sudden lull we were all on our feet.
+
+"Is it all over, Jabez?" I asked.
+
+"It's only begun," he said. "I scarce remember such a gale as this
+since I was a boy. Pass that bottle of yours round, Will; we shall be
+busy again directly. One of you take the helm; I'm stiff with the wet.
+We shall have it round from the south in a few minutes."
+
+There was scarce a breath of wind now, and she rolled so I thought she
+would have turned turtle.
+
+"Get out a sweep," Jabez said, "and bring her head round."
+
+We had scarcely done so ere the first squall from behind struck us,
+and in five minutes we were running back as fast as we had come. The
+wind was at first south, but settled round to southeast. We got up a
+little more sail now, and made a shift to keep her to the west, for
+with this wind we should have been ashore long before morning if we
+had run straight before it. The sea had been heavy--it was tremendous
+now; and, light and seaworthy as the _Jane_ was, we had to keep baling
+as the sea broke into her. Over and over again I thought that it was
+all over with us as the great waves towered above our stern, but they
+slipped under us as we went driving on at twelve or fourteen knots an
+hour. I stood up by the side of Jabez, and asked him what he thought
+of it.
+
+"I can't keep her off the wind," he said; "we must run, and by
+midnight we shall be among the Scillys. Then it's a toss-up."
+
+Jabez's calculations could not have been far out, for it was just
+midnight, as far as I could tell, when we saw a flash right ahead.
+
+"That's a ship on one of the Scillys," Jabez said. "I wish I knew
+which it was."
+
+He tried to bring her a little more up into the wind, but she nearly
+lay over onto her beam-ends, and Jabez let her go ahead again. We saw
+one more flash, and then a broad faint light. The ship was burning a
+blue light. She was not a mile ahead now, and we could see she was a
+large vessel. I had often been to the Scillys before, and knew them as
+well as I did our coast, but I could not see the land. It was as Jabez
+had said--a toss-up. If we just missed one of them we might manage to
+bring up under its lee; but if we ran dead into one or other of them
+the _Jane_ would break up like an egg-shell.
+
+We were rapidly running down upon the wreck when the glare of a fire
+on shore shone up. It was a great blaze, and we could faintly see the
+land and a white cottage some hundred yards from the shore.
+
+"I know it," Jabez shouted; "we are close to the end of the island; we
+may miss it yet. Hoist the mainsail a bit."
+
+I leapt up with another to seize the halyards, when a great wave
+struck us; she gave a roll, and the next moment I was in the water.
+
+After the first wild efforts I felt calm like. I knew the shore was
+but half a mile ahead, and that the wind would set me dead upon it. I
+loosened my tarpaulin coat and shook it off, and I found that with
+mother's belt I could keep easily enough afloat, though I was half
+drowned with the waves as they swept in from behind me. My mother's
+dream cheered me up, for, according to that, it did not seem as I was
+to be drowned, whatever was to come afterwards. I drifted past the
+wreck within a hundred yards or so. They were still burning blue
+lights; but the sea made a clean sweep over her, and I saw that in a
+very few minutes she would go to pieces. Many times as the seas broke
+over me I quite gave up hope of reaching shore; but I was a fair
+swimmer, and the bottles buoyed me up, and I struggled on.
+
+I could see the fire on shore, but the surf that broke against the
+rocks showed a certain death if I made for it, and I tried hard to
+work to the left, where I could see no breaking surf. It seemed to me
+that the fire was built close to the end of the island. As I came
+close I found that this was so. I drifted past the point of land not
+fifty feet off, where the waves were sending their spray a hundred
+feet up; then I made a great struggle, and got in under the lee of the
+point. There was a little bay with a shelving shore, and here I made a
+shift to land. Five minutes to rest, and then I made my way towards
+the fire. There was no one there, and I went to the edge of the rocks.
+Here four or five men with ropes were standing, trying to secure some
+of the casks, chests, and wreckage from the ship. The surf was full of
+floating objects, but nothing could stand the shock of a crash against
+those rocks. The water was deep alongside, and the waves, as they
+struck, flew up in spray, which made standing almost impossible.
+
+The men came round me when they saw me. There was no hearing one speak
+in the noise of the storm; so I made signs I had landed behind the
+point, and that if they came with their ropes to the point they might
+get something as it floated past. They went off, and I sat down by the
+fire, wrung my clothes as well as I could,--I thought nothing of the
+wet, for one is wet through half the time in a fishing-boat,--took off
+mother's belt, and found one of the bottles had broke as I got ashore;
+but luckily it was the one which was quite empty. I got the cork out
+of the other, and had a drink of brandy, and then felt pretty right
+again. I had good hopes the boat was all right, for she would get
+round the point easy, and Jabez would bring her up under the lee of
+the island. I thought I would go and see if I could help the others,
+and perhaps save someone drifting from the wreck; but I did not think
+there was very much chance, for she lay some little distance to the
+right, and I hardly thought a swimmer could keep off the shore.
+
+Just as I was going to move I saw two of them coming back. They had a
+body between them, and they put it down a little distance from the
+fire. I was on the other side, and they had forgotten all about me.
+They stooped over the figure, and I could not see what they were
+doing. I got up and went over, and they gave a start when they saw me.
+"Is he alive?" says I. "Dunno," one of 'em growled; and I could see
+pretty well that if I had not been there it would have gone hard with
+the chap. He was a foreign, Jewish-looking fellow, and had around him
+one of the ship's life-buoys. There were lots of rings on his fingers,
+and he had a belt round his waist that looked pretty well stuffed out.
+I put my hand to his heart, and found he still breathed; and then I
+poured a few drops of brandy which remained in my bottle down his
+throat.
+
+While I was doing this the two men had talked to each other aside.
+"He's alive, all right," says I. "That's a good job," one of 'em said;
+but I knew he didn't think so. "We'll carry him up to our cottage.
+You'll be all the better for a sleep; it must be past two o'clock by
+this time."
+
+They took the chap up, and carried him to the cottage, and put him on
+a bed. He was moaning a little, and between us we undressed him and
+got him into bed. "I doubt he'll come round," I said.
+
+"I don't believe he will. Will you have a drink of whisky?"
+
+I was mighty glad to do so, and then, throwing off my wet clothes, I
+got into the other bed, for there were two in the room.
+
+The men said they were going down again to see what they could get.
+They left the whisky bottle on the table, and as soon as I was alone I
+jumped out and poured a little into the other chap's teeth, so as to
+give him as good a chance as I could; but I didn't much think he'd get
+round, and then I got into bed and shut my eyes. I was just going off,
+when, with a sudden jump, I sat straight up. Mother's dream came right
+across me. I was out of bed in a moment, and looked at the door. There
+was no bolt, so I put a couple of chairs against it. Then I took my
+clasp-knife out of my pocket and opened it. I gave the other chap a
+shake, but there was no sense in him, and I got into bed again. I
+thought to myself they would never risk a fight when they saw me armed
+and ready. But I soon found that I couldn't keep awake; so I got up
+and dressed in my wet clothes, and went to the door. I found it was
+fastened on the outside. I soon opened the window and got out, but
+before I did that I rolled up some clothes and put 'em in the bed, and
+made a sort of likeness of a man there. The poor fellow in bed was
+lying very still now, and I felt pretty sure that he would not live
+till morning. The candle was a fresh one when they had first lighted
+it, and I left it burning.
+
+When I had got out I shut the window, and went away fifty yards or so,
+where I could hear them come back. Presently I heard some footsteps
+coming from the opposite direction. Then I heard a voice I knew say,
+"There is the fire; we shall soon know whether the poor lad has got
+ashore."
+
+"Here am I, Jabez," I said. "Hush!" as he and the other were going to
+break into a shout of welcome, "hush! Some wreckers are coming up
+directly to cut my throat and that of another chap in that cottage."
+
+In a word or two I told them all about it; and they agreed to wait
+with me and see the end of it. Jabez had brought the _Jane_ up under
+the lee of the island, and, leaving two of the men on board, had come
+on shore in the cobble with the other to look for me, but with very
+faint hopes of finding me.
+
+"You had best get hold of something to fight with, if you mean to take
+these fellows, Jabez."
+
+"A good lump of rock is as good a weapon as another," Jabez said.
+
+Our plan was soon arranged, and half an hour later we heard footsteps
+coming up from the shore again. Two men passed us, went into the
+cottage, and shut the door. Jabez and I made round to the window,
+where we could see in, and John Redpath stood at the door. He was to
+open it and rush in when he heard us shout. We stood a little back,
+but we could see well into the room. Presently we saw the door open
+very quietly, little by little. A hand came through and moved the
+chairs, and then it opened wide. Then the two men entered. One, a big
+fellow, had a knife in his hand, and drew towards the bed, where, as
+it seemed, I was sleeping, with my head covered up by the clothes. The
+other had no knife in his hand, and came towards the other bed.
+
+"Get ready, lad," Jabez said to me.
+
+The big fellow raised his knife and plunged it down into the figure,
+throwing his weight onto it at the same moment, while the smaller man
+snatched the pillow from under the other's head and clapped it over
+his face, and threw his weight on it. As they did so we pushed the
+casement open and leapt in. I seized the smaller man, who was
+suffocating the other chap, and before he could draw his knife I had
+him on the ground and my knee on his chest. The big fellow had leapt
+up. He gave a howl of rage as Jabez rushed at him, and stood at bay
+with his knife. Jabez stopped, however, and threw his lump of rock, as
+big as a baby's head, right into his stomach. It just tumbled him over
+like a cannon-shot. John burst in through the door, and we had 'em
+both tied tightly before five minutes was over. Then we lit a big fire
+in the kitchen, and with warm clothes and some hot whisky and water
+we got the foreign chap pretty well round.
+
+In the morning I went off and found a village on the other side of the
+island. I woke them up and told my story, and, to do 'em justice,
+though there were some who would have shielded the fellows we had
+caught, the best part were on our side. Some of 'em told me there had
+been suspicion upon these men, and that they bore a bad name. There
+was no magistrate in the island, and no one objected when I said we
+would take them across to Penzance and give them in charge there.
+
+So we did; and they were tried and got transportation for life for
+attempting to murder the foreign chap, who, it turned out, was a
+Brazilian Jew, with diamonds. He offered us all sorts of presents, but
+we would have none; but that's neither here nor there.
+
+So you see, master, mother's dream saved me from drowning and from
+having my throat cut. I gave up fishing after that and went into the
+queen's service. Mother sold the boat, and went to live with a sister
+of hers at Truro. The Scilly Islands have changed since those times,
+and you'll meet as much kindness there if you're wrecked as you will
+anywhere else; but they were a rough lot in those days, and I had a
+pretty close shave of it, hadn't I?
+
+
+
+
+Boys' Own Library.
+
+
+ BOUND IN CLOTH.
+
+ Large Type, Fine Book Paper. Illustrated. Printed Wrappers.
+
+ A selection of the Best Books for Boys, by the most popular
+ Authors.
+
+ Handsome Cloth Binding. Covers Stamped in Inks and Gold.
+
+ THESE BOOKS ARE ALL COPYRIGHTED.
+
+ Price, 75 Cents Each, Postpaid.
+
+#Horatio Alger, Jr.#
+
+ Adventures of a Telegraph Boy.
+ Dean Dunham.
+ Erie Train Boy.
+ Five Hundred Dollar Check.
+ From Canal Boy to President.
+ From Farm Boy to Senator.
+ Mark Stanton.
+ Ned Newton.
+ New York Boy.
+ Tom Brace.
+ Tom Tracy.
+ Walter Griffith.
+ Young Acrobat.
+
+#C. B. Ashley.#
+
+ Gilbert, the Trapper
+
+#Annie Ashmore.#
+
+ Smuggler's Cave, The.
+
+#Capt. Ralph Bonehill.#
+
+ Neka, the Boy Conjurer.
+ Tour of the Zero Club.
+
+#Walter F. Burns.#
+
+ In the Sunk Lands.
+
+#Frank H. Converse.#
+
+ Gold of Flat Top Mountain.
+ Happy-Go-Lucky Jack.
+ Heir to a Million.
+ In Search of an Unknown Race.
+ In Southern Seas.
+ Mystery of a Diamond.
+ That Treasure.
+ Voyage to the Gold Coast.
+
+#Harry Collingwood.#
+
+ Pirate Island.
+
+#George H. Coomer.#
+
+ Boys In the Forecastle.
+ Old Man of the Mountain.
+
+#William Dalton.#
+
+ Tiger Prince.
+ War Tiger.
+ White Elephant.
+
+#Edward S. Ellis.#
+
+ Arthur Helmuth.
+ Check Number 2134.
+ From Tent to White House.
+ Golden Rock.
+ Land of Mystery.
+ On the Trail of Geronimo.
+ Perils of the Jungle.
+ White Mustang.
+
+#George Manville Fenn.#
+
+ Commodore Junk.
+ Dingo Boys.
+ Golden Magnet.
+ Grand Chaco.
+ Weathercock.
+
+#Ensign Clarke Fitch, U. S. N.#
+
+ Bound for Annapolis.
+ Cliff, the Naval Cadet.
+ Cruise of the Training Ship.
+ From Port to Port.
+ Strange Cruise, A.
+
+#William Murray Graydon.#
+
+ Butcher of Cawnpore, The.
+ Camp In the Snow, The.
+ Campaigning with Braddock.
+ Cryptogram, The.
+ From Lake to Wilderness.
+ In Barracks and Wigwam.
+ In Fort and Prison.
+ Jungles and Traitors.
+ Rajah's Fortress, The.
+ White King of Africa, The.
+ With Boer and Britisher.
+
+#Lieut. Frederick Garrison, U. S. A.#
+
+ Cadet's Honor, A.
+ Off for West Point.
+ On Guard.
+ West Point Treasure, A.
+ West Point Rivals, The.
+
+#Headon Hill.#
+
+ Spectre Gold.
+
+#Henry Harrison Lewis.#
+
+ Centerboard Jim.
+ Ensign Merrill.
+ King of the Island.
+ Midshipman Merrill.
+ Sword and Pen.
+ Valley of Mystery, The.
+ Yankee Boys In Japan.
+
+#Lieut. Lionel Lounsberry.#
+
+ Cadet Kit Carey.
+ Capt. Carey.
+ Kit Carey's Protege.
+ Lieut. Carey's Luck.
+ Out with Commodore Decatur.
+ Randy, the Pilot.
+ Tom Truxton's Ocean Trip.
+ Tom Truxton's School Days.
+ Treasure of the Golden Crater.
+ Won at West Point.
+
+#Victor St. Clair.#
+
+ Cast Away in the Jungle.
+ Comrades Under Castro.
+ For Home and Honor.
+ From Switch to Lever.
+ Little Snap, the Postboy.
+ Zig-Zag, the Boy Conjuror.
+ Zip, the Acrobat.
+
+#Arthur M. Winfield.#
+
+ Mark Dale's Stage Venture.
+ Young Bank Clerk, The.
+ Young Bridge Tender, The.
+
+#Matthew White, Jr.#
+
+ Adventures of a Young Athlete.
+ Eric Dane.
+ Guy Hammersley.
+ My Mysterious Fortune.
+ Tour of a Private Car.
+ Young Editor, The.
+
+#Gayle Winterton.#
+
+ Young Actor, The.
+
+#Ernest A. Young.#
+
+ Boats, Bats and Bicycles.
+
+
+
+
+Splendid Books for Girls.
+
+
+ HANDSOMELY BOUND IN CLOTH, ILLUSTRATED.
+
+ Price, 60 Cents Each, Postpaid.
+
+#EVELYN RAYMOND'S delightful stories:#
+
+ #Breakneck Farm.#
+
+ The trials and triumphs of Faith Merriman and her brothers, on
+ an old abandoned country place.
+
+ #Jessica Trent.#
+
+ Her Adventures on a Ranch.
+
+ #Jessica, the Heiress.#
+
+ This is Evelyn Raymond's new book, just published. A Charming
+ Story.
+
+#KATE TANNATT WOODS:#
+
+ #A Fair Maid of Marblehead.#
+
+ A book to please both young and old.
+
+
+ THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY, New York.
+
+
+
+
+BOYS' OWN LIBRARY
+
+
+ Bound in Cloth.
+ Price, 75 Cents Each, Postpaid.
+
+#Brooks McCormick.#
+
+ Giant Islanders, The.
+ How He Won.
+ Nature's Young Noblemen.
+ Rival Battalions.
+
+#Walter Morris.#
+
+ Bob Porter at Lakeview Academy.
+
+#Stanley Norris.#
+
+ Phil, the Showman.
+ Young Showman's Rivals, The.
+ Young Showman's Pluck, The.
+ Young Showman's Triumph, The.
+
+#Lieut. James K. Orton.#
+
+ Beach Boy Joe.
+ Last Chance Mine.
+ Secret Chart, The.
+ Tom Havens with the White Squadron.
+
+#James Otis.#
+
+ Chased Through Norway.
+ Inland Waterways.
+ Reuben Green's Adventures at Yale.
+ Unprovoked Mutiny, An.
+ Wheeling for Fortune.
+
+#Gilbert Patten.#
+
+ Boy Boomers.
+ Boy Cattle King.
+ Boy from the West.
+ Don Kirk's Mine.
+ Jud and Joe.
+
+#St. George Rathborne.#
+
+ Canoe and Camp Fire.
+ Chums of the Prairie.
+ Gulf Cruisers, The.
+ Paddling Under Palmettos.
+ Rival Canoe Boys.
+ Shifting Winds.
+ Sunset Ranch.
+ Young Range Riders.
+
+#Arthur Sewell.#
+
+ Gay Dashleigh's Academy Days.
+
+#Capt. David Southwick.#
+
+ Jack Wheeler.
+
+#Burt L. Standish.#
+
+ Frank Merriwell's Bravery.
+ Frank Merriwell Down South.
+ Frank Merriwell's School Days.
+ Frank Merriwell's Chums.
+ Frank Merriwell's Foes.
+ Frank Merriwell's Trip West.
+
+
+
+
+The New "Henty" Series.
+
+
+ With large INLAID PANEL IN THREE COLORS on each book. The
+ Illustrations are reproductions of paintings representing
+ scenes in the Stories. The elegant cover design is done in
+ Inks and Gold, on a fine quality of Cloth. These books are all
+ by G. A. Henty. Illustrated. Printed Wrappers.
+
+ AMONG MALAY PIRATES. A Story of Adventure and Peril.
+ BONNIE PRINCE CHARLIE. A Tale of Fontenoy and Culloden.
+ BOY KNIGHT, THE. A Tale of the Crusades.
+ BRAVEST OF THE BRAVE, THE. With Peterborough in Spain.
+ BY ENGLAND'S AID; or, The Freeing of the Netherlands (1585-1604).
+ BY PIKE AND DYKE. A Tale of the Rise of the Dutch Republic.
+ BY RIGHT OF CONQUEST; or, With Cortez in Mexico.
+ BY SHEER PLUCK. A Tale of the Ashanti War.
+ CAPTAIN BAYLEY'S HEIR. A Tale of the Gold Fields of California.
+ CAT OF BUBASTES, THE. A Story of Ancient Egypt.
+ CORNET OF HORSE, THE. A Tale of Marlborough's Wars.
+ DRAGON AND THE RAVEN; or, The Days of King Alfred.
+ FACING DEATH. A Tale of the Coal Mines.
+ FINAL RECKONING, A. A Tale of Bush Life in Australia.
+ FOR NAME AND FAME; or, Through Afghan Passes.
+ FOR THE TEMPLE. A Tale of the Fall of Jerusalem.
+ FRIENDS, THOUGH DIVIDED. A Tale of the Civil War in England.
+ GOLDEN CANON, THE. A Tale of Gold Hunting in Mexico.
+ IN FREEDOM'S CAUSE. A Story of Wallace and Bruce.
+ IN THE REIGN OF TERROR. Adventures of a Westminster Boy.
+ IN TIMES OF PERIL. A Tale of India.
+ JACK ARCHER. A Tale of the Crimea.
+ LION OF ST. MARK, THE. A Story of Venice in the 14th Century.
+ LION OF THE NORTH, THE. A Tale of Gustavus Adolphus and Wars of
+ Religion.
+ LOST HEIR, THE. A Tale of Kidnapping in India.
+ MAORI AND SETTLER. A Story of the New Zealand War.
+ ONE OF THE 28TH. A Tale of Waterloo.
+ ORANGE AND GREEN. A Tale of the Boyne and Limerick.
+ OUT ON THE PAMPAS. A Tale of South America.
+ ST. GEORGE FOR ENGLAND. A Tale of Cressy and Poitiers.
+ STURDY AND STRONG; or, How George Andrews Made his Way.
+ THROUGH THE FRAY. A Story of the Luddite Riots.
+ TRUE TO THE OLD FLAG. A Tale of the American War of Independence.
+ UNDER DRAKE'S FLAG. A Tale of the Spanish Main.
+ WITH CLIVE IN INDIA; or, The Beginnings of an Empire.
+ WITH LEE IN VIRGINIA. A Story of the American Civil War.
+ WITH WOLFE IN CANADA; or, The Winning of a Continent.
+ YOUNG BUGLERS, THE. A Tale of the Peninsular War.
+ YOUNG CARTHAGINIAN, THE. A Story of the Times of Hannibal.
+ YOUNG COLONISTS, THE. A Story of War in South Africa.
+ YOUNG FRANC-TIREURS. A Tale of the Franco-Prussian War.
+ YOUNG MIDSHIPMAN, THE. A Tale of the Siege of Alexandria.
+
+ _Any of the above books will be sent postpaid, upon receipt of
+ price, 50 cents._
+
+ THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY, New York.
+
+
+
+
+Boys' Popular Library.
+
+
+ BOUND IN CLOTH.
+
+ An excellent series of books for boys by such popular authors
+ as Optic, Kingston and other well-known writers.
+
+ These books are Bound in Cloth, with very attractive cover
+ designs stamped in colors. The are all well printed from large
+ type, on good paper. Printed wrappers.
+
+ Price, 50 Cents Each, Postpaid.
+
+#Walter Aimwell.#
+
+ Jerry.
+ Whistler.
+
+#Horatio Alger, Jr.#
+
+ Brave and Bold.
+ Only an Irish Boy.
+ Paul, the Peddler.
+ Phil, the Fiddler.
+ Slow and Sure.
+ Strive and Succeed.
+ Strong and Steady.
+ Tom, the Bootblack.
+ Try and Trust.
+
+#Z. R. Bennett.#
+
+ Young Vagabond, A.
+
+#Daniel Defoe.#
+
+ Robinson Crusoe.
+
+#John De Morgan.#
+
+ Always on Duty.
+
+#Richard Dowling.#
+
+ Catmur's Cave.
+
+#George Manville Fenn.#
+
+ In the Wilds of New Mexico.
+
+#Blanche Willis Howard.#
+
+ Battle and a Boy, A.
+
+#W. H. G. Kingston.#
+
+ Dick Cheveley.
+ From Powder Monkey to Admiral.
+ Hendricks, the Hunter.
+ Mark Seaworth's Voyage on the Indian Ocean.
+ Peter Trawl.
+ Peter, the Whaler.
+ Shore and Ocean.
+ The Midshipman, Marmaduke Merry.
+
+#Leon Lewis.#
+
+ Diamond Seekers of Brazil.
+ Kit Carson's Last Trail.
+ Silver Ship, The.
+ Young Castaways, The.
+
+#Montleau & Wyse.#
+
+ Swiss Family Robinson.
+
+#Alfred Oldfellow.#
+
+ Joe Nichols.
+ Uncle Nat.
+ Way to Success.
+
+#Oliver Optic#
+
+ All Aboard (Sequel to "Boat Club").
+ Boat Club, The.
+ Little by Little.
+ Now or Never.
+ Try Again.
+
+#Capt. Mayne Reid.#
+
+ Boy Tar, The.
+ Cliff Climber, The.
+ Lone Ranch, The.
+ Ran Away to Sea.
+
+#Gordon Stables.#
+
+ Cruise of the Snowbird.
+ Life at Sea.
+ Wild Adventures 'Round the Pole.
+ Young Explorer, The.
+
+#Jefferys Taylor.#
+
+ Boy Crusoes, The.
+
+#A Wolvertonian.#
+
+ Three Years at Wolverton.
+
+#Ernest A. Young.#
+
+ Toss Up for Luck.
+
+
+ THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY, New York.
+
+
+
+
+Girls' Popular Library.
+
+
+ ELEGANTLY BOUND IN CLOTH.
+
+ LARGE TYPE. GOOD PAPER. Printed Wrappers. Very attractive
+ cover design stamped in colors. Just the books that girls
+ delight to read--and can read with profit as well as pleasure.
+ Note the list of Authors--all well-known writers of the best
+ books for girls.
+
+ Price, 50 Cents Each, Postpaid.
+
+#Walter Aimwell.#
+
+ Ella.
+ Jessie.
+ Marcus.
+
+#Mary D. Brine.#
+
+ Echoes from Story Land.
+ Stories Grandma Told.
+
+#Alice Carey.#
+
+ Clovernook Children.
+ Clovernook Tales. Vol. I.
+ Clovernook Tales. Vol. II.
+
+#Rosa Nouchette Carey.#
+
+ Averil.
+ Our Bessie.
+
+#Cousin Virginia.#
+
+ Cricket's Friends, The.
+ Dolls' Club, The.
+ 3 Vols. in 1.
+ Jo's Doll.
+ Katy's Christmas.
+ Patty's Pranks.
+
+#Lewis Carroll.#
+
+ Alice's Adventures In Wonderland.
+ Through the Looking-Glass.
+
+#Maria S. Cummins.#
+
+ Lamplighter, The.
+
+#Mary A. Denison.#
+
+ Barbara's Triumphs.
+ Frenchman's Ward, The.
+ Guardian's Trust, The.
+
+#Maria Edgeworth.#
+
+ Simple Susan.
+
+#Juliana Horatia Ewing.#
+
+ Flat-Iron for a Farthing, A.
+ Great Emergency, A.
+ Jackanapes.
+ Jan of the Windmill.
+ Six to Sixteen.
+ We and the World.
+
+#Julia Goddard.#
+
+ Fairy Tales In Other Lands.
+
+#Virginia F. Townsend.#
+
+ Amy Deane.
+ While it Was Morning.
+
+
+ THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY. New York.
+
+
+
+
+TRANSCRIBER'S NOTE: All apparent printer's errors retained.
+
+
+
+
+
+End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of Sturdy and Strong, by G. A. Henty
+
+*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK STURDY AND STRONG ***
+
+***** This file should be named 33939-8.txt or 33939-8.zip *****
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+ http://www.gutenberg.org/3/3/9/3/33939/
+
+Produced by David Edwards and the Online Distributed
+Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This file was
+produced from images generously made available by The
+Internet Archive)
+
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+http://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need, are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
+http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at http://pglaf.org
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit http://pglaf.org
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
+To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ http://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
diff --git a/33939-8.zip b/33939-8.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2ac97d5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/33939-8.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/33939-h.zip b/33939-h.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..48482b3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/33939-h.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/33939-h/33939-h.htm b/33939-h/33939-h.htm
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..020f2e9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/33939-h/33939-h.htm
@@ -0,0 +1,10750 @@
+<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
+ "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
+
+<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml">
+ <head>
+ <meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html;charset=iso-8859-1" />
+ <title>
+ The Project Gutenberg eBook of Sturdy And Strong, by G. A. Henty.
+ </title>
+ <style type="text/css">
+
+ p { margin-top: .75em;
+ text-align: justify;
+ margin-bottom: .75em;
+ }
+ h1,h2,h3,h4,h5,h6 {
+ text-align: center; /* all headings centered */
+ clear: both;
+ }
+ hr { width: 33%;
+ margin-top: 2em;
+ margin-bottom: 2em;
+ margin-left: auto;
+ margin-right: auto;
+ clear: both;
+ }
+
+ table {margin-left: auto; margin-right: auto;}
+
+ body{margin-left: 10%;
+ margin-right: 10%;
+ }
+
+ .pagenum { /* uncomment the next line for invisible page numbers */
+ /* visibility: hidden; */
+ position: absolute;
+ left: 92%;
+ font-size: smaller;
+ text-align: right;
+ } /* page numbers */
+
+ .blockquot{margin-left: 5%; margin-right: 10%;}
+
+ .center {text-align: center;}
+ .smcap {font-variant: small-caps;}
+ .u {text-decoration: underline;}
+
+ .caption {font-weight: bold;}
+
+ .figcenter {margin: auto; text-align: center;}
+
+ </style>
+ </head>
+<body>
+
+
+<pre>
+
+The Project Gutenberg EBook of Sturdy and Strong, by G. A. Henty
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+Title: Sturdy and Strong
+ How George Andrews Made His Way
+
+Author: G. A. Henty
+
+Release Date: October 7, 2010 [EBook #33939]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1
+
+*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK STURDY AND STRONG ***
+
+
+
+
+Produced by David Edwards and the Online Distributed
+Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This file was
+produced from images generously made available by The
+Internet Archive)
+
+
+
+
+
+
+</pre>
+
+
+
+
+<div class="figcenter" style="width: 70%;">
+<img src="images/cover.jpg" width="100%" alt="" title="" />
+<span class="caption">STURDY AND STRONG<br />
+G. A. HENTY</span>
+</div>
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+
+<div class="figcenter" style="width: 70%;">
+<img src="images/frontis.jpg" width="100%" alt="" title="" />
+<span class="caption">"SURLY JOE SAT WITH A CHILD ON EITHER SIDE, TELLING THEM
+SEA STORIES."&mdash;<i>Frontispiece.</i><br />
+<i>Sturdy and Strong.</i></span>
+</div>
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h1>STURDY AND STRONG</h1>
+
+<h4>OR</h4>
+
+<h3><i>How George Andrews Made His Way</i></h3>
+
+<h3><small>BY</small><br />
+
+<big>G. A. HENTY</big><br />
+
+<small>AUTHOR OF "THE YOUNG CARTHAGINIAN," "WITH CLIVE<br />
+IN INDIA," "IN FREEDOM'S CAUSE," "THE LION<br />
+OF THE NORTH," "FACING DEATH,"<br />
+ETC., ETC., ETC.</small></h3>
+
+<h3>NEW YORK<br />
+<big>THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY</big><br />
+PUBLISHERS</h3>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<p><span class='pagenum'>[Pg iii]</span></p>
+<h2>PREFACE.</h2>
+
+
+<p>Whatever may be said as to distinction of
+classes in England, it is certain that in no country
+in the world is the upward path more open to those
+who brace themselves to climb it than in our own.
+The proportion of those who remain absolutely
+stationary is comparatively small. We are all living
+on a hillside, and we must either go up or down.
+It is easier to descend than to ascend; but he who
+fixes his eyes upwards, nerves himself for the climb,
+and determines with all his might and power to
+win his way towards the top, is sure to find himself
+at the end of his day at a far higher level than when
+he started upon his journey. It may be said, and
+sometimes foolishly is said, that luck is everything;
+but in nineteen cases out of twenty what is called
+luck is simply a combination of opportunity, and of
+the readiness and quickness to turn that opportunity
+to advantage. The voyager must take
+every advantage of wind, tide, and current, if he
+would make a favorable journey; and for success
+in life it is necessary not only to be earnest, steadfast,
+and true, but to have the faculty of turning
+every opportunity to the best advantage; just as
+a climber utilizes every tuft of grass, every little
+shrub, every projecting rock, as a hold for his hands
+<span class='pagenum'>[Pg iv]</span>
+or feet. George Andrews had what may be called
+luck&mdash;that is, he had opportunities and took advantage
+of them, and his rise in life was consequently
+far more rapid than if he had let them pass
+without grasping them; but in any case his steadiness,
+perseverance, and determination to get on
+would assuredly have made their way in the long
+run. If similar qualities and similar determinations
+are yours, you need not despair of similar success
+in life.</p>
+
+<p style='text-align:right'><span class="smcap">G. A. Henty.</span></p>
+
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<p><span class='pagenum'>[Pg v]</span></p>
+<h2>CONTENTS.</h2>
+
+
+<table border="0" cellpadding="5" cellspacing="0" summary="Table of Contents">
+<tr>
+ <td>&nbsp;</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Sturdy and Strong</span>:</td>
+ <td align="right"><small>PAGE</small></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_I"><b>I.</b></a></td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Alone</span>,</td>
+ <td align="right"><a href="#Page_1">1</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_II"><b>II.</b></a></td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Two Friends</span>,</td>
+ <td align="right"><a href="#Page_25">25</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_III"><b>III.</b></a></td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Work</span>,</td>
+ <td align="right"><a href="#Page_48">48</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_IV"><b>IV.</b></a></td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Home</span>,</td>
+ <td align="right"><a href="#Page_74">74</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_V"><b>V.</b></a></td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">An Adventure</span>,</td>
+ <td align="right"><a href="#Page_97">97</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_VI"><b>VI.</b></a></td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Fire!</span>,</td>
+ <td align="right"><a href="#Page_117">117</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td align="right"><a href="#CHAPTER_VII"><b>VII.</b></a></td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Saved!</span>,</td>
+ <td align="right"><a href="#Page_142">142</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td>&nbsp;</td>
+ <td><a href="#DO_YOUR_DUTY"><span class="smcap">Do Your Duty</span></a>,</td>
+ <td align="right"><a href="#Page_165">165</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td>&nbsp;</td>
+ <td><a href="#SURLY_JOE"><span class="smcap">Surly Joe</span></a>,</td>
+ <td align="right"><a href="#Page_231">231</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td>&nbsp;</td>
+ <td><a href="#A_FISH-WIFES_DREAM"><span class="smcap">A Fish-wife's Dream</span></a>,</td>
+ <td align="right"><a href="#Page_257">257</a></td>
+</tr>
+</table>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_1" id="Page_1">[Pg 1]</a></span></p>
+<h1>STURDY AND STRONG.</h1>
+<hr style="width: 15%;" />
+
+
+<h2><a name="CHAPTER_I" id="CHAPTER_I"></a>CHAPTER I.</h2>
+
+<h3>ALONE.</h3>
+
+
+<p>"You heard what he said, George?"</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, mother, mother!"</p>
+
+<p>"Don't sob so, my boy; he is right. I have seen
+it coming a long time, and, hard as it seems, it will
+be better. There is no disgrace in it. I have tried
+my best, and if my health had not broken down we
+might have managed, but you see it was not to be.
+I shall not mind it, dear; it is really only for your
+sake that I care about it at all."</p>
+
+<p>The boy had ceased sobbing, and sat now with a
+white set face.</p>
+
+<p>"Mother, it will break my heart to think that I
+cannot keep you from this. If we could only have
+managed for a year or two I could have earned
+more then; but to think of you&mdash;you in the workhouse!"</p>
+
+<p>"In a workhouse infirmary, my boy," his mother
+said gently. "You see it is not as if it were from
+any fault of ours. We have done our best. You
+and I have managed for two years; but what with
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_2" id="Page_2">[Pg 2]</a></span>
+my health and my eyes breaking down we can do
+so no longer. I hope it will not be for long, dear.
+You see I shall have rest and quiet, and I hope I
+shall soon be able to be out again."</p>
+
+<p>"Not soon, mother. The doctor said you ought
+not to use your eyes for months."</p>
+
+<p>"Even months pass quickly, George, when one
+has hope. I have felt this coming so long that I
+shall be easier and happier now it has come. After
+all, what is a workhouse infirmary but a hospital,
+and it would not seem so very dreadful to you my
+going into a hospital; the difference is only in
+name; both are, after all, charities, but the one is
+kept up out of subscriptions, the other from the
+rates."</p>
+
+<p>His mother's words conveyed but little comfort
+to George Andrews. He had just come in from his
+work, and had heard what the parish doctor had
+told his mother.</p>
+
+<p>"I can do nothing for you here, Mrs. Andrews.
+You must have rest and quiet for your eyes, and
+not only that, but you must have strengthening
+food. It is no use my blinking the truth. It is
+painful for you, I know. I can well understand
+that; but I see no other way. If you refuse to go
+I won't answer for your life."</p>
+
+<p>"I will go, doctor," she had answered quietly.
+"I know that it will be best. It will be a blow to
+my boy, but I see no other way."</p>
+
+<p>"If you don't want your boy to be alone in the
+<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_3" id="Page_3">[Pg 3]</a></span>
+world, ma'am, you will do as I advise you. I will
+go round in the morning and get you the order of
+admission, and as I shall be driving out that way I
+will, if you like, take you myself."</p>
+
+<p>"Thank you, doctor; you are very good. Yes,
+I will be ready in the morning, and I thank you
+for your offer."</p>
+
+<p>"Very well, then, that's settled," the doctor said
+briskly. "At ten o'clock I will be here."</p>
+
+<p>Although a little rough in manner, Dr. Jeffries
+was a kind-hearted and humane man.</p>
+
+<p>"Poor woman," he said to himself as he went
+downstairs, "it is hard for her. It is easy to see
+that she is a lady, and a thorough lady too; but
+what can I do for her! I might get her a little
+temporary help, but that would be of no use--she
+is completely broken down with anxiety and insufficient
+food, and unless her eyes have a long
+holiday she will lose her sight. No, there's nothing
+else for it, but it is hard."</p>
+
+<p>It was hard. Mrs. Andrews was, as the doctor
+said, a lady. She had lost both her parents while
+she was at school. She had no near relations, and
+as she was sixteen when her mother died she had
+remained at school finishing her education and
+teaching the younger children. Then she had obtained
+a situation as governess in a gentleman's
+family, and two years afterwards had married a
+young barrister who was a frequent visitor at the
+house.</p>
+
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_4" id="Page_4">[Pg 4]</a></span>Mr.
+Andrews was looked upon as a rising man,
+and for the first seven or eight years of her marriage
+his wife's life had been a very happy one.
+Then her husband was prostrated by a fever which
+he caught in one of the midland towns while on
+circuit, and although he partially recovered he was
+never himself again. His power of work seemed
+to be lost; a languor which he could not overcome
+took possession of him. A troublesome cough
+ere long attacked him, and two years later Mrs.
+Andrews was a widow, and her boy, then nine years
+old, an orphan.</p>
+
+<p>During the last two years of his life Mr. Andrews
+had earned but little in his profession. The comfortable
+house which he occupied had been given
+up, and they had removed to one much smaller.
+But in spite of this, debts mounted up, and when,
+after his death, the remaining furniture was sold
+and everything settled, there remained only about
+two hundred pounds. Mrs. Andrews tried to get
+some pupils among her late husband's friends, but
+during the last two years she had lost sight of many
+of these, and now met with but poor success among
+the others. She was a quiet and retiring woman,
+and shrank from continuous solicitations, and at
+the end of three years she found her little store
+exhausted.</p>
+
+<p>Hitherto she had kept George at school, but
+could no longer do so, and, giving up her lodging
+in Brompton, went down to Croydon, where some<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_5" id="Page_5">[Pg 5]</a></span>one
+had told her that they thought she would have
+a better chance of obtaining pupils, but the cards
+which some of the tradesmen allowed her to put in
+the window led to no result, and finding this to be
+the case she applied at one of the milliner's for
+work. This she obtained, and for a year supported
+herself and her boy by needlework.</p>
+
+<p>From the time when George left school she had
+gone on teaching him his lessons; but on the day
+when he was thirteen years old he declared that he
+would no longer submit to his mother working for
+both of them, and, setting out, called at shop after
+shop inquiring if they wanted an errand-boy. He
+succeeded at last in getting a place at a grocer's
+where he was to receive three shillings a week and
+his meals, going home to sleep at night in the
+closet-like little attic adjoining the one room which
+his mother could now afford.</p>
+
+<p>For a while they were more comfortable than
+they had been for some time; now that his mother
+had no longer George to feed, her earnings and the
+three shillings he brought home every Saturday
+night enabled them to live in comparative ease, and
+on Sunday something like a feast was always prepared.
+But six months later Mrs. Andrews felt
+her eyesight failing, the lids became inflamed, and
+a dull aching pain settled in the eyeballs. Soon
+she could only work for a short time together, her
+earnings became smaller and smaller, and her employers
+presently told her that she kept the work<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_6" id="Page_6">[Pg 6]</a></span>
+so long in hand that they could no longer employ
+her. There was now only George's three shillings
+a week to rely upon, and this was swallowed up by
+the rent. In despair she had applied to the parish
+doctor about her eyes. For a fortnight he attended
+her, and at the end of that time had peremptorily
+given the order of which she had told her
+son.</p>
+
+<p>To her it was a relief; she had seen that it must
+come. Piece by piece every article of clothing she
+possessed, save those she wore, had been pawned
+for food, and every resource was now exhausted.
+She was worn out with the struggle, and the certainty
+of rest and food overcame her repugnance
+to the house. For George's sake too, much as she
+knew he would feel her having to accept such a
+refuge, she was glad that the struggle was at an
+end. The lad had for the last six months suffered
+greatly for her sake. Every meal to which he sat
+down at his employer's seemed to choke him as he
+contrasted it with the fare to which she was reduced,
+although, as far as possible, she had concealed
+from him how sore was her strait.</p>
+
+<p>George cried himself to sleep that night, and he
+could scarce speak when he said good-by to his
+mother in the morning, for he could not tell when
+he should see her again.</p>
+
+<p>"You will stop where you are, my boy, will you not?"</p>
+
+<p>"I cannot promise, mother. I don't know yet<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_7" id="Page_7">[Pg 7]</a></span>
+what I shall do; but please don't ask me to promise
+anything. You must let me do what I think best.
+I have got to make a home for you when you are
+cured. I am fourteen now, and am as strong as
+most boys of my age. I ought to be able to earn
+a shilling a day somehow, and with seven shillings
+a week, mother, and you just working a little, you
+know, so as not to hurt your eyes, we ought to be
+able to do. Don't you bother about me, mother.
+I want to try anyhow what I can do till you come
+out. When you do, then I will do whatever you
+tell me; that's fair, isn't it?"</p>
+
+<p>Mrs. Andrews would have remonstrated, but he
+said:</p>
+
+<p>"Well, mother, you see at the worst I can get a
+year's character from Dutton, so that if I can't get
+anything else to do I can get the same sort of
+place again, and as I am a year older than I was
+when he took me, and can tie up parcels neatly
+now, I ought to get a little more anyhow. You
+see I shall be safe enough, and though I have never
+grumbled, you know, mother&mdash;have I?&mdash;I think
+I would rather do anything than be a grocer's boy.
+I would rather, when I grow up, be a bricklayer's
+laborer, or a plowman, or do any what I call man's
+work, than be pottering about behind a counter,
+with a white apron on, weighing out sugar and
+currants."</p>
+
+<p>"I can't blame you, George," Mrs. Andrews
+said with a sigh. "It's natural, my boy. If I get<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_8" id="Page_8">[Pg 8]</a></span>
+my eyesight and my health again, when you grow
+up to be a man we will lay by a little money, and
+you and I will go out together to one of the colonies.
+It will be easier to rise again there than here,
+and with hard work both of us might surely hope
+to get on. There must be plenty of villages in
+Australia and Canada where I could do well with
+teaching, and you could get work in whatever way
+you may be inclined to. So, my boy, let us set
+that before us. It will be something to hope for
+and work for, and will cheer us to go through whatever
+may betide us up to that time."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, mother," George said. "It will be comfort
+indeed to have something to look forward to.
+Nothing can comfort me much to-day; but if
+anything could it would be some such plan as
+that."</p>
+
+<p>The last words he said to his mother as, blinded
+with tears, he kissed her before starting to work,
+were:</p>
+
+<p>"I shall think of our plan every day, and look
+forward to that more than anything else in the
+world&mdash;next to your coming to me again."</p>
+
+<p>At ten o'clock Dr. Jeffries drove up to Mrs. Andrews'
+humble lodging in a brougham instead of
+his ordinary gig, having borrowed the carriage
+from one of the few of his patients who kept such
+a vehicle, on purpose to take Mrs. Andrews, for
+she was so weak and worn that he was sure she
+would not be able to sit upright in a gig for the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_9" id="Page_9">[Pg 9]</a></span>
+three miles that had to be traversed. He managed
+in the course of his rounds to pass the workhouse
+again in the afternoon, and brought George, before
+he left work, a line written in pencil on a leaf
+torn from his pocketbook:</p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>"My darling, I am very comfortable. Everything
+is clean and nice, and the doctor and people
+kind. Do not fret about me.&mdash;Your loving
+mother."</p></div>
+
+<p>Although George's expressed resolution of leaving
+his present situation, and seeking to earn his
+living in some other way, caused Mrs. Andrews
+much anxiety, she had not sought strongly to dissuade
+him from it. No doubt it would be wiser
+for him to stay in his present situation, where he
+was well treated and well fed, and it certainly
+seemed improbable to her that he would be able
+to get a better living elsewhere. Still she could
+not blame him for wishing at least to try. She herself
+shared to some extent his prejudice against the
+work in which he was employed. There is no
+disgrace in honest work; but she felt that she would
+rather see him engaged in hard manual labor than
+as a shop boy. At any rate, as he said, if he failed
+he could come back again to Croydon, and, with a
+year's character from his present employer, would
+probably be able to obtain a situation similar to
+that which he now held. She was somewhat com<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_10" id="Page_10">[Pg 10]</a></span>forted,
+too, by a few words the doctor had said to
+her during their drive.</p>
+
+<p>"I think you are fortunate in your son, Mrs.
+Andrews. He seems to me a fine steady boy. If
+I can, in any way, do him a good turn while you are
+away from him, I will."</p>
+
+<p>George remained for another month in his situation,
+for he knew that it would never do to start on
+his undertaking penniless. At the end of that
+time, having saved up ten shillings, and having
+given notice to his employer, he left the shop for
+the last time, and started to walk to London. It
+was not until he began to enter the crowded streets
+that he felt the full magnitude of his undertaking.
+To be alone in London, a solitary atom in the busy
+mass of humanity, is a trying situation even for a
+man; to a boy of fourteen it is terrible. Buying
+a penny roll, George sat down to eat it in one of the
+niches of a bridge over the river, and then kneeling
+up watched the barges and steamers passing below
+him.</p>
+
+<p>Had it not been for his mother, his first thought,
+like that of most English boys thrown on the world,
+would have been to go to sea; but this idea he had
+from the first steadily set aside as out of the question.
+His plan was to obtain employment as a boy
+in some manufacturing work, for he thought that
+there, by steadiness and perseverance, he might
+make his way.</p>
+
+<p>On one thing he was resolved. He would make<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_11" id="Page_11">[Pg 11]</a></span>
+his money last as long as possible. Three penny-worth
+of bread a day would, he calculated, be sufficient
+for his wants. As to sleeping, he thought
+he might manage to sleep anywhere; it was summer
+time and the nights were warm. He had no idea
+what the price of a bed would be, or how to set
+about getting a lodging. He did not care how
+roughly he lived so that he could but make his
+money last. The first few days he determined to
+look about him. Something might turn up. If
+it did not he would set about getting a place in
+earnest. He had crossed Waterloo Bridge, and,
+keeping straight on, found himself in Covent Garden,
+where he was astonished and delighted at the
+quantities of fruit, vegetables, and flowers.</p>
+
+<p>Although he twice set out in different directions
+to explore the streets, he each time returned to
+Covent Garden. There were many lads of his own
+age playing about there, and he thought that from
+them he might get some hints as to how to set
+about earning a living. They looked ragged and
+poor enough, but they might be able to tell him
+something&mdash;about sleeping, for instance. For although
+before starting the idea of sleeping anywhere
+had seemed natural enough, it looked more
+formidable now that he was face to face with it.</p>
+
+<p>Going to a cook-shop in a street off the market
+he bought two slices of plum-pudding. He rather
+grudged the twopence which he paid; but he felt
+that it might be well laid out. Provided with the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_12" id="Page_12">[Pg 12]</a></span>
+pudding he returned to the market, sat himself
+down on an empty basket, and began to eat slowly
+and leisurely.</p>
+
+<p>In a short time he noticed a lad of about his own
+age watching him greedily.</p>
+
+<p>He was far from being a respectable-looking boy.
+His clothes were ragged, and his toes could be seen
+through a hole in his boot. He wore neither hat
+nor cap, and his hair looked as if it had not been
+combed since the day of his birth. There was a
+sharp, pinched look on his face. But had he been
+washed and combed and decently clad he would
+not have been a bad-looking boy. At any rate
+George liked his face better than most he had seen
+in the market, and he longed for a talk with someone.
+So he held out his other slice of pudding,
+and said:</p>
+
+<p>"Have a bit?"</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, yes!" the boy replied "Walker, eh?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, I mean it, really. Will you have a bit?"</p>
+
+<p>"No larks?" asked the boy.</p>
+
+<p>"No; no larks. Here you are."</p>
+
+<p>Feeling assured now that no trick was intended
+the boy approached, took without a word the pudding
+which George held out, and, seating himself
+on a basket close to him, took a great bite.</p>
+
+<p>"Where do you live?" George asked, when the
+slice of pudding had half disappeared.</p>
+
+<p>"Anywheres," the boy replied, waving his hand
+round.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_13" id="Page_13">[Pg 13]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"I mean, where do you sleep?"</p>
+
+<p>The boy nodded, to intimate that his sleeping-place
+was included in the general description of his
+domicile.</p>
+
+<p>"And no one interferes with you?" George inquired.</p>
+
+<p>"The beaks, they moves you on when they
+ketches you; but ef yer get under a cart or
+in among the baskets you generally dodges
+'em."</p>
+
+<p>"And suppose you want to pay for a place to
+sleep, where do you go and how much do you
+pay?"</p>
+
+<p>"Tuppence," the boy said; "or if yer want a
+first-rate, fourpence. Does yer want to find a
+crib?" he asked doubtfully, examining his companion.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, yes," George said. "I want to find
+some quiet place where I can sleep, cheap, you
+know."</p>
+
+<p>"Out of work?" the boy inquired.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes. I haven't got anything to do at present.
+I am looking for a place, you know."</p>
+
+<p>"Don't know no one about?"</p>
+
+<p>"No; I have just come in from Croydon."</p>
+
+<p>The boy shook his head.</p>
+
+<p>"Don't know nothing as would suit," he said.
+"Why, yer'd get them clothes and any money yet
+had walked off with the wery fust night."</p>
+
+<p>"I should not get a room to myself, I suppose,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_14" id="Page_14">[Pg 14]</a></span>
+even for fourpence?" George asked, making a
+rapid calculation that this would come to two and
+fourpence per week, as much as his mother had
+paid for a comparatively comfortable room in
+Croydon.</p>
+
+<p>The boy opened his eyes in astonishment at his
+companion requiring a room for himself.</p>
+
+<p>"Lor' bless yer, yer'd have a score of them with
+yer!"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't care about a bed," George said. "Just
+some place to sleep in. Just some straw in any
+quiet corner."</p>
+
+<p>This seemed more reasonable to the boy, and he
+thought the matter over.</p>
+
+<p>"Well," he said at last, "I knows of a place
+where they puts up the hosses of the market carts.
+I knows a hostler there. Sometimes when it's
+wery cold he lets me sleep up in the loft. Aint it
+warm and comfortable just! I helps him with the
+hosses sometimes, and that's why. I will ax him if
+yer likes."</p>
+
+<p>George assented at once. His ideas as to the
+possibility of sleeping in the open air had vanished
+when he saw the surroundings, and a bed in a quiet
+loft seemed to him vastly better than sleeping in
+a room with twenty others.</p>
+
+<p>"How do you live?" he asked the lad, "and
+what's your name?"</p>
+
+<p>"They calls me the Shadder," the boy said rather
+proudly; "but my real name's Bill."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_15" id="Page_15">[Pg 15]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Why do they call you the Shadow?" George
+asked.</p>
+
+<p>"'Cause the bobbies finds it so hard to lay hands
+on me," Bill replied.</p>
+
+<p>"But what do they want to lay hands on you
+for?" George asked.</p>
+
+<p>"Why, for bagging things, in course," Bill replied
+calmly.</p>
+
+<p>"Bagging things? Do you mean stealing?"
+George said, greatly shocked.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, not regular prigging," the Shadow replied;
+"not wipes, yer know, nor tickers, nor them
+kind of things. I aint never prigged nothing of
+that kind."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, what is it then you do&mdash;prig?" George
+asked, mystified.</p>
+
+<p>"Apples or cabbages, or a bunch of radishes,
+onions sometimes, or 'taters. That aint regular
+prigging, you know."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, it seems to me the same sort of thing,"
+George said, after a pause.</p>
+
+<p>"I tell yer it aint the same sort of thing at all,"
+the Shadow said angrily. "Everyone as aint a
+fool knows that taters aint wipes, and no one can't
+say as a apple and a ticker are the same."</p>
+
+<p>"No, not the same," George agreed; "but you
+see one is just as much stealing as the other."</p>
+
+<p>"No, it aint," the boy reasserted. "One is the
+same as money and t'other aint. I am hungry and
+I nips a apple off a stall. No one aint the worse for<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_16" id="Page_16">[Pg 16]</a></span>
+it. You don't suppose as they misses a apple here?
+Why, there's wagon-loads of 'em, and lots of 'em is
+rotten. Well, it aint no more if I takes one than
+if it was rotten. Is it now?"</p>
+
+<p>George thought there was a difference, but he
+did not feel equal to explaining it.</p>
+
+<p>"The policemen must think differently," he said
+at last, "else they wouldn't be always trying to
+catch you."</p>
+
+<p>"Who cares for the bobbies?" Bill said contemptuously.
+"I don't; and I don't want no more
+jaw with you about it. If yer don't likes it, yer
+leaves it. I didn't ask for yer company, did I?
+So now then."</p>
+
+<p>George had really taken a fancy to the boy, and
+moreover he saw that in the event of a quarrel his
+chance of finding a refuge for the night was small.
+In his sense of utter loneliness in the great city he
+was loath to break with the only acquaintance he
+had made.</p>
+
+<p>"I didn't mean to offend you, Bill," he said;
+"only I was sorry to hear you say you took things.
+It seems to me you might get into trouble; and it
+would be better after all to work for a living."</p>
+
+<p>"What sort of work?" Bill said derisively.
+"Who's agoing to give me work? Does yer think
+I have only got to walk into a shop and ask for
+'ployment? They wouldn't want to know nothing
+about my character, I suppose? nor where I had
+worked before? nor where my feyther lived? nor<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_17" id="Page_17">[Pg 17]</a></span>
+nothing? Oh, no, of course not! It's blooming
+easy to get work about here; only got to ax for it,
+that's all. Good wages and all found, that's your
+kind."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't suppose it's easy," George said; "but
+it seems to me people could get something to do
+if they tried."</p>
+
+<p>"Tried!" the boy said bitterly. "Do yer think
+we don't try! Why, we are always trying to earn
+a copper or two. Why, we begins at three o'clock
+in the morning when the market-carts come in, and
+we goes on till they comes out of that there theater
+at night, just trying to pick up a copper. Sometimes
+one does and sometimes one doesn't. It's
+a good day, I tell you, when we have made a tanner
+by the end of it. Don't tell me! And now as to
+this ere stable; yer means it?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes," George said; "certainly I mean it."</p>
+
+<p>"Wery well then, you be here at this corner at
+nine o'clock. I will go before that and square it
+with Ned. That's the chap I was speaking of."</p>
+
+<p>"I had better give you something to give him,"
+George said. "Will a shilling do?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, a bob will do for three or four nights.
+Are you going to trust me with it?"</p>
+
+<p>"Of course I am," George replied. "I am sure
+you wouldn't be so mean as to do me out of it; besides,
+you told me that you never stole money and
+those sort of things."</p>
+
+<p>"It aint everyone as would trust me with a bob<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_18" id="Page_18">[Pg 18]</a></span>
+for all that," Bill replied; "and yer are running a
+risk, yer know, and I tells yer if yer goes on with
+that sort of game yer'll get took in rarely afore
+yer've done. Well, hand it over. I aint a-going
+to bilk yer."</p>
+
+<p>The Shadow spoke carelessly, but this proof of
+confidence on the part of his companion really
+touched him, and as he went off he said to himself,
+"He aint a bad sort, that chap, though he is so
+precious green. I must look arter him a bit and
+see he don't get into no mischief."</p>
+
+<p>George, on his part, as he walked away down
+into the Strand again, felt that he had certainly run
+a risk in thus intrusting a tenth of his capital to his
+new acquaintance; but the boy's face and manner
+had attracted him, and he felt that, although the
+Shadow's notions of right and wrong might be of
+a confused nature, he meant to act straight toward
+him.</p>
+
+<p>George passed the intervening hours before the
+time named for his meeting in Covent Garden in
+staring into the shop windows in the Strand, and
+in wondering at the constant stream of vehicles
+and foot passengers flowing steadily out westward.
+He was nearly knocked under the wheels of the
+vehicles a score of times from his ignorance as to
+the rule of the road, and at last he was so confused
+by the jostling and pushing that he was glad to
+turn down a side street and to sit down for a time
+on a doorstep.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_19" id="Page_19">[Pg 19]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>When nine o'clock approached he went into a
+baker's shop and bought a loaf, which would, he
+thought, do for supper and breakfast for himself
+and his companion. Having further invested
+threepence in cheese, he made his way up to the
+market.</p>
+
+<p>The Shadow was standing at the corner whistling
+loudly.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, here yer be! That's all right; come along.
+I have squared Ned, and it's all right."</p>
+
+<p>He led the way down two or three streets and
+then stopped at a gateway.</p>
+
+<p>"You stop here," he said, "and I will see as
+there aint no one but Ned about."</p>
+
+<p>He returned in a minute.</p>
+
+<p>"It's all clear! Ned, he's a-rubbing down a
+hoss; he won't take no notice of yer as yer pass.
+He don't want to see yer, yer know, 'cause in case
+anyone comed and found yer up there he could
+swear he never saw yer go in, and didn't know
+nothing about yer. I will go with yer to the door,
+and then yer will see a ladder in the corner; if yer
+whip up that yer'll find it all right up there."</p>
+
+<p>"But you are coming too, aint you?" George
+asked.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, no, I aint a-coming. Yer don't want a
+chap like me up there. I might pick yer pocket,
+yer know; besides I aint your sort."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, nonsense!" George said. "I should like
+to have you with me, Bill; I should really. Be<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_20" id="Page_20">[Pg 20]</a></span>sides,
+what's the difference between us? We have
+both got to work for ourselves and make our way
+in the world."</p>
+
+<p>"There's a lot of difference. Yer don't talk the
+way as I do; yer have been brought up different.
+Don't tell me."</p>
+
+<p>"I may have been brought up differently, Bill.
+I have been fortunate there; but now, you see, I
+have got to get my living in the best way I can,
+and if I have had a better education than you have,
+you know ever so much more about London and
+how to get your living than I do, so that makes us
+quits."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, wery well," Bill said; "it's all the same
+to this child. So if yer aint too proud, here
+goes."</p>
+
+<p>He led the way down a stable yard, past several
+doors, showing the empty stalls which would be all
+filled when the market carts arrived. At the last
+door on the right he stopped. George looked in.
+At the further end a man was rubbing down a horse
+by the faint light of a lantern, the rest of the stable
+was in darkness.</p>
+
+<p>"This way," Bill whispered.</p>
+
+<p>Keeping close behind him, George entered the
+stable. The boy stopped in the corner.</p>
+
+<p>"Here's the ladder. I will go up fust and give
+yer a hand when yer gets to the top."</p>
+
+<p>George stood quiet until his companion had
+mounted, and then ascended the ladder, which was<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_21" id="Page_21">[Pg 21]</a></span>
+fixed against the wall. Presently a voice whispered
+in his ear:</p>
+
+<p>"Give us your hand. Mind how yer puts your
+foot."</p>
+
+<p>In a minute he was standing in the loft. His
+companion drew him along in the darkness, and in
+a few steps arrived at a pile of hay.</p>
+
+<p>"There yer are," Bill said in a low voice; "yer
+'ave only to make yourself comfortable there.
+Now mind you don't fall down one of the holes
+into the mangers."</p>
+
+<p>"I wish we had a little light," George said, as he
+ensconced himself in the hay.</p>
+
+<p>"I will give you some light in a minute," Bill
+said, as he left his side, and directly afterwards a
+door opened and the light of a gaslight in the yard
+streamed in.</p>
+
+<p>"That's where they pitches the hay in," Bill said
+as he rejoined him. "I shuts it up afore I goes to
+sleep, 'cause the master he comes out sometimes
+when the carts comes in, and there would be a
+blooming row if he saw it open; but we are all
+right now."</p>
+
+<p>"That's much nicer," George said. "Now
+here's a loaf I brought with me. We will cut it in
+half and put by a half for the morning, and eat the
+other half between us now, and I have got some
+cheese here too."</p>
+
+<p>"That's tiptop!" the boy said. "Yer're a good
+sort, I could see that, and I am pretty empty, I<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_22" id="Page_22">[Pg 22]</a></span>
+am, for I aint had nothing except that bit of duff
+yer gave me since morning, and I only had a crust
+then. 'Cept for running against you I aint been
+lucky to-day. Couldn't get a job nohows, and it
+aint for want of trying neither."</p>
+
+<p>For some minutes the boys ate in silence.
+George had given much the largest portion to his
+companion, for he himself was too dead tired to be
+very hungry. When he had finished, he said:</p>
+
+<p>"Look here, Bill; we will talk in the morning.
+I am so dead beat I can scarcely keep my eyes
+open, so I will just say my prayers and go off to
+sleep."</p>
+
+<p>"Say your prayers!" Bill said in astonishment.
+"Do yer mean to say as yer says prayers!"</p>
+
+<p>"Of course I do," George replied; "don't you?"</p>
+
+<p>"Never said one in my life," Bill said decidedly;
+"don't know how, don't see as it would do no good
+ef I did."</p>
+
+<p>"It would do good, Bill," George said. "I
+hope some day you will think differently, and I will
+teach you some you will like."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't want to know none," Bill said positively.
+"A missionary chap, he came and prayed
+with an old woman I lodged with once. I could not
+make head nor tail of it, and she died just the same,
+so you see what good did it do her?"</p>
+
+<p>But George was too tired to enter upon a theological
+argument. He was already half asleep, and
+Bill's voice sounded a long way off.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_23" id="Page_23">[Pg 23]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Good-night," he muttered; "I will talk to you
+in the morning," and in another minute he was fast
+asleep.</p>
+
+<p>Bill took an armful of hay and shook it lightly
+over his companion; then he closed the door of the
+loft and threw himself on the hay, and was soon
+also sound asleep. When George woke in the
+morning the daylight was streaming in through the
+cracks of the door. His companion was gone.
+He heard the voices of several men in the yard,
+while a steady champing noise and an occasional
+shout or the sound of a scraping on the stones told
+him the stalls below were all full now.</p>
+
+<p>George felt that he had better remain where he
+was. Bill had told him the evening before that
+the horses and carts generally set out again at
+about nine o'clock, and he thought he had better
+wait till they had gone before he slipped down below.
+Closing his eyes he was very soon off to
+sleep again. When he woke, Bill was sitting by
+his side looking at him.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, you are a oner to sleep," the boy said.
+"Why, it's nigh ten o'clock, and it's time for us to
+be moving. Ned will be going off in a few minutes,
+and the stables will be locked up till the evening."</p>
+
+<p>"Is there time to eat our bread and cheese?"
+George asked.</p>
+
+<p>"No, we had better eat it when we get down to
+the market; come along."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_24" id="Page_24">[Pg 24]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>George at once rose, shook the hay off his
+clothes, and descended the ladder, Bill leading the
+way. There was no one in the stable, and the yard
+was also empty. On reaching the market they sat
+down on two empty baskets, and at once began to
+eat their bread and cheese.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_25" id="Page_25">[Pg 25]</a></span></p>
+<h2><a name="CHAPTER_II" id="CHAPTER_II"></a>CHAPTER II.</h2>
+
+<h3>TWO FRIENDS.</h3>
+
+
+<p>"I did wake before, Bill," George said after he
+had eaten a few mouthfuls; "but you were out."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, I turned out as soon as the carts began to
+come in," Bill said, "and a wery good morning I
+have had. One old chap gave me twopence for
+looking arter his hoss and cart while he went into
+the market with his flowers. But the best move
+was just now. A chap as was driving off with
+flowers, one of them swell West-end shops, I expect,
+by the look of the trap, let his rug fall. He didn't
+see it till I ran after him with it, then he gave me a
+tanner; that was something like. Have yer finished
+yer bread and cheese?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes," George said, "and I could manage a drink
+of water if I could get one."</p>
+
+<p>"There's a fountain handy," Bill said; "but you
+come along with me, I am agoing to stand two cups
+of coffee if yer aint too proud to take it;" and he
+looked doubtfully at his companion.</p>
+
+<p>"I am not at all too proud," George said, for he
+saw that the slightest hesitation would hurt his
+companion's feelings.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_26" id="Page_26">[Pg 26]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"It aint fust-rate coffee," Bill said, as with a
+brightened look on his face he turned and led the
+way to a little coffee-stall; "but it's hot and sweet,
+and yer can't expect more nor that for a penny."</p>
+
+<p>George found the coffee really better than he had
+expected, and Bill was evidently very much gratified
+at his expression of approval.</p>
+
+<p>"Now," he said, when they had both finished,
+"for a draw of 'baccy," and he produced a short
+clay pipe. "Don't yer smoke?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, I haven't begun yet."</p>
+
+<p>"Ah! ye don't know what a comfort a pipe is,"
+Bill said. "Why, when yer are cold and hungry
+and down on your luck a pipe is a wonderful thing,
+and so cheap; why, a ounce of 'baccy will fill yer
+thirty pipes if yer don't squeeze it in too hard.
+Well, an ounce of 'baccy costs threepence halfpenny,
+so, as I makes out, yer gets eight pipes for a
+penny; and now," he went on when he had filled
+and lit his pipe, "let's know what's yer game."</p>
+
+<p>"You mean what am I going to do?" George
+asked.</p>
+
+<p>Bill nodded.</p>
+
+<p>"I want to get employment in some sort of works.
+I have been an errand-boy in a grocer's for more
+than a year, and I have got a written character from
+my master in my pocket; but I don't like the sort of
+thing; I would rather work with my own hands.
+There are plenty of works where they employ boys,
+and you know one might get on as one gets older.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_27" id="Page_27">[Pg 27]</a></span>
+The first thing is to find out whereabouts works of
+that sort are."</p>
+
+<p>"There are lots of works at the East End, I have
+heard tell," Bill said; "and then there's Clerkenwell
+and King's Cross, they aint so far off, and there are
+works there, all sorts of works, I should say; but I
+don't know nuffin' about that sort of work. The
+only work as I have done is holding hosses and carrying
+plants into the market, and sometimes when
+I have done pretty well I goes down and lays out
+what I got in <i>Echoes</i>, or <i>Globes</i>, or <i>Evening Standards</i>;
+that pays yer, that does, for if yer can sell them
+all yer will get a bob for eight penn'orth of papers,
+that gives yer fourpence for an hour's work, and I
+calls that blooming good, and can't yer get a tuck-out
+for a bob! Oh, no, I should think not! Well,
+what shall it be? I knows the way out to Whitechapel
+and to Clerkenwell, so whichever yer likes I
+can show yer."</p>
+
+<p>"If Clerkenwell's the nearest we may as well try
+that first," George said, "and I shall be much
+obliged to you for showing the way."</p>
+
+<p>The two boys spent the whole day in going from
+workshop to workshop for employment; but the answers
+to his application were unvarying: either he
+was too young or there was no place vacant.
+George took the disappointment quietly, for he had
+made up his mind that he would have difficulty in
+getting a place; but Bill became quite angry on behalf
+of his companion.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_28" id="Page_28">[Pg 28]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"This is worse nor the market," he said. "A
+chap can pick up a few coppers there, and here we
+have been a-tramping about all day and aint done
+nothing."</p>
+
+<p>Day after day George set out on his quest, but all
+was without success. He and Bill still slept in the
+loft, and after the first day he took to getting up at
+the same time as his companion, and going out with
+him to try and pick up a few pence from the men
+with the market-carts. Every other morning they
+were able to lie later, as there were only regular
+marketdays three mornings a week.</p>
+
+<p>On market mornings he found that he earned
+more than Bill, his better clothes giving him an advantage,
+as the men were more willing to trust their
+carts and rugs to the care of a quiet, respectable-looking
+boy than to that of the arabs who frequented
+the Garden. But all that was earned was laid out in
+common between the two boys, and George found
+himself seldom obliged to draw above a few pence
+on his private stock. He had by this time told the
+Shadow exactly how much money he had, and the
+boy, seeing the difficulty that George found in getting
+work, was most averse to the store being
+trenched upon, and always gave his vote against the
+smallest addition to their ordinary fare of bread
+and cheese being purchased, except from their earnings
+of the day. This George felt was the more
+creditable on Bill's part, inasmuch as the latter had,
+in deference to his prejudices, abstained from the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_29" id="Page_29">[Pg 29]</a></span>
+petty thefts of fruit with which before he had seasoned
+his dry crusts.</p>
+
+<p>George had learned now what Bill knew of his
+history, which was little enough. He supposed he
+had had a father, but he knew nothing of him;
+whether he had died, or whether he had cut away
+and left mother, Bill had no idea. His mother he
+remembered well, though she had died when he was,
+as he said, a little chap. He spoke of her always in
+a hushed voice, and in a tone of reverence, as a superior
+being.</p>
+
+<p>"We was poor, you know," he said to George,
+"and I know mother was often short of grub, but
+she was just kind. I don't never remember her
+whacking me; always spoke soft and low like; she
+was good, she was. She used to pray, you know,
+and what I remember most is as the night afore she
+was took away to a hospital she says, 'Try and live
+honest, Bill; it will be hard, but try, my boy. Don't
+you take to stealing, however poor you may be;'
+and I aint," Bill said earnestly over and over again.
+"When I has seed any chap going along with a
+ticker handy, which I could have boned and got
+away among the carts as safe as ninepence, or when
+I has seed a woman with her purse a-sticking out of
+them outside pockets, and I aint had a penny to
+bless myself with, and perhaps nothing to eat all day,
+I have felt it hard not to make a grab; but I just
+thought of what she said, and I aint done it. As I
+told yer, I have often nabbed things off the stalls or<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_30" id="Page_30">[Pg 30]</a></span>
+out of the baskets or carts. It didn't seem to me as
+that was stealing, but as you says it is, I aint going
+to do so no more. Now look yer here, George; they
+tells me as the parsons says as when people die and
+they are good they goes up there, yer know."</p>
+
+<p>George nodded, for there was a question in his
+companion's tone.</p>
+
+<p>"Then, of course," Bill went on, "she is up there.
+Now it aint likely as ever I should see her again,
+'cause, you know, there aint nothing good about
+me; but if she was to come my way, wherever I
+might be, and was to say to me, 'Bill, have you been
+a-stealing?' do yer think she would feel very bad
+about them 'ere apples and things?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, Bill, I am sure she would not. You see
+you didn't quite know that was stealing, and you
+kept from stealing the things that you thought she
+spoke of, and now that you see it is wrong taking
+even little things you are not going to take them
+any more."</p>
+
+<p>"That I won't, so help me bob!" the boy said;
+"not if I never gets another apple between my
+teeth."</p>
+
+<p>"That's right, Bill. You see you ought to do it,
+not only to please your mother, but to please God.
+That's what my mother has told me over and over
+again."</p>
+
+<p>"Has she now?" Bill said with great interest,
+"and did you use to prig apples and sichlike sometimes?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_31" id="Page_31">[Pg 31]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"No," George said, "not that sort of thing; but
+she was talking of things in general. Of doing
+things that were wrong, such as telling lies and deceiving,
+and that sort of thing."</p>
+
+<p>"And your mother thinks as God knows all about
+it?"</p>
+
+<p>George nodded.</p>
+
+<p>"And that he don't like it, eh, when things is done
+bad?"</p>
+
+<p>George nodded again.</p>
+
+<p>"Lor', what a time he must have of it!" Bill
+said in solemn wonder. "Why, I heard a woman
+say last week as six children was enough to worrit
+anyone into the grave; and just to think of all of
+us!" and Bill waved his arm in a comprehensive
+way and repeated, "What a time he must have
+of it!"</p>
+
+<p>For a time the boys sat silent in their loft, Bill
+wondering over the problem that had presented
+itself to him, and George trying to find some appropriate
+explanation in reply to the difficulty Bill had
+started. At last he said:</p>
+
+<p>"I am afraid, Bill, that I can't explain all this to
+you, for I am not accustomed to talk about such
+things. My mother talks to me sometimes, and of
+course I went to church regularly; but that's different
+from my talking about it; but you know what
+we have got to do is to try and please God, and love
+him because he loves us."</p>
+
+<p>"That's whear it is," Bill said; "that's what I've<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_32" id="Page_32">[Pg 32]</a></span>
+heard fellows say beats 'em. If he loves a chap like
+me how is it he don't do something for him? why
+don't he get you a place, for instance? You aint
+been a-prigging apples or a-putting him out.
+That's what I wants to know."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, Bill, but as I have heard my mother say, it
+would be very hard to understand if this world were
+the only one; but you see we are only here a little
+time, and after that there's on and on and on, right
+up without any end, and what does it matter if we
+are poor or unhappy in this little time if we are
+going to be ever so happy afterwards? This is only
+a sort of little trial to see how we behave, as it were,
+and if we do the best we can, even though that best
+is very little, then you see we get a tremendous reward.
+For instance, you would not think a man
+was unkind who kept you five minutes holding his
+horse on a cold day, if he were going to give you
+enough to get you clothes and good lodging for the
+rest of your life."</p>
+
+<p>"No, I should think not," Bill said fervently; "so
+it's like that, is it?"</p>
+
+<p>George nodded. "Like that, only more."</p>
+
+<p>"My eye!" Bill murmured to himself, lost in
+astonishment at this new view of things.</p>
+
+<p>After that there were few evenings when, before
+they nestled themselves down in the hay, the boys
+did not talk on this subject. At first George felt
+awkward and nervous in speaking of it, for like the
+generality of English boys, however earnest their<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_33" id="Page_33">[Pg 33]</a></span>
+convictions may be, he was shy of speaking what he
+felt; but his companion's eagerness to know more
+of this, to him, new story encouraged him to speak,
+and having in his bundle a small Bible which his
+mother had given him, he took to reading to Bill a
+chapter or two in the mornings when they had not
+to go out to the early market.</p>
+
+<p>It is true that Bill's questions frequently puzzled
+him. The boy saw things in a light so wholly different
+from that in which he himself had been accustomed
+to regard them that he found a great
+difficulty in replying to them.</p>
+
+<p>George wrote a letter to his mother, telling her
+exactly what he was doing, for he knew that if he
+only said that he had not yet succeeded in getting
+work she would be very anxious about him, and although
+he had nothing satisfactory to tell her, at
+least he could tell her that he had sufficient to eat
+and as much comfort as he cared for. Twice he received
+replies from her, directed to him at a little
+coffee-house, which, when they had had luck, the
+boys occasionally patronized. As time went on
+without his succeeding in obtaining employment
+George's hopes fell, and at last he said to his mate;
+"I will try for another fortnight, Bill, and if at the
+end of that time I don't get anything to do I shall go
+back to Croydon again."</p>
+
+<p>"But yer can earn yer living here!" Bill remonstrated.</p>
+
+<p>"I can earn enough to prevent me from starving,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_34" id="Page_34">[Pg 34]</a></span>
+but that is all, Bill. I came up to London in hopes
+of getting something to do by which I might some
+day make my way up; if I were to stop here like this
+I should be going down, and a nice sight I should be
+to mother if, when she gets well enough to come out
+of the infirmary, I were to go back all in rags."</p>
+
+<p>"What sort of a place is Croydon?" Bill asked.
+"Is there any chance of picking up a living there?
+'cause I tells yer fair, if yer goes off I goes with yer.
+I aint a-thinking of living with yer, George; but we
+might see each other sometime, mightn't we? Yer
+wouldn't mind that?"</p>
+
+<p>"Mind it! certainly not, Bill! You have been a
+good friend to me, and I should be sorry to think of
+you all alone here."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, blow being a good friend to yer!" Bill replied.
+"I aint done nothing except put yer in the
+way of getting a sleeping-place, and as it's given me
+one too I have had the best of that job. It's been
+good of yer to take up with a chap like me as don't
+know how to read or write or nothing, and as aint
+no good anyway. But you will let me go with yer
+to Croydon, won't yer?"</p>
+
+<p>"Certainly I will, Bill; but you won't be able to
+see much of me. I shall have to get a place like the
+last. The man I was with said he would take me
+back again if I wanted to come, and you know I am
+all day in the shop or going out with parcels, and of
+course you would have to be busy too at something."</p>
+
+<p>"What sort of thing do yer think, George? I<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_35" id="Page_35">[Pg 35]</a></span>
+can hold a hoss, but that aint much for a living.
+One may go for days without getting a chance."</p>
+
+<p>"I should say, Bill, that your best chance would
+be to try and get work either in a brickfield or with a
+market-gardener. At any rate we should be able
+to get a talk for half an hour in the evening. I was
+always done at nine o'clock, and if we were both in
+work we could take a room together."</p>
+
+<p>Bill shook his head.</p>
+
+<p>"That would be wery nice, but I couldn't have it,
+George. I knows as I aint fit company for yer, and
+if yer was with a shop-keeping bloke he would think
+yer was going to run off with the money if he knew
+yer kept company with a chap like me. No, the
+'greement must be as yer goes yer ways and I goes
+mine; but I hopes as yer will find suffin to do up
+here, not 'cause as I wouldn't like to go down to this
+place of yourn, but because yer have set yer heart on
+getting work here."</p>
+
+<p>A week later the two boys were out late in Covent
+Garden trying to earn a few pence by fetching
+up cabs and carriages for people coming out from a
+concert in the floral hall. George had just succeeded
+in earning threepence, and had returned to
+the entrance to the hall, and was watching the people
+come out, and trying to get another job. Presently
+a gentleman, with a girl of some nine or ten years
+old, came out and took their place on the footpath.</p>
+
+<p>"Can I call you a carriage, sir?" George asked.</p>
+
+<p>"No, thank you, lad, a man has gone for it."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_36" id="Page_36">[Pg 36]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>George fell back and stood watching the girl, who
+was in a white dress, with a little hood trimmed with
+swansdown over her head.</p>
+
+<p>Presently his eye fell on something on which the
+light glittered as it hung from her neck. Just as he
+was looking a hand reached over her shoulder,
+there was a jerk, and a sudden cry from the child,
+then a boy dived into the crowd, and at the same
+moment George dashed after him. There was a
+cry of "Stop, thief!" and several hands made a grab
+at George as he dived through the crowd; but he
+slipped through them and was soon in the roadway.</p>
+
+<p>Some twenty yards ahead of him he saw the boy
+running. He turned up Bow Street and then
+dashed down an alley. He did not know that he
+was followed until suddenly George sprang upon
+his back, and the two fell with a crash, the young
+thief undermost. George seized his right hand, and
+kneeling upon him, twisted it behind his back and
+forced him to open his fingers, the boy, taken by surprise,
+and not knowing who was his assailant, making
+but slight resistance.</p>
+
+<p>George seized the gold locket and dashed back at
+full speed into the market, and was soon in the thick
+of the crowd round the entrance. The gentleman
+was standing talking to a policeman, who was taking
+a note of the description of the lost trinket.
+The girl was standing by crying.</p>
+
+<p>"Here is your locket," George said, putting it<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_37" id="Page_37">[Pg 37]</a></span>
+into her hand. "I saw the boy take it, and have
+got it from him."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, papa! papa!" the girl cried. "Here is my
+locket again."</p>
+
+<p>"Why, where did you get it from?" her father
+asked in astonishment.</p>
+
+<p>"This boy has just given it to me," she replied.
+"He says he took it from the boy who stole it."</p>
+
+<p>"Which boy, Nellie? Which is the boy who
+brought it back?"</p>
+
+<p>The girl looked round, but George was gone.</p>
+
+<p>"Why didn't you stop him, my dear?" her
+father said. "Of course I should wish to thank
+and reward him, for the locket was a very valuable
+one, and the more so to us from its having belonged
+to your mother. Did you notice the boy, policeman?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, sir, I did not see him at all."</p>
+
+<p>"Was he a poor boy, Nellie?"</p>
+
+<p>"Not a very, very poor boy, father," the girl replied.
+"At least I don't think so; but I only looked
+at his face. He didn't speak like a poor boy at
+all."</p>
+
+<p>"Would you know him again?"</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, yes, I am sure I should. He was a good-looking
+boy with a nice face."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, I am very sorry he has gone away, my
+dear. Evidently he does not want a reward, but at
+any rate I should have liked to thank him. Are you
+always on this beat, policeman?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_38" id="Page_38">[Pg 38]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"I am on night duty, sir, while the concerts are
+on."</p>
+
+<p>"At any rate, I dare say you know the constables
+who are about here in the daytime. I wish you
+would mention the fact to them, and ask them if
+they get any clew to the boy who has rendered me
+this service, to let me know. Here is a card with
+my name and address."</p>
+
+<p>After restoring the locket George made his way
+to the entrance to the stables, where he generally met
+Bill after the theater had closed and there was no
+farther chance of earning money. It was not till
+half an hour later that the boy came running up.</p>
+
+<p>"I have got eightpence," he said. "That is
+something like luck. I got three jobs. One stood
+me fourpence, the other two gave me tuppence each.
+What do yer say? Shall we have a cup of coffee
+afore we turns in?"</p>
+
+<p>"I think we had better not, Bill. I have got sixpence.
+We will put that by, with the sixpence we
+saved the other day, for the hostler. We haven't
+given him anything for some time. Your eightpence
+will get us a good breakfast in the morning."</p>
+
+<p>When they had comfortably nestled themselves
+in the hay George told his companion how he had
+rescued and restored the locket.</p>
+
+<p>"And he didn't give yer nuffin! I never heerd
+tell of such a scaly trick as that. I should ha' said it
+ought to have been good for a bob anyway."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_39" id="Page_39">[Pg 39]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"I did not wait to see, Bill. Directly I had given
+the little girl her locket I bolted."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, that were soft. Why couldn't yer have
+waited to have seen what the bloke meant to give
+yer?"</p>
+
+<p>"I did not want to be paid for such a thing as
+that," George replied. "I don't mind being paid
+when I have done a job for anyone; but this was
+different altogether."</p>
+
+<p>Bill meditated for a minute or two.</p>
+
+<p>"I can't see no difference, nohow," he said at last.
+"Yer did him a good turn, and got the thing back.
+I dare say it were worth five bob."</p>
+
+<p>"A good deal more than that, Bill."</p>
+
+<p>"More nor that! Well, then, he ought to have
+come down handsome. Didn't yer run like winking,
+and didn't yer jump on the chap's back and
+knock him down, and didn't yer run back again?
+And warn't there a chance, ef one of the bobbies
+had got hold of yer collar and found it in yer hand,
+of yer being had up for stealing it? And then yer
+walks off and don't give him a chance of giving yer
+nuffin. My eye, but yer are a flat!"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't suppose you will quite understand, Bill.
+But when people do a thing to oblige somebody, and
+not as a piece of regular work, they don't expect to
+be paid. I shouldn't have liked it if they had offered
+me money for such a thing."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, ef yer says so, no doubt it's right," Bill
+rejoined; "but it seems a rum sort of notion to me.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_40" id="Page_40">[Pg 40]</a></span>
+When people loses things they expects to pay to get
+'em back. Why, don't yer see outside the p'lice
+station, and in the shop winders, papers offering so
+much for giving back things as is lost. I can't read
+'em myself, yer know; but chaps have read 'em to
+me. Why, I've heerd of as much as five quid being
+offered for watches and sichlike as was lost by ladies
+coming out of theayters, and I have often thought
+what a turn of luck it would be to light on one of
+'em. And now yer says as I oughtn't to take the
+money ef I found it."</p>
+
+<p>"No, I don't say that, Bill. If you found a thing
+and saw a reward offered, and you wanted the
+money, you would have good right to take it. But,
+you see, in this case I saw how sorry the girl was at
+losing her locket, and I went after it to please her,
+and I was quite content that I got it back for
+her."</p>
+
+<p>Bill tried again to think the matter over in his
+mind, but he was getting warm and sleepy, and in
+a few minutes was sound off.</p>
+
+<p>Two or three days later the lads had, to their great
+satisfaction, obtained a job. Walnuts were just
+coming in, and the boys were engaged to take off the
+green shucks. Bill was particularly pleased, for he
+had never before been taken on for such a job, and
+he considered it a sort of promotion. Five or six
+women were also employed, and as the group were
+standing round some great baskets Bill suddenly
+nudged his friend:<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_41" id="Page_41">[Pg 41]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"I say, my eye, aint that little gal pretty?"</p>
+
+<p>George looked up from his work and at once
+recognized the girl to whom he had restored the
+locket. Her eye fell on him at the same moment.</p>
+
+<p>"There, papa!" she exclaimed. "I told you if
+you brought me down to the market I felt sure I
+should know the boy again if I saw him. That's
+him, the one looking down into the basket. But he
+knew me again, for I saw him look surprised when
+he noticed me."</p>
+
+<p>The gentleman made his way through the women
+to George.</p>
+
+<p>"My lad, are you the boy who restored the locket
+to my daughter three evenings ago?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sir," George said, coloring as he looked
+up. "I was standing close by when the boy took it,
+so I gave chase and brought it back, and that's all."</p>
+
+<p>"You were off again in such a hurry that we
+hadn't time to thank you. Just come across to my
+daughter. I suppose you can leave your work for
+a minute?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sir. We are working by the job," George
+said, and looking rather shamefaced he followed the
+gentleman to the sidewalk.</p>
+
+<p>"This is your boy, as you call him, Nellie."</p>
+
+<p>"I was sure I should know him again," the child
+said, "though I only saw him for a moment. We
+are very much obliged to you, boy, papa and me, because
+it had been mamma's locket, and we should
+have been very sorry to have lost it."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_42" id="Page_42">[Pg 42]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"I am glad I was able to get it back for you,"
+George said; "but I don't want to be thanked for
+doing it; and I don't want to be paid either, thank
+you, sir," he said, flushing as the gentleman put his
+hand into his pocket.</p>
+
+<p>"No! and why not?" the gentleman said in surprise.
+"You have done me a great service, and
+there is no reason why I should not pay you for it.
+If I had lost it I would gladly have paid a reward to
+get it back."</p>
+
+<p>"Thank you, sir," George said quietly; "but all
+the same I would rather not be paid for a little thing
+like that."</p>
+
+<p>"You are a strange fellow," the gentleman said
+again. "One does not expect to find a boy in the
+market here refusing money when he has earned it."</p>
+
+<p>"I should not refuse it if I had earned it," George
+said; "but I don't call getting back a locket for a
+young lady who has lost it earning money."</p>
+
+<p>"How do you live, lad? You don't speak like a
+boy who has been brought up in the market here."</p>
+
+<p>"I have only been here three months," George
+said. "I came up to London to look for work, but
+could not get any. Most days I go about looking
+for it, and do what odd jobs I can get when there's
+a chance."</p>
+
+<p>"What sort of work do you want? Have you
+been accustomed to any work? Perhaps I could
+help you."</p>
+
+<p>"I have been a year as an errand-boy," George<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_43" id="Page_43">[Pg 43]</a></span>
+answered; "but I didn't like it, and I thought I
+would rather get some sort of work that I could
+work at when I got to be a man instead of sticking
+in a shop."</p>
+
+<p>"Did you run away from home, then?" the gentleman
+asked.</p>
+
+<p>"No, sir. My mother was ill and went into an
+infirmary, and so as I was alone I thought I would
+come to London and try to get the sort of work I
+liked; but I have tried almost all over London."</p>
+
+<p>"And are you all alone here?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, sir, not quite alone. I found a friend in
+that boy there, and we have worked together since I
+came up."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, lad, if you really want work I can give it
+you."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, thank you, sir!" George exclaimed fervently.</p>
+
+<p>"And your friend too, if he likes. I have some
+works down at Limehouse and employ a good many
+boys. Here is the address;" and he took a card
+from his pocket, wrote a few words on the back of
+it, and handed it to George.</p>
+
+<p>"Ask for the foreman, and give him that, and he
+will arrange for you to begin work on Monday.
+Come along, Nellie; we have got to buy the fruit for
+to-morrow, you know."</p>
+
+<p>So saying he took his daughter's hand, and
+George, wild with delight, ran off to tell Bill that he
+had obtained work for them both.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_44" id="Page_44">[Pg 44]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Well, Nellie, are you satisfied?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, I am glad you could give him work, papa;
+didn't he look pleased? Wasn't it funny his saying
+he wouldn't have any money?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes; I hardly expected to have met with a refusal
+in Covent Garden; but you were right, child,
+and you are a better judge of character than I gave
+you credit for. You said he was a nice-looking lad,
+and spoke like a gentleman, and he does. He is
+really a very good style of boy. Of course he is
+shabby and dirty now, and you see he has been an
+errand-boy at a grocer's; but he must have been better
+brought up than the generality of such lads.
+The one he called his friend looked a wild sort of
+specimen, altogether a different sort of boy. I
+should say he was one of the regular arabs hanging
+about this place. If so, I expect a very few days'
+work will sicken him; but I shouldn't be surprised
+if your boy, as you call him, sticks to it."</p>
+
+<p>The next morning the two boys presented themselves
+at Mr. Penrose's works at Limehouse. These
+were sawing and planing works, and the sound of
+many wheels, and the hoarse rasping sound of saws
+innumerable, came out through the open windows
+of the building as they entered the yard.</p>
+
+<p>"Now what do you boys want?" a workman said
+as he appeared at one of the doors.</p>
+
+<p>"We want to see the foreman," George said. "I
+have a card for him from Mr. Penrose."</p>
+
+<p>"I will let him know," the man replied.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_45" id="Page_45">[Pg 45]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Two minutes later the foreman came out, and
+George handed him the card. He read what Mr.
+Penrose had written upon it and said:</p>
+
+<p>"Very well, you can come in on Monday; pay,
+eight shillings a week; seven o'clock; there, that will
+do. Oh, what are your names?" taking out a
+pocket-book. "George Andrews and William
+Smith;" and then, with a nod, he went back into his
+room, while the boys, almost bewildered at the
+rapidity with which the business had been arranged,
+went out into the street again.</p>
+
+<p>"There we are, Bill, employed," George said in
+delight.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, there we is," Bill agreed, but in a more
+doubtful tone; "it's a rum start, aint it? I don't
+expect I shall make much hand of it, but I am wery
+glad for you, George."</p>
+
+<p>"Why shouldn't you make much hand of it?
+You are as strong as I am."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes; but then, you see, I aint been accustomed
+to work regular, and I expect I shan't like it&mdash;not
+at first; but I am going to try. George, don't
+yer think as I aint agoing to try. I aint that sort;
+still I expects I shall get the sack afore long."</p>
+
+<p>"Nonsense, Bill! you will like it when you once
+get accustomed to it, and it's a thousand times better
+having to draw your pay regularly at the end of the
+week than to get up in the morning not knowing
+whether you are going to have breakfast or not.
+Won't mother be pleased when I write and tell her<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_46" id="Page_46">[Pg 46]</a></span>
+I have got a place! Last time she wrote she said
+that she was a great deal better, and the doctor
+thought she would be out in the spring, and then I
+hope she will be coming up here, and that will be
+jolly."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, that's just it," Bill said; "that's whear it
+is; you and I will get on fust-rate, but it aint likely
+as your mother would put up with a chap like me."</p>
+
+<p>"My mother knows that you have been a good
+friend to me, Bill, and that will be quite enough
+for her. You wait till you see her."</p>
+
+<p>"My eye, what a lot of little houses there is about
+here!" Bill said, "just all the same pattern; and
+how wide the streets is to what they is up Drury
+Lane!"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, we ought to have no difficulty in getting a
+room here, Bill, now that we shall have money to
+pay for it; only think, we shall have sixteen shillings
+a week between us!"</p>
+
+<p>"It's a lot of money," Bill said vaguely. "Sixteen
+bob! My eye, there aint no saying what it
+will buy! I wish I looked a little bit more respectable,"
+he said, with a new feeling as to the deficiencies
+of his attire. "It didn't matter in the Garden;
+but to go to work with a lot of other chaps, these
+togs aint what you may call spicy."</p>
+
+<p>"They certainly are not, Bill," George said with
+a laugh. "We must see what we can manage."</p>
+
+<p>George's own clothes were worn and old, but they
+looked respectable indeed by the side of those of his<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_47" id="Page_47">[Pg 47]</a></span>
+companion. Bill's elbows were both out, the jacket
+was torn and ragged, he had no waistcoat, and his
+trousers were far too large for him, and were kept
+up by a single brace, and were patched in a dozen
+places.</p>
+
+<p>When George first met him he was shoeless, but
+soon after they had set up housekeeping together
+George had bought from a cobbler's stall a pair of
+boots for two shillings, and these, although now almost
+falling to pieces, were still the best part of
+Bill's outfit.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_48" id="Page_48">[Pg 48]</a></span></p>
+<h2><a name="CHAPTER_III" id="CHAPTER_III"></a>CHAPTER III.</h2>
+
+<h3>WORK.</h3>
+
+
+<p>The next morning George went out with the
+bundle containing his Sunday clothes, which had
+been untouched since his arrival in town, and going
+to an old-clothes shop he exchanged them for a suit
+of working clothes in fair condition, and then returning
+hid his bundle in the hay and rejoined Bill,
+who had from early morning been at work shelling
+walnuts. Although Bill was somewhat surprised
+at his companion not beginning work at the usual
+time he asked no questions, for his faith in George
+was so unbounded that everything he did was right
+in his eyes.</p>
+
+<p>"There is our last day's work in the market, Bill,"
+George said as they reached their loft that evening.</p>
+
+<p>"It's your last day's work, George, I aint no
+doubt; but I expects it aint mine by a long way. I
+have been a-thinking over this 'ere go, and I don't
+think as it will act nohow. In the first place I aint
+fit to go to such a place, and they are sure to make
+it hot for me."</p>
+
+<p>"That's nonsense, Bill; there are lots of roughish
+sort of boys in works of that sort, and you will soon
+be at home with the rest."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_49" id="Page_49">[Pg 49]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"In the next place," Bill went on, unheeding the
+interruption, "I shall be getting into some blooming
+row or other afore I have been there a week, and
+they will like enough turn you out as well as me.
+That's what I am a-thinking most on, George. If
+they chucks me the chances are as they chucks you
+too; and if they did that arter all the pains you have
+had to get a place I should go straight off and make
+a hole in the water. That's how I looks at it."</p>
+
+<p>"But I don't think, Bill, that there's any chance
+of your getting into a row. Of course at first we
+must both expect to be blown up sometimes, but if
+we do our best and don't answer back again we shall
+do as well as the others."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, I shouldn't cheek 'em back," Bill said. "I
+am pretty well used to getting blown up. Every
+one's always at it, and I know well enough as it
+don't pay to cheek back, not unless you have got a
+market-cart between you and a clear road for a bolt.
+I wasn't born yesterday. Yer've been wery good to
+me, you have, George, and before any harm should
+come to yer through me, s'help me, I'd chuck myself
+under a market-wagon."</p>
+
+<p>"I know you would, Bill; but, whatever you say,
+you have been a far greater help to me than I have
+to you. Anyhow we are not going to part now.
+You are coming to work with me to start with, and
+I know you will do your best to keep your place.
+If you fail, well, so much the worse, it can't be
+helped; but after our being sent there by Mr. Pen<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_50" id="Page_50">[Pg 50]</a></span>rose
+I feel quite sure that the foreman would not
+turn me off even if he had to get rid of you."</p>
+
+<p>"D'yer think so?"</p>
+
+<p>"I do, indeed, Bill."</p>
+
+<p>"Will yer take yer davey?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, if it's any satisfaction to you, Bill, I will
+take my davey that I do not think that they would
+turn me off even if they sent you away."</p>
+
+<p>"And yer really wants me to go with yer, so help
+yer?"</p>
+
+<p>"Really and truly, Bill."</p>
+
+<p>"Wery well, George, then I goes; but mind yer,
+it's 'cause yer wishes me."</p>
+
+<p>So saying, Bill curled himself up in the hay, and
+George soon heard by his regular breathing that he
+was sound asleep.</p>
+
+<p>The next morning, before anyone was stirring,
+they went down into the yard, as was their custom
+on Sunday mornings, for a good wash, stripping to
+the waist and taking it by turns to pump over each
+other. Bill had at first protested against the
+fashion, saying as he did very well and did not see
+no use in it; but seeing that George really enjoyed it
+he followed his example. After a morning or two,
+indeed, and with the aid of a piece of soap which
+George had bought, Bill got himself so bright and
+shiny as to excite much sarcastic comment and remark
+from his former companions, which led to
+more than one pugilistic encounter.</p>
+
+<p>That morning George remained behind in the loft<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_51" id="Page_51">[Pg 51]</a></span>
+for a minute or two after Bill had run down, attired
+only in his trousers. When Bill went up the ladder
+after his ablutions he began hunting about in the
+hay.</p>
+
+<p>"What are you up to, Bill?"</p>
+
+<p>"Blest if I can find my shirt. Here's two of
+yourn knocking about, but I can't see where's mine,
+nor my jacket neither."</p>
+
+<p>"It's no use your looking, Bill, for you won't find
+them, and even if you found them you couldn't put
+'em on. I have torn them up."</p>
+
+<p>"Torn up my jacket!" Bill exclaimed in consternation.
+"What lark are yer up to now, George?"</p>
+
+<p>"No lark at all. We are going together to work
+to-morrow, and you could not go as you were; so
+you put on that shirt and those things," and he
+threw over the clothes he had procured the day
+before.</p>
+
+<p>Bill looked in astonishment.</p>
+
+<p>"Why, where did yer get 'em, George? I knows
+yer only had four bob with what we got yesterday.
+Yer didn't find 'em, and yer didn't&mdash;no, in course
+yer didn't&mdash;nip 'em."</p>
+
+<p>"No, I didn't steal them certainly," George said,
+laughing. "I swapped my Sunday clothes for them
+yesterday. I can do without them very well till we
+earn enough to get another suit. There, don't say
+anything about it, Bill, else I will punch your
+head."</p>
+
+<p>Bill stared at him with open eyes for a minute,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_52" id="Page_52">[Pg 52]</a></span>
+and then threw himself down in the hay and burst
+into tears.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, I say, don't do that!" George exclaimed.
+"What have you to cry about?"</p>
+
+<p>"Aint it enough to make a cove cry," Bill sobbed,
+"to find a chap doing things for him like that? I
+wish I may die if I don't feel as if I should bust.
+It's too much, that's what it is, and it's all on one
+side; that's the wust of it."</p>
+
+<p>"I dare say you will make it even some time, Bill;
+so don't let's say anything more about it, but put
+on your clothes. We will have a cup of coffee each
+and a loaf between us for breakfast, and then we will
+go for a walk into the park, the same as we did last
+Sunday, and hear the preaching."</p>
+
+<p>The next morning they were up at their accustomed
+hour and arrived at the works at Limehouse
+before the doors were opened. Presently some men
+and boys arrived, the doors were opened, and the
+two boys followed the others in.</p>
+
+<p>"Hallo! who are you?" the man at the gate
+asked.</p>
+
+<p>George gave their names, and the man looked at
+his time-book.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, it's all right; you are the new boys. You
+are to go into that planing-shop," and he pointed to
+one of the doors opening into the yard.</p>
+
+<p>The boys were not long before they were at work.
+Bill was ordered to take planks from a large pile
+and to hand them to a man, who passed them under<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_53" id="Page_53">[Pg 53]</a></span>
+one of the planing-machines. George was told to
+take them away as fast as they were finished and
+pile them against a wall. When the machines
+stopped for any adjustment or alteration both were
+to sweep up the shavings and ram them into bags,
+in which they were carried to the engine-house.</p>
+
+<p>For a time the boys were almost dazzled by the
+whirl of the machinery, the rapid motion of the
+numerous wheels and shafting overhead, and of the
+broad bands which carried the power from them to
+the machinery on the floor, by the storm of shavings
+which flew from the cutters, and the unceasing
+activity which prevailed around them. Beyond receiving
+an occasional order, shouted in a loud tone&mdash;for
+conversation in an ordinary voice would have
+been inaudible&mdash;nothing occurred till the bell rang
+at half-past eight for breakfast. Then the machinery
+suddenly stopped, and a strange hush succeeded
+the din which had prevailed.</p>
+
+<p>"How long have we got now?" George asked the
+man from whose bench he had been taking the
+planks.</p>
+
+<p>"Half an hour," the man said as he hurried
+away.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, what do you think of it, Bill?" George
+asked when they had got outside.</p>
+
+<p>"Didn't think as there could be such a row," Bill
+replied. "Why, talk about the Garden! Lor',
+why it aint nothing to it. I hardly knew what I
+was a-doing at first."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_54" id="Page_54">[Pg 54]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"No more did I, Bill. You must mind what you
+do and not touch any of those straps and wheels and
+things. I know when I was at Croydon there was a
+man killed in a sawmill there by being caught in the
+strap; they said it drew him up and smashed him
+against the ceiling. And now we had better look
+out for a baker's."</p>
+
+<p>"I suppose there aint a coffee-stall nowhere
+handy?"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't suppose there is, Bill; at any rate we
+have no time to spare to look for one. There's a
+pump in the yard, so we can have a drink of water
+as we come back. Well, the work doesn't seem
+very hard, Bill," George said as they ate their
+bread.</p>
+
+<p>"No, it aint hard," Bill admitted, "if it weren't
+for all them rattling wheels. But I expect it aint
+going to be like that regular. They've just gived
+us an easy job to begin with. Yer'll see it will be
+worse presently."</p>
+
+<p>"We shall soon get accustomed to the noise, Bill,
+and I don't think we shall find the work any harder.
+They don't put boys at hard work, but just jobs like
+we are doing, to help the men."</p>
+
+<p>"What shall we do about night, George?"</p>
+
+<p>"I think that at dinner-time we had better ask the
+man we work for. He looks a good-natured sort
+of chap. He may know of someone he could
+recommend us to."</p>
+
+<p>They worked steadily till dinner-time; then as<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_55" id="Page_55">[Pg 55]</a></span>
+they came out George said to the man with whom
+they were working:</p>
+
+<p>"We want to get a room. We have been lodging
+together in London, and don't know anyone
+down here. I thought perhaps you could tell us of
+some quiet, respectable people who have a room to
+let?"</p>
+
+<p>The man looked at George more closely than he
+had hitherto done.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, there aint many people as would care
+about taking in two boys, but you seem a well-spoken
+young chap and different to most of 'em. Do you
+think you could keep regular hours, and not come
+clattering in and out fifty times in the evening, and
+playing tom-fools' tricks of all sorts?"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't think we should be troublesome,"
+George said; "and I am quite sure we shouldn't be
+noisy."</p>
+
+<p>"You would want to be cooked for, in course?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, I don't think so," George said. "Beyond
+hot water for a cup of tea in the evening, we should
+not want much cooking done, especially if there is
+a coffee-stall anywhere where we could get a cup in
+the morning."</p>
+
+<p>"You haven't got any traps, I suppose?"</p>
+
+<p>George looked puzzled.</p>
+
+<p>"I mean bed and chairs, and so on."</p>
+
+<p>George shook his head.</p>
+
+<p>"We might get them afterwards, but we haven't
+any now."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_56" id="Page_56">[Pg 56]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Well, I don't mind trying you young fellows.
+I have got a bedroom in my place empty. A brother
+of mine who lodged and worked with me has just
+got a job as foreman down in the country. At any
+rate I will try you for a week, and if at the end of
+that time you and my missis don't get on together
+you must shift. Two bob a week. I suppose that
+will about suit you?"</p>
+
+<p>George said that would suit very well, and expressed
+his thanks to the man for taking them in.</p>
+
+<p>They had been walking briskly since they left the
+works, and now stopped suddenly before the door of
+a house in a row. It was just like its neighbor, except
+that George noticed that the blinds and windows
+were cleaner than the others, and that the door
+had been newly painted and varnished.</p>
+
+<p>"Here we are," the man said. "You had best
+come in and see the missis and the room. Missis!"
+he shouted, and a woman appeared from the backroom.
+"I have let Harry's room, mother," he said,
+"and these are the new lodgers."</p>
+
+<p>"My stars, John!" she exclaimed; "you don't
+mean to say that you let the room to them two boys.
+I should have thought you had better sense. Why,
+they will be trampling up and down the stairs like
+young hosses, wear out the oil cloth, and frighten
+the baby into fits. I never did hear such a
+thing!"</p>
+
+<p>"I think they are quiet boys, Bessie, and won't
+give much trouble. At any rate I have agreed to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_57" id="Page_57">[Pg 57]</a></span>
+try them for a week, and if you don't get on with
+them at the end of that time, of course they must
+go. They have only come to work at the shop to-day;
+they work with me, and as far as I can see they
+are quiet young chaps enough. Come along, lads,
+I will show you your room."</p>
+
+<p>It was halfway up the stairs, at the back of the
+house, over the kitchen, which was built out there.
+It was a comfortable little room, not large, but sufficiently
+so for two boys. There was a bed, a chest
+of drawers, two chairs, and a dressing-table, and a
+strip of carpet ran alongside the bed, and there was,
+moreover, a small fireplace.</p>
+
+<p>"Will that do for you?" the man asked.</p>
+
+<p>"Capitally," George said; "it could not be nicer;"
+while Bill was so taken aback by its comfort and
+luxury that he was speechless.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, that's settled, then," the man said. "If
+you have got any things you can bring 'em in when
+you like."</p>
+
+<p>"We have not got any to speak of," George said,
+flushing a little. "I came up from the country
+three months ago to look for work, and beyond odd
+jobs I have had nothing to do since, so that everything
+I had is pretty well gone; but I can pay a
+week's rent in advance," he said, putting his hand
+in his pocket.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, you needn't mind that!" the man said; "as
+you work in the shop it's safe enough. Now I must
+get my dinner, else I shall be late for work."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_58" id="Page_58">[Pg 58]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Well, Bill, what do you think of that?" George
+asked as they left the house.</p>
+
+<p>"My eye," Bill exclaimed in admiration; "aint it
+nice just! Why, yer couldn't get a room like that,
+not furnished, anywhere near the market, not at
+four bob a week. Aint it clean just; so help me if
+the house don't look as if it has been scrubbed down
+every day! What a woman that must be for washing!"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes; we shall have to rub our feet well, Bill, and
+make as little mess as we can in going in and out."</p>
+
+<p>"I should think so," Bill said. "It don't seem to
+me as if it could be true as we're to have such a room
+as that to ourselves, and to walk into a house bold
+without being afraid as somebody would have his
+eye on you, and chivey you; and eight bob a week
+for grub regular."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, let's get some bread and cheese, Bill;
+pretty near half our time must be gone, and mind
+we must be very saving at first. There will be several
+things to get; a kettle and a teapot, and a coffeepot,
+and some cups and saucers, and we shall want a
+gridiron for frying rashers of bacon upon."</p>
+
+<p>"My eye, won't it be prime!" Bill broke in.</p>
+
+<p>"And we shall want some towels," George went
+on with his enumeration.</p>
+
+<p>"Towels!" repeated Bill. "What are they
+like?"</p>
+
+<p>"They are cloths for wiping your hands and face
+after you have washed."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_59" id="Page_59">[Pg 59]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Well, if yer says we wants 'em, George, of
+course we must get 'em; but I've always found my
+hands dried quick enough by themselves, especially
+if I gived 'em a rub on my trousers."</p>
+
+<p>"And then, Bill, you know," George went on, "I
+want to save every penny we can, so as to get some
+things to furnish two rooms by the time mother
+comes out."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, in course we must," Bill agreed warmly,
+though a slight shade passed over his face at the
+thought that they were not to be always alone together.
+"Well, yer know, George, I am game for
+anythink. I can hold on with a penn'orth of bread
+a day. I have done it over and over, and if yer says
+the word I am ready to do it again."</p>
+
+<p>"No, Bill, we needn't do that," George laughed.
+"Still, we must live as cheap as we can. We will
+stick to bread for breakfast, and bread and cheese
+for dinner, and bread for supper, with sometimes a
+rasher as a great treat. At any rate we will try to
+live on six shillings a week."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh! we can do that fine," Bill said confidently;
+"and then two shillings for rent, and that will leave
+us eight shillings a week to put by."</p>
+
+<p>"Mother said that the doctor didn't think she
+would be able to come out 'til the spring. We are
+just at the beginning of November, so if she comes
+out the first of April, that's five months, say twenty-two
+weeks. Twenty-two weeks at eight shillings,
+let me see. That's eight pounds in twenty weeks,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_60" id="Page_60">[Pg 60]</a></span>
+eight pounds sixteen altogether, that would furnish
+two rooms very well, I should think."</p>
+
+<p>"My eye, I should think so!" Bill exclaimed, for
+to his mind eight pound sixteen was an almost unheard-of
+sum, and the fact that his companion had
+been able to calculate it increased if possible his admiration
+for him.</p>
+
+<p>It needed but two or three days to reconcile Mrs.
+Grimstone to her new lodgers.</p>
+
+<p>"I wouldn't have believed," she said at the end of
+the week to a neighbor, "as two boys could have
+been that quiet. They comes in after work as regular
+as the master. They rubs their feet on the mat,
+and you can scarce hear 'em go upstairs, and I don't
+hear no more of 'em till they goes out agin in the
+morning. They don't come back here to breakfast
+or dinner. Eats it, I suppose, standing
+like."</p>
+
+<p>"But what do they do with themselves all the
+evening, Mrs. Grimstone?"</p>
+
+<p>"One of 'em reads to the other. I think I can
+hear a voice going regular over the kitchen."</p>
+
+<p>"And how's their room?"</p>
+
+<p>"As clean and tidy as a new pin. They don't
+lock the door when they goes out, and I looked in
+yesterday, expecting to find it like a pigsty; but
+they had made the bed afore starting for work, and
+set everything in its place, and laid the fire like for
+when they come back."</p>
+
+<p>Mrs. Grimstone was right. George had expended<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_61" id="Page_61">[Pg 61]</a></span>
+six pence in as many old books at a bookstall. One
+of them was a spelling-book, and he had at once set
+to work teaching Bill his letters. Bill had at first
+protested. "He had done very well without reading,
+and didn't see much good in it." However, as
+George insisted he gave way, as he would have done
+to any proposition whatever upon which his friend
+had set his mind. So for an hour every evening
+after they had finished tea Bill worked at his letters
+and spelling, and then George read aloud to him
+from one of the other books.</p>
+
+<p>"You must get on as fast as you can this winter,
+Bill," he said; "because when the summer evenings
+come we shall want to go for long walks."</p>
+
+<p>They found that they did very well upon the sum
+they agreed on. Tea and sugar cost less than
+George had expected. Mrs. Grimstone took in for
+them regularly a halfpenny-worth of milk, and for
+tea they were generally able to afford a bloater between
+them, or a very thin rasher of bacon. Their
+enjoyment of their meals was immense. Bill indeed
+frequently protested that they were spending too
+much money; but George said as long as they kept
+within the sum agreed upon, and paid their rent,
+coal, candles, and what little washing they required
+out of the eight shillings a week, they were doing
+very well.</p>
+
+<p>They had by this time got accustomed to the din
+of the machinery, and were able to work in comfort.
+Mr. Penrose had several times come through the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_62" id="Page_62">[Pg 62]</a></span>
+room, and had given them a nod. After they had
+been there a month he spoke to Grimstone.</p>
+
+<p>"How do those boys do their work?"</p>
+
+<p>"Wonderful well, sir; they are the two best boys
+we have ever had. No skylarking about, and I
+never have to wait a minute for a plank. They
+generally comes in a few minutes before time and
+gets the bench cleared up. They are first-rate boys.
+They lodge with me, and two quieter and better-behaved
+chaps in a house there never was."</p>
+
+<p>"I am glad to hear it," Mr. Penrose said. "I am
+interested in them, and am pleased to hear so good
+an account."</p>
+
+<p>That Saturday, to their surprise, when they went
+to get their money they received ten shillings apiece.</p>
+
+<p>"That's two shillings too much," George said as
+the money was handed to them.</p>
+
+<p>"That's all right," the foreman said. "The
+governor ordered you both to have a rise."</p>
+
+<p>"My eye!" Bill said as they went out. "What
+do you think of that, George? Four bob a week
+more to put by regularly. How much more will
+that make by the time your mother comes?"</p>
+
+<p>"We won't put it all by, Bill. I think the other
+will be enough. This four shillings a week we will
+put aside at present for clothes. We want two more
+shirts apiece, and some more stockings, and we shall
+want some shoes before long, and another suit of
+clothes each. We must keep ourselves decent, you
+know."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_63" id="Page_63">[Pg 63]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>From the time when they began work the boys
+had gone regularly every Sunday morning to a small
+iron church near their lodging, and they also went
+to an evening service once a week. Their talk, too,
+at home was often on religion, for Bill was extremely
+anxious to learn, and although his questions
+and remarks often puzzled George to answer, he
+was always ready to explain things as far as he
+could.</p>
+
+<p>February came, and to George's delight he heard,
+from his mother that she was so much better that
+the doctor thought that when she came out at the
+end of April she would be as strong as she had ever
+been. Her eyes had benefited greatly by her long
+rest, and she said that she was sure she should be
+able to do work as before. She had written several
+times since they had been at Limehouse, expressing
+her great pleasure at hearing that George was so
+well and comfortable. At Christmas, the works
+being closed for four days, George had gone down
+to see her, and they had a delightful talk together.
+Christmas had indeed been a memorable occasion to
+the boys, for on Christmas Eve the carrier had left a
+basket at Grimstone's directed "George Andrews."
+The boys had prepared their Christmas dinner, consisting
+of some fine rashers of bacon and sixpenny-worth
+of cold plum pudding from a cook-shop, and
+had already rather lamented this outlay, for Mrs.
+Grimstone had that afternoon invited them to dine
+downstairs. George was reading from a book<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_64" id="Page_64">[Pg 64]</a></span>
+which he bought for a penny that morning when
+there was a knock at the door, and Mrs. Grimstone
+said:</p>
+
+<p>"Here is a hamper for you, George."</p>
+
+<p>"A hamper for me!" George exclaimed in astonishment,
+opening the door. "Why, whoever could
+have sent a hamper for me! It must be a mistake."</p>
+
+<p>"That's your name on the direction, anyhows,"
+Mrs. Grimstone said.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, that's my name, sure enough," George
+agreed, and at once began to unknot the string
+which fastened down the lid.</p>
+
+<p>"Here is a Christmas card at the top!" he
+shouted. He turned it over. On the back were the
+words:</p>
+
+<p>"With all good wishes, Helen Penrose."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, that is kind," George said in rather a
+husky voice; and indeed it was the kindness that
+prompted the gift rather than the gift itself that
+touched him.</p>
+
+<p>"Now, then, George," Bill remonstrated; "never
+mind that there card, let's see what's inside."</p>
+
+<p>The hamper was unpacked, and was found to contain
+a cold goose, a Christmas pudding, and some
+oranges and apples. These were all placed on the
+table, and when Mrs. Grimstone had retired Bill
+executed a war-dance in triumph and delight.</p>
+
+<p>"I never did see such a game," he said at last, as
+he sat down exhausted. "There's a Christmas din<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_65" id="Page_65">[Pg 65]</a></span>ner
+for yer! Why, it's like them stories of the genii
+you was a-telling me about&mdash;chaps as come whenever
+yer rubbed a ring or an old lamp, and brought
+a tuck-out or whatever yer asked for. Of course
+that wasn't true; yer told me it wasn't, and I
+shouldn't have believed it if yer hadn't, but this 'ere
+is true. Now I sees, George, as what yer said was
+right and what I said was wrong. I thought yer
+were a flat 'cause yer wouldn't take nothing for getting
+back that there locket, and now yer see what's
+come of it, two good berths for us and a Christmas
+dinner fit for a king. Now what are we going to
+do with it, 'cause yer know we dines with them
+downstairs to-morrow?"</p>
+
+<p>"The best thing we can do, I think," George answered,
+"will be to invite all of them downstairs,
+Bob Grimstone, his wife, and the three young uns,
+to supper, not to-morrow night nor the night after,
+because I shan't be back from Croydon till late, but
+say the evening after."</p>
+
+<p>"But we can't hold them all," Bill said, looking
+round the room.</p>
+
+<p>"No, we can't hold them here, certainly, but I
+dare say they will let us have the feed in their parlor.
+There will be nothing to get, you know, but some
+bread and butter, and some beer for Bob. Mrs.
+Grimstone don't take it, so we must have plenty of
+tea."</p>
+
+<p>"I should like some beer too, just for once,
+George, with such a blow-out as that."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_66" id="Page_66">[Pg 66]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"No, no, Bill, you and I will stick to tea. You
+know we agreed that we wouldn't take beer. If we
+begin it once we shall want it again, so we are not
+going to alter from what we agreed to. We see
+plenty of the misery which drink causes all round
+and the way in which money is wasted over it. I
+like a glass of beer as well as you do, and when I
+get to be a man I dare say I shall take a glass with
+my dinner regularly, though I won't do even that if
+I find it makes me want to take more; but anyhow at
+present we can do without it."</p>
+
+<p>Bill agreed, and the dinner-party downstairs and
+the supper two nights afterwards came off in due
+course, and were both most successful.</p>
+
+<p>The acknowledgment of the gift had been a matter
+of some trouble to George, but he had finally
+bought a pretty New Year's card and had written
+on the back, "with the grateful thanks of George
+Andrews," and had sent it to the daughter of his
+employer.</p>
+
+<p>At the beginning of April George had consulted
+Grimstone and his wife as to the question of preparing
+a home for his mother.</p>
+
+<p>"How much would two rooms cost?" he had
+asked; "one a good-sized one and the other the same
+size as ours."</p>
+
+<p>"Four shillings or four and sixpence," Mrs.
+Grimstone replied.</p>
+
+<p>"And supposing we had a parlor and two little
+bedrooms?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_67" id="Page_67">[Pg 67]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Five and sixpence or six shillings, I should say,"
+Mrs. Grimstone replied.</p>
+
+<p>"And how much for a whole house?"</p>
+
+<p>"It depends upon the size. We pay seven shillings
+a week, but you might get one without the
+kitchen and bedroom over it behind for six shillings."</p>
+
+<p>"That would be much the nicest," George said,
+"only it would cost such a lot to furnish it."</p>
+
+<p>"But you needn't furnish it all at once," Mrs.
+Grimstone suggested. "Just a kitchen and two
+bedrooms for a start, and you can put things into
+the parlor afterwards. That's the way we did when
+we first married. But you must have some furniture."</p>
+
+<p>"And how much will it cost for the kitchen and
+two bedrooms?"</p>
+
+<p>"Of course going cheaply to work and buying
+the things secondhand, I should say I could pick up
+the things for you, so that you could do very well,"
+Mrs. Grimstone said, "for six or seven pounds."</p>
+
+<p>"That will do capitally," George said, "for by
+the end of this month Bill and I will have more than
+ten pounds laid by."</p>
+
+<p>"What! since you came here?" Grimstone exclaimed
+in astonishment. "Do you mean to say
+you boys have laid by five pounds apiece?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, and bought a lot of things too," his wife
+put in.</p>
+
+<p>"Why, you must have been starving yourselves!"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_68" id="Page_68">[Pg 68]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"We don't look like it," George laughed. "I
+am sure Bill is a stone heavier than when he came
+here."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, young chap, it does you a lot of credit,"
+Bob Grimstone said. "It isn't every boy, by a long
+way, would stint himself as you must have done for
+the last five months to make a comfortable home for
+his mother, for I know lots of men who are earning
+their two quid a week and has their old people in
+the workhouse. Well, all I can say is that if I or
+the missis here can be of any use to you in taking a
+house we shall be right down glad."</p>
+
+<p>"Thank you," George said. "We will look
+about for a house, and when we have fixed on one
+if you or Mrs. Grimstone will go about it for
+us I shall be much obliged, for I don't think
+landlords would be inclined to let a house to two
+boys."</p>
+
+<p>"All right, George! we will do that for you with
+pleasure. Besides, you know, there are things,
+when you are going to take a house, that you stand
+out for; such as papering and painting, or putting
+in a new range, and things of that sort."</p>
+
+<p>After their dinner on the following Sunday the
+two boys set out house-hunting.</p>
+
+<p>"If it's within a mile that will do," George said.
+"It doesn't matter about our going home in the
+breakfast time. We can bring our grub in a basket
+and our tea in a bottle, as several of the hands do;
+but if it's over a mile we shall have to hurry to get<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_69" id="Page_69">[Pg 69]</a></span>
+there and back for dinner. Still there are plenty of
+houses in a mile."</p>
+
+<p>There were indeed plenty of houses, in long regular
+rows, bare and hard-looking, but George wanted
+to find something more pleasant and homelike than
+these. Late in the afternoon he came upon what he
+wanted. It was just about a mile from the works
+and beyond the lines of regular streets. Here he
+found a turning off the main road with but eight
+houses in it, four on each side. It looked as if the
+man who built them had intended to run a street
+down for some distance, but had either been unable
+to obtain enough ground or had changed his mind.</p>
+
+<p>They stood in pairs, each with its garden in front,
+with a bow-window and little portico. They appeared
+to be inhabited by a different class to those
+who lived in the rows, chiefly by city clerks, for the
+gardens were nicely kept, the blinds were clean and
+spotless, muslin curtains hung in the windows, and
+fancy tables with pretty ornaments stood between
+them. Fortunately one of them, the last on the
+left-hand side, was to let.</p>
+
+<p>"What do you think of this, Bill?"</p>
+
+<p>"It seems to be just the thing; but how about the
+rent, George? I should think they were awful
+dear."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't suppose they are any more than the
+houses in the rows, Bill. They are very small, you
+see, and I don't suppose they would suit workmen as
+well as the others; at any rate we will see."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_70" id="Page_70">[Pg 70]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Whereupon George noted down on a scrap of
+paper the name of the agent of whom inquiry was to
+be made.</p>
+
+<p>"No. 8," he said; "but what's the name of the
+street? Oh, there it is. Laburnum Villas. No.
+8 Laburnum Villas; that sounds first-rate, doesn't
+it? I will get Mrs. Grimstone to go round to the
+agent to-morrow."</p>
+
+<p>This Mrs. Grimstone agreed to do directly she
+was asked. After speaking to her husband she said,
+"I will get the key from the agent's and will be there
+just after twelve to-morrow, so if you go there
+straight when you get out you will be able to see the
+rooms and what state it's in."</p>
+
+<p>"But how about Bob's dinner?" George asked.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, he will have it cold to-morrow, and I will
+set it out for him before I start."</p>
+
+<p>"That is very kind, Mrs. Grimstone, thank you
+very much. It would be just the thing."</p>
+
+<p>Accordingly, at ten minutes past twelve on the
+following day the two boys arrived breathless at No.
+8 Laburnum Villas.</p>
+
+<p>"Hurrah!" George shouted, "there is Mrs.
+Grimstone at the window."</p>
+
+<p>The door was opened and they rushed in.</p>
+
+<p>"It's a tidy little place," Mrs. Grimstone said;
+"and it's in good order and won't want any money
+laying out upon it."</p>
+
+<p>The house was certainly small, but the boys were
+delighted with it. On the ground-floor were two<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_71" id="Page_71">[Pg 71]</a></span>
+little rooms opening with folding doors, and a little
+kitchen built out behind. There was a room over
+this, and two rooms above the sitting rooms.</p>
+
+<p>"That's just the right number," George said, "a
+bedroom each for us; it couldn't be nicer; and what
+pretty paper!"</p>
+
+<p>"And there is a good long slip of garden behind,"
+Mrs. Grimstone said, "where you could grow lots
+of vegetables. Of course in the front you would
+have flowers."</p>
+
+<p>"And how much do they want for it?"</p>
+
+<p>"Seven and sixpence a week, including rates and
+taxes. I call it dear for its size, but then of course
+it's got the garden and it looks pretty and nice.
+The agent says it's been painted and papered from
+top to bottom since the last people left, but he says
+the owner won't let it unless somebody comes who
+is likely to stop, and he will want references of respectability."</p>
+
+<p>"All right!" George said; "I can manage that,"
+for he had already been thinking of the question in
+his mind; "and we can manage seven and sixpence
+a week; can't we, Bill?"</p>
+
+<p>"We will try, anyhow," Bill said stoutly, for he
+was as much pleased with the cottage as George
+was.</p>
+
+<p>They explored the garden behind the house.
+This was about a hundred feet long by twenty-five
+wide. Half of it was covered with stumps of a
+plantation of cabbages, the other half was empty and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_72" id="Page_72">[Pg 72]</a></span>
+had evidently been dug up by the last tenants ready
+for planting.</p>
+
+<p>"Why, I should think we shall be able to grow
+all our own potatoes here!" George exclaimed in
+delight.</p>
+
+<p>Mrs. Grimstone was a country woman, and she shook her head.</p>
+
+<p>"You wouldn't be able to do that, George, not if
+you gave it all up to potatoes; but if you planted the
+further end with potatoes you might get a good
+many, and then, you know, at this end you might
+have three or four rows of peas and French beans,
+and lettuces and such like, but you will have to get
+some manure to put in. Things won't grow without
+manure even in the country, and I am sure they
+won't here; and then you know you can have flowers
+in the front of the house. But it's time for you to
+be off, else you will be late at the works. I am sure
+it's more than half an hour since you came in. I
+will take the key back and tell them they shall have
+an answer by Wednesday or Thursday."</p>
+
+<p>George did not think they could have been a quarter
+of an hour; however, he and Bill started at a trot,
+which they increased into a run at the top of their
+speed when the first clock they saw pointed to seven
+minutes to one. The bell was ringing as they approached
+the works; it stopped when they were
+within fifty yards, and the gate was just closing as
+they rushed up.</p>
+
+<p>"Too late," the man said.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_73" id="Page_73">[Pg 73]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Oh, do let us through," George panted out; "it's
+the first time we have ever been late, and we have
+run a mile to be here in time!"</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, it's you, is it?" the man said, opening the
+gate a few inches to look through. "Ah, well I
+will let you in this time, 'cause you are well-behaved
+young chaps; but don't you run it so close another
+time, else you will have to lose your hour."</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_74" id="Page_74">[Pg 74]</a></span></p>
+<h2><a name="CHAPTER_IV" id="CHAPTER_IV"></a>CHAPTER IV.</h2>
+
+<h3>HOME.</h3>
+
+
+<p>That evening George wrote a letter to Dr.
+Jeffries at Croydon, saying that he had taken a
+little house for his mother to come to when she
+came out of the infirmary, and as he had kindly said
+that he would render her help if he could, would he
+be good enough to write to the agent whose address
+he gave, saying that Mrs. Andrews, who was
+about taking No. 8 Laburnum Villas, was a person
+of respectability.</p>
+
+<p>The following evening he received a letter from
+the doctor saying that he had written to the agent,
+and that he was glad indeed to hear that George
+was getting on so well that he was able to provide
+a home for his mother.</p>
+
+<p>On Wednesday at dinner-time Mrs. Grimstone
+handed George a key.</p>
+
+<p>"There you are, George. You are master of
+the house now. The agent said the reference was
+most satisfactory; so I paid him the seven and sixpence
+you gave me for a week's rent in advance,
+and you can go in when you like. We shall be
+sorry to lose you both, for I don't want two better
+lodgers. You don't give no trouble, and all has<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_75" id="Page_75">[Pg 75]</a></span>
+been quiet and pleasant in the house; and to think
+what a taking I was in that day as Bob brought
+you here for the first time, to think as he had let
+the room to two boys. But there, one never
+knows, and I wouldn't have believed it as boys could
+be so quiet in a house."</p>
+
+<p>"Now we must begin to see about furniture,"
+Bob Grimstone said. "The best plan, I think,
+will be for you two to go round of an evening to
+all the shops in the neighborhood, and mark off just
+what you think will suit you. You put down the
+prices stuck on them, and just what they are, and
+then the missis can go in the morning and bargain
+for them. She will get them five shillings in the
+pound cheaper than you would. It's wonderful
+how women do beat men down, to be sure. When
+a man hears what's the price of a thing he leaves
+it or takes it just as he likes, but a woman begins
+by offering half the sum. Then the chap says no,
+and she makes as if she was going away; he lets
+her go a little way and then he hollers after her,
+and comes down a goodish bit in the price. Then
+she says she don't particularly want it and
+shouldn't think of giving any such price as that.
+Then he tries again, and so they gets on till they
+hit on a figure as suits them both. You see that
+little tea-caddy in the corner? My wife was just
+three weeks buying that caddy. The chap wanted
+seven and six for it, and she offered him half a
+crown. He came down half a crown at the end of<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_76" id="Page_76">[Pg 76]</a></span>
+the first week, and at last she got it for three and
+nine. Now, the first thing you have got to do is
+to make out a list. First of all you have got to
+put down the things as you must have, and then
+the things you can do without, though you will
+get them if you can afford it. Mother will help
+you at that."</p>
+
+<p>So Mrs. Grimstone and George sat down with
+paper and a pencil, and George was absolutely horrified
+at the list of things which Mrs. Grimstone
+declared were absolutely indispensable. However,
+after much discussion, some few items were
+marked as doubtful. When the list was finished
+the two boys started on an exploring expedition,
+and the next week all their evenings were fully occupied.
+In ten days after they began the three
+bedrooms and the kitchen were really smartly furnished,
+Mrs. Grimstone proving a wonderful hand
+at bargaining, and making the ten pounds go farther
+than George had believed possible. On the
+Sunday Bob went with his wife and the boys to
+inspect the house.</p>
+
+<p>"It's a very comfortable little place," he said,
+"and that front bedroom with the chintz curtains
+the missis made up is as nice a little room as you
+want to see. As to the others they will do well
+enough for you boys."</p>
+
+<p>The only articles of furniture in the sitting room
+were two long muslin curtains, which Mrs. Grimstone
+had bought a bargain at a shop selling off;<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_77" id="Page_77">[Pg 77]</a></span>
+for it was agreed that this was necessary to give
+the house a furnished appearance. Bob Grimstone
+was so much pleased at what had been done
+that he shared George's feeling of regret that one
+of the sitting rooms could not also be furnished,
+and on the walk home said:</p>
+
+<p>"Look here, George. I know you would like
+to have the house nice for your mother. You
+couldn't make one of those sitting rooms comfortable
+not under a five-pound note, not even with
+the missis to market for you, but you might for
+that. I have got a little money laid by in the
+savings-bank, and I will lend you five pounds, and
+welcome, if you like to take it. I know it will be
+just as safe with you as it will be there."</p>
+
+<p>"Thank you very much, Bob&mdash;thank you very
+much, but I won't take it. In the first place, I
+should like mother to know that the furniture is all
+ours, bought out of Bill's savings and mine; and
+in the next place, I should find it hard at first to
+pay back anything. I think we can just manage
+on our money, but that will be all. I told you
+mother does work, but she mayn't be able to get
+any at first, so we can't reckon on that. When
+she does, you know, we shall be able gradually to
+buy the furniture."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, perhaps you are right, George," the man
+said after a pause. "You would have been welcome
+to the money: but perhaps you are right not
+to take it. I borrowed a little money when I first<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_78" id="Page_78">[Pg 78]</a></span>
+went into housekeeping, and it took a wonderful
+trouble to pay off, and if there's illness or anything
+of that sort it weighs on you. Not that I should
+be in any hurry about it. It wouldn't worry me,
+but it would worry you."</p>
+
+<p>A week later Mrs. Andrews was to leave the infirmary,
+and on Saturday George asked for a day
+off to go down to fetch her. Every evening
+through the week he and Bill had worked away at
+digging up the garden. Fortunately there was
+a moon, for it was dark by the time they came out
+from the works. Bill was charged with the commission
+to lay in the store of provisions for the
+Sunday, and he was to be sure to have a capital
+fire and tea ready by four o'clock, the hour at which
+George calculated he would be back.</p>
+
+<p>Very delighted was George as in his best suit&mdash;for
+he and Bill had two suits each now&mdash;he stepped
+out of the train at Croydon and walked to the
+workhouse. His mother had told him that she
+would meet him at the gate at half-past two, and
+punctually at the time he was there. A few minutes
+later Mrs. Andrews came out, not dressed as
+he had seen her at Christmas, in the infirmary garb,
+but in her own clothes. George gave a cry of delight
+as he ran forward to meet her.</p>
+
+<p>"My darling mother! and you are looking quite
+yourself again."</p>
+
+<p>"I am, thank God, George. It has seemed a
+long nine months, but the rest and quiet have done<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_79" id="Page_79">[Pg 79]</a></span>
+wonders for me. Everyone has been very kind;
+and of course the knowledge, dear boy, that you
+had got work that you liked helped me to get
+strong again. And you are looking well too; and
+your friend, I hope he is well?"</p>
+
+<p>"Quite well, mother, but in a great fright about
+you. He is glad you are coming because I am
+glad; but the poor fellow has quite made up his
+mind that you won't like him and you won't think
+him a fit companion for me. I told him over and
+over again that you are not that sort; but nothing
+can persuade him. Of course, mother, he doesn't
+talk good grammar, and he uses some queer expressions;
+but he is very much changed in that way
+since I first knew him, and he tries very hard, and
+don't mind a bit how often I correct him, and he
+is beginning to read easy words quite well; and
+he is one of the best-hearted fellows in the
+world."</p>
+
+<p>"If he is kind to you, George, and fond of you,
+that's enough for me," Mrs. Andrews said; "but
+I have no doubt I shall soon like him for himself.
+You could not like him as much as you do if there
+were not something nice about him. And you
+have succeeded in getting a room for me in the
+house in which you lodge?" for George had never
+mentioned a word in his letter about taking a
+house, and had asked Dr. Jeffries if he should see
+his mother to say nothing to her about his application
+to him.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_80" id="Page_80">[Pg 80]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Yes, that's all right, mother," he replied
+briskly.</p>
+
+<p>"And you have got some new clothes since I
+saw you last, George. You wanted them; yours
+were getting rather shabby when I saw you at
+Christmas."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, mother, they were."</p>
+
+<p>"I suppose you had to part with your best suit
+while you were so long out of work?"</p>
+
+<p>"That was it, mother; but you see I have been
+able to get some more things. They are only
+cheap ones, you know, but they will do very well
+until I can afford better ones. I am not walking
+too fast for you, am I? But we shall just catch
+the train. Or look here, would you mind going
+straight by yourself to the railway station? Then
+you can walk slowly. I will go round and get your
+box. I went into our old place as I came along,
+and Mrs. Larkins said she would bring it downstairs
+for me as I came back."</p>
+
+<p>"No, I would rather go round with you, George.
+I want to thank her for having kept it for me so
+long. Even if we do miss the train it will not matter
+much, as it will make no difference whether we
+get in town an hour earlier or later."</p>
+
+<p>As George could not explain his special reason
+for desiring to catch that train he was obliged to
+agree, and they stopped a quarter of an hour at
+their old lodging, as Mrs. Larkins insisted upon
+their having a cup of tea which she had prepared<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_81" id="Page_81">[Pg 81]</a></span>
+for them. However, when they reached the station
+they found that a train was going shortly, and
+when they reached town they were not so very
+much later than George had calculated upon.</p>
+
+<p>They took a cab, for although Mrs. Andrews'
+box was not heavy, it was too much for George to
+carry that distance; besides, Mrs. Andrews herself
+was tired from her walk to the station from the
+infirmary, having had no exercise for so long.
+When they got into the neighborhood of Limehouse
+George got outside to direct the cabman.
+It was just a quarter past four when the cab drew up
+at No. 8 Laburnum Villas.</p>
+
+<p>"Why, is this the house?" Mrs. Andrews asked
+in surprise as George jumped down and opened the
+door. "Why, you told me in one of your letters
+it was a house in a row. What a pretty little place!
+It is really here, George?"</p>
+
+<p>"It is here, mother; we moved the other day.
+There is Bill at the door;" but Bill, having opened
+the door, ran away out into the garden, and
+George, having paid the cabman, carried his
+mother's box in and entered the house with her.</p>
+
+<p>"Straight on, mother, into the little room at the
+end."</p>
+
+<p>"What a snug little kitchen!" Mrs. Andrews
+said as she entered it; "and tea all laid and ready!
+What, have they lent you the room for this evening?"</p>
+
+<p>"My dear mother," George said, throwing his<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_82" id="Page_82">[Pg 82]</a></span>
+arms round her neck, "this is your kitchen and
+your house, all there is of it, only the sitting room
+isn't furnished yet. We must wait for that, you
+know."</p>
+
+<p>"What! you have taken a whole house, my boy!
+that is very nice; but can we afford it, George? It
+seems too good to be true."</p>
+
+<p>"It is quite true, mother, and I think it's a dear
+little house, and will be splendid when we have got
+it all furnished. Now come up and see the bedrooms.
+This is Bill's, you know," and he opened
+the door on the staircase, "and this is mine, and
+this is yours."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, what a pretty little room!" Mrs. Andrews
+said: "but, my dear George, the rent of this house
+and the hire of the furniture will surely be more
+than we can afford to pay. I know what a good
+manager you are, my boy, but I have such a horror
+of getting into debt that it almost frightens
+me."</p>
+
+<p>"The rent of the house is seven and sixpence a
+week, mother, with rates and taxes, and we can
+afford that out of Bill's earnings and mine, even
+if you did not do any work at all; and as to the
+furniture, it is every bit paid for out of our savings
+since we went to work."</p>
+
+<p>On hearing which Mrs. Andrews threw her arms
+round George's neck and burst into tears of happiness.
+She was not very strong, and the thought
+of the sacrifices these two boys must have made to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_83" id="Page_83">[Pg 83]</a></span>
+get a house together for her completely overpowered
+her.</p>
+
+<p>"It seems impossible, George," she said when
+she had recovered herself. "Why, you have only
+been earning ten shillings a week each, and you
+have had to keep yourselves and get clothes and
+all sorts of things; it seems impossible."</p>
+
+<p>"It has not cost so much as you think, mother,
+and Bill and I had both learned to live cheap in
+Covent Garden; but now let us go downstairs; you
+have not seen Bill yet, and I know tea will be
+ready."</p>
+
+<p>But Bill had not yet come in, and George had to
+go out into the garden to fetch him.</p>
+
+<p>"Come on, Bill; mother is delighted with everything.
+She won't eat you, you know."</p>
+
+<p>"No, she won't eat me, George; but she will
+think me an out-and-out sort of 'ottentot," which
+word had turned up in a book the boys had been
+reading on an evening previously.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, wait till she says so; come along."</p>
+
+<p>So linking his arm in Bill's, George drew him
+along, and brought him shamefaced and bashful
+into the kitchen.</p>
+
+<p>"This is Bill, mother."</p>
+
+<p>"I am glad to see you, Bill," Mrs. Andrews said,
+holding out her hand. "I have heard so much of
+you from George that I seem to know you quite
+well."</p>
+
+<p>Bill put his hand out shyly.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_84" id="Page_84">[Pg 84]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"I am sure we shall get on well together," Mrs.
+Andrews went on. "I shall never forget that you
+were a friend to my boy when he was friendless in
+London."</p>
+
+<p>"It's all the t'other way, ma'am," Bill said
+eagerly; "don't you go for to think it. Why, just
+look what George has done for me! There was I,
+a-hanging about the Garden, pretty nigh starving,
+and sure to get quadded sooner or later; and now
+here I am living decent, and earning a good wage;
+and he has taught me to read, ma'am, and to know
+about things, and aint been ashamed of me, though
+I am so different to what he is. I tell you, ma'am,
+there aint no saying what a friend he's been to me,
+and I aint done nothing for him as I can see."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, Bill, you perhaps both owe each other
+something," Mrs. Andrews said: "and I owe you
+something as well as my son, for George tells me
+that it is to your self-denial as well as to his own
+that I owe this delightful surprise of finding a home
+ready for me; and now," she went on, seeing how
+confused and unhappy Bill looked, "I think you
+two ought to make tea this evening, for you are the
+hosts, and I am the guest. In future it will be my
+turn."</p>
+
+<p>"All right, mother! you sit down in this armchair;
+Bill, you do the rashers, and I will pour the
+water into the pot and then toast the muffins."</p>
+
+<p>Bill was at home now; such culinary efforts as
+they had hitherto attempted had generally fallen to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_85" id="Page_85">[Pg 85]</a></span>
+his share, as he had a greater aptitude for the work
+than George had, and a dish of bacon fried to a
+turn was soon upon the table.</p>
+
+<p>Mrs. Andrews had been watching Bill closely,
+and was pleased with the result of her observation.
+Bill was indeed greatly improved in appearance
+since he had first made George's acquaintance.
+His cheeks had filled out, and his face had lost its
+hardness of outline; the quick, restless, hunted expression
+of his eyes had nearly died out, and he no
+longer looked as if constantly on the watch to
+dodge an expected cuff; his face had always had
+a large share of that merriment and love of fun
+which seem the common portion of the London
+arabs, and seldom desert them under all their hardships;
+but it was a happier and brighter spirit now,
+and had altogether lost its reckless character. A
+similar change is always observable among the
+waifs picked up off the streets by the London
+refuges after they have been a few months on board
+a training ship.</p>
+
+<p>When all was ready the party sat down to their
+meal. Mrs. Andrews undertook the pouring out
+of the tea, saying that although she was a guest,
+as the only lady present she should naturally preside.
+George cut the bread, and Bill served the
+bacon. The muffins were piled on a plate in the
+front of the fire as a second course.</p>
+
+<p>It was perhaps the happiest meal that any of the
+three had ever sat down to. Mrs. Andrews was<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_86" id="Page_86">[Pg 86]</a></span>
+not only happy at finding so comfortable a home
+prepared for her, but was filled with a deep feeling of
+pride and thankfulness at the evidence of the
+love, steadiness, and self-sacrifice of her son.
+George was delighted at having his mother with
+him again, and at seeing her happiness and contentment
+at the home he had prepared for her. Bill
+was delighted because George was so, and he was
+moreover vastly relieved at finding Mrs. Andrews
+less terrible than he had depicted her.</p>
+
+<p>After tea was cleared away they talked together
+for a while, and then Bill&mdash;feeling with instinctive
+delicacy that George and his mother would like to
+talk together for a time&mdash;said he should take a turn
+for an hour, and on getting outside the house executed
+so wild a war-dance of satisfaction that it was
+fortunate it was dark, or Laburnum Villas would
+have been astonished and scandalized at the spectacle.</p>
+
+<p>"I like your friend Bill very much," Mrs. Andrews
+said when she was alone with George. "I
+was sure from what you told me that he must be
+a good-hearted lad; but brought up as he has been,
+poor boy, I feared a little that he would scarcely
+be a desirable companion in point of manners. Of
+course, as you say, his grammar is a little peculiar;
+but his manners are wonderfully quiet and nice,
+considering all."</p>
+
+<p>"Look what an example he's had, mother,"
+George laughed; "but really he has taken great<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_87" id="Page_87">[Pg 87]</a></span>
+pains ever since he knew that you were coming
+home. He has been asking me to tell him of anything
+he does which is not right, especially about
+eating and that sort of thing. You see he had
+never used a fork till we came down here, and he
+made me show him directly how it should be held
+and what to do with it. It has been quite funny to
+me to see him watching me at meals, and doing
+exactly the same."</p>
+
+<p>"And you have taught him to read, George?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, mother."</p>
+
+<p>"And something of better things, George?" she
+asked.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, mother, as much as I could. He didn't
+know anything when I met him; but he goes to
+church with me now regularly, and says his prayers
+every night, and I can tell you he thinks a lot of it.
+More, I think, than I ever did," he added honestly.</p>
+
+<p>"Perhaps he has done you as much good as you
+have done him, George."</p>
+
+<p>"Perhaps he has, mother; yes, I think so. When
+you see a chap so very earnest for a thing you can't
+help being earnest yourself; besides, you know,
+mother," he went on a little shyly, for George had
+not been accustomed to talk much of these matters
+with his mother&mdash;"you see when one's down in
+the world and hard up, and not quite sure about
+the next meal, and without any friend, one seems
+to think more of these things than one does when
+one is jolly at school with other fellows."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_88" id="Page_88">[Pg 88]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Perhaps so, George, though I do not know
+why it should be so, for the more blessings one has
+the more reason for love and gratitude to the giver.
+However, dear, I think we have both reason to be
+grateful now, have we not?"</p>
+
+<p>"That we have, mother. Only think of the difference
+since we said good-by to each other last
+summer! Now here you are strong and well
+again, and we are together and don't mean to be
+separated, and I have got a place I like and have
+a good chance of getting on in, and we have got a
+pretty little house all to ourselves, and you will be
+able to live a little like a lady again,&mdash;I mean as
+you were accustomed to,&mdash;and everything is so
+nice. Oh, mother, I am sure we have every reason
+to be grateful!"</p>
+
+<p>"We have indeed, George, and I even more than
+you, in the proofs you have given me that my son
+is likely to turn out all that even I could wish him."</p>
+
+<p>Bill's hour was a very long one.</p>
+
+<p>"You must not go out of an evening, Bill, to
+get out of our way," Mrs. Andrews said when he
+returned, "else I shall think that I am in your way.
+It was kind of you to think of it the first evening,
+and George and I are glad to have had a long talk
+together, but in future I hope you won't do it.
+You see there will be lots to do of an evening.
+There will be your lessons and George's, for I hope
+now that he's settled he will give up an hour or two
+every evening to study. Not Latin and Greek,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_89" id="Page_89">[Pg 89]</a></span>
+George," she added, smiling, seeing a look of something
+like dismay in George's face, "that will be
+only a waste of time to you now, but a study of
+such things as may be useful to you in your present
+work and in your future life, and a steady course
+of reading really good books by good authors.
+Then perhaps when you have both done your work,
+you will take it by turns to read out loud while I
+do my sewing. Then perhaps some day, who
+knows, if we get on very flourishingly, after we
+have furnished our sitting room, we may be able
+to indulge in the luxury of a piano again and have
+a little music of an evening."</p>
+
+<p>"That will be jolly, mother. Why, it will be
+really like old times, when you used to sing to
+me!"</p>
+
+<p>Mrs. Andrews' eyes filled with tears at the
+thought of the old times, but she kept them back
+bravely, so as not to mar, even for a moment, the
+happiness of this first evening. So they chatted
+till nine o'clock, when they had supper. After it
+was over Mrs. Andrews left the room for a minute
+and went upstairs and opened her box, and returned
+with a Bible in her hand.</p>
+
+<p>"I think, boys," she said, "we ought to end this
+first happy evening in our new home by thanking
+God together for his blessings."</p>
+
+<p>"I am sure we ought, mother," George said, and
+Bill's face expressed his approval.</p>
+
+<p>So Mrs. Andrews read a chapter, and then they<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_90" id="Page_90">[Pg 90]</a></span>
+knelt and thanked God for his blessings, and the
+custom thus begun was continued henceforth in
+No. 8 Laburnum Villas.</p>
+
+<p>Hitherto George and his companion had found
+things much more pleasant at the works than they
+had expected. They had, of course, had principally
+to do with Bob Grimstone; still there were
+many other men in the shop, and at times, when
+his bench was standing idle while some slight alterations
+or adjustment of machinery were made,
+they were set to work with others. Men are quick
+to see when boys are doing their best, and, finding
+the lads intent upon their work and given neither
+to idleness nor skylarking, they seldom had a sharp
+word addressed to them. But after Mrs. Andrews
+had come home they found themselves addressed
+in a warmer and more kindly manner by the men.
+Bob Grimstone had told two or three of his mates
+of the sacrifices the boys had made to save up
+money to make a home for the mother of one of
+them when she came out of hospital. They were
+not less impressed than he had been, and the story
+went the round of the workshops and even came
+to the ears of the foreman, and there was not a man
+there but expressed himself in warm terms of surprise
+and admiration that two lads should for six
+months have stinted themselves of food in order
+to lay by half their pay for such a purpose.</p>
+
+<p>"There's precious few would have done such a
+thing," one of the older workmen said, "not one<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_91" id="Page_91">[Pg 91]</a></span>
+in a thousand; why, not one chap in a hundred,
+even when he's going to be married, will stint himself
+like that to make a home for the gal he is going
+to make his wife, so as to start housekeeping out
+of debt; and as to doing it for a mother, where will
+you find 'em? In course a man ought to do as
+much for his mother as for the gal who is agoing to
+be his wife, seeing how much he owes her; but how
+many does it, that's what I says, how many does
+it?"</p>
+
+<p>So after that the boys were surprised to find how
+many of the men, when they met them at the gate,
+would give them a kindly nod or a hearty, "Good-morning,
+young chaps!"</p>
+
+<p>A day or two after Mrs. Andrews had settled in
+Laburnum Villas she went up to town and called
+upon a number of shops, asking for work. As she
+was able to give an excellent reference to the firm
+for whom she had worked at Croydon she succeeded
+before the end of the week in obtaining millinery
+work for a firm in St. Paul's Churchyard,
+and as she had excellent taste and was very quick
+at her needle she was soon able to earn considerably
+more than she had done at Croydon.</p>
+
+<p>The three were equally determined that they
+would live as closely as possible until the sitting-rooms
+were furnished, and by strict management
+they kept within the boys' pay, Mrs. Andrews'
+earnings being devoted to the grand purpose.
+The small articles were bought first, and each week<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_92" id="Page_92">[Pg 92]</a></span>
+there was great congratulation and pleasure as
+some new article was placed in the rooms. Then
+there was a pause for some time, then came the
+chairs, then after an interval a table, and lastly the
+carpet. This crowning glory was not attained until
+the end of July. After this they moved solemnly
+into the sitting-room, agreeing that the
+looking-glass, chiffonier, and sofa could be added
+at a more gradual rate, and that the whole of Mrs.
+Andrews' earnings need no longer be devoted.</p>
+
+<p>"Now, boys," Mrs. Andrews said on that memorable
+evening, "I want you in future, when you
+come in, to change your working clothes before
+you come in here to your teas. So long as we
+lived in the kitchen I have let things go on, but I
+think there's something in the old saying, 'Company
+clothes, company manners,' and I think it is
+good when boys come in that they should lay aside
+their heavy-nailed shoes and their working clothes.
+Certainly such boots and clothes are apt to render
+people clumsy in their movements, and the difference
+of walk which you observe between men of
+different classes arises very greatly from the clumsy,
+heavy boots which workingmen must wear."</p>
+
+<p>"But what does it matter, mother?" George
+urged, for it seemed to him that it would be rather
+a trouble to change his clothes every day. "These
+little things don't make any real difference to a
+man."</p>
+
+<p>"Not any vital difference, George, but a real<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_93" id="Page_93">[Pg 93]</a></span>
+difference for all that. Manners make the man,
+you know! that is, they influence strangers and
+people who only know him in connection with business.
+If two men apply together for a place the
+chances are strongly in favor of the man with the
+best manners getting it. Besides, my boy, I think
+the observance of little courtesies of this kind make
+home pleasanter and brighter. You see I always
+change my dress before tea, and I am sure you
+prefer my sitting down to the table tidy and neat
+with a fresh collar and cuffs, to my taking my place
+in my working dress with odds and ends of threads
+and litter clinging to it."</p>
+
+<p>"Of course I do, mother, and I see what you
+mean now. Certainly I will change my things in
+future. You don't mind, do you, Bill?"</p>
+
+<p>Bill would not have minded in the least any
+amount of trouble by which he could give the
+slightest satisfaction to Mrs. Andrews, who had
+now a place in his affections closely approximating
+to that which George occupied.</p>
+
+<p>During the summer months the programme for
+the evening was not carried out as arranged, for at
+the end of April Mrs. Andrews herself declared that
+there must be a change.</p>
+
+<p>"The evenings are getting light enough now for
+a walk after tea, boys, and you must therefore cut
+short our reading and studies till the days close in
+again in the autumn. It would do you good to
+get out in the air a bit."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_94" id="Page_94">[Pg 94]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"But will you come with us, mother?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, George. Sometimes as evenings get
+longer we may make little excursions together: go
+across the river to Greenwich and spend two or
+three hours in the park, or take a steamer and go
+up the river to Kew; but as a general thing you
+had better take your rambles together. I have my
+front garden to look after, the vegetables are your
+work, you know, and if I like I can go out and do
+whatever shopping I have to do while you two are
+away."</p>
+
+<p>So the boys took to going out walks, which got
+longer and longer as the evenings drew out, and
+when they were not disposed for a long ramble they
+would go down to a disused wharf and sit there and
+watch the barges drifting down the river or tacking
+backwards and forwards, if there was a wind,
+with their great brown and yellow sails hauled
+tautly in, and the great steamers dropping quietly
+down the river, and the little busy tugs dragging
+great ships after them. There was an endless
+source of amusement in wondering from what ports
+the various craft had come or what was their destination.</p>
+
+<p>"What seems most wonderful to me, George,"
+Bill said one day, "when one looks at them big
+steamers&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>"Those," George corrected.</p>
+
+<p>"Thank ye&mdash;at those big steamers, is to think
+that they can be tossed about, and the sea go over<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_95" id="Page_95">[Pg 95]</a></span>
+them, as one reads about, just the same way as the
+wave they make when they goes down&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>"Go down, Bill."</p>
+
+<p>"Thank ye&mdash;go down the river, tosses the little
+boats about; it don't seem possible that water can
+toss itself about so high as that, does it?"</p>
+
+<p>"It does seem extraordinary, Bill; we know that
+it is so because there are constantly wrecks; but
+looking at the water it does not seem possible that
+it should rise up into waves large enough to knock
+one of those great steamers in pieces. Some day,
+Bill, not this year, of course, because the house
+isn't finished, but next year, I hope we shall be able
+all of us to go down for a trip to the sea. I have
+seen it stuck up you can go to Margate and back
+for three or four shillings; and though Bob Grimstone
+says that isn't regular sea, it would be enough
+to show us something of what it's like."</p>
+
+<p>The garden occupied a good deal of the boys'
+time. Bill's long experience in the market had
+given him an interest in vegetables, and he was always
+ready for an hour's work in the garden after
+tea. The results of much labor and plenty of
+manure were not unsatisfactory, and Mrs. Andrews
+was delighted with her regular supply of fresh vegetables.
+Bill's anticipation, however, of the amount
+that could be grown in a limited space were by no
+means fulfilled, and seeing the small amount which
+could be daily gathered, and recalling the countless
+piled-up wagons which he had been accustomed to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_96" id="Page_96">[Pg 96]</a></span>
+see in Covent Garden, he was continually expressing
+his astonishment at the enormous quantity of
+ground which must be employed in keeping up the
+supply of the market.</p>
+
+<p>They did not that year get the trip to Margate;
+but in the autumn, after the great work of furnishing
+was finished, they did get several long
+jaunts, once out to Epping Forest on an omnibus,
+once in a steamer up to Kew, and several times
+across to Greenwich Park. Mrs. Andrews found
+it a very happy summer, free from the wear of
+anxiety, which, more even than the work, had
+brought on her long illness. She grew stronger
+and better than she had ever expected to be again,
+and those who had only known the pale, harassed-looking
+needlewoman of Croydon would not have
+recognized her now; indeed, as George said sometimes,
+his mother looked younger and younger every
+day. She had married very young, and was still
+scarcely five-and-thirty, and although she laughed
+and said that George was a foolish boy when he said
+that people always took her for his sister, she really
+looked some years younger than she was. Her
+step had regained its elasticity, and there was a ring
+of gladness and happiness in her voice which was
+very attractive, and even strangers sometimes
+looked round as they passed the bright, pleasant-looking
+woman chatting gayly with the two healthy,
+good-looking young fellows.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_97" id="Page_97">[Pg 97]</a></span></p>
+<h2><a name="CHAPTER_V" id="CHAPTER_V"></a>CHAPTER V.</h2>
+
+<h3>AN ADVENTURE.</h3>
+
+
+<p>In August the annual outing, or, as it was called,
+the bean-feast, at the works took place. Usually
+the men went in vans down into Epping Forest;
+but this year it was determined that a steamer
+should be engaged to take the whole party with
+their wives and families down to Gravesend. They
+were to make an early start, and on arriving there
+all were to do as they pleased until they assembled
+to dine in a pavilion at one of the hotels. After
+this they were to go to the gardens and amuse
+themselves there until the steamer started in the
+evening. The party embarked at Blackwell at ten
+o'clock in the morning. George and Bill got together
+up in the bow of the steamer, and were delighted
+with their voyage down, their only regret
+being that Mrs. Andrews had declined to accompany
+them, saying that she would far rather go
+with them alone than with so large a party.</p>
+
+<p>"What shall we do, Bill?" George said, when
+they landed. "We are not to dine till two, so we
+have two good hours before us. I vote we hire a
+boat and go out. It will be ten times as jolly here
+as up in that crowded river by London."</p>
+
+<p>This was said in reference to various short rows<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_98" id="Page_98">[Pg 98]</a></span>
+which they had had in boats belonging to barges
+which had been sometimes lent them for half an
+hour of an evening by a good-natured bargeman as
+they hung about the wharves.</p>
+
+<p>"I suppose you can row, young chaps?" the
+waterman, whom they hired the boat of, said.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, yes, we can row!" George replied with the
+confidence of youth.</p>
+
+<p>"Mind the tide is running out strong," the
+waterman said.</p>
+
+<p>"All right, we will mind," George answered,
+scarce heeding his words; and getting out the oars
+they pushed off.</p>
+
+<p>For some little time they rowed among the anchored
+vessels, both being especially filled with delight
+at the yachts moored opposite the clubhouses.
+These were new craft to them, and the
+beauty and neatness of everything struck them with
+surprise and admiration. Tide had only turned a
+short time before they got into their boat, and
+while keeping near the shore they had no difficulty
+in rowing against it.</p>
+
+<p>Presently they determined to have a look at a
+fine East-Indiaman moored well out in the stream
+a short distance below Gravesend. They ceased
+rowing when they approached her, and sat idly on
+their oars talking over the distant voyage on which
+she was probably about to start, and the country
+she might visit, George was telling his companion
+the ports she would touch if her destination was<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_99" id="Page_99">[Pg 99]</a></span>
+China, and absorbed in their conversation they paid
+no attention to anything else, until George gave a
+sudden exclamation.</p>
+
+<p>"Good gracious, Bill! Why, the ship is ever so
+far behind. It is two miles, I should think, from
+the town. We must set to work or we shan't be
+back in time for dinner."</p>
+
+<p>The boys' knowledge of the navigation of the
+Thames was not sufficient to tell them that to row
+against tide it is necessary to keep close inshore,
+and turning the boat's head they set to work to
+row back in the middle of the river. Their knowledge
+of rowing was but slight, and the mere operation
+of their oars took up all their attention. They
+rowed away till their hands burned and the perspiration
+ran down their faces.</p>
+
+<p>After half an hour of this George looked round,
+thinking that he ought to be near to the vessel by
+this time. He uttered an exclamation of surprise
+and dismay. Neither the ship nor Gravesend were
+visible. Their puny efforts had availed nothing
+against the sweeping tide. They had already,
+without knowing it, swept round the turn in the
+river, and were now entering Sea Reach.</p>
+
+<p>"My goodness, Bill! what are we to do? Just
+look at that buoy; we are going past it as fast as
+a horse could trot. Look what a width the river
+is. What on earth are we to do?"</p>
+
+<p>"I have no idea," Bill replied. "Where shall
+we go to if we go on like this?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_100" id="Page_100">[Pg 100]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Right out to sea, I should think," George said.
+"I do not know how far it is; but the river seems
+to get wider and wider in front."</p>
+
+<p>"Perhaps," Bill suggested, "the tide will turn
+again and take us back."</p>
+
+<p>"Not it," George said. "It was against us, you
+know, all the way down, and could only have
+turned a little while before we got in the boat.
+Look at that line of barges sailing down on the
+right-hand side. I vote we pull to them and ask
+the men what we had better do. Anyhow we could
+row to the land and get out there and wait till tide
+turns. It turned at about eleven, so that it will
+turn again somewhere about five. The steamer is
+not to start till eight, so we shall be back in plenty
+of time to catch it. We shall lose the dinner and
+the fun in the gardens, but that can't be helped."</p>
+
+<p>"That don't make no odds," Bill said cheerfully;
+"this is a regular venture, this is; but I say, shan't
+we have to pay a lot for the boat?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes," George assented mournfully; "but perhaps
+the man will let us off cheap when he sees we
+couldn't help it. He looked a good-tempered sort
+of chap. Come, let us set to work. Every minute
+it is taking us further away."</p>
+
+<p>They set steadily to work. The boat was a large
+and heavy one, and their progress was by no means
+rapid.</p>
+
+<p>"How thick it's getting!" George exclaimed
+suddenly.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_101" id="Page_101">[Pg 101]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Aint it just!" Bill assented. "My eye,
+George, I can't see the barges!"</p>
+
+<p>Unobserved by them a fog had been steadily
+creeping up the river. They were just at its edge
+when they made the discovery. Another two
+minutes and it rolled thickly over them, and they
+could not see ten yards away. They looked at
+each other in silent bewilderment.</p>
+
+<p>"What's to be done, George?" Bill said at
+length in awe-struck tones.</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know, Bill; I haven't an idea. It's no
+use rowing, that I see, for we don't know which
+way the boat's head is pointing."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, it can't be helped," Bill said philosophically.
+"I am going to have a pipe. Oh, I say,
+aint my hands blistered!"</p>
+
+<p>"All right, you can have your pipe, Bill, but
+keep your oar in your hand to be ready to row."</p>
+
+<p>"What for?" Bill demanded. "I thought you
+said it warn't no use rowing!"</p>
+
+<p>"No more it is, Bill; but we must look out for
+those big buoys. If the tide were to sweep us
+against one of them we should capsize to a certainty.
+That must have been a big steamer," he
+went on, as the boat rolled suddenly. "It's lucky
+we were pretty well over towards the side of the
+river, before the fog came on. Listen&mdash;there's another.
+I can hear the beat of her engines. I have
+an idea, Bill!" he exclaimed suddenly. "We
+know the steamers were passing to the left of us<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_102" id="Page_102">[Pg 102]</a></span>
+when the fog came on. If we listen to their whistles
+and the sound of their paddles, and then row
+to the right, we shall get to the bank at last."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, that's a good idea," Bill agreed, laying
+down the pipe he had just lighted. "There's a
+whistle over there."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, and another the other way," George said,
+puzzled. "Why, how can that be! Oh, I suppose
+one is coming up the river and one down,
+but it's awfully confusing."</p>
+
+<p>It was so, but by dint of listening intently the
+boys gained some idea of the proper direction; but
+they could only row a few strokes at a time, being
+obliged to stop continually to listen for fresh guidance.</p>
+
+<p>Fortunately for them the fog lay low on the water,
+and the upper spars of the steamers were above it,
+and men placed there were able to direct those on
+deck as to their course. Had it not been for this
+the steamers must all have anchored. As it was
+they proceeded slowly and cautiously on their way,
+whistling freely to warn any small craft, that might
+be hidden in the fog, of their coming.</p>
+
+<p>Half an hour's rowing and the boys gave a simultaneous
+exclamation. The boat had quietly
+grounded on the edge of a mud flat. They could
+not see the bank, and had no idea how far distant it
+was. Bill at once offered to get overboard and
+reconnoiter, but George would not hear of it.</p>
+
+<p>"You might not be able to find your way back,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_103" id="Page_103">[Pg 103]</a></span>
+Bill, or you might sink in the mud and not be able
+to get out again. No, we won't separate; and, look
+here, we must keep the boat afloat just at the edge
+of the mud. If we were to get left here we should
+not float again till tide comes up to us, and that
+wouldn't be till about two hours before high tide,
+and it won't be high, you know, until twelve o'clock
+at night."</p>
+
+<p>"I wish this fog would clear off!" Bill said, looking
+round at the wall of white vapor which surrounded
+them. "It regular confuses a chap. I
+say, I expect they are just sitting down to dinner at
+present. I feel awfully hungry."</p>
+
+<p>"It's no use thinking about that, Bill. We shall
+be a good deal more hungry before we are done;
+but I am so glad we have found the land and
+stopped going out to sea that I don't mind being
+hungry."</p>
+
+<p>"But I say, George, if this fog keeps on how are
+we to find our way back to Gravesend?"</p>
+
+<p>"The only way will be, Bill, to keep quite close to
+the edge of the mud&mdash;just as close as the boat will
+swim. That way, you know, we must come to
+Gravesend at last."</p>
+
+<p>"So we must. I didn't think of that. You have
+got a good head, George, you have. I should never
+have thought about the way to find the bank if it
+hadn't been for you, and might have gone on floating
+and floating till we was starved."</p>
+
+<p>"This fog can't last forever, Bill."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_104" id="Page_104">[Pg 104]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"No, but I have known them last a week in
+London."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, but not in August, Bill."</p>
+
+<p>"No, not in August," Bill assented; "but you
+see these here fogs may last just as long down
+here in August as they do in London in November."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't think so, Bill. Anyhow it doesn't matter
+to us; we have got the land for a guide, and I
+hope we shall be back in Gravesend before it's quite
+dark."</p>
+
+<p>"But if we don't, George?"</p>
+
+<p>"Well, if we don't we must run her ashore before
+it gets too dark, and wait till it is morning. We
+shall be all right if we keep quite cool and use our
+senses. If we had something to eat I shouldn't mind
+a bit, except that mother will be getting anxious
+about us. It's a regular adventure, and we shall
+have something to talk about for a long time. Look
+out, Bill, we must push her further off&mdash;she's getting
+aground!"</p>
+
+<p>For an hour they sat and chatted.</p>
+
+<p>"Hullo! what's that?" Bill exclaimed at last.
+"That's the rattle of a chain. I expect it's a barge
+anchoring somewhere near. Listen; I can hear
+voices. I vote we hollo."</p>
+
+<p>George lifted up his voice in a lusty shout. The
+shout was repeated not very far off, and was followed
+by the shout of "Who are you?"</p>
+
+<p>"We have drifted down from Gravesend and lost<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_105" id="Page_105">[Pg 105]</a></span>
+our way," George shouted back. "We will come
+on board if you will let us."</p>
+
+<p>"All right!" the voice replied; "I will go on
+shouting and you row to my voice."</p>
+
+<p>It was but a hundred yards, and then a voice close
+at hand said sharply:</p>
+
+<p>"Row bow hard or you will be across the chain."</p>
+
+<p>Bill rowed hard, and George, looking round, saw
+that they were close to the bows of a barge. Half
+a dozen more strokes and they were alongside. Bill
+seized a hand-rope and sprang onto the barge, and
+the boat was soon towing astern.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, young men, however did you manage to
+get here?" one of the bargemen asked. "It's lucky
+for you you weren't taken out to sea with the tide."</p>
+
+<p>George related the history of their voyage and
+how they had managed to reach the shore.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, you are good-plucked uns anyhow," the
+man said; "aint they, Jack? Most chaps your age
+would just have sat in the boat and howled, and
+a good many longshoremen too. You have done
+the best thing you could under the circumstances."</p>
+
+<p>"Where are we?" George asked.</p>
+
+<p>"You are on board the <i>Sarah and Jane</i> topsail
+barge, that's where you are, about three parts down
+Sea Reach. We know our way pretty well even in a
+fog, but we agreed it was no use trying to find the
+Swashway with it as thick as this, so we brought
+up."</p>
+
+<p>"Where is the Swashway?" George asked.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_106" id="Page_106">[Pg 106]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"The Swashway is a channel where the barges
+go when they are making for Sheerness. It's well
+buoyed out and easy enough to follow with the help
+of Sheerness lights on a dark night; but these fogs
+are worse than anything. It aint no use groping
+about for the buoy when you can't see ten yards
+ahead, and you might find yourself high and dry on
+the mud and have to wait till next tide. Mayhap
+this fog will clear off before evening, and we shall
+be able to work in; and now I expect you two young
+uns would like some grub. Come below."</p>
+
+<p>The two boys joyfully followed into the little
+cabin, and were soon satisfying their hunger on
+bread and cold meat. The bargee drew a jug of
+water from the breaker and placed it before them.</p>
+
+<p>"The fire has gone out," he said, "or I would
+give yer a cup of tea&mdash;that's our tipple; we don't
+keep spirits on board the <i>Sarah and Jane</i>. I like a
+drop on shore, but it aint stuff to have on a barge,
+where you wants your senses handy at all times.
+And now what are you thinking of doing?" he asked
+when the boys had finished.</p>
+
+<p>"What we had made up our minds to do was to
+lie where we were at the edge of the mud till tide
+turned, and then to keep as close to the shore as we
+could until we got back to Gravesend. The steamer
+we came by does not go back till late, and we
+thought we should be back by that time."</p>
+
+<p>"No, you wouldn't," the man said. "Out in the
+middle of the stream you would be back in two<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_107" id="Page_107">[Pg 107]</a></span>
+hours easy, but not close inshore. The tide don't
+help you much there, and half your time you are in
+eddies and back-currents. No, you wouldn't be
+back in Gravesend by eight noway."</p>
+
+<p>"Then what would you advise us to do?"</p>
+
+<p>"Well, just at present I won't give no advice at
+all. We will see how things are going after a bit.
+Now let's take a look round."</p>
+
+<p>So saying he climbed the ladder to the deck, followed
+by the boys. The white fog still shut the
+boat in like a curtain.</p>
+
+<p>"What do you think of it, Jack?"</p>
+
+<p>"Don't know," the other replied. "Thought just
+now there was a puff of air coming down the river.
+I wish it would, or we shan't make Sheerness to-night,
+much less Rochester. Yes, that's a puff sure
+enough. You are in luck, young uns. Like
+enough in half an hour there will be a brisk wind
+blowing, driving all this fog out to sea before it."</p>
+
+<p>Another and another puff came, and tiny ripples
+swept across the oil-like face of the water.</p>
+
+<p>"It's a-coming, sure enough," the bargeman said.
+"I'd bet a pot of beer as the fog will have lifted in
+a quarter of an hour."</p>
+
+<p>Stronger and stronger came the puffs of wind.</p>
+
+<p>The fog seemed as if stirred by an invisible hand.
+It was no longer a dull, uniform whitish-gray; dark
+shadows seemed to flit across it, and sometimes the
+view of the water extended here and there.</p>
+
+<p>"There's the shore!" Bill exclaimed suddenly,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_108" id="Page_108">[Pg 108]</a></span>
+but ere George could turn round to look it was gone
+again.</p>
+
+<p>"I shall have the anchor up directly, lads. Now
+I tell you what will be the best thing for you if the
+wind holds, as I expect it will. We shall be at
+Sheerness in little over an hour&mdash;that will make it
+four o'clock," he added, consulting his watch, "and
+the young flood will be coming up soon afterwards,
+and I shall go up with the first of it to Rochester.
+We shall get there maybe somewhere about seven
+o'clock. Now the best thing I can do for you is to
+tow that ere boat up to Rochester with me, and you
+can get a train there that will take you up to town
+in goodish time."</p>
+
+<p>"You are very kind," George said; "but what are
+we to do about the boat?"</p>
+
+<p>"I shall be going back to-morrow night, or more
+likely next morning, and I will take her along and
+hand her over to her rightful owner at Gravesend."</p>
+
+<p>"James Kitson."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, I know him."</p>
+
+<p>"But how about paying for it?" George said.
+"I am afraid he will expect a great deal of money,
+for it has been away all the time, and we have only
+got six shillings between us."</p>
+
+<p>"You will want that to get up to town. Never
+mind about the boat. I will put that square for you.
+I will tell Kitson as how you have been shipwrecked,
+and he will think himself precious lucky in getting
+the boat without being damaged. If I take the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_109" id="Page_109">[Pg 109]</a></span>
+trouble to tow it up to Rochester and back, he
+needn't grumble about getting no fare."</p>
+
+<p>"I would rather pay something," George said;
+"though, you see, we can't afford to pay
+much."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, then, you send him a post-office order for
+five bob. I will tell him you are going to send him
+that, and he will thank his stars he has got so well
+out of it. If you had drifted out to sea, as he expects
+you have by this time, and the boat didn't get
+smashed by a steamer, you would likely enough have
+been taken off by one of them; but the captain
+wouldn't have troubled himself about that old tub.
+I looks upon Kitson as being in luck this job, so
+don't you worry about him. There, the mist's driving
+off fast. We will up with the kedge."</p>
+
+<p>The boys lent a hand at the windlass, and the
+anchor was soon hanging from the bow. Then the
+brail of the mainsail was loosed, and the great sail
+shaken out. The foresail was hoisted, and in a few
+minutes the <i>Sarah and Jane</i> was running before a
+brisk wind down Sea Reach.</p>
+
+<p>The fog had rolled off now, and it was clear
+astern, though a thick bank still hung over the river
+ahead, but this was rapidly melting away; and the
+bargeman, who told them his name was Will Atkins,
+pointed out a large building low down on the water
+ahead.</p>
+
+<p>"That's Sheerness Fort," he said. "You can
+lend Jack a hand to get up the topsail. The wind is<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_110" id="Page_110">[Pg 110]</a></span>
+rising every minute, and we shall soon be bowling
+along hand over hand."</p>
+
+<p>Both ahead and astern of them were a line of
+barges, which had, like the <i>Sarah and Jane</i>, anchored
+when the fog was thickest, and were, like her,
+making their way to Sheerness. The wind was
+blowing briskly now, and the barge made her way
+through the water at a rate which surprised the boys.</p>
+
+<p>"I had no idea that barges sailed so fast," George
+said.</p>
+
+<p>"There are not many craft can beat them," Atkins
+replied. "With a breeze so strong that they
+can only just carry their topsails, they will hold their
+own with pretty nigh anything afloat. There are
+mighty few yachts can keep alongside us when we
+are doing our best."</p>
+
+<p>As Atkins had predicted, in little over an hour
+they brought up just inside the mouth of the Medway,
+and dropped the anchor to wait till the tide
+turned to help them up to Rochester. At six o'clock
+they were again under way. The wind had fortunately
+veered round somewhat to the north of west,
+and they were able for the most part to lay their
+course, so that soon after seven they were abreast
+of the dockyard, and a few minutes later dropped
+anchor off Rochester.</p>
+
+<p>"Jump into the boat, boys," the good-natured
+bargeman said; "I will put you ashore at once.
+There is the station close to the end of the bridge."</p>
+
+<p>With many very hearty thanks for his kindness<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_111" id="Page_111">[Pg 111]</a></span>
+the lads jumped ashore and hurried up to the station.
+They found that there would be a train in half
+an hour, and by nine o'clock they arrived in
+town.</p>
+
+<p>Before they had landed the bargeman had
+scrawled on a piece of paper, "Your boat was picked
+up by the <i>Sarah and Jane</i>. Will bring her back on
+return trip. No damage done. William Atkins."
+This he had handed to the boys, and they now got
+an envelope and directed it to "James Kitson,
+Waterman, Gravesend," and posted it, and then set
+out to walk home.</p>
+
+<p>"It's not been the sort of day we expected,"
+George said; "but it's been good fun, hasn't it?"</p>
+
+<p>"Grand!" Bill agreed. "But I didn't think so
+when we were in the middle of that fog listening to
+them whistles and trying to find out the way. I
+didn't say much, George, but I felt downright
+funky."</p>
+
+<p>"I didn't like it either, Bill. There was such a
+horribly lonely feeling, lost in the fog there; but it
+was all right as soon as we touched the mouth, and
+got an idea where we were. I was worrying most
+about mother getting anxious if we did not get back
+to-night, and a little about what we should have to
+pay for the boat. It was lucky that bargeman took
+the matter in his hands for us. I expect we should
+have had to pay over a pound. He was an awfully
+good fellow, wasn't he?"</p>
+
+<p>"I should just think he was," Bill said. "He<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_112" id="Page_112">[Pg 112]</a></span>
+was a good un, and no mistake. It aint cost us so
+very much either, considering."</p>
+
+<p>"That it hasn't, Bill. Two and threepence apiece
+railway fare, that's four and sixpence, and five bob
+we are to send down for the boat, nine shillings and
+sixpence. Well, we should have paid two shillings
+for the boat anyhow, and I expect we should have
+spent another shilling apiece in things at the gardens,
+perhaps more; that would make four shillings
+anyhow, so we have only spent about five shillings
+more than we calculated. And haven't we got a lot
+to talk about! It's been a regular adventure."</p>
+
+<p>"It has," Bill said doubtfully; "but I don't think
+I want many more of them kind of adventures.
+It's all right now, you know, but it wasn't jolly at
+the time. I always thought as adventures was
+jolly; but that didn't seem to me to have no jolliness
+about it, not when we was out there. It's all very
+well to hear tell of shipwrecks and fights with savages,
+but I expect there aint no larks about it at the
+time. I suppose you will send that five bob off to-morrow,
+and get it off your mind?"</p>
+
+<p>"No. Atkins said we had better not send it for
+another three or four days. The man will have got
+his boat back all right then, and the five bob would
+come upon him unexpectedly. He was going to tell
+Kitson that he had arranged with us that was what
+we were to pay, as we couldn't afford more; but he
+will never expect to get it, so when it comes he will
+be only too glad to receive it."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_113" id="Page_113">[Pg 113]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>They were met at the door of the house by Bob
+Grimstone, who was just coming out.</p>
+
+<p>"Why, what have you boys been up to?" he said
+angrily. "I have been wondering all day what has
+become of you, and the missis has done nothing but
+worry and fidget. It's regular spoilt the day.
+What have you been up to? I haven't seen you
+since we got ashore at Gravesend, and I have just
+come round to ask your mother if she has heard of
+you."</p>
+
+<p>"I am very sorry, Bob, but it wasn't our fault, at
+least it was not altogether our fault. We went for
+a row, and the tide took us down, and then the fog
+came on and we got lost."</p>
+
+<p>"I expected better of you," Grimstone said
+angrily. "Foggy, indeed! I've been anxious and
+worried all day. I did think as you warn't like
+other boys, but could be trusted, and then you go
+and play such a prank as this. Well, go in; your
+mother is in a nice taking about you."</p>
+
+<p>"My dear mother," George said as he ran in, "I
+am so sorry you have been uneasy about us, awfully
+sorry; but really it hasn't been our fault altogether."</p>
+
+<p>"Never mind that now, George," Mrs. Andrews
+said, throwing her arms round his neck. "Fortunately
+I did not know anything about it till Mr.
+Grimstone came in a few minutes ago. I had been
+expecting you in for some little time, but I supposed
+the steamer was late, and I was not at all uneasy
+till Mr. Grimstone came in and said that he had not<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_114" id="Page_114">[Pg 114]</a></span>
+seen either of you since the steamer got to Gravesend,
+and that you had not come back with the rest.
+Is Bill with you?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, mother; he is at the door talking to
+Bob."</p>
+
+<p>"Ask Mr. Grimstone to come in again," Mrs.
+Andrews said. "He has been most kind, and he
+had promised to go down to Gravesend by the first
+train in the morning if you did not come home to-night,
+and to make inquiries about you there. He
+tried to cheer me up by saying that as you were together
+nothing could very well happen to you and
+that probably you had only got into some boyish
+scrape&mdash;perhaps, he suggested, only gone out into
+the country and had helped yourselves to some
+apples, and had so got locked up."</p>
+
+<p>Bob, however, would not come in again, but went
+off saying he would hear all about it in the morning,
+but would go off to tell his wife at once that they
+had returned safely, for "that she was in such a
+worry as never was."</p>
+
+<p>Hearing that the boys had had nothing to eat
+since two o'clock, Mrs. Andrews at once laid the
+table for supper; and when they had finished it
+listened to George's account of their adventure.</p>
+
+<p>"You had a very narrow escape, boys," she said
+when they had finished. "You might have been
+swept out to sea, or run down by a steamer in the
+fog. I hope to-night that you will neither of you
+forget to thank God for his protection through the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_115" id="Page_115">[Pg 115]</a></span>
+danger you have run; and I do hope, my dear boys,
+that you will be more careful in future."</p>
+
+<p>The next evening, after work was over, George
+went in to Bob Grimstone's and told them all that
+had happened. When the story was told, Bob
+agreed that after all it was not altogether their fault,
+and that, indeed, they had, in some respects, justified
+his opinion of them. Mrs. Grimstone, however,
+was not so easily pacified. They had come back,
+she said; but it was more than likely that they
+wouldn't have come back at all, but might have been
+drifting out far at sea, perhaps cutting each other's
+throats and eating each other alive, which was, as
+the good woman said, what she had heard happened
+when boats were lost at sea.</p>
+
+<p>Two days later they sent off the money to the
+waterman, and received in reply a letter from him
+saying that the boat had been brought safely back
+by the <i>Sarah and Jane</i> and that he was glad to get
+the five shillings.</p>
+
+<p>"Bill Atkins told me as you said you would send
+it; but knowing what boys is, I say fair as I didn't
+expect to see the color of your money. It aint
+everyone as would have paid up when they got safe
+away, and I consider as you have behaved handsome."</p>
+
+<p>They had heard from Atkins of the wharf off
+which the <i>Sarah and Jane</i> might generally be found
+moored, between her cruises, and after one or two
+ineffectual attempts they one day found the barge<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_116" id="Page_116">[Pg 116]</a></span>
+there when they rowed up to the spot. She had but
+just returned from a trip to Rochester and Bill Atkins
+was still on board. He was very glad to see
+the boys, but they had great difficulty in persuading
+him to accept a pound of tobacco which their mother
+had sent off to him with her compliments as a token
+of gratitude for his kindness to them.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, young chaps, I didn't look for nothing of
+the sort, but seeing as your mother has got it for
+me it wouldn't be manners to say no. Well, look
+here, any time as you are disposed for a sail down
+to Rochester and back you're free of the <i>Sarah and
+Jane</i>, and heartily glad shall I be to have you with
+me."</p>
+
+<p>The boys thanked him for the offer, but said as
+they were still at work there was but small chance
+of their being able to accept it, but that they should
+be glad to come and have a chat with him sometimes
+when he was in the Pool.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_117" id="Page_117">[Pg 117]</a></span></p>
+<h2><a name="CHAPTER_VI" id="CHAPTER_VI"></a>CHAPTER VI.</h2>
+
+<h3>FIRE!</h3>
+
+
+<p>One Saturday evening early in October the boys
+had been for a long walk down among the marshes.
+They had told Mrs. Andrews they would be late,
+and it was past eight o'clock when they came along
+past the works.</p>
+
+<p>"We shan't get home at this hour again for some
+time, I expect," George said, "for they say that we
+are going to begin to work overtime on Monday,
+and that the orders are so heavy that it will very
+likely have to be kept up all through the winter."</p>
+
+<p>"I am glad it didn't begin earlier," Bill replied;
+"it would have been horrid if we had lost all our
+walks while the weather was fine. How dark the
+place looks how it's shut up, and how quiet and still
+it is after the rattle we are accustomed to!"</p>
+
+<p>"Stop a moment," George said, putting his hand
+on his arm.</p>
+
+<p>"What is it, George?"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know. It seemed to me, for a moment,
+as if I saw the big stack clearly and then it was
+dark again."</p>
+
+<p>"How could that be, George?"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know; it looked to me as if it was a re<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_118" id="Page_118">[Pg 118]</a></span>flection
+of light from one of the windows at the
+back there. There it is again."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, I saw it," Bill agreed. "What can it
+be?"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know, Bill; let's run around to the back.
+There might be&mdash;it's awful to think of&mdash;but there
+might be a fire."</p>
+
+<p>The boys ran down a narrow lane by the side of
+the works onto a piece of waste ground behind.</p>
+
+<p>"Look, Bill, look at the glare in the molding-room.
+There must be fire. Here, help to put this
+bit of old timber against the wall."</p>
+
+<p>The piece of wood was placed into position, the
+two lads climbed up it onto the wall, and dropped
+into the yard within. Just as they did so there was
+a clatter of falling glass, followed by a glare of light
+as a body of flame burst out from one of the windows.</p>
+
+<p>"Let's ring the dinner-bell, Bill; that will call
+people's attention, and then we must do the best we
+can."</p>
+
+<p>They ran along until they reached the front gate,
+and then, seizing the bell-rope, rang it violently.</p>
+
+<p>In a minute or two there was a clatter of feet outside,
+and shouts of "What's the matter?"</p>
+
+<p>"There is a fire in the molding-room," George
+shouted; "run for the engines, someone, and break
+the gate open. Now come on, Bill."</p>
+
+<p>The two boys ran towards that part of the building
+where the flames had been seen, broke a window,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_119" id="Page_119">[Pg 119]</a></span>
+and climbed in. There was an almost stifling smell
+of burning wood and at a door at the end of the
+planing-room they could see a light flame flickering
+through the cracks of the door leading into the
+molding-room, which was next to it.</p>
+
+<p>"Quick, Bill, screw that leather pipe onto the
+hydrant. We must stop it from getting through
+here till the engines come."</p>
+
+<p>The hydrant communicated with the great tank at
+the top of the building, and as soon as the hose was
+screwed on and Bill stood with the nozzle directed
+towards the burning door, George turned the cock
+and volumes of water flew out.</p>
+
+<p>The first result seemed disastrous. The door was
+already nearly burned through, and, as the powerful
+jet flew against it, it seemed to crumble away and a
+mass of flame darted out from the molding-room.
+The joists and timbers supporting the floor above
+the planing-room would have caught at once, but
+the boys deluged them with water, as also the framework
+of the door, and then, throwing the stream of
+water into the blazing workshop, they kept down
+the flames near the door. The smoke was stifling.</p>
+
+<p>"We shall be choked, George!" Bill gasped.</p>
+
+<p>"Lie down, Bill. I have heard the air is always
+better near the ground."</p>
+
+<p>This they found to be the case, and they were still
+able to direct the jet of water. But three or four
+minutes had elapsed when the outer door of the
+planing-house was unlocked and Bob Grimstone and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_120" id="Page_120">[Pg 120]</a></span>
+several other men rushed in, but were at once driven
+back by the smoke. George had recognized Grimstone's
+voice, and shouted:</p>
+
+<p>"This way, Bob, the fire hasn't got through yet.
+Come and lend a hand, for it's gaining on us in
+spite of the water. You can breathe if you kneel
+down."</p>
+
+<p>Grimstone, with two or three of the men, crawled
+in and joined the boys.</p>
+
+<p>"What! is it you, George? How on earth did
+you get here?" Bob exclaimed.</p>
+
+<p>"We saw a light as we were passing, and got in
+from behind. When we saw what it was we rang
+the alarm-bell, and then came on here to do what we
+could till help came."</p>
+
+<p>"You are good-plucked, you are," Grimstone
+said admiringly; "but I am afraid it's not much
+good."</p>
+
+<p>"You take the hose, Bob, and keep the rafters
+drenched there. Bill and I will crawl forward and
+clear the shavings out of the way if we can. They
+have caught half a dozen times already."</p>
+
+<p>The two boys crawled forward, and although the
+heat was tremendous they managed to clear away
+the shavings for a considerable distance. The
+smoke and heat were so great that they were obliged
+to crawl back into the outer air, where for a while
+they lay almost insensible. There were crowds of
+men in the yard now, but most of them were round
+at the back, powerless to aid at present, and only<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_121" id="Page_121">[Pg 121]</a></span>
+watching the flames as they roared through the
+whole of the windows of the molding-room.</p>
+
+<p>Men were hurrying past with buckets of water,
+and one of them, seeing the condition of the boys,
+dashed some over their heads and faces, and they
+presently staggered to their feet. It was now a
+quarter of an hour since they had first given the
+alarm, and they were just about to re-enter the
+planing-shop to rejoin Bill when they met him and
+his comrades coming out.</p>
+
+<p>"All the water's gone," he said; "if the engines
+aint here in a minute or two it will be too late."</p>
+
+<p>But just at that moment there was a cheer outside,
+and immediately afterwards a fire-engine
+dashed through the gate. Grimstone ran up to the
+firemen as they leaped off.</p>
+
+<p>"The great thing," he said, "is to prevent it
+spreading from that shop into this. We have been
+keeping it back till now, but the tank has just run
+dry."</p>
+
+<p>While the other firemen were fitting the hose to
+the fire-plug just outside the gates one of them made
+his way into the planing-room to ascertain the exact
+position of affairs.</p>
+
+<p>"Quick, lads," he said; "there's no time to be
+lost; the fire is making its way through. Another
+five minutes and we should have been too late to
+save any of this block. Is there any communication
+through the upper floors?" he asked Grimstone.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, there is a door on each floor,"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_122" id="Page_122">[Pg 122]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Have you got any empty sacks about the
+place?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, there is a pile of them in there."</p>
+
+<p>The fireman gave instructions to one of his comrades,
+while he himself made his way into the planing-room
+with the hose; the other got out the sacks,
+and assisted by Grimstone and some of the hands
+drenched them with water, and then proceeding to
+the door on the first floor piled them against it.</p>
+
+<p>"It is hot already," he said as he laid his hand
+upon it. "Now, do you men bring me buckets of
+water. Keep the sacks drenched till another engine
+comes up."</p>
+
+<p>George and Bill, finding they could be of no more
+use, made their way out to the back and joined the
+crowd watching the flames, which had already
+spread to the first floor. They were, however, with
+the rest of the lookers-on, speedily turned out of the
+yard by the police, who, having now arrived in
+sufficient strength, proceeded at once to clear the
+premises of all save a score or two of men who were
+engaged in assisting the firemen.</p>
+
+<p>As the boys went out through the front gate another
+engine dashed up at full speed, dropping
+lighted cinders on its way.</p>
+
+<p>"Hurray!" Bill said; "this is a steamer. I expect
+they will do now."</p>
+
+<p>Then the boys made their way round again to the
+back, and by means of the pieces of timber established
+themselves on the wall, where they were soon<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_123" id="Page_123">[Pg 123]</a></span>
+joined by a number of others, and watched the struggle
+with the flames.</p>
+
+<p>In half an hour six engines were on the spot;
+but even this force had no visible effect upon the
+flames in that portion of the building in which they
+had taken possession, and the firemen turned the
+whole of their efforts to prevent it from spreading.</p>
+
+<p>The party wall dividing it from the main building
+was a very strong one; but so hot had it become that
+the floor boards touching it were over and over again
+in flames.</p>
+
+<p>A score of men with saws and axes cut away the
+flooring adjoining the doors on the first and second
+stories. The planing-room was fortunately not
+boarded. While a portion of the fire brigade
+worked unceasingly in preventing the spread of the
+flames in this direction, the rest turned their attention
+to the great wood piles, which were repeatedly
+ignited by the fragments of burning wood.</p>
+
+<p>Presently the roof fell in, and the flames shot up
+high into the air, but grand as the sight was, the
+boys did not wait any longer looking on. Their
+faces smarted severely from the heat to which they
+had been exposed; their hands had been a good deal
+burned by the shavings; their hair, eyebrows, and
+eyelashes were singed, and the eyeballs ached with
+the glare.</p>
+
+<p>"I will run home now, Bill; mother will likely
+enough hear of the fire, and as we said we should
+be back soon after eight she will be getting anxious."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_124" id="Page_124">[Pg 124]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"I will go and tell her it's all right; you stop and
+see the end of it here."</p>
+
+<p>But this George would not hear of.</p>
+
+<p>"Very well, then, I will go with you. I must
+get some grease or something to put on my face and
+hands; they are smarting awfully."</p>
+
+<p>Mrs. Andrews gave an exclamation of surprise
+and alarm as the boys entered. The irritation of
+the wood smoke had so much inflamed their eyes
+that they could scarcely see out of them, and their
+faces looked like pieces of raw beef.</p>
+
+<p>"Whatever has happened, boys?" she exclaimed.</p>
+
+<p>"There's a great fire at Penrose's, mother; it
+broke out just as we were passing, so we stopped to
+help for a bit, and then came home to tell you, thinking
+that you might be anxious."</p>
+
+<p>"A fire at the works!" Mrs. Andrews exclaimed;
+"that is dreadful. Dreadful for Mr. Penrose, and
+for all of you who work there; more, perhaps, for
+you than for him, for no doubt he is insured, and
+you may be out of work for months. Thank God I
+have plenty of work, so I dare say we shall be able
+to tide it over."</p>
+
+<p>"It is not all burned, mother; only the molding-shop
+and the floors above it are on fire at present,
+and as there are six fire-engines at work, and they
+keep on arriving every minute, I hope they will
+save the rest; and now, mother, what can we
+do to our faces and hands, they are smarting
+awfully?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_125" id="Page_125">[Pg 125]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Dear me, George, are you burnt? I thought
+you were only dreadfully hot."</p>
+
+<p>"We feel hot, mother, just as if our faces were
+being roasted."</p>
+
+<p>"I will get some oil, that will be the best thing,"
+Mrs. Andrews said, hurrying away to the kitchen,
+and coming back with a piece of cotton-wool, and
+some olive-oil in a cup.</p>
+
+<p>"You are burned, George. Why, child, your
+hair is all singed, and your eyebrows and eyelashes.
+Why, what have you been doing to yourselves?
+There could have been no occasion to put your heads
+into the flames like that. Why, your hands are
+worse still; they are quite blistered. I had better
+wrap them up in cotton-wool."</p>
+
+<p>"It's the inside that's the worst, mother; perhaps
+if you put a bit of cotton-wool there and tie it round
+the back it will do; we can't go out with our hands
+all swaddled round like that. And now, please, directly
+you have done we want to go down again to
+see the fire. Just you go up to the road corner,
+mother. It's a grand sight, I can tell you."</p>
+
+<p>"We will have tea first," Mrs. Andrews said decidedly;
+"everything has been ready except pouring
+the water in since eight o'clock, and it's a quarter
+past nine now. After we have done I will put on
+my bonnet and walk down with you as near as I can
+get. I am not going to lose you out of my sight
+again."</p>
+
+<p>So after their meal they went down together, but<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_126" id="Page_126">[Pg 126]</a></span>
+could not get anywhere near the works, all the approaches
+now being guarded by the police. It was
+a grand sight, but the worst was over, and there was
+a general feeling of confidence in the crowd that it
+would spread no further. A dozen engines were at
+work now. Some of the firemen were on the roof,
+some on the stacks of timber, which looked red-hot
+from the deep glow from the fire. The flames were
+intermittent now, sometimes leaping up high above
+the shell of the burned-out buildings, then dying
+down again.</p>
+
+<p>"Thank God it's no worse!" Mrs. Andrews said
+fervently. "It would have been a bad winter for a
+great many down here if the fire had spread; as it
+is, not a quarter of the buildings are burned."</p>
+
+<p>"No, nothing like that, mother; not above a
+tenth, I should say. It's lucky that there was a
+strong wall between that and the next shops, or it
+must all have gone. I have heard them say that
+part was added on five or six years ago, so that the
+wall at the end of the planing-shop was an outside
+wall before; that accounts for its being so thick."</p>
+
+<p>After looking on for about half an hour they went
+back home. But neither of the boys got much sleep
+that night, the excitement they had gone through
+and the pain of their burns keeping them wide
+awake till nearly morning. As Mrs. Andrews heard
+no movement in their rooms&mdash;whereas they were
+usually up and about almost as early on Sundays as
+on other days, being unable to sleep after their usual<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_127" id="Page_127">[Pg 127]</a></span>
+hour for rising&mdash;she did not disturb them. George
+was the first to awake, and looking out of the window
+felt sure by the light that it was later than
+usual. He put his head out of the door and
+shouted:</p>
+
+<p>"Bill, are you up?" There was no answer.
+"Mother, are you up; what o'clock is it?"</p>
+
+<p>"Up! hours ago, George. Why, it's past
+eleven!"</p>
+
+<p>George gave an exclamation of astonishment and
+rushed into Bill's room. The latter had woke at
+his shout.</p>
+
+<p>"It's past eleven, Bill, and mother has been up
+for hours;" and he dashed off again to his room to
+dress. It was but a few minutes before they came
+downstairs just at the same moment.</p>
+
+<p>"Why didn't you wake us, mother?"</p>
+
+<p>"Because I thought it better to let you sleep on,
+George. I guessed that your burns had kept you
+awake for some time."</p>
+
+<p>"That they did. I thought I was never going to
+get to sleep," George said; and Bill gave a similar
+account of himself. "Still, mother, a short night
+does no harm for once, and you haven't been able to
+get to church."</p>
+
+<p>"It does not matter for once, George. What
+figures you both are!"</p>
+
+<p>"We are figures," George said ruefully. "I
+hardly knew myself when I looked in the glass.
+My eyes are almost shut up, and the skin is peeling<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_128" id="Page_128">[Pg 128]</a></span>
+off my nose, and my hair is all rough and scrubby;
+and Bill looks as bad as I do. You are a figure,
+Bill!" and George burst into a fit of laughter.</p>
+
+<p>"He's no worse than you, George; but come
+along, breakfast is waiting."</p>
+
+<p>"You haven't waited breakfast for us, I hope,
+mother?"</p>
+
+<p>"I made myself a cup of tea the first thing, boys,
+and had a slice of bread and butter, for I thought
+you might not be down for some time; but I am
+quite ready to join you; we have got fish. I put
+them down directly you called."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, I am glad you are not starving, mother;
+and I am glad too you didn't have your regular
+breakfast. It would have been horrid to sit down
+on Sunday morning without you, when it's the only
+regular breakfast we get in the week."</p>
+
+<p>Just as they had finished their meal there was a
+knock at the door. It was Bob Grimstone. Bill
+opened the door.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, how are you to-day, lad? I thought I
+would just come round and see. You look pretty
+badly burned; and so do you, George," he added, as
+he followed Bill into the sitting room.</p>
+
+<p>"Good-day, Mrs. Andrews."</p>
+
+<p>"Good-morning, Mr. Grimstone," Mrs. Andrews
+said. Since her coming the Grimstones had several
+times come in on Sunday afternoon to Laburnum
+Villas. Mrs. Andrews would, indeed, have wished
+them to come in more frequently, for she felt much<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_129" id="Page_129">[Pg 129]</a></span>
+indebted to them for their kindness to George, and,
+moreover, liked them for themselves, for both were
+good specimens of their class.</p>
+
+<p>"I see you were busy last night too, Mr. Grimstone;
+your face looks scorched; but you did not
+manage to get yourself burned as these silly boys
+did. What a blessing it is for us all that the fire did
+not spread!"</p>
+
+<p>"Well, Mrs. Andrews, I don't think those two
+lads can have told you what they did, for if they had
+you would hardly call them silly boys."</p>
+
+<p>Mrs. Andrews looked surprised.</p>
+
+<p>"They told me they lent a hand to put out the
+fire&mdash;I think those were George's words&mdash;but they
+did not tell me anything else."</p>
+
+<p>"They saved the building, ma'am. If it hadn't
+been for them there would not have been a stick or
+stone of Penrose's standing now; the shops and the
+wood piles would all have gone, and we should all
+have been idle for six months to come; there is no
+doubt about that at all."</p>
+
+<p>"Why, how was that, Mr. Grimstone? How
+was it they did more than anyone else?"</p>
+
+<p>"In the first place they discovered it, ma'am, and
+rung the alarm-bell; it mightn't have been found
+out for another five minutes, and five minutes would
+have been enough for the fire. In the next place,
+when they had given the alarm they did the only
+thing that could have saved the place: they got
+into the planing-shop and turned on the hose there,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_130" id="Page_130">[Pg 130]</a></span>
+and fought the fire from spreading through the door
+till we got in seven or eight minutes later. It was
+all we could do to stop it then; but if they hadn't
+done what they did the planing-shop would have
+been alight from end to end, and the floors above it
+too, before the first engine arrived, and then nothing
+could have saved the whole lot. I can tell you, Mrs.
+Andrews, that there isn't a man on the works, nor
+the wife of a man, who doesn't feel that they owe
+these two lads their living through the winter. I
+don't know what Mr. Penrose will say about it, but I
+know what we all feel."</p>
+
+<p>"Why, George," Mrs. Andrews said, while her
+eyes were filled with happy tears at the praises of
+her son, "why did you not tell me about it?"</p>
+
+<p>"Why, mother, there was not anything to tell,"
+George said, "and Bob has made a great fuss about
+nothing. As I told you, we saw a light as we came
+along and when we went round behind and got on
+the wall we saw the place was on fire, so we rang
+the alarm-bell, and then turned on the hose and
+flooded the place with water till Bob and some more
+came to help us."</p>
+
+<p>"It sounds very simple, Mrs. Andrews, but I can
+tell you it wasn't so. When we opened the door of
+the planing-shop it was so full of smoke that it didn't
+seem as if anyone could breathe there for a minute,
+and as we could see the glare of the flames at the
+other end we thought the place was gone. We
+should have gone out and waited for the engines if<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_131" id="Page_131">[Pg 131]</a></span>
+we hadn't heard the boys sing out that they were
+there; and even though we knelt down and crawled
+in, as they shouted to us to do, we were pretty nearly
+stifled. When we took the hose they crawled forward
+and got the shavings cleared away; that was
+how they burned their hands, I expect; and I hear
+they tumbled down insensible when they got out.
+Now, ma'am, they may make light of it, but if ever
+two young chaps behaved like heroes they did, and
+you have every right to be proud of them&mdash;I say of
+them, because although Bill's no son of yours I know
+he is what you and your boy have made him. He
+was telling me about it one day."</p>
+
+<p>"Will work go on to-morrow as usual, Bob?"
+George asked, in order to change the subject.</p>
+
+<p>"In some of the shops it will, no doubt," Bob
+said; "but in our shop and the floors above it it will
+take a day or two to clear up. I saw the foreman
+just now, and he tells me that a strong gang of carpenters
+will be put on, for both the floors are burned
+away at the end of the wall and pretty near twenty
+feet of the roof are charred. Two surveyors are
+coming down this afternoon to examine the wall and
+say whether it is safe. The walls of the shops that
+are burned out must come down, of course. The
+surveyor says that if the wall at the end of the planing-room
+looks pretty strong they will build up another
+wall against it as soon as it gets cold enough
+and the rubbish is cleared away for men to work;
+that will make a strong job of it, and there won't be<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_132" id="Page_132">[Pg 132]</a></span>
+any loss of time. Of course if the old one has to
+come down there can't be much work done in the
+shops till it's finished. The governor got down
+about ten o'clock last night. A messenger went up
+to him almost directly after the fire broke out, but
+he was out at dinner, and by the time he got down
+here all danger of it spreading was over. He had
+a talk with the foreman and arranged about the wall
+with him. He is as anxious as we are that there
+should be no delay, for there are some heavy orders
+in, and, of course, he doesn't want them taken anywhere
+else."</p>
+
+<p>"Will you look at their hands, Mr. Grimstone. I
+don't know much about it, but they seem to be badly
+burned."</p>
+
+<p>"That they are, ma'am," Mr. Grimstone said
+when he had examined them; "pretty nigh raw. If
+I might give an opinion, I should say as the doctor
+had better see them; they are precious painful, aint
+they, George?"</p>
+
+<p>"They do feel as if they were on fire, Bob, but I
+don't see any use in a doctor. I don't suppose he
+can do more than mother has."</p>
+
+<p>"Perhaps not, George, but he had better see them
+for all that; he may give you some cooling lotion for
+them, and I can tell you burns on the hand are apt
+to be serious matters, for the muscles of the fingers
+may get stiffened. I have known two or three cases
+like that. You had better go at once to Dr. Maxwell;
+he always attends if there are any accidents at<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_133" id="Page_133">[Pg 133]</a></span>
+the works. You know the house, George; it is
+about halfway between this and the works."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, you had better go at once, boys," Mrs. Andrews
+said; "there, put on your hats and be off."</p>
+
+<p>"I will walk with them. I must be off anyway,
+for the missis will be waiting dinner for me."</p>
+
+<p>"Are we to pay, mother?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, not till you have done, George. I dare say
+you will have to have your hands dressed several
+times."</p>
+
+<p>"There won't be any occasion to pay him, Mrs.
+Andrews. The firm always pays the doctor in case
+of accidents, and you may be very sure that in this
+case they will be only too glad."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, in any case, George," Mrs. Andrews said,
+"you can tell the doctor that you will pay when he
+says that you need not come to him again. If Mr.
+Penrose hears about it and chooses to pay I should
+not think of refusing, as you have been burned in
+his service; but certainly I should not assume that
+he will do so."</p>
+
+<p>"Shall I go in with you, boys?" Bob asked when
+they reached the door. "I know the doctor; he attended
+me two years ago when I pretty nigh had my
+finger taken off by one of the cutters."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, please, Bob, I wish you would."</p>
+
+<p>They were shown into the surgery, where the
+doctor soon joined them.</p>
+
+<p>"I've brought these two young chaps for you to
+look at their hands, Dr. Maxwell. They got them<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_134" id="Page_134">[Pg 134]</a></span>
+burnt last night at the fire. Mrs. Andrews, the
+mother of this lad, wished me to say that she would
+pay the charges when you have done with them; but
+as if it hadn't been for them the works would have
+been burnt down as sure as you are standing there,
+I expect the firm will take the matter in their own
+hands."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, they are nasty burns," the doctor said, examining
+the boys' hands. "Can you open and shut
+them, boy?"</p>
+
+<p>"I think I could if tried, sir," George said, "but
+I shouldn't like to try, for if I move my fingers at
+all it hurts them awfully."</p>
+
+<p>"I see you have had oil and cotton-wool on your
+hands."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes."</p>
+
+<p>"The best thing you can do, boys, is to put on
+some soothing poultices. Tell your mother to get
+some linseed and mix it with olive-oil. I will give
+you a bottle of laudanum. Let her put about twenty
+drops of that into the oil before she mixes it with
+the linseed. Every four or five hours change the
+poultices. I think you will find that will relieve the
+pain a good deal. I see your faces are scorched too.
+You can do nothing better than keep them moistened
+with sweet-oil. I should advise you to keep as quiet
+as possible for three or four days."</p>
+
+<p>"But we shall want to get to work, sir," George
+said.</p>
+
+<p>"Nonsense! You will be very lucky if you can<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_135" id="Page_135">[Pg 135]</a></span>
+use your hands in another fortnight. I will send
+in the usual certificate to the works."</p>
+
+<p>"Will you tell the foreman, Bob," George said
+when they left the doctor's, "how it is we can't come
+to work? You tell him we wanted to, and that we
+hope to come back as soon as our hands are all right;
+because, you see, the men and boys at the shops
+which have been burnt down will be all out of work,
+and it would be awful if we found our places filled
+up when we went to work again."</p>
+
+<p>"Don't you be afraid, George; there is no fear of
+your being out of work after what you have
+done."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, what did the doctor say?" was Mrs. Andrews'
+first question when they returned home.</p>
+
+<p>"He didn't say much, mother, except that we
+must not think of going to work for a fortnight anyhow,
+and we are to have poultices made with linseed
+mixed with oil, and twenty drops of laudanum from
+this bottle, and it must be put on fresh every three
+or four hours. I am afraid it will be an awful
+trouble."</p>
+
+<p>"The trouble won't matter," Mrs. Andrews said
+brightly. "Did he say you were to go to bed?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, mother; but we were to keep as quiet as we
+could."</p>
+
+<p>"Then in that case, George, I think you had better
+go to bed."</p>
+
+<p>"No; I am sure we had better not," George said.
+"I should toss and fidget about there horridly. The<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_136" id="Page_136">[Pg 136]</a></span>
+best thing will be for us to sit here, and then we
+shall be all together. And if you talk to us, and
+perhaps read to us, we shan't feel it half so much.
+What are you going to do, mother?" he asked five
+minutes afterwards, as Mrs. Andrews came down
+with her bonnet on.</p>
+
+<p>"I am going to get some linseed, George, of
+course. I haven't got any in the house."</p>
+
+<p>"But it's Sunday, mother, and the shops will be
+shut."</p>
+
+<p>"I shall get it at the chemist's, George. They
+will always supply things that are needed even on
+Sunday. People are ill on Sunday as well as any
+other day, you know. I shan't be gone more than
+a quarter of an hour. You must keep very quiet
+till I come back."</p>
+
+<p>The boys found a good deal of relief from the
+effect of the poultices, and were very much better
+after a good night's rest. At ten o'clock the next
+morning, as Mrs. Andrews was sitting at her work,
+with the boys both on the hearthrug in front of the
+fire, there was a knock at the door. It was a loud
+double knock, quite unlike the ordinary summons of
+the baker's boy, who was the only regular caller.
+The boys jumped up in surprise.</p>
+
+<p>"Who can that be, mother?"</p>
+
+<p>"We shall soon see," Mrs. Andrews said quietly.</p>
+
+<p>She was not surprised, on opening the door, to see
+a gentleman standing there, whom, by the description
+the boys had given of him, she guessed to be<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_137" id="Page_137">[Pg 137]</a></span>
+their employer. A little girl was standing by his
+side.</p>
+
+<p>"Is this Mrs. Andrews?" the gentleman asked.</p>
+
+<p>"I am Mrs. Andrews," the lady answered quietly.</p>
+
+<p>"My name is Penrose. I have called with my
+daughter to inquire after the two lads&mdash;one of them
+your son, I believe&mdash;who so gallantly saved my place
+from being burned down on Saturday evening. I
+only heard about it late yesterday evening, when I
+came down to arrange about some matters with the
+foreman. He did not know the facts of the case
+on Saturday night, but had learned them yesterday,
+and there can be no doubt whatever, from what he
+says, that had it not been for the presence of mind
+and bravery of these two lads nothing could have
+saved the entire works and all the wood piles from
+destruction. I told my daughter this morning, and
+she insisted on coming down with me. You know
+she is already indebted to your son for saving a
+locket which we both greatly valued."</p>
+
+<p>"Will you walk in, sir?" and Mrs. Andrews
+showed them into the sitting room.</p>
+
+<p>Mr. Penrose had been somewhat surprised by
+Mrs. Andrews' manner, although the foreman, in
+telling him of the boys' conduct, had also stated
+what he knew about them.</p>
+
+<p>"They are out-of-the-way sort of boys, sir," he
+said. "There was quite a talk about them in the
+shops in the spring. They lodged with Grimstone,
+and it seems that after they had been here at work<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_138" id="Page_138">[Pg 138]</a></span>
+five months Andrews' mother, who had been ill, was
+coming to them, and they got Grimstone to take a
+house for them, and it turned out that ever since
+they had been at work here they had been putting by
+half their wages to furnish a place for her, so they
+must have lived on about five shillings a week each
+and got clothes for themselves out of it. Now, sir,
+boys as would do that aint ordinary boys, and there
+was quite a talk among the men about it. I hear
+from Grimstone that Mrs. Andrews is a superior
+sort of person, he says quite a lady. She does work,
+I believe, for some London shop."</p>
+
+<p>Mr. Penrose, therefore, was prepared to find the
+boys in a more comfortable abode than usual, and
+their mother what the foreman called a superior sort
+of woman; but he perceived at once by her address
+that Grimstone's estimate had been a correct one,
+and that she was indeed a lady. The prettiness of
+the little sitting room, with its comfortable furniture,
+its snowy curtains and pretty belongings,
+heightened this feeling.</p>
+
+<p>"I have come to see you, boys," he said, "and to
+tell you how indebted I feel to you for your exertions
+on Saturday. There is no doubt that had it
+not been for you the place would have been entirely
+burned. It was fully insured, but it would have
+been a serious matter for me, as I should have lost
+four or five months' work, and it would have been
+still more serious for the men to have been thrown
+out of employment at this time of the year, so we all<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_139" id="Page_139">[Pg 139]</a></span>
+feel very much indebted to you. I hope you are not
+much burned."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, no, sir! our hands are burned a bit, but they
+will be all right in a few days. Bill and I are very
+glad, sir, that we happened to be passing, and were
+able to give the alarm and do something to stop the
+flames till the others came up; but we don't feel that
+it was anything out of the way. It was just a piece
+of fun and excitement to us."</p>
+
+<p>"They didn't say anything about it, Mr. Penrose,
+when they came home, and it was only when one of
+the men came in next day to ask after them that I
+heard that they had really been of use."</p>
+
+<p>"It is all very well to say so, lads," Mr. Penrose
+replied; "but there is no doubt you showed a great
+deal of courage, as well as presence of mind, and
+you may be sure that I shall not forget it. And
+now, Mrs. Andrews," he said, turning round to her,
+"I feel rather in a false position. I came round to
+see the lads, who, when I last saw them, were not
+in very flourishing circumstances, and I was going
+to make them a present for the service they had done
+me, and my daughter has brought them a basket
+with some wine, jelly, and other things such as are
+good for sick boys. Finding them as I find them,
+in your care and in such a home, you see I feel a difficulty
+about it altogether."</p>
+
+<p>"Thank you, sir," Mrs. Andrews said, "for the
+kindness of your intention; but my boys&mdash;for although
+one is in no way related to me I feel towards<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_140" id="Page_140">[Pg 140]</a></span>
+him as if he were my own&mdash;would not like to take
+money for doing their duty towards their employer."</p>
+
+<p>"No, indeed!" George and Bill exclaimed simultaneously.</p>
+
+<p>"As you see, sir, thanks to the work you were
+good enough to give the boys and to my needle,"&mdash;and
+she glanced towards the articles on the table,&mdash;"we
+are very comfortable; but I am sure the boys
+will be very glad to accept the things which your
+daughter has been so kind as to bring down for
+them, and will feel very much obliged for her
+thoughtfulness."</p>
+
+<p>"That is right," Mr. Penrose said, relieved.
+"Nelly, you may as well leave the basket as it is.
+I am sure you don't want to carry it back again?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, papa," Nelly said; and indeed even the
+empty basket would have been more than the child
+could well have carried. It had come on the top of
+the carriage to the railway-station, and a porter had
+accompanied Mr. Penrose with it to Laburnum
+Villas.</p>
+
+<p>"You would have hardly known your young
+friend. Would you, Nelly?"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't think I should," she said, shaking her
+head. "He looks dreadfully burned, and his hair
+is all funny and frizzled."</p>
+
+<p>"It will soon grow again," George said, smiling.
+"The doctor says our faces will be all right when
+the skin is peeled off. Thank you very much, Miss
+Penrose, for all the nice things. It was a fortunate<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_141" id="Page_141">[Pg 141]</a></span>
+day indeed for us when I caught that boy stealing
+your locket."</p>
+
+<p>"And it was a fortunate day for us too," Mr.
+Penrose responded. "Now, Mrs. Andrews, we will
+say good-by. You will not mind my calling again
+to see how the boys are getting on?"</p>
+
+<p>"It will be very kind of you, sir, and we shall be
+glad to see you," Mrs. Andrews replied; "but I hope
+in a few days they will both be out of the doctor's
+hands."</p>
+
+<p>"I can't shake hands with you," Mr. Penrose said,
+patting the boys on the shoulder, "but I hope next
+time I see you to be able to do so. Good-morning,
+Mrs. Andrews."</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_142" id="Page_142">[Pg 142]</a></span></p>
+<h2><a name="CHAPTER_VII" id="CHAPTER_VII"></a>CHAPTER VII.</h2>
+
+<h3>SAVED!</h3>
+
+
+<p>"Now let us have a look at the basket, mother,"
+George said as Mrs. Andrews returned into the
+room after seeing her two visitors off. "It's very
+kind of him, isn't it? and I am glad he didn't offer us
+money; that would have been horrid, wouldn't it?"</p>
+
+<p>"I am glad he did not, too, George. Mr. Penrose
+is evidently a gentleman of delicacy and refinement
+of feeling, and he saw that he would give pain
+if he did so."</p>
+
+<p>"You see it too, don't you, Bill?" George asked.
+"You know you thought I was a fool not to take
+money when he offered it for getting back the locket;
+but you see it in the same way now, don't you?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes; I shouldn't have liked to take money,"
+Bill said. "I sees&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>"See," Mrs. Andrews corrected.</p>
+
+<p>"Thank you. I see things different&mdash;differently,"
+he corrected himself, seeing that George was
+about to speak, "to what I did then."</p>
+
+<p>"Now, mother," George said, "let us open the
+basket; it's almost as big as a clothes-basket,
+isn't it?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_143" id="Page_143">[Pg 143]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>The cover was lifted and the contents, which had
+after much thought been settled by Nelly herself,
+were disclosed. There were two bottles of port-wine,
+a large mold of jelly, a great cake, two dozen
+oranges, some apples, a box of preserved fruit, some
+almonds and raisins, two packets of Everton toffee,
+a dozen mince-pies, and four pots of black-currant
+jelly, on the cover of one of which was written in a
+sprawling hand, "Two teaspoonfuls stirred up in
+a tumbler of water for a drink at night."</p>
+
+<p>"This will make a grand feast, mother; what a
+jolly collection, isn't it? I think Miss Penrose must
+have chosen it herself, don't you?"</p>
+
+<p>"It certainly looks like it, George," Mrs. Andrews
+replied, smiling. "I do not think any grownup
+person would have chosen mince-pies and toffee
+as appropriate for sick boys."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes; but she must have known we were not
+badly burned, mother; and besides, you see, she put
+in currant-jelly to make drinks, and there are the
+oranges too. I vote that we have an orange and
+some toffee at once, Bill."</p>
+
+<p>"I have tasted oranges," Bill said, "lots of them
+in the market, but I never tasted toffee."</p>
+
+<p>"It's first-rate, I can tell you."</p>
+
+<p>"Why, they look like bits of tin," Bill said as the
+packet was opened.</p>
+
+<p>George burst into a laugh.</p>
+
+<p>"That's tin-foil, that's only to wrap it up; you
+peel that off, Bill, and you will find the toffee inside.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_144" id="Page_144">[Pg 144]</a></span>
+Now, mother, you have a glass of wine and a piece
+of cake."</p>
+
+<p>"I will have a piece of cake, George; but I am
+not going to open the wine. We will put that by in
+case of illness or of any very extraordinary occasion."</p>
+
+<p>"I am glad the other things won't keep, mother,
+or I expect you would be wanting to put them all
+away. Isn't this toffee good, Bill?"</p>
+
+<p>"First-rate," Bill agreed. "What is it made
+of?"</p>
+
+<p>"Sugar and butter melted together over the fire."</p>
+
+<p>"You are like two children," Mrs. Andrews
+laughed, "instead of boys getting on for sixteen
+years old. Now I must clear this table again and
+get to work; I promised these four bonnets should
+be sent in to-morrow morning, and there's lots to be
+done to them yet."</p>
+
+<p>It was three weeks before the boys were able to
+go to work again. The foreman came round on
+Saturdays with their wages. Mr. Penrose called
+again; this time they were out, but he chatted for
+some time with Mrs. Andrews.</p>
+
+<p>"I don't wish to pry into your affairs, Mrs. Andrews,"
+he said, after asking about the boys; "but
+I have a motive for asking if your son has, as I suppose
+he has, from his way of speaking, had a fair
+education."</p>
+
+<p>"He was at school up to the age of twelve," Mrs.
+Andrews said quietly; "circumstances at that time<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_145" id="Page_145">[Pg 145]</a></span>
+obliged me to remove him; but I have since done
+what I could myself towards continuing his education,
+and he still works regularly of an evening."</p>
+
+<p>"Why I ask, Mrs. Andrews, was that I should
+like in time to place him in the counting-house. I
+say in time, because I think it will be better for him
+for the next two or three years to continue to work
+in the shops. I will have him moved from shop to
+shop so as to learn thoroughly the various branches
+of the business. That is what I should do had I a
+son of my own to bring into the business. It will
+make him more valuable afterwards, and fit him to
+take a good position either in my shops or in any
+similar business should an opening occur."</p>
+
+<p>"I am greatly obliged to you, sir," Mrs. Andrews
+said gratefully; "though I say it myself, a better
+boy never lived."</p>
+
+<p>"I am sure he is by what I have heard of him,
+and I shall be only too glad, after the service he has
+rendered me, to do everything in my power to push
+him forward. His friend, I hear, has not had the
+same advantages. At the time I first saw him he
+looked a regular young arab."</p>
+
+<p>"So he was, sir; but he is a fine young fellow.
+He was very kind to my boy when he was alone in
+London, and gave up his former life to be with him.
+George taught him to read before I came here, and
+he has worked hard ever since. No one could be
+nicer in the house than he is, and had I been his own
+mother he could not be more dutiful or anxious to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_146" id="Page_146">[Pg 146]</a></span>
+please. Indeed I may say that I am indebted for
+my home here as much to him as to my own
+boy."</p>
+
+<p>"I am glad to hear you say so, Mrs. Andrews, for
+of course I should wish to do something for him too.
+At any rate, I will give him, like your son, every
+opportunity of learning the business, and he will in
+time be fit for a position of foreman of a shop&mdash;by
+no means a bad one for a lad who has had such a
+beginning as he has had. After that, of course, it
+must depend upon himself. I think, if you will
+allow me to suggest, it would be as well that you
+should not tell them the nature of our conversation.
+Of course it is for you to decide; but, however steady
+boys they are, it might make them a little less able
+to get on well with their associates in a shop if they
+know that they are going to be advanced."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't think it would make any difference to
+them, sir; but at the same time I do think it would
+be as well not to tell them."</p>
+
+<p>One day Bill was out by himself as the men were
+coming out of the shop, and he stopped to speak to
+Bob Grimstone.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh! I am glad to find you without George,"
+Bob said; "'cause I want to talk to you. Look
+here! the men in all the shops have made a subscription
+to give you and George a present. Everyone
+feels that it's your doing that we have not got to
+idle all this winter, and when someone started the
+idea there wasn't a man in the two shops that didn't<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_147" id="Page_147">[Pg 147]</a></span>
+agree with him. I am the treasurer, I am, and it's
+come to just thirty pounds. Now I don't know
+what you two boys would like, whether you would
+like it in money, or whether you would like it in
+something else, so I thought I would ask you first.
+I thought you would know what George would like,
+seeing what friends you are, and then you know it
+would come as a surprise to him. Now, what do
+you say?"</p>
+
+<p>"Its very kind of you," Bill said. "I am sure
+George would like anything better than money, and
+so should I."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, you think it over, Bill, and let me know
+in a day or two. We were thinking of a watch for
+each of you, with an inscription, saying it was presented
+to you by your shopmates for having saved
+the factory, and so kept them at work for months
+just at the beginning of winter. That's what
+seemed to me that you would like; but if there is
+anything you would like better, just you say so.
+You come down here to-morrow or next day, when
+you have thought it over, and give me an answer.
+Of course you can consult George if you think
+best."</p>
+
+<p>Bill met Bob Grimstone on the following day.</p>
+
+<p>"I have thought it over," he said, "and I know
+what George and me would like better than any
+possible thing you could get."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, what is it, Bill?"</p>
+
+<p>"Well, what we have set our minds on, and what<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_148" id="Page_148">[Pg 148]</a></span>
+we were going to save up our money to get, was a
+piano for George's mother. I heard her say that we
+could get a very nice one for about thirty pounds,
+and it would be splendid if you were all to give it
+her."</p>
+
+<p>"Very well, Bill, then a piano it shall be. I know
+a chap as works at Kirkman's, and I expect he will
+be able to give us a good one for the money."</p>
+
+<p>Accordingly on the Saturday afternoon before the
+boys were going to work again, Mrs. Andrews and
+George were astonished at seeing a cart stop before
+the house, and the foreman, Bob Grimstone, and
+four other men coming up to the door.</p>
+
+<p>Bill ran and opened the door, and the men entered.
+He had been apprised of the time that they might
+be expected, and at once showed them in.</p>
+
+<p>"Mrs. Andrews," the foreman said, "I and my
+mates here are a deputation from the hands employed
+in the shop, and we have come to offer you a
+little sort of testimonial of what we feel we owe your
+son and Bill Smith for putting out the fire and saving
+the shops. If it hadn't been for them it would
+have been a bad winter for us all. So after thinking
+it over and finding out what form of testimonial
+the lads would like best, we have got you a piano,
+which we hope you may live long to play on and
+enjoy. We had proposed to give them a watch
+each; but we found that they would rather that it
+took the form of a piano."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, how good and kind of you all!" Mrs. An<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_149" id="Page_149">[Pg 149]</a></span>drews
+said, much affected. "I shall indeed be
+proud of your gift, both for itself and for the kind
+feeling towards my boys which it expresses."</p>
+
+<p>"Then, ma'am, with your permission we will just
+bring it in;" and the deputation retired to assist with
+the piano.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, boys, how could you do it without telling
+me!" Mrs. Andrews exclaimed.</p>
+
+<p>George had hitherto stood speechless with surprise.</p>
+
+<p>"But I didn't know anything about it, mother.
+I don't know what they mean by saying that we
+would rather have it than watches. Of course we
+would, a hundred times; but I don't know how they
+knew it."</p>
+
+<p>"Then it must have been your kind thought,
+Bill."</p>
+
+<p>"It wasn't no kind thought, Mrs. Andrews, but
+they spoke to me about it, and I knew that a piano
+was what we should like better than anything else,
+and I didn't say anything about it, because Bob
+Grimstone thought that it would be nicer to be a surprise
+to George as well as to you."</p>
+
+<p>"You are right, old boy," George said, shaking
+Bill by the hand; "why, there never was such a good
+idea; it is splendid, mother, isn't it?"</p>
+
+<p>The men now appeared at the door with the
+piano. This was at once placed in the position
+which had long ago been decided upon as the best
+place for the piano when it should come. Mrs. An<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_150" id="Page_150">[Pg 150]</a></span>drews
+opened it, and there on the front was a silver
+plate with the inscription:</p>
+
+<p>"To Mrs. Andrews from the Employees at
+Messrs. Penrose &amp; Co., in token of their gratitude to
+George Andrews and William Smith for their courage
+and presence of mind, by which the factory was
+saved from being destroyed by fire on Saturday the
+23d of October, 1857."</p>
+
+<p>The tears which stood in Mrs. Andrews' eyes rendered
+it difficult for her to read the inscription.</p>
+
+<p>"I thank you, indeed," she said. "Now, perhaps
+you would like to hear its tones." So saying
+she sat down and played "Home, Sweet Home."
+"It has a charming touch," she said as she rose,
+"and, you see, the air was an appropriate one, for
+your gift will serve to make home even sweeter than
+before. Give, please, my grateful thanks, and those
+of my boys, to all who have subscribed."</p>
+
+<p>The inhabitants of No. 8 Laburnum Villas had
+long been a subject of considerable discussion
+and interest to their neighbors, for the appearance
+of the boys as they came home of an evening
+in their working clothes seemed altogether incongruous
+with that of their mother and with the
+neatness and prettiness of the villa, and was, indeed,
+considered derogatory to the respectability of
+Laburnum Villas in general. Upon this evening
+they were still further mystified at hearing
+the notes of a female voice of great power and sweetness,
+accompanied by a piano, played evidently by<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_151" id="Page_151">[Pg 151]</a></span>
+an accomplished musician, issuing from the house.
+As to the boys, they thought that, next only to that
+of the home-coming of Mrs. Andrews, never was
+such a happy evening spent in the world.</p>
+
+<p>I do not think that in all London there was a
+household that enjoyed that winter more than did
+the inmates of No. 8 Laburnum Villas. Their total
+earnings were about thirty-five shillings a week,
+much less than that of many a mechanic, but ample
+for them not only to live, but to live in comfort and
+even refinement. No stranger, who had looked into
+the pretty drawing room in the evening, would have
+dreamed that the lady at the piano worked as a
+milliner for her living, or that the lads were boys in
+a manufactory.</p>
+
+<p>When spring came they began to plan various
+trips and excursions which could be taken on bank
+holidays or during the long summer evenings, when
+an event happened which, for a time, cut short all
+their plans. The word had been passed round the
+shops the first thing in the morning that Mr. Penrose
+was coming down with a party of ladies and
+gentlemen to go over the works, and that things were
+to be made as tidy as possible.</p>
+
+<p>Accordingly there was a general clearing up, and
+vast quantities of shavings and sawdust were swept
+up from the floors, although when the machines had
+run again for a few hours no one would have
+thought that a broom had been seen in the place for
+weeks.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_152" id="Page_152">[Pg 152]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>George was now in a shop where a number of
+machines were at work grooving, mortising, and
+performing other work to prepare the wood for
+builders' purposes. The party arrived just as work
+had recommenced after dinner.</p>
+
+<p>There were ten or twelve gentlemen and as many
+ladies. Nelly Penrose, with two girls about her
+own age, accompanied the party. They stopped for
+a time in each shop while Mr. Penrose explained the
+nature of the work and the various points of the
+machinery.</p>
+
+<p>They had passed through most of the other rooms
+before they entered that in which George was engaged,
+and the young girls, taking but little interest
+in the details of the machinery, wandered somewhat
+away from the rest of the party, chatting among
+themselves. George had his eye upon them, and
+was wishing that Mr. Penrose would turn round and
+speak to them, for they were moving about carelessly
+and not paying sufficient heed to the machinery.</p>
+
+<p>Suddenly he threw down his work and darted forward
+with a shout; but he was too late, a revolving-band
+had caught Nelly Penrose's dress. In an instant
+she was dragged forward and in another moment
+would have been whirled into the middle of
+the machinery.</p>
+
+<p>There was a violent scream, followed by a sudden
+crash and a harsh grating sound, and then the whole
+of the machinery on that side of the room came to
+a standstill. For a moment no one knew what had<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_153" id="Page_153">[Pg 153]</a></span>
+happened. Mr. Penrose and some of his friends
+rushed forward to raise Nelly. Her hand was held
+fast between the band and the pulley, and the band
+had to be cut to relieve it.</p>
+
+<p>"What an escape! what an escape!" Mr. Penrose
+murmured, as he lifted her. "Another second and
+nothing could have saved her. But what stopped
+the machinery?" and for the first time he looked
+round the shop. There was a little group of men a
+few yards away, and, having handed Nelly, who was
+crying bitterly, for her hand was much bruised, to
+one of the ladies, he stepped towards them. The
+foreman came forward to meet him.</p>
+
+<p>"I think, sir, you had better get the ladies out of
+the shop. I am afraid young Andrews is badly hurt."</p>
+
+<p>"How is it? What is the matter?" Mr. Penrose asked.</p>
+
+<p>"I think, sir, he saw the danger your daughter
+was in, and shoved his foot in between two of the
+cog-wheels."</p>
+
+<p>"You don't say so!" Mr. Penrose exclaimed, as
+he pushed forward among the men.</p>
+
+<p>Two of them were supporting George Andrews,
+who, as pale as death, lay in their arms. One of his
+feet was jammed in between two of the cog-wheels.
+He was scarcely conscious.</p>
+
+<p>"Good Heavens," Mr. Penrose exclaimed in a
+low tone, "his foot must be completely crushed!
+Have you thrown off the driving belt, Williams?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_154" id="Page_154">[Pg 154]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sir, I did that first thing."</p>
+
+<p>"That's right; now work away for your lives,
+lads." This was said to two men who had already
+seized spanners and were unscrewing the bolts of
+the bearings in order to enable the upper shafting to
+be lifted and the cog-wheel removed. Then Mr.
+Penrose returned to his friends.</p>
+
+<p>"Pray leave the shop," he said, "and go down
+into the office. There's been a bad accident; a noble
+young fellow has sacrificed himself to save Nelly's
+life, and is, I fear, terribly hurt. Williams, send off
+a man instantly for the surgeon. Let him jump
+into one of the cabs he will find waiting at the gate,
+and tell the man to drive as hard as he can go. If
+Dr. Maxwell is not at home let him fetch someone
+else."</p>
+
+<p>George had indeed sacrificed himself to save Nelly
+Penrose. When he saw the band catch her dress he
+had looked round for an instant for something with
+which to stop the machinery, but there was nothing
+at hand, and without an instant's hesitation he had
+thrust his foot between the cog-wheels. He had on
+very heavy, thickly nailed working boots, and the
+iron-bound sole threw the cogs out of gear and bent
+the shaft, thereby stopping the machinery. George
+felt a dull, sickening pain, which seemed to numb
+and paralyze him all over, and he remembered little
+more until, on the shafting being removed, his foot
+was extricated and he was laid gently down on a
+heap of shavings. The first thing he realized when<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_155" id="Page_155">[Pg 155]</a></span>
+he was conscious was that someone was pouring
+some liquid, which half-choked him, down his throat.</p>
+
+<p>When he opened his eyes, Mr. Penrose, kneeling
+beside him, was supporting his head, while on the
+other side knelt Bill Smith, the tears streaming down
+his cheeks and struggling to suppress his sobs.</p>
+
+<p>"What is it, Bill? What's the matter?" Then
+the remembrance of what had passed flashed upon
+him.</p>
+
+<p>"Is she safe; was I in time?"</p>
+
+<p>"Quite safe, my dear boy. Thank God, your
+noble sacrifice was not in vain," Mr. Penrose answered
+with quivering lips, for he too had the
+greatest difficulty in restraining his emotion.</p>
+
+<p>"Am I badly hurt, sir?" George asked after a
+pause, "because, if so, will you please send home for
+mother? I don't feel in any pain, but I feel strange
+and weak."</p>
+
+<p>"It is your foot, my boy. I fear that it is badly
+crushed, but otherwise you are unhurt. Your boot
+threw the machinery out of gear."</p>
+
+<p>In ten minutes the doctor arrived. He had already
+been informed of the nature of the accident.</p>
+
+<p>"Is it any use trying to cut the boot off?" Mr.
+Penrose asked in a low voice as Dr. Maxwell stooped
+over George's leg.</p>
+
+<p>"Not the slightest," the doctor answered in the
+same tone. "The foot is crushed to a pulp. It
+must come off at the ankle. Nothing can save it.
+He had better be taken home at once. You had best<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_156" id="Page_156">[Pg 156]</a></span>
+send to Guy's and get an operating surgeon for him.
+I would rather it were done by someone whose hand
+is more used than mine to this sort of work."</p>
+
+<p>"I am a governor of Guy's," Mr. Penrose said,
+"and will send off at once for one of their best men.
+You are not afraid of the case, I hope, Dr. Maxwell?"</p>
+
+<p>"Not of the local injury," Dr. Maxwell replied;
+"but the shock to the system of such a smash is very
+severe. However, he has youth, strength, and a
+good constitution, so we must hope for the best.
+The chances are all in his favor. We are thinking
+of taking you home, my boy," he went on, speaking
+aloud to George. "Are you in any great pain?"</p>
+
+<p>"I am not in any pain, sir; only I feel awfully
+cold, and, please, will someone go on before and
+tell mother. Bill had better not go; he would
+frighten her to death and make her think it was
+much worse than it is."</p>
+
+<p>"I will go myself," Mr. Penrose replied. "I will
+prepare her for your coming."</p>
+
+<p>"Drink some more of this brandy," the doctor
+said; "that will warm you and give you strength for
+your journey."</p>
+
+<p>There was a stretcher always kept at the works
+in case of emergency, and George was placed on
+this and covered with some rugs. Four of the men
+raised it onto their shoulders and set out, Mr. Penrose
+at once driving on to prepare Mrs. Andrews.</p>
+
+<p>Bill followed the procession heart-broken. When<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_157" id="Page_157">[Pg 157]</a></span>
+it neared home he fell behind and wandered away,
+not being able to bring himself to witness the grief
+of Mrs. Andrews. For hours he wandered about,
+sitting down in waste places and crying as if his
+heart would break. "If it had been me it wouldn't
+have mattered," he kept on exclaiming&mdash;"wouldn't
+have mattered a bit. It wouldn't have been no odds
+one way or the other. There, we have always been
+together in the shops till this week, and now when
+we get separated this is what comes of it. Here am
+I, walking about all right, and George all crushed
+up, and his mother breaking her heart. Why, I
+would rather a hundred times that they had smashed
+me up all over than have gone and hurt George like
+that!"</p>
+
+<p>It was dark before he made his way back, and,
+entering at the back door, took off his boots, and was
+about to creep upstairs when Mrs. Andrews came
+out of the kitchen.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, Mrs. Andrews!" he exclaimed, and the
+tears again burst from him.</p>
+
+<p>"Do not cry, Bill; George is in God's hands, and
+the doctors have every hope that he will recover.
+They are upstairs with him now, with a nurse whom
+Mr. Penrose has fetched down from the hospital.
+He will have to lose his foot, poor boy," she added
+with a sob that she could not repress, "but we
+should feel very thankful that it is no worse after
+such an accident as that. The doctor says that his
+thick boots saved him. If it hadn't been for that<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_158" id="Page_158">[Pg 158]</a></span>
+his whole leg would have been drawn into the machinery,
+and then nothing could have saved him.
+Now I must go upstairs, as I only came down for
+some hot water."</p>
+
+<p>"May I go up to him, Mrs. Andrews?"</p>
+
+<p>"I think, my boy, you had better stop down here
+for the present for both your sakes. I will let you
+know when you can go up to him."</p>
+
+<p>So Bill crouched before the fire and waited. He
+heard movements upstairs and wondered what they
+were doing and why they didn't keep quiet, and
+when he would be allowed to go up. Once or twice
+the nurse came down for hot water, but Bill did not
+speak to her; but in half an hour Mrs. Andrews herself
+returned, looking, Bill thought, even paler than
+before.</p>
+
+<p>"I have just slipped down to tell you, my boy,
+that it's all over. They gave him chloroform, and
+have taken his foot off."</p>
+
+<p>"And didn't it hurt it awful?" Bill asked in an
+awed voice.</p>
+
+<p>"Not in the least. He knew nothing about it,
+and the first thing he asked when he came to was
+when they were going to begin. They will be going
+away directly, and then you can come up and sit
+quietly in his room if you like. The doctors say he
+will probably drop asleep."</p>
+
+<p>Bill was obliged to go outside again and wrestle
+with himself before he felt that he was fit to go up
+into George's room. It was a long struggle, and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_159" id="Page_159">[Pg 159]</a></span>
+had George caught his muttered remonstrances to
+himself he would have felt that Bill had suffered a
+bad relapse into his former method of talking. It
+came out in jerks between his sobs.</p>
+
+<p>"Come, none of that now. Aint yer ashamed of
+yerself, a-howling and a-blubbering like a gal! Call
+yerself a man!&mdash;you are a babby, that's what
+you are. Now, dry up, and let's have no more
+of it."</p>
+
+<p>But it was a long time before he again mastered
+himself; then he went to the scullery and held his
+head under the tap till the water took away his
+breath, then polished his face till it shone, and then
+went and sat quietly down till Mrs. Andrews came
+in and told him that he could go upstairs to George.
+He went up to the bedside and took George's hand,
+but he could not trust himself to speak.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, Bill, old boy," George said cheerily, but in
+a somewhat lower voice than usual, "this is a sudden
+go, isn't it?"</p>
+
+<p>Bill nodded. He was still speechless.</p>
+
+<p>"Don't you take it to heart, Bill," George said,
+feeling that the lad was shaking from head to foot.
+"It won't make much odds, you know. I shall soon
+be about again all right. I expect they will be able
+to put on an artificial foot, and I shall be stumping
+about as well as ever, though I shouldn't be much
+good at a race."</p>
+
+<p>"I wish it had been me," Bill broke out. "I
+would have jammed my head in between them<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_160" id="Page_160">[Pg 160]</a></span>
+wheels cheerful, that I would, rather than you
+should have gone and done it."</p>
+
+<p>"Fortunately there was no time," George said
+with a smile. "Don't you fret yourself, Bill; one
+can get on well enough without a foot, and it didn't
+hurt me a bit coming off. No, nor the squeeze
+either, not regular hurting; it was just a sort of
+scrunch, and then I didn't feel anything more.
+Why, I have often hurt myself ten times as much at
+play and thought nothing of it. I expect it looked
+much worse to you than it felt to me."</p>
+
+<p>"We will talk of it another time," Bill said
+huskily. "Your mother said I wasn't to talk, and
+I wasn't to let you talk, but just to sit down here
+quiet, and you are to try to go off to sleep." So
+saying he sat down by the bedside. George asked
+one or two more questions, but Bill only shook his
+head. Presently George closed his eyes, and a short
+time afterwards his quiet regular breathing showed
+that he was asleep.</p>
+
+<p>The next six weeks passed pleasantly enough to
+George. Every day hampers containing flowers
+and various niceties in the way of food were sent
+down by Mr. Penrose, and that gentleman himself
+very frequently called in for a chat with him. As
+soon as the wound had healed an instrument-maker
+came down from town to measure him for an artificial
+foot, but before he was able to wear this he
+could get about on crutches.</p>
+
+<p>The first day that he was downstairs Mr. Pen<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_161" id="Page_161">[Pg 161]</a></span>rose
+brought Nelly down to see him. The child
+looked pale and awed as he came in.</p>
+
+<p>"My little girl has asked me to thank you for
+her, George," Mr. Penrose said as she advanced
+timidly and placed her hand in his. "I have not
+said much to you about my own feelings and I won't
+say much about hers; but you can understand what
+we both feel. Why, my boy, it was a good Providence,
+indeed, which threw you in my way! I
+thought so when you saved the mill from destruction.
+I feel it tenfold more now that you have
+saved my child. The ways of God are, indeed,
+strange. Who would have thought that all this
+could have sprung from that boy snatching the
+locket from Helen as we came out of the theater!
+And now about the future, George. I owe you a
+great debt, infinitely greater than I can ever repay;
+but what I can do I will. In the future I shall regard
+you as my son, and I hope that you will look
+to me as to a father. I have been talking to your
+mother, and she says that she thinks your tastes lie
+altogether in the direction of engineering. Is that
+so?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sir. I have often thought I would rather
+be an engineer than anything else, but I don't
+like&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>"Never mind what you like and what you don't
+like," Mr. Penrose said quietly. "You belong to
+me now, you know and must do as you are told.
+What I propose is this, that you shall go to a good<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_162" id="Page_162">[Pg 162]</a></span>
+school for another three years, and I will then apprentice
+you to a first-class engineer, either mechanical
+or civil as you may then prefer, and when you
+have learned your business I will take good care
+that you are pushed on. What do you say to
+that?"</p>
+
+<p>"I think it is too much altogether," George
+said.</p>
+
+<p>"Never mind about that," Mr. Penrose said,
+"that is my business. If that is the only objection
+we can imagine it settled. There is another thing.
+I know how attached you are to your friend Bill,
+and I am indebted to him, too, for the part he played
+at the fire, so I propose, if he is willing, to put him
+to a good middle-class school for a bit. In the
+course of a couple of years he will get a sufficient
+education to get on fairly with, and then I propose,
+according as you may choose to be a civil or mechanical
+engineer, to place him with a mason or
+smith; then by the time that you are ready to start
+in business he will be ready to take a place under
+you, so that you may again work together."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, thank you, sir!" George exclaimed, even
+more pleased at the news relating to Bill than at his
+own good fortune, great as was the delight which
+the prospect opened by Mr. Penrose's offer caused
+him.</p>
+
+<p>As soon as George could be moved, Mr. Penrose
+sent him with his mother and Bill down to the seaside.
+Here George rapidly regained strength, and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_163" id="Page_163">[Pg 163]</a></span>
+when, after a stay there of two months, he returned
+to town, he was able to walk so well with his artificial
+foot that his loss would not have been noticed
+by a stranger.</p>
+
+<p>The arrangements settled by Mr. Penrose were
+all in due time carried out. George went for three
+years to a good school, and was then apprenticed to
+one of the leading civil engineers. With him he
+remained five years and then went out for him to
+survey a railroad about to be constructed in Brazil,
+and remained there as one of the staff who superintended
+its construction. Bill, who was now a
+clever young mason, accompanied him, and through
+George's interest with the contractor obtained the
+sub-contract for the masonry of some of the bridges
+and culverts.</p>
+
+<p>This was ten years ago, and George Andrews is
+now one of the most rising engineers of the day, and
+whatever business he undertakes his friend Bill is
+still his right-hand man. Mr. Penrose has been in
+all respects as good as his word, and has been ready
+to assist George with his personal influence in all
+his undertakings, and in all respects has treated him
+as a son, while Nelly has regarded him with the
+affection of a sister.</p>
+
+<p>Both George and Bill have been married some
+years, and Mrs. Andrews the elder is one of the
+proudest and happiest of mothers. She still lives
+with her son at the earnest request of his wife, who
+is often left alone during George's frequent ab<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_164" id="Page_164">[Pg 164]</a></span>sence
+abroad on professional duties. As for Bill, he
+has not even yet got over his wonder at his own
+good fortune, and ever blesses the day when he first
+met George in Covent Garden.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_165" id="Page_165">[Pg 165]</a></span></p>
+<h2><a name="DO_YOUR_DUTY" id="DO_YOUR_DUTY"></a>DO YOUR DUTY.</h2>
+
+
+<p>Early in the month of March, 1801, an old sailor
+was sitting on a bench gazing over the stretch of sea
+which lies between Hayling Island and the Isle of
+Wight. The prospect was a lively one, for in those
+days ships of war were constantly running in and
+out, and great convoys of merchantmen sailed under
+the protection of our cruisers; and the traffic between
+Spithead and Portsmouth resembled that of a much
+frequented road.</p>
+
+<p>Peter Langley had been a boatswain in the king's
+service, and had settled down in his old age on a pension,
+and lived in a small cottage near the western
+extremity of Hayling Island. Here he could see
+what was going on at Spithead, and when he needed
+a talk with his old "chums" could get into his boat,
+which was lying hauled up on the sand, and with
+a good wind arrive in an hour at the Hard. He was
+sitting at present on a portion of a wreck thrown up
+by a very high tide on the sandy slope, when his
+meditations were disturbed by a light step behind
+him, and a lad in a sailor's dress, some fifteen years
+of age, with a bright honest face, came running
+down behind him.</p>
+
+<p>"Hallo, dad!"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_166" id="Page_166">[Pg 166]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Hallo, my boy! Bless me, who'd ha' thought
+o' seeing you!" and the old man clasped the boy in
+his arms in a way that showed the close relationship
+between the two. "I didn't expect you for another
+week."</p>
+
+<p>"No! we've made a quick passage of it," the boy
+said; "fine wind all the way up, with a gale or two
+in the right quarter. We only arrived in the river
+on Monday, and as soon as we were fairly in dock I
+got leave to run down to see you."</p>
+
+<p>"What were you in such a hurry for?" the old
+sailor said. "It's the duty of every hand to stop
+by the ship till she's cleared out."</p>
+
+<p>"I have always stayed before till the crew were
+paid off; but no sooner had we cast anchor than one
+of the owners came on board, and told the captain
+that another cargo was ready, that the ship was to
+be unloaded with all speed, and to take in cargo and
+sail again in a fortnight at the utmost, as a fleet was
+on the point of sailing for the West Indies under a
+strong convoy."</p>
+
+<p>"A fortnight! That's sharp work," the old
+sailor said. "And the goods will have to be bundled
+out and in again with double speed. I know what
+it will be. You will be going out with the paint all
+wet, and those lubbers the stevedores will rub it off
+as fast as it's put on. Well, a few days at sea will
+shake all down into its place. But how did you get
+leave?"</p>
+
+<p>"I am rather a favorite with the first officer," the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_167" id="Page_167">[Pg 167]</a></span>
+lad said. "The men who desired to leave were to
+be discharged at once and a fresh gang taken on
+board, so I asked him directly the news came round
+if I might have four days away. He agreed at once,
+and I came down by the night coach; and here I am
+for eight-and-forty hours."</p>
+
+<p>"It's a short stay," the old sailor said, "after
+more than a year away, but we mustn't waste the
+time in regretting it. You've grown, Harry, and
+are getting on fast. In another couple of years
+you'll be fit to join a king's ship. I suppose you've
+got over your silly idea about sticking to the merchant
+service. It's all very well to learn your business
+there as a boy, and I grant that in some things
+a merchantman is a better school than a king's ship.
+They have fewer hands, and each man has to do
+more and to learn to think for himself. Still, after
+all, there's no place like a saucy frigate for excitement
+and happiness."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know, dad," the boy said. "I have been
+learning a little navigation. The first officer has
+been very kind to me, and I hope in the course of
+two or three years to pass and get a berth as a third
+mate. Still, I should like three or four years on
+board a man-of-war."</p>
+
+<p>"I should think so," the old sailor said, "for a
+man ought to do his duty to his country."</p>
+
+<p>"But there are plenty of men to do their duty to
+their country," the boy said.</p>
+
+<p>"Not a bit of it!" the sailor exclaimed. "There's<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_168" id="Page_168">[Pg 168]</a></span>
+a great difficulty in finding hands for the navy.
+Everyone wants to throw their duty upon everyone
+else. They all hanker after the higher wages and
+loafing life on board a merchantman, and hate to
+keep themselves smart and clean as they must do in
+a king's ship. If I had my way, every tar should
+serve at least five years of his life on board a man-of-war.
+It is above all things essential, Harry, that
+you should do your duty."</p>
+
+<p>"I am ready to do my duty, dad," the boy said,
+"when the time comes. I do it now to the best of
+my power, and I have in my pocket a letter from the
+first officer to you. He told you when you went
+down with me to see me off on my last voyage
+that he would keep an eye upon me, and he has
+done so."</p>
+
+<p>"That's right," the old man said. "As you say,
+Harry, a man may do his duty anywhere; still, for
+all that, it is part of his duty, if he be a sailor, to help
+his majesty, for a time at least, against his enemies.
+Look at me. Why, I served man and boy for nigh
+fifty years, and was in action one way and another
+over a hundred times, and here I am now with a
+snug little pension, and as comfortable as his gracious
+majesty himself. What can you want more
+than that?"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know that I can want more," the boy
+said, "in its way, at least; but there are other ways
+in the merchant service. I might command a ship
+by the time I am thirty, and be my own master in<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_169" id="Page_169">[Pg 169]</a></span>stead
+of being a mere part of a machine. I have
+heard the balls flying too," he said, laughing.</p>
+
+<p>"What! did you have a brush with Mounseer?"
+the old tar said, greatly interested.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes; we had a bit of a fight with a large privateer
+off the coast of Spain. Fortunately the old
+bark carries a long eighteen, as well as her twelves,
+and when the Frenchman found that we could play
+at long bowls as well as himself he soon drew off,
+but not before we had drilled a few holes in his sails
+and knocked away a bit of his bulwarks."</p>
+
+<p>"Were you hit, Harry?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, two or three shots hulled her, but they did
+little damage beyond knocking away a few of the
+fittings and frightening the lady passengers. We
+had a strong crew, and a good many were sorry that
+the skipper did not hide his teeth and let the Frenchman
+come close before he opened fire. We should
+like to have towed him up the river with our flag
+over the tricolor."</p>
+
+<p>"There, you see, Harry," the old sailor said,
+"you were just as ready to fight as if you had been
+on a man-of-war; and while in a sailing ship you
+only get a chance if one of these privateers happens
+to see you, in a king's ship you go looking about for
+an enemy, and when you see one the chances are he
+is bigger, instead of smaller, than yourself."</p>
+
+<p>"Ah! well, dad, we shall never quite agree on it,
+I expect," the boy said; "but for all that, I do mean
+to serve for a few years in a man-of-war. I expect<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_170" id="Page_170">[Pg 170]</a></span>
+that we may have a chance of seeing some fighting
+in the West Indies. There are, they say, several
+French cruisers in that direction, and although we
+shall have a considerable convoy the Frenchmen
+generally have the legs of our ships. I believe that
+some of the vessels of the convoy are taking out
+troops, and that we are going to have a slap at some
+of the French islands. Has there been any news
+here since I went?"</p>
+
+<p>"Nothing beyond a few rows with the smugglers.
+The revenue officers have a busy time here. There's
+no such place for smuggling on the coast as between
+Portsmouth and Chichester. These creeks are just
+the places for smugglers, and there's so much traffic
+in the Channel that a solitary lugger does not attract
+the attention of the coastguard as it does where the
+sea's more empty. However, I don't trouble myself
+one way or the other about it. I may know a
+good deal of the smuggling, or I may not, but it's
+no business of mine. If it were my duty to lend a
+hand to the coast-guard, I should do it; but as it
+isn't, I have no ill-will to the smugglers, and am
+content enough to get my spirits cheap."</p>
+
+<p>"But, dad, surely it's your duty to prevent the
+king being cheated?" Harry said with a smile.</p>
+
+<p>"If the king himself were going to touch the
+money," the old sailor said sturdily, "I would lend
+a hand to see that he got it, but there's no saying
+where this money would have gone. Besides, if the
+spirits hadn't been run, they would not have been<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_171" id="Page_171">[Pg 171]</a></span>
+brought over here at all, so after all the revenue is
+none the worse for the smuggling."</p>
+
+<p>The boy laughed. "You can cheat yourself, dad,
+when you like, but you know as well as I do that
+smuggling's dishonest, and that those who smuggle
+cheat the revenue."</p>
+
+<p>"Ah, well!" the sailor said, "it may be so, but I
+don't clearly see that it's my duty to give information
+in the matter. If I did feel as it were going to
+be my duty, I should let all my neighbors know it,
+and take mighty good care that they didn't say anything
+within earshot of me, that I might feel called
+on to repeat. And now, let's go up to the cottage
+and see the old woman."</p>
+
+<p>"I looked in there for a moment," Harry said,
+"as I passed. Mother looks as hale and hearty as
+she did when I left, and so do you, dad."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, we have nothing to complain of," the old
+man said. "I have been so thoroughly seasoned
+with salt water that it would take a long time for
+me to decay."</p>
+
+<p>When they got up to the cottage they found that
+Jane Langley had got breakfast prepared. Rashers
+of bacon were smoking on the table, and a large
+tankard of beer stood by, for in those days the use of
+tea had not become general in this country.</p>
+
+<p>"Have you heard, mother," Peter Langley said,
+"that the boy is to leave us again in forty-eight
+hours?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, indeed," the old woman said; "but this is<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_172" id="Page_172">[Pg 172]</a></span>
+hard news. I had hoped that you would be with us
+for a bit, my boy, for we're getting on fast in life,
+and may not be here when you return."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, mother! we will not think of such a thing
+as that," Harry said. "Father was just saying that
+he's so seasoned that even time cannot make much
+of such a tough morsel; and you seem as hearty as
+he is."</p>
+
+<p>"Aye, boy," Peter said, "that be true, but when
+old oak does come down, he generally falls sudden.
+However, we won't make our first meal sad by talking
+of what might be."</p>
+
+<p>Gayly during the meal they chatted over the incidents
+of Harry's voyage to India and back. It
+was his second trip. The lad had had a much better
+education than most boys in his rank of life at that
+time, the boatswain having placed him at the age of
+ten in charge of a schoolmaster at Portsmouth.
+When Harry had reached that age Peter had retired
+from the service, and had settled down at Hayling,
+but for two years longer he had kept Harry at
+school. Then he had apprenticed him to a firm of
+shipowners in London, and one of the officers under
+whom Peter had served had spoken to the heads of
+the firm, so that the boy was put in a ship commanded
+by a kind and considerate officer, and to
+whose charge he was specially recommended. Thus
+he had not forgotten what he had learned at school,
+as is too often the case with lads in his position.
+His skipper had seen that he not only kept up what<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_173" id="Page_173">[Pg 173]</a></span>
+he knew, but that he studied for an hour or so each
+day such subjects as would be useful to him in his
+career.</p>
+
+<p>After breakfast the pair again went out onto the
+sandhills, Peter, as usual, carrying a huge telescope
+with him, with which he was in the habit of surveying
+every ship as she rounded the west of the island
+and came running in through the channel to Portsmouth.
+Most of the men-of-war he knew in an instant,
+and the others he could make a shrewd guess
+at. Generally when alone with Harry he was full
+of talk of the sea, of good advice as to the lad's
+future bearing, and of suggestions and hints as to
+the best course to be adopted in various emergencies.
+But to-day he appeared unusually thoughtful, and
+smoked his pipe, and looked out in silence over the
+sea, scarcely even lifting his telescope to his eye.</p>
+
+<p>"I've been thinking, Harry," he said at last,
+"that as you are going away again, and, as the old
+woman says, you may not find us both here when
+you come back, it is right that I should tell you a
+little more about yourself. I once told you, years
+ago, that you were not my son, and that I would give
+you more particulars some day."</p>
+
+<p>The lad looked anxiously up at the old sailor. It
+was a matter which he had often thought over in
+his mind, for although he loved the honest tar and
+his good wife as much as he could have done his
+natural parents, still, since he had known that he
+was their adopted son only, he had naturally won<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_174" id="Page_174">[Pg 174]</a></span>dered
+much as to who his parents were, and what
+was their condition in life.</p>
+
+<p>"I thought it as well," the old sailor began, "not
+to tell you this here yarn until you were getting on.
+Boys' heads get upset with a little breeze, especially
+if they have no ballast, and though it isn't likely now
+that you will ever get any clew as to your birth, and
+it will make no difference whether it was a duke or
+a ship's caulker who was your father, still it's right
+that you should know the facts, as no one can say
+when they start on a voyage in life what craft they
+may fall aboard before they've done. It may be,
+Harry, that as you intends to stick to the merchant
+service&mdash;saving, of course, that little time you mean
+to serve on board a king's ship&mdash;you may rise to be
+a skipper, and perhaps an owner. It may be, boy,
+that as a skipper you may fall in love with some taut
+craft sailing in your convoy. I've seen such things
+before now, and then the fact that you might be, for
+aught you know, the son of a marquis instead of
+being that of a boatswain, might score in your favor.
+Women have curious notions, and though, for my
+part, I can't see that it makes much difference where
+the keel of a craft was laid as long as it's sound and
+well-built, there are those who thinks different.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, to tell you the yarn. It were nigh fourteen
+years ago that I was boatswain aboard the
+<i>Alert</i> frigate, as taut a craft as ever sailed. We
+had a smart captain and as good a crew as you'd
+want to see. We were cruising in the West<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_175" id="Page_175">[Pg 175]</a></span>
+Indies, and had for months been, off and on, in
+chase of a craft that had done much damage
+there. She carried a black flag, and her skipper
+was said to be the biggest villain that ever even
+commanded a pirate. Scarce a week passed
+but some ship was missing. It mattered little
+to him whether she sailed under the English, the
+French, or the Spanish flag; all was fish to him.
+Many and many a vessel sailed laden that never
+reached Europe. Sometimes a few charred timbers
+would be thrown up on the shore of the islands,
+showing that the ship to which they belonged had
+been taken and burned before she had gone many
+days on her way. Often and often had the pirate
+been chased. She was bark-rigged, which was in
+itself a very unusual thing with pirates&mdash;indeed, I
+never knew of one before. But she had been, I believe,
+a merchantman captured by the pirate, and
+was such a beauty that he hoisted his flag on her,
+and handed his own schooner over to his mate.
+Somehow or other he had altered her ballast, and
+maybe lengthened her a bit, for those pirates have
+a rendezvous in some of the islands, where they are
+so strong that they can, if need be, build a ship of
+their own. Anyhow, she was the fastest ship of her
+class that ever was seen on those seas, and though
+our cruisers had over and over again chased her, she
+laughed at them, and would for a whole day keep
+just out of reach of their bow-chasers with half her
+sails set, while the cruisers were staggering under<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_176" id="Page_176">[Pg 176]</a></span>
+every rag they could put on their masts. Then
+when she was tired of that game she would hoist her
+full canvas and leave the king's vessel behind as if
+she was standing still. Once or twice she nearly got
+caught by cruisers coming up in different directions,
+but each time she managed to slip away without ever
+having a rope or stay started by a shot. We in the
+<i>Alert</i> had been on her footsteps a dozen times, but
+had had no more luck than the rest of them, and the
+mere name of the <i>Seamew</i> was sufficient to put any
+one of us into a passion. There wasn't one of the
+ship's company, from the captain down to the
+powder-monkey, who wouldn't have cheerfully
+given a year's pay to get alongside the <i>Seamew</i>.
+The <i>Alert</i> carried thirty-two guns, and our crew was
+stronger than usual in a vessel of that size, for there
+was a good deal of boat service, and it was considered
+that at any moment 'Yellow Jack' might lay
+a good many hands up&mdash;or down, as the case may
+be. Well, one night we were at anchor in Porto
+Rico, and the first lieutenant had strolled up with
+two of the middies to the top of a hill just before the
+sun went down. He had taken a glass with him.
+Just as the night was falling, a middy on our quarter-deck,
+who was looking at the shore with a glass,
+said to the second lieutenant, who was on watch:</p>
+
+<p>"'Look, sir; here comes Mr. Jones with Keen
+and Hobart down that hill as if he were running a
+race. He isn't likely to be racing the middies.
+What can he be after?'<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_177" id="Page_177">[Pg 177]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"'No,' the second lieutenant said, with a smile;
+'Mr. Jones is hardly likely to be racing the middies';
+which, indeed, was true enough, for the first lieutenant
+was as stiff as a ramrod&mdash;a good officer, but
+as strict a martinet as ever I sailed under.</p>
+
+<p>"The second lieutenant took the glasses, and saw
+that, whatever the reason might be, it was as the midshipman
+had said. The news that Mr. Jones was
+coming down the hill, running as if Old Nick was
+after him, soon spread, and there was quite an excitement
+on the quarter-deck as to what could be
+the matter.</p>
+
+<p>"Ten minutes afterwards the gig was seen coming
+off to the ship, and it was evident, by the way
+the spray was flying and the oars bending, that the
+men were pulling as if for life or death. By this
+time the news had spread through the ship, and the
+captain himself was on the quarter-deck.</p>
+
+<p>"'Give me the speaking-trumpet,' he said, and as
+the boat came within call he shouted, 'What's the
+matter, Mr. Jones? Is anything wrong?'</p>
+
+<p>"'I've sighted,' the lieutenant said, standing up
+and making a trumpet with his two hands, 'two
+craft together round the point of the island some
+fifteen miles at sea. They're low down on the sea-line,
+but by their look I think that one is the <i>Seamew</i>
+and the other a merchantman she has captured.'</p>
+
+<p>"Not a moment was lost. The captain gave the
+orders sharp and quick. The men, who were all
+standing about, were in a minute clustering on the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_178" id="Page_178">[Pg 178]</a></span>
+yards, and never was canvas got on a ship faster
+than it was on the <i>Alert</i> that evening. Before the
+boat was fairly run up to the davits the anchor was
+at the cat-head, and the <i>Alert's</i> bows were pointing
+seawards. Five minutes afterwards, with every
+stitch of canvas set, we were running out of the harbor.
+The first lieutenant had taken the bearings
+pretty accurately, and as there was a brisk evening
+breeze blowing we spun along at a famous rate. By
+this time it was dark, and we had every hope that
+we might come upon the pirate before she had
+finished transferring the cargo of her prize under
+her own hatches. Not a light was shown, and as
+the moon was not up we hoped to get within gunshot
+before being seen, as the pirate, seeing no craft
+within sight before the sun went down, would not
+suspect that the <i>Alert</i> could be on his traces. We
+had to sail close to the wind till we were round the
+point of the island, and then to run nearly before it
+towards the spot where the vessels had been seen.
+In two hours from the time of starting we reckoned
+that we must be getting close to them if they still
+remained hove-to.</p>
+
+<p>"All of a sudden, some two miles ahead, a point
+or two off the starboard bow, a great flame shot up.
+Every moment it grew and grew until we could see
+a large ship in flames, while another lay about a
+quarter of a mile distant. Three or four boats were
+pulling from the ship in flames towards the other,
+and as this was a bark we had no doubt that we had<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_179" id="Page_179">[Pg 179]</a></span>
+caught the <i>Seamew</i> at her villainous work. The
+pirate was lying between us and the burning merchantman,
+so that while her spars stood out clear
+and distinct against the glare of light we must have
+been invisible to her. The word was passed quickly
+forward for the men to go to quarters. Every gun
+was double-shotted and run out, and then, all being
+ready for the fight, the men stripped to their waists,
+cutlasses and boarding-pikes ready to hand, we
+waited with breathless anxiety. We were already
+within range of our bow-chasers, and as yet there
+was no sign that the pirate was conscious of our
+presence. The boats were now near him, and no
+doubt those on board were looking rather in their
+direction than to windward. Rapidly the <i>Alert</i>
+tore through the water, the sail trimmers were all
+ready to take in her light canvas at a moment's
+notice. The officers clustered on the quarter-deck,
+and the men stood by their guns with every eye
+strained at the pirate. Nearer and nearer we came,
+and our hopes rose higher and higher. We were
+within a mile now, when suddenly a great movement
+was seen on board the pirate. The breeze was
+steady, and the sea quiet, and loud words of command
+could be heard shouted as a swarm of men ran
+up the rattlins. It was clear we were seen. There
+was no further need of concealment, and the captain
+gave word for the bow-chasers to open. Quickly as
+the pirate got her canvas spread&mdash;and I do think that
+sharp as we had been on board the <i>Alert</i>, the <i>Sea<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_180" id="Page_180">[Pg 180]</a></span>mew</i>
+was even quicker in getting under canvas&mdash;we
+were scarce a quarter of a mile from her when she
+got fairly under way. Up to this moment not a
+gun had spoken save the two bow-chasers, as the
+captain would not yaw her until the last moment
+Then round she came and poured a broadside into
+the <i>Seamew</i>. Orders had been given to fire high,
+and every man was on his mettle. The maintop-mast
+of the <i>Seamew</i> fell, snapped at the cap; the
+peak halyards of the mizzen were shot away, and a
+number of holes were drilled through her sails. A
+loud cheer broke from our men. Fast as the <i>Seamew</i>
+was she was sufficiently crippled now to prevent
+her getting away, and at last she was to show
+whether she could fight as well as run, and I must
+say for her she did.</p>
+
+<p>"She carried but twenty guns against our thirty-two,
+but they were of far heavier metal, and after
+ten minutes the <i>Alert</i> was as much bruised and battered
+as if she had been fighting a Frenchman of
+equal size for an hour. However, we had not been
+idle, and as our shot had been principally directed
+against the enemy's rigging, as our great object was
+to cripple her and so prevent her from getting away,
+she was by this time a mere wreck above, although
+her sides were scarcely touched; whereas two of our
+ports had been knocked into one, and some thirty of
+our men had been struck down either by shot or by
+splinters. Pouring a last broadside into her, the
+captain ordered the <i>Alert</i> to be brought alongside<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_181" id="Page_181">[Pg 181]</a></span>
+the <i>Seamew</i>. There was no need to call upon the
+boarders to be ready. Every man was prepared,
+and as the vessels came alongside our men rushed to
+the assault. But the crew of the <i>Seamew</i> were as
+eager to board us as we were them, and upon the
+very bulwarks a desperate combat ensued. Strong
+as we were, the <i>Seamew</i> carried fully as many hands,
+and as they were fighting with halters round their
+necks it's little wonder that they fought so well.</p>
+
+<p>"I've been in a good many fights, but never did
+I see one like that. Each man hacked, and hewed,
+and wielded his boarding-pike as if the whole fight
+depended upon his single exertions. Gradually the
+men whose places were at the guns on the starboard
+side left their places and joined in the fight, while
+those on the port side continued to pour a fire of
+grape into the enemy. It was near half an hour
+before we got a fair footing on the pirate's deck, and
+then steadily and gradually we fought our way forward.
+But it was another half-hour after the
+pirate captain and all his officers had been killed, and
+fully half the crew cut down, that the rest surrendered.</p>
+
+<p>"On board the <i>Alert</i> we had fully one-third of
+our complement killed or wounded. Mr. Jones had
+been shot through the head; the second and third
+lieutenants were both badly wounded, and the captain
+himself had had his jaw broken by a pistol fired
+in his face. I got this scar on my cheek, which
+spoiled my beauty for the rest of my life, but as I<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_182" id="Page_182">[Pg 182]</a></span>
+had been over thirty years married to the old woman
+that made but little difference. Never were a crew
+more glorious than we were that night. Even the
+wounded felt that the victory had been cheaply purchased.
+We had captured the scourge of these seas,
+which had for ten years laughed at all the fastest
+cruisers of our navy, and we felt as proud as if we
+had captured a French first-rate.</p>
+
+<p>"All hands were at work next day in repairing
+damages. I was up aloft seeing to the fitting of fresh
+gear to the topgallant-mast when I saw something
+floating at sea which took my attention. It seemed
+to me like a box, and an empty one, for it floated
+high on the water. Its lid seemed to be open, and I
+thought once or twice that I saw something inside.
+I slid down to the quarter-deck and reported what I
+had seen. The third lieutenant, who was doing duty
+with his arm in a sling, was not disposed to take the
+men off their work to lower a boat; but as I pointed
+out that the box might have belonged to the merchantman
+which had been burned overnight, and
+that it might afford some clew as to the name of the
+ship, he consented, and with four hands I was soon
+rowing towards the box.</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know what I had expected to see, but I
+was never more surprised than when, getting there,
+I found that it was a trunk, and that in it, sitting
+up, was a child about eighteen months old. That
+was you, Harry. In the bottom of the trunk were
+a locket with a woman's likeness in it, a curious In<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_183" id="Page_183">[Pg 183]</a></span>dian
+bangle, and a few other articles of jewelry.
+How you got there we never knew, but the supposition
+was that when the pirate was overhauling the
+merchantman, and her true nature was ascertained,
+some mother, knowing the fate that awaited all on
+board, had put you in an open trunk, had thrown in
+what ornaments she had about her, and had dropped
+the trunk overboard, in hopes that it might drift
+away and be picked up by some passing ship. It
+was a wild venture, with a thousand to one against
+its success, but the Lord had watched over it, and
+there you were as snug and comfortable as if you
+had been laying in your own cot, though, by the
+way, you were squalling as loud as a litter of kittens,
+and I expect had missed your breakfast considerably.
+You were sitting up, and it was lucky that you were
+backward of your age, for, although by your size
+we guessed you to be eighteen months, you were still
+unable to walk. If you had been as active as some
+chaps of that age you would have scrambled onto
+your feet, and no doubt capsized your boat.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, we brought you on board, and there was
+a great talk as to what was to be done with you; but
+as I was your discoverer I claimed you as a lawful
+prize, and I thought you would amuse the old
+woman while I was at sea, and perhaps be a comfort
+to me when I got laid up in ordinary, as indeed you
+have been. So that's all I know, Harry. Every
+inquiry was made, but we never heard of any ship
+which exactly answered to the description. You<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_184" id="Page_184">[Pg 184]</a></span>
+see, beyond the fact that she was a square-rigged
+ship we could say but little about her. The ornaments
+found in the box seemed to show that she had
+come from the East Indies, but of course that could
+not be, for what would she be doing there? But at
+any rate the person who put you into the trunk, and
+who was no doubt your mother, had been to the East
+Indies, or at least had been given those ornaments
+by someone who had, for there was no doubt where
+they were turned out.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, on board the <i>Alert</i> everyone got promoted.
+There was enough valuable property found on board
+the <i>Seamew</i> to give us a handsome sum all round,
+and it was my share of the prize-money that enabled
+me to buy this little cottage, and went no small way
+towards paying for your schooling and board. As
+no one else claimed you, and your friends could not
+be heard of, no one disputed my right to your guardianship;
+and so, my boy, here you have been cruising
+about the world as Harry Langley ever since."</p>
+
+<p>The old sailor was silent, and Harry was some
+time before he spoke.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, dad, you may not have been my real
+father, but no one could have been a better father to
+me than you have, and as it isn't likely now that I
+shall ever hit upon a clew which could lead me to
+discover who I am, I shall continue to regard you as
+my real father. Still, as you say, it may perhaps in
+life be some advantage to me to be able to claim that
+I am the son of a marquis;" and he laughed merrily.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_185" id="Page_185">[Pg 185]</a></span>
+They talked the matter over for some time, and then
+Harry changed the subject.</p>
+
+<p>"Are all our friends well?" Harry asked.</p>
+
+<p>"All except poor Tom Hardy. He slipped his
+cable six months since, and his wife, poor old soul,
+is gone to some friends near Winchester."</p>
+
+<p>"Who's living in the cottage?"</p>
+
+<p>"Black Jack has taken it."</p>
+
+<p>"What! has he moved from his old place, then?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, it is said that he's taken it for a Frenchy,
+who comes down off and on. They say he's in the
+smuggling business with Black Jack, and that he
+disposes of the silks and wines that are brought over
+in the <i>Lucy</i>, and that Jack trades over in France
+with his friends. The lieutenant at the coast-guard
+station has his eye upon him, and I believe that some
+day they will catch Black Jack as he runs his cargo;
+but he's a slippery customer. It would be a good day
+for Hayling if they could do so, for he and his crew
+do a lot of harm to the place. They look more like
+men who have belonged to the <i>Seamew</i> I was talking
+to you about than honest English fishermen."</p>
+
+<p>"It is a curious thing, dad, that the Frenchman
+should be coming backwards and forwards here,
+and I wonder that the revenue people don't inquire
+into it."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't suppose that they know very much about
+it, Harry. He comes off and on, generally arriving
+at night, and leaving a few hours afterwards. I hear
+about these things because everyone knows that old<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_186" id="Page_186">[Pg 186]</a></span>
+Peter Langley is not the chap to put his nose into
+other people's business. I don't like these goings
+on, I must say, and consider they will end badly.
+However, it is no business of ours, lad. We get our
+brandy cheap in Hayling&mdash;nowhere cheaper, I
+should say&mdash;and that, after all, is the matter that
+concerns us most. The wind's rising fast; I think
+we're in for a gale."</p>
+
+<p>It was as Peter said. The clouds were rising fast
+behind the island, the waves were breaking with a
+short, sharp sound upon the beach, white heads were
+beginning to show themselves out at sea, the fishing
+craft were running in towards Portsmouth under
+reefed sails, the men-of-war at Spithead could be
+seen sending down their topmasts, and everything
+betokened that it would be a nasty night.</p>
+
+<p>"What time must you leave, Harry?"</p>
+
+<p>"I shall go off at three to-morrow morning; shall
+cross the ferry, and catch the coach as it goes along
+at eight. I promised that I would be back on the
+following morning, and I would not fail in keeping
+my appointment, for as the captain has been so good
+I should be sorry that he should think that I had
+broken my word."</p>
+
+<p>In the course of the day Harry went over to the
+village and saw many of his boy friends. Bill
+Simpkins, however, his great chum, happened to be
+away, but his parents said that he would be back at
+nine in the evening. He had gone over to Winchester
+to see a brother who was in a regiment quar<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_187" id="Page_187">[Pg 187]</a></span>tered
+there. Accordingly, soon after nine o'clock
+Harry said to his father that he would just walk
+over to have a chat with his friend, and be back in
+an hour or so.</p>
+
+<p>"Thou had best stop at home and go to bed at
+once," Jane Langley said; "if thou hast to start at
+three o'clock, it were time thou wert in bed now."</p>
+
+<p>"I am accustomed to short nights," Harry said,
+laughing, "and I shall be able to sleep long to-morrow."</p>
+
+<p>Putting on his hat, he nodded to the old couple,
+and went off at a run into the darkness.</p>
+
+<p>The road was a wide one, and but little frequented,
+and the grass grew thick over a considerable
+portion of the sides, therefore as he ran along with
+a light, springy tread the sound of his footsteps was
+deadened. As he came along by the cottage of
+which he had been speaking to Peter Langley he
+heard the sound of voices within. Being curious to
+see what this mysterious Frenchman was like, Harry
+paused, lightly lifted the latch of the gate, and entered
+the little garden. He had intended to peep in
+at the window, and having satisfied his curiosity to
+be off; but just as he reached the door the latter
+opened suddenly, and Harry had only time to draw
+back behind the little porch before two men came
+out. In one Harry recognized by his voice the
+smuggler Black Jack; the other was by his halting
+English evidently the foreigner. They stopped for
+a moment, looking out into the night.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_188" id="Page_188">[Pg 188]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"I tell you," the smuggler said, "it's going to be
+a storm, and no mistake. The <i>Lucy</i> is a tight craft,
+and has weathered gales when many a bigger ship
+has gone down. Still, I don't like running out into
+it without necessity."</p>
+
+<p>"Necezity," said the Frenchman. "I sould have
+sought zat ze earning of five hundred pounds was as
+urgent a necezity as was wanted."</p>
+
+<p>"Aye, the money will be handy enough," the
+smuggler said, "though one does put one's head
+into the noose to earn it. However, the sum is
+bigger than usual, and, as you say, the affair is important."</p>
+
+<p>"Bah!" the Frenchman said, "what does it matter
+about ze nooze? It hasn't got over your zick
+neck or my zin one, and till it does we needn't trouble
+about it. I tell you zis is ze most important dispatch
+we have ever sent, and if it gets safe to hand
+zey cannot grudge us double pay. I have ridden
+from London wizout stopping, and have killed a
+horse worth fifty of your guineas. However, zat
+matters not. Zis letter should fetch us ze money to
+pay for a dozen horses and a dozen of your <i>Lucys</i>."</p>
+
+<p>"All right!" the smuggler said; "in an hour we
+will be off. Letters like that in your pocket are best
+not kept on hand. You are sure that the <i>Chasse
+Mar&eacute;e</i> will put out to meet us in such weather as we
+are likely to have?"</p>
+
+<p>"She will put out if a hurricane's blowing," the
+Frenchman said. "Zey know ze importance of ze<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_189" id="Page_189">[Pg 189]</a></span>
+news, which is expected, and which I am bringing
+zem. <i>Mon Dieu!</i> what sums have been paid to get
+ze news zat's in zis little dispatch!"</p>
+
+<p>"Do you know what it is?" the smuggler said.</p>
+
+<p>"Not for certain," the Frenchman replied, "but
+I believe it is ze orders zat are to be sent to ze
+British fleet, and zat zey are about to strike a great
+blow zomewhere."</p>
+
+<p>"Well," the smuggler said, "I will go round and
+tell the boys. I warned them to be in readiness, and
+I will send them straight down to the beach. In a
+quarter of an hour I will return for you."</p>
+
+<p>While this conversation had been going on Harry
+had been standing against the porch, the sides of
+which were filled with latticework over which a
+creeper grew. He had been frightened at the importance
+of the secret that he was hearing, and had
+been rapidly meditating in his mind how this all-portant
+information which was about to be conveyed
+to the enemy could be stopped. He had made up
+his mind that the instant the smuggler moved out
+he would make his way down to the village, tell the
+tale to half a dozen men, and have the Frenchman
+seized. He saw at once that it would be difficult,
+for the smuggler and his gang were not men to be
+attacked with impunity, and the fishers of the village
+would hesitate in taking part in such a struggle
+merely on the information of a boy. However,
+Harry saw that it was the only chance.</p>
+
+<p>In his anxiety to stand close to the lattice and so<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_190" id="Page_190">[Pg 190]</a></span>
+hide himself from the view of the two men who were
+standing on the little garden-path in front, he
+pressed too hard against it. The woodwork was
+rotten with age, and suddenly with a crash it gave
+way.</p>
+
+<p>With an oath the smuggler turned round, and he
+and the Frenchman dashed to the spot, and in an
+instant had collared the lad. In a moment he was
+dragged into the room.</p>
+
+<p>"We must cut his throat, mounseer," the smuggler
+said, with a terrible imprecation. "The scoundrel
+has heard what we've said, and our lives won't
+be worth a minute's purchase if he were to be let free.
+Stand by and I'll knock out his brains;" and he
+seized a heavy poker from the side of the hearth.</p>
+
+<p>"No, no," the Frenchman said, "don't let us have
+blood. Zere might be inquiries, and zese sings will
+sometimes be found. Better take him to sea wis
+you in ze <i>Lucy</i>, and hand him over to ze <i>Chasse
+Mar&eacute;e</i>. Zey will take care zat he does not come
+back again."</p>
+
+<p>"I will take care myself," the smuggler said.
+"I'm not going to risk my neck on the chance of his
+blabbing. It's better, as you say, to have no blood,
+but as soon as the <i>Lucy's</i> at sea overboard he goes."</p>
+
+<p>"We can talk of it," the Frenchman said. "I'm
+wis you zat he must be silenced, but it may be better&mdash;my
+plan zan yours. Zis boy belongs, I suppose,
+to ze village?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes," the smuggler said, "I know him by sight.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_191" id="Page_191">[Pg 191]</a></span>
+He's the son of an old man-of-war's man who lives
+half a mile away."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, you see, some of your men might some
+day, if they quarreled wis you, or in zeir drink, drop
+some words which might lead to inquiries. Better
+put him on board ze <i>Chasse Mar&eacute;e</i>. I will see ze
+matter is settled."</p>
+
+<p>Harry had spoken no word from the time he was
+grasped. He felt in an instant that his life was forfeited,
+and was surprised that he had not been instantly
+killed. He had not raised his voice to hallo,
+for he knew that no cottagers were near, and was
+sure that an attempt to give the alarm would insure
+his instant death. To struggle would have been
+useless. He was unarmed, and although a stout lad,
+was but a child in the grasp of a powerful man like
+the smuggler. He saw, too, that on the instant the
+Frenchman had drawn a dagger from his breast, and
+though more quiet than the smuggler he felt by the
+tone of his voice that he was as determined as his
+colleague that his silence should be secured by death.</p>
+
+<p>In another minute he was bound and thrown into
+a corner. The Frenchman then took his seat near
+him, assuring him in a low tone that he would at his
+first movement plant his dagger in his heart. The
+smuggler strolled off to summon his crew, and for a
+quarter of an hour silence reigned in the cottage.</p>
+
+<p>"You are one fool," the Frenchman said at last,
+as if he had been thinking the matter over&mdash;"one
+meddlesome fool. Why you want to listen at<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_192" id="Page_192">[Pg 192]</a></span>
+people's doors and learn zeir secrets? I don't want
+to kill you, but what are we to do? You make us
+kill you. You push your own head into ze trap.
+Zat is ze way wis boys. Zey are forever meddling
+in affairs zat concern zem not, and zen we have ze
+trouble to kill zem. I would give a hundred pounds
+if zis had not happened; but what can I do? It is
+my life against yours, and alzough I am sorry to
+have to do it&mdash;<i>parbleu!</i> my life is of much more
+value zan zat of a fishing boy. Bah! you are one
+meddlesome fool."</p>
+
+<p>So exasperated was the Frenchman at the trouble
+which the prying of this lad had brought upon him
+that he got up and angrily gave him a kick. A few
+minutes later the smuggler returned.</p>
+
+<p>"The men have all gone down to the boat," he
+said briefly. "Come along, mounseer. Bring that
+tin case with you, and those pistols."</p>
+
+<p>"Zere is no fear zat I forget ze tin case," the
+Frenchman said. "As to ze pistols&mdash;zey are not of
+much use. However, I will take zem;" and he
+thrust them into the pockets of his coat.</p>
+
+<p>The smuggler stooped, picked up Harry, threw
+him onto a sail which he had laid on the ground,
+wrapped this round him, and then cast him over his
+shoulder.</p>
+
+<p>"I'm not likely to meet anyone on my way to the
+boat," he said, "but should I do so I'm taking the
+mainsail of the <i>Lucy</i> down to her."</p>
+
+<p>In another minute Harry heard the door slam,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_193" id="Page_193">[Pg 193]</a></span>
+and then he felt himself being carried steadily along,
+his weight being as nothing to the smuggler. Not
+a word was spoken between the two men on their
+way down to the shore. Presently Harry felt by
+the deadened sound of the footsteps, and by the more
+uneven motion, that he was being carried over the
+sandy slopes down to the edge of the sea, and
+through the canvas he could hear the loud roar of
+the waves, which were now breaking violently.</p>
+
+<p>Presently he was flung roughly down on the
+sands. A minute later he was lifted by the head and
+feet, and swung into a boat. Not a word was
+spoken as it was shoved off through the breakers,
+and after ten minutes' hard rowing he felt a shock,
+and knew that they were alongside of the <i>Lucy</i>. He
+was hauled up on deck. He heard a few words of
+command, and then felt the vessel was on her way.
+A minute or two later the covering was unloosed.
+His cords were cut, and the smuggler said to him,
+"You can't get away now, and may as well make
+yourself handy for the present. Give a haul on that
+rope."</p>
+
+<p>The <i>Lucy</i> was, in fact, short-handed, two of the
+six men who composed her crew being absent.
+She was a lugger of some twenty-five tons' burden,
+built something like an ordinary fishing-boat, but
+longer and lower, and was, in fact, used for fishing
+when her crew were not engaged upon other adventures.
+She was a remarkably fast craft, and had
+more than once showed her heels with success when<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_194" id="Page_194">[Pg 194]</a></span>
+chased by the revenue cutters. She owed her immunity
+from capture, however, chiefly to her appearance,
+as from her size and build she generally
+passed unsuspected as an innocent fisherman.</p>
+
+<p>The storm increased in violence, and the little
+lugger, although a good sea-boat, had difficulty in
+making her way almost in the teeth of the gale. She
+was bound, Harry gained from a word or two
+dropped by the captain, for the mouth of the Loire,
+off which she was to be met by the <i>Chasse Mar&eacute;e</i>.
+Long before morning the coast of England was out
+of sight, and the lugger was struggling down Channel
+bravely holding her way in the sou'westerly gale.</p>
+
+<p>"Will she be zere true to her time?" the Frenchman
+asked the smuggler.</p>
+
+<p>"Aye, she will do it," Black Jack said, "if the
+wind holds as at present. Two o'clock in the morning
+is the time named, and if your people are as
+punctual as I shall be, the five hundred pounds will
+be gained. There's one thing&mdash;in such a gale as is
+blowing to-day none of our cruisers who may be off
+the coast are likely to trouble themselves about a
+boat like ours. They may wonder what we are
+doing at sea, but are scarcely likely to chase us."</p>
+
+<p>Once or twice in the course of the day large vessels
+were seen in the distance, which Harry knew,
+by the cut of their sails, to be English cruisers. All
+were, however, lying-to under the smallest canvas,
+and Harry knew that any assistance from them was
+out of the question. Towards evening the gale<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_195" id="Page_195">[Pg 195]</a></span>
+moderated, but the sea was still very high. During
+the day Harry had turned over in his mind every
+possible plan by which he might destroy the tin case
+which contained, as he knew, such important documents.
+From what he had gathered he learned that
+the success of some great undertaking upon which
+the British fleet were about to embark would be
+marred if these papers were to find their way into
+the hands of the French authorities. His own life
+he regarded as absolutely forfeited, for he was sure
+that no sooner was he fairly on board the French
+<i>Chasse Mar&eacute;e</i> than he would, at the orders of the
+French spy, be thrown overboard, and that his life
+had been so preserved, not from any feeling of
+mercy, but in order that his death might be accomplished
+with less risk to those whose safety demanded
+it.</p>
+
+<p>He was determined, if opportunity presented,
+to seize the little case and to leap overboard with
+it. The French spy never for one moment put it
+down. It was a small tin case, with a handle at the
+top, and some eight inches long by three inches wide,
+and the same deep. Sometimes the Frenchman put
+it in his pocket, beyond which it projected, but even
+then he took the precaution always to keep his hand
+upon it. During the day Harry was constantly employed
+in work on board the lugger, hauling at ropes
+and acting as if he were one of the regular crew.
+He had shared in the meals with the men, but beyond
+a curse now and then not a word had been addressed<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_196" id="Page_196">[Pg 196]</a></span>
+to him by any on board. The night came on; the
+wind was still going down, but the sea was very
+heavy. From the occasional rifts in the clouds the
+stars could be seen shining brightly, and once or
+twice the moon broke through and spread a light
+over the angry sea. As time went on the smuggler
+became anxious, and kept a keen lookout ahead.</p>
+
+<p>"It is past two," he exclaimed presently to the
+Frenchman, "and we are nearly off the mouth of
+the river. When the moon shone out just now I
+thought I caught sight of a vessel coming out, and
+I believe to windward an English cruiser is lying.
+However, I will get ready the lanterns."</p>
+
+<p>The next time the moon came out a vessel was
+clearly seen. The smuggler raised the lantern above
+the bulwarks, held it there for half a minute, and
+then lowered it. This he repeated three times. A
+moment later a similar signal was made on the bows
+of the vessel.</p>
+
+<p>"That's her," the smuggler exclaimed exultingly,
+"and the five hundred pounds is as good as in my
+pocket!"</p>
+
+<p>As he spoke a bright flash was seen to windward.</p>
+
+<p>"Confound it!" the smuggler said, "that cruiser
+has caught sight of the Frenchman. However, we
+shall be on board in plenty of time, and whether she
+gets safe to shore or not matters not much to me.
+I shall have done my part of the work, and you,
+mounseer, will give me the order for payment on
+London."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_197" id="Page_197">[Pg 197]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"It's done, my friend," the Frenchman said;
+"you've done your work well. Here's the order."</p>
+
+<p>By this time the French craft was within a distance
+of a quarter of a mile, running down at a great
+pace under her reefed sails.</p>
+
+<p>"It'll be no easy matter to get on board," the
+smuggler said, "for the sea is running tremendously.
+They will have to throw a rope, and you will have
+to catch it, mounseer, and jump overboard. I suppose
+your dispatch-box is water-tight?"</p>
+
+<p>"And the boy?" the Frenchman asked.</p>
+
+<p>"Let them throw another rope," the smuggler
+said, "and you can haul him on board too. It won't
+make much matter whether I slip the noose round
+his body or his neck. The last will be the easiest
+plan perhaps, for then, if he happens not to be alive
+when you pull him out, it would be an accident; and
+even if anyone chooses to peach, they can't swear
+that it was purposely done."</p>
+
+<p>Harry was standing near, and heard the words.
+He was close to the helm at the time, and watched
+with intense anxiety as the <i>Chasse Mar&eacute;e</i> ran rapidly
+down to them. It was clear that what had to be
+done must be done quickly, for another flash came
+up from the cruiser; and although in the din of the
+wind and the toss of the waves it could not be seen
+where her shot had fallen, the brightness of the flash
+showed that she had come up since the last shot was
+discharged. The <i>Chasse Mar&eacute;e</i> ran down, and as
+she came her captain stood upon the bulwarks and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_198" id="Page_198">[Pg 198]</a></span>
+shouted at the top of his voice "Keep her steady,
+and as I run past I will throw a rope."</p>
+
+<p>"Throw two," Black Jack shouted. "There are
+two to come on board."</p>
+
+<p>The course taken by the <i>Chasse Mar&eacute;e</i> would
+bring her along at a distance of some ten yards from
+the side of the lugger. At the moment a squall
+came, and the lugger's head turned a little towards
+the approaching craft. When she was just upon
+them Harry saw that his one chance of escape had
+come. With a sudden rush he knocked the man at
+the helm from his footing, and put the tiller up hard.
+The lugger paid off instantly. Black Jack, with an
+oath, turned round and sprang at Harry. The lad
+leaped beneath his uplifted hand, sprang at the
+Frenchman, who was standing with his back to him,
+and snatching the tin box from his hand leaped overboard.</p>
+
+<p>Momentary as had been his hold upon the tiller it
+had been sufficient. The vessel had paid off from
+the wind, and before the helmsman could regain his
+feet, or Black Jack could seize the tiller, she lay
+across the course of the <i>Chasse Mar&eacute;e</i>; and in another
+moment the French craft plunged down upon
+her, and with a crash the <i>Lucy</i> sank under her bows,
+and went down with all on board.</p>
+
+<p>As Harry sank beneath the waves he heard a
+shout of dismay from those on board the <i>Lucy</i>.
+When he came up a minute later he saw the <i>Chasse
+Mar&eacute;e</i> plowing her way from him, but no sign of the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_199" id="Page_199">[Pg 199]</a></span>
+<i>Lucy</i> was to be seen. Harry was a good swimmer,
+and fortunately the dispatch-box which he grasped
+was water-tight, and buttoning it within his jacket
+he felt that it kept his head easily above the water.
+He swam as well as he could away from the spot
+where the Lucy had disappeared, for he knew that
+if Black Jack or the Frenchman had escaped being
+run down and should see him, his death was certain&mdash;not
+indeed that his chances were in any case good,
+but with the natural hopefulness of boyhood he clung
+to life, and resolved to make a fight for it as long as
+possible. Had it not been for the dispatch-box he
+must have speedily succumbed, for in so heavy a sea
+it was difficult in the extreme to swim. However,
+after a short time he turned his back to the wind, and
+suffered himself quietly to drift.</p>
+
+<p>Hour passed after hour, and at last, to his intense
+delight, morning began to break. He saw on his
+right the low shores of the French coast, and looking
+round beheld seaward the British cruiser which
+had fired at the <i>Chasse Mar&eacute;e</i>. She was running
+quietly along the coast, and was evidently on guard
+at the mouth of the river. The sea had now gone
+down much, and the sun rose bright in an almost
+cloudless sky.</p>
+
+<p>Invigorated by the sight of the vessel Harry at
+once swam towards her. She was farther out by a
+mile than the spot where he was swimming, and was
+some two miles astern of him. She was sailing but
+slowly, and he hoped that by the time she came along<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_200" id="Page_200">[Pg 200]</a></span>
+he would be able to get within a distance whence he
+might be seen. His fear was that she might run
+back before she reached the spot where she would be
+nearer to him.</p>
+
+<p>With all his strength he swam steadily out, keeping
+his eye fixed steadily on the ship. Still she came
+onward, and was within half a mile when she was
+abreast of him. Then raising himself as high as he
+could from the water, he shouted at the top of his
+voice. Again and again he splashed with his hands
+to make as much spray and commotion as possible in
+order to attract attention. His heart almost stood
+still with joy as he heard an answering hail, and a
+moment later he saw the vessel come round into the
+wind, and lay there with her sails back. Then a
+boat was lowered, and five minutes later he was
+hauled in, his senses almost leaving him now that
+the time for exertion had passed. It was not until
+he had been lifted onto the deck of the <i>Viper</i>, and
+brandy had been poured down his throat, that he
+was able to speak. As soon as he was sufficiently
+recovered he was sent for to the captain's cabin.</p>
+
+<p>"And who are you, boy, and whence do you
+come?" the captain asked. "Do you belong to the
+<i>Chasse Mar&eacute;e</i>, which we chased in the night?"</p>
+
+<p>The officer spoke in French, supposing that Harry
+had fallen overboard from that craft.</p>
+
+<p>"I am English, sir," Harry said, "and escaped
+from a lugger which was run down by the French
+craft just as you were firing at her."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_201" id="Page_201">[Pg 201]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"I thought," exclaimed the captain, "that my
+eyes had not been wrong. I was sure that I saw a
+small fishing-boat close to the <i>Chasse Mar&eacute;e</i>. We
+lost sight of her when a cloud came over the moon,
+and thought we must have been mistaken. How
+came you there in an English fishing-boat?"</p>
+
+<p>Harry modestly told the story, and produced the
+dispatch-box.</p>
+
+<p>"This is important news indeed," the officer said,
+"and your conduct has been in every way most gallant.
+What is your name, lad?"</p>
+
+<p>"Harry Langley," he replied. "I am an apprentice
+on board the Indiaman <i>Dundas Castle</i>, and was
+to have sailed this week in the convoy for the West
+Indies."</p>
+
+<p>"You will not be able to do that now," the captain
+said. "This is most important. However,
+the steward will take charge of you, and I will talk
+to you again presently."</p>
+
+<p>The steward was called, and was told to put Harry
+into a cot slung for him, and to give him a bowl of
+warm soup; and in a few minutes the lad was asleep.</p>
+
+<p>The <i>Viper</i> shortly afterwards hauled her wind,
+and ran down to a consort who was keeping watch
+with her over the mouth of the Loire. The captain
+repaired on board the other ship, whose commander
+was his senior officer, and a consultation was held
+between them, after which the <i>Viper</i> was again got
+under sail and shaped her course for Portsmouth.</p>
+
+<p>The wind was fair, and the next morning the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_202" id="Page_202">[Pg 202]</a></span>
+<i>Viper</i> passed through the Needles, and soon afterwards
+anchored at Spithead. Here a large number
+of men-of-war and frigates were at anchor, and
+above two of the largest floated the flags of admirals.
+The <i>Viper</i> had made her signal as she came in sight
+of the fleet, and a reply was instantly run up from
+the masthead of the admiral's ship, directing the captain
+to come on board immediately the anchor was
+dropped. The moment this was done the captain's
+gig was lowered, and calling to Harry to follow him
+the captain took his seat in the stern-sheets, and
+rowed for the admiral's ship. Directing the lad to
+remain on deck, the captain at once entered the admiral's
+cabin, and a few minutes later the admiral's
+orderly summoned Harry to enter.</p>
+
+<p>Admiral Sir Hyde Parker had evidently had a
+breakfast party, for a number of naval officers, including
+Admiral Nelson and most of the captains of
+the men-of-war, were seated round the table. The
+admiral turned to Harry.</p>
+
+<p>"So you are the lad who has brought this box of
+dispatches?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sir," Harry said modestly.</p>
+
+<p>"Tell us your story over again," the admiral said.
+"It's a strange one."</p>
+
+<p>Harry again repeated the account of his adventures
+from the time of leaving his father's cottage.
+When he had done Admiral Nelson exclaimed:</p>
+
+<p>"Very well, my lad. You could not have acted
+with more presence of mind had you been a captain<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_203" id="Page_203">[Pg 203]</a></span>
+of the fleet. You showed great bravery and did
+your duty nobly."</p>
+
+<p>"There wasn't much bravery, sir," Harry said
+modestly, "for I knew that they were going to kill
+me anyhow, so that it made no difference. But I
+was determined, if possible, that the dispatches
+should be destroyed."</p>
+
+<p>The admiral smiled. He was not accustomed to
+hear his dicta even so slightly questioned by a
+lad.</p>
+
+<p>"You are an apprentice in the merchant service,
+Captain Skinner tells me," Sir Hyde Parker said,
+"and have been two years at sea."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sir," Harry said.</p>
+
+<p>"Would you like to be on the quarter-deck of one
+of his majesty's vessels, instead of that of a merchantman?"</p>
+
+<p>Harry's eyes glistened at the question.</p>
+
+<p>"I should indeed, sir," he said.</p>
+
+<p>"Then you shall be, my boy," the admiral answered.
+"Have any of you gentlemen a vacancy
+in the midshipmen's berth? If not, I'll have him
+ranked as a supernumerary on board my ship."</p>
+
+<p>"I am short of a midshipman, Sir Hyde," one of
+the captains said. "Poor little De Lisle fell overboard
+the night before last as we came round from
+Plymouth. He was about the size of this lad, and
+I'll arrange for him to have his togs. I like his
+look, and I should be glad to have him with me. I
+am sure he will be a credit to the service."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_204" id="Page_204">[Pg 204]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"That's settled, then," the admiral said. "You
+are now, sir," he said, turning to Harry again, "an
+officer in his majesty's service, and, as Captain Ball
+remarks, I am sure you will do credit to the service.
+A lad who does his duty when death is staring him
+in the face, and without a hope that the act of devotion
+will ever be known or recognized, is sure to
+make a brave and worthy officer."</p>
+
+<p>Harry's new captain wrote a few words on a piece
+of paper, and said to the admiral's servant, "Will
+you tell the midshipman of my gig to come here?"</p>
+
+<p>A minute afterwards the midshipman entered.
+The captain gave him the slip of paper and said,
+"Take this young gentleman on board the ship with
+you at once, and present him to Mr. Francis, and
+with him give this note. He will be your shipmate
+in future. See that he's made comfortable."</p>
+
+<p>The midshipman then beckoned to Harry to follow
+him, gazing askance, and with no slight astonishment
+in his face, at the appearance of his new
+messmate. Harry's attire, indeed, was not in accordance
+with the received ideas of that of a midshipman
+freshly joining a ship. His clothes were
+all so much shrunk that his ankles showed below his
+trousers, and his wrists below his coat-sleeves.
+Without a word the midshipman took his place in
+the stern-sheets, and beckoned Harry to sit beside
+him.</p>
+
+<p>"Where have you sprung from?" he said shortly.</p>
+
+<p>"I hail last from the admiral's cabin," Harry said<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_205" id="Page_205">[Pg 205]</a></span>
+with a laugh. "Before that from his majesty's
+ship <i>Viper</i>, and before that from the sea."</p>
+
+<p>"You look like the sea," said the midshipman.
+"But what have you been doing? Have you served
+before?"</p>
+
+<p>"Not in a king's ship," Harry said; "I have only
+just been appointed."</p>
+
+<p>The midshipman was too surprised at Harry's
+appearance to question him further. He felt that
+there was some mystery in the affair, and that it
+would be better for him to wait until he saw the footing
+upon which Harry was placed. He had little
+doubt from the fact of his appointment being made
+under such circumstances that there must be something
+at once singular and noteworthy about it.</p>
+
+<p>Upon reaching the ship Harry's new messmate at
+once led him up to the first lieutenant, and presented
+the captain's note. The lieutenant opened it and
+glanced at the contents. They were brief:</p>
+
+<p>"Harry Langley has been appointed midshipman
+on board the <i>C&aelig;sar</i>, and has been promoted by Sir
+Hyde Parker himself. He has performed a most
+gallant action, and one of the greatest importance.
+Make him at home at once, and let him have poor
+De Lisle's kit. I will arrange about it."</p>
+
+<p>The senior midshipman was at once sent for by
+Mr. Francis, and Harry handed over to him. The
+first lieutenant intimated to him briefly the contents
+of the captain's letter, telling the midshipman to
+make him as comfortable as possible.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_206" id="Page_206">[Pg 206]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>Harry was led below to the cockpit, where his arrival
+was greeted with a storm of questions, as his
+appearance on the quarter-deck had naturally excited
+a great deal of observation. The midshipman who
+had come with him could, of course, furnish no information,
+and beyond the brief fact mentioned by
+the captain and repeated by the first lieutenant, his
+new conductor could say no more.</p>
+
+<p>"Just wait," the midshipman said, "till he's got
+into his new clothes and looks presentable. He's in
+my charge, and I am to make him comfortable. As
+he has been put on the quarter-deck by Sir Hyde
+himself you may be sure he has done something out
+of the way."</p>
+
+<p>In a few minutes Harry was rigged out in full
+midshipman's dress, and being a very good-looking
+and gentlemanly lad, his appearance favorably impressed
+his new messmates, who had at first been disposed
+to resent the intrusion among themselves of a
+youngster whose appearance was at least the reverse
+of reputable.</p>
+
+<p>"Now," said one of the passed mates, "this meeting
+will resolve itself into a committee. Let everyone
+who can, sit down; and let those who can't,
+stand quiet. I am the president of the court. Now,
+prisoner at the bar," he said, "what is your
+name?"</p>
+
+<p>"Harry Langley."</p>
+
+<p>"And how came you here?"</p>
+
+<p>"I was brought in the captain's gig."<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_207" id="Page_207">[Pg 207]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"No equivocation, prisoner. I mean what
+brought you onto the quarter-deck?"</p>
+
+<p>"I had the good luck," Harry said, "to prevent
+a very important dispatch falling into the hands of
+the French."</p>
+
+<p>"The deuce you had!" the president said; "and
+how was that? That is to say," he said, "if there's
+no secret about it?"</p>
+
+<p>"None at all," Harry said, "the matter was very
+simple;" and for the second time that morning he
+told the story.</p>
+
+<p>When he had done there was a general exclamation
+of approval among those present, and the midshipmen
+crowded round him, shaking his hand, patting
+him on the back, and declaring that he was a
+trump.</p>
+
+<p>"The prisoner is acquitted," the president said,
+"and is received as a worthy member of this noble
+body. Boy!"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sir."</p>
+
+<p>"Go to the purser and ask him to send in two
+bottles of rum for this honorable mess to drink the
+health of a new comrade."</p>
+
+<p>Presently the boy returned.</p>
+
+<p>"The purser says, sir, who is going to pay for the
+rum?"</p>
+
+<p>There was a roar of laughter among the middies,
+for the master's mate, who had acted as president,
+was notoriously in the purser's books to the full
+amount of his credit. However, a midshipman,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_208" id="Page_208">[Pg 208]</a></span>
+who happened that morning to have received a remittance,
+undertook to stand the liquor to the mess,
+and Harry's health was drunk with all honors.</p>
+
+<p>"I suppose," one of the midshipmen said, "that
+the contents of the dispatch were with reference to
+the point to which we are all bound. I wonder
+where it can be?"</p>
+
+<p>Here an animated discussion arose as to the various
+points against which the attack of the fleet, now
+rapidly assembling at Spithead, might be directed.
+So far no whisper of its probable course had been
+made public, and it was believed indeed that even the
+captains of the fleet were ignorant of its object.</p>
+
+<p>Upon the following day Harry at once obtained
+leave to go on shore for twenty-four hours. Immediately
+he reached the Head he chartered a
+wherry, and was on the point of sailing when he
+heard a well-known voice among a group of sailors
+standing near him.</p>
+
+<p>"I can't make head or tail of it," Peter Langley
+said. "My boy left me merely to go down to the
+village, and was to have returned the first thing in
+the morning to join his ship in London. Well, he
+never came back no more. What he did with himself,
+unless he sailed in a smuggling lugger which
+put out an hour or two afterwards, I can't make out.
+The boy would never have shipped in that craft willingly,
+and I can see no reason why he should have
+gone otherwise. He didn't cross the ferry, and I
+can't help suspecting there was some foul play.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_209" id="Page_209">[Pg 209]</a></span>
+When Black Jack returns I will have it out of him
+if I kill him for it. He has a strong party there, and
+I want half a dozen good tight hands to come with
+me to Hayling. He will probably be back in a
+couple of days, and if we tackle him directly he
+lands we may find out something about him. Who
+will go with me?"</p>
+
+<p>Half a dozen voices exclaimed that they were
+willing to assist their old mate, when suddenly Harry
+stepped in among them, saying, "There's no occasion
+for that. I can tell them all about him."</p>
+
+<p>Peter Langley stepped backwards in his astonishment,
+and stared open-mouthed at Harry.</p>
+
+<p>"Dash my buttons!" he exclaimed; "why, if it
+isn't Harry himself, and in a midshipman's rig.
+What means this, my boy?"</p>
+
+<p>"It means, father, that I am a midshipman on
+board his majesty's ship <i>C&aelig;sar</i>."</p>
+
+<p>Peter stood for a moment as one stupefied with
+astonishment, and then threw his tarpaulin high in
+the air with a shout of delight. It fell into the
+water, and the tide carried it away; Peter gave it no
+further thought, but, seizing Harry's hand, wrung
+it with enthusiastic delight.</p>
+
+<p>"This is news indeed, my boy," he said. "To
+think of seeing you on the quarter-deck, and that so
+soon!"</p>
+
+<p>It was some minutes before Harry could shake
+himself free from his friends, all of whom were old
+chums of the boatswain, and had known him in his<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_210" id="Page_210">[Pg 210]</a></span>
+childhood. Drawing Peter aside at last he took him
+to a quiet hotel, and there, to the intense astonishment
+of the veteran, he related to him the circumstances
+which had led to his elevation. The old
+sailor was alternately filled with wrath and admiration,
+and it was only the consideration that beyond
+doubt Black Jack and the Frenchman had both perished
+in the <i>Lucy</i> that restrained him from instantly
+rushing off to take vengeance upon them.</p>
+
+<p>An hour later the pair took a wherry and sailed
+to Hayling, where the joy of Peter was rivaled by
+that of Harry's foster-mother. That evening Peter
+went out and so copiously ordered grog for all the
+seafaring population in honor of the event that the
+village was a scene of rejoicing and festivity such
+as was unknown in its quiet annals.</p>
+
+<p>The next day Harry rejoined his ship, and
+commenced his regular duties as a midshipman on
+board.</p>
+
+<p>A week later the whole of the ships destined to
+take part in it had arrived. The "Blue Peter" was
+hoisted at the ship's head, and on a gun firing from
+the admiral's ship the anchors were weighed, and
+the fleet soon left Spithead behind them. It consisted
+of eighteen sail of the line, with a number of
+frigates and gunboats. The expedition was commanded
+by Sir Hyde Parker, with Admiral Nelson
+second in command. Contrary to the general expedition
+they sailed eastward instead of passing
+through the Solent, and, coasting along the south of<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_211" id="Page_211">[Pg 211]</a></span>
+England, passed through the Straits of Dover and
+stood out into the North Sea.</p>
+
+<p>Harry had had an interview with his captain four
+days after he had joined. The latter told him that
+the dispatch-box which he had taken had been sent
+up to London, and that its contents proved to be of
+the highest importance, and that the Lords of the
+Admiralty had themselves written to the admiral
+expressing their extreme satisfaction at the capture,
+saying that the whole of their plans would have been
+disconcerted had the papers fallen into the hands of
+the enemy. They were pleased to express their
+strong approval of the conduct of Harry Langley,
+and gave their assurance that when the time came
+his claim for promotion should not be ignored.</p>
+
+<p>"So, my lad," the captain said, "you may be sure
+that when you have passed your cadetship you will
+get your epaulette without loss of time, and if you
+are steady and well conducted you may look out for
+a brilliant position. It is not many lads who enter
+the navy under such favorable conditions. I should
+advise you to study hard in order to fit yourself for
+command when the time should come. From what
+you tell me your education has not been neglected,
+and I have no doubt you know as much as the majority
+of my midshipmen as to books. But books
+are not all. An officer in his majesty's service
+should be a gentleman. That you are that in manner,
+I am happy to see. But it is desirable also that
+an officer should be able in all society to hold his own<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_212" id="Page_212">[Pg 212]</a></span>
+in point of general knowledge with other gentlemen.
+Midshipmen, as a class, are too much given to
+shirking their studies, and to think that if an officer
+can handle and fight a ship it is all that is required.
+It may be all that is absolutely necessary, but you
+will find that the men who have most made their
+mark are all something more than rough sailors.
+I need say nothing to you as to the necessity of at
+all times and hazards doing your duty. That is a
+lesson that you have clearly already learned."</p>
+
+<p>As the fleet still kept east, expectation rose
+higher and higher as to the object of the expedition.
+Some supposed that a dash was to be made on
+Holland. Others conceived that the object of the
+expedition must be one of the North German or
+Russian forts, and the latter were confirmed in their
+ideas when one fine morning the fleet were found
+to be entering the Sound. Instead of passing
+through, however, the fleet anchored here, out of
+gunshot of the forts of Copenhagen; and great was
+the astonishment of the officers and men alike of the
+fleet when it became known that an ultimatum had
+been sent on shore, and that the Danes (who had
+been regarded as a neutral power) were called upon
+at once to surrender their fleet to the English.</p>
+
+<p>Upon the face of facts known to the world at large,
+this was indeed a most monstrous breach of justice
+and right. The Danes had taken no part in the
+great struggle which had been going on, and their
+sympathies were generally supposed to be with the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_213" id="Page_213">[Pg 213]</a></span>
+English rather than the French. Thus, for a fleet
+to appear before the capital of Denmark, and to summon
+its king to surrender his fleet, appeared a high-handed
+act of brute force.</p>
+
+<p>In fact, however, the English government had
+learned that negotiations had been proceeding between
+the Danish government and the French; and
+that a great scheme had been agreed upon, by which
+the Danes should join the French at a given moment,
+and the united fleets being augmented by ships of
+other powers, a sudden attack would be made upon
+England. Had this secret confederation not been
+interfered with, the position of England would have
+been seriously threatened. The fleet which the allies
+would have been able to put onto the scene would
+have greatly exceeded that which England could
+have mustered to defend her coast, and although
+peace nominally prevailed between England and
+Denmark the English ministry considered itself
+justified&mdash;and posterity has agreed in the verdict&mdash;in
+taking time by the forelock, and striking a blow
+before their seeming ally had time to throw off the
+mask and to join in the projected attack upon them.</p>
+
+<p>It was the news of this secret resolve on the part
+of the cabinet that, having in some way been obtained
+by a heavy bribe from a subordinate in the
+admiralty, was being carried over in cipher to
+France in the <i>Lucy</i>, and had it reached its destination
+the Danes would have been warned in time, and
+the enterprise undertaken by Parker and Nelson<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_214" id="Page_214">[Pg 214]</a></span>
+would have been impossible, for the forts of Copenhagen,
+aided by the fleet in the harbor, were too
+strong to have been attacked had they been thoroughly
+prepared for the strife. As all these matters
+were unknown to the officers of the fleet, great was
+the astonishment when the captains of the ships
+assembled in the admiral's cabin, and each received
+orders as to the position which his vessel was to take
+up, and the part it was to bear in the contest. This
+being settled, the captains returned to their respective
+ships.</p>
+
+<p>Several days were spent in negotiations, but as the
+Danes finally refused compliance with the English
+demands the long-looked-for signal was hoisted and
+the fleet stood in through the Sound. It was a fine
+sight as the leading squadron, consisting of twelve
+line-of-battle ships and a number of frigates under
+Admiral Nelson, steered on through the Sound, followed
+at a short distance by Sir Hyde Parker with
+the rest of the fleet. The Danish forts on the Sound
+cannonaded them, but their fire was very ineffectual,
+and the fleet without replying steered on until they
+had attained the position intended for them. The
+Danes were prepared for action. Their fleet of
+thirteen men-of-war and a number of frigates, supported
+by floating batteries mounting seventy heavy
+guns, was moored in a line four miles long in front
+of the town, and was further supported by the forts
+on shore.</p>
+
+<p>This great force was to be engaged by the squad<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_215" id="Page_215">[Pg 215]</a></span>ron
+of Admiral Nelson alone, as that of Sir Hyde
+Parker remained outside menacing the formidable
+Crown Batteries and preventing these from adding
+their fire to that of the fleet and other shore batteries
+upon Nelson's squadron.</p>
+
+<p>The <i>C&aelig;sar</i>, the leading ship of the fleet, had been
+directed to sail right past the line of ships and to
+operate against a detached fort standing on a spit of
+land on the right flank of the Danish position. This
+fort mounted many guns, much superior to those of
+the C&aelig;sar in weight, but the crew were in high spirits
+at the prospect of a fight, little as they understood
+the cause for which they were engaged. Stripping
+to the waist, they clustered round the guns, each officer
+at his post, Harry, with two other midshipmen,
+being upon the quarter-deck near the captain to carry
+orders from him as might be required to different
+parts of the ship. As the <i>C&aelig;sar</i> passed along the
+line of ships to take up her position she was saluted
+by a storm of fire from the Danish vessels, to which
+she made no reply. She suffered, however, but
+little injury, although shot and shell whistled between
+the masts and struck the water on all sides of
+her, several striking the hull with a dull, crashing
+sound, while her sails were pierced with holes.
+Harry felt that he was rather pale, and was disgusted
+with himself at the feeling of discomfort which he
+experienced. But there is nothing that tries the
+nerves more than standing the fire of an enemy before
+it is time to set to work to reply. As soon as<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_216" id="Page_216">[Pg 216]</a></span>
+orders were given for the <i>C&aelig;sar's</i> fire to be opened,
+directly the guns could be brought to bear, and the
+roar of her cannon answered those of the fort, the
+feeling of uneasiness on Harry's part disappeared,
+and was succeeded by that of the excitement of
+battle. The din was prodigious. Along the whole
+line the British fleet was engaged, and the boom of
+the heavy guns of the ships, forts, and batteries, and
+the rattle of musketry from the tops of the
+ships, kept up a deep roar like that of incessant
+thunder.</p>
+
+<p>"The water is very shallow, sir," the first lieutenant
+reported to the captain. "There are but two
+fathoms under her foot. The wind, too, is dropping
+so much that we have scarcely steerage-way,
+and the current is sweeping us along fast."</p>
+
+<p>"Prepare to anchor, Mr. Francis," the captain
+said.</p>
+
+<p>He had scarcely spoken, however, when there was
+a slight shivering sensation in the ship, and it was
+known by all on board that she was aground, and
+that on a falling tide. While the starboard guns were
+kept at work the men were called off from those of
+the port side, boats were lowered and hawsers were
+got out, and every effort was made to tow the ship
+off the shoal. The sailors pulled hard in spite of
+the storm of shot and shell which fell round them
+from the fort and the nearest Danish ships. But the
+<i>C&aelig;sar</i> was fast. Calling the men on board again,
+the captain requested the first lieutenant to go aloft<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_217" id="Page_217">[Pg 217]</a></span>
+and see what was going on in other parts of the line.
+He returned with the news that four or five other
+ships were plainly aground, and that things appeared
+to be going badly. In the meantime the <i>C&aelig;sar</i> was
+suffering heavily. The fire of the fort was well
+directed, and the gunners, working their pieces under
+comparative shelter, were able to pour their fire
+steadily into the <i>C&aelig;sar</i>, while a floating battery and
+two frigates also kept up an incessant fire.</p>
+
+<p>The number of killed and wounded was already
+large, but as only the guns of the starboard side
+could be worked the fire was kept up with unabated
+zeal, and the fort bore many signs of the accuracy of
+the fire. The parapet was in many places shot away
+and several of the guns put out of action. But the
+<i>C&aelig;sar</i> was clearly overmatched, and the captain
+hastily wrote a note to the admiral, stating that the
+ship was aground and was altogether overmatched,
+and begging that another vessel might be dispatched
+to his aid, if one could be spared, in order to partially
+relieve her of the enemy's fire.</p>
+
+<p>"Here, Mr. Langley, take the gig and row off to
+the flagship instantly."</p>
+
+<p>Harry obeyed orders. Through the storm of shot
+and shell which was flying, striking up the water
+in all directions, he made his way to the admirals
+ship, which was lying nearly a mile away.</p>
+
+<p>Admiral Nelson opened the note and read it
+through.</p>
+
+<p>"Tell Captain Ball," he said, "that I haven't a<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_218" id="Page_218">[Pg 218]</a></span>
+ship to spare. Several are aground, and all hard
+pressed. He must do the best he can. Ah! you
+are the lad whom I saw in Sir Hyde Parker's cabin,
+are you not?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sir."</p>
+
+<p>The Admiral nodded in token of approval, and
+Harry prepared to leave. Suddenly a thought
+struck him, and running into the captain's cabin he
+asked the steward for a small tablecloth.</p>
+
+<p>"What on earth d'you want it for?" he exclaimed.</p>
+
+<p>"Never mind. Give it me at once."</p>
+
+<p>Seizing the tablecloth he ran down into the boat.
+As they returned towards the <i>C&aelig;sar</i> they could see
+how hardly matters were going with her. One of
+her masts was down. Her sides were battered and
+torn, and several of her port-holes were knocked into
+one. Still her fire continued unabated, but it was
+clear that she could not much longer resist.</p>
+
+<p>"Do you think she must haul down her flag?"
+Harry said to the coxswain of the boat.</p>
+
+<p>"Aye, aye, sir," the coxswain said. "Wood and
+iron can't stand such a pounding as that much
+longer. Most captains would have hauled down the
+flag long before this, and even our skipper can't stand
+out much longer. There won't be a man alive to
+fight her."</p>
+
+<p>"Will you do as I order?" Harry said.</p>
+
+<p>"Aye, sir," the coxswain said in surprise, "I will
+do what you like;" for the story of the conduct by<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_219" id="Page_219">[Pg 219]</a></span>
+which Harry had gained his midshipman's promotion
+had been repeated through the ship, and the men
+were all proud of the lad who had behaved so
+pluckily.</p>
+
+<p>"At least," Harry said, "it may do good, and it
+can't do harm. Where's the boat-hook? Fasten
+this tablecloth to it and pull for the fort."</p>
+
+<p>The coxswain gave an exclamation of surprise,
+but did as Harry told him, and with the white flag
+flying the boat pulled straight towards the fort. As
+he was seen to do so the fire of the latter, which had
+been directed towards the boat, ceased, although the
+duel between the battery and the <i>C&aelig;sar</i> continued
+with unabated vigor. Harry steered direct to the
+steps on the sea face and mounted to the interior of
+the fort, where, on saying that he brought a message
+from the captain, he was at once conducted to the
+commandant.</p>
+
+<p>"I am come, sir," Harry said, "from the captain
+to beg of you to surrender at once. Your guns have
+been nobly fought, but two more ships are coming
+down to engage with you, and the captain would
+fain save further effusion of life. You have done all
+that brave men could do, but the fight everywhere
+goes against you, and further resistance is vain. In
+a quarter of an hour a fire will be centered upon your
+guns that will mean annihilation, and the captain
+therefore begs you to spare the brave men under your
+orders from further sacrifice."</p>
+
+<p>Taken by surprise by this sudden demand, which<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_220" id="Page_220">[Pg 220]</a></span>
+was fortunately at the moment backed up by two
+ships of the squadron which had hitherto taken no
+part in the action being seen sailing in, the governor,
+after a hasty consultation with his officers, resolved
+to surrender, and two minutes afterwards the Danish
+flag was hauled down in the fort and the white flag
+run up. One of the Danish officers was directed to
+return with Harry to the ship to notify the captain
+of the surrender of the fort.</p>
+
+<p>The astonishment of Captain Ball at seeing the
+course of his boat suddenly altered, a white flag
+hoisted, and the gig proceeding direct to the fort,
+had been extreme, and he could only suppose that
+Harry had received some orders direct from the
+admiral and that a general cessation of hostilities
+was ordered. His surprise became astonishment
+when he saw the Danish flag disappear and the white
+flag hoisted in its place; and a shout of relief and
+exultation echoed from stem to stern of the <i>C&aelig;sar</i>,
+for all had felt that the conflict was hopeless and that
+in a few minutes the <i>C&aelig;sar</i> must strike her flag.
+All sorts of conjectures were rife as to the sudden
+and unexpected surrender of the fort, and expectation
+was at its highest when the gig was seen rowing
+out again with a Danish officer by the side of the
+midshipman.</p>
+
+<p>On reaching the ship's side Harry ascended the
+ladder with the Danish officer, and advancing to
+Captain Ball said:</p>
+
+<p>"This officer, sir, has, in compliance with the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_221" id="Page_221">[Pg 221]</a></span>
+summons which I took to the commander of the fort
+in your name, come off to surrender."</p>
+
+<p>The Danish officer advanced and handed his
+sword to the captain, saying:</p>
+
+<p>"In the name of the commander of the fort I surrender."</p>
+
+<p>The captain handed him back his sword, and
+ordering Harry to follow him at once entered his
+cabin. His astonishment was unbounded when the
+latter informed him what he had done, with many
+apologies for having taken the matter into his own
+hands.</p>
+
+<p>"I saw," he said, "that the <i>C&aelig;sar</i> was being
+knocked to pieces, and the coxswain told me that it
+was impossible she could much longer resist. I
+therefore thought that I could do no harm by calling
+upon the governor to surrender, and that it was possible
+that I might succeed, as you see that I
+have."</p>
+
+<p>"You certainly have saved the <i>C&aelig;sar</i>," Captain
+Ball said warmly, "and we are all indeed indebted
+to you. It was a piece of astounding impudence
+indeed for a midshipman to convey a message with
+which his captain had not charged him; but success
+in the present case a thousand times condones the
+offense. You have indeed done well, young sir, and
+I and the ship's company are vastly indebted to you.
+I will report the matter to the admiral."</p>
+
+<p>A hundred men speedily took their places in the
+boats. Lieutenant Francis was sent ashore to take<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_222" id="Page_222">[Pg 222]</a></span>
+possession, and a few minutes later the British flag
+was flying upon the fort.</p>
+
+<p>Ordering Harry to accompany him, Captain Ball
+at once took his place in his gig and rowed to the
+flagship. The battle was still raging, and to the
+practiced eye there was no doubt that the English
+fleet was suffering very severely. Captain Ball
+mounted the quarter-deck, and saluting the admiral
+reported that the fort with which he was engaged
+had struck, but that the <i>C&aelig;sar</i> being aground was
+unable to render any assistance to the general attack.</p>
+
+<p>"A good many of us are aground, Ball," Admiral
+Nelson said, "but I congratulate you on having
+caused the fort to haul down its colors. Several of
+the Danish men-of-war have struck, but we cannot
+take possession, and fresh boat-loads of men came
+off from shore, and their fire has reopened. Our
+position is an unpleasant one. Sir Hyde Parker has
+signaled to me to draw off, but so far I have paid no
+attention. I fear that we shall have to haul off and
+leave some four or five ships to the enemy."</p>
+
+<p>"The fact is," Captain Ball said, "it wasn't I who
+made the fort haul down its flag, but this midshipman
+of mine."</p>
+
+<p>"Ha!" said the admiral, glancing at Harry, who,
+at Captain Ball's order, had left the boat and was
+standing a short distance off. "How on earth did
+he do that?"</p>
+
+<p>"When you told him, sir, that you could give us
+no aid he took upon himself, instead of returning to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_223" id="Page_223">[Pg 223]</a></span>
+the ship, to row straight to the fort with one of your
+tablecloths fastened to the boat-hook, and summoned
+the commander in my name to surrender at
+once so as to save all further effusion of life, seeing
+that more ships were bearing down and that he had
+done all that a brave man could, and should now
+think of the lives of his troops."</p>
+
+<p>"An impudent little rascal!" the admiral exclaimed.
+"Midshipmen were impudent enough in
+my days, but this boy beats everything. However,
+his idea was an excellent one, and, by Jupiter! I
+will adopt it myself. A man should never be above
+learning, and we are in such a sore strait that one
+catches at a straw."</p>
+
+<p>So saying, the admiral, calling to his own captain,
+entered his cabin, and at once indited a letter to the
+King of Denmark begging him to surrender in order
+to save the blood of his subjects, expressing admiration
+at the way in which they had fought, and saying
+that they had done all that was possible to save
+honor, and might now surrender with a full consciousness
+of having done their duty. This missive
+was at once dispatched to shore, and the admiral
+awaited with anxiety its result.</p>
+
+<p>A half-hour elapsed, the firing continuing with
+unabated fury.</p>
+
+<p>"By Jove, Ball," the admiral suddenly exclaimed,
+"there's the white flag!" and a tremendous cheer
+broke along the whole of the British ships as the flag
+of truce waved over the principal fort of Copen<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_224" id="Page_224">[Pg 224]</a></span>hagen.
+Instantly the fire on both sides ceased.
+Boats passed between the shore and the flagship with
+the proposals for surrender and conditions. Nelson
+insisted that the Danish fleet should be surrendered,
+in so firm and decisive a tone as to convince the king
+that he had it in his power completely to destroy the
+town, and had only so far desisted from motives of
+humanity. At length, to the intense relief of the
+admiral and his principal officers, who knew how
+sore the strait was, and to the delight of the sailors,
+the negotiations were completed, and the victory of
+Copenhagen won.</p>
+
+<p>"Where's that boy?" the admiral asked.</p>
+
+<p>"That boy" was unfortunately no longer on the
+quarter-deck. One of the last shots fired from the
+Danish fleet had struck him above the knee, carrying
+away his leg. He had at once been carried down to
+the cockpit, and was attended to by the surgeons of
+the flagship. In the excitement of an action men
+take but little heed of what is happening around
+them, and the fall of the young midshipman was unnoticed
+by his captain. Now, however, that the
+battle was over, Captain Ball looked round for his
+midshipman, and was filled with sorrow upon hearing
+what had happened. He hurried below to the
+wounded boy, whose leg had already been amputated,
+above the point at which the ball had severed
+it, by the surgeon.</p>
+
+<p>"The white flag has been hoisted, my lad," he
+said, "and Copenhagen has been captured, and to<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_225" id="Page_225">[Pg 225]</a></span>
+you more than to anyone is this great victory due.
+I am sorry, indeed, that you should have been
+shot."</p>
+
+<p>Harry smiled faintly.</p>
+
+<p>"It is the fortune of war, sir. My career in the
+navy has not been a long one. It is but a fortnight
+since I got my commission, and now I am leaving
+it altogether."</p>
+
+<p>"Leaving the navy, perhaps," the captain said
+cheerfully, "but not leaving life, I hope. I trust
+there's a long one before you; but Admiral Nelson
+will, I am sure, be as grieved as I am that the career
+of a young officer, who promised to rise to the
+highest honors of his profession and be a credit and
+glory to his country, has been cut short."</p>
+
+<p>A short time later the admiral himself came down
+and shook hands with the boy, and thanked him for
+his services, and cheered him up by telling him that
+he would take care that his presence of mind and
+courage should be known.</p>
+
+<p>For some days Harry lay between life and death,
+but by the time that the ship sailed into Portsmouth
+harbor the doctors had considerable hope that he
+would pull round. He was carried at once to the
+Naval Hospital, and a few hours later Peter Langley
+was by his bedside. His captain frequently came to
+see him, and upon one occasion came while his
+foster-father was sitting by his bedside.</p>
+
+<p>"Ah, Peter, is it you?" he said. "Your son told
+me that you had served his majesty; but I didn't<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_226" id="Page_226">[Pg 226]</a></span>
+recognize the name as that of my old boatswain on
+board the <i>Cleopatra</i>."</p>
+
+<p>"I am glad to see your honor," Peter said; "but
+I wish it had been on any other occasion. However,
+I think that the lad will not slip his wind this time;
+but he's fretting that his career on blue water is at
+an end."</p>
+
+<p>"It is sad that it should be so," Captain Ball said;
+"but there are many men who may live to a good
+age and will have done less for their country than
+this lad in the short time he was at sea. First, he
+prevented the dispatch, which would have warned
+the enemy of what was coming, from reaching them;
+and, in the second place, his sharpness and readiness
+saved no small portion of Admiral Nelson's fleet,
+and converted what threatened to be a defeat into a
+victory. You must be proud of your son, old
+salt."</p>
+
+<p>"Has not the boy told you, sir, that he's not my
+son?" the boatswain said.</p>
+
+<p>"No, indeed!" Captain Ball exclaimed, surprised;
+"on the contrary, he spoke of you as his father."</p>
+
+<p>In a few words Peter Langley related the circumstances
+of the finding of Harry when a baby. Captain
+Ball was silent for a while, and then said, "Do
+you know, Peter, that I have been greatly struck by
+the resemblance of that lad to an old friend and
+school-fellow of mine, a Mr. Harper? They are as
+like as two peas&mdash;that is, he is exactly what my
+friend was at his age. My friend never was married;<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_227" id="Page_227">[Pg 227]</a></span>
+but I remember hearing a good many years ago&mdash;I
+should say some fifteen years ago, which would be
+about in accordance with this lad's age&mdash;that he had
+lost a sister at sea. The ship she was in was supposed
+to have foundered, and was never heard of
+again. She was the wife of the captain, and was
+taking her first voyage with him. Of course it may
+be a mere coincidence; still the likeness is so strong
+that it would be worth while making some inquiries.
+Have you anything by which the child can be identified?"</p>
+
+<p>"There are some trinkets, sir, of Indian workmanship
+for the most part, and a locket. I will
+bring them over to your honor to-morrow if you
+will let me."</p>
+
+<p>"Do so," Captain Ball said; "I am going up to
+London to-morrow, and shall see my friend. Don't
+speak to the boy about it, for it's a thousand to one
+against its being more than a coincidence. Still I
+hope sincerely for his sake that it may be so."</p>
+
+<p>The next evening Captain Ball went up by coach
+to London, and the following day called upon his
+friend, who was a rich retired East-Indian director.
+He told the story as Peter had told it to him.</p>
+
+<p>"The dates answer," he said; "and, curiously,
+although the ship was lost in the West Indies, it's
+likely enough that the ornaments of my poor sister
+would have been Indian, as I was in the habit of
+often sending her home things from Calcutta."</p>
+
+<p>"I have them with me," Captain Ball said, and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_228" id="Page_228">[Pg 228]</a></span>
+produced the little packet which Peter had given
+him.</p>
+
+<p>The old gentleman glanced at the ornaments, and
+then, taking the locket, pressed the spring. He gave
+a cry as he saw the portrait within it, and exclaimed,
+"Yes, that's the likeness of my sister as she was
+when I last saw her! What an extraordinary discovery!
+Where is the lad of whom you have been
+speaking? for surely he is my nephew, the son of my
+sister Mary and Jack Peters."</p>
+
+<p>Captain Ball then related the story of Harry's doings
+from the time he had known him, and the old
+gentleman was greatly moved at the tale of bravery.
+The very next day he went down to Portsmouth
+with Captain Ball, and Harry, to his astonishment,
+found himself claimed as nephew by the friend of
+his captain.</p>
+
+<p>When Harry was well enough to be moved he
+went up to London with his uncle, and a fortnight
+later received an official letter directing him to attend
+at the Board of Admiralty.</p>
+
+<p>Donning his midshipman uniform he proceeded
+thither in his uncle's carriage, and walked with
+crutches&mdash;for his wound was not as yet sufficiently
+healed to allow him to wear an artificial leg&mdash;to the
+board-room. Here were assembled the first lord
+and his colleagues. Admiral Nelson was also
+present, and at once greeted him kindly.</p>
+
+<p>A seat was placed for him, and the first lord then
+addressed him. "Mr. Peters, Admiral Nelson has<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_229" id="Page_229">[Pg 229]</a></span>
+brought to our notice the clever stratagem by which,
+on your own initiation and without instruction, you
+obtained the surrender of the Danish fort, and saved
+the <i>C&aelig;sar</i> at a time when she was aground and altogether
+overmatched. Admiral Nelson has also been
+good enough to say that it was the success which
+attended your action which suggested to him the
+course that he took which brought the battle to a
+happy termination. Thus we cannot but feel that
+the victory which has been won is in no small degree
+due to you. Moreover, we are mindful that it was
+your bravery and quickness which prevented the
+news of the intended sailing of the fleet from reaching
+the Continent, in which case the attack could not
+have been carried out. Under such extraordinary
+and exceptional circumstances we feel that an extraordinary
+and exceptional acknowledgment is due
+to you. We all feel very deep regret that the loss of
+your leg will render you unfit for active service at
+sea, and has deprived his majesty of the loss of so
+meritorious and most promising a young officer.
+We are about, therefore, to take a course altogether
+without precedent. You will be continued on the
+full-pay list all your life, you will at once be promoted
+to the rank of lieutenant, three years hence to
+that of commander, and again in another three years
+to the rank of post captain. The board are glad to
+hear from Captain Ball that you are in good hands,
+and wish you every good fortune in life."</p>
+
+<p>Harry was so overcome with pleasure that he<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_230" id="Page_230">[Pg 230]</a></span>
+could only stammer a word or two of thanks, and
+the first lord, his colleagues, and Admiral Nelson
+having warmly shaken hands with him, he was taken
+back to the carriage, still in a state of bewilderment
+at the honor which had been bestowed upon him.</p>
+
+<p>There is little more to tell. Having no other relations
+his uncle adopted him as his heir, and the
+only further connection that Harry had with the sea
+was that when he was twenty-one he possessed the
+fastest and best-equipped yacht which sailed out of
+an English port. Later on he sat in Parliament,
+married, and to the end of his life declared that, after
+all, the luckiest point in his career was the cutting
+off of his leg by the last shot fired by the Danish batteries,
+for that, had this not happened, he should
+never have known who he was, would never have
+met the wife whom he dearly loved, and would have
+passed his life as a miserable bachelor. Peter Langley,
+when not at sea with Harry in his yacht, lived in
+a snug cottage at Southsea, and had never reason to
+the end of his life to regret the time when he sighted
+the floating box from the tops of the <i>Alert</i>.</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_231" id="Page_231">[Pg 231]</a></span></p>
+<h2><a name="SURLY_JOE" id="SURLY_JOE"></a>SURLY JOE.</h2>
+
+
+<p>"You wonder why I am called Surly Joe, sir?
+No, as you say, I hope I don't deserve the title now;
+but I did once, and a name like that sticks to a man
+for life. Well, sir, the fish are not biting at present,
+and I don't mind if I tell you how I got it."</p>
+
+<p>The speaker was a boatman, a man some fifty
+years old, broad and weather-beaten; he had but one
+arm. I had been spending a month's well-earned
+holiday at Scarborough, and had been making the
+most of it, sailing or fishing every day. Upon my
+first arrival I had gone out with the one-armed boatman,
+and as he was a cheery companion, and his
+boat, the <i>Grateful Mary</i>, was the best and fastest on
+the strand, I had stuck to him throughout. The
+boatmen at our watering-places soon learn when a
+visitor fixes upon a particular boat, and cease to importune
+him with offers of a sail; consequently it
+became an understood thing after a day or two that
+I was private property, and as soon as I was seen
+making my way across the wet, soppy sand, which
+is the one drawback to the pleasure of Scarborough,
+a shout would at once be raised for Surly Joe. The
+name seemed a singularly inappropriate one; but it<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_232" id="Page_232">[Pg 232]</a></span>
+was not until the very day before I was returning to
+town that I made any remark on the subject. By
+this time we had become great allies; for what with
+a bathe in the morning early, a sail before lunch, and
+a fishing expedition afterwards, I had almost lived
+on board the <i>Grateful Mary</i>. The day had been too
+clear and bright for fishing; the curly-headed, barefooted
+boy who assisted Joe had grown tired of
+watching us catch nothing, and had fallen asleep in
+the bow of the boat; and the motion, as the boat rose
+and fell gently on the swell, was so eminently provocative
+of sleep that I had nodded once or twice as
+I sat with my eyes fixed on my line. Then the happy
+idea had occurred to me to remark that I wondered
+why my companion was called by a nickname which
+seemed so singularly inappropriate. Joe's offer to
+tell me how he obtained it woke me at once. I refilled
+my pipe,&mdash;an invariable custom, I observe, with
+smokers when they are sitting down to listen to a
+story,&mdash;passed my pouch to Joe, who followed my
+example; and when we had "lighted up" Joe began:</p>
+
+<p>"Well, sir, it's about twelve years ago. I was a
+strong, active chap then&mdash;not that I aint strong now,
+for I can shove a boat over the sandbar with any
+man on the shore&mdash;but I aint as active as I were. I
+warn't called Surly Joe then, and I had my two arms
+like other men. My nickname then was Curly;
+'cause, you see, my hair won't lay straight on my
+head, not when it gets as wet as seaweed. I owned
+my own boat, and the boys that worked with me<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_233" id="Page_233">[Pg 233]</a></span>
+warn't strangers, like Dick there, but they were my
+own flesh and blood. I was mighty proud of the
+two boys: fine straight tough-built lads was they, and
+as good-plucked uns as any on the shore. I had
+lost their mother ten years, maybe, before that, and
+I never thought of giving them another. One of
+'em was about twelve, just the size of Dick there;
+the other was a year older. Full of tricks and mischief
+they was, but good boys, sir, and could handle
+the boat nigh as well as I could. There was one
+thing they couldn't do, sir&mdash;they couldn't swim. I
+used to tell 'em they ought to learn; but there, you
+see, I can't swim myself, and out of all the men and
+boys on this shore I don't suppose one in twenty on
+'em can swim. Rum, aint it, sir? All their lives
+in the water or on the water, seeing all these visitors
+as comes here either swimming or learning to swim,
+and yet they won't try. They talks about instinks;
+I don't believe in instinks, else everybody who's got
+to pass his life on the water would learn to swim,
+instead of being just the boys as never does learn.
+That year, sir, I was doing well. There was a gentleman
+and his wife and darter used to use my boat
+regular; morning and afternoon they'd go out for a
+sail whenever it warn't too rough for the boat to put
+out. I don't think the old gentleman and lady cared
+so much for it; but they was just wrapped up in the
+girl, who was a pale, quiet sort o' girl, who had come
+down to the sea for her health. She was wonderful
+fond of the sea, and a deal o' good it did her; she<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_234" id="Page_234">[Pg 234]</a></span>
+warn't like the same creature after she had been here
+two months.</p>
+
+<p>"It was a roughish sort of afternoon, with squalls
+from the east, but not too rough to go out: they
+was to go out at four o'clock, and they came down
+punctual; but the gentleman says, when he gets
+down:</p>
+
+<p>"'We have just got a telegram, Joe, to say as a
+friend is coming down by the five-o'clock train, and
+we must be at the station to meet her, she being an
+invalid; but I don't want Mary to lose her sail, so
+will trust her with you.'</p>
+
+<p>"'You'll take great care of her, Joe, and bring
+her back safe,' the mother says, half laughing like;
+but I could see she were a little anxious about lettin'
+her go alone, which had never happened before.</p>
+
+<p>"'I'll take care of her, ma'am,' I says; 'you may
+take your oath I'll bring her back if I comes back
+myself.'</p>
+
+<p>"'Good-by, mamma,' the girl says as she steps on
+the plank; 'don't you fidget: you know you can
+trust Joe; and I'll be back at half-past six to dinner.'</p>
+
+<p>"Well, sir, as we pushed off I felt somehow responsible
+like, and although I'd told the boys before
+that one reef would be enough, I made 'em put in
+another before I hoisted the sail. There warn't
+many boats out, for there was more sea on than most
+visitors care to face; but once fairly outside we went
+along through it splendid. When we got within a<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_235" id="Page_235">[Pg 235]</a></span>
+mile of Fley, I asks her if we should turn, or
+go on for a bit farther.</p>
+
+<p>"'We shall go back as quick as we've come, shan't
+we, Joe?'</p>
+
+<p>"'Just about the same, miss; the wind's straight
+on the shore.'</p>
+
+<p>"'We haven't been out twenty minutes,' she
+says, looking at her watch; 'I'd rather go a bit
+farther.'</p>
+
+<p>"Well, sir, we ran till we were off the brig. The
+wind was freshening, and the gusts coming down
+strong; it was backing round rather to the north
+too, and the sea was getting up.</p>
+
+<p>"'I a'most think, miss, we'd better run into
+Filey,' I says; 'and you could go across by the
+coach.'</p>
+
+<p>"'But there's no danger, is there, Joe?'</p>
+
+<p>"'No, miss, there aint no danger; but we shall
+get a ducking before we get back; there's rain in that
+squall to windward.'</p>
+
+<p>"'Oh, I don't care a bit for rain, Joe; and the
+coach won't get in till half-past seven, and mamma
+would be in a dreadful fright. Oh, I'd so much
+rather go on!'</p>
+
+<p>"I did not say no more, but I put her about, and
+in another few minutes the squall was down upon
+us. The rain came against us as if it wanted to
+knock holes in the boat, and the wind just howled
+again. A sharper squall I don't know as ever I was
+put in. It was so black you couldn't have seen two<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_236" id="Page_236">[Pg 236]</a></span>
+boats' length. I eased off the sheet, and put the
+helm up; but something went wrong, and&mdash;I don't
+know rightly how it was, sir. I've thought it over
+hundreds and hundreds of times, and I can't reason
+it out in any sort of form. But the 'sponsibility of
+that young gal weighed on me, I expect, and I must
+somehow ha' lost my head&mdash;I don't know, I can't
+account for it; but there it was, and in less time than
+it takes me to tell you we were all in the water.
+Whatever I'd ha' been before, I was cool enough
+now. I threw one arm round the gal, as I felt her
+going, and with the other I caught hold of the side
+of the boat. We was under water for a moment,
+and then I made shift to get hold of the rudder as
+she floated bottom upwards. The boys had stuck to
+her too, but they couldn't get hold of the keel; for
+you know how deep them boats are forward, drawing
+nigh a foot of water there more than they does
+astern. However, after a bit, they managed to get
+down to'rds the stern, and get a hand on the keel
+about halfway along. They couldn't come no
+nigher, because, as you know, the keel of them boats
+only runs halfway along. 'Hould on, lads!' I
+shouted; 'hould on for your lives! They'll have
+seen us from the cliff, and 'll have a lugger out here
+for us in no time.'</p>
+
+<p>"I said so to cheer them up; but I knew in my
+heart that a lugger, to get out with that wind on,
+would have to run right into t'other side o' the bay
+before she could get room enough to weather the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_237" id="Page_237">[Pg 237]</a></span>
+brig. The girl hadn't spoken a word since the
+squall struck us, except that she gave a little short
+cry as the boat went over; and when we came up she
+got her hands on the rudder, and held on there as
+well as she could with my help. The squall did not
+last five minutes; and when it cleared off I could look
+round and judge of our chances. They weren't
+good. There was a party of people on the cliff, and
+another on the brig, who were making their way out
+as far as they could on the brig, for it were about
+half-tide. They must have seen us go over as we
+went into the squall, for as we lifted I could see over
+the brig, and there was a man galloping on horseback
+along the sands to'rds Filey as hard as he could
+go. We were, maybe, a quarter of a mile off the
+brig, and I saw that we should drift down on it before
+a boat could beat out of the bay and get round
+to us. The sea was breaking on it, as it always does
+break if there's ever so little wind from the east, and
+the spray was flying up fifty feet in places where the
+waves hit the face of the rock. There aint a worse
+place on all the coast than this, running as it do nigh
+a mile out from the head, and bare at low water.
+The waves broke over the boat heavy, and I had as
+much as I could do to hold on by one hand to the
+rudder, which swung backwards and forwards with
+every wave. As to the boys, I knew they couldn't
+hold on if they couldn't get onto the bottom of the
+boat; so I shouted to 'em to try to climb up. But
+they couldn't do it, sir; they'd tried already, over and<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_238" id="Page_238">[Pg 238]</a></span>
+over again. It would ha' been easy enough in calm
+water; but with the boat rolling and such waves
+going over her, and knocking them back again when
+they'd half got up, it was too much for 'em. If I'd
+ha' been free I could have got 'em up by working
+round to the side opposite 'em, and given them a
+hand to haul them up; but as it was, with only one
+hand free, it took me all my time to hold on where I
+was. The girl saw it too, for she turned her face
+round to me, and spoke for the first time.</p>
+
+<p>"'Let me go, please,' says she, 'and help your
+boys.'</p>
+
+<p>"'I can't do it,' said I. 'I've got to hold you till
+we're both drowned together.'</p>
+
+<p>"I spoke short and hard, sir; for, if you'll believe
+me, I was actually beginning to hate that gal.
+There was my own two boys a-struggling for their
+lives, and I couldn't lend a hand to help 'em, because
+I was hampered by that white-faced thing. She
+saw it in my face, for she gave a sort of little cry,
+and said:</p>
+
+<p>"'Oh, do&mdash;do let me go!'</p>
+
+<p>"I didn't answer a word, but held on all the
+harder. Presently Bill&mdash;he was my youngest boy&mdash;sang
+out:</p>
+
+<p>"'Father, can't you get round and lend us a hand
+to get up? I can't hold on much longer.'</p>
+
+<p>"'I can't help you, Bill,' says I. 'I've given my
+promise to take this young woman back, and I must
+keep my word. Her life's more precious to her<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_239" id="Page_239">[Pg 239]</a></span>
+father than yours is to me, no doubt, and she's got to
+be saved.'</p>
+
+<p>"It was cruel of me, sir, and altogether unjust,
+and I knew it was when I said it, but I couldn't help
+it. I felt as if I had a devil in me. I was just mad
+with sorrow and hopelessness, and yet each word
+seemed to come as cold and hard from me as if it
+was frozen. For a moment she didn't move, and
+then, all of a sudden like, she gave a twist out of my
+arms and went straight down. I grabbed at her,
+and just got hold of her cloak and pulled her up
+again. She never moved after that, but just lay
+quiet on my arm as if she was dead. Her head was
+back, half in, half out of the water; and it was only
+by the tears that run down sometimes through her
+eyelids, and by a little sob in her breast, that I knew
+that she was sensible.</p>
+
+<p>"Presently Bill says, 'Good-by, father. God
+bless you!' and then he let go his hold and went
+down. Five minutes afterwards, maybe, though it
+seemed a week to me, Jack did the same.</p>
+
+<p>"There we was&mdash;the girl and I&mdash;alone.</p>
+
+<p>"I think now, sir, looking back upon it, as I was
+mad then. I felt somehow as that the gal had
+drowned my two boys; and the devil kept whispering
+to me to beat her white face in, and then to go
+with her to the bottom. I should ha' done it too,
+but my promise kept me back. I had sworn she
+should get safe to shore if I could, and it seemed to
+me that included the promise that I would do my<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_240" id="Page_240">[Pg 240]</a></span>
+best for us both to get there. I was getting weak
+now, and sometimes I seemed to wander, and my
+thoughts got mixed up, and I talked to the boys as if
+they could hear me. Once or twice my hold had
+slipped, and I had hard work enough to get hold
+again. I was sensible enough to know as it couldn't
+last much longer, and, talking as in my sleep, I had
+told the boys I would be with 'em in a minute or
+two, when a sound of shouting quite close roused me
+up sudden.</p>
+
+<p>"Then I saw we had drifted close to the brig.
+Some men had climbed along, taking hold hand-in-hand
+when they passed across places where the sea
+was already breaking over, and bringing with them
+the rope which, as I afterwards heard, the man on
+horseback had brought back from Filey. It was a
+brave deed on their part, sir, for the tide was rising
+fast. When they saw I lifted my head and could
+hear them they shouted that they would throw me
+the rope, and that I must leave go of the boat, which
+would have smashed us to pieces, as I knew, if she
+had struck the rocks with us. Where they were
+standing the rock was full six feet above the sea;
+but a little farther it shelved down, and each wave
+ran three feet deep across the brig. They asked me
+could I swim; and when I shook my head, for I was
+too far gone to speak now, one of 'em jumped in
+with the end of the rope. He twisted it round the
+two of us, and shouted to his friends to pull. It was
+time, for we weren't much above a boat's length from<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_241" id="Page_241">[Pg 241]</a></span>
+the brig. Three of the chaps as had the rope run
+down to the low part of the rock and pulled together,
+while another two kept hold of the end of the rope
+and kept on the rock, so as to prevent us all being
+washed across the brig together. I don't remember
+much more about it. I let go the boat, sank down at
+once, as if the girl and I had been lead, felt a tug of
+the rope, and then, just as the water seemed choking
+me, a great smash, and I remember nothing else.
+When I came to my right senses again I was in a bed
+at Filey. I had had a bad knock on the head, and
+my right arm, which had been round the girl, was
+just splintered. They took it off that night. The
+first thing as they told me when I came round was
+that the gal was safe. I don't know whether I was
+glad or sorry to hear it. I was glad, because I had
+kept my promise and brought her back alive. I was
+sorry, because I hated her like pison. Why should
+she have been saved when my two boys was
+drowned? She was well-plucked, was that gal, for
+she had never quite lost her senses; and the moment
+she had got warm in bed with hot blankets, and suchlike
+she wanted to get dry clothes and to go straight
+on to Scarborough in a carriage. However, the
+doctor would not hear of it, and she wrote a little
+letter saying as she was all right; and a man galloped
+off with it on horseback, and got there just as
+they had got a carriage to the door to drive over to
+Filey to ask if there was any news there about the
+boat. They came over and slept there, and she went<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_242" id="Page_242">[Pg 242]</a></span>
+back with them next day. I heard all this afterwards,
+for I was off my head, what with the blow I
+had got and one thing and another, before I had been
+there an hour. And I raved and cussed at the girl,
+they tell me, so that they wouldn't let her father in to
+see me.</p>
+
+<p>"It was nigh a fortnight before I came to myself,
+to find my arm gone, and then I was another month
+before I was out of bed. They came over to Filey
+when I was sensible, and I hear they had got the
+best doctor over from Scarborough to see me, and
+paid everything for me till I was well, but I wouldn't
+see them when they came. I was quite as bitter
+against her as I had been when I was in the sea
+drowning; and I was so fierce when they talked of
+coming in that the doctor told them it would make
+me bad again if they came. So they went up to
+London, and when I could get about they sent me a
+letter, the gal herself and her father and mother,
+thanking me, I suppose; but I don't know, for I just
+tore 'em into pieces without reading them. Then a
+lawyer of the town here came to me and said he'd
+'struction to buy me a new boat, and to buy a 'nuity
+for me. I told him his 'nuity couldn't bring my boys
+back again, and that I warn't going to take blood-money;
+and as to the boat, I'd knock a hole in her
+and sink her if she came. A year after that lawyer
+came to me again, and said he'd more 'structions;
+and I told him though I'd only one arm left I was
+man enough still to knock his head off his shoulders,<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_243" id="Page_243">[Pg 243]</a></span>
+and that I'd do it if he came to me with his 'structions
+or anything else.</p>
+
+<p>"By this time I'd settled down to work on the
+shore, and had got the name of Surly Joe. Rightly
+enough, too. I had one of them planks with wheels
+that people use to get in and out of the boats; and
+as the boatmen on the shore was all good to me,
+being sorry for my loss, and so telling my story to
+people as went out with them, I got enough to live
+on comfortable, only there was nothing comfortable
+about me. I wouldn't speak a word, good
+or bad, to a soul for days together, unless it was
+to swear at anyone as tried to talk to me. I
+hated everyone, and myself wuss nor all. I was
+always cussing the rocks that didn't kill me, and
+wondering how many years I'd got to go on at this
+work before my turn came. Fortunately I'd never
+cared for drink; but sometimes I'd find my thoughts
+too hard for me, and I'd go and drink glass after
+glass till I tumbled under the table.</p>
+
+<p>"At first my old mates tried to get me round, and
+made offers to me to take a share in their boats, or to
+make one in a fishing voyage; but I would not hear
+them, and in time they dropped off one by one, and
+left me to myself, and for six years there wasn't a
+surlier, wuss-conditioned, lonelier chap, not in all
+England, than I was. Well, sir, one day&mdash;it was just
+at the beginning of the season, but was too rough a
+day for sailing&mdash;I was a-sitting down on the steps of
+a machine doing nothing, just wondering and won<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_244" id="Page_244">[Pg 244]</a></span>dering
+why things was as they was, when two little
+gals cum up. One was, maybe, five, and the other
+a year younger. I didn't notice as they'd just cum
+away from the side of a lady and gentleman. I never
+did notice nothing that didn't just concern me; but I
+did see that they had a nurse not far off. The biggest
+girl had great big eyes, dark and soft, and she looked
+up into my face, and held out a broken wooden spade
+and a bit of string, and says she, 'Sailor-man, please
+mend our spade.' I was struck all of a heap like; for
+though I had been mighty fond of little children in
+the old days, and was still always careful of lifting
+them into boats, my name and my black looks had
+been enough, and none of them had spoken to me
+for years. I felt quite strange like when that child
+spoke out to me, a'most like what I've read Robinson
+Crusoe, he as was wrecked on the island, felt
+when he saw the mark of a foot.</p>
+
+<p>"I goes to hold out my hand, and then I draws it
+back, and says, gruff, 'Don't you see I aint got but
+one hand? Go to your nurse.'</p>
+
+<p>"I expected to see her run right off; but she
+didn't, but stood as quiet as may be, with her eyes
+looking up into my face.</p>
+
+<p>"'Nurse can't mend spade; break again when
+Nina digs. Nina will hold spade together, sailor-man
+tie it up strong.'</p>
+
+<p>"I didn't answer at once; but I saw her lip quiver,
+and it was plain she had been crying just before; so
+I put my hand into my pocket and brings out a bit<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_245" id="Page_245">[Pg 245]</a></span>
+of string, for the stuff she'd got in her hand was of
+no account; and I says, in a strange sort of voice, as
+I hardly knew as my own, 'All right, missy, I'll
+tie it.'</p>
+
+<p>"So she held the broken pieces together, and I
+ties 'em up with the aid of my hand and my teeth,
+and makes a strong, ship-shape job of it. I did it sitting
+on the bottom step, with a child standing on
+each side watching me. When I had done it the
+eldest took it, and felt it.</p>
+
+<p>"'That is nice and strong,' she said; 'thank you.
+Annie, say thank you.'</p>
+
+<p>"'T'ank you,' she said; and, with a little pat on
+my arm as a good-by, the little ones trotted away to
+a nurse sitting some little distance off.</p>
+
+<p>"It may seem a little thing to you, sir, just a half-minute's
+talk to a child; but it warn't a little thing
+to me. It seemed regularly to upset me like; and I
+sat there thinking it over and wondering what was
+come over me, till an hour afterwards they went
+past me with their nurse; and the little things ran
+up to me and said, 'The spade's quite good now&mdash;good-by,
+sailor-man!' and went on again. So I
+shook it off and went to my work; for as the tide rose
+the wind dropped, and a few boats went out; and
+thinking what a fool I was, was gruffer and surlier
+than ever.</p>
+
+<p>"Next morning I was lending a mate a hand
+painting a boat, when I saw the two children coming
+along the sand again, and I wondered to myself<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_246" id="Page_246">[Pg 246]</a></span>
+whether they would know me again, or think any
+more of me, and though I wanted them to do so I
+turned my back to the way they was coming, and
+went on with my painting. Somehow I felt wonderful
+glad when I heard their little feet come, pattering
+along the sand, and they sang out:</p>
+
+<p>"'Good-morning, sailor-man!'</p>
+
+<p>"'Good-morning!' says I, short-like, as if I didn't
+want no talk; and I goes on with my work without
+turning round.</p>
+
+<p>"Just then one of the men at the boats hails me.</p>
+
+<p>"'Joe, there's a party coming down.'</p>
+
+<p>"'I'm busy,' shouts I back; 'shove the plank out
+yourself.'</p>
+
+<p>"The children stopped quiet by me for a minute
+or two, watching me at work, and then the eldest
+says:</p>
+
+<p>"'May we get inside the boat, Joe? we've never
+been inside a boat, and we do want to so much.'</p>
+
+<p>"'My hand is all covered with paint,' says I, making
+a fight with myself against giving in.</p>
+
+<p>"Then the little one said:</p>
+
+<p>"'Oo stoop down, Joe; sissy and me take hold
+round oor neck; then oo stand up and we det in.'</p>
+
+<p>"Well, sir, the touch of their little arms and those
+soft little faces against my cheeks as they got in
+fairly knocked me over, and it was some time before
+I could see what I was doing.</p>
+
+<p>"Once in, they never stopped talking. They
+asked about everything, and I had to answer them;<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_247" id="Page_247">[Pg 247]</a></span>
+and as I got accustomed to it the words came freer,
+till I was talking away with them as if I had known
+'em all my life. Once I asked them didn't their papa
+and mamma ever take 'em out for a sail, and they
+shook their heads and said mammy hated the sea,
+and said it was a cruel sea; by which I judged as she
+must have lost someone dear to her by it.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, sir, I must cut a long story short. Those
+children used to come every day down to talk with
+me, and I got to look for it regular; and if it was a
+wet day and they couldn't come I'd be regular put
+out by it; and I got to getting apples and cakes in
+my pockets for them. After a fortnight I took to
+carrying them across the wet sands and putting them
+on the stand as I wheeled it out and back with people
+to the boats. I didn't do it till they'd asked their
+mother, and brought back the message that she knew
+she could trust them with me.</p>
+
+<p>"All this time it never once struck me as strange
+that their nurse should sit with a baby-brother of
+theirs at a distance, and let them play with me by
+the hour together, without calling them away, for I
+wondered so much at myself, and to find myself telling
+stories to 'em just as I'd do with children who
+came out sailing with me in the old time, and in
+knowing as I was so wrapped up in 'em that I
+couldn't wonder at anything else. Natural like, I
+changed a good deal in other respects, and I got to
+give a good-morning to mates as I had scarce spoken
+with for years; and the moment the children turned<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_248" id="Page_248">[Pg 248]</a></span>
+down onto the sands there'd be sure to be a shout of
+'There's your little ladies, Joe.'</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know why my mates should ha' been
+pleased to see me coming round, for I had made myself
+onpleasant enough on the shore; but they'd made
+'lowances for me, and they met me as kindly as if I'd
+cum back from a vyage. They did it just quiet like,
+and would just say, natural, 'Lend us a hand here,
+Joe, boy,' or 'Give us a shoulder over the bank, Joe,'
+and ask me what I thought o' the weather. It was
+a hard day for me when, after staying nigh two
+months, the little ladies came to say good-by. It
+warn't as bad as might have been, though, for they
+were going to stay with some friends near York, and
+were to come back again in a fortnight before they
+went back to London. But they kissed me, and
+cried, and gave me a pipe and a lot o' 'bacca, and I
+was to think of them whenever I smoked it, and they
+would be sure to think of me, for they loved me very
+much.</p>
+
+<p>"That very afternoon, sir, as I was standing by
+my stage, Jim Saunders&mdash;he'd been mate with me
+before I owned a boat of my own&mdash;says out loud:</p>
+
+<p>"'Lor', here's my party a-coming down, and I've
+jammed my hand so as I can't hoist a sail. Who'll
+come out and lend me a hand?'</p>
+
+<p>"Well, everyone says they were busy, and
+couldn't come; but I believe now as the whole thing
+was a got-up plan to get me afloat again; and then
+Jim turns to me as if a sudden idea had struck him.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_249" id="Page_249">[Pg 249]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"'Come, Joe, lend us a hand for the sake o' old
+times; come along, old chap.'</p>
+
+<p>"I was taken aback like, and could only say something
+about my stage; but half a dozen chaps volunteers
+to look after my stage, and afore I scarce knew
+what I was after I was bundled aboard the boat; and
+as the party got in I'm blest if I don't think as every
+chap on the shore runs in to help shove her off, and
+a score of hands was held out just to give me a shake
+as we started.</p>
+
+<p>"I don't think I was much good on that vyage,
+for I went and sat up in the bow, with my back to
+the others, and my eyes fixed far ahead.</p>
+
+<p>"I needn't tell you, sir, when I'd once broken the
+ice I went regular to the sea again, and handed my
+stage over to a poor fellow who had lost his craft
+and a leg the winter before.</p>
+
+<p>"One day when I came in from a sail I saw two
+little figures upon the sands, and it needed no word
+from anyone to tell me my little ladies had come
+back. They jumped and clapped their hands when
+they saw me, and would have run across the water
+to meet me hadn't I shouted to them to wait just a
+minute till I should be with them.</p>
+
+<p>"'We've been waiting a long time, Joe. Where
+have you been?'</p>
+
+<p>"'I've been out sailing, missy.'</p>
+
+<p>"'Joe, don't you know it's wicked to tell stories?
+You told us you should never go on sea any
+more.'<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_250" id="Page_250">[Pg 250]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"'No more I didn't think I should, missy; and I
+don't suppose I ever should if I hadn't met you,
+though you won't understand that. However, I've
+give up the stage, and have taken to the sea again.'</p>
+
+<p>"'I'm glad of that, Joe,' the eldest said, 'and
+mamma will be glad too.'</p>
+
+<p>"'Why should mamma be glad, little one?' I
+asked.</p>
+
+<p>"'Mamma will be glad,' she said positively. 'I
+know she will be glad when I tells her.'</p>
+
+<p>"We'd sat down by this time, and I began to talk
+to them about their mamma. Mamma very good,
+very kind, very pretty, they both agreed; and then
+they went on telling me about their home in London,
+and their carriage and amusements. Presently they
+stopped, and I could see the eldest wanted to say
+something particular, for she puckered up her forehead
+as she always did when she was very serious;
+and then she said, with her hands folded before her,
+almost as if she was saying a lesson:</p>
+
+<p>"'Mamma very happy woman. She's got two
+little girls and baby-brother, and papa love her so
+much; but there's one thing keeps her from being
+quite happy.'</p>
+
+<p>"'Is there, missy?' I asked. 'She ought to be
+happy with all these things. What is it?'</p>
+
+<p>"'Mamma once had someone do a great thing for
+her. If it hadn't been for him Nina and sissy and
+little baby-brother could never have been born, and
+papa would never have had dear mamma to love;<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_251" id="Page_251">[Pg 251]</a></span>
+but it cost the man who did it a great deal&mdash;all he
+cared for; and now he won't let mamma and papa
+and us love him and help him; and it makes mamma
+unhappy when she thinks of it.'</p>
+
+<p>"Here she had evidently finished what she had
+heard her mamma say, for her forehead got smooth
+again, and she began to fill my pockets with sand.</p>
+
+<p>"'It don't sound likely, missy, that doesn't,' I
+says. 'It don't stand to reason nohow. You can't
+have understood what mamma said.'</p>
+
+<p>"'Mamma said it over and over again, lots of
+time,' Nina said. 'Nina quite sure she said right.'</p>
+
+<p>"We didn't say no more about it then, though
+after the children had gone I wondered to myself
+how a chap could go on so foolish as that. Well, sir,
+three days after come round from Whitby this very
+boat, the <i>Grateful Mary</i>. She was sent care of Joe
+Denton; and as that was me, I had her hauled up on
+the beach till I should hear whose she was. Several
+visitors that had been out with me had said, promiscuous
+like, that they should like to have a boat of
+their own, and I supposed they had bought her at
+Whitby and sent her down, though why they should
+have sent her to my care I couldn't quite see.</p>
+
+<p>"Two days afterwards them children come down,
+and says:</p>
+
+<p>"'We want you to go through the town to the
+other cliff with us, Joe.'</p>
+
+<p>"'I can't,' says I. 'I'm all right talking to you
+here, missies; but I shouldn't be a credit to you in<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_252" id="Page_252">[Pg 252]</a></span>
+the town, and your pa wouldn't be best pleased if he
+was to see you walking about in the streets with a
+boatman.'</p>
+
+<p>"'Papa said we might ask you, Joe.'</p>
+
+<p>"I shook my head, and the little ladies ran off to
+their nurse, who come back with them and says:</p>
+
+<p>"'Master told me to say he should be pertickler
+glad if you would go with the young ladies.'</p>
+
+<p>"'Oh, very well,' I says; 'if their pa don't object,
+and they wishes it, I'd go with 'em anywheres. You
+wait here a quarter of an hour, while I goes and
+cleans myself, and I'll go with you.'</p>
+
+<p>"When I comes back the youngest takes my hand,
+and the oldest holds by my jacket, and we goes up
+into High Street, and across to the other cliff. We
+goes along till we comes to a pretty little cottage
+looking over the sea. There was a garden in front,
+new planted with flowers.</p>
+
+<p>"'Are you sure you are going right?' says I,
+when they turned in.</p>
+
+<p>"They nodded, and ran up to the door and turned
+the handle.</p>
+
+<p>"'Come in, Joe,' they said; and they dragged me
+into a parlor, where a lady and gentleman was sitting.</p>
+
+<p>"The gentleman got up.</p>
+
+<p>"'My little girls have spoken so much to me
+about you, Joe, that I feel that we know each other
+already.'</p>
+
+<p>"'Yes, sir, surely,' says I.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_253" id="Page_253">[Pg 253]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"'Well, Joe, do you know that I owe you a great
+deal as to these little girls?'</p>
+
+<p>"'Bless you, sir, it's I as owe a great deal to the
+little missies; they have made a changed man of me,
+they have; you ask anyone on the shore.'</p>
+
+<p>"'I hope they have, Joe; for had they not got
+round your heart, and led you to your better self, I
+could never have done what I have done, for you
+would have rendered it useless.'</p>
+
+<p>"I didn't say nothing, sir, for I could make neither
+head nor tail of what he was saying, and, I dessay,
+looked as surprised as might be. Then he takes a
+step forward, and he puts a hand on my shoulder,
+and says he:</p>
+
+<p>"'Joe, have you never guessed who these little
+girls were?'</p>
+
+<p>"I looked first at the children, and then at him,
+and then at the lady, who had a veil down, but was
+wiping her eyes underneath it. I was downright
+flummuxed.</p>
+
+<p>"'I see you haven't,' the gentleman went on.
+'Well, Joe, it is time you should know now. I owe
+to you all that is dear to me in this world, and our
+one unhappiness has been that you would not hear
+us, that you had lost everything and would not let us
+do anything to lighten your blow.'</p>
+
+<p>"Still, sir, I couldn't make out what he meant,
+and began to think that I was mad, or that he was.
+Then the lady stood up and threw back her veil, and
+come up in front of me with the tears a-running<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_254" id="Page_254">[Pg 254]</a></span>
+down her face; and I fell back a step, and sits down
+suddenly in a chair, for, sure enough, it was that gal.
+Different to what I had seen her last, healthy-looking
+and well&mdash;older, in course; a woman now, and the
+mother of my little ladies.</p>
+
+<p>"She stood before me, sir, with her hands out before
+her, pleading like.</p>
+
+<p>"'Don't hate me any more, Joe. Let my children
+stand between us. I know what you have suffered,
+and, in all my happiness, the thought of your
+loneliness has been a trouble, as my husband will tell
+you. I so often thought of you&mdash;a broken, lonely
+man. I have talked to the children of you till they
+loved the man that saved their mother's life. I cannot
+give you what you have lost, Joe&mdash;no one can do
+that; but you may make us happy in making you
+comfortable. At least, if you cannot help hating
+me, let the love I know you bear my children weigh
+with you.'</p>
+
+<p>"As she spoke the children were hanging on me;
+and when she stopped the little one said:</p>
+
+<p>"'Oh, Joe, oo must be dood; oo mustn't hate
+mamma, and make her cry!'</p>
+
+<p>"Well, sir, I know as I need tell you more about
+it. You can imagine how I quite broke down, like
+a great baby, and called myself every kind of name,
+saying only that I thought, and I a'most think so
+now, that I had been somehow mad from the moment
+the squall struck the <i>Kate</i> till the time I first
+met the little girls.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_255" id="Page_255">[Pg 255]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"When I thought o' that, and how I'd cut that
+poor gal to her drowning heart with my words, I
+could ha' knelt to her if she'd ha' let me. At last,
+when I was quiet, she explained that this cottage and
+its furniture and the <i>Grateful Mary</i> was all for me;
+and we'd a great fight over it, and I only gave in
+when at last she says that if I didn't do as she wanted
+she'd never come down to Scarborough with the
+little ladies no more; but that if I 'greed they'd come
+down regular every year, and that the little girls
+should go out sailing with me regular in the <i>Grateful
+Mary</i>.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, sir, there was no arguing against that,
+was there? So here I am; and next week I expect
+Miss Mary that was, with her husband, who's a Parliament
+man, as she was engaged to be married to
+at the time of the upset, and my little ladies, who is
+getting quite big girls too. And if you hadn't been
+going away I'd ha' sailed round the castle tower,
+and I'd ha' pointed out the cottage to you. Yes,
+sir, I see what you are going to ask. I found it
+lonely there; and I found the widow of a old mate of
+mine who seemed to think as how she could make
+me comfortable; and comfortable I am, sir&mdash;no
+words could say how comfortable I am; and do you
+know, sir, I'm blest if there aint a Joe up there at
+this identical time, only he's a very little one, and
+has got both arms. So you see, sir, I have got about
+as little right as has any chap in this mortial world
+to the name of Surly Joe."</p>
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_256" id="Page_256">[Pg 256]</a></span></p>
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<p><span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_257" id="Page_257">[Pg 257]</a></span></p>
+<h2><a name="A_FISH-WIFES_DREAM" id="A_FISH-WIFES_DREAM"></a>A FISH-WIFE'S DREAM.</h2>
+
+
+<p>Falmouth is not a fashionable watering-place.
+Capitalists and speculative builders have somehow
+left it alone, and, except for its great hotel, standing
+in a position, as far as I know, unrivaled, there have
+been comparatively few additions to it in the last
+quarter of a century. Were I a yachtsman I should
+make Falmouth my headquarters: blow high, blow
+low, there are shelter and plenty of sailing room,
+while in fine weather there is a glorious coast along
+which to cruise&mdash;something very different from the
+flat shores from Southampton to Brighton. It is
+some six years since that I was lying in the harbor,
+having sailed round in a friend's yacht from Cowes.
+Upon the day after we had come in my friend went
+into Truro, and I landed, strolled up, and sat down
+on a bench high on the seaward face of the hill that
+shelters the inner harbor.</p>
+
+<p>An old coastguardsman came along. I offered
+him tobacco, and in five minutes we were in full talk.</p>
+
+<p>"I suppose those are the pilchard boats far out
+there?"</p>
+
+<p>"Aye, that's the pilchard fleet."</p>
+
+<p>"Do they do well generally?"<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_258" id="Page_258">[Pg 258]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Sometimes they do, sometimes they don't; it's
+an uncertain fish the pilchard, and it's a rough life is
+fishing on this coast. There aint a good harbor not
+this side of the Lizard; and if they're caught in a
+gale from the southeast it goes hard with them.
+With a southwester they can run back here."</p>
+
+<p>"Were you ever a fisherman yourself?"</p>
+
+<p>"Aye, I began life at it; I went a-fishing as a boy
+well-nigh fifty year back, but I got a sickener of it,
+and tramped to Plymouth and shipped in a frigate
+there, and served all my time in queen's ships."</p>
+
+<p>"Did you get sick of fishing because of the hardships
+of the life, or from any particular circumstance?"</p>
+
+<p>"I got wrecked on the Scillys. There was fifty
+boats lost that night, and scarce a hand was saved.
+I shouldn't have been saved myself if it had not been
+for a dream of mother's."</p>
+
+<p>"That's curious," I said. "Would you mind
+telling me about it?"</p>
+
+<p>The old sailor did not speak for a minute or two;
+and then, after a sharp puff at his pipe, he told me
+the following story, of which I have but slightly
+altered the wording:</p>
+
+<p>I lived with mother at Tregannock. It's a bit of
+a village now, as it was then. My father had been
+washed overboard and drowned two years before. I
+was his only son. The boat I sailed in was mother's,
+and four men and myself worked her in shares. I
+was twenty-one, or maybe twenty-two, years old<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_259" id="Page_259">[Pg 259]</a></span>
+then. It was one day early in October. We had
+had a bad season, and times were hard. We'd
+agreed to start at eight o'clock in the morning. I
+was up at five, and went down to the boats to see as
+everything was ready. When I got back mother
+had made breakfast; and when we sat down I saw
+that the old woman had been crying, and looked
+altogether queer like.</p>
+
+<p>"My boy," says she, "I want you not to go out this trip."</p>
+
+<p>"Not go out!" said I; "not go out, mother!
+Why? What's happened? Your share and mine
+didn't come to three pounds last month, and it would
+be a talk if I didn't go out in the <i>Jane</i>. Why, what
+is it?"</p>
+
+<p>"My boy," says she, "I've had a dream as how
+you was drowned."</p>
+
+<p>"Drowned!" said I; "I'm not going to be
+drowned, mother."</p>
+
+<p>But what she said made me feel creepy like, for us
+Cornishmen goes a good deal on dreams and tokens;
+and sure enough mother had dreamed father was
+going to be drowned before he started on that last
+trip of his.</p>
+
+<p>"That's not all, Will," she said. "I dreamed of
+you in bed, and a chap was leaning over you cutting
+your throat."</p>
+
+<p>I didn't care much for going on with my breakfast
+after that; but in a minute or two I plucks up
+and says:<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_260" id="Page_260">[Pg 260]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"Well, mother, you're wrong, anyhow; for
+if I be drowned no one has no call to cut my
+throat."</p>
+
+<p>"I didn't see you downright drowned in my
+dream," she said. "You was in the sea&mdash;a terribly
+rough sea&mdash;at night, and the waves were breaking
+down on you."</p>
+
+<p>"I can't help going, mother," I says, after a bit.
+"It's a fine day, and it's our boat. All the lads and
+girls in the village would laugh at me if I stayed at
+home."</p>
+
+<p>"That's just what your father said; and he went
+to his death."</p>
+
+<p>And my mother, as she says this, puts her apron
+over her head and began to cry again. I'd more
+than half a mind to give way; but you know what
+young chaps are. The thought of what the girls of
+the place would say about my being afraid to go was
+too much for me.</p>
+
+<p>At last, when mother saw I was bent on going,
+she got up and said:</p>
+
+<p>"Well, Will, if my prayers can't keep you back,
+will you do something else I ask you?"</p>
+
+<p>"I will, mother," said I&mdash;"anything but stay
+back."</p>
+
+<p>She went off without a word into her bedroom,
+and she came back with something in her arms.</p>
+
+<p>"Look here, Will, I made this for your father,
+and he wouldn't have it; now I ask you to take it,
+and put it on if a storm comes on. You see, you<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_261" id="Page_261">[Pg 261]</a></span>
+can put it on under your dreadnaught coat, and no
+one will be any the wiser."</p>
+
+<p>The thing she brought in was two flat Dutch
+spirit-bottles, sewn between two pieces of canvas.
+It had got strings sewed on for tying round the body,
+and put on as she did to show me how, one bottle
+each side of the chest, it lay pretty flat.</p>
+
+<p>"Now, Will, these bottles will keep you up for
+hours. A gentleman who was staying in the village
+before you was born was talking about wrecks, and
+he said that a couple of empty bottles, well corked,
+would keep up a fair swimmer for hours. So I
+made it; but no words could get your father to try
+it, though he was willing enough to say that it would
+probably keep him afloat. You'll try it, won't you,
+Will?"</p>
+
+<p>I didn't much like taking it, but I thought there
+wasn't much chance of a storm, and that if I put it
+under my coat and hid it away down in the forecastle,
+no one would see it; and so to please her I
+said I'd take it, and that if a bad storm came on I
+would slip it on.</p>
+
+<p>"I will put a wineglass of brandy into one of the
+bottles," mother said. "It may be useful to you;
+who can say?"</p>
+
+<p>I got the life-preserver, as you call it nowadays,
+on board without its being seen, and stowed it away
+in my locker. I felt glad now I'd got it, for mother's
+dream had made me feel uneasy; and on my way
+down old Dick Tremaine said to me:<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_262" id="Page_262">[Pg 262]</a></span></p>
+
+<p>"I don't like the look of the sky, lad."</p>
+
+<p>"No!" says I; "why, it looks fine enough."</p>
+
+<p>"Too fine, lad. I tell ye, boy, I don't like the look
+of it. I think we're going to have a bad blow."</p>
+
+<p>I told the others what he had said; but they didn't
+heed much. Two boats had come in that morning
+with a fine catch, and after the bad time we'd been
+having it would have taken a lot to keep them in
+after that.</p>
+
+<p>We thought no more about it after we had once
+started. The wind was light and puffy; but we had
+great luck, and were too busy to watch the weather.
+What wind there was, was northerly; but towards
+sunset it dropped suddenly, and as the sails flapped
+we looked round at the sky.</p>
+
+<p>"I fear old Dick was right, lads," Jabez Harper,
+who was skipper, said, "and I wish we had taken
+more heed to his words. That's about as wild a
+sunset as may be; and look how that drift is nearing
+our boat."</p>
+
+<p>Even I, who was the youngest of them, was old
+enough to read the signs of a storm&mdash;the heavy bank
+of dark clouds, the pale-yellow broken light, the
+horse-tails high up in the sky, and the small broken
+irregular masses of cloud that hurried across them.
+Instinctively we looked round towards the coast.
+It was fully fifteen miles away, and we were to the
+east of it. The great change in the appearance of
+the sky had taken place in the last half-hour; previous
+to that time there had been nothing which<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_263" id="Page_263">[Pg 263]</a></span>
+would have struck any but a man grown old upon
+the coast like Dick Tremaine.</p>
+
+<p>"Reef the mainsail," Jabez said, "and the foresail
+too; take in the mizzen. Like enough it will
+come with a squall, and we'd best be as snug as may
+be. What do you say? shall we throw over some
+of the fish?"</p>
+
+<p>It was a hard thing to agree to; but every minute
+the sky was changing. The scud was flying thicker
+and faster overhead, and the land was lost in a black
+cloud that seemed to touch the water.</p>
+
+<p>"We needn't throw 'em all out," Jabez said; "if
+we get rid of half she'll be about in her best trim;
+and she's as good a sea-boat as there is on the coast.
+Come, lads, don't look at it."</p>
+
+<p>It was, as he said, no use looking at it, and in five
+minutes half our catch of the day was overboard.
+The <i>Jane</i> was a half-decked boat, yawl-rigged; she
+wasn't built in our parts, but had been brought round
+from somewhere east by a gentleman as a fishing-craft.
+He had used her for two years, and had got
+tired of the sport, and my father had bought her of
+him. She wasn't the sort of boat generally used
+about here, but we all liked her, and swore by her.</p>
+
+<p>"It will be a tremendous blow for the first few
+minutes, I reckon," Jabez said after a while.
+"Lower down her sails altogether; get her head to
+it with a sweep. I'll take the helm; Harry, you
+stand ready to hoist the foresail a few feet; and,
+Will, you and John stand by the hoists of the main<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_264" id="Page_264">[Pg 264]</a></span>sail.
+We must show enough to keep her laying-to
+as long as we can. You'd best get your coats out
+and put 'em on, and batten down the hatch."</p>
+
+<p>I let the others go down first, and when they came
+up I went in, tied the life-belt round me, and put on
+my oilskin. I fetched out a bottle of hollands from
+my locker, and then came out and fastened the hatch.</p>
+
+<p>"Here comes the first puff," Jabez said.</p>
+
+<p>I stowed away the bottle among some ropes for
+our future use, and took hold of the throat halyard.</p>
+
+<p>"Here it comes," Jabez said, as a white line appeared
+under the cloud of mist and darkness ahead,
+and then with a roar it was upon us.</p>
+
+<p>I have been at sea, man and boy, for forty years,
+and I never remember in these latitudes such a squall
+as that. For a few minutes I could scarcely see or
+breathe. The spray flew in sheets over us, and the
+wind roared so that you wouldn't have heard a sixty-eight-pounder
+ten yards off. At first I thought we
+were going down bodily. It was lucky we had
+taken every stitch of canvas off her, for, as she spun
+round, the force of the wind against the masts and
+rigging all but capsized her. In five minutes the
+first burst was over, and we were running before it
+under our close-reefed foresail only. There was no
+occasion for us to stand by the halyards now, and
+we all gathered in the stern, and crouched down in
+the well. Although the sun had only gone down
+half an hour it was pitch-dark, except that the white
+foam round us gave a sort of dim light that made the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_265" id="Page_265">[Pg 265]</a></span>
+sky look all the blacker. The sea got up in less time
+than it takes in telling, and we were soon obliged to
+hoist the foresail a bit higher to prevent the waves
+from coming in over the stern. For three hours we
+tore on before the gale, and then it lulled almost as
+suddenly as it had come on. There had scarcely
+been a word spoken between us during this time. I
+was half asleep in spite of the showers of spray.
+Jim Hackers, who was always smoking, puffed away
+steadily; Jabez was steering still, and the others were
+quite quiet. With the sudden lull we were all on
+our feet.</p>
+
+<p>"Is it all over, Jabez?" I asked.</p>
+
+<p>"It's only begun," he said. "I scarce remember
+such a gale as this since I was a boy. Pass that
+bottle of yours round, Will; we shall be busy again
+directly. One of you take the helm; I'm stiff with
+the wet. We shall have it round from the south in
+a few minutes."</p>
+
+<p>There was scarce a breath of wind now, and she
+rolled so I thought she would have turned turtle.</p>
+
+<p>"Get out a sweep," Jabez said, "and bring her
+head round."</p>
+
+<p>We had scarcely done so ere the first squall from
+behind struck us, and in five minutes we were running
+back as fast as we had come. The wind was
+at first south, but settled round to southeast. We
+got up a little more sail now, and made a shift to
+keep her to the west, for with this wind we should
+have been ashore long before morning if we had run<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_266" id="Page_266">[Pg 266]</a></span>
+straight before it. The sea had been heavy&mdash;it was
+tremendous now; and, light and seaworthy as the
+<i>Jane</i> was, we had to keep baling as the sea broke into
+her. Over and over again I thought that it was all
+over with us as the great waves towered above our
+stern, but they slipped under us as we went driving
+on at twelve or fourteen knots an hour. I stood up
+by the side of Jabez, and asked him what he thought
+of it.</p>
+
+<p>"I can't keep her off the wind," he said; "we
+must run, and by midnight we shall be among the
+Scillys. Then it's a toss-up."</p>
+
+<p>Jabez's calculations could not have been far out,
+for it was just midnight, as far as I could tell, when
+we saw a flash right ahead.</p>
+
+<p>"That's a ship on one of the Scillys," Jabez said.
+"I wish I knew which it was."</p>
+
+<p>He tried to bring her a little more up into the
+wind, but she nearly lay over onto her beam-ends,
+and Jabez let her go ahead again. We saw one
+more flash, and then a broad faint light. The ship
+was burning a blue light. She was not a mile ahead
+now, and we could see she was a large vessel. I had
+often been to the Scillys before, and knew them as
+well as I did our coast, but I could not see the land.
+It was as Jabez had said&mdash;a toss-up. If we just
+missed one of them we might manage to bring up
+under its lee; but if we ran dead into one or other of
+them the <i>Jane</i> would break up like an egg-shell.</p>
+
+<p>We were rapidly running down upon the wreck<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_267" id="Page_267">[Pg 267]</a></span>
+when the glare of a fire on shore shone up. It was
+a great blaze, and we could faintly see the land and a
+white cottage some hundred yards from the shore.</p>
+
+<p>"I know it," Jabez shouted; "we are close to the
+end of the island; we may miss it yet. Hoist the
+mainsail a bit."</p>
+
+<p>I leapt up with another to seize the halyards,
+when a great wave struck us; she gave a roll, and
+the next moment I was in the water.</p>
+
+<p>After the first wild efforts I felt calm like. I
+knew the shore was but half a mile ahead, and that
+the wind would set me dead upon it. I loosened my
+tarpaulin coat and shook it off, and I found that with
+mother's belt I could keep easily enough afloat,
+though I was half drowned with the waves as they
+swept in from behind me. My mother's dream
+cheered me up, for, according to that, it did not seem
+as I was to be drowned, whatever was to come afterwards.
+I drifted past the wreck within a hundred
+yards or so. They were still burning blue lights;
+but the sea made a clean sweep over her, and I saw
+that in a very few minutes she would go to pieces.
+Many times as the seas broke over me I quite gave
+up hope of reaching shore; but I was a fair swimmer,
+and the bottles buoyed me up, and I struggled on.</p>
+
+<p>I could see the fire on shore, but the surf that
+broke against the rocks showed a certain death if I
+made for it, and I tried hard to work to the left,
+where I could see no breaking surf. It seemed to me
+that the fire was built close to the end of the island.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_268" id="Page_268">[Pg 268]</a></span>
+As I came close I found that this was so. I drifted
+past the point of land not fifty feet off, where the
+waves were sending their spray a hundred feet up;
+then I made a great struggle, and got in under the lee
+of the point. There was a little bay with a shelving
+shore, and here I made a shift to land. Five minutes
+to rest, and then I made my way towards the fire.
+There was no one there, and I went to the edge of
+the rocks. Here four or five men with ropes were
+standing, trying to secure some of the casks, chests,
+and wreckage from the ship. The surf was full of
+floating objects, but nothing could stand the shock of
+a crash against those rocks. The water was deep
+alongside, and the waves, as they struck, flew up in
+spray, which made standing almost impossible.</p>
+
+<p>The men came round me when they saw me.
+There was no hearing one speak in the noise of the
+storm; so I made signs I had landed behind the point,
+and that if they came with their ropes to the point
+they might get something as it floated past. They
+went off, and I sat down by the fire, wrung my
+clothes as well as I could,&mdash;I thought nothing of the
+wet, for one is wet through half the time in a fishing-boat,&mdash;took
+off mother's belt, and found one of the
+bottles had broke as I got ashore; but luckily it was
+the one which was quite empty. I got the cork out
+of the other, and had a drink of brandy, and then felt
+pretty right again. I had good hopes the boat was
+all right, for she would get round the point easy, and
+Jabez would bring her up under the lee of the island.<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_269" id="Page_269">[Pg 269]</a></span>
+I thought I would go and see if I could help the
+others, and perhaps save someone drifting from the
+wreck; but I did not think there was very much
+chance, for she lay some little distance to the right,
+and I hardly thought a swimmer could keep off the
+shore.</p>
+
+<p>Just as I was going to move I saw two of them
+coming back. They had a body between them, and
+they put it down a little distance from the fire. I
+was on the other side, and they had forgotten all
+about me. They stooped over the figure, and I could
+not see what they were doing. I got up and went
+over, and they gave a start when they saw me. "Is
+he alive?" says I. "Dunno," one of 'em growled;
+and I could see pretty well that if I had not been
+there it would have gone hard with the chap. He
+was a foreign, Jewish-looking fellow, and had around
+him one of the ship's life-buoys. There were lots of
+rings on his fingers, and he had a belt round his
+waist that looked pretty well stuffed out. I put my
+hand to his heart, and found he still breathed; and
+then I poured a few drops of brandy which remained
+in my bottle down his throat.</p>
+
+<p>While I was doing this the two men had talked
+to each other aside. "He's alive, all right," says I.
+"That's a good job," one of 'em said; but I knew
+he didn't think so. "We'll carry him up to our cottage.
+You'll be all the better for a sleep; it must
+be past two o'clock by this time."</p>
+
+<p>They took the chap up, and carried him to the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_270" id="Page_270">[Pg 270]</a></span>
+cottage, and put him on a bed. He was moaning a
+little, and between us we undressed him and got
+him into bed. "I doubt he'll come round," I said.</p>
+
+<p>"I don't believe he will. Will you have a drink
+of whisky?"</p>
+
+<p>I was mighty glad to do so, and then, throwing off
+my wet clothes, I got into the other bed, for there
+were two in the room.</p>
+
+<p>The men said they were going down again to see
+what they could get. They left the whisky bottle
+on the table, and as soon as I was alone I jumped
+out and poured a little into the other chap's teeth,
+so as to give him as good a chance as I could; but I
+didn't much think he'd get round, and then I got
+into bed and shut my eyes. I was just going off,
+when, with a sudden jump, I sat straight up.
+Mother's dream came right across me. I was out of
+bed in a moment, and looked at the door. There
+was no bolt, so I put a couple of chairs against it.
+Then I took my clasp-knife out of my pocket and
+opened it. I gave the other chap a shake, but there
+was no sense in him, and I got into bed again. I
+thought to myself they would never risk a fight when
+they saw me armed and ready. But I soon found
+that I couldn't keep awake; so I got up and dressed
+in my wet clothes, and went to the door. I found it
+was fastened on the outside. I soon opened the
+window and got out, but before I did that I rolled
+up some clothes and put 'em in the bed, and made a
+sort of likeness of a man there. The poor fellow in<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_271" id="Page_271">[Pg 271]</a></span>
+bed was lying very still now, and I felt pretty sure
+that he would not live till morning. The candle was
+a fresh one when they had first lighted it, and I left
+it burning.</p>
+
+<p>When I had got out I shut the window, and went
+away fifty yards or so, where I could hear them
+come back. Presently I heard some footsteps coming
+from the opposite direction. Then I heard a
+voice I knew say, "There is the fire; we shall soon
+know whether the poor lad has got ashore."</p>
+
+<p>"Here am I, Jabez," I said. "Hush!" as he and
+the other were going to break into a shout of welcome,
+"hush! Some wreckers are coming up directly
+to cut my throat and that of another chap in
+that cottage."</p>
+
+<p>In a word or two I told them all about it; and
+they agreed to wait with me and see the end of it.
+Jabez had brought the <i>Jane</i> up under the lee of the
+island, and, leaving two of the men on board, had
+come on shore in the cobble with the other to
+look for me, but with very faint hopes of finding
+me.</p>
+
+<p>"You had best get hold of something to fight
+with, if you mean to take these fellows, Jabez."</p>
+
+<p>"A good lump of rock is as good a weapon as another,"
+Jabez said.</p>
+
+<p>Our plan was soon arranged, and half an hour
+later we heard footsteps coming up from the shore
+again. Two men passed us, went into the cottage,
+and shut the door. Jabez and I made round to the<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_272" id="Page_272">[Pg 272]</a></span>
+window, where we could see in, and John Redpath
+stood at the door. He was to open it and rush in
+when he heard us shout. We stood a little back,
+but we could see well into the room. Presently we
+saw the door open very quietly, little by little. A
+hand came through and moved the chairs, and then
+it opened wide. Then the two men entered. One,
+a big fellow, had a knife in his hand, and drew towards
+the bed, where, as it seemed, I was sleeping,
+with my head covered up by the clothes. The other
+had no knife in his hand, and came towards the other
+bed.</p>
+
+<p>"Get ready, lad," Jabez said to me.</p>
+
+<p>The big fellow raised his knife and plunged it
+down into the figure, throwing his weight onto it at
+the same moment, while the smaller man snatched
+the pillow from under the other's head and clapped
+it over his face, and threw his weight on it. As they
+did so we pushed the casement open and leapt in.
+I seized the smaller man, who was suffocating the
+other chap, and before he could draw his knife I had
+him on the ground and my knee on his chest. The
+big fellow had leapt up. He gave a howl of rage
+as Jabez rushed at him, and stood at bay with his
+knife. Jabez stopped, however, and threw his lump
+of rock, as big as a baby's head, right into his
+stomach. It just tumbled him over like a cannon-shot.
+John burst in through the door, and we had
+'em both tied tightly before five minutes was over.
+Then we lit a big fire in the kitchen, and with warm<span class='pagenum'><a name="Page_273" id="Page_273">[Pg 273]</a></span>
+clothes and some hot whisky and water we got the
+foreign chap pretty well round.</p>
+
+<p>In the morning I went off and found a village on
+the other side of the island. I woke them up and
+told my story, and, to do 'em justice, though there
+were some who would have shielded the fellows we
+had caught, the best part were on our side. Some
+of 'em told me there had been suspicion upon these
+men, and that they bore a bad name. There was no
+magistrate in the island, and no one objected when
+I said we would take them across to Penzance and
+give them in charge there.</p>
+
+<p>So we did; and they were tried and got transportation
+for life for attempting to murder the foreign
+chap, who, it turned out, was a Brazilian Jew, with
+diamonds. He offered us all sorts of presents, but
+we would have none; but that's neither here nor
+there.</p>
+
+<p>So you see, master, mother's dream saved me
+from drowning and from having my throat cut. I
+gave up fishing after that and went into the queen's
+service. Mother sold the boat, and went to live
+with a sister of hers at Truro. The Scilly Islands
+have changed since those times, and you'll meet as
+much kindness there if you're wrecked as you will
+anywhere else; but they were a rough lot in those
+days, and I had a pretty close shave of it, hadn't I?</p>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2>Boys' Own Library.</h2>
+
+<h4>BOUND IN CLOTH.</h4>
+
+
+<p>Large Type, Fine Book Paper. Illustrated. Printed Wrappers.</p>
+
+<p>A selection of the Best Books for Boys, by the most popular Authors.</p>
+
+<p>Handsome Cloth Binding. Covers Stamped in Inks and Gold.</p>
+
+<p>THESE BOOKS ARE ALL COPYRIGHTED.</p>
+
+<h4>Price, 75 Cents Each, Postpaid.</h4>
+
+
+<p><b>Horatio Alger, Jr.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Adventures of a Telegraph Boy.<br />
+Dean Dunham.<br />
+Erie Train Boy.<br />
+Five Hundred Dollar Check.<br />
+From Canal Boy to President.<br />
+From Farm Boy to Senator.<br />
+Mark Stanton.<br />
+Ned Newton.<br />
+New York Boy.<br />
+Tom Brace.<br />
+Tom Tracy.<br />
+Walter Griffith.<br />
+Young Acrobat.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+
+<p><b>C. B. Ashley.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Gilbert, the Trapper<br />
+</p></div>
+
+
+<p><b>Annie Ashmore.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Smuggler's Cave, The.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+
+<p><b>Capt. Ralph Bonehill.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Neka, the Boy Conjurer.<br />
+Tour of the Zero Club.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+
+<p><b>Walter F. Burns.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+In the Sunk Lands.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+
+<p><b>Frank H. Converse.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Gold of Flat Top Mountain.<br />
+Happy-Go-Lucky Jack.<br />
+Heir to a Million.<br />
+In Search of an Unknown Race.<br />
+In Southern Seas.<br />
+Mystery of a Diamond.<br />
+That Treasure.<br />
+Voyage to the Gold Coast.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+
+<p><b>Harry Collingwood.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Pirate Island.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+
+<p><b>George H. Coomer.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Boys In the Forecastle.<br />
+Old Man of the Mountain.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+
+<p><b>William Dalton.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Tiger Prince.<br />
+War Tiger.<br />
+White Elephant.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+
+<p><b>Edward S. Ellis.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Arthur Helmuth.<br />
+Check Number 2134.<br />
+From Tent to White House.<br />
+Golden Rock.<br />
+Land of Mystery.<br />
+On the Trail of Geronimo.<br />
+Perils of the Jungle.<br />
+White Mustang.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>George Manville Fenn.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Commodore Junk.<br />
+Dingo Boys.<br />
+Golden Magnet.<br />
+Grand Chaco.<br />
+Weathercock.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Ensign Clarke Fitch, U. S. N.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Bound for Annapolis.<br />
+Cliff, the Naval Cadet.<br />
+Cruise of the Training Ship.<br />
+From Port to Port.<br />
+Strange Cruise, A.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>William Murray Graydon.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Butcher of Cawnpore, The.<br />
+Camp In the Snow, The.<br />
+Campaigning with Braddock.<br />
+Cryptogram, The.<br />
+From Lake to Wilderness.<br />
+In Barracks and Wigwam.<br />
+In Fort and Prison.<br />
+Jungles and Traitors.<br />
+Rajah's Fortress, The.<br />
+White King of Africa, The.<br />
+With Boer and Britisher.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Lieut. Frederick Garrison, U. S. A.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Cadet's Honor, A.<br />
+Off for West Point.<br />
+On Guard.<br />
+West Point Treasure, A.<br />
+West Point Rivals, The.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Headon Hill.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Spectre Gold.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Henry Harrison Lewis.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Centerboard Jim.<br />
+Ensign Merrill.<br />
+King of the Island.<br />
+Midshipman Merrill.<br />
+Sword and Pen.<br />
+Valley of Mystery, The.<br />
+Yankee Boys In Japan.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Lieut. Lionel Lounsberry.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Cadet Kit Carey.<br />
+Capt. Carey.<br />
+Kit Carey's Protege.<br />
+Lieut. Carey's Luck.<br />
+Out with Commodore Decatur.<br />
+Randy, the Pilot.<br />
+Tom Truxton's Ocean Trip.<br />
+Tom Truxton's School Days.<br />
+Treasure of the Golden Crater.<br />
+Won at West Point.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Victor St. Clair.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Cast Away in the Jungle.<br />
+Comrades Under Castro.<br />
+For Home and Honor.<br />
+From Switch to Lever.<br />
+Little Snap, the Postboy.<br />
+Zig-Zag, the Boy Conjuror.<br />
+Zip, the Acrobat.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Arthur M. Winfield.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Mark Dale's Stage Venture.<br />
+Young Bank Clerk, The.<br />
+Young Bridge Tender, The.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Matthew White, Jr.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Adventures of a Young Athlete.<br />
+Eric Dane.<br />
+Guy Hammersley.<br />
+My Mysterious Fortune.<br />
+Tour of a Private Car.<br />
+Young Editor, The.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Gayle Winterton.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Young Actor, The.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Ernest A. Young.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Boats, Bats and Bicycles.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2>Splendid Books for Girls.</h2>
+
+<h4>HANDSOMELY BOUND IN CLOTH, ILLUSTRATED.</h4>
+
+<h4>Price, 60 Cents Each, Postpaid.</h4>
+
+
+<p><b>EVELYN RAYMOND'S delightful stories:</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p><b>Breakneck Farm.</b></p>
+
+<p>The trials and triumphs of Faith Merriman and her
+brothers, on an old abandoned country place.</p>
+
+<p><b>Jessica Trent.</b></p>
+
+<p>Her Adventures on a Ranch.</p>
+
+<p><b>Jessica, the Heiress.</b></p>
+
+<p>This is Evelyn Raymond's new book, just published.
+A Charming Story.</p></div>
+
+
+<p><b>KATE TANNATT WOODS:</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p><b>A Fair Maid of Marblehead.</b></p>
+
+<p>A book to please both young and old.</p></div>
+
+<h4>THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY, New York.</h4>
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2>BOYS' OWN LIBRARY&mdash;Continued</h2>
+
+<h4>Bound in Cloth. Price, 75 Cents Each, Postpaid.</h4>
+
+
+<p><b>Brooks McCormick.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Giant Islanders, The.<br />
+How He Won.<br />
+Nature's Young Noblemen.<br />
+Rival Battalions.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Walter Morris.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Bob Porter at Lakeview Academy.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Stanley Norris.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Phil, the Showman.<br />
+Young Showman's Rivals, The.<br />
+Young Showman's Pluck, The.<br />
+Young Showman's Triumph, The.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Lieut. James K. Orton.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Beach Boy Joe.<br />
+Last Chance Mine.<br />
+Secret Chart, The.<br />
+Tom Havens with the White Squadron.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>James Otis.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Chased Through Norway.<br />
+Inland Waterways.<br />
+Reuben Green's Adventures at Yale.<br />
+Unprovoked Mutiny, An.<br />
+Wheeling for Fortune.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Gilbert Patten.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Boy Boomers.<br />
+Boy Cattle King.<br />
+Boy from the West.<br />
+Don Kirk's Mine.<br />
+Jud and Joe.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>St. George Rathborne.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Canoe and Camp Fire.<br />
+Chums of the Prairie.<br />
+Gulf Cruisers, The.<br />
+Paddling Under Palmettos.<br />
+Rival Canoe Boys.<br />
+Shifting Winds.<br />
+Sunset Ranch.<br />
+Young Range Riders.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Arthur Sewell.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Gay Dashleigh's Academy Days.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Capt. David Southwick.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Jack Wheeler.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Burt L. Standish.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Frank Merriwell's Bravery.<br />
+Frank Merriwell Down South.<br />
+Frank Merriwell's School Days.<br />
+Frank Merriwell's Chums.<br />
+Frank Merriwell's Foes.<br />
+Frank Merriwell's Trip West.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2>The New "Henty" Series.</h2>
+
+
+<p>With large INLAID PANEL IN THREE COLORS
+on each book. The Illustrations are reproductions of paintings
+representing scenes in the Stories. The elegant cover
+design is done in Inks and Gold, on a fine quality of Cloth.
+These books are all by G. A. Henty. Illustrated. Printed
+Wrappers.</p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>AMONG MALAY PIRATES. A Story of Adventure and Peril.<br />
+BONNIE PRINCE CHARLIE. A Tale of Fontenoy and Culloden.<br />
+BOY KNIGHT, THE. A Tale of the Crusades.<br />
+BRAVEST OF THE BRAVE, THE. With Peterborough in Spain.<br />
+BY ENGLAND'S AID; or, The Freeing of the Netherlands (1585-1604).<br />
+BY PIKE AND DYKE. A Tale of the Rise of the Dutch Republic.<br />
+BY RIGHT OF CONQUEST; or, With Cortez in Mexico.<br />
+BY SHEER PLUCK. A Tale of the Ashanti War.<br />
+CAPTAIN BAYLEY'S HEIR. A Tale of the Gold Fields of California.<br />
+CAT OF BUBASTES, THE. A Story of Ancient Egypt.<br />
+CORNET OF HORSE, THE. A Tale of Marlborough's Wars.<br />
+DRAGON AND THE RAVEN; or, The Days of King Alfred.<br />
+FACING DEATH. A Tale of the Coal Mines.<br />
+FINAL RECKONING, A. A Tale of Bush Life in Australia.<br />
+FOR NAME AND FAME; or, Through Afghan Passes.<br />
+FOR THE TEMPLE. A Tale of the Fall of Jerusalem.<br />
+FRIENDS, THOUGH DIVIDED. A Tale of the Civil War in England.<br />
+GOLDEN CANON, THE. A Tale of Gold Hunting in Mexico.<br />
+IN FREEDOM'S CAUSE. A Story of Wallace and Bruce.<br />
+IN THE REIGN OF TERROR. Adventures of a Westminster Boy.<br />
+IN TIMES OF PERIL. A Tale of India.<br />
+JACK ARCHER. A Tale of the Crimea.<br />
+LION OF ST. MARK, THE. A Story of Venice in the 14th Century.<br />
+LION OF THE NORTH, THE. A Tale of Gustavus Adolphus and Wars of Religion.<br />
+LOST HEIR, THE. A Tale of Kidnapping in India.<br />
+MAORI AND SETTLER. A Story of the New Zealand War.<br />
+ONE OF THE 28TH. A Tale of Waterloo.<br />
+ORANGE AND GREEN. A Tale of the Boyne and Limerick.<br />
+OUT ON THE PAMPAS. A Tale of South America.<br />
+ST. GEORGE FOR ENGLAND. A Tale of Cressy and Poitiers.<br />
+STURDY AND STRONG; or, How George Andrews Made his Way.<br />
+THROUGH THE FRAY. A Story of the Luddite Riots.<br />
+TRUE TO THE OLD FLAG. A Tale of the American War of Independence.<br />
+UNDER DRAKE'S FLAG. A Tale of the Spanish Main.<br />
+WITH CLIVE IN INDIA; or, The Beginnings of an Empire.<br />
+WITH LEE IN VIRGINIA. A Story of the American Civil War.<br />
+WITH WOLFE IN CANADA; or, The Winning of a Continent.<br />
+YOUNG BUGLERS, THE. A Tale of the Peninsular War.<br />
+YOUNG CARTHAGINIAN, THE. A Story of the Times of Hannibal.<br />
+YOUNG COLONISTS, THE. A Story of War in South Africa.<br />
+YOUNG FRANC-TIREURS. A Tale of the Franco-Prussian War.<br />
+YOUNG MIDSHIPMAN, THE. A Tale of the Siege of Alexandria.</p></div>
+
+<h4><i>Any of the above books will be sent postpaid,
+upon receipt of price, 50 cents.</i></h4>
+
+<h4>THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY, New York.</h4>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2>Boys' Popular Library.</h2>
+
+<h4>BOUND IN CLOTH.</h4>
+
+
+<p>An excellent series of books for boys by such popular
+authors as Optic, Kingston and other well-known writers.</p>
+
+<p>These books are Bound in Cloth, with very attractive
+cover designs stamped in colors. The are all well printed
+from large type, on good paper. Printed wrappers.</p>
+
+<h4>Price, 50 Cents Each, Postpaid.</h4>
+
+<p><b>Walter Aimwell.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Jerry.<br />
+Whistler.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Horatio Alger, Jr.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Brave and Bold.<br />
+Only an Irish Boy.<br />
+Paul, the Peddler.<br />
+Phil, the Fiddler.<br />
+Slow and Sure.<br />
+Strive and Succeed.<br />
+Strong and Steady.<br />
+Tom, the Bootblack.<br />
+Try and Trust.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Z. R. Bennett.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Young Vagabond, A.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Daniel Defoe.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Robinson Crusoe.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>John De Morgan.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Always on Duty.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Richard Dowling.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Catmur's Cave.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>George Manville Fenn.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+In the Wilds of New Mexico.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Blanche Willis Howard.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Battle and a Boy, A.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>W. H. G. Kingston.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Dick Cheveley.<br />
+From Powder Monkey to Admiral.<br />
+Hendricks, the Hunter.<br />
+Mark Seaworth's Voyage on the Indian Ocean.<br />
+Peter Trawl.<br />
+Peter, the Whaler.<br />
+Shore and Ocean.<br />
+The Midshipman, Marmaduke Merry.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Leon Lewis.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Diamond Seekers of Brazil.<br />
+Kit Carson's Last Trail.<br />
+Silver Ship, The.<br />
+Young Castaways, The.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Montleau &amp; Wyse.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Swiss Family Robinson.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Alfred Oldfellow.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Joe Nichols.<br />
+Uncle Nat.<br />
+Way to Success.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Oliver Optic</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+All Aboard (Sequel to "Boat Club").<br />
+Boat Club, The.<br />
+Little by Little.<br />
+Now or Never.<br />
+Try Again.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Capt. Mayne Reid.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Boy Tar, The.<br />
+Cliff Climber, The.<br />
+Lone Ranch, The.<br />
+Ran Away to Sea.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Gordon Stables.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Cruise of the Snowbird.<br />
+Life at Sea.<br />
+Wild Adventures 'Round the Pole.<br />
+Young Explorer, The.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Jefferys Taylor.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Boy Crusoes, The.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>A Wolvertonian.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Three Years at Wolverton.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Ernest A. Young.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Toss Up for Luck.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<h4>THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY, New York.</h4>
+
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<h2>Girls' Popular Library.</h2>
+
+<h4>ELEGANTLY BOUND IN CLOTH.</h4>
+
+
+<p>LARGE TYPE. GOOD PAPER. Printed Wrappers.
+Very attractive cover design stamped in colors. Just the
+books that girls delight to read&mdash;and can read with profit
+as well as pleasure. Note the list of Authors&mdash;all well-known
+writers of the best books for girls.</p>
+
+<h4>Price, 50 Cents Each, Postpaid.</h4>
+
+<p><b>Walter Aimwell.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Ella.<br />
+Jessie.<br />
+Marcus.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Mary D. Brine.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Echoes from Story Land.<br />
+Stories Grandma Told.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Alice Carey.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Clovernook Children.<br />
+Clovernook Tales. Vol. I.<br />
+Clovernook Tales. Vol. II.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Rosa Nouchette Carey.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Averil.<br />
+Our Bessie.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Cousin Virginia.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Cricket's Friends, The.<br />
+Dolls' Club, The.<br />
+3 Vols. in 1.<br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">Jo's Doll.</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">Katy's Christmas.</span><br />
+<span style="margin-left: 1em;">Patty's Pranks.</span><br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Lewis Carroll.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Alice's Adventures In Wonderland.<br />
+Through the Looking-Glass.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Maria S. Cummins.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Lamplighter, The.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Mary A. Denison.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Barbara's Triumphs.<br />
+Frenchman's Ward, The.<br />
+Guardian's Trust, The.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Maria Edgeworth.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Simple Susan.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Juliana Horatia Ewing.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Flat-Iron for a Farthing, A.<br />
+Great Emergency, A.<br />
+Jackanapes.<br />
+Jan of the Windmill.<br />
+Six to Sixteen.<br />
+We and the World.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Julia Goddard.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Fairy Tales In Other Lands.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<p><b>Virginia F. Townsend.</b></p>
+
+<div class="blockquot"><p>
+Amy Deane.<br />
+While it Was Morning.<br />
+</p></div>
+
+<h4>THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY. New York.</h4>
+
+
+<hr style="width: 65%;" />
+<p><b>TRANSCRIBER'S NOTE:</b> All apparent printer's errors retained.</p>
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+<pre>
+
+
+
+
+
+End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of Sturdy and Strong, by G. A. Henty
+
+*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK STURDY AND STRONG ***
+
+***** This file should be named 33939-h.htm or 33939-h.zip *****
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+ http://www.gutenberg.org/3/3/9/3/33939/
+
+Produced by David Edwards and the Online Distributed
+Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This file was
+produced from images generously made available by The
+Internet Archive)
+
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+http://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need, are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
+http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at http://pglaf.org
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit http://pglaf.org
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
+To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ http://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
+
+</pre>
+
+</body>
+</html>
diff --git a/33939-h/images/cover.jpg b/33939-h/images/cover.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..309e0a8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/33939-h/images/cover.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/33939-h/images/frontis.jpg b/33939-h/images/frontis.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..72b53dd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/33939-h/images/frontis.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/33939.txt b/33939.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..07c9bf3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/33939.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,8474 @@
+The Project Gutenberg EBook of Sturdy and Strong, by G. A. Henty
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+Title: Sturdy and Strong
+ How George Andrews Made His Way
+
+Author: G. A. Henty
+
+Release Date: October 7, 2010 [EBook #33939]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ASCII
+
+*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK STURDY AND STRONG ***
+
+
+
+
+Produced by David Edwards and the Online Distributed
+Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This file was
+produced from images generously made available by The
+Internet Archive)
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ STURDY AND STRONG
+
+ G. A. HENTY
+
+
+ [Illustration: "SURLY JOE SAT WITH A CHILD ON EITHER SIDE,
+ TELLING THEM SEA STORIES."--_Frontispiece._
+ _Sturdy and Strong._]
+
+
+
+ STURDY AND STRONG
+ OR
+ _How George Andrews Made His Way_
+
+ BY
+ G. A. HENTY
+
+ AUTHOR OF "THE YOUNG CARTHAGINIAN," "WITH CLIVE IN INDIA,"
+ "IN FREEDOM'S CAUSE," "THE LION OF THE NORTH," "FACING DEATH,"
+ ETC., ETC., ETC.
+
+
+ NEW YORK
+ THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY
+ PUBLISHERS
+
+
+
+
+PREFACE.
+
+
+Whatever may be said as to distinction of classes in England, it is
+certain that in no country in the world is the upward path more open
+to those who brace themselves to climb it than in our own. The
+proportion of those who remain absolutely stationary is comparatively
+small. We are all living on a hillside, and we must either go up or
+down. It is easier to descend than to ascend; but he who fixes his
+eyes upwards, nerves himself for the climb, and determines with all
+his might and power to win his way towards the top, is sure to find
+himself at the end of his day at a far higher level than when he
+started upon his journey. It may be said, and sometimes foolishly is
+said, that luck is everything; but in nineteen cases out of twenty
+what is called luck is simply a combination of opportunity, and of the
+readiness and quickness to turn that opportunity to advantage. The
+voyager must take every advantage of wind, tide, and current, if he
+would make a favorable journey; and for success in life it is
+necessary not only to be earnest, steadfast, and true, but to have the
+faculty of turning every opportunity to the best advantage; just as a
+climber utilizes every tuft of grass, every little shrub, every
+projecting rock, as a hold for his hands or feet. George Andrews had
+what may be called luck--that is, he had opportunities and took
+advantage of them, and his rise in life was consequently far more
+rapid than if he had let them pass without grasping them; but in any
+case his steadiness, perseverance, and determination to get on would
+assuredly have made their way in the long run. If similar qualities
+and similar determinations are yours, you need not despair of similar
+success in life.
+
+ G. A. HENTY.
+
+
+
+
+CONTENTS.
+
+
+ STURDY AND STRONG: PAGE
+ I. ALONE, 1
+ II. TWO FRIENDS, 25
+ III. WORK, 48
+ IV. HOME, 74
+ V. AN ADVENTURE, 97
+ VI. FIRE! 117
+ VII. SAVED! 142
+ DO YOUR DUTY, 165
+ SURLY JOE, 231
+ A FISH-WIFE'S DREAM, 257
+
+
+
+
+STURDY AND STRONG.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I.
+
+ALONE.
+
+
+"You heard what he said, George?"
+
+"Oh, mother, mother!"
+
+"Don't sob so, my boy; he is right. I have seen it coming a long time,
+and, hard as it seems, it will be better. There is no disgrace in it.
+I have tried my best, and if my health had not broken down we might
+have managed, but you see it was not to be. I shall not mind it, dear;
+it is really only for your sake that I care about it at all."
+
+The boy had ceased sobbing, and sat now with a white set face.
+
+"Mother, it will break my heart to think that I cannot keep you from
+this. If we could only have managed for a year or two I could have
+earned more then; but to think of you--you in the workhouse!"
+
+"In a workhouse infirmary, my boy," his mother said gently. "You see it
+is not as if it were from any fault of ours. We have done our best. You
+and I have managed for two years; but what with my health and my eyes
+breaking down we can do so no longer. I hope it will not be for long,
+dear. You see I shall have rest and quiet, and I hope I shall soon be
+able to be out again."
+
+"Not soon, mother. The doctor said you ought not to use your eyes for
+months."
+
+"Even months pass quickly, George, when one has hope. I have felt this
+coming so long that I shall be easier and happier now it has come. After
+all, what is a workhouse infirmary but a hospital, and it would not seem
+so very dreadful to you my going into a hospital; the difference is only
+in name; both are, after all, charities, but the one is kept up out of
+subscriptions, the other from the rates."
+
+His mother's words conveyed but little comfort to George Andrews. He had
+just come in from his work, and had heard what the parish doctor had
+told his mother.
+
+"I can do nothing for you here, Mrs. Andrews. You must have rest and
+quiet for your eyes, and not only that, but you must have strengthening
+food. It is no use my blinking the truth. It is painful for you, I know.
+I can well understand that; but I see no other way. If you refuse to go
+I won't answer for your life."
+
+"I will go, doctor," she had answered quietly. "I know that it will be
+best. It will be a blow to my boy, but I see no other way."
+
+"If you don't want your boy to be alone in the world, ma'am, you will do
+as I advise you. I will go round in the morning and get you the order of
+admission, and as I shall be driving out that way I will, if you like,
+take you myself."
+
+"Thank you, doctor; you are very good. Yes, I will be ready in the
+morning, and I thank you for your offer."
+
+"Very well, then, that's settled," the doctor said briskly. "At ten
+o'clock I will be here."
+
+Although a little rough in manner, Dr. Jeffries was a kind-hearted and
+humane man.
+
+"Poor woman," he said to himself as he went downstairs, "it is hard for
+her. It is easy to see that she is a lady, and a thorough lady too; but
+what can I do for her! I might get her a little temporary help, but that
+would be of no use--she is completely broken down with anxiety and
+insufficient food, and unless her eyes have a long holiday she will lose
+her sight. No, there's nothing else for it, but it is hard."
+
+It was hard. Mrs. Andrews was, as the doctor said, a lady. She had lost
+both her parents while she was at school. She had no near relations, and
+as she was sixteen when her mother died she had remained at school
+finishing her education and teaching the younger children. Then she had
+obtained a situation as governess in a gentleman's family, and two years
+afterwards had married a young barrister who was a frequent visitor at
+the house.
+
+Mr. Andrews was looked upon as a rising man, and for the first seven or
+eight years of her marriage his wife's life had been a very happy one.
+Then her husband was prostrated by a fever which he caught in one of the
+midland towns while on circuit, and although he partially recovered he
+was never himself again. His power of work seemed to be lost; a languor
+which he could not overcome took possession of him. A troublesome cough
+ere long attacked him, and two years later Mrs. Andrews was a widow, and
+her boy, then nine years old, an orphan.
+
+During the last two years of his life Mr. Andrews had earned but
+little in his profession. The comfortable house which he occupied had
+been given up, and they had removed to one much smaller. But in spite
+of this, debts mounted up, and when, after his death, the remaining
+furniture was sold and everything settled, there remained only about
+two hundred pounds. Mrs. Andrews tried to get some pupils among her
+late husband's friends, but during the last two years she had lost
+sight of many of these, and now met with but poor success among the
+others. She was a quiet and retiring woman, and shrank from continuous
+solicitations, and at the end of three years she found her little
+store exhausted.
+
+Hitherto she had kept George at school, but could no longer do so,
+and, giving up her lodging in Brompton, went down to Croydon, where
+someone had told her that they thought she would have a better chance
+of obtaining pupils, but the cards which some of the tradesmen allowed
+her to put in the window led to no result, and finding this to be the
+case she applied at one of the milliner's for work. This she obtained,
+and for a year supported herself and her boy by needlework.
+
+From the time when George left school she had gone on teaching him his
+lessons; but on the day when he was thirteen years old he declared
+that he would no longer submit to his mother working for both of them,
+and, setting out, called at shop after shop inquiring if they wanted
+an errand-boy. He succeeded at last in getting a place at a grocer's
+where he was to receive three shillings a week and his meals, going
+home to sleep at night in the closet-like little attic adjoining the
+one room which his mother could now afford.
+
+For a while they were more comfortable than they had been for some
+time; now that his mother had no longer George to feed, her earnings
+and the three shillings he brought home every Saturday night enabled
+them to live in comparative ease, and on Sunday something like a feast
+was always prepared. But six months later Mrs. Andrews felt her
+eyesight failing, the lids became inflamed, and a dull aching pain
+settled in the eyeballs. Soon she could only work for a short time
+together, her earnings became smaller and smaller, and her employers
+presently told her that she kept the work so long in hand that they
+could no longer employ her. There was now only George's three
+shillings a week to rely upon, and this was swallowed up by the rent.
+In despair she had applied to the parish doctor about her eyes. For a
+fortnight he attended her, and at the end of that time had
+peremptorily given the order of which she had told her son.
+
+To her it was a relief; she had seen that it must come. Piece by piece
+every article of clothing she possessed, save those she wore, had been
+pawned for food, and every resource was now exhausted. She was worn
+out with the struggle, and the certainty of rest and food overcame her
+repugnance to the house. For George's sake too, much as she knew he
+would feel her having to accept such a refuge, she was glad that the
+struggle was at an end. The lad had for the last six months suffered
+greatly for her sake. Every meal to which he sat down at his
+employer's seemed to choke him as he contrasted it with the fare to
+which she was reduced, although, as far as possible, she had concealed
+from him how sore was her strait.
+
+George cried himself to sleep that night, and he could scarce speak
+when he said good-by to his mother in the morning, for he could not
+tell when he should see her again.
+
+"You will stop where you are, my boy, will you not?"
+
+"I cannot promise, mother. I don't know yet what I shall do; but
+please don't ask me to promise anything. You must let me do what I
+think best. I have got to make a home for you when you are cured. I am
+fourteen now, and am as strong as most boys of my age. I ought to be
+able to earn a shilling a day somehow, and with seven shillings a
+week, mother, and you just working a little, you know, so as not to
+hurt your eyes, we ought to be able to do. Don't you bother about me,
+mother. I want to try anyhow what I can do till you come out. When you
+do, then I will do whatever you tell me; that's fair, isn't it?"
+
+Mrs. Andrews would have remonstrated, but he said:
+
+"Well, mother, you see at the worst I can get a year's character from
+Dutton, so that if I can't get anything else to do I can get the same
+sort of place again, and as I am a year older than I was when he took
+me, and can tie up parcels neatly now, I ought to get a little more
+anyhow. You see I shall be safe enough, and though I have never
+grumbled, you know, mother--have I?--I think I would rather do
+anything than be a grocer's boy. I would rather, when I grow up, be a
+bricklayer's laborer, or a plowman, or do any what I call man's work,
+than be pottering about behind a counter, with a white apron on,
+weighing out sugar and currants."
+
+"I can't blame you, George," Mrs. Andrews said with a sigh. "It's
+natural, my boy. If I get my eyesight and my health again, when you
+grow up to be a man we will lay by a little money, and you and I will
+go out together to one of the colonies. It will be easier to rise
+again there than here, and with hard work both of us might surely hope
+to get on. There must be plenty of villages in Australia and Canada
+where I could do well with teaching, and you could get work in
+whatever way you may be inclined to. So, my boy, let us set that
+before us. It will be something to hope for and work for, and will
+cheer us to go through whatever may betide us up to that time."
+
+"Yes, mother," George said. "It will be comfort indeed to have
+something to look forward to. Nothing can comfort me much to-day; but
+if anything could it would be some such plan as that."
+
+The last words he said to his mother as, blinded with tears, he kissed
+her before starting to work, were:
+
+"I shall think of our plan every day, and look forward to that more
+than anything else in the world--next to your coming to me again."
+
+At ten o'clock Dr. Jeffries drove up to Mrs. Andrews' humble lodging
+in a brougham instead of his ordinary gig, having borrowed the
+carriage from one of the few of his patients who kept such a vehicle,
+on purpose to take Mrs. Andrews, for she was so weak and worn that he
+was sure she would not be able to sit upright in a gig for the three
+miles that had to be traversed. He managed in the course of his rounds
+to pass the workhouse again in the afternoon, and brought George,
+before he left work, a line written in pencil on a leaf torn from his
+pocketbook:
+
+ "My darling, I am very comfortable. Everything is clean and
+ nice, and the doctor and people kind. Do not fret about
+ me.--Your loving mother."
+
+Although George's expressed resolution of leaving his present
+situation, and seeking to earn his living in some other way, caused
+Mrs. Andrews much anxiety, she had not sought strongly to dissuade him
+from it. No doubt it would be wiser for him to stay in his present
+situation, where he was well treated and well fed, and it certainly
+seemed improbable to her that he would be able to get a better living
+elsewhere. Still she could not blame him for wishing at least to try.
+She herself shared to some extent his prejudice against the work in
+which he was employed. There is no disgrace in honest work; but she
+felt that she would rather see him engaged in hard manual labor than
+as a shop boy. At any rate, as he said, if he failed he could come
+back again to Croydon, and, with a year's character from his present
+employer, would probably be able to obtain a situation similar to that
+which he now held. She was somewhat comforted, too, by a few words
+the doctor had said to her during their drive.
+
+"I think you are fortunate in your son, Mrs. Andrews. He seems to me a
+fine steady boy. If I can, in any way, do him a good turn while you
+are away from him, I will."
+
+George remained for another month in his situation, for he knew that
+it would never do to start on his undertaking penniless. At the end of
+that time, having saved up ten shillings, and having given notice to
+his employer, he left the shop for the last time, and started to walk
+to London. It was not until he began to enter the crowded streets that
+he felt the full magnitude of his undertaking. To be alone in London,
+a solitary atom in the busy mass of humanity, is a trying situation
+even for a man; to a boy of fourteen it is terrible. Buying a penny
+roll, George sat down to eat it in one of the niches of a bridge over
+the river, and then kneeling up watched the barges and steamers
+passing below him.
+
+Had it not been for his mother, his first thought, like that of most
+English boys thrown on the world, would have been to go to sea; but
+this idea he had from the first steadily set aside as out of the
+question. His plan was to obtain employment as a boy in some
+manufacturing work, for he thought that there, by steadiness and
+perseverance, he might make his way.
+
+On one thing he was resolved. He would make his money last as long as
+possible. Three penny-worth of bread a day would, he calculated, be
+sufficient for his wants. As to sleeping, he thought he might manage
+to sleep anywhere; it was summer time and the nights were warm. He had
+no idea what the price of a bed would be, or how to set about getting
+a lodging. He did not care how roughly he lived so that he could but
+make his money last. The first few days he determined to look about
+him. Something might turn up. If it did not he would set about getting
+a place in earnest. He had crossed Waterloo Bridge, and, keeping
+straight on, found himself in Covent Garden, where he was astonished
+and delighted at the quantities of fruit, vegetables, and flowers.
+
+Although he twice set out in different directions to explore the
+streets, he each time returned to Covent Garden. There were many lads
+of his own age playing about there, and he thought that from them he
+might get some hints as to how to set about earning a living. They
+looked ragged and poor enough, but they might be able to tell him
+something--about sleeping, for instance. For although before starting
+the idea of sleeping anywhere had seemed natural enough, it looked
+more formidable now that he was face to face with it.
+
+Going to a cook-shop in a street off the market he bought two slices
+of plum-pudding. He rather grudged the twopence which he paid; but he
+felt that it might be well laid out. Provided with the pudding he
+returned to the market, sat himself down on an empty basket, and began
+to eat slowly and leisurely.
+
+In a short time he noticed a lad of about his own age watching him
+greedily.
+
+He was far from being a respectable-looking boy. His clothes were
+ragged, and his toes could be seen through a hole in his boot. He wore
+neither hat nor cap, and his hair looked as if it had not been combed
+since the day of his birth. There was a sharp, pinched look on his
+face. But had he been washed and combed and decently clad he would not
+have been a bad-looking boy. At any rate George liked his face better
+than most he had seen in the market, and he longed for a talk with
+someone. So he held out his other slice of pudding, and said:
+
+"Have a bit?"
+
+"Oh, yes!" the boy replied "Walker, eh?"
+
+"No, I mean it, really. Will you have a bit?"
+
+"No larks?" asked the boy.
+
+"No; no larks. Here you are."
+
+Feeling assured now that no trick was intended the boy approached,
+took without a word the pudding which George held out, and, seating
+himself on a basket close to him, took a great bite.
+
+"Where do you live?" George asked, when the slice of pudding had half
+disappeared.
+
+"Anywheres," the boy replied, waving his hand round.
+
+"I mean, where do you sleep?"
+
+The boy nodded, to intimate that his sleeping-place was included in
+the general description of his domicile.
+
+"And no one interferes with you?" George inquired.
+
+"The beaks, they moves you on when they ketches you; but ef yer get
+under a cart or in among the baskets you generally dodges 'em."
+
+"And suppose you want to pay for a place to sleep, where do you go and
+how much do you pay?"
+
+"Tuppence," the boy said; "or if yer want a first-rate, fourpence.
+Does yer want to find a crib?" he asked doubtfully, examining his
+companion.
+
+"Well, yes," George said. "I want to find some quiet place where I can
+sleep, cheap, you know."
+
+"Out of work?" the boy inquired.
+
+"Yes. I haven't got anything to do at present. I am looking for a
+place, you know."
+
+"Don't know no one about?"
+
+"No; I have just come in from Croydon."
+
+The boy shook his head.
+
+"Don't know nothing as would suit," he said. "Why, yer'd get them
+clothes and any money yet had walked off with the wery fust night."
+
+"I should not get a room to myself, I suppose, even for fourpence?"
+George asked, making a rapid calculation that this would come to two
+and fourpence per week, as much as his mother had paid for a
+comparatively comfortable room in Croydon.
+
+The boy opened his eyes in astonishment at his companion requiring a
+room for himself.
+
+"Lor' bless yer, yer'd have a score of them with yer!"
+
+"I don't care about a bed," George said. "Just some place to sleep in.
+Just some straw in any quiet corner."
+
+This seemed more reasonable to the boy, and he thought the matter
+over.
+
+"Well," he said at last, "I knows of a place where they puts up the
+hosses of the market carts. I knows a hostler there. Sometimes when
+it's wery cold he lets me sleep up in the loft. Aint it warm and
+comfortable just! I helps him with the hosses sometimes, and that's
+why. I will ax him if yer likes."
+
+George assented at once. His ideas as to the possibility of sleeping
+in the open air had vanished when he saw the surroundings, and a bed
+in a quiet loft seemed to him vastly better than sleeping in a room
+with twenty others.
+
+"How do you live?" he asked the lad, "and what's your name?"
+
+"They calls me the Shadder," the boy said rather proudly; "but my real
+name's Bill."
+
+"Why do they call you the Shadow?" George asked.
+
+"'Cause the bobbies finds it so hard to lay hands on me," Bill
+replied.
+
+"But what do they want to lay hands on you for?" George asked.
+
+"Why, for bagging things, in course," Bill replied calmly.
+
+"Bagging things? Do you mean stealing?" George said, greatly shocked.
+
+"Well, not regular prigging," the Shadow replied; "not wipes, yer
+know, nor tickers, nor them kind of things. I aint never prigged
+nothing of that kind."
+
+"Well, what is it then you do--prig?" George asked, mystified.
+
+"Apples or cabbages, or a bunch of radishes, onions sometimes, or
+'taters. That aint regular prigging, you know."
+
+"Well, it seems to me the same sort of thing," George said, after a
+pause.
+
+"I tell yer it aint the same sort of thing at all," the Shadow said
+angrily. "Everyone as aint a fool knows that taters aint wipes, and no
+one can't say as a apple and a ticker are the same."
+
+"No, not the same," George agreed; "but you see one is just as much
+stealing as the other."
+
+"No, it aint," the boy reasserted. "One is the same as money and
+t'other aint. I am hungry and I nips a apple off a stall. No one aint
+the worse for it. You don't suppose as they misses a apple here? Why,
+there's wagon-loads of 'em, and lots of 'em is rotten. Well, it aint
+no more if I takes one than if it was rotten. Is it now?"
+
+George thought there was a difference, but he did not feel equal to
+explaining it.
+
+"The policemen must think differently," he said at last, "else they
+wouldn't be always trying to catch you."
+
+"Who cares for the bobbies?" Bill said contemptuously. "I don't; and I
+don't want no more jaw with you about it. If yer don't likes it, yer
+leaves it. I didn't ask for yer company, did I? So now then."
+
+George had really taken a fancy to the boy, and moreover he saw that
+in the event of a quarrel his chance of finding a refuge for the night
+was small. In his sense of utter loneliness in the great city he was
+loath to break with the only acquaintance he had made.
+
+"I didn't mean to offend you, Bill," he said; "only I was sorry to
+hear you say you took things. It seems to me you might get into
+trouble; and it would be better after all to work for a living."
+
+"What sort of work?" Bill said derisively. "Who's agoing to give me
+work? Does yer think I have only got to walk into a shop and ask for
+'ployment? They wouldn't want to know nothing about my character, I
+suppose? nor where I had worked before? nor where my feyther lived?
+nor nothing? Oh, no, of course not! It's blooming easy to get work
+about here; only got to ax for it, that's all. Good wages and all
+found, that's your kind."
+
+"I don't suppose it's easy," George said; "but it seems to me people
+could get something to do if they tried."
+
+"Tried!" the boy said bitterly. "Do yer think we don't try! Why, we
+are always trying to earn a copper or two. Why, we begins at three
+o'clock in the morning when the market-carts come in, and we goes on
+till they comes out of that there theater at night, just trying to
+pick up a copper. Sometimes one does and sometimes one doesn't. It's a
+good day, I tell you, when we have made a tanner by the end of it.
+Don't tell me! And now as to this ere stable; yer means it?"
+
+"Yes," George said; "certainly I mean it."
+
+"Wery well then, you be here at this corner at nine o'clock. I will go
+before that and square it with Ned. That's the chap I was speaking
+of."
+
+"I had better give you something to give him," George said. "Will a
+shilling do?"
+
+"Yes, a bob will do for three or four nights. Are you going to trust
+me with it?"
+
+"Of course I am," George replied. "I am sure you wouldn't be so mean
+as to do me out of it; besides, you told me that you never stole money
+and those sort of things."
+
+"It aint everyone as would trust me with a bob for all that," Bill
+replied; "and yer are running a risk, yer know, and I tells yer if yer
+goes on with that sort of game yer'll get took in rarely afore yer've
+done. Well, hand it over. I aint a-going to bilk yer."
+
+The Shadow spoke carelessly, but this proof of confidence on the part
+of his companion really touched him, and as he went off he said to
+himself, "He aint a bad sort, that chap, though he is so precious
+green. I must look arter him a bit and see he don't get into no
+mischief."
+
+George, on his part, as he walked away down into the Strand again,
+felt that he had certainly run a risk in thus intrusting a tenth of
+his capital to his new acquaintance; but the boy's face and manner had
+attracted him, and he felt that, although the Shadow's notions of
+right and wrong might be of a confused nature, he meant to act
+straight toward him.
+
+George passed the intervening hours before the time named for his
+meeting in Covent Garden in staring into the shop windows in the
+Strand, and in wondering at the constant stream of vehicles and foot
+passengers flowing steadily out westward. He was nearly knocked under
+the wheels of the vehicles a score of times from his ignorance as to
+the rule of the road, and at last he was so confused by the jostling
+and pushing that he was glad to turn down a side street and to sit
+down for a time on a doorstep.
+
+When nine o'clock approached he went into a baker's shop and bought a
+loaf, which would, he thought, do for supper and breakfast for himself
+and his companion. Having further invested threepence in cheese, he
+made his way up to the market.
+
+The Shadow was standing at the corner whistling loudly.
+
+"Oh, here yer be! That's all right; come along. I have squared Ned,
+and it's all right."
+
+He led the way down two or three streets and then stopped at a
+gateway.
+
+"You stop here," he said, "and I will see as there aint no one but Ned
+about."
+
+He returned in a minute.
+
+"It's all clear! Ned, he's a-rubbing down a hoss; he won't take no
+notice of yer as yer pass. He don't want to see yer, yer know, 'cause
+in case anyone comed and found yer up there he could swear he never
+saw yer go in, and didn't know nothing about yer. I will go with yer
+to the door, and then yer will see a ladder in the corner; if yer whip
+up that yer'll find it all right up there."
+
+"But you are coming too, aint you?" George asked.
+
+"Oh, no, I aint a-coming. Yer don't want a chap like me up there. I
+might pick yer pocket, yer know; besides I aint your sort."
+
+"Oh, nonsense!" George said. "I should like to have you with me, Bill;
+I should really. Besides, what's the difference between us? We have
+both got to work for ourselves and make our way in the world."
+
+"There's a lot of difference. Yer don't talk the way as I do; yer have
+been brought up different. Don't tell me."
+
+"I may have been brought up differently, Bill. I have been fortunate
+there; but now, you see, I have got to get my living in the best way I
+can, and if I have had a better education than you have, you know ever
+so much more about London and how to get your living than I do, so
+that makes us quits."
+
+"Oh, wery well," Bill said; "it's all the same to this child. So if
+yer aint too proud, here goes."
+
+He led the way down a stable yard, past several doors, showing the
+empty stalls which would be all filled when the market carts arrived.
+At the last door on the right he stopped. George looked in. At the
+further end a man was rubbing down a horse by the faint light of a
+lantern, the rest of the stable was in darkness.
+
+"This way," Bill whispered.
+
+Keeping close behind him, George entered the stable. The boy stopped
+in the corner.
+
+"Here's the ladder. I will go up fust and give yer a hand when yer
+gets to the top."
+
+George stood quiet until his companion had mounted, and then ascended
+the ladder, which was fixed against the wall. Presently a voice
+whispered in his ear:
+
+"Give us your hand. Mind how yer puts your foot."
+
+In a minute he was standing in the loft. His companion drew him along
+in the darkness, and in a few steps arrived at a pile of hay.
+
+"There yer are," Bill said in a low voice; "yer 'ave only to make
+yourself comfortable there. Now mind you don't fall down one of the
+holes into the mangers."
+
+"I wish we had a little light," George said, as he ensconced himself
+in the hay.
+
+"I will give you some light in a minute," Bill said, as he left his
+side, and directly afterwards a door opened and the light of a
+gaslight in the yard streamed in.
+
+"That's where they pitches the hay in," Bill said as he rejoined him.
+"I shuts it up afore I goes to sleep, 'cause the master he comes out
+sometimes when the carts comes in, and there would be a blooming row
+if he saw it open; but we are all right now."
+
+"That's much nicer," George said. "Now here's a loaf I brought with
+me. We will cut it in half and put by a half for the morning, and eat
+the other half between us now, and I have got some cheese here too."
+
+"That's tiptop!" the boy said. "Yer're a good sort, I could see that,
+and I am pretty empty, I am, for I aint had nothing except that bit
+of duff yer gave me since morning, and I only had a crust then. 'Cept
+for running against you I aint been lucky to-day. Couldn't get a job
+nohows, and it aint for want of trying neither."
+
+For some minutes the boys ate in silence. George had given much the
+largest portion to his companion, for he himself was too dead tired to
+be very hungry. When he had finished, he said:
+
+"Look here, Bill; we will talk in the morning. I am so dead beat I can
+scarcely keep my eyes open, so I will just say my prayers and go off
+to sleep."
+
+"Say your prayers!" Bill said in astonishment. "Do yer mean to say as
+yer says prayers!"
+
+"Of course I do," George replied; "don't you?"
+
+"Never said one in my life," Bill said decidedly; "don't know how,
+don't see as it would do no good ef I did."
+
+"It would do good, Bill," George said. "I hope some day you will think
+differently, and I will teach you some you will like."
+
+"I don't want to know none," Bill said positively. "A missionary chap,
+he came and prayed with an old woman I lodged with once. I could not
+make head nor tail of it, and she died just the same, so you see what
+good did it do her?"
+
+But George was too tired to enter upon a theological argument. He was
+already half asleep, and Bill's voice sounded a long way off.
+
+"Good-night," he muttered; "I will talk to you in the morning," and in
+another minute he was fast asleep.
+
+Bill took an armful of hay and shook it lightly over his companion;
+then he closed the door of the loft and threw himself on the hay, and
+was soon also sound asleep. When George woke in the morning the
+daylight was streaming in through the cracks of the door. His
+companion was gone. He heard the voices of several men in the yard,
+while a steady champing noise and an occasional shout or the sound of
+a scraping on the stones told him the stalls below were all full now.
+
+George felt that he had better remain where he was. Bill had told him
+the evening before that the horses and carts generally set out again
+at about nine o'clock, and he thought he had better wait till they had
+gone before he slipped down below. Closing his eyes he was very soon
+off to sleep again. When he woke, Bill was sitting by his side looking
+at him.
+
+"Well, you are a oner to sleep," the boy said. "Why, it's nigh ten
+o'clock, and it's time for us to be moving. Ned will be going off in a
+few minutes, and the stables will be locked up till the evening."
+
+"Is there time to eat our bread and cheese?" George asked.
+
+"No, we had better eat it when we get down to the market; come
+along."
+
+George at once rose, shook the hay off his clothes, and descended the
+ladder, Bill leading the way. There was no one in the stable, and the
+yard was also empty. On reaching the market they sat down on two empty
+baskets, and at once began to eat their bread and cheese.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II.
+
+TWO FRIENDS.
+
+
+"I did wake before, Bill," George said after he had eaten a few
+mouthfuls; "but you were out."
+
+"Yes, I turned out as soon as the carts began to come in," Bill said,
+"and a wery good morning I have had. One old chap gave me twopence for
+looking arter his hoss and cart while he went into the market with his
+flowers. But the best move was just now. A chap as was driving off
+with flowers, one of them swell West-end shops, I expect, by the look
+of the trap, let his rug fall. He didn't see it till I ran after him
+with it, then he gave me a tanner; that was something like. Have yer
+finished yer bread and cheese?"
+
+"Yes," George said, "and I could manage a drink of water if I could
+get one."
+
+"There's a fountain handy," Bill said; "but you come along with me, I
+am agoing to stand two cups of coffee if yer aint too proud to take
+it;" and he looked doubtfully at his companion.
+
+"I am not at all too proud," George said, for he saw that the
+slightest hesitation would hurt his companion's feelings.
+
+"It aint fust-rate coffee," Bill said, as with a brightened look on
+his face he turned and led the way to a little coffee-stall; "but it's
+hot and sweet, and yer can't expect more nor that for a penny."
+
+George found the coffee really better than he had expected, and Bill
+was evidently very much gratified at his expression of approval.
+
+"Now," he said, when they had both finished, "for a draw of 'baccy,"
+and he produced a short clay pipe. "Don't yer smoke?"
+
+"No, I haven't begun yet."
+
+"Ah! ye don't know what a comfort a pipe is," Bill said. "Why, when
+yer are cold and hungry and down on your luck a pipe is a wonderful
+thing, and so cheap; why, a ounce of 'baccy will fill yer thirty pipes
+if yer don't squeeze it in too hard. Well, an ounce of 'baccy costs
+threepence halfpenny, so, as I makes out, yer gets eight pipes for a
+penny; and now," he went on when he had filled and lit his pipe,
+"let's know what's yer game."
+
+"You mean what am I going to do?" George asked.
+
+Bill nodded.
+
+"I want to get employment in some sort of works. I have been an
+errand-boy in a grocer's for more than a year, and I have got a
+written character from my master in my pocket; but I don't like the
+sort of thing; I would rather work with my own hands. There are plenty
+of works where they employ boys, and you know one might get on as one
+gets older. The first thing is to find out whereabouts works of that
+sort are."
+
+"There are lots of works at the East End, I have heard tell," Bill
+said; "and then there's Clerkenwell and King's Cross, they aint so far
+off, and there are works there, all sorts of works, I should say; but
+I don't know nuffin' about that sort of work. The only work as I have
+done is holding hosses and carrying plants into the market, and
+sometimes when I have done pretty well I goes down and lays out what I
+got in _Echoes_, or _Globes_, or _Evening Standards_; that pays yer,
+that does, for if yer can sell them all yer will get a bob for eight
+penn'orth of papers, that gives yer fourpence for an hour's work, and
+I calls that blooming good, and can't yer get a tuck-out for a bob!
+Oh, no, I should think not! Well, what shall it be? I knows the way
+out to Whitechapel and to Clerkenwell, so whichever yer likes I can
+show yer."
+
+"If Clerkenwell's the nearest we may as well try that first," George
+said, "and I shall be much obliged to you for showing the way."
+
+The two boys spent the whole day in going from workshop to workshop
+for employment; but the answers to his application were unvarying:
+either he was too young or there was no place vacant. George took the
+disappointment quietly, for he had made up his mind that he would have
+difficulty in getting a place; but Bill became quite angry on behalf
+of his companion.
+
+"This is worse nor the market," he said. "A chap can pick up a few
+coppers there, and here we have been a-tramping about all day and aint
+done nothing."
+
+Day after day George set out on his quest, but all was without
+success. He and Bill still slept in the loft, and after the first day
+he took to getting up at the same time as his companion, and going out
+with him to try and pick up a few pence from the men with the
+market-carts. Every other morning they were able to lie later, as
+there were only regular marketdays three mornings a week.
+
+On market mornings he found that he earned more than Bill, his better
+clothes giving him an advantage, as the men were more willing to trust
+their carts and rugs to the care of a quiet, respectable-looking boy
+than to that of the arabs who frequented the Garden. But all that was
+earned was laid out in common between the two boys, and George found
+himself seldom obliged to draw above a few pence on his private stock.
+He had by this time told the Shadow exactly how much money he had, and
+the boy, seeing the difficulty that George found in getting work, was
+most averse to the store being trenched upon, and always gave his vote
+against the smallest addition to their ordinary fare of bread and
+cheese being purchased, except from their earnings of the day. This
+George felt was the more creditable on Bill's part, inasmuch as the
+latter had, in deference to his prejudices, abstained from the petty
+thefts of fruit with which before he had seasoned his dry crusts.
+
+George had learned now what Bill knew of his history, which was little
+enough. He supposed he had had a father, but he knew nothing of him;
+whether he had died, or whether he had cut away and left mother, Bill
+had no idea. His mother he remembered well, though she had died when
+he was, as he said, a little chap. He spoke of her always in a hushed
+voice, and in a tone of reverence, as a superior being.
+
+"We was poor, you know," he said to George, "and I know mother was
+often short of grub, but she was just kind. I don't never remember her
+whacking me; always spoke soft and low like; she was good, she was.
+She used to pray, you know, and what I remember most is as the night
+afore she was took away to a hospital she says, 'Try and live honest,
+Bill; it will be hard, but try, my boy. Don't you take to stealing,
+however poor you may be;' and I aint," Bill said earnestly over and
+over again. "When I has seed any chap going along with a ticker handy,
+which I could have boned and got away among the carts as safe as
+ninepence, or when I has seed a woman with her purse a-sticking out of
+them outside pockets, and I aint had a penny to bless myself with, and
+perhaps nothing to eat all day, I have felt it hard not to make a
+grab; but I just thought of what she said, and I aint done it. As I
+told yer, I have often nabbed things off the stalls or out of the
+baskets or carts. It didn't seem to me as that was stealing, but as
+you says it is, I aint going to do so no more. Now look yer here,
+George; they tells me as the parsons says as when people die and they
+are good they goes up there, yer know."
+
+George nodded, for there was a question in his companion's tone.
+
+"Then, of course," Bill went on, "she is up there. Now it aint likely
+as ever I should see her again, 'cause, you know, there aint nothing
+good about me; but if she was to come my way, wherever I might be, and
+was to say to me, 'Bill, have you been a-stealing?' do yer think she
+would feel very bad about them 'ere apples and things?"
+
+"No, Bill, I am sure she would not. You see you didn't quite know that
+was stealing, and you kept from stealing the things that you thought
+she spoke of, and now that you see it is wrong taking even little
+things you are not going to take them any more."
+
+"That I won't, so help me bob!" the boy said; "not if I never gets
+another apple between my teeth."
+
+"That's right, Bill. You see you ought to do it, not only to please
+your mother, but to please God. That's what my mother has told me over
+and over again."
+
+"Has she now?" Bill said with great interest, "and did you use to prig
+apples and sichlike sometimes?"
+
+"No," George said, "not that sort of thing; but she was talking of
+things in general. Of doing things that were wrong, such as telling
+lies and deceiving, and that sort of thing."
+
+"And your mother thinks as God knows all about it?"
+
+George nodded.
+
+"And that he don't like it, eh, when things is done bad?"
+
+George nodded again.
+
+"Lor', what a time he must have of it!" Bill said in solemn wonder.
+"Why, I heard a woman say last week as six children was enough to
+worrit anyone into the grave; and just to think of all of us!" and
+Bill waved his arm in a comprehensive way and repeated, "What a time
+he must have of it!"
+
+For a time the boys sat silent in their loft, Bill wondering over the
+problem that had presented itself to him, and George trying to find
+some appropriate explanation in reply to the difficulty Bill had
+started. At last he said:
+
+"I am afraid, Bill, that I can't explain all this to you, for I am not
+accustomed to talk about such things. My mother talks to me sometimes,
+and of course I went to church regularly; but that's different from my
+talking about it; but you know what we have got to do is to try and
+please God, and love him because he loves us."
+
+"That's whear it is," Bill said; "that's what I've heard fellows say
+beats 'em. If he loves a chap like me how is it he don't do something
+for him? why don't he get you a place, for instance? You aint been
+a-prigging apples or a-putting him out. That's what I wants to know."
+
+"Yes, Bill, but as I have heard my mother say, it would be very hard
+to understand if this world were the only one; but you see we are only
+here a little time, and after that there's on and on and on, right up
+without any end, and what does it matter if we are poor or unhappy in
+this little time if we are going to be ever so happy afterwards? This
+is only a sort of little trial to see how we behave, as it were, and
+if we do the best we can, even though that best is very little, then
+you see we get a tremendous reward. For instance, you would not think
+a man was unkind who kept you five minutes holding his horse on a cold
+day, if he were going to give you enough to get you clothes and good
+lodging for the rest of your life."
+
+"No, I should think not," Bill said fervently; "so it's like that, is
+it?"
+
+George nodded. "Like that, only more."
+
+"My eye!" Bill murmured to himself, lost in astonishment at this new
+view of things.
+
+After that there were few evenings when, before they nestled
+themselves down in the hay, the boys did not talk on this subject. At
+first George felt awkward and nervous in speaking of it, for like the
+generality of English boys, however earnest their convictions may be,
+he was shy of speaking what he felt; but his companion's eagerness to
+know more of this, to him, new story encouraged him to speak, and
+having in his bundle a small Bible which his mother had given him, he
+took to reading to Bill a chapter or two in the mornings when they had
+not to go out to the early market.
+
+It is true that Bill's questions frequently puzzled him. The boy saw
+things in a light so wholly different from that in which he himself
+had been accustomed to regard them that he found a great difficulty in
+replying to them.
+
+George wrote a letter to his mother, telling her exactly what he was
+doing, for he knew that if he only said that he had not yet succeeded
+in getting work she would be very anxious about him, and although he
+had nothing satisfactory to tell her, at least he could tell her that
+he had sufficient to eat and as much comfort as he cared for. Twice he
+received replies from her, directed to him at a little coffee-house,
+which, when they had had luck, the boys occasionally patronized. As
+time went on without his succeeding in obtaining employment George's
+hopes fell, and at last he said to his mate; "I will try for another
+fortnight, Bill, and if at the end of that time I don't get anything
+to do I shall go back to Croydon again."
+
+"But yer can earn yer living here!" Bill remonstrated.
+
+"I can earn enough to prevent me from starving, but that is all,
+Bill. I came up to London in hopes of getting something to do by which
+I might some day make my way up; if I were to stop here like this I
+should be going down, and a nice sight I should be to mother if, when
+she gets well enough to come out of the infirmary, I were to go back
+all in rags."
+
+"What sort of a place is Croydon?" Bill asked. "Is there any chance of
+picking up a living there? 'cause I tells yer fair, if yer goes off I
+goes with yer. I aint a-thinking of living with yer, George; but we
+might see each other sometime, mightn't we? Yer wouldn't mind that?"
+
+"Mind it! certainly not, Bill! You have been a good friend to me, and
+I should be sorry to think of you all alone here."
+
+"Oh, blow being a good friend to yer!" Bill replied. "I aint done
+nothing except put yer in the way of getting a sleeping-place, and as
+it's given me one too I have had the best of that job. It's been good
+of yer to take up with a chap like me as don't know how to read or
+write or nothing, and as aint no good anyway. But you will let me go
+with yer to Croydon, won't yer?"
+
+"Certainly I will, Bill; but you won't be able to see much of me. I
+shall have to get a place like the last. The man I was with said he
+would take me back again if I wanted to come, and you know I am all
+day in the shop or going out with parcels, and of course you would
+have to be busy too at something."
+
+"What sort of thing do yer think, George? I can hold a hoss, but that
+aint much for a living. One may go for days without getting a chance."
+
+"I should say, Bill, that your best chance would be to try and get
+work either in a brickfield or with a market-gardener. At any rate we
+should be able to get a talk for half an hour in the evening. I was
+always done at nine o'clock, and if we were both in work we could take
+a room together."
+
+Bill shook his head.
+
+"That would be wery nice, but I couldn't have it, George. I knows as I
+aint fit company for yer, and if yer was with a shop-keeping bloke he
+would think yer was going to run off with the money if he knew yer
+kept company with a chap like me. No, the 'greement must be as yer
+goes yer ways and I goes mine; but I hopes as yer will find suffin to
+do up here, not 'cause as I wouldn't like to go down to this place of
+yourn, but because yer have set yer heart on getting work here."
+
+A week later the two boys were out late in Covent Garden trying to
+earn a few pence by fetching up cabs and carriages for people coming
+out from a concert in the floral hall. George had just succeeded in
+earning threepence, and had returned to the entrance to the hall, and
+was watching the people come out, and trying to get another job.
+Presently a gentleman, with a girl of some nine or ten years old, came
+out and took their place on the footpath.
+
+"Can I call you a carriage, sir?" George asked.
+
+"No, thank you, lad, a man has gone for it."
+
+George fell back and stood watching the girl, who was in a white
+dress, with a little hood trimmed with swansdown over her head.
+
+Presently his eye fell on something on which the light glittered as it
+hung from her neck. Just as he was looking a hand reached over her
+shoulder, there was a jerk, and a sudden cry from the child, then a
+boy dived into the crowd, and at the same moment George dashed after
+him. There was a cry of "Stop, thief!" and several hands made a grab
+at George as he dived through the crowd; but he slipped through them
+and was soon in the roadway.
+
+Some twenty yards ahead of him he saw the boy running. He turned up
+Bow Street and then dashed down an alley. He did not know that he was
+followed until suddenly George sprang upon his back, and the two fell
+with a crash, the young thief undermost. George seized his right hand,
+and kneeling upon him, twisted it behind his back and forced him to
+open his fingers, the boy, taken by surprise, and not knowing who was
+his assailant, making but slight resistance.
+
+George seized the gold locket and dashed back at full speed into the
+market, and was soon in the thick of the crowd round the entrance. The
+gentleman was standing talking to a policeman, who was taking a note
+of the description of the lost trinket. The girl was standing by
+crying.
+
+"Here is your locket," George said, putting it into her hand. "I saw
+the boy take it, and have got it from him."
+
+"Oh, papa! papa!" the girl cried. "Here is my locket again."
+
+"Why, where did you get it from?" her father asked in astonishment.
+
+"This boy has just given it to me," she replied. "He says he took it
+from the boy who stole it."
+
+"Which boy, Nellie? Which is the boy who brought it back?"
+
+The girl looked round, but George was gone.
+
+"Why didn't you stop him, my dear?" her father said. "Of course I
+should wish to thank and reward him, for the locket was a very
+valuable one, and the more so to us from its having belonged to your
+mother. Did you notice the boy, policeman?"
+
+"No, sir, I did not see him at all."
+
+"Was he a poor boy, Nellie?"
+
+"Not a very, very poor boy, father," the girl replied. "At least I
+don't think so; but I only looked at his face. He didn't speak like a
+poor boy at all."
+
+"Would you know him again?"
+
+"Oh, yes, I am sure I should. He was a good-looking boy with a nice
+face."
+
+"Well, I am very sorry he has gone away, my dear. Evidently he does
+not want a reward, but at any rate I should have liked to thank him.
+Are you always on this beat, policeman?"
+
+"I am on night duty, sir, while the concerts are on."
+
+"At any rate, I dare say you know the constables who are about here in
+the daytime. I wish you would mention the fact to them, and ask them
+if they get any clew to the boy who has rendered me this service, to
+let me know. Here is a card with my name and address."
+
+After restoring the locket George made his way to the entrance to the
+stables, where he generally met Bill after the theater had closed and
+there was no farther chance of earning money. It was not till half an
+hour later that the boy came running up.
+
+"I have got eightpence," he said. "That is something like luck. I got
+three jobs. One stood me fourpence, the other two gave me tuppence
+each. What do yer say? Shall we have a cup of coffee afore we turns
+in?"
+
+"I think we had better not, Bill. I have got sixpence. We will put
+that by, with the sixpence we saved the other day, for the hostler. We
+haven't given him anything for some time. Your eightpence will get us
+a good breakfast in the morning."
+
+When they had comfortably nestled themselves in the hay George told
+his companion how he had rescued and restored the locket.
+
+"And he didn't give yer nuffin! I never heerd tell of such a scaly
+trick as that. I should ha' said it ought to have been good for a bob
+anyway."
+
+"I did not wait to see, Bill. Directly I had given the little girl her
+locket I bolted."
+
+"Well, that were soft. Why couldn't yer have waited to have seen what
+the bloke meant to give yer?"
+
+"I did not want to be paid for such a thing as that," George replied.
+"I don't mind being paid when I have done a job for anyone; but this
+was different altogether."
+
+Bill meditated for a minute or two.
+
+"I can't see no difference, nohow," he said at last. "Yer did him a
+good turn, and got the thing back. I dare say it were worth five bob."
+
+"A good deal more than that, Bill."
+
+"More nor that! Well, then, he ought to have come down handsome.
+Didn't yer run like winking, and didn't yer jump on the chap's back
+and knock him down, and didn't yer run back again? And warn't there a
+chance, ef one of the bobbies had got hold of yer collar and found it
+in yer hand, of yer being had up for stealing it? And then yer walks
+off and don't give him a chance of giving yer nuffin. My eye, but yer
+are a flat!"
+
+"I don't suppose you will quite understand, Bill. But when people do a
+thing to oblige somebody, and not as a piece of regular work, they
+don't expect to be paid. I shouldn't have liked it if they had offered
+me money for such a thing."
+
+"Well, ef yer says so, no doubt it's right," Bill rejoined; "but it
+seems a rum sort of notion to me. When people loses things they
+expects to pay to get 'em back. Why, don't yer see outside the p'lice
+station, and in the shop winders, papers offering so much for giving
+back things as is lost. I can't read 'em myself, yer know; but chaps
+have read 'em to me. Why, I've heerd of as much as five quid being
+offered for watches and sichlike as was lost by ladies coming out of
+theayters, and I have often thought what a turn of luck it would be to
+light on one of 'em. And now yer says as I oughtn't to take the money
+ef I found it."
+
+"No, I don't say that, Bill. If you found a thing and saw a reward
+offered, and you wanted the money, you would have good right to take
+it. But, you see, in this case I saw how sorry the girl was at losing
+her locket, and I went after it to please her, and I was quite content
+that I got it back for her."
+
+Bill tried again to think the matter over in his mind, but he was
+getting warm and sleepy, and in a few minutes was sound off.
+
+Two or three days later the lads had, to their great satisfaction,
+obtained a job. Walnuts were just coming in, and the boys were engaged
+to take off the green shucks. Bill was particularly pleased, for he
+had never before been taken on for such a job, and he considered it a
+sort of promotion. Five or six women were also employed, and as the
+group were standing round some great baskets Bill suddenly nudged his
+friend:
+
+"I say, my eye, aint that little gal pretty?"
+
+George looked up from his work and at once recognized the girl to whom
+he had restored the locket. Her eye fell on him at the same moment.
+
+"There, papa!" she exclaimed. "I told you if you brought me down to
+the market I felt sure I should know the boy again if I saw him.
+That's him, the one looking down into the basket. But he knew me
+again, for I saw him look surprised when he noticed me."
+
+The gentleman made his way through the women to George.
+
+"My lad, are you the boy who restored the locket to my daughter three
+evenings ago?"
+
+"Yes, sir," George said, coloring as he looked up. "I was standing
+close by when the boy took it, so I gave chase and brought it back,
+and that's all."
+
+"You were off again in such a hurry that we hadn't time to thank you.
+Just come across to my daughter. I suppose you can leave your work for
+a minute?"
+
+"Yes, sir. We are working by the job," George said, and looking rather
+shamefaced he followed the gentleman to the sidewalk.
+
+"This is your boy, as you call him, Nellie."
+
+"I was sure I should know him again," the child said, "though I only
+saw him for a moment. We are very much obliged to you, boy, papa and
+me, because it had been mamma's locket, and we should have been very
+sorry to have lost it."
+
+"I am glad I was able to get it back for you," George said; "but I
+don't want to be thanked for doing it; and I don't want to be paid
+either, thank you, sir," he said, flushing as the gentleman put his
+hand into his pocket.
+
+"No! and why not?" the gentleman said in surprise. "You have done me a
+great service, and there is no reason why I should not pay you for it.
+If I had lost it I would gladly have paid a reward to get it back."
+
+"Thank you, sir," George said quietly; "but all the same I would
+rather not be paid for a little thing like that."
+
+"You are a strange fellow," the gentleman said again. "One does not
+expect to find a boy in the market here refusing money when he has
+earned it."
+
+"I should not refuse it if I had earned it," George said; "but I don't
+call getting back a locket for a young lady who has lost it earning
+money."
+
+"How do you live, lad? You don't speak like a boy who has been brought
+up in the market here."
+
+"I have only been here three months," George said. "I came up to
+London to look for work, but could not get any. Most days I go about
+looking for it, and do what odd jobs I can get when there's a chance."
+
+"What sort of work do you want? Have you been accustomed to any work?
+Perhaps I could help you."
+
+"I have been a year as an errand-boy," George answered; "but I didn't
+like it, and I thought I would rather get some sort of work that I
+could work at when I got to be a man instead of sticking in a shop."
+
+"Did you run away from home, then?" the gentleman asked.
+
+"No, sir. My mother was ill and went into an infirmary, and so as I
+was alone I thought I would come to London and try to get the sort of
+work I liked; but I have tried almost all over London."
+
+"And are you all alone here?"
+
+"No, sir, not quite alone. I found a friend in that boy there, and we
+have worked together since I came up."
+
+"Well, lad, if you really want work I can give it you."
+
+"Oh, thank you, sir!" George exclaimed fervently.
+
+"And your friend too, if he likes. I have some works down at Limehouse
+and employ a good many boys. Here is the address;" and he took a card
+from his pocket, wrote a few words on the back of it, and handed it to
+George.
+
+"Ask for the foreman, and give him that, and he will arrange for you
+to begin work on Monday. Come along, Nellie; we have got to buy the
+fruit for to-morrow, you know."
+
+So saying he took his daughter's hand, and George, wild with delight,
+ran off to tell Bill that he had obtained work for them both.
+
+"Well, Nellie, are you satisfied?"
+
+"Yes, I am glad you could give him work, papa; didn't he look pleased?
+Wasn't it funny his saying he wouldn't have any money?"
+
+"Yes; I hardly expected to have met with a refusal in Covent Garden;
+but you were right, child, and you are a better judge of character
+than I gave you credit for. You said he was a nice-looking lad, and
+spoke like a gentleman, and he does. He is really a very good style of
+boy. Of course he is shabby and dirty now, and you see he has been an
+errand-boy at a grocer's; but he must have been better brought up than
+the generality of such lads. The one he called his friend looked a
+wild sort of specimen, altogether a different sort of boy. I should
+say he was one of the regular arabs hanging about this place. If so, I
+expect a very few days' work will sicken him; but I shouldn't be
+surprised if your boy, as you call him, sticks to it."
+
+The next morning the two boys presented themselves at Mr. Penrose's
+works at Limehouse. These were sawing and planing works, and the sound
+of many wheels, and the hoarse rasping sound of saws innumerable, came
+out through the open windows of the building as they entered the yard.
+
+"Now what do you boys want?" a workman said as he appeared at one of
+the doors.
+
+"We want to see the foreman," George said. "I have a card for him from
+Mr. Penrose."
+
+"I will let him know," the man replied.
+
+Two minutes later the foreman came out, and George handed him the
+card. He read what Mr. Penrose had written upon it and said:
+
+"Very well, you can come in on Monday; pay, eight shillings a week;
+seven o'clock; there, that will do. Oh, what are your names?" taking
+out a pocket-book. "George Andrews and William Smith;" and then, with
+a nod, he went back into his room, while the boys, almost bewildered
+at the rapidity with which the business had been arranged, went out
+into the street again.
+
+"There we are, Bill, employed," George said in delight.
+
+"Yes, there we is," Bill agreed, but in a more doubtful tone; "it's a
+rum start, aint it? I don't expect I shall make much hand of it, but I
+am wery glad for you, George."
+
+"Why shouldn't you make much hand of it? You are as strong as I am."
+
+"Yes; but then, you see, I aint been accustomed to work regular, and I
+expect I shan't like it--not at first; but I am going to try. George,
+don't yer think as I aint agoing to try. I aint that sort; still I
+expects I shall get the sack afore long."
+
+"Nonsense, Bill! you will like it when you once get accustomed to it,
+and it's a thousand times better having to draw your pay regularly at
+the end of the week than to get up in the morning not knowing whether
+you are going to have breakfast or not. Won't mother be pleased when I
+write and tell her I have got a place! Last time she wrote she said
+that she was a great deal better, and the doctor thought she would be
+out in the spring, and then I hope she will be coming up here, and
+that will be jolly."
+
+"Yes, that's just it," Bill said; "that's whear it is; you and I will
+get on fust-rate, but it aint likely as your mother would put up with
+a chap like me."
+
+"My mother knows that you have been a good friend to me, Bill, and
+that will be quite enough for her. You wait till you see her."
+
+"My eye, what a lot of little houses there is about here!" Bill said,
+"just all the same pattern; and how wide the streets is to what they
+is up Drury Lane!"
+
+"Yes, we ought to have no difficulty in getting a room here, Bill, now
+that we shall have money to pay for it; only think, we shall have
+sixteen shillings a week between us!"
+
+"It's a lot of money," Bill said vaguely. "Sixteen bob! My eye, there
+aint no saying what it will buy! I wish I looked a little bit more
+respectable," he said, with a new feeling as to the deficiencies of
+his attire. "It didn't matter in the Garden; but to go to work with a
+lot of other chaps, these togs aint what you may call spicy."
+
+"They certainly are not, Bill," George said with a laugh. "We must see
+what we can manage."
+
+George's own clothes were worn and old, but they looked respectable
+indeed by the side of those of his companion. Bill's elbows were both
+out, the jacket was torn and ragged, he had no waistcoat, and his
+trousers were far too large for him, and were kept up by a single
+brace, and were patched in a dozen places.
+
+When George first met him he was shoeless, but soon after they had set
+up housekeeping together George had bought from a cobbler's stall a
+pair of boots for two shillings, and these, although now almost
+falling to pieces, were still the best part of Bill's outfit.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III.
+
+WORK.
+
+
+The next morning George went out with the bundle containing his Sunday
+clothes, which had been untouched since his arrival in town, and going
+to an old-clothes shop he exchanged them for a suit of working clothes
+in fair condition, and then returning hid his bundle in the hay and
+rejoined Bill, who had from early morning been at work shelling
+walnuts. Although Bill was somewhat surprised at his companion not
+beginning work at the usual time he asked no questions, for his faith
+in George was so unbounded that everything he did was right in his
+eyes.
+
+"There is our last day's work in the market, Bill," George said as
+they reached their loft that evening.
+
+"It's your last day's work, George, I aint no doubt; but I expects it
+aint mine by a long way. I have been a-thinking over this 'ere go, and
+I don't think as it will act nohow. In the first place I aint fit to
+go to such a place, and they are sure to make it hot for me."
+
+"That's nonsense, Bill; there are lots of roughish sort of boys in
+works of that sort, and you will soon be at home with the rest."
+
+"In the next place," Bill went on, unheeding the interruption, "I
+shall be getting into some blooming row or other afore I have been
+there a week, and they will like enough turn you out as well as me.
+That's what I am a-thinking most on, George. If they chucks me the
+chances are as they chucks you too; and if they did that arter all the
+pains you have had to get a place I should go straight off and make a
+hole in the water. That's how I looks at it."
+
+"But I don't think, Bill, that there's any chance of your getting into
+a row. Of course at first we must both expect to be blown up
+sometimes, but if we do our best and don't answer back again we shall
+do as well as the others."
+
+"Oh, I shouldn't cheek 'em back," Bill said. "I am pretty well used to
+getting blown up. Every one's always at it, and I know well enough as
+it don't pay to cheek back, not unless you have got a market-cart
+between you and a clear road for a bolt. I wasn't born yesterday.
+Yer've been wery good to me, you have, George, and before any harm
+should come to yer through me, s'help me, I'd chuck myself under a
+market-wagon."
+
+"I know you would, Bill; but, whatever you say, you have been a far
+greater help to me than I have to you. Anyhow we are not going to part
+now. You are coming to work with me to start with, and I know you will
+do your best to keep your place. If you fail, well, so much the worse,
+it can't be helped; but after our being sent there by Mr. Penrose I
+feel quite sure that the foreman would not turn me off even if he had
+to get rid of you."
+
+"D'yer think so?"
+
+"I do, indeed, Bill."
+
+"Will yer take yer davey?"
+
+"Yes, if it's any satisfaction to you, Bill, I will take my davey that
+I do not think that they would turn me off even if they sent you
+away."
+
+"And yer really wants me to go with yer, so help yer?"
+
+"Really and truly, Bill."
+
+"Wery well, George, then I goes; but mind yer, it's 'cause yer wishes
+me."
+
+So saying, Bill curled himself up in the hay, and George soon heard by
+his regular breathing that he was sound asleep.
+
+The next morning, before anyone was stirring, they went down into the
+yard, as was their custom on Sunday mornings, for a good wash,
+stripping to the waist and taking it by turns to pump over each other.
+Bill had at first protested against the fashion, saying as he did very
+well and did not see no use in it; but seeing that George really
+enjoyed it he followed his example. After a morning or two, indeed,
+and with the aid of a piece of soap which George had bought, Bill got
+himself so bright and shiny as to excite much sarcastic comment and
+remark from his former companions, which led to more than one
+pugilistic encounter.
+
+That morning George remained behind in the loft for a minute or two
+after Bill had run down, attired only in his trousers. When Bill went
+up the ladder after his ablutions he began hunting about in the hay.
+
+"What are you up to, Bill?"
+
+"Blest if I can find my shirt. Here's two of yourn knocking about, but
+I can't see where's mine, nor my jacket neither."
+
+"It's no use your looking, Bill, for you won't find them, and even if
+you found them you couldn't put 'em on. I have torn them up."
+
+"Torn up my jacket!" Bill exclaimed in consternation. "What lark are
+yer up to now, George?"
+
+"No lark at all. We are going together to work to-morrow, and you
+could not go as you were; so you put on that shirt and those things,"
+and he threw over the clothes he had procured the day before.
+
+Bill looked in astonishment.
+
+"Why, where did yer get 'em, George? I knows yer only had four bob
+with what we got yesterday. Yer didn't find 'em, and yer didn't--no,
+in course yer didn't--nip 'em."
+
+"No, I didn't steal them certainly," George said, laughing. "I swapped
+my Sunday clothes for them yesterday. I can do without them very well
+till we earn enough to get another suit. There, don't say anything
+about it, Bill, else I will punch your head."
+
+Bill stared at him with open eyes for a minute, and then threw
+himself down in the hay and burst into tears.
+
+"Oh, I say, don't do that!" George exclaimed. "What have you to cry
+about?"
+
+"Aint it enough to make a cove cry," Bill sobbed, "to find a chap
+doing things for him like that? I wish I may die if I don't feel as if
+I should bust. It's too much, that's what it is, and it's all on one
+side; that's the wust of it."
+
+"I dare say you will make it even some time, Bill; so don't let's say
+anything more about it, but put on your clothes. We will have a cup of
+coffee each and a loaf between us for breakfast, and then we will go
+for a walk into the park, the same as we did last Sunday, and hear the
+preaching."
+
+The next morning they were up at their accustomed hour and arrived at
+the works at Limehouse before the doors were opened. Presently some
+men and boys arrived, the doors were opened, and the two boys followed
+the others in.
+
+"Hallo! who are you?" the man at the gate asked.
+
+George gave their names, and the man looked at his time-book.
+
+"Yes, it's all right; you are the new boys. You are to go into that
+planing-shop," and he pointed to one of the doors opening into the
+yard.
+
+The boys were not long before they were at work. Bill was ordered to
+take planks from a large pile and to hand them to a man, who passed
+them under one of the planing-machines. George was told to take them
+away as fast as they were finished and pile them against a wall. When
+the machines stopped for any adjustment or alteration both were to
+sweep up the shavings and ram them into bags, in which they were
+carried to the engine-house.
+
+For a time the boys were almost dazzled by the whirl of the machinery,
+the rapid motion of the numerous wheels and shafting overhead, and of
+the broad bands which carried the power from them to the machinery on
+the floor, by the storm of shavings which flew from the cutters, and
+the unceasing activity which prevailed around them. Beyond receiving
+an occasional order, shouted in a loud tone--for conversation in an
+ordinary voice would have been inaudible--nothing occurred till the
+bell rang at half-past eight for breakfast. Then the machinery
+suddenly stopped, and a strange hush succeeded the din which had
+prevailed.
+
+"How long have we got now?" George asked the man from whose bench he
+had been taking the planks.
+
+"Half an hour," the man said as he hurried away.
+
+"Well, what do you think of it, Bill?" George asked when they had got
+outside.
+
+"Didn't think as there could be such a row," Bill replied. "Why, talk
+about the Garden! Lor', why it aint nothing to it. I hardly knew what
+I was a-doing at first."
+
+"No more did I, Bill. You must mind what you do and not touch any of
+those straps and wheels and things. I know when I was at Croydon there
+was a man killed in a sawmill there by being caught in the strap; they
+said it drew him up and smashed him against the ceiling. And now we
+had better look out for a baker's."
+
+"I suppose there aint a coffee-stall nowhere handy?"
+
+"I don't suppose there is, Bill; at any rate we have no time to spare
+to look for one. There's a pump in the yard, so we can have a drink of
+water as we come back. Well, the work doesn't seem very hard, Bill,"
+George said as they ate their bread.
+
+"No, it aint hard," Bill admitted, "if it weren't for all them
+rattling wheels. But I expect it aint going to be like that regular.
+They've just gived us an easy job to begin with. Yer'll see it will be
+worse presently."
+
+"We shall soon get accustomed to the noise, Bill, and I don't think we
+shall find the work any harder. They don't put boys at hard work, but
+just jobs like we are doing, to help the men."
+
+"What shall we do about night, George?"
+
+"I think that at dinner-time we had better ask the man we work for. He
+looks a good-natured sort of chap. He may know of someone he could
+recommend us to."
+
+They worked steadily till dinner-time; then as they came out George
+said to the man with whom they were working:
+
+"We want to get a room. We have been lodging together in London, and
+don't know anyone down here. I thought perhaps you could tell us of
+some quiet, respectable people who have a room to let?"
+
+The man looked at George more closely than he had hitherto done.
+
+"Well, there aint many people as would care about taking in two boys,
+but you seem a well-spoken young chap and different to most of 'em. Do
+you think you could keep regular hours, and not come clattering in and
+out fifty times in the evening, and playing tom-fools' tricks of all
+sorts?"
+
+"I don't think we should be troublesome," George said; "and I am quite
+sure we shouldn't be noisy."
+
+"You would want to be cooked for, in course?"
+
+"No, I don't think so," George said. "Beyond hot water for a cup of
+tea in the evening, we should not want much cooking done, especially
+if there is a coffee-stall anywhere where we could get a cup in the
+morning."
+
+"You haven't got any traps, I suppose?"
+
+George looked puzzled.
+
+"I mean bed and chairs, and so on."
+
+George shook his head.
+
+"We might get them afterwards, but we haven't any now."
+
+"Well, I don't mind trying you young fellows. I have got a bedroom in
+my place empty. A brother of mine who lodged and worked with me has
+just got a job as foreman down in the country. At any rate I will try
+you for a week, and if at the end of that time you and my missis don't
+get on together you must shift. Two bob a week. I suppose that will
+about suit you?"
+
+George said that would suit very well, and expressed his thanks to the
+man for taking them in.
+
+They had been walking briskly since they left the works, and now
+stopped suddenly before the door of a house in a row. It was just like
+its neighbor, except that George noticed that the blinds and windows
+were cleaner than the others, and that the door had been newly painted
+and varnished.
+
+"Here we are," the man said. "You had best come in and see the missis
+and the room. Missis!" he shouted, and a woman appeared from the
+backroom. "I have let Harry's room, mother," he said, "and these are
+the new lodgers."
+
+"My stars, John!" she exclaimed; "you don't mean to say that you let
+the room to them two boys. I should have thought you had better sense.
+Why, they will be trampling up and down the stairs like young hosses,
+wear out the oil cloth, and frighten the baby into fits. I never did
+hear such a thing!"
+
+"I think they are quiet boys, Bessie, and won't give much trouble. At
+any rate I have agreed to try them for a week, and if you don't get
+on with them at the end of that time, of course they must go. They
+have only come to work at the shop to-day; they work with me, and as
+far as I can see they are quiet young chaps enough. Come along, lads,
+I will show you your room."
+
+It was halfway up the stairs, at the back of the house, over the
+kitchen, which was built out there. It was a comfortable little room,
+not large, but sufficiently so for two boys. There was a bed, a chest
+of drawers, two chairs, and a dressing-table, and a strip of carpet
+ran alongside the bed, and there was, moreover, a small fireplace.
+
+"Will that do for you?" the man asked.
+
+"Capitally," George said; "it could not be nicer;" while Bill was so
+taken aback by its comfort and luxury that he was speechless.
+
+"Well, that's settled, then," the man said. "If you have got any
+things you can bring 'em in when you like."
+
+"We have not got any to speak of," George said, flushing a little. "I
+came up from the country three months ago to look for work, and beyond
+odd jobs I have had nothing to do since, so that everything I had is
+pretty well gone; but I can pay a week's rent in advance," he said,
+putting his hand in his pocket.
+
+"Oh, you needn't mind that!" the man said; "as you work in the shop
+it's safe enough. Now I must get my dinner, else I shall be late for
+work."
+
+"Well, Bill, what do you think of that?" George asked as they left the
+house.
+
+"My eye," Bill exclaimed in admiration; "aint it nice just! Why, yer
+couldn't get a room like that, not furnished, anywhere near the
+market, not at four bob a week. Aint it clean just; so help me if the
+house don't look as if it has been scrubbed down every day! What a
+woman that must be for washing!"
+
+"Yes; we shall have to rub our feet well, Bill, and make as little
+mess as we can in going in and out."
+
+"I should think so," Bill said. "It don't seem to me as if it could be
+true as we're to have such a room as that to ourselves, and to walk
+into a house bold without being afraid as somebody would have his eye
+on you, and chivey you; and eight bob a week for grub regular."
+
+"Well, let's get some bread and cheese, Bill; pretty near half our
+time must be gone, and mind we must be very saving at first. There
+will be several things to get; a kettle and a teapot, and a coffeepot,
+and some cups and saucers, and we shall want a gridiron for frying
+rashers of bacon upon."
+
+"My eye, won't it be prime!" Bill broke in.
+
+"And we shall want some towels," George went on with his enumeration.
+
+"Towels!" repeated Bill. "What are they like?"
+
+"They are cloths for wiping your hands and face after you have
+washed."
+
+"Well, if yer says we wants 'em, George, of course we must get 'em;
+but I've always found my hands dried quick enough by themselves,
+especially if I gived 'em a rub on my trousers."
+
+"And then, Bill, you know," George went on, "I want to save every
+penny we can, so as to get some things to furnish two rooms by the
+time mother comes out."
+
+"Yes, in course we must," Bill agreed warmly, though a slight shade
+passed over his face at the thought that they were not to be always
+alone together. "Well, yer know, George, I am game for anythink. I can
+hold on with a penn'orth of bread a day. I have done it over and over,
+and if yer says the word I am ready to do it again."
+
+"No, Bill, we needn't do that," George laughed. "Still, we must live
+as cheap as we can. We will stick to bread for breakfast, and bread
+and cheese for dinner, and bread for supper, with sometimes a rasher
+as a great treat. At any rate we will try to live on six shillings a
+week."
+
+"Oh! we can do that fine," Bill said confidently; "and then two
+shillings for rent, and that will leave us eight shillings a week to
+put by."
+
+"Mother said that the doctor didn't think she would be able to come
+out 'til the spring. We are just at the beginning of November, so if
+she comes out the first of April, that's five months, say twenty-two
+weeks. Twenty-two weeks at eight shillings, let me see. That's eight
+pounds in twenty weeks, eight pounds sixteen altogether, that would
+furnish two rooms very well, I should think."
+
+"My eye, I should think so!" Bill exclaimed, for to his mind eight
+pound sixteen was an almost unheard-of sum, and the fact that his
+companion had been able to calculate it increased if possible his
+admiration for him.
+
+It needed but two or three days to reconcile Mrs. Grimstone to her new
+lodgers.
+
+"I wouldn't have believed," she said at the end of the week to a
+neighbor, "as two boys could have been that quiet. They comes in after
+work as regular as the master. They rubs their feet on the mat, and
+you can scarce hear 'em go upstairs, and I don't hear no more of 'em
+till they goes out agin in the morning. They don't come back here to
+breakfast or dinner. Eats it, I suppose, standing like."
+
+"But what do they do with themselves all the evening, Mrs. Grimstone?"
+
+"One of 'em reads to the other. I think I can hear a voice going
+regular over the kitchen."
+
+"And how's their room?"
+
+"As clean and tidy as a new pin. They don't lock the door when they
+goes out, and I looked in yesterday, expecting to find it like a
+pigsty; but they had made the bed afore starting for work, and set
+everything in its place, and laid the fire like for when they come
+back."
+
+Mrs. Grimstone was right. George had expended six pence in as many
+old books at a bookstall. One of them was a spelling-book, and he had
+at once set to work teaching Bill his letters. Bill had at first
+protested. "He had done very well without reading, and didn't see much
+good in it." However, as George insisted he gave way, as he would have
+done to any proposition whatever upon which his friend had set his
+mind. So for an hour every evening after they had finished tea Bill
+worked at his letters and spelling, and then George read aloud to him
+from one of the other books.
+
+"You must get on as fast as you can this winter, Bill," he said;
+"because when the summer evenings come we shall want to go for long
+walks."
+
+They found that they did very well upon the sum they agreed on. Tea
+and sugar cost less than George had expected. Mrs. Grimstone took in
+for them regularly a halfpenny-worth of milk, and for tea they were
+generally able to afford a bloater between them, or a very thin rasher
+of bacon. Their enjoyment of their meals was immense. Bill indeed
+frequently protested that they were spending too much money; but
+George said as long as they kept within the sum agreed upon, and paid
+their rent, coal, candles, and what little washing they required out
+of the eight shillings a week, they were doing very well.
+
+They had by this time got accustomed to the din of the machinery, and
+were able to work in comfort. Mr. Penrose had several times come
+through the room, and had given them a nod. After they had been there
+a month he spoke to Grimstone.
+
+"How do those boys do their work?"
+
+"Wonderful well, sir; they are the two best boys we have ever had. No
+skylarking about, and I never have to wait a minute for a plank. They
+generally comes in a few minutes before time and gets the bench
+cleared up. They are first-rate boys. They lodge with me, and two
+quieter and better-behaved chaps in a house there never was."
+
+"I am glad to hear it," Mr. Penrose said. "I am interested in them,
+and am pleased to hear so good an account."
+
+That Saturday, to their surprise, when they went to get their money
+they received ten shillings apiece.
+
+"That's two shillings too much," George said as the money was handed
+to them.
+
+"That's all right," the foreman said. "The governor ordered you both
+to have a rise."
+
+"My eye!" Bill said as they went out. "What do you think of that,
+George? Four bob a week more to put by regularly. How much more will
+that make by the time your mother comes?"
+
+"We won't put it all by, Bill. I think the other will be enough. This
+four shillings a week we will put aside at present for clothes. We
+want two more shirts apiece, and some more stockings, and we shall
+want some shoes before long, and another suit of clothes each. We must
+keep ourselves decent, you know."
+
+From the time when they began work the boys had gone regularly every
+Sunday morning to a small iron church near their lodging, and they
+also went to an evening service once a week. Their talk, too, at home
+was often on religion, for Bill was extremely anxious to learn, and
+although his questions and remarks often puzzled George to answer, he
+was always ready to explain things as far as he could.
+
+February came, and to George's delight he heard, from his mother that
+she was so much better that the doctor thought that when she came out
+at the end of April she would be as strong as she had ever been. Her
+eyes had benefited greatly by her long rest, and she said that she was
+sure she should be able to do work as before. She had written several
+times since they had been at Limehouse, expressing her great pleasure
+at hearing that George was so well and comfortable. At Christmas, the
+works being closed for four days, George had gone down to see her, and
+they had a delightful talk together. Christmas had indeed been a
+memorable occasion to the boys, for on Christmas Eve the carrier had
+left a basket at Grimstone's directed "George Andrews." The boys had
+prepared their Christmas dinner, consisting of some fine rashers of
+bacon and sixpenny-worth of cold plum pudding from a cook-shop, and
+had already rather lamented this outlay, for Mrs. Grimstone had that
+afternoon invited them to dine downstairs. George was reading from a
+book which he bought for a penny that morning when there was a knock
+at the door, and Mrs. Grimstone said:
+
+"Here is a hamper for you, George."
+
+"A hamper for me!" George exclaimed in astonishment, opening the door.
+"Why, whoever could have sent a hamper for me! It must be a mistake."
+
+"That's your name on the direction, anyhows," Mrs. Grimstone said.
+
+"Yes, that's my name, sure enough," George agreed, and at once began
+to unknot the string which fastened down the lid.
+
+"Here is a Christmas card at the top!" he shouted. He turned it over.
+On the back were the words:
+
+"With all good wishes, Helen Penrose."
+
+"Well, that is kind," George said in rather a husky voice; and indeed
+it was the kindness that prompted the gift rather than the gift itself
+that touched him.
+
+"Now, then, George," Bill remonstrated; "never mind that there card,
+let's see what's inside."
+
+The hamper was unpacked, and was found to contain a cold goose, a
+Christmas pudding, and some oranges and apples. These were all placed
+on the table, and when Mrs. Grimstone had retired Bill executed a
+war-dance in triumph and delight.
+
+"I never did see such a game," he said at last, as he sat down
+exhausted. "There's a Christmas dinner for yer! Why, it's like them
+stories of the genii you was a-telling me about--chaps as come
+whenever yer rubbed a ring or an old lamp, and brought a tuck-out or
+whatever yer asked for. Of course that wasn't true; yer told me it
+wasn't, and I shouldn't have believed it if yer hadn't, but this 'ere
+is true. Now I sees, George, as what yer said was right and what I
+said was wrong. I thought yer were a flat 'cause yer wouldn't take
+nothing for getting back that there locket, and now yer see what's
+come of it, two good berths for us and a Christmas dinner fit for a
+king. Now what are we going to do with it, 'cause yer know we dines
+with them downstairs to-morrow?"
+
+"The best thing we can do, I think," George answered, "will be to
+invite all of them downstairs, Bob Grimstone, his wife, and the three
+young uns, to supper, not to-morrow night nor the night after, because
+I shan't be back from Croydon till late, but say the evening after."
+
+"But we can't hold them all," Bill said, looking round the room.
+
+"No, we can't hold them here, certainly, but I dare say they will let
+us have the feed in their parlor. There will be nothing to get, you
+know, but some bread and butter, and some beer for Bob. Mrs. Grimstone
+don't take it, so we must have plenty of tea."
+
+"I should like some beer too, just for once, George, with such a
+blow-out as that."
+
+"No, no, Bill, you and I will stick to tea. You know we agreed that we
+wouldn't take beer. If we begin it once we shall want it again, so we
+are not going to alter from what we agreed to. We see plenty of the
+misery which drink causes all round and the way in which money is
+wasted over it. I like a glass of beer as well as you do, and when I
+get to be a man I dare say I shall take a glass with my dinner
+regularly, though I won't do even that if I find it makes me want to
+take more; but anyhow at present we can do without it."
+
+Bill agreed, and the dinner-party downstairs and the supper two nights
+afterwards came off in due course, and were both most successful.
+
+The acknowledgment of the gift had been a matter of some trouble to
+George, but he had finally bought a pretty New Year's card and had
+written on the back, "with the grateful thanks of George Andrews," and
+had sent it to the daughter of his employer.
+
+At the beginning of April George had consulted Grimstone and his wife
+as to the question of preparing a home for his mother.
+
+"How much would two rooms cost?" he had asked; "one a good-sized one
+and the other the same size as ours."
+
+"Four shillings or four and sixpence," Mrs. Grimstone replied.
+
+"And supposing we had a parlor and two little bedrooms?"
+
+"Five and sixpence or six shillings, I should say," Mrs. Grimstone
+replied.
+
+"And how much for a whole house?"
+
+"It depends upon the size. We pay seven shillings a week, but you
+might get one without the kitchen and bedroom over it behind for six
+shillings."
+
+"That would be much the nicest," George said, "only it would cost such
+a lot to furnish it."
+
+"But you needn't furnish it all at once," Mrs. Grimstone suggested.
+"Just a kitchen and two bedrooms for a start, and you can put things
+into the parlor afterwards. That's the way we did when we first
+married. But you must have some furniture."
+
+"And how much will it cost for the kitchen and two bedrooms?"
+
+"Of course going cheaply to work and buying the things secondhand, I
+should say I could pick up the things for you, so that you could do
+very well," Mrs. Grimstone said, "for six or seven pounds."
+
+"That will do capitally," George said, "for by the end of this month
+Bill and I will have more than ten pounds laid by."
+
+"What! since you came here?" Grimstone exclaimed in astonishment. "Do
+you mean to say you boys have laid by five pounds apiece?"
+
+"Yes, and bought a lot of things too," his wife put in.
+
+"Why, you must have been starving yourselves!"
+
+"We don't look like it," George laughed. "I am sure Bill is a stone
+heavier than when he came here."
+
+"Well, young chap, it does you a lot of credit," Bob Grimstone said.
+"It isn't every boy, by a long way, would stint himself as you must
+have done for the last five months to make a comfortable home for his
+mother, for I know lots of men who are earning their two quid a week
+and has their old people in the workhouse. Well, all I can say is that
+if I or the missis here can be of any use to you in taking a house we
+shall be right down glad."
+
+"Thank you," George said. "We will look about for a house, and when we
+have fixed on one if you or Mrs. Grimstone will go about it for us I
+shall be much obliged, for I don't think landlords would be inclined
+to let a house to two boys."
+
+"All right, George! we will do that for you with pleasure. Besides,
+you know, there are things, when you are going to take a house, that
+you stand out for; such as papering and painting, or putting in a new
+range, and things of that sort."
+
+After their dinner on the following Sunday the two boys set out
+house-hunting.
+
+"If it's within a mile that will do," George said. "It doesn't matter
+about our going home in the breakfast time. We can bring our grub in a
+basket and our tea in a bottle, as several of the hands do; but if
+it's over a mile we shall have to hurry to get there and back for
+dinner. Still there are plenty of houses in a mile."
+
+There were indeed plenty of houses, in long regular rows, bare and
+hard-looking, but George wanted to find something more pleasant and
+homelike than these. Late in the afternoon he came upon what he
+wanted. It was just about a mile from the works and beyond the lines
+of regular streets. Here he found a turning off the main road with but
+eight houses in it, four on each side. It looked as if the man who
+built them had intended to run a street down for some distance, but
+had either been unable to obtain enough ground or had changed his
+mind.
+
+They stood in pairs, each with its garden in front, with a bow-window
+and little portico. They appeared to be inhabited by a different class
+to those who lived in the rows, chiefly by city clerks, for the
+gardens were nicely kept, the blinds were clean and spotless, muslin
+curtains hung in the windows, and fancy tables with pretty ornaments
+stood between them. Fortunately one of them, the last on the left-hand
+side, was to let.
+
+"What do you think of this, Bill?"
+
+"It seems to be just the thing; but how about the rent, George? I
+should think they were awful dear."
+
+"I don't suppose they are any more than the houses in the rows, Bill.
+They are very small, you see, and I don't suppose they would suit
+workmen as well as the others; at any rate we will see."
+
+Whereupon George noted down on a scrap of paper the name of the agent
+of whom inquiry was to be made.
+
+"No. 8," he said; "but what's the name of the street? Oh, there it is.
+Laburnum Villas. No. 8 Laburnum Villas; that sounds first-rate,
+doesn't it? I will get Mrs. Grimstone to go round to the agent
+to-morrow."
+
+This Mrs. Grimstone agreed to do directly she was asked. After
+speaking to her husband she said, "I will get the key from the agent's
+and will be there just after twelve to-morrow, so if you go there
+straight when you get out you will be able to see the rooms and what
+state it's in."
+
+"But how about Bob's dinner?" George asked.
+
+"Oh, he will have it cold to-morrow, and I will set it out for him
+before I start."
+
+"That is very kind, Mrs. Grimstone, thank you very much. It would be
+just the thing."
+
+Accordingly, at ten minutes past twelve on the following day the two
+boys arrived breathless at No. 8 Laburnum Villas.
+
+"Hurrah!" George shouted, "there is Mrs. Grimstone at the window."
+
+The door was opened and they rushed in.
+
+"It's a tidy little place," Mrs. Grimstone said; "and it's in good
+order and won't want any money laying out upon it."
+
+The house was certainly small, but the boys were delighted with it. On
+the ground-floor were two little rooms opening with folding doors,
+and a little kitchen built out behind. There was a room over this, and
+two rooms above the sitting rooms.
+
+"That's just the right number," George said, "a bedroom each for us;
+it couldn't be nicer; and what pretty paper!"
+
+"And there is a good long slip of garden behind," Mrs. Grimstone said,
+"where you could grow lots of vegetables. Of course in the front you
+would have flowers."
+
+"And how much do they want for it?"
+
+"Seven and sixpence a week, including rates and taxes. I call it dear
+for its size, but then of course it's got the garden and it looks
+pretty and nice. The agent says it's been painted and papered from top
+to bottom since the last people left, but he says the owner won't let
+it unless somebody comes who is likely to stop, and he will want
+references of respectability."
+
+"All right!" George said; "I can manage that," for he had already been
+thinking of the question in his mind; "and we can manage seven and
+sixpence a week; can't we, Bill?"
+
+"We will try, anyhow," Bill said stoutly, for he was as much pleased
+with the cottage as George was.
+
+They explored the garden behind the house. This was about a hundred
+feet long by twenty-five wide. Half of it was covered with stumps of a
+plantation of cabbages, the other half was empty and had evidently
+been dug up by the last tenants ready for planting.
+
+"Why, I should think we shall be able to grow all our own potatoes
+here!" George exclaimed in delight.
+
+Mrs. Grimstone was a country woman, and she shook her head.
+
+"You wouldn't be able to do that, George, not if you gave it all up to
+potatoes; but if you planted the further end with potatoes you might
+get a good many, and then, you know, at this end you might have three
+or four rows of peas and French beans, and lettuces and such like, but
+you will have to get some manure to put in. Things won't grow without
+manure even in the country, and I am sure they won't here; and then
+you know you can have flowers in the front of the house. But it's time
+for you to be off, else you will be late at the works. I am sure it's
+more than half an hour since you came in. I will take the key back and
+tell them they shall have an answer by Wednesday or Thursday."
+
+George did not think they could have been a quarter of an hour;
+however, he and Bill started at a trot, which they increased into a
+run at the top of their speed when the first clock they saw pointed to
+seven minutes to one. The bell was ringing as they approached the
+works; it stopped when they were within fifty yards, and the gate was
+just closing as they rushed up.
+
+"Too late," the man said.
+
+"Oh, do let us through," George panted out; "it's the first time we
+have ever been late, and we have run a mile to be here in time!"
+
+"Oh, it's you, is it?" the man said, opening the gate a few inches to
+look through. "Ah, well I will let you in this time, 'cause you are
+well-behaved young chaps; but don't you run it so close another time,
+else you will have to lose your hour."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV.
+
+HOME.
+
+
+That evening George wrote a letter to Dr. Jeffries at Croydon, saying
+that he had taken a little house for his mother to come to when she
+came out of the infirmary, and as he had kindly said that he would
+render her help if he could, would he be good enough to write to the
+agent whose address he gave, saying that Mrs. Andrews, who was about
+taking No. 8 Laburnum Villas, was a person of respectability.
+
+The following evening he received a letter from the doctor saying that
+he had written to the agent, and that he was glad indeed to hear that
+George was getting on so well that he was able to provide a home for
+his mother.
+
+On Wednesday at dinner-time Mrs. Grimstone handed George a key.
+
+"There you are, George. You are master of the house now. The agent
+said the reference was most satisfactory; so I paid him the seven and
+sixpence you gave me for a week's rent in advance, and you can go in
+when you like. We shall be sorry to lose you both, for I don't want
+two better lodgers. You don't give no trouble, and all has been quiet
+and pleasant in the house; and to think what a taking I was in that
+day as Bob brought you here for the first time, to think as he had let
+the room to two boys. But there, one never knows, and I wouldn't have
+believed it as boys could be so quiet in a house."
+
+"Now we must begin to see about furniture," Bob Grimstone said. "The
+best plan, I think, will be for you two to go round of an evening to
+all the shops in the neighborhood, and mark off just what you think
+will suit you. You put down the prices stuck on them, and just what
+they are, and then the missis can go in the morning and bargain for
+them. She will get them five shillings in the pound cheaper than you
+would. It's wonderful how women do beat men down, to be sure. When a
+man hears what's the price of a thing he leaves it or takes it just as
+he likes, but a woman begins by offering half the sum. Then the chap
+says no, and she makes as if she was going away; he lets her go a
+little way and then he hollers after her, and comes down a goodish bit
+in the price. Then she says she don't particularly want it and
+shouldn't think of giving any such price as that. Then he tries again,
+and so they gets on till they hit on a figure as suits them both. You
+see that little tea-caddy in the corner? My wife was just three weeks
+buying that caddy. The chap wanted seven and six for it, and she
+offered him half a crown. He came down half a crown at the end of the
+first week, and at last she got it for three and nine. Now, the first
+thing you have got to do is to make out a list. First of all you have
+got to put down the things as you must have, and then the things you
+can do without, though you will get them if you can afford it. Mother
+will help you at that."
+
+So Mrs. Grimstone and George sat down with paper and a pencil, and
+George was absolutely horrified at the list of things which Mrs.
+Grimstone declared were absolutely indispensable. However, after much
+discussion, some few items were marked as doubtful. When the list was
+finished the two boys started on an exploring expedition, and the next
+week all their evenings were fully occupied. In ten days after they
+began the three bedrooms and the kitchen were really smartly
+furnished, Mrs. Grimstone proving a wonderful hand at bargaining, and
+making the ten pounds go farther than George had believed possible. On
+the Sunday Bob went with his wife and the boys to inspect the house.
+
+"It's a very comfortable little place," he said, "and that front
+bedroom with the chintz curtains the missis made up is as nice a
+little room as you want to see. As to the others they will do well
+enough for you boys."
+
+The only articles of furniture in the sitting room were two long
+muslin curtains, which Mrs. Grimstone had bought a bargain at a shop
+selling off; for it was agreed that this was necessary to give the
+house a furnished appearance. Bob Grimstone was so much pleased at
+what had been done that he shared George's feeling of regret that one
+of the sitting rooms could not also be furnished, and on the walk home
+said:
+
+"Look here, George. I know you would like to have the house nice for
+your mother. You couldn't make one of those sitting rooms comfortable
+not under a five-pound note, not even with the missis to market for
+you, but you might for that. I have got a little money laid by in the
+savings-bank, and I will lend you five pounds, and welcome, if you
+like to take it. I know it will be just as safe with you as it will be
+there."
+
+"Thank you very much, Bob--thank you very much, but I won't take it.
+In the first place, I should like mother to know that the furniture is
+all ours, bought out of Bill's savings and mine; and in the next
+place, I should find it hard at first to pay back anything. I think we
+can just manage on our money, but that will be all. I told you mother
+does work, but she mayn't be able to get any at first, so we can't
+reckon on that. When she does, you know, we shall be able gradually to
+buy the furniture."
+
+"Well, perhaps you are right, George," the man said after a pause.
+"You would have been welcome to the money: but perhaps you are right
+not to take it. I borrowed a little money when I first went into
+housekeeping, and it took a wonderful trouble to pay off, and if
+there's illness or anything of that sort it weighs on you. Not that I
+should be in any hurry about it. It wouldn't worry me, but it would
+worry you."
+
+A week later Mrs. Andrews was to leave the infirmary, and on Saturday
+George asked for a day off to go down to fetch her. Every evening
+through the week he and Bill had worked away at digging up the garden.
+Fortunately there was a moon, for it was dark by the time they came
+out from the works. Bill was charged with the commission to lay in the
+store of provisions for the Sunday, and he was to be sure to have a
+capital fire and tea ready by four o'clock, the hour at which George
+calculated he would be back.
+
+Very delighted was George as in his best suit--for he and Bill had two
+suits each now--he stepped out of the train at Croydon and walked to
+the workhouse. His mother had told him that she would meet him at the
+gate at half-past two, and punctually at the time he was there. A few
+minutes later Mrs. Andrews came out, not dressed as he had seen her at
+Christmas, in the infirmary garb, but in her own clothes. George gave
+a cry of delight as he ran forward to meet her.
+
+"My darling mother! and you are looking quite yourself again."
+
+"I am, thank God, George. It has seemed a long nine months, but the
+rest and quiet have done wonders for me. Everyone has been very kind;
+and of course the knowledge, dear boy, that you had got work that you
+liked helped me to get strong again. And you are looking well too; and
+your friend, I hope he is well?"
+
+"Quite well, mother, but in a great fright about you. He is glad you
+are coming because I am glad; but the poor fellow has quite made up
+his mind that you won't like him and you won't think him a fit
+companion for me. I told him over and over again that you are not that
+sort; but nothing can persuade him. Of course, mother, he doesn't talk
+good grammar, and he uses some queer expressions; but he is very much
+changed in that way since I first knew him, and he tries very hard,
+and don't mind a bit how often I correct him, and he is beginning to
+read easy words quite well; and he is one of the best-hearted fellows
+in the world."
+
+"If he is kind to you, George, and fond of you, that's enough for me,"
+Mrs. Andrews said; "but I have no doubt I shall soon like him for
+himself. You could not like him as much as you do if there were not
+something nice about him. And you have succeeded in getting a room for
+me in the house in which you lodge?" for George had never mentioned a
+word in his letter about taking a house, and had asked Dr. Jeffries if
+he should see his mother to say nothing to her about his application
+to him.
+
+"Yes, that's all right, mother," he replied briskly.
+
+"And you have got some new clothes since I saw you last, George. You
+wanted them; yours were getting rather shabby when I saw you at
+Christmas."
+
+"Yes, mother, they were."
+
+"I suppose you had to part with your best suit while you were so long
+out of work?"
+
+"That was it, mother; but you see I have been able to get some more
+things. They are only cheap ones, you know, but they will do very well
+until I can afford better ones. I am not walking too fast for you, am
+I? But we shall just catch the train. Or look here, would you mind
+going straight by yourself to the railway station? Then you can walk
+slowly. I will go round and get your box. I went into our old place as
+I came along, and Mrs. Larkins said she would bring it downstairs for
+me as I came back."
+
+"No, I would rather go round with you, George. I want to thank her for
+having kept it for me so long. Even if we do miss the train it will
+not matter much, as it will make no difference whether we get in town
+an hour earlier or later."
+
+As George could not explain his special reason for desiring to catch
+that train he was obliged to agree, and they stopped a quarter of an
+hour at their old lodging, as Mrs. Larkins insisted upon their having
+a cup of tea which she had prepared for them. However, when they
+reached the station they found that a train was going shortly, and
+when they reached town they were not so very much later than George
+had calculated upon.
+
+They took a cab, for although Mrs. Andrews' box was not heavy, it was
+too much for George to carry that distance; besides, Mrs. Andrews
+herself was tired from her walk to the station from the infirmary,
+having had no exercise for so long. When they got into the
+neighborhood of Limehouse George got outside to direct the cabman. It
+was just a quarter past four when the cab drew up at No. 8 Laburnum
+Villas.
+
+"Why, is this the house?" Mrs. Andrews asked in surprise as George
+jumped down and opened the door. "Why, you told me in one of your
+letters it was a house in a row. What a pretty little place! It is
+really here, George?"
+
+"It is here, mother; we moved the other day. There is Bill at the
+door;" but Bill, having opened the door, ran away out into the garden,
+and George, having paid the cabman, carried his mother's box in and
+entered the house with her.
+
+"Straight on, mother, into the little room at the end."
+
+"What a snug little kitchen!" Mrs. Andrews said as she entered it;
+"and tea all laid and ready! What, have they lent you the room for
+this evening?"
+
+"My dear mother," George said, throwing his arms round her neck,
+"this is your kitchen and your house, all there is of it, only the
+sitting room isn't furnished yet. We must wait for that, you know."
+
+"What! you have taken a whole house, my boy! that is very nice; but
+can we afford it, George? It seems too good to be true."
+
+"It is quite true, mother, and I think it's a dear little house, and
+will be splendid when we have got it all furnished. Now come up and
+see the bedrooms. This is Bill's, you know," and he opened the door on
+the staircase, "and this is mine, and this is yours."
+
+"Oh, what a pretty little room!" Mrs. Andrews said: "but, my dear
+George, the rent of this house and the hire of the furniture will
+surely be more than we can afford to pay. I know what a good manager
+you are, my boy, but I have such a horror of getting into debt that it
+almost frightens me."
+
+"The rent of the house is seven and sixpence a week, mother, with
+rates and taxes, and we can afford that out of Bill's earnings and
+mine, even if you did not do any work at all; and as to the furniture,
+it is every bit paid for out of our savings since we went to work."
+
+On hearing which Mrs. Andrews threw her arms round George's neck and
+burst into tears of happiness. She was not very strong, and the
+thought of the sacrifices these two boys must have made to get a
+house together for her completely overpowered her.
+
+"It seems impossible, George," she said when she had recovered
+herself. "Why, you have only been earning ten shillings a week each,
+and you have had to keep yourselves and get clothes and all sorts of
+things; it seems impossible."
+
+"It has not cost so much as you think, mother, and Bill and I had both
+learned to live cheap in Covent Garden; but now let us go downstairs;
+you have not seen Bill yet, and I know tea will be ready."
+
+But Bill had not yet come in, and George had to go out into the garden
+to fetch him.
+
+"Come on, Bill; mother is delighted with everything. She won't eat
+you, you know."
+
+"No, she won't eat me, George; but she will think me an out-and-out
+sort of 'ottentot," which word had turned up in a book the boys had
+been reading on an evening previously.
+
+"Well, wait till she says so; come along."
+
+So linking his arm in Bill's, George drew him along, and brought him
+shamefaced and bashful into the kitchen.
+
+"This is Bill, mother."
+
+"I am glad to see you, Bill," Mrs. Andrews said, holding out her hand.
+"I have heard so much of you from George that I seem to know you quite
+well."
+
+Bill put his hand out shyly.
+
+"I am sure we shall get on well together," Mrs. Andrews went on. "I
+shall never forget that you were a friend to my boy when he was
+friendless in London."
+
+"It's all the t'other way, ma'am," Bill said eagerly; "don't you go
+for to think it. Why, just look what George has done for me! There was
+I, a-hanging about the Garden, pretty nigh starving, and sure to get
+quadded sooner or later; and now here I am living decent, and earning
+a good wage; and he has taught me to read, ma'am, and to know about
+things, and aint been ashamed of me, though I am so different to what
+he is. I tell you, ma'am, there aint no saying what a friend he's been
+to me, and I aint done nothing for him as I can see."
+
+"Well, Bill, you perhaps both owe each other something," Mrs. Andrews
+said: "and I owe you something as well as my son, for George tells me
+that it is to your self-denial as well as to his own that I owe this
+delightful surprise of finding a home ready for me; and now," she went
+on, seeing how confused and unhappy Bill looked, "I think you two
+ought to make tea this evening, for you are the hosts, and I am the
+guest. In future it will be my turn."
+
+"All right, mother! you sit down in this armchair; Bill, you do the
+rashers, and I will pour the water into the pot and then toast the
+muffins."
+
+Bill was at home now; such culinary efforts as they had hitherto
+attempted had generally fallen to his share, as he had a greater
+aptitude for the work than George had, and a dish of bacon fried to a
+turn was soon upon the table.
+
+Mrs. Andrews had been watching Bill closely, and was pleased with the
+result of her observation. Bill was indeed greatly improved in
+appearance since he had first made George's acquaintance. His cheeks
+had filled out, and his face had lost its hardness of outline; the
+quick, restless, hunted expression of his eyes had nearly died out,
+and he no longer looked as if constantly on the watch to dodge an
+expected cuff; his face had always had a large share of that merriment
+and love of fun which seem the common portion of the London arabs, and
+seldom desert them under all their hardships; but it was a happier and
+brighter spirit now, and had altogether lost its reckless character. A
+similar change is always observable among the waifs picked up off the
+streets by the London refuges after they have been a few months on
+board a training ship.
+
+When all was ready the party sat down to their meal. Mrs. Andrews
+undertook the pouring out of the tea, saying that although she was a
+guest, as the only lady present she should naturally preside. George
+cut the bread, and Bill served the bacon. The muffins were piled on a
+plate in the front of the fire as a second course.
+
+It was perhaps the happiest meal that any of the three had ever sat
+down to. Mrs. Andrews was not only happy at finding so comfortable a
+home prepared for her, but was filled with a deep feeling of pride and
+thankfulness at the evidence of the love, steadiness, and
+self-sacrifice of her son. George was delighted at having his mother
+with him again, and at seeing her happiness and contentment at the
+home he had prepared for her. Bill was delighted because George was
+so, and he was moreover vastly relieved at finding Mrs. Andrews less
+terrible than he had depicted her.
+
+After tea was cleared away they talked together for a while, and then
+Bill--feeling with instinctive delicacy that George and his mother
+would like to talk together for a time--said he should take a turn for
+an hour, and on getting outside the house executed so wild a war-dance
+of satisfaction that it was fortunate it was dark, or Laburnum Villas
+would have been astonished and scandalized at the spectacle.
+
+"I like your friend Bill very much," Mrs. Andrews said when she was
+alone with George. "I was sure from what you told me that he must be a
+good-hearted lad; but brought up as he has been, poor boy, I feared a
+little that he would scarcely be a desirable companion in point of
+manners. Of course, as you say, his grammar is a little peculiar; but
+his manners are wonderfully quiet and nice, considering all."
+
+"Look what an example he's had, mother," George laughed; "but really
+he has taken great pains ever since he knew that you were coming
+home. He has been asking me to tell him of anything he does which is
+not right, especially about eating and that sort of thing. You see he
+had never used a fork till we came down here, and he made me show him
+directly how it should be held and what to do with it. It has been
+quite funny to me to see him watching me at meals, and doing exactly
+the same."
+
+"And you have taught him to read, George?"
+
+"Yes, mother."
+
+"And something of better things, George?" she asked.
+
+"Yes, mother, as much as I could. He didn't know anything when I met
+him; but he goes to church with me now regularly, and says his prayers
+every night, and I can tell you he thinks a lot of it. More, I think,
+than I ever did," he added honestly.
+
+"Perhaps he has done you as much good as you have done him, George."
+
+"Perhaps he has, mother; yes, I think so. When you see a chap so very
+earnest for a thing you can't help being earnest yourself; besides,
+you know, mother," he went on a little shyly, for George had not been
+accustomed to talk much of these matters with his mother--"you see
+when one's down in the world and hard up, and not quite sure about the
+next meal, and without any friend, one seems to think more of these
+things than one does when one is jolly at school with other fellows."
+
+"Perhaps so, George, though I do not know why it should be so, for the
+more blessings one has the more reason for love and gratitude to the
+giver. However, dear, I think we have both reason to be grateful now,
+have we not?"
+
+"That we have, mother. Only think of the difference since we said
+good-by to each other last summer! Now here you are strong and well
+again, and we are together and don't mean to be separated, and I have
+got a place I like and have a good chance of getting on in, and we
+have got a pretty little house all to ourselves, and you will be able
+to live a little like a lady again,--I mean as you were accustomed
+to,--and everything is so nice. Oh, mother, I am sure we have every
+reason to be grateful!"
+
+"We have indeed, George, and I even more than you, in the proofs you
+have given me that my son is likely to turn out all that even I could
+wish him."
+
+Bill's hour was a very long one.
+
+"You must not go out of an evening, Bill, to get out of our way," Mrs.
+Andrews said when he returned, "else I shall think that I am in your
+way. It was kind of you to think of it the first evening, and George
+and I are glad to have had a long talk together, but in future I hope
+you won't do it. You see there will be lots to do of an evening. There
+will be your lessons and George's, for I hope now that he's settled he
+will give up an hour or two every evening to study. Not Latin and
+Greek, George," she added, smiling, seeing a look of something like
+dismay in George's face, "that will be only a waste of time to you
+now, but a study of such things as may be useful to you in your
+present work and in your future life, and a steady course of reading
+really good books by good authors. Then perhaps when you have both
+done your work, you will take it by turns to read out loud while I do
+my sewing. Then perhaps some day, who knows, if we get on very
+flourishingly, after we have furnished our sitting room, we may be
+able to indulge in the luxury of a piano again and have a little music
+of an evening."
+
+"That will be jolly, mother. Why, it will be really like old times,
+when you used to sing to me!"
+
+Mrs. Andrews' eyes filled with tears at the thought of the old times,
+but she kept them back bravely, so as not to mar, even for a moment,
+the happiness of this first evening. So they chatted till nine
+o'clock, when they had supper. After it was over Mrs. Andrews left the
+room for a minute and went upstairs and opened her box, and returned
+with a Bible in her hand.
+
+"I think, boys," she said, "we ought to end this first happy evening
+in our new home by thanking God together for his blessings."
+
+"I am sure we ought, mother," George said, and Bill's face expressed
+his approval.
+
+So Mrs. Andrews read a chapter, and then they knelt and thanked God
+for his blessings, and the custom thus begun was continued henceforth
+in No. 8 Laburnum Villas.
+
+Hitherto George and his companion had found things much more pleasant
+at the works than they had expected. They had, of course, had
+principally to do with Bob Grimstone; still there were many other men
+in the shop, and at times, when his bench was standing idle while some
+slight alterations or adjustment of machinery were made, they were set
+to work with others. Men are quick to see when boys are doing their
+best, and, finding the lads intent upon their work and given neither
+to idleness nor skylarking, they seldom had a sharp word addressed to
+them. But after Mrs. Andrews had come home they found themselves
+addressed in a warmer and more kindly manner by the men. Bob Grimstone
+had told two or three of his mates of the sacrifices the boys had made
+to save up money to make a home for the mother of one of them when she
+came out of hospital. They were not less impressed than he had been,
+and the story went the round of the workshops and even came to the
+ears of the foreman, and there was not a man there but expressed
+himself in warm terms of surprise and admiration that two lads should
+for six months have stinted themselves of food in order to lay by half
+their pay for such a purpose.
+
+"There's precious few would have done such a thing," one of the older
+workmen said, "not one in a thousand; why, not one chap in a hundred,
+even when he's going to be married, will stint himself like that to
+make a home for the gal he is going to make his wife, so as to start
+housekeeping out of debt; and as to doing it for a mother, where will
+you find 'em? In course a man ought to do as much for his mother as
+for the gal who is agoing to be his wife, seeing how much he owes her;
+but how many does it, that's what I says, how many does it?"
+
+So after that the boys were surprised to find how many of the men,
+when they met them at the gate, would give them a kindly nod or a
+hearty, "Good-morning, young chaps!"
+
+A day or two after Mrs. Andrews had settled in Laburnum Villas she
+went up to town and called upon a number of shops, asking for work. As
+she was able to give an excellent reference to the firm for whom she
+had worked at Croydon she succeeded before the end of the week in
+obtaining millinery work for a firm in St. Paul's Churchyard, and as
+she had excellent taste and was very quick at her needle she was soon
+able to earn considerably more than she had done at Croydon.
+
+The three were equally determined that they would live as closely as
+possible until the sitting-rooms were furnished, and by strict
+management they kept within the boys' pay, Mrs. Andrews' earnings
+being devoted to the grand purpose. The small articles were bought
+first, and each week there was great congratulation and pleasure as
+some new article was placed in the rooms. Then there was a pause for
+some time, then came the chairs, then after an interval a table, and
+lastly the carpet. This crowning glory was not attained until the end
+of July. After this they moved solemnly into the sitting-room,
+agreeing that the looking-glass, chiffonier, and sofa could be added
+at a more gradual rate, and that the whole of Mrs. Andrews' earnings
+need no longer be devoted.
+
+"Now, boys," Mrs. Andrews said on that memorable evening, "I want you
+in future, when you come in, to change your working clothes before you
+come in here to your teas. So long as we lived in the kitchen I have
+let things go on, but I think there's something in the old saying,
+'Company clothes, company manners,' and I think it is good when boys
+come in that they should lay aside their heavy-nailed shoes and their
+working clothes. Certainly such boots and clothes are apt to render
+people clumsy in their movements, and the difference of walk which you
+observe between men of different classes arises very greatly from the
+clumsy, heavy boots which workingmen must wear."
+
+"But what does it matter, mother?" George urged, for it seemed to him
+that it would be rather a trouble to change his clothes every day.
+"These little things don't make any real difference to a man."
+
+"Not any vital difference, George, but a real difference for all
+that. Manners make the man, you know! that is, they influence
+strangers and people who only know him in connection with business. If
+two men apply together for a place the chances are strongly in favor
+of the man with the best manners getting it. Besides, my boy, I think
+the observance of little courtesies of this kind make home pleasanter
+and brighter. You see I always change my dress before tea, and I am
+sure you prefer my sitting down to the table tidy and neat with a
+fresh collar and cuffs, to my taking my place in my working dress with
+odds and ends of threads and litter clinging to it."
+
+"Of course I do, mother, and I see what you mean now. Certainly I will
+change my things in future. You don't mind, do you, Bill?"
+
+Bill would not have minded in the least any amount of trouble by which
+he could give the slightest satisfaction to Mrs. Andrews, who had now
+a place in his affections closely approximating to that which George
+occupied.
+
+During the summer months the programme for the evening was not carried
+out as arranged, for at the end of April Mrs. Andrews herself declared
+that there must be a change.
+
+"The evenings are getting light enough now for a walk after tea, boys,
+and you must therefore cut short our reading and studies till the days
+close in again in the autumn. It would do you good to get out in the
+air a bit."
+
+"But will you come with us, mother?"
+
+"No, George. Sometimes as evenings get longer we may make little
+excursions together: go across the river to Greenwich and spend two or
+three hours in the park, or take a steamer and go up the river to Kew;
+but as a general thing you had better take your rambles together. I
+have my front garden to look after, the vegetables are your work, you
+know, and if I like I can go out and do whatever shopping I have to do
+while you two are away."
+
+So the boys took to going out walks, which got longer and longer as
+the evenings drew out, and when they were not disposed for a long
+ramble they would go down to a disused wharf and sit there and watch
+the barges drifting down the river or tacking backwards and forwards,
+if there was a wind, with their great brown and yellow sails hauled
+tautly in, and the great steamers dropping quietly down the river, and
+the little busy tugs dragging great ships after them. There was an
+endless source of amusement in wondering from what ports the various
+craft had come or what was their destination.
+
+"What seems most wonderful to me, George," Bill said one day, "when
+one looks at them big steamers----"
+
+"Those," George corrected.
+
+"Thank ye--at those big steamers, is to think that they can be tossed
+about, and the sea go over them, as one reads about, just the same
+way as the wave they make when they goes down----"
+
+"Go down, Bill."
+
+"Thank ye--go down the river, tosses the little boats about; it don't
+seem possible that water can toss itself about so high as that, does
+it?"
+
+"It does seem extraordinary, Bill; we know that it is so because there
+are constantly wrecks; but looking at the water it does not seem
+possible that it should rise up into waves large enough to knock one
+of those great steamers in pieces. Some day, Bill, not this year, of
+course, because the house isn't finished, but next year, I hope we
+shall be able all of us to go down for a trip to the sea. I have seen
+it stuck up you can go to Margate and back for three or four
+shillings; and though Bob Grimstone says that isn't regular sea, it
+would be enough to show us something of what it's like."
+
+The garden occupied a good deal of the boys' time. Bill's long
+experience in the market had given him an interest in vegetables, and
+he was always ready for an hour's work in the garden after tea. The
+results of much labor and plenty of manure were not unsatisfactory,
+and Mrs. Andrews was delighted with her regular supply of fresh
+vegetables. Bill's anticipation, however, of the amount that could be
+grown in a limited space were by no means fulfilled, and seeing the
+small amount which could be daily gathered, and recalling the
+countless piled-up wagons which he had been accustomed to see in
+Covent Garden, he was continually expressing his astonishment at the
+enormous quantity of ground which must be employed in keeping up the
+supply of the market.
+
+They did not that year get the trip to Margate; but in the autumn,
+after the great work of furnishing was finished, they did get several
+long jaunts, once out to Epping Forest on an omnibus, once in a
+steamer up to Kew, and several times across to Greenwich Park. Mrs.
+Andrews found it a very happy summer, free from the wear of anxiety,
+which, more even than the work, had brought on her long illness. She
+grew stronger and better than she had ever expected to be again, and
+those who had only known the pale, harassed-looking needlewoman of
+Croydon would not have recognized her now; indeed, as George said
+sometimes, his mother looked younger and younger every day. She had
+married very young, and was still scarcely five-and-thirty, and
+although she laughed and said that George was a foolish boy when he
+said that people always took her for his sister, she really looked
+some years younger than she was. Her step had regained its elasticity,
+and there was a ring of gladness and happiness in her voice which was
+very attractive, and even strangers sometimes looked round as they
+passed the bright, pleasant-looking woman chatting gayly with the two
+healthy, good-looking young fellows.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V.
+
+AN ADVENTURE.
+
+
+In August the annual outing, or, as it was called, the bean-feast, at
+the works took place. Usually the men went in vans down into Epping
+Forest; but this year it was determined that a steamer should be
+engaged to take the whole party with their wives and families down to
+Gravesend. They were to make an early start, and on arriving there all
+were to do as they pleased until they assembled to dine in a pavilion
+at one of the hotels. After this they were to go to the gardens and
+amuse themselves there until the steamer started in the evening. The
+party embarked at Blackwell at ten o'clock in the morning. George and
+Bill got together up in the bow of the steamer, and were delighted
+with their voyage down, their only regret being that Mrs. Andrews had
+declined to accompany them, saying that she would far rather go with
+them alone than with so large a party.
+
+"What shall we do, Bill?" George said, when they landed. "We are not
+to dine till two, so we have two good hours before us. I vote we hire
+a boat and go out. It will be ten times as jolly here as up in that
+crowded river by London."
+
+This was said in reference to various short rows which they had had
+in boats belonging to barges which had been sometimes lent them for
+half an hour of an evening by a good-natured bargeman as they hung
+about the wharves.
+
+"I suppose you can row, young chaps?" the waterman, whom they hired
+the boat of, said.
+
+"Oh, yes, we can row!" George replied with the confidence of youth.
+
+"Mind the tide is running out strong," the waterman said.
+
+"All right, we will mind," George answered, scarce heeding his words;
+and getting out the oars they pushed off.
+
+For some little time they rowed among the anchored vessels, both being
+especially filled with delight at the yachts moored opposite the
+clubhouses. These were new craft to them, and the beauty and neatness
+of everything struck them with surprise and admiration. Tide had only
+turned a short time before they got into their boat, and while keeping
+near the shore they had no difficulty in rowing against it.
+
+Presently they determined to have a look at a fine East-Indiaman
+moored well out in the stream a short distance below Gravesend. They
+ceased rowing when they approached her, and sat idly on their oars
+talking over the distant voyage on which she was probably about to
+start, and the country she might visit, George was telling his
+companion the ports she would touch if her destination was China, and
+absorbed in their conversation they paid no attention to anything
+else, until George gave a sudden exclamation.
+
+"Good gracious, Bill! Why, the ship is ever so far behind. It is two
+miles, I should think, from the town. We must set to work or we shan't
+be back in time for dinner."
+
+The boys' knowledge of the navigation of the Thames was not sufficient
+to tell them that to row against tide it is necessary to keep close
+inshore, and turning the boat's head they set to work to row back in
+the middle of the river. Their knowledge of rowing was but slight, and
+the mere operation of their oars took up all their attention. They
+rowed away till their hands burned and the perspiration ran down their
+faces.
+
+After half an hour of this George looked round, thinking that he ought
+to be near to the vessel by this time. He uttered an exclamation of
+surprise and dismay. Neither the ship nor Gravesend were visible.
+Their puny efforts had availed nothing against the sweeping tide. They
+had already, without knowing it, swept round the turn in the river,
+and were now entering Sea Reach.
+
+"My goodness, Bill! what are we to do? Just look at that buoy; we are
+going past it as fast as a horse could trot. Look what a width the
+river is. What on earth are we to do?"
+
+"I have no idea," Bill replied. "Where shall we go to if we go on like
+this?"
+
+"Right out to sea, I should think," George said. "I do not know how
+far it is; but the river seems to get wider and wider in front."
+
+"Perhaps," Bill suggested, "the tide will turn again and take us
+back."
+
+"Not it," George said. "It was against us, you know, all the way down,
+and could only have turned a little while before we got in the boat.
+Look at that line of barges sailing down on the right-hand side. I
+vote we pull to them and ask the men what we had better do. Anyhow we
+could row to the land and get out there and wait till tide turns. It
+turned at about eleven, so that it will turn again somewhere about
+five. The steamer is not to start till eight, so we shall be back in
+plenty of time to catch it. We shall lose the dinner and the fun in
+the gardens, but that can't be helped."
+
+"That don't make no odds," Bill said cheerfully; "this is a regular
+venture, this is; but I say, shan't we have to pay a lot for the
+boat?"
+
+"Yes," George assented mournfully; "but perhaps the man will let us
+off cheap when he sees we couldn't help it. He looked a good-tempered
+sort of chap. Come, let us set to work. Every minute it is taking us
+further away."
+
+They set steadily to work. The boat was a large and heavy one, and
+their progress was by no means rapid.
+
+"How thick it's getting!" George exclaimed suddenly.
+
+"Aint it just!" Bill assented. "My eye, George, I can't see the
+barges!"
+
+Unobserved by them a fog had been steadily creeping up the river. They
+were just at its edge when they made the discovery. Another two
+minutes and it rolled thickly over them, and they could not see ten
+yards away. They looked at each other in silent bewilderment.
+
+"What's to be done, George?" Bill said at length in awe-struck tones.
+
+"I don't know, Bill; I haven't an idea. It's no use rowing, that I
+see, for we don't know which way the boat's head is pointing."
+
+"Well, it can't be helped," Bill said philosophically. "I am going to
+have a pipe. Oh, I say, aint my hands blistered!"
+
+"All right, you can have your pipe, Bill, but keep your oar in your
+hand to be ready to row."
+
+"What for?" Bill demanded. "I thought you said it warn't no use
+rowing!"
+
+"No more it is, Bill; but we must look out for those big buoys. If the
+tide were to sweep us against one of them we should capsize to a
+certainty. That must have been a big steamer," he went on, as the boat
+rolled suddenly. "It's lucky we were pretty well over towards the side
+of the river, before the fog came on. Listen--there's another. I can
+hear the beat of her engines. I have an idea, Bill!" he exclaimed
+suddenly. "We know the steamers were passing to the left of us when
+the fog came on. If we listen to their whistles and the sound of their
+paddles, and then row to the right, we shall get to the bank at last."
+
+"Yes, that's a good idea," Bill agreed, laying down the pipe he had
+just lighted. "There's a whistle over there."
+
+"Yes, and another the other way," George said, puzzled. "Why, how can
+that be! Oh, I suppose one is coming up the river and one down, but
+it's awfully confusing."
+
+It was so, but by dint of listening intently the boys gained some idea
+of the proper direction; but they could only row a few strokes at a
+time, being obliged to stop continually to listen for fresh guidance.
+
+Fortunately for them the fog lay low on the water, and the upper spars
+of the steamers were above it, and men placed there were able to
+direct those on deck as to their course. Had it not been for this the
+steamers must all have anchored. As it was they proceeded slowly and
+cautiously on their way, whistling freely to warn any small craft,
+that might be hidden in the fog, of their coming.
+
+Half an hour's rowing and the boys gave a simultaneous exclamation.
+The boat had quietly grounded on the edge of a mud flat. They could
+not see the bank, and had no idea how far distant it was. Bill at once
+offered to get overboard and reconnoiter, but George would not hear of
+it.
+
+"You might not be able to find your way back, Bill, or you might sink
+in the mud and not be able to get out again. No, we won't separate;
+and, look here, we must keep the boat afloat just at the edge of the
+mud. If we were to get left here we should not float again till tide
+comes up to us, and that wouldn't be till about two hours before high
+tide, and it won't be high, you know, until twelve o'clock at night."
+
+"I wish this fog would clear off!" Bill said, looking round at the
+wall of white vapor which surrounded them. "It regular confuses a
+chap. I say, I expect they are just sitting down to dinner at present.
+I feel awfully hungry."
+
+"It's no use thinking about that, Bill. We shall be a good deal more
+hungry before we are done; but I am so glad we have found the land and
+stopped going out to sea that I don't mind being hungry."
+
+"But I say, George, if this fog keeps on how are we to find our way
+back to Gravesend?"
+
+"The only way will be, Bill, to keep quite close to the edge of the
+mud--just as close as the boat will swim. That way, you know, we must
+come to Gravesend at last."
+
+"So we must. I didn't think of that. You have got a good head, George,
+you have. I should never have thought about the way to find the bank
+if it hadn't been for you, and might have gone on floating and
+floating till we was starved."
+
+"This fog can't last forever, Bill."
+
+"No, but I have known them last a week in London."
+
+"Yes, but not in August, Bill."
+
+"No, not in August," Bill assented; "but you see these here fogs may
+last just as long down here in August as they do in London in
+November."
+
+"I don't think so, Bill. Anyhow it doesn't matter to us; we have got
+the land for a guide, and I hope we shall be back in Gravesend before
+it's quite dark."
+
+"But if we don't, George?"
+
+"Well, if we don't we must run her ashore before it gets too dark, and
+wait till it is morning. We shall be all right if we keep quite cool
+and use our senses. If we had something to eat I shouldn't mind a bit,
+except that mother will be getting anxious about us. It's a regular
+adventure, and we shall have something to talk about for a long time.
+Look out, Bill, we must push her further off--she's getting aground!"
+
+For an hour they sat and chatted.
+
+"Hullo! what's that?" Bill exclaimed at last. "That's the rattle of a
+chain. I expect it's a barge anchoring somewhere near. Listen; I can
+hear voices. I vote we hollo."
+
+George lifted up his voice in a lusty shout. The shout was repeated
+not very far off, and was followed by the shout of "Who are you?"
+
+"We have drifted down from Gravesend and lost our way," George
+shouted back. "We will come on board if you will let us."
+
+"All right!" the voice replied; "I will go on shouting and you row to
+my voice."
+
+It was but a hundred yards, and then a voice close at hand said
+sharply:
+
+"Row bow hard or you will be across the chain."
+
+Bill rowed hard, and George, looking round, saw that they were close
+to the bows of a barge. Half a dozen more strokes and they were
+alongside. Bill seized a hand-rope and sprang onto the barge, and the
+boat was soon towing astern.
+
+"Well, young men, however did you manage to get here?" one of the
+bargemen asked. "It's lucky for you you weren't taken out to sea with
+the tide."
+
+George related the history of their voyage and how they had managed to
+reach the shore.
+
+"Well, you are good-plucked uns anyhow," the man said; "aint they,
+Jack? Most chaps your age would just have sat in the boat and howled,
+and a good many longshoremen too. You have done the best thing you
+could under the circumstances."
+
+"Where are we?" George asked.
+
+"You are on board the _Sarah and Jane_ topsail barge, that's where you
+are, about three parts down Sea Reach. We know our way pretty well
+even in a fog, but we agreed it was no use trying to find the Swashway
+with it as thick as this, so we brought up."
+
+"Where is the Swashway?" George asked.
+
+"The Swashway is a channel where the barges go when they are making
+for Sheerness. It's well buoyed out and easy enough to follow with the
+help of Sheerness lights on a dark night; but these fogs are worse
+than anything. It aint no use groping about for the buoy when you
+can't see ten yards ahead, and you might find yourself high and dry on
+the mud and have to wait till next tide. Mayhap this fog will clear
+off before evening, and we shall be able to work in; and now I expect
+you two young uns would like some grub. Come below."
+
+The two boys joyfully followed into the little cabin, and were soon
+satisfying their hunger on bread and cold meat. The bargee drew a jug
+of water from the breaker and placed it before them.
+
+"The fire has gone out," he said, "or I would give yer a cup of
+tea--that's our tipple; we don't keep spirits on board the _Sarah and
+Jane_. I like a drop on shore, but it aint stuff to have on a barge,
+where you wants your senses handy at all times. And now what are you
+thinking of doing?" he asked when the boys had finished.
+
+"What we had made up our minds to do was to lie where we were at the
+edge of the mud till tide turned, and then to keep as close to the
+shore as we could until we got back to Gravesend. The steamer we came
+by does not go back till late, and we thought we should be back by
+that time."
+
+"No, you wouldn't," the man said. "Out in the middle of the stream you
+would be back in two hours easy, but not close inshore. The tide
+don't help you much there, and half your time you are in eddies and
+back-currents. No, you wouldn't be back in Gravesend by eight noway."
+
+"Then what would you advise us to do?"
+
+"Well, just at present I won't give no advice at all. We will see how
+things are going after a bit. Now let's take a look round."
+
+So saying he climbed the ladder to the deck, followed by the boys. The
+white fog still shut the boat in like a curtain.
+
+"What do you think of it, Jack?"
+
+"Don't know," the other replied. "Thought just now there was a puff of
+air coming down the river. I wish it would, or we shan't make
+Sheerness to-night, much less Rochester. Yes, that's a puff sure
+enough. You are in luck, young uns. Like enough in half an hour there
+will be a brisk wind blowing, driving all this fog out to sea before
+it."
+
+Another and another puff came, and tiny ripples swept across the
+oil-like face of the water.
+
+"It's a-coming, sure enough," the bargeman said. "I'd bet a pot of
+beer as the fog will have lifted in a quarter of an hour."
+
+Stronger and stronger came the puffs of wind.
+
+The fog seemed as if stirred by an invisible hand. It was no longer a
+dull, uniform whitish-gray; dark shadows seemed to flit across it, and
+sometimes the view of the water extended here and there.
+
+"There's the shore!" Bill exclaimed suddenly, but ere George could
+turn round to look it was gone again.
+
+"I shall have the anchor up directly, lads. Now I tell you what will
+be the best thing for you if the wind holds, as I expect it will. We
+shall be at Sheerness in little over an hour--that will make it four
+o'clock," he added, consulting his watch, "and the young flood will be
+coming up soon afterwards, and I shall go up with the first of it to
+Rochester. We shall get there maybe somewhere about seven o'clock. Now
+the best thing I can do for you is to tow that ere boat up to
+Rochester with me, and you can get a train there that will take you up
+to town in goodish time."
+
+"You are very kind," George said; "but what are we to do about the
+boat?"
+
+"I shall be going back to-morrow night, or more likely next morning,
+and I will take her along and hand her over to her rightful owner at
+Gravesend."
+
+"James Kitson."
+
+"Yes, I know him."
+
+"But how about paying for it?" George said. "I am afraid he will
+expect a great deal of money, for it has been away all the time, and
+we have only got six shillings between us."
+
+"You will want that to get up to town. Never mind about the boat. I
+will put that square for you. I will tell Kitson as how you have been
+shipwrecked, and he will think himself precious lucky in getting the
+boat without being damaged. If I take the trouble to tow it up to
+Rochester and back, he needn't grumble about getting no fare."
+
+"I would rather pay something," George said; "though, you see, we
+can't afford to pay much."
+
+"Well, then, you send him a post-office order for five bob. I will
+tell him you are going to send him that, and he will thank his stars
+he has got so well out of it. If you had drifted out to sea, as he
+expects you have by this time, and the boat didn't get smashed by a
+steamer, you would likely enough have been taken off by one of them;
+but the captain wouldn't have troubled himself about that old tub. I
+looks upon Kitson as being in luck this job, so don't you worry about
+him. There, the mist's driving off fast. We will up with the kedge."
+
+The boys lent a hand at the windlass, and the anchor was soon hanging
+from the bow. Then the brail of the mainsail was loosed, and the great
+sail shaken out. The foresail was hoisted, and in a few minutes the
+_Sarah and Jane_ was running before a brisk wind down Sea Reach.
+
+The fog had rolled off now, and it was clear astern, though a thick
+bank still hung over the river ahead, but this was rapidly melting
+away; and the bargeman, who told them his name was Will Atkins,
+pointed out a large building low down on the water ahead.
+
+"That's Sheerness Fort," he said. "You can lend Jack a hand to get up
+the topsail. The wind is rising every minute, and we shall soon be
+bowling along hand over hand."
+
+Both ahead and astern of them were a line of barges, which had, like
+the _Sarah and Jane_, anchored when the fog was thickest, and were,
+like her, making their way to Sheerness. The wind was blowing briskly
+now, and the barge made her way through the water at a rate which
+surprised the boys.
+
+"I had no idea that barges sailed so fast," George said.
+
+"There are not many craft can beat them," Atkins replied. "With a
+breeze so strong that they can only just carry their topsails, they
+will hold their own with pretty nigh anything afloat. There are mighty
+few yachts can keep alongside us when we are doing our best."
+
+As Atkins had predicted, in little over an hour they brought up just
+inside the mouth of the Medway, and dropped the anchor to wait till
+the tide turned to help them up to Rochester. At six o'clock they were
+again under way. The wind had fortunately veered round somewhat to the
+north of west, and they were able for the most part to lay their
+course, so that soon after seven they were abreast of the dockyard,
+and a few minutes later dropped anchor off Rochester.
+
+"Jump into the boat, boys," the good-natured bargeman said; "I will
+put you ashore at once. There is the station close to the end of the
+bridge."
+
+With many very hearty thanks for his kindness the lads jumped ashore
+and hurried up to the station. They found that there would be a train
+in half an hour, and by nine o'clock they arrived in town.
+
+Before they had landed the bargeman had scrawled on a piece of paper,
+"Your boat was picked up by the _Sarah and Jane_. Will bring her back
+on return trip. No damage done. William Atkins." This he had handed to
+the boys, and they now got an envelope and directed it to "James
+Kitson, Waterman, Gravesend," and posted it, and then set out to walk
+home.
+
+"It's not been the sort of day we expected," George said; "but it's
+been good fun, hasn't it?"
+
+"Grand!" Bill agreed. "But I didn't think so when we were in the
+middle of that fog listening to them whistles and trying to find out
+the way. I didn't say much, George, but I felt downright funky."
+
+"I didn't like it either, Bill. There was such a horribly lonely
+feeling, lost in the fog there; but it was all right as soon as we
+touched the mouth, and got an idea where we were. I was worrying most
+about mother getting anxious if we did not get back to-night, and a
+little about what we should have to pay for the boat. It was lucky
+that bargeman took the matter in his hands for us. I expect we should
+have had to pay over a pound. He was an awfully good fellow, wasn't
+he?"
+
+"I should just think he was," Bill said. "He was a good un, and no
+mistake. It aint cost us so very much either, considering."
+
+"That it hasn't, Bill. Two and threepence apiece railway fare, that's
+four and sixpence, and five bob we are to send down for the boat, nine
+shillings and sixpence. Well, we should have paid two shillings for
+the boat anyhow, and I expect we should have spent another shilling
+apiece in things at the gardens, perhaps more; that would make four
+shillings anyhow, so we have only spent about five shillings more than
+we calculated. And haven't we got a lot to talk about! It's been a
+regular adventure."
+
+"It has," Bill said doubtfully; "but I don't think I want many more of
+them kind of adventures. It's all right now, you know, but it wasn't
+jolly at the time. I always thought as adventures was jolly; but that
+didn't seem to me to have no jolliness about it, not when we was out
+there. It's all very well to hear tell of shipwrecks and fights with
+savages, but I expect there aint no larks about it at the time. I
+suppose you will send that five bob off to-morrow, and get it off your
+mind?"
+
+"No. Atkins said we had better not send it for another three or four
+days. The man will have got his boat back all right then, and the five
+bob would come upon him unexpectedly. He was going to tell Kitson that
+he had arranged with us that was what we were to pay, as we couldn't
+afford more; but he will never expect to get it, so when it comes he
+will be only too glad to receive it."
+
+They were met at the door of the house by Bob Grimstone, who was just
+coming out.
+
+"Why, what have you boys been up to?" he said angrily. "I have been
+wondering all day what has become of you, and the missis has done
+nothing but worry and fidget. It's regular spoilt the day. What have
+you been up to? I haven't seen you since we got ashore at Gravesend,
+and I have just come round to ask your mother if she has heard of
+you."
+
+"I am very sorry, Bob, but it wasn't our fault, at least it was not
+altogether our fault. We went for a row, and the tide took us down,
+and then the fog came on and we got lost."
+
+"I expected better of you," Grimstone said angrily. "Foggy, indeed!
+I've been anxious and worried all day. I did think as you warn't like
+other boys, but could be trusted, and then you go and play such a
+prank as this. Well, go in; your mother is in a nice taking about
+you."
+
+"My dear mother," George said as he ran in, "I am so sorry you have
+been uneasy about us, awfully sorry; but really it hasn't been our
+fault altogether."
+
+"Never mind that now, George," Mrs. Andrews said, throwing her arms
+round his neck. "Fortunately I did not know anything about it till Mr.
+Grimstone came in a few minutes ago. I had been expecting you in for
+some little time, but I supposed the steamer was late, and I was not
+at all uneasy till Mr. Grimstone came in and said that he had not
+seen either of you since the steamer got to Gravesend, and that you
+had not come back with the rest. Is Bill with you?"
+
+"Yes, mother; he is at the door talking to Bob."
+
+"Ask Mr. Grimstone to come in again," Mrs. Andrews said. "He has been
+most kind, and he had promised to go down to Gravesend by the first
+train in the morning if you did not come home to-night, and to make
+inquiries about you there. He tried to cheer me up by saying that as
+you were together nothing could very well happen to you and that
+probably you had only got into some boyish scrape--perhaps, he
+suggested, only gone out into the country and had helped yourselves to
+some apples, and had so got locked up."
+
+Bob, however, would not come in again, but went off saying he would
+hear all about it in the morning, but would go off to tell his wife at
+once that they had returned safely, for "that she was in such a worry
+as never was."
+
+Hearing that the boys had had nothing to eat since two o'clock, Mrs.
+Andrews at once laid the table for supper; and when they had finished
+it listened to George's account of their adventure.
+
+"You had a very narrow escape, boys," she said when they had finished.
+"You might have been swept out to sea, or run down by a steamer in the
+fog. I hope to-night that you will neither of you forget to thank God
+for his protection through the danger you have run; and I do hope, my
+dear boys, that you will be more careful in future."
+
+The next evening, after work was over, George went in to Bob
+Grimstone's and told them all that had happened. When the story was
+told, Bob agreed that after all it was not altogether their fault, and
+that, indeed, they had, in some respects, justified his opinion of
+them. Mrs. Grimstone, however, was not so easily pacified. They had
+come back, she said; but it was more than likely that they wouldn't
+have come back at all, but might have been drifting out far at sea,
+perhaps cutting each other's throats and eating each other alive,
+which was, as the good woman said, what she had heard happened when
+boats were lost at sea.
+
+Two days later they sent off the money to the waterman, and received
+in reply a letter from him saying that the boat had been brought
+safely back by the _Sarah and Jane_ and that he was glad to get the
+five shillings.
+
+"Bill Atkins told me as you said you would send it; but knowing what
+boys is, I say fair as I didn't expect to see the color of your money.
+It aint everyone as would have paid up when they got safe away, and I
+consider as you have behaved handsome."
+
+They had heard from Atkins of the wharf off which the _Sarah and Jane_
+might generally be found moored, between her cruises, and after one or
+two ineffectual attempts they one day found the barge there when they
+rowed up to the spot. She had but just returned from a trip to
+Rochester and Bill Atkins was still on board. He was very glad to see
+the boys, but they had great difficulty in persuading him to accept a
+pound of tobacco which their mother had sent off to him with her
+compliments as a token of gratitude for his kindness to them.
+
+"Well, young chaps, I didn't look for nothing of the sort, but seeing
+as your mother has got it for me it wouldn't be manners to say no.
+Well, look here, any time as you are disposed for a sail down to
+Rochester and back you're free of the _Sarah and Jane_, and heartily
+glad shall I be to have you with me."
+
+The boys thanked him for the offer, but said as they were still at
+work there was but small chance of their being able to accept it, but
+that they should be glad to come and have a chat with him sometimes
+when he was in the Pool.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI.
+
+FIRE!
+
+
+One Saturday evening early in October the boys had been for a long
+walk down among the marshes. They had told Mrs. Andrews they would be
+late, and it was past eight o'clock when they came along past the
+works.
+
+"We shan't get home at this hour again for some time, I expect,"
+George said, "for they say that we are going to begin to work overtime
+on Monday, and that the orders are so heavy that it will very likely
+have to be kept up all through the winter."
+
+"I am glad it didn't begin earlier," Bill replied; "it would have been
+horrid if we had lost all our walks while the weather was fine. How
+dark the place looks how it's shut up, and how quiet and still it is
+after the rattle we are accustomed to!"
+
+"Stop a moment," George said, putting his hand on his arm.
+
+"What is it, George?"
+
+"I don't know. It seemed to me, for a moment, as if I saw the big
+stack clearly and then it was dark again."
+
+"How could that be, George?"
+
+"I don't know; it looked to me as if it was a reflection of light
+from one of the windows at the back there. There it is again."
+
+"Yes, I saw it," Bill agreed. "What can it be?"
+
+"I don't know, Bill; let's run around to the back. There might
+be--it's awful to think of--but there might be a fire."
+
+The boys ran down a narrow lane by the side of the works onto a piece
+of waste ground behind.
+
+"Look, Bill, look at the glare in the molding-room. There must be
+fire. Here, help to put this bit of old timber against the wall."
+
+The piece of wood was placed into position, the two lads climbed up it
+onto the wall, and dropped into the yard within. Just as they did so
+there was a clatter of falling glass, followed by a glare of light as
+a body of flame burst out from one of the windows.
+
+"Let's ring the dinner-bell, Bill; that will call people's attention,
+and then we must do the best we can."
+
+They ran along until they reached the front gate, and then, seizing
+the bell-rope, rang it violently.
+
+In a minute or two there was a clatter of feet outside, and shouts of
+"What's the matter?"
+
+"There is a fire in the molding-room," George shouted; "run for the
+engines, someone, and break the gate open. Now come on, Bill."
+
+The two boys ran towards that part of the building where the flames
+had been seen, broke a window, and climbed in. There was an almost
+stifling smell of burning wood and at a door at the end of the
+planing-room they could see a light flame flickering through the
+cracks of the door leading into the molding-room, which was next to
+it.
+
+"Quick, Bill, screw that leather pipe onto the hydrant. We must stop
+it from getting through here till the engines come."
+
+The hydrant communicated with the great tank at the top of the
+building, and as soon as the hose was screwed on and Bill stood with
+the nozzle directed towards the burning door, George turned the cock
+and volumes of water flew out.
+
+The first result seemed disastrous. The door was already nearly burned
+through, and, as the powerful jet flew against it, it seemed to
+crumble away and a mass of flame darted out from the molding-room. The
+joists and timbers supporting the floor above the planing-room would
+have caught at once, but the boys deluged them with water, as also the
+framework of the door, and then, throwing the stream of water into the
+blazing workshop, they kept down the flames near the door. The smoke
+was stifling.
+
+"We shall be choked, George!" Bill gasped.
+
+"Lie down, Bill. I have heard the air is always better near the
+ground."
+
+This they found to be the case, and they were still able to direct the
+jet of water. But three or four minutes had elapsed when the outer
+door of the planing-house was unlocked and Bob Grimstone and several
+other men rushed in, but were at once driven back by the smoke. George
+had recognized Grimstone's voice, and shouted:
+
+"This way, Bob, the fire hasn't got through yet. Come and lend a hand,
+for it's gaining on us in spite of the water. You can breathe if you
+kneel down."
+
+Grimstone, with two or three of the men, crawled in and joined the
+boys.
+
+"What! is it you, George? How on earth did you get here?" Bob
+exclaimed.
+
+"We saw a light as we were passing, and got in from behind. When we
+saw what it was we rang the alarm-bell, and then came on here to do
+what we could till help came."
+
+"You are good-plucked, you are," Grimstone said admiringly; "but I am
+afraid it's not much good."
+
+"You take the hose, Bob, and keep the rafters drenched there. Bill and
+I will crawl forward and clear the shavings out of the way if we can.
+They have caught half a dozen times already."
+
+The two boys crawled forward, and although the heat was tremendous
+they managed to clear away the shavings for a considerable distance.
+The smoke and heat were so great that they were obliged to crawl back
+into the outer air, where for a while they lay almost insensible.
+There were crowds of men in the yard now, but most of them were round
+at the back, powerless to aid at present, and only watching the
+flames as they roared through the whole of the windows of the
+molding-room.
+
+Men were hurrying past with buckets of water, and one of them, seeing
+the condition of the boys, dashed some over their heads and faces, and
+they presently staggered to their feet. It was now a quarter of an
+hour since they had first given the alarm, and they were just about to
+re-enter the planing-shop to rejoin Bill when they met him and his
+comrades coming out.
+
+"All the water's gone," he said; "if the engines aint here in a minute
+or two it will be too late."
+
+But just at that moment there was a cheer outside, and immediately
+afterwards a fire-engine dashed through the gate. Grimstone ran up to
+the firemen as they leaped off.
+
+"The great thing," he said, "is to prevent it spreading from that shop
+into this. We have been keeping it back till now, but the tank has
+just run dry."
+
+While the other firemen were fitting the hose to the fire-plug just
+outside the gates one of them made his way into the planing-room to
+ascertain the exact position of affairs.
+
+"Quick, lads," he said; "there's no time to be lost; the fire is
+making its way through. Another five minutes and we should have been
+too late to save any of this block. Is there any communication through
+the upper floors?" he asked Grimstone.
+
+"Yes, there is a door on each floor,"
+
+"Have you got any empty sacks about the place?"
+
+"Yes, there is a pile of them in there."
+
+The fireman gave instructions to one of his comrades, while he himself
+made his way into the planing-room with the hose; the other got out
+the sacks, and assisted by Grimstone and some of the hands drenched
+them with water, and then proceeding to the door on the first floor
+piled them against it.
+
+"It is hot already," he said as he laid his hand upon it. "Now, do you
+men bring me buckets of water. Keep the sacks drenched till another
+engine comes up."
+
+George and Bill, finding they could be of no more use, made their way
+out to the back and joined the crowd watching the flames, which had
+already spread to the first floor. They were, however, with the rest
+of the lookers-on, speedily turned out of the yard by the police, who,
+having now arrived in sufficient strength, proceeded at once to clear
+the premises of all save a score or two of men who were engaged in
+assisting the firemen.
+
+As the boys went out through the front gate another engine dashed up
+at full speed, dropping lighted cinders on its way.
+
+"Hurray!" Bill said; "this is a steamer. I expect they will do now."
+
+Then the boys made their way round again to the back, and by means of
+the pieces of timber established themselves on the wall, where they
+were soon joined by a number of others, and watched the struggle with
+the flames.
+
+In half an hour six engines were on the spot; but even this force had
+no visible effect upon the flames in that portion of the building in
+which they had taken possession, and the firemen turned the whole of
+their efforts to prevent it from spreading.
+
+The party wall dividing it from the main building was a very strong
+one; but so hot had it become that the floor boards touching it were
+over and over again in flames.
+
+A score of men with saws and axes cut away the flooring adjoining the
+doors on the first and second stories. The planing-room was
+fortunately not boarded. While a portion of the fire brigade worked
+unceasingly in preventing the spread of the flames in this direction,
+the rest turned their attention to the great wood piles, which were
+repeatedly ignited by the fragments of burning wood.
+
+Presently the roof fell in, and the flames shot up high into the air,
+but grand as the sight was, the boys did not wait any longer looking
+on. Their faces smarted severely from the heat to which they had been
+exposed; their hands had been a good deal burned by the shavings;
+their hair, eyebrows, and eyelashes were singed, and the eyeballs
+ached with the glare.
+
+"I will run home now, Bill; mother will likely enough hear of the
+fire, and as we said we should be back soon after eight she will be
+getting anxious."
+
+"I will go and tell her it's all right; you stop and see the end of it
+here."
+
+But this George would not hear of.
+
+"Very well, then, I will go with you. I must get some grease or
+something to put on my face and hands; they are smarting awfully."
+
+Mrs. Andrews gave an exclamation of surprise and alarm as the boys
+entered. The irritation of the wood smoke had so much inflamed their
+eyes that they could scarcely see out of them, and their faces looked
+like pieces of raw beef.
+
+"Whatever has happened, boys?" she exclaimed.
+
+"There's a great fire at Penrose's, mother; it broke out just as we
+were passing, so we stopped to help for a bit, and then came home to
+tell you, thinking that you might be anxious."
+
+"A fire at the works!" Mrs. Andrews exclaimed; "that is dreadful.
+Dreadful for Mr. Penrose, and for all of you who work there; more,
+perhaps, for you than for him, for no doubt he is insured, and you may
+be out of work for months. Thank God I have plenty of work, so I dare
+say we shall be able to tide it over."
+
+"It is not all burned, mother; only the molding-shop and the floors
+above it are on fire at present, and as there are six fire-engines at
+work, and they keep on arriving every minute, I hope they will save
+the rest; and now, mother, what can we do to our faces and hands, they
+are smarting awfully?"
+
+"Dear me, George, are you burnt? I thought you were only dreadfully
+hot."
+
+"We feel hot, mother, just as if our faces were being roasted."
+
+"I will get some oil, that will be the best thing," Mrs. Andrews said,
+hurrying away to the kitchen, and coming back with a piece of
+cotton-wool, and some olive-oil in a cup.
+
+"You are burned, George. Why, child, your hair is all singed, and your
+eyebrows and eyelashes. Why, what have you been doing to yourselves?
+There could have been no occasion to put your heads into the flames
+like that. Why, your hands are worse still; they are quite blistered.
+I had better wrap them up in cotton-wool."
+
+"It's the inside that's the worst, mother; perhaps if you put a bit of
+cotton-wool there and tie it round the back it will do; we can't go
+out with our hands all swaddled round like that. And now, please,
+directly you have done we want to go down again to see the fire. Just
+you go up to the road corner, mother. It's a grand sight, I can tell
+you."
+
+"We will have tea first," Mrs. Andrews said decidedly; "everything has
+been ready except pouring the water in since eight o'clock, and it's a
+quarter past nine now. After we have done I will put on my bonnet and
+walk down with you as near as I can get. I am not going to lose you
+out of my sight again."
+
+So after their meal they went down together, but could not get
+anywhere near the works, all the approaches now being guarded by the
+police. It was a grand sight, but the worst was over, and there was a
+general feeling of confidence in the crowd that it would spread no
+further. A dozen engines were at work now. Some of the firemen were on
+the roof, some on the stacks of timber, which looked red-hot from the
+deep glow from the fire. The flames were intermittent now, sometimes
+leaping up high above the shell of the burned-out buildings, then
+dying down again.
+
+"Thank God it's no worse!" Mrs. Andrews said fervently. "It would have
+been a bad winter for a great many down here if the fire had spread;
+as it is, not a quarter of the buildings are burned."
+
+"No, nothing like that, mother; not above a tenth, I should say. It's
+lucky that there was a strong wall between that and the next shops, or
+it must all have gone. I have heard them say that part was added on
+five or six years ago, so that the wall at the end of the planing-shop
+was an outside wall before; that accounts for its being so thick."
+
+After looking on for about half an hour they went back home. But
+neither of the boys got much sleep that night, the excitement they had
+gone through and the pain of their burns keeping them wide awake till
+nearly morning. As Mrs. Andrews heard no movement in their
+rooms--whereas they were usually up and about almost as early on
+Sundays as on other days, being unable to sleep after their usual
+hour for rising--she did not disturb them. George was the first to
+awake, and looking out of the window felt sure by the light that it
+was later than usual. He put his head out of the door and shouted:
+
+"Bill, are you up?" There was no answer. "Mother, are you up; what
+o'clock is it?"
+
+"Up! hours ago, George. Why, it's past eleven!"
+
+George gave an exclamation of astonishment and rushed into Bill's
+room. The latter had woke at his shout.
+
+"It's past eleven, Bill, and mother has been up for hours;" and he
+dashed off again to his room to dress. It was but a few minutes before
+they came downstairs just at the same moment.
+
+"Why didn't you wake us, mother?"
+
+"Because I thought it better to let you sleep on, George. I guessed
+that your burns had kept you awake for some time."
+
+"That they did. I thought I was never going to get to sleep," George
+said; and Bill gave a similar account of himself. "Still, mother, a
+short night does no harm for once, and you haven't been able to get to
+church."
+
+"It does not matter for once, George. What figures you both are!"
+
+"We are figures," George said ruefully. "I hardly knew myself when I
+looked in the glass. My eyes are almost shut up, and the skin is
+peeling off my nose, and my hair is all rough and scrubby; and Bill
+looks as bad as I do. You are a figure, Bill!" and George burst into a
+fit of laughter.
+
+"He's no worse than you, George; but come along, breakfast is
+waiting."
+
+"You haven't waited breakfast for us, I hope, mother?"
+
+"I made myself a cup of tea the first thing, boys, and had a slice of
+bread and butter, for I thought you might not be down for some time;
+but I am quite ready to join you; we have got fish. I put them down
+directly you called."
+
+"Well, I am glad you are not starving, mother; and I am glad too you
+didn't have your regular breakfast. It would have been horrid to sit
+down on Sunday morning without you, when it's the only regular
+breakfast we get in the week."
+
+Just as they had finished their meal there was a knock at the door. It
+was Bob Grimstone. Bill opened the door.
+
+"Well, how are you to-day, lad? I thought I would just come round and
+see. You look pretty badly burned; and so do you, George," he added,
+as he followed Bill into the sitting room.
+
+"Good-day, Mrs. Andrews."
+
+"Good-morning, Mr. Grimstone," Mrs. Andrews said. Since her coming the
+Grimstones had several times come in on Sunday afternoon to Laburnum
+Villas. Mrs. Andrews would, indeed, have wished them to come in more
+frequently, for she felt much indebted to them for their kindness to
+George, and, moreover, liked them for themselves, for both were good
+specimens of their class.
+
+"I see you were busy last night too, Mr. Grimstone; your face looks
+scorched; but you did not manage to get yourself burned as these silly
+boys did. What a blessing it is for us all that the fire did not
+spread!"
+
+"Well, Mrs. Andrews, I don't think those two lads can have told you
+what they did, for if they had you would hardly call them silly boys."
+
+Mrs. Andrews looked surprised.
+
+"They told me they lent a hand to put out the fire--I think those were
+George's words--but they did not tell me anything else."
+
+"They saved the building, ma'am. If it hadn't been for them there
+would not have been a stick or stone of Penrose's standing now; the
+shops and the wood piles would all have gone, and we should all have
+been idle for six months to come; there is no doubt about that at
+all."
+
+"Why, how was that, Mr. Grimstone? How was it they did more than
+anyone else?"
+
+"In the first place they discovered it, ma'am, and rung the
+alarm-bell; it mightn't have been found out for another five minutes,
+and five minutes would have been enough for the fire. In the next
+place, when they had given the alarm they did the only thing that
+could have saved the place: they got into the planing-shop and turned
+on the hose there, and fought the fire from spreading through the
+door till we got in seven or eight minutes later. It was all we could
+do to stop it then; but if they hadn't done what they did the
+planing-shop would have been alight from end to end, and the floors
+above it too, before the first engine arrived, and then nothing could
+have saved the whole lot. I can tell you, Mrs. Andrews, that there
+isn't a man on the works, nor the wife of a man, who doesn't feel that
+they owe these two lads their living through the winter. I don't know
+what Mr. Penrose will say about it, but I know what we all feel."
+
+"Why, George," Mrs. Andrews said, while her eyes were filled with
+happy tears at the praises of her son, "why did you not tell me about
+it?"
+
+"Why, mother, there was not anything to tell," George said, "and Bob
+has made a great fuss about nothing. As I told you, we saw a light as
+we came along and when we went round behind and got on the wall we saw
+the place was on fire, so we rang the alarm-bell, and then turned on
+the hose and flooded the place with water till Bob and some more came
+to help us."
+
+"It sounds very simple, Mrs. Andrews, but I can tell you it wasn't so.
+When we opened the door of the planing-shop it was so full of smoke
+that it didn't seem as if anyone could breathe there for a minute, and
+as we could see the glare of the flames at the other end we thought
+the place was gone. We should have gone out and waited for the engines
+if we hadn't heard the boys sing out that they were there; and even
+though we knelt down and crawled in, as they shouted to us to do, we
+were pretty nearly stifled. When we took the hose they crawled forward
+and got the shavings cleared away; that was how they burned their
+hands, I expect; and I hear they tumbled down insensible when they got
+out. Now, ma'am, they may make light of it, but if ever two young
+chaps behaved like heroes they did, and you have every right to be
+proud of them--I say of them, because although Bill's no son of yours
+I know he is what you and your boy have made him. He was telling me
+about it one day."
+
+"Will work go on to-morrow as usual, Bob?" George asked, in order to
+change the subject.
+
+"In some of the shops it will, no doubt," Bob said; "but in our shop
+and the floors above it it will take a day or two to clear up. I saw
+the foreman just now, and he tells me that a strong gang of carpenters
+will be put on, for both the floors are burned away at the end of the
+wall and pretty near twenty feet of the roof are charred. Two
+surveyors are coming down this afternoon to examine the wall and say
+whether it is safe. The walls of the shops that are burned out must
+come down, of course. The surveyor says that if the wall at the end of
+the planing-room looks pretty strong they will build up another wall
+against it as soon as it gets cold enough and the rubbish is cleared
+away for men to work; that will make a strong job of it, and there
+won't be any loss of time. Of course if the old one has to come down
+there can't be much work done in the shops till it's finished. The
+governor got down about ten o'clock last night. A messenger went up to
+him almost directly after the fire broke out, but he was out at
+dinner, and by the time he got down here all danger of it spreading
+was over. He had a talk with the foreman and arranged about the wall
+with him. He is as anxious as we are that there should be no delay,
+for there are some heavy orders in, and, of course, he doesn't want
+them taken anywhere else."
+
+"Will you look at their hands, Mr. Grimstone. I don't know much about
+it, but they seem to be badly burned."
+
+"That they are, ma'am," Mr. Grimstone said when he had examined them;
+"pretty nigh raw. If I might give an opinion, I should say as the
+doctor had better see them; they are precious painful, aint they,
+George?"
+
+"They do feel as if they were on fire, Bob, but I don't see any use in
+a doctor. I don't suppose he can do more than mother has."
+
+"Perhaps not, George, but he had better see them for all that; he may
+give you some cooling lotion for them, and I can tell you burns on the
+hand are apt to be serious matters, for the muscles of the fingers may
+get stiffened. I have known two or three cases like that. You had
+better go at once to Dr. Maxwell; he always attends if there are any
+accidents at the works. You know the house, George; it is about
+halfway between this and the works."
+
+"Yes, you had better go at once, boys," Mrs. Andrews said; "there, put
+on your hats and be off."
+
+"I will walk with them. I must be off anyway, for the missis will be
+waiting dinner for me."
+
+"Are we to pay, mother?"
+
+"No, not till you have done, George. I dare say you will have to have
+your hands dressed several times."
+
+"There won't be any occasion to pay him, Mrs. Andrews. The firm always
+pays the doctor in case of accidents, and you may be very sure that in
+this case they will be only too glad."
+
+"Well, in any case, George," Mrs. Andrews said, "you can tell the
+doctor that you will pay when he says that you need not come to him
+again. If Mr. Penrose hears about it and chooses to pay I should not
+think of refusing, as you have been burned in his service; but
+certainly I should not assume that he will do so."
+
+"Shall I go in with you, boys?" Bob asked when they reached the door.
+"I know the doctor; he attended me two years ago when I pretty nigh
+had my finger taken off by one of the cutters."
+
+"Yes, please, Bob, I wish you would."
+
+They were shown into the surgery, where the doctor soon joined them.
+
+"I've brought these two young chaps for you to look at their hands,
+Dr. Maxwell. They got them burnt last night at the fire. Mrs.
+Andrews, the mother of this lad, wished me to say that she would pay
+the charges when you have done with them; but as if it hadn't been for
+them the works would have been burnt down as sure as you are standing
+there, I expect the firm will take the matter in their own hands."
+
+"Yes, they are nasty burns," the doctor said, examining the boys'
+hands. "Can you open and shut them, boy?"
+
+"I think I could if tried, sir," George said, "but I shouldn't like to
+try, for if I move my fingers at all it hurts them awfully."
+
+"I see you have had oil and cotton-wool on your hands."
+
+"Yes."
+
+"The best thing you can do, boys, is to put on some soothing
+poultices. Tell your mother to get some linseed and mix it with
+olive-oil. I will give you a bottle of laudanum. Let her put about
+twenty drops of that into the oil before she mixes it with the
+linseed. Every four or five hours change the poultices. I think you
+will find that will relieve the pain a good deal. I see your faces are
+scorched too. You can do nothing better than keep them moistened with
+sweet-oil. I should advise you to keep as quiet as possible for three
+or four days."
+
+"But we shall want to get to work, sir," George said.
+
+"Nonsense! You will be very lucky if you can use your hands in
+another fortnight. I will send in the usual certificate to the works."
+
+"Will you tell the foreman, Bob," George said when they left the
+doctor's, "how it is we can't come to work? You tell him we wanted to,
+and that we hope to come back as soon as our hands are all right;
+because, you see, the men and boys at the shops which have been burnt
+down will be all out of work, and it would be awful if we found our
+places filled up when we went to work again."
+
+"Don't you be afraid, George; there is no fear of your being out of
+work after what you have done."
+
+"Well, what did the doctor say?" was Mrs. Andrews' first question when
+they returned home.
+
+"He didn't say much, mother, except that we must not think of going to
+work for a fortnight anyhow, and we are to have poultices made with
+linseed mixed with oil, and twenty drops of laudanum from this bottle,
+and it must be put on fresh every three or four hours. I am afraid it
+will be an awful trouble."
+
+"The trouble won't matter," Mrs. Andrews said brightly. "Did he say
+you were to go to bed?"
+
+"No, mother; but we were to keep as quiet as we could."
+
+"Then in that case, George, I think you had better go to bed."
+
+"No; I am sure we had better not," George said. "I should toss and
+fidget about there horridly. The best thing will be for us to sit
+here, and then we shall be all together. And if you talk to us, and
+perhaps read to us, we shan't feel it half so much. What are you going
+to do, mother?" he asked five minutes afterwards, as Mrs. Andrews came
+down with her bonnet on.
+
+"I am going to get some linseed, George, of course. I haven't got any
+in the house."
+
+"But it's Sunday, mother, and the shops will be shut."
+
+"I shall get it at the chemist's, George. They will always supply
+things that are needed even on Sunday. People are ill on Sunday as
+well as any other day, you know. I shan't be gone more than a quarter
+of an hour. You must keep very quiet till I come back."
+
+The boys found a good deal of relief from the effect of the poultices,
+and were very much better after a good night's rest. At ten o'clock
+the next morning, as Mrs. Andrews was sitting at her work, with the
+boys both on the hearthrug in front of the fire, there was a knock at
+the door. It was a loud double knock, quite unlike the ordinary
+summons of the baker's boy, who was the only regular caller. The boys
+jumped up in surprise.
+
+"Who can that be, mother?"
+
+"We shall soon see," Mrs. Andrews said quietly.
+
+She was not surprised, on opening the door, to see a gentleman
+standing there, whom, by the description the boys had given of him,
+she guessed to be their employer. A little girl was standing by his
+side.
+
+"Is this Mrs. Andrews?" the gentleman asked.
+
+"I am Mrs. Andrews," the lady answered quietly.
+
+"My name is Penrose. I have called with my daughter to inquire after
+the two lads--one of them your son, I believe--who so gallantly saved
+my place from being burned down on Saturday evening. I only heard
+about it late yesterday evening, when I came down to arrange about
+some matters with the foreman. He did not know the facts of the case
+on Saturday night, but had learned them yesterday, and there can be no
+doubt whatever, from what he says, that had it not been for the
+presence of mind and bravery of these two lads nothing could have
+saved the entire works and all the wood piles from destruction. I told
+my daughter this morning, and she insisted on coming down with me. You
+know she is already indebted to your son for saving a locket which we
+both greatly valued."
+
+"Will you walk in, sir?" and Mrs. Andrews showed them into the sitting
+room.
+
+Mr. Penrose had been somewhat surprised by Mrs. Andrews' manner,
+although the foreman, in telling him of the boys' conduct, had also
+stated what he knew about them.
+
+"They are out-of-the-way sort of boys, sir," he said. "There was quite
+a talk about them in the shops in the spring. They lodged with
+Grimstone, and it seems that after they had been here at work five
+months Andrews' mother, who had been ill, was coming to them, and they
+got Grimstone to take a house for them, and it turned out that ever
+since they had been at work here they had been putting by half their
+wages to furnish a place for her, so they must have lived on about
+five shillings a week each and got clothes for themselves out of it.
+Now, sir, boys as would do that aint ordinary boys, and there was
+quite a talk among the men about it. I hear from Grimstone that Mrs.
+Andrews is a superior sort of person, he says quite a lady. She does
+work, I believe, for some London shop."
+
+Mr. Penrose, therefore, was prepared to find the boys in a more
+comfortable abode than usual, and their mother what the foreman called
+a superior sort of woman; but he perceived at once by her address that
+Grimstone's estimate had been a correct one, and that she was indeed a
+lady. The prettiness of the little sitting room, with its comfortable
+furniture, its snowy curtains and pretty belongings, heightened this
+feeling.
+
+"I have come to see you, boys," he said, "and to tell you how indebted
+I feel to you for your exertions on Saturday. There is no doubt that
+had it not been for you the place would have been entirely burned. It
+was fully insured, but it would have been a serious matter for me, as
+I should have lost four or five months' work, and it would have been
+still more serious for the men to have been thrown out of employment
+at this time of the year, so we all feel very much indebted to you. I
+hope you are not much burned."
+
+"Oh, no, sir! our hands are burned a bit, but they will be all right
+in a few days. Bill and I are very glad, sir, that we happened to be
+passing, and were able to give the alarm and do something to stop the
+flames till the others came up; but we don't feel that it was anything
+out of the way. It was just a piece of fun and excitement to us."
+
+"They didn't say anything about it, Mr. Penrose, when they came home,
+and it was only when one of the men came in next day to ask after them
+that I heard that they had really been of use."
+
+"It is all very well to say so, lads," Mr. Penrose replied; "but there
+is no doubt you showed a great deal of courage, as well as presence of
+mind, and you may be sure that I shall not forget it. And now, Mrs.
+Andrews," he said, turning round to her, "I feel rather in a false
+position. I came round to see the lads, who, when I last saw them,
+were not in very flourishing circumstances, and I was going to make
+them a present for the service they had done me, and my daughter has
+brought them a basket with some wine, jelly, and other things such as
+are good for sick boys. Finding them as I find them, in your care and
+in such a home, you see I feel a difficulty about it altogether."
+
+"Thank you, sir," Mrs. Andrews said, "for the kindness of your
+intention; but my boys--for although one is in no way related to me I
+feel towards him as if he were my own--would not like to take money
+for doing their duty towards their employer."
+
+"No, indeed!" George and Bill exclaimed simultaneously.
+
+"As you see, sir, thanks to the work you were good enough to give the
+boys and to my needle,"--and she glanced towards the articles on the
+table,--"we are very comfortable; but I am sure the boys will be very
+glad to accept the things which your daughter has been so kind as to
+bring down for them, and will feel very much obliged for her
+thoughtfulness."
+
+"That is right," Mr. Penrose said, relieved. "Nelly, you may as well
+leave the basket as it is. I am sure you don't want to carry it back
+again?"
+
+"No, papa," Nelly said; and indeed even the empty basket would have
+been more than the child could well have carried. It had come on the
+top of the carriage to the railway-station, and a porter had
+accompanied Mr. Penrose with it to Laburnum Villas.
+
+"You would have hardly known your young friend. Would you, Nelly?"
+
+"I don't think I should," she said, shaking her head. "He looks
+dreadfully burned, and his hair is all funny and frizzled."
+
+"It will soon grow again," George said, smiling. "The doctor says our
+faces will be all right when the skin is peeled off. Thank you very
+much, Miss Penrose, for all the nice things. It was a fortunate day
+indeed for us when I caught that boy stealing your locket."
+
+"And it was a fortunate day for us too," Mr. Penrose responded. "Now,
+Mrs. Andrews, we will say good-by. You will not mind my calling again
+to see how the boys are getting on?"
+
+"It will be very kind of you, sir, and we shall be glad to see you,"
+Mrs. Andrews replied; "but I hope in a few days they will both be out
+of the doctor's hands."
+
+"I can't shake hands with you," Mr. Penrose said, patting the boys on
+the shoulder, "but I hope next time I see you to be able to do so.
+Good-morning, Mrs. Andrews."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII.
+
+SAVED!
+
+
+"Now let us have a look at the basket, mother," George said as Mrs.
+Andrews returned into the room after seeing her two visitors off.
+"It's very kind of him, isn't it? and I am glad he didn't offer us
+money; that would have been horrid, wouldn't it?"
+
+"I am glad he did not, too, George. Mr. Penrose is evidently a
+gentleman of delicacy and refinement of feeling, and he saw that he
+would give pain if he did so."
+
+"You see it too, don't you, Bill?" George asked. "You know you thought
+I was a fool not to take money when he offered it for getting back the
+locket; but you see it in the same way now, don't you?"
+
+"Yes; I shouldn't have liked to take money," Bill said. "I sees----"
+
+"See," Mrs. Andrews corrected.
+
+"Thank you. I see things different--differently," he corrected
+himself, seeing that George was about to speak, "to what I did then."
+
+"Now, mother," George said, "let us open the basket; it's almost as
+big as a clothes-basket, isn't it?"
+
+The cover was lifted and the contents, which had after much thought
+been settled by Nelly herself, were disclosed. There were two bottles
+of port-wine, a large mold of jelly, a great cake, two dozen oranges,
+some apples, a box of preserved fruit, some almonds and raisins, two
+packets of Everton toffee, a dozen mince-pies, and four pots of
+black-currant jelly, on the cover of one of which was written in a
+sprawling hand, "Two teaspoonfuls stirred up in a tumbler of water for
+a drink at night."
+
+"This will make a grand feast, mother; what a jolly collection, isn't
+it? I think Miss Penrose must have chosen it herself, don't you?"
+
+"It certainly looks like it, George," Mrs. Andrews replied, smiling.
+"I do not think any grownup person would have chosen mince-pies and
+toffee as appropriate for sick boys."
+
+"Yes; but she must have known we were not badly burned, mother; and
+besides, you see, she put in currant-jelly to make drinks, and there
+are the oranges too. I vote that we have an orange and some toffee at
+once, Bill."
+
+"I have tasted oranges," Bill said, "lots of them in the market, but I
+never tasted toffee."
+
+"It's first-rate, I can tell you."
+
+"Why, they look like bits of tin," Bill said as the packet was opened.
+
+George burst into a laugh.
+
+"That's tin-foil, that's only to wrap it up; you peel that off, Bill,
+and you will find the toffee inside. Now, mother, you have a glass of
+wine and a piece of cake."
+
+"I will have a piece of cake, George; but I am not going to open the
+wine. We will put that by in case of illness or of any very
+extraordinary occasion."
+
+"I am glad the other things won't keep, mother, or I expect you would
+be wanting to put them all away. Isn't this toffee good, Bill?"
+
+"First-rate," Bill agreed. "What is it made of?"
+
+"Sugar and butter melted together over the fire."
+
+"You are like two children," Mrs. Andrews laughed, "instead of boys
+getting on for sixteen years old. Now I must clear this table again
+and get to work; I promised these four bonnets should be sent in
+to-morrow morning, and there's lots to be done to them yet."
+
+It was three weeks before the boys were able to go to work again. The
+foreman came round on Saturdays with their wages. Mr. Penrose called
+again; this time they were out, but he chatted for some time with Mrs.
+Andrews.
+
+"I don't wish to pry into your affairs, Mrs. Andrews," he said, after
+asking about the boys; "but I have a motive for asking if your son
+has, as I suppose he has, from his way of speaking, had a fair
+education."
+
+"He was at school up to the age of twelve," Mrs. Andrews said quietly;
+"circumstances at that time obliged me to remove him; but I have
+since done what I could myself towards continuing his education, and
+he still works regularly of an evening."
+
+"Why I ask, Mrs. Andrews, was that I should like in time to place him
+in the counting-house. I say in time, because I think it will be
+better for him for the next two or three years to continue to work in
+the shops. I will have him moved from shop to shop so as to learn
+thoroughly the various branches of the business. That is what I should
+do had I a son of my own to bring into the business. It will make him
+more valuable afterwards, and fit him to take a good position either
+in my shops or in any similar business should an opening occur."
+
+"I am greatly obliged to you, sir," Mrs. Andrews said gratefully;
+"though I say it myself, a better boy never lived."
+
+"I am sure he is by what I have heard of him, and I shall be only too
+glad, after the service he has rendered me, to do everything in my
+power to push him forward. His friend, I hear, has not had the same
+advantages. At the time I first saw him he looked a regular young
+arab."
+
+"So he was, sir; but he is a fine young fellow. He was very kind to my
+boy when he was alone in London, and gave up his former life to be
+with him. George taught him to read before I came here, and he has
+worked hard ever since. No one could be nicer in the house than he is,
+and had I been his own mother he could not be more dutiful or anxious
+to please. Indeed I may say that I am indebted for my home here as
+much to him as to my own boy."
+
+"I am glad to hear you say so, Mrs. Andrews, for of course I should
+wish to do something for him too. At any rate, I will give him, like
+your son, every opportunity of learning the business, and he will in
+time be fit for a position of foreman of a shop--by no means a bad one
+for a lad who has had such a beginning as he has had. After that, of
+course, it must depend upon himself. I think, if you will allow me to
+suggest, it would be as well that you should not tell them the nature
+of our conversation. Of course it is for you to decide; but, however
+steady boys they are, it might make them a little less able to get on
+well with their associates in a shop if they know that they are going
+to be advanced."
+
+"I don't think it would make any difference to them, sir; but at the
+same time I do think it would be as well not to tell them."
+
+One day Bill was out by himself as the men were coming out of the
+shop, and he stopped to speak to Bob Grimstone.
+
+"Oh! I am glad to find you without George," Bob said; "'cause I want
+to talk to you. Look here! the men in all the shops have made a
+subscription to give you and George a present. Everyone feels that
+it's your doing that we have not got to idle all this winter, and when
+someone started the idea there wasn't a man in the two shops that
+didn't agree with him. I am the treasurer, I am, and it's come to
+just thirty pounds. Now I don't know what you two boys would like,
+whether you would like it in money, or whether you would like it in
+something else, so I thought I would ask you first. I thought you
+would know what George would like, seeing what friends you are, and
+then you know it would come as a surprise to him. Now, what do you
+say?"
+
+"Its very kind of you," Bill said. "I am sure George would like
+anything better than money, and so should I."
+
+"Well, you think it over, Bill, and let me know in a day or two. We
+were thinking of a watch for each of you, with an inscription, saying
+it was presented to you by your shopmates for having saved the
+factory, and so kept them at work for months just at the beginning of
+winter. That's what seemed to me that you would like; but if there is
+anything you would like better, just you say so. You come down here
+to-morrow or next day, when you have thought it over, and give me an
+answer. Of course you can consult George if you think best."
+
+Bill met Bob Grimstone on the following day.
+
+"I have thought it over," he said, "and I know what George and me
+would like better than any possible thing you could get."
+
+"Well, what is it, Bill?"
+
+"Well, what we have set our minds on, and what we were going to save
+up our money to get, was a piano for George's mother. I heard her say
+that we could get a very nice one for about thirty pounds, and it
+would be splendid if you were all to give it her."
+
+"Very well, Bill, then a piano it shall be. I know a chap as works at
+Kirkman's, and I expect he will be able to give us a good one for the
+money."
+
+Accordingly on the Saturday afternoon before the boys were going to
+work again, Mrs. Andrews and George were astonished at seeing a cart
+stop before the house, and the foreman, Bob Grimstone, and four other
+men coming up to the door.
+
+Bill ran and opened the door, and the men entered. He had been
+apprised of the time that they might be expected, and at once showed
+them in.
+
+"Mrs. Andrews," the foreman said, "I and my mates here are a
+deputation from the hands employed in the shop, and we have come to
+offer you a little sort of testimonial of what we feel we owe your son
+and Bill Smith for putting out the fire and saving the shops. If it
+hadn't been for them it would have been a bad winter for us all. So
+after thinking it over and finding out what form of testimonial the
+lads would like best, we have got you a piano, which we hope you may
+live long to play on and enjoy. We had proposed to give them a watch
+each; but we found that they would rather that it took the form of a
+piano."
+
+"Oh, how good and kind of you all!" Mrs. Andrews said, much affected.
+"I shall indeed be proud of your gift, both for itself and for the
+kind feeling towards my boys which it expresses."
+
+"Then, ma'am, with your permission we will just bring it in;" and the
+deputation retired to assist with the piano.
+
+"Oh, boys, how could you do it without telling me!" Mrs. Andrews
+exclaimed.
+
+George had hitherto stood speechless with surprise.
+
+"But I didn't know anything about it, mother. I don't know what they
+mean by saying that we would rather have it than watches. Of course we
+would, a hundred times; but I don't know how they knew it."
+
+"Then it must have been your kind thought, Bill."
+
+"It wasn't no kind thought, Mrs. Andrews, but they spoke to me about
+it, and I knew that a piano was what we should like better than
+anything else, and I didn't say anything about it, because Bob
+Grimstone thought that it would be nicer to be a surprise to George as
+well as to you."
+
+"You are right, old boy," George said, shaking Bill by the hand; "why,
+there never was such a good idea; it is splendid, mother, isn't it?"
+
+The men now appeared at the door with the piano. This was at once
+placed in the position which had long ago been decided upon as the
+best place for the piano when it should come. Mrs. Andrews opened it,
+and there on the front was a silver plate with the inscription:
+
+"To Mrs. Andrews from the Employees at Messrs. Penrose & Co., in token
+of their gratitude to George Andrews and William Smith for their
+courage and presence of mind, by which the factory was saved from
+being destroyed by fire on Saturday the 23d of October, 1857."
+
+The tears which stood in Mrs. Andrews' eyes rendered it difficult for
+her to read the inscription.
+
+"I thank you, indeed," she said. "Now, perhaps you would like to hear
+its tones." So saying she sat down and played "Home, Sweet Home." "It
+has a charming touch," she said as she rose, "and, you see, the air
+was an appropriate one, for your gift will serve to make home even
+sweeter than before. Give, please, my grateful thanks, and those of my
+boys, to all who have subscribed."
+
+The inhabitants of No. 8 Laburnum Villas had long been a subject of
+considerable discussion and interest to their neighbors, for the
+appearance of the boys as they came home of an evening in their
+working clothes seemed altogether incongruous with that of their
+mother and with the neatness and prettiness of the villa, and was,
+indeed, considered derogatory to the respectability of Laburnum Villas
+in general. Upon this evening they were still further mystified at
+hearing the notes of a female voice of great power and sweetness,
+accompanied by a piano, played evidently by an accomplished musician,
+issuing from the house. As to the boys, they thought that, next only
+to that of the home-coming of Mrs. Andrews, never was such a happy
+evening spent in the world.
+
+I do not think that in all London there was a household that enjoyed
+that winter more than did the inmates of No. 8 Laburnum Villas. Their
+total earnings were about thirty-five shillings a week, much less than
+that of many a mechanic, but ample for them not only to live, but to
+live in comfort and even refinement. No stranger, who had looked into
+the pretty drawing room in the evening, would have dreamed that the
+lady at the piano worked as a milliner for her living, or that the
+lads were boys in a manufactory.
+
+When spring came they began to plan various trips and excursions which
+could be taken on bank holidays or during the long summer evenings,
+when an event happened which, for a time, cut short all their plans.
+The word had been passed round the shops the first thing in the
+morning that Mr. Penrose was coming down with a party of ladies and
+gentlemen to go over the works, and that things were to be made as
+tidy as possible.
+
+Accordingly there was a general clearing up, and vast quantities of
+shavings and sawdust were swept up from the floors, although when the
+machines had run again for a few hours no one would have thought that
+a broom had been seen in the place for weeks.
+
+George was now in a shop where a number of machines were at work
+grooving, mortising, and performing other work to prepare the wood for
+builders' purposes. The party arrived just as work had recommenced
+after dinner.
+
+There were ten or twelve gentlemen and as many ladies. Nelly Penrose,
+with two girls about her own age, accompanied the party. They stopped
+for a time in each shop while Mr. Penrose explained the nature of the
+work and the various points of the machinery.
+
+They had passed through most of the other rooms before they entered
+that in which George was engaged, and the young girls, taking but
+little interest in the details of the machinery, wandered somewhat
+away from the rest of the party, chatting among themselves. George had
+his eye upon them, and was wishing that Mr. Penrose would turn round
+and speak to them, for they were moving about carelessly and not
+paying sufficient heed to the machinery.
+
+Suddenly he threw down his work and darted forward with a shout; but
+he was too late, a revolving-band had caught Nelly Penrose's dress. In
+an instant she was dragged forward and in another moment would have
+been whirled into the middle of the machinery.
+
+There was a violent scream, followed by a sudden crash and a harsh
+grating sound, and then the whole of the machinery on that side of the
+room came to a standstill. For a moment no one knew what had
+happened. Mr. Penrose and some of his friends rushed forward to raise
+Nelly. Her hand was held fast between the band and the pulley, and the
+band had to be cut to relieve it.
+
+"What an escape! what an escape!" Mr. Penrose murmured, as he lifted
+her. "Another second and nothing could have saved her. But what
+stopped the machinery?" and for the first time he looked round the
+shop. There was a little group of men a few yards away, and, having
+handed Nelly, who was crying bitterly, for her hand was much bruised,
+to one of the ladies, he stepped towards them. The foreman came
+forward to meet him.
+
+"I think, sir, you had better get the ladies out of the shop. I am
+afraid young Andrews is badly hurt."
+
+"How is it? What is the matter?" Mr. Penrose asked.
+
+"I think, sir, he saw the danger your daughter was in, and shoved his
+foot in between two of the cog-wheels."
+
+"You don't say so!" Mr. Penrose exclaimed, as he pushed forward among
+the men.
+
+Two of them were supporting George Andrews, who, as pale as death, lay
+in their arms. One of his feet was jammed in between two of the
+cog-wheels. He was scarcely conscious.
+
+"Good Heavens," Mr. Penrose exclaimed in a low tone, "his foot must be
+completely crushed! Have you thrown off the driving belt, Williams?"
+
+"Yes, sir, I did that first thing."
+
+"That's right; now work away for your lives, lads." This was said to
+two men who had already seized spanners and were unscrewing the bolts
+of the bearings in order to enable the upper shafting to be lifted and
+the cog-wheel removed. Then Mr. Penrose returned to his friends.
+
+"Pray leave the shop," he said, "and go down into the office. There's
+been a bad accident; a noble young fellow has sacrificed himself to
+save Nelly's life, and is, I fear, terribly hurt. Williams, send off a
+man instantly for the surgeon. Let him jump into one of the cabs he
+will find waiting at the gate, and tell the man to drive as hard as he
+can go. If Dr. Maxwell is not at home let him fetch someone else."
+
+George had indeed sacrificed himself to save Nelly Penrose. When he
+saw the band catch her dress he had looked round for an instant for
+something with which to stop the machinery, but there was nothing at
+hand, and without an instant's hesitation he had thrust his foot
+between the cog-wheels. He had on very heavy, thickly nailed working
+boots, and the iron-bound sole threw the cogs out of gear and bent the
+shaft, thereby stopping the machinery. George felt a dull, sickening
+pain, which seemed to numb and paralyze him all over, and he
+remembered little more until, on the shafting being removed, his foot
+was extricated and he was laid gently down on a heap of shavings. The
+first thing he realized when he was conscious was that someone was
+pouring some liquid, which half-choked him, down his throat.
+
+When he opened his eyes, Mr. Penrose, kneeling beside him, was
+supporting his head, while on the other side knelt Bill Smith, the
+tears streaming down his cheeks and struggling to suppress his sobs.
+
+"What is it, Bill? What's the matter?" Then the remembrance of what
+had passed flashed upon him.
+
+"Is she safe; was I in time?"
+
+"Quite safe, my dear boy. Thank God, your noble sacrifice was not in
+vain," Mr. Penrose answered with quivering lips, for he too had the
+greatest difficulty in restraining his emotion.
+
+"Am I badly hurt, sir?" George asked after a pause, "because, if so,
+will you please send home for mother? I don't feel in any pain, but I
+feel strange and weak."
+
+"It is your foot, my boy. I fear that it is badly crushed, but
+otherwise you are unhurt. Your boot threw the machinery out of gear."
+
+In ten minutes the doctor arrived. He had already been informed of the
+nature of the accident.
+
+"Is it any use trying to cut the boot off?" Mr. Penrose asked in a low
+voice as Dr. Maxwell stooped over George's leg.
+
+"Not the slightest," the doctor answered in the same tone. "The foot
+is crushed to a pulp. It must come off at the ankle. Nothing can save
+it. He had better be taken home at once. You had best send to Guy's
+and get an operating surgeon for him. I would rather it were done by
+someone whose hand is more used than mine to this sort of work."
+
+"I am a governor of Guy's," Mr. Penrose said, "and will send off at
+once for one of their best men. You are not afraid of the case, I
+hope, Dr. Maxwell?"
+
+"Not of the local injury," Dr. Maxwell replied; "but the shock to the
+system of such a smash is very severe. However, he has youth,
+strength, and a good constitution, so we must hope for the best. The
+chances are all in his favor. We are thinking of taking you home, my
+boy," he went on, speaking aloud to George. "Are you in any great
+pain?"
+
+"I am not in any pain, sir; only I feel awfully cold, and, please,
+will someone go on before and tell mother. Bill had better not go; he
+would frighten her to death and make her think it was much worse than
+it is."
+
+"I will go myself," Mr. Penrose replied. "I will prepare her for your
+coming."
+
+"Drink some more of this brandy," the doctor said; "that will warm you
+and give you strength for your journey."
+
+There was a stretcher always kept at the works in case of emergency,
+and George was placed on this and covered with some rugs. Four of the
+men raised it onto their shoulders and set out, Mr. Penrose at once
+driving on to prepare Mrs. Andrews.
+
+Bill followed the procession heart-broken. When it neared home he
+fell behind and wandered away, not being able to bring himself to
+witness the grief of Mrs. Andrews. For hours he wandered about,
+sitting down in waste places and crying as if his heart would break.
+"If it had been me it wouldn't have mattered," he kept on
+exclaiming--"wouldn't have mattered a bit. It wouldn't have been no
+odds one way or the other. There, we have always been together in the
+shops till this week, and now when we get separated this is what comes
+of it. Here am I, walking about all right, and George all crushed up,
+and his mother breaking her heart. Why, I would rather a hundred times
+that they had smashed me up all over than have gone and hurt George
+like that!"
+
+It was dark before he made his way back, and, entering at the back
+door, took off his boots, and was about to creep upstairs when Mrs.
+Andrews came out of the kitchen.
+
+"Oh, Mrs. Andrews!" he exclaimed, and the tears again burst from him.
+
+"Do not cry, Bill; George is in God's hands, and the doctors have
+every hope that he will recover. They are upstairs with him now, with
+a nurse whom Mr. Penrose has fetched down from the hospital. He will
+have to lose his foot, poor boy," she added with a sob that she could
+not repress, "but we should feel very thankful that it is no worse
+after such an accident as that. The doctor says that his thick boots
+saved him. If it hadn't been for that his whole leg would have been
+drawn into the machinery, and then nothing could have saved him. Now I
+must go upstairs, as I only came down for some hot water."
+
+"May I go up to him, Mrs. Andrews?"
+
+"I think, my boy, you had better stop down here for the present for
+both your sakes. I will let you know when you can go up to him."
+
+So Bill crouched before the fire and waited. He heard movements
+upstairs and wondered what they were doing and why they didn't keep
+quiet, and when he would be allowed to go up. Once or twice the nurse
+came down for hot water, but Bill did not speak to her; but in half an
+hour Mrs. Andrews herself returned, looking, Bill thought, even paler
+than before.
+
+"I have just slipped down to tell you, my boy, that it's all over.
+They gave him chloroform, and have taken his foot off."
+
+"And didn't it hurt it awful?" Bill asked in an awed voice.
+
+"Not in the least. He knew nothing about it, and the first thing he
+asked when he came to was when they were going to begin. They will be
+going away directly, and then you can come up and sit quietly in his
+room if you like. The doctors say he will probably drop asleep."
+
+Bill was obliged to go outside again and wrestle with himself before
+he felt that he was fit to go up into George's room. It was a long
+struggle, and had George caught his muttered remonstrances to himself
+he would have felt that Bill had suffered a bad relapse into his
+former method of talking. It came out in jerks between his sobs.
+
+"Come, none of that now. Aint yer ashamed of yerself, a-howling and
+a-blubbering like a gal! Call yerself a man!--you are a babby, that's
+what you are. Now, dry up, and let's have no more of it."
+
+But it was a long time before he again mastered himself; then he went
+to the scullery and held his head under the tap till the water took
+away his breath, then polished his face till it shone, and then went
+and sat quietly down till Mrs. Andrews came in and told him that he
+could go upstairs to George. He went up to the bedside and took
+George's hand, but he could not trust himself to speak.
+
+"Well, Bill, old boy," George said cheerily, but in a somewhat lower
+voice than usual, "this is a sudden go, isn't it?"
+
+Bill nodded. He was still speechless.
+
+"Don't you take it to heart, Bill," George said, feeling that the lad
+was shaking from head to foot. "It won't make much odds, you know. I
+shall soon be about again all right. I expect they will be able to put
+on an artificial foot, and I shall be stumping about as well as ever,
+though I shouldn't be much good at a race."
+
+"I wish it had been me," Bill broke out. "I would have jammed my head
+in between them wheels cheerful, that I would, rather than you should
+have gone and done it."
+
+"Fortunately there was no time," George said with a smile. "Don't you
+fret yourself, Bill; one can get on well enough without a foot, and it
+didn't hurt me a bit coming off. No, nor the squeeze either, not
+regular hurting; it was just a sort of scrunch, and then I didn't feel
+anything more. Why, I have often hurt myself ten times as much at play
+and thought nothing of it. I expect it looked much worse to you than
+it felt to me."
+
+"We will talk of it another time," Bill said huskily. "Your mother
+said I wasn't to talk, and I wasn't to let you talk, but just to sit
+down here quiet, and you are to try to go off to sleep." So saying he
+sat down by the bedside. George asked one or two more questions, but
+Bill only shook his head. Presently George closed his eyes, and a
+short time afterwards his quiet regular breathing showed that he was
+asleep.
+
+The next six weeks passed pleasantly enough to George. Every day
+hampers containing flowers and various niceties in the way of food
+were sent down by Mr. Penrose, and that gentleman himself very
+frequently called in for a chat with him. As soon as the wound had
+healed an instrument-maker came down from town to measure him for an
+artificial foot, but before he was able to wear this he could get
+about on crutches.
+
+The first day that he was downstairs Mr. Penrose brought Nelly down
+to see him. The child looked pale and awed as he came in.
+
+"My little girl has asked me to thank you for her, George," Mr.
+Penrose said as she advanced timidly and placed her hand in his. "I
+have not said much to you about my own feelings and I won't say much
+about hers; but you can understand what we both feel. Why, my boy, it
+was a good Providence, indeed, which threw you in my way! I thought so
+when you saved the mill from destruction. I feel it tenfold more now
+that you have saved my child. The ways of God are, indeed, strange.
+Who would have thought that all this could have sprung from that boy
+snatching the locket from Helen as we came out of the theater! And now
+about the future, George. I owe you a great debt, infinitely greater
+than I can ever repay; but what I can do I will. In the future I shall
+regard you as my son, and I hope that you will look to me as to a
+father. I have been talking to your mother, and she says that she
+thinks your tastes lie altogether in the direction of engineering. Is
+that so?"
+
+"Yes, sir. I have often thought I would rather be an engineer than
+anything else, but I don't like----"
+
+"Never mind what you like and what you don't like," Mr. Penrose said
+quietly. "You belong to me now, you know and must do as you are told.
+What I propose is this, that you shall go to a good school for
+another three years, and I will then apprentice you to a first-class
+engineer, either mechanical or civil as you may then prefer, and when
+you have learned your business I will take good care that you are
+pushed on. What do you say to that?"
+
+"I think it is too much altogether," George said.
+
+"Never mind about that," Mr. Penrose said, "that is my business. If
+that is the only objection we can imagine it settled. There is another
+thing. I know how attached you are to your friend Bill, and I am
+indebted to him, too, for the part he played at the fire, so I
+propose, if he is willing, to put him to a good middle-class school
+for a bit. In the course of a couple of years he will get a sufficient
+education to get on fairly with, and then I propose, according as you
+may choose to be a civil or mechanical engineer, to place him with a
+mason or smith; then by the time that you are ready to start in
+business he will be ready to take a place under you, so that you may
+again work together."
+
+"Oh, thank you, sir!" George exclaimed, even more pleased at the news
+relating to Bill than at his own good fortune, great as was the
+delight which the prospect opened by Mr. Penrose's offer caused him.
+
+As soon as George could be moved, Mr. Penrose sent him with his mother
+and Bill down to the seaside. Here George rapidly regained strength,
+and when, after a stay there of two months, he returned to town, he
+was able to walk so well with his artificial foot that his loss would
+not have been noticed by a stranger.
+
+The arrangements settled by Mr. Penrose were all in due time carried
+out. George went for three years to a good school, and was then
+apprenticed to one of the leading civil engineers. With him he
+remained five years and then went out for him to survey a railroad
+about to be constructed in Brazil, and remained there as one of the
+staff who superintended its construction. Bill, who was now a clever
+young mason, accompanied him, and through George's interest with the
+contractor obtained the sub-contract for the masonry of some of the
+bridges and culverts.
+
+This was ten years ago, and George Andrews is now one of the most
+rising engineers of the day, and whatever business he undertakes his
+friend Bill is still his right-hand man. Mr. Penrose has been in all
+respects as good as his word, and has been ready to assist George with
+his personal influence in all his undertakings, and in all respects
+has treated him as a son, while Nelly has regarded him with the
+affection of a sister.
+
+Both George and Bill have been married some years, and Mrs. Andrews
+the elder is one of the proudest and happiest of mothers. She still
+lives with her son at the earnest request of his wife, who is often
+left alone during George's frequent absence abroad on professional
+duties. As for Bill, he has not even yet got over his wonder at his
+own good fortune, and ever blesses the day when he first met George in
+Covent Garden.
+
+
+
+
+DO YOUR DUTY.
+
+
+Early in the month of March, 1801, an old sailor was sitting on a
+bench gazing over the stretch of sea which lies between Hayling Island
+and the Isle of Wight. The prospect was a lively one, for in those
+days ships of war were constantly running in and out, and great
+convoys of merchantmen sailed under the protection of our cruisers;
+and the traffic between Spithead and Portsmouth resembled that of a
+much frequented road.
+
+Peter Langley had been a boatswain in the king's service, and had
+settled down in his old age on a pension, and lived in a small cottage
+near the western extremity of Hayling Island. Here he could see what
+was going on at Spithead, and when he needed a talk with his old
+"chums" could get into his boat, which was lying hauled up on the
+sand, and with a good wind arrive in an hour at the Hard. He was
+sitting at present on a portion of a wreck thrown up by a very high
+tide on the sandy slope, when his meditations were disturbed by a
+light step behind him, and a lad in a sailor's dress, some fifteen
+years of age, with a bright honest face, came running down behind him.
+
+"Hallo, dad!"
+
+"Hallo, my boy! Bless me, who'd ha' thought o' seeing you!" and the
+old man clasped the boy in his arms in a way that showed the close
+relationship between the two. "I didn't expect you for another week."
+
+"No! we've made a quick passage of it," the boy said; "fine wind all
+the way up, with a gale or two in the right quarter. We only arrived
+in the river on Monday, and as soon as we were fairly in dock I got
+leave to run down to see you."
+
+"What were you in such a hurry for?" the old sailor said. "It's the
+duty of every hand to stop by the ship till she's cleared out."
+
+"I have always stayed before till the crew were paid off; but no
+sooner had we cast anchor than one of the owners came on board, and
+told the captain that another cargo was ready, that the ship was to be
+unloaded with all speed, and to take in cargo and sail again in a
+fortnight at the utmost, as a fleet was on the point of sailing for
+the West Indies under a strong convoy."
+
+"A fortnight! That's sharp work," the old sailor said. "And the goods
+will have to be bundled out and in again with double speed. I know
+what it will be. You will be going out with the paint all wet, and
+those lubbers the stevedores will rub it off as fast as it's put on.
+Well, a few days at sea will shake all down into its place. But how
+did you get leave?"
+
+"I am rather a favorite with the first officer," the lad said. "The
+men who desired to leave were to be discharged at once and a fresh
+gang taken on board, so I asked him directly the news came round if I
+might have four days away. He agreed at once, and I came down by the
+night coach; and here I am for eight-and-forty hours."
+
+"It's a short stay," the old sailor said, "after more than a year
+away, but we mustn't waste the time in regretting it. You've grown,
+Harry, and are getting on fast. In another couple of years you'll be
+fit to join a king's ship. I suppose you've got over your silly idea
+about sticking to the merchant service. It's all very well to learn
+your business there as a boy, and I grant that in some things a
+merchantman is a better school than a king's ship. They have fewer
+hands, and each man has to do more and to learn to think for himself.
+Still, after all, there's no place like a saucy frigate for excitement
+and happiness."
+
+"I don't know, dad," the boy said. "I have been learning a little
+navigation. The first officer has been very kind to me, and I hope in
+the course of two or three years to pass and get a berth as a third
+mate. Still, I should like three or four years on board a man-of-war."
+
+"I should think so," the old sailor said, "for a man ought to do his
+duty to his country."
+
+"But there are plenty of men to do their duty to their country," the
+boy said.
+
+"Not a bit of it!" the sailor exclaimed. "There's a great difficulty
+in finding hands for the navy. Everyone wants to throw their duty upon
+everyone else. They all hanker after the higher wages and loafing life
+on board a merchantman, and hate to keep themselves smart and clean as
+they must do in a king's ship. If I had my way, every tar should serve
+at least five years of his life on board a man-of-war. It is above all
+things essential, Harry, that you should do your duty."
+
+"I am ready to do my duty, dad," the boy said, "when the time comes. I
+do it now to the best of my power, and I have in my pocket a letter
+from the first officer to you. He told you when you went down with me
+to see me off on my last voyage that he would keep an eye upon me, and
+he has done so."
+
+"That's right," the old man said. "As you say, Harry, a man may do his
+duty anywhere; still, for all that, it is part of his duty, if he be a
+sailor, to help his majesty, for a time at least, against his enemies.
+Look at me. Why, I served man and boy for nigh fifty years, and was in
+action one way and another over a hundred times, and here I am now
+with a snug little pension, and as comfortable as his gracious majesty
+himself. What can you want more than that?"
+
+"I don't know that I can want more," the boy said, "in its way, at
+least; but there are other ways in the merchant service. I might
+command a ship by the time I am thirty, and be my own master instead
+of being a mere part of a machine. I have heard the balls flying too,"
+he said, laughing.
+
+"What! did you have a brush with Mounseer?" the old tar said, greatly
+interested.
+
+"Yes; we had a bit of a fight with a large privateer off the coast of
+Spain. Fortunately the old bark carries a long eighteen, as well as
+her twelves, and when the Frenchman found that we could play at long
+bowls as well as himself he soon drew off, but not before we had
+drilled a few holes in his sails and knocked away a bit of his
+bulwarks."
+
+"Were you hit, Harry?"
+
+"Yes, two or three shots hulled her, but they did little damage beyond
+knocking away a few of the fittings and frightening the lady
+passengers. We had a strong crew, and a good many were sorry that the
+skipper did not hide his teeth and let the Frenchman come close before
+he opened fire. We should like to have towed him up the river with our
+flag over the tricolor."
+
+"There, you see, Harry," the old sailor said, "you were just as ready
+to fight as if you had been on a man-of-war; and while in a sailing
+ship you only get a chance if one of these privateers happens to see
+you, in a king's ship you go looking about for an enemy, and when you
+see one the chances are he is bigger, instead of smaller, than
+yourself."
+
+"Ah! well, dad, we shall never quite agree on it, I expect," the boy
+said; "but for all that, I do mean to serve for a few years in a
+man-of-war. I expect that we may have a chance of seeing some
+fighting in the West Indies. There are, they say, several French
+cruisers in that direction, and although we shall have a considerable
+convoy the Frenchmen generally have the legs of our ships. I believe
+that some of the vessels of the convoy are taking out troops, and that
+we are going to have a slap at some of the French islands. Has there
+been any news here since I went?"
+
+"Nothing beyond a few rows with the smugglers. The revenue officers
+have a busy time here. There's no such place for smuggling on the
+coast as between Portsmouth and Chichester. These creeks are just the
+places for smugglers, and there's so much traffic in the Channel that
+a solitary lugger does not attract the attention of the coastguard as
+it does where the sea's more empty. However, I don't trouble myself
+one way or the other about it. I may know a good deal of the
+smuggling, or I may not, but it's no business of mine. If it were my
+duty to lend a hand to the coast-guard, I should do it; but as it
+isn't, I have no ill-will to the smugglers, and am content enough to
+get my spirits cheap."
+
+"But, dad, surely it's your duty to prevent the king being cheated?"
+Harry said with a smile.
+
+"If the king himself were going to touch the money," the old sailor
+said sturdily, "I would lend a hand to see that he got it, but there's
+no saying where this money would have gone. Besides, if the spirits
+hadn't been run, they would not have been brought over here at all,
+so after all the revenue is none the worse for the smuggling."
+
+The boy laughed. "You can cheat yourself, dad, when you like, but you
+know as well as I do that smuggling's dishonest, and that those who
+smuggle cheat the revenue."
+
+"Ah, well!" the sailor said, "it may be so, but I don't clearly see
+that it's my duty to give information in the matter. If I did feel as
+it were going to be my duty, I should let all my neighbors know it,
+and take mighty good care that they didn't say anything within earshot
+of me, that I might feel called on to repeat. And now, let's go up to
+the cottage and see the old woman."
+
+"I looked in there for a moment," Harry said, "as I passed. Mother
+looks as hale and hearty as she did when I left, and so do you, dad."
+
+"Yes, we have nothing to complain of," the old man said. "I have been
+so thoroughly seasoned with salt water that it would take a long time
+for me to decay."
+
+When they got up to the cottage they found that Jane Langley had got
+breakfast prepared. Rashers of bacon were smoking on the table, and a
+large tankard of beer stood by, for in those days the use of tea had
+not become general in this country.
+
+"Have you heard, mother," Peter Langley said, "that the boy is to
+leave us again in forty-eight hours?"
+
+"No, indeed," the old woman said; "but this is hard news. I had hoped
+that you would be with us for a bit, my boy, for we're getting on fast
+in life, and may not be here when you return."
+
+"Oh, mother! we will not think of such a thing as that," Harry said.
+"Father was just saying that he's so seasoned that even time cannot
+make much of such a tough morsel; and you seem as hearty as he is."
+
+"Aye, boy," Peter said, "that be true, but when old oak does come
+down, he generally falls sudden. However, we won't make our first meal
+sad by talking of what might be."
+
+Gayly during the meal they chatted over the incidents of Harry's
+voyage to India and back. It was his second trip. The lad had had a
+much better education than most boys in his rank of life at that time,
+the boatswain having placed him at the age of ten in charge of a
+schoolmaster at Portsmouth. When Harry had reached that age Peter had
+retired from the service, and had settled down at Hayling, but for two
+years longer he had kept Harry at school. Then he had apprenticed him
+to a firm of shipowners in London, and one of the officers under whom
+Peter had served had spoken to the heads of the firm, so that the boy
+was put in a ship commanded by a kind and considerate officer, and to
+whose charge he was specially recommended. Thus he had not forgotten
+what he had learned at school, as is too often the case with lads in
+his position. His skipper had seen that he not only kept up what he
+knew, but that he studied for an hour or so each day such subjects as
+would be useful to him in his career.
+
+After breakfast the pair again went out onto the sandhills, Peter, as
+usual, carrying a huge telescope with him, with which he was in the
+habit of surveying every ship as she rounded the west of the island
+and came running in through the channel to Portsmouth. Most of the
+men-of-war he knew in an instant, and the others he could make a
+shrewd guess at. Generally when alone with Harry he was full of talk
+of the sea, of good advice as to the lad's future bearing, and of
+suggestions and hints as to the best course to be adopted in various
+emergencies. But to-day he appeared unusually thoughtful, and smoked
+his pipe, and looked out in silence over the sea, scarcely even
+lifting his telescope to his eye.
+
+"I've been thinking, Harry," he said at last, "that as you are going
+away again, and, as the old woman says, you may not find us both here
+when you come back, it is right that I should tell you a little more
+about yourself. I once told you, years ago, that you were not my son,
+and that I would give you more particulars some day."
+
+The lad looked anxiously up at the old sailor. It was a matter which
+he had often thought over in his mind, for although he loved the
+honest tar and his good wife as much as he could have done his natural
+parents, still, since he had known that he was their adopted son only,
+he had naturally wondered much as to who his parents were, and what
+was their condition in life.
+
+"I thought it as well," the old sailor began, "not to tell you this
+here yarn until you were getting on. Boys' heads get upset with a
+little breeze, especially if they have no ballast, and though it isn't
+likely now that you will ever get any clew as to your birth, and it
+will make no difference whether it was a duke or a ship's caulker who
+was your father, still it's right that you should know the facts, as
+no one can say when they start on a voyage in life what craft they may
+fall aboard before they've done. It may be, Harry, that as you intends
+to stick to the merchant service--saving, of course, that little time
+you mean to serve on board a king's ship--you may rise to be a
+skipper, and perhaps an owner. It may be, boy, that as a skipper you
+may fall in love with some taut craft sailing in your convoy. I've
+seen such things before now, and then the fact that you might be, for
+aught you know, the son of a marquis instead of being that of a
+boatswain, might score in your favor. Women have curious notions, and
+though, for my part, I can't see that it makes much difference where
+the keel of a craft was laid as long as it's sound and well-built,
+there are those who thinks different.
+
+"Well, to tell you the yarn. It were nigh fourteen years ago that I
+was boatswain aboard the _Alert_ frigate, as taut a craft as ever
+sailed. We had a smart captain and as good a crew as you'd want to
+see. We were cruising in the West Indies, and had for months been,
+off and on, in chase of a craft that had done much damage there. She
+carried a black flag, and her skipper was said to be the biggest
+villain that ever even commanded a pirate. Scarce a week passed but
+some ship was missing. It mattered little to him whether she sailed
+under the English, the French, or the Spanish flag; all was fish to
+him. Many and many a vessel sailed laden that never reached Europe.
+Sometimes a few charred timbers would be thrown up on the shore of the
+islands, showing that the ship to which they belonged had been taken
+and burned before she had gone many days on her way. Often and often
+had the pirate been chased. She was bark-rigged, which was in itself a
+very unusual thing with pirates--indeed, I never knew of one before.
+But she had been, I believe, a merchantman captured by the pirate, and
+was such a beauty that he hoisted his flag on her, and handed his own
+schooner over to his mate. Somehow or other he had altered her
+ballast, and maybe lengthened her a bit, for those pirates have a
+rendezvous in some of the islands, where they are so strong that they
+can, if need be, build a ship of their own. Anyhow, she was the
+fastest ship of her class that ever was seen on those seas, and though
+our cruisers had over and over again chased her, she laughed at them,
+and would for a whole day keep just out of reach of their bow-chasers
+with half her sails set, while the cruisers were staggering under
+every rag they could put on their masts. Then when she was tired of
+that game she would hoist her full canvas and leave the king's vessel
+behind as if she was standing still. Once or twice she nearly got
+caught by cruisers coming up in different directions, but each time
+she managed to slip away without ever having a rope or stay started by
+a shot. We in the _Alert_ had been on her footsteps a dozen times, but
+had had no more luck than the rest of them, and the mere name of the
+_Seamew_ was sufficient to put any one of us into a passion. There
+wasn't one of the ship's company, from the captain down to the
+powder-monkey, who wouldn't have cheerfully given a year's pay to get
+alongside the _Seamew_. The _Alert_ carried thirty-two guns, and our
+crew was stronger than usual in a vessel of that size, for there was a
+good deal of boat service, and it was considered that at any moment
+'Yellow Jack' might lay a good many hands up--or down, as the case may
+be. Well, one night we were at anchor in Porto Rico, and the first
+lieutenant had strolled up with two of the middies to the top of a
+hill just before the sun went down. He had taken a glass with him.
+Just as the night was falling, a middy on our quarter-deck, who was
+looking at the shore with a glass, said to the second lieutenant, who
+was on watch:
+
+"'Look, sir; here comes Mr. Jones with Keen and Hobart down that hill
+as if he were running a race. He isn't likely to be racing the
+middies. What can he be after?'
+
+"'No,' the second lieutenant said, with a smile; 'Mr. Jones is hardly
+likely to be racing the middies'; which, indeed, was true enough, for
+the first lieutenant was as stiff as a ramrod--a good officer, but as
+strict a martinet as ever I sailed under.
+
+"The second lieutenant took the glasses, and saw that, whatever the
+reason might be, it was as the midshipman had said. The news that Mr.
+Jones was coming down the hill, running as if Old Nick was after him,
+soon spread, and there was quite an excitement on the quarter-deck as
+to what could be the matter.
+
+"Ten minutes afterwards the gig was seen coming off to the ship, and
+it was evident, by the way the spray was flying and the oars bending,
+that the men were pulling as if for life or death. By this time the
+news had spread through the ship, and the captain himself was on the
+quarter-deck.
+
+"'Give me the speaking-trumpet,' he said, and as the boat came within
+call he shouted, 'What's the matter, Mr. Jones? Is anything wrong?'
+
+"'I've sighted,' the lieutenant said, standing up and making a trumpet
+with his two hands, 'two craft together round the point of the island
+some fifteen miles at sea. They're low down on the sea-line, but by
+their look I think that one is the _Seamew_ and the other a
+merchantman she has captured.'
+
+"Not a moment was lost. The captain gave the orders sharp and quick.
+The men, who were all standing about, were in a minute clustering on
+the yards, and never was canvas got on a ship faster than it was on
+the _Alert_ that evening. Before the boat was fairly run up to the
+davits the anchor was at the cat-head, and the _Alert's_ bows were
+pointing seawards. Five minutes afterwards, with every stitch of
+canvas set, we were running out of the harbor. The first lieutenant
+had taken the bearings pretty accurately, and as there was a brisk
+evening breeze blowing we spun along at a famous rate. By this time it
+was dark, and we had every hope that we might come upon the pirate
+before she had finished transferring the cargo of her prize under her
+own hatches. Not a light was shown, and as the moon was not up we
+hoped to get within gunshot before being seen, as the pirate, seeing
+no craft within sight before the sun went down, would not suspect that
+the _Alert_ could be on his traces. We had to sail close to the wind
+till we were round the point of the island, and then to run nearly
+before it towards the spot where the vessels had been seen. In two
+hours from the time of starting we reckoned that we must be getting
+close to them if they still remained hove-to.
+
+"All of a sudden, some two miles ahead, a point or two off the
+starboard bow, a great flame shot up. Every moment it grew and grew
+until we could see a large ship in flames, while another lay about a
+quarter of a mile distant. Three or four boats were pulling from the
+ship in flames towards the other, and as this was a bark we had no
+doubt that we had caught the _Seamew_ at her villainous work. The
+pirate was lying between us and the burning merchantman, so that while
+her spars stood out clear and distinct against the glare of light we
+must have been invisible to her. The word was passed quickly forward
+for the men to go to quarters. Every gun was double-shotted and run
+out, and then, all being ready for the fight, the men stripped to
+their waists, cutlasses and boarding-pikes ready to hand, we waited
+with breathless anxiety. We were already within range of our
+bow-chasers, and as yet there was no sign that the pirate was
+conscious of our presence. The boats were now near him, and no doubt
+those on board were looking rather in their direction than to
+windward. Rapidly the _Alert_ tore through the water, the sail
+trimmers were all ready to take in her light canvas at a moment's
+notice. The officers clustered on the quarter-deck, and the men stood
+by their guns with every eye strained at the pirate. Nearer and nearer
+we came, and our hopes rose higher and higher. We were within a mile
+now, when suddenly a great movement was seen on board the pirate. The
+breeze was steady, and the sea quiet, and loud words of command could
+be heard shouted as a swarm of men ran up the rattlins. It was clear
+we were seen. There was no further need of concealment, and the
+captain gave word for the bow-chasers to open. Quickly as the pirate
+got her canvas spread--and I do think that sharp as we had been on
+board the _Alert_, the _Seamew_ was even quicker in getting under
+canvas--we were scarce a quarter of a mile from her when she got
+fairly under way. Up to this moment not a gun had spoken save the two
+bow-chasers, as the captain would not yaw her until the last moment
+Then round she came and poured a broadside into the _Seamew_. Orders
+had been given to fire high, and every man was on his mettle. The
+maintop-mast of the _Seamew_ fell, snapped at the cap; the peak
+halyards of the mizzen were shot away, and a number of holes were
+drilled through her sails. A loud cheer broke from our men. Fast as
+the _Seamew_ was she was sufficiently crippled now to prevent her
+getting away, and at last she was to show whether she could fight as
+well as run, and I must say for her she did.
+
+"She carried but twenty guns against our thirty-two, but they were of
+far heavier metal, and after ten minutes the _Alert_ was as much
+bruised and battered as if she had been fighting a Frenchman of equal
+size for an hour. However, we had not been idle, and as our shot had
+been principally directed against the enemy's rigging, as our great
+object was to cripple her and so prevent her from getting away, she
+was by this time a mere wreck above, although her sides were scarcely
+touched; whereas two of our ports had been knocked into one, and some
+thirty of our men had been struck down either by shot or by splinters.
+Pouring a last broadside into her, the captain ordered the _Alert_ to
+be brought alongside the _Seamew_. There was no need to call upon the
+boarders to be ready. Every man was prepared, and as the vessels came
+alongside our men rushed to the assault. But the crew of the _Seamew_
+were as eager to board us as we were them, and upon the very bulwarks
+a desperate combat ensued. Strong as we were, the _Seamew_ carried
+fully as many hands, and as they were fighting with halters round
+their necks it's little wonder that they fought so well.
+
+"I've been in a good many fights, but never did I see one like that.
+Each man hacked, and hewed, and wielded his boarding-pike as if the
+whole fight depended upon his single exertions. Gradually the men
+whose places were at the guns on the starboard side left their places
+and joined in the fight, while those on the port side continued to
+pour a fire of grape into the enemy. It was near half an hour before
+we got a fair footing on the pirate's deck, and then steadily and
+gradually we fought our way forward. But it was another half-hour
+after the pirate captain and all his officers had been killed, and
+fully half the crew cut down, that the rest surrendered.
+
+"On board the _Alert_ we had fully one-third of our complement killed
+or wounded. Mr. Jones had been shot through the head; the second and
+third lieutenants were both badly wounded, and the captain himself had
+had his jaw broken by a pistol fired in his face. I got this scar on
+my cheek, which spoiled my beauty for the rest of my life, but as I
+had been over thirty years married to the old woman that made but
+little difference. Never were a crew more glorious than we were that
+night. Even the wounded felt that the victory had been cheaply
+purchased. We had captured the scourge of these seas, which had for
+ten years laughed at all the fastest cruisers of our navy, and we felt
+as proud as if we had captured a French first-rate.
+
+"All hands were at work next day in repairing damages. I was up aloft
+seeing to the fitting of fresh gear to the topgallant-mast when I saw
+something floating at sea which took my attention. It seemed to me
+like a box, and an empty one, for it floated high on the water. Its
+lid seemed to be open, and I thought once or twice that I saw
+something inside. I slid down to the quarter-deck and reported what I
+had seen. The third lieutenant, who was doing duty with his arm in a
+sling, was not disposed to take the men off their work to lower a
+boat; but as I pointed out that the box might have belonged to the
+merchantman which had been burned overnight, and that it might afford
+some clew as to the name of the ship, he consented, and with four
+hands I was soon rowing towards the box.
+
+"I don't know what I had expected to see, but I was never more
+surprised than when, getting there, I found that it was a trunk, and
+that in it, sitting up, was a child about eighteen months old. That
+was you, Harry. In the bottom of the trunk were a locket with a
+woman's likeness in it, a curious Indian bangle, and a few other
+articles of jewelry. How you got there we never knew, but the
+supposition was that when the pirate was overhauling the merchantman,
+and her true nature was ascertained, some mother, knowing the fate
+that awaited all on board, had put you in an open trunk, had thrown in
+what ornaments she had about her, and had dropped the trunk overboard,
+in hopes that it might drift away and be picked up by some passing
+ship. It was a wild venture, with a thousand to one against its
+success, but the Lord had watched over it, and there you were as snug
+and comfortable as if you had been laying in your own cot, though, by
+the way, you were squalling as loud as a litter of kittens, and I
+expect had missed your breakfast considerably. You were sitting up,
+and it was lucky that you were backward of your age, for, although by
+your size we guessed you to be eighteen months, you were still unable
+to walk. If you had been as active as some chaps of that age you would
+have scrambled onto your feet, and no doubt capsized your boat.
+
+"Well, we brought you on board, and there was a great talk as to what
+was to be done with you; but as I was your discoverer I claimed you as
+a lawful prize, and I thought you would amuse the old woman while I
+was at sea, and perhaps be a comfort to me when I got laid up in
+ordinary, as indeed you have been. So that's all I know, Harry. Every
+inquiry was made, but we never heard of any ship which exactly
+answered to the description. You see, beyond the fact that she was a
+square-rigged ship we could say but little about her. The ornaments
+found in the box seemed to show that she had come from the East
+Indies, but of course that could not be, for what would she be doing
+there? But at any rate the person who put you into the trunk, and who
+was no doubt your mother, had been to the East Indies, or at least had
+been given those ornaments by someone who had, for there was no doubt
+where they were turned out.
+
+"Well, on board the _Alert_ everyone got promoted. There was enough
+valuable property found on board the _Seamew_ to give us a handsome
+sum all round, and it was my share of the prize-money that enabled me
+to buy this little cottage, and went no small way towards paying for
+your schooling and board. As no one else claimed you, and your friends
+could not be heard of, no one disputed my right to your guardianship;
+and so, my boy, here you have been cruising about the world as Harry
+Langley ever since."
+
+The old sailor was silent, and Harry was some time before he spoke.
+
+"Well, dad, you may not have been my real father, but no one could
+have been a better father to me than you have, and as it isn't likely
+now that I shall ever hit upon a clew which could lead me to discover
+who I am, I shall continue to regard you as my real father. Still, as
+you say, it may perhaps in life be some advantage to me to be able to
+claim that I am the son of a marquis;" and he laughed merrily. They
+talked the matter over for some time, and then Harry changed the
+subject.
+
+"Are all our friends well?" Harry asked.
+
+"All except poor Tom Hardy. He slipped his cable six months since, and
+his wife, poor old soul, is gone to some friends near Winchester."
+
+"Who's living in the cottage?"
+
+"Black Jack has taken it."
+
+"What! has he moved from his old place, then?"
+
+"No, it is said that he's taken it for a Frenchy, who comes down off
+and on. They say he's in the smuggling business with Black Jack, and
+that he disposes of the silks and wines that are brought over in the
+_Lucy_, and that Jack trades over in France with his friends. The
+lieutenant at the coast-guard station has his eye upon him, and I
+believe that some day they will catch Black Jack as he runs his cargo;
+but he's a slippery customer. It would be a good day for Hayling if
+they could do so, for he and his crew do a lot of harm to the place.
+They look more like men who have belonged to the _Seamew_ I was
+talking to you about than honest English fishermen."
+
+"It is a curious thing, dad, that the Frenchman should be coming
+backwards and forwards here, and I wonder that the revenue people
+don't inquire into it."
+
+"I don't suppose that they know very much about it, Harry. He comes
+off and on, generally arriving at night, and leaving a few hours
+afterwards. I hear about these things because everyone knows that old
+Peter Langley is not the chap to put his nose into other people's
+business. I don't like these goings on, I must say, and consider they
+will end badly. However, it is no business of ours, lad. We get our
+brandy cheap in Hayling--nowhere cheaper, I should say--and that,
+after all, is the matter that concerns us most. The wind's rising
+fast; I think we're in for a gale."
+
+It was as Peter said. The clouds were rising fast behind the island,
+the waves were breaking with a short, sharp sound upon the beach,
+white heads were beginning to show themselves out at sea, the fishing
+craft were running in towards Portsmouth under reefed sails, the
+men-of-war at Spithead could be seen sending down their topmasts, and
+everything betokened that it would be a nasty night.
+
+"What time must you leave, Harry?"
+
+"I shall go off at three to-morrow morning; shall cross the ferry, and
+catch the coach as it goes along at eight. I promised that I would be
+back on the following morning, and I would not fail in keeping my
+appointment, for as the captain has been so good I should be sorry
+that he should think that I had broken my word."
+
+In the course of the day Harry went over to the village and saw many
+of his boy friends. Bill Simpkins, however, his great chum, happened
+to be away, but his parents said that he would be back at nine in the
+evening. He had gone over to Winchester to see a brother who was in a
+regiment quartered there. Accordingly, soon after nine o'clock Harry
+said to his father that he would just walk over to have a chat with
+his friend, and be back in an hour or so.
+
+"Thou had best stop at home and go to bed at once," Jane Langley said;
+"if thou hast to start at three o'clock, it were time thou wert in bed
+now."
+
+"I am accustomed to short nights," Harry said, laughing, "and I shall
+be able to sleep long to-morrow."
+
+Putting on his hat, he nodded to the old couple, and went off at a run
+into the darkness.
+
+The road was a wide one, and but little frequented, and the grass grew
+thick over a considerable portion of the sides, therefore as he ran
+along with a light, springy tread the sound of his footsteps was
+deadened. As he came along by the cottage of which he had been
+speaking to Peter Langley he heard the sound of voices within. Being
+curious to see what this mysterious Frenchman was like, Harry paused,
+lightly lifted the latch of the gate, and entered the little garden.
+He had intended to peep in at the window, and having satisfied his
+curiosity to be off; but just as he reached the door the latter opened
+suddenly, and Harry had only time to draw back behind the little porch
+before two men came out. In one Harry recognized by his voice the
+smuggler Black Jack; the other was by his halting English evidently
+the foreigner. They stopped for a moment, looking out into the night.
+
+"I tell you," the smuggler said, "it's going to be a storm, and no
+mistake. The _Lucy_ is a tight craft, and has weathered gales when
+many a bigger ship has gone down. Still, I don't like running out into
+it without necessity."
+
+"Necezity," said the Frenchman. "I sould have sought zat ze earning of
+five hundred pounds was as urgent a necezity as was wanted."
+
+"Aye, the money will be handy enough," the smuggler said, "though one
+does put one's head into the noose to earn it. However, the sum is
+bigger than usual, and, as you say, the affair is important."
+
+"Bah!" the Frenchman said, "what does it matter about ze nooze? It
+hasn't got over your zick neck or my zin one, and till it does we
+needn't trouble about it. I tell you zis is ze most important dispatch
+we have ever sent, and if it gets safe to hand zey cannot grudge us
+double pay. I have ridden from London wizout stopping, and have killed
+a horse worth fifty of your guineas. However, zat matters not. Zis
+letter should fetch us ze money to pay for a dozen horses and a dozen
+of your _Lucys_."
+
+"All right!" the smuggler said; "in an hour we will be off. Letters
+like that in your pocket are best not kept on hand. You are sure that
+the _Chasse Maree_ will put out to meet us in such weather as we are
+likely to have?"
+
+"She will put out if a hurricane's blowing," the Frenchman said. "Zey
+know ze importance of ze news, which is expected, and which I am
+bringing zem. _Mon Dieu!_ what sums have been paid to get ze news
+zat's in zis little dispatch!"
+
+"Do you know what it is?" the smuggler said.
+
+"Not for certain," the Frenchman replied, "but I believe it is ze
+orders zat are to be sent to ze British fleet, and zat zey are about
+to strike a great blow zomewhere."
+
+"Well," the smuggler said, "I will go round and tell the boys. I
+warned them to be in readiness, and I will send them straight down to
+the beach. In a quarter of an hour I will return for you."
+
+While this conversation had been going on Harry had been standing
+against the porch, the sides of which were filled with latticework
+over which a creeper grew. He had been frightened at the importance of
+the secret that he was hearing, and had been rapidly meditating in his
+mind how this all-portant information which was about to be conveyed
+to the enemy could be stopped. He had made up his mind that the
+instant the smuggler moved out he would make his way down to the
+village, tell the tale to half a dozen men, and have the Frenchman
+seized. He saw at once that it would be difficult, for the smuggler
+and his gang were not men to be attacked with impunity, and the
+fishers of the village would hesitate in taking part in such a
+struggle merely on the information of a boy. However, Harry saw that
+it was the only chance.
+
+In his anxiety to stand close to the lattice and so hide himself from
+the view of the two men who were standing on the little garden-path in
+front, he pressed too hard against it. The woodwork was rotten with
+age, and suddenly with a crash it gave way.
+
+With an oath the smuggler turned round, and he and the Frenchman
+dashed to the spot, and in an instant had collared the lad. In a
+moment he was dragged into the room.
+
+"We must cut his throat, mounseer," the smuggler said, with a terrible
+imprecation. "The scoundrel has heard what we've said, and our lives
+won't be worth a minute's purchase if he were to be let free. Stand by
+and I'll knock out his brains;" and he seized a heavy poker from the
+side of the hearth.
+
+"No, no," the Frenchman said, "don't let us have blood. Zere might be
+inquiries, and zese sings will sometimes be found. Better take him to
+sea wis you in ze _Lucy_, and hand him over to ze _Chasse Maree_. Zey
+will take care zat he does not come back again."
+
+"I will take care myself," the smuggler said. "I'm not going to risk
+my neck on the chance of his blabbing. It's better, as you say, to
+have no blood, but as soon as the _Lucy's_ at sea overboard he goes."
+
+"We can talk of it," the Frenchman said. "I'm wis you zat he must be
+silenced, but it may be better--my plan zan yours. Zis boy belongs, I
+suppose, to ze village?"
+
+"Yes," the smuggler said, "I know him by sight. He's the son of an
+old man-of-war's man who lives half a mile away."
+
+"Well, you see, some of your men might some day, if they quarreled wis
+you, or in zeir drink, drop some words which might lead to inquiries.
+Better put him on board ze _Chasse Maree_. I will see ze matter is
+settled."
+
+Harry had spoken no word from the time he was grasped. He felt in an
+instant that his life was forfeited, and was surprised that he had not
+been instantly killed. He had not raised his voice to hallo, for he
+knew that no cottagers were near, and was sure that an attempt to give
+the alarm would insure his instant death. To struggle would have been
+useless. He was unarmed, and although a stout lad, was but a child in
+the grasp of a powerful man like the smuggler. He saw, too, that on
+the instant the Frenchman had drawn a dagger from his breast, and
+though more quiet than the smuggler he felt by the tone of his voice
+that he was as determined as his colleague that his silence should be
+secured by death.
+
+In another minute he was bound and thrown into a corner. The Frenchman
+then took his seat near him, assuring him in a low tone that he would
+at his first movement plant his dagger in his heart. The smuggler
+strolled off to summon his crew, and for a quarter of an hour silence
+reigned in the cottage.
+
+"You are one fool," the Frenchman said at last, as if he had been
+thinking the matter over--"one meddlesome fool. Why you want to listen
+at people's doors and learn zeir secrets? I don't want to kill you,
+but what are we to do? You make us kill you. You push your own head
+into ze trap. Zat is ze way wis boys. Zey are forever meddling in
+affairs zat concern zem not, and zen we have ze trouble to kill zem. I
+would give a hundred pounds if zis had not happened; but what can I
+do? It is my life against yours, and alzough I am sorry to have to do
+it--_parbleu!_ my life is of much more value zan zat of a fishing boy.
+Bah! you are one meddlesome fool."
+
+So exasperated was the Frenchman at the trouble which the prying of
+this lad had brought upon him that he got up and angrily gave him a
+kick. A few minutes later the smuggler returned.
+
+"The men have all gone down to the boat," he said briefly. "Come
+along, mounseer. Bring that tin case with you, and those pistols."
+
+"Zere is no fear zat I forget ze tin case," the Frenchman said. "As to
+ze pistols--zey are not of much use. However, I will take zem;" and he
+thrust them into the pockets of his coat.
+
+The smuggler stooped, picked up Harry, threw him onto a sail which he
+had laid on the ground, wrapped this round him, and then cast him over
+his shoulder.
+
+"I'm not likely to meet anyone on my way to the boat," he said, "but
+should I do so I'm taking the mainsail of the _Lucy_ down to her."
+
+In another minute Harry heard the door slam, and then he felt himself
+being carried steadily along, his weight being as nothing to the
+smuggler. Not a word was spoken between the two men on their way down
+to the shore. Presently Harry felt by the deadened sound of the
+footsteps, and by the more uneven motion, that he was being carried
+over the sandy slopes down to the edge of the sea, and through the
+canvas he could hear the loud roar of the waves, which were now
+breaking violently.
+
+Presently he was flung roughly down on the sands. A minute later he
+was lifted by the head and feet, and swung into a boat. Not a word was
+spoken as it was shoved off through the breakers, and after ten
+minutes' hard rowing he felt a shock, and knew that they were
+alongside of the _Lucy_. He was hauled up on deck. He heard a few
+words of command, and then felt the vessel was on her way. A minute or
+two later the covering was unloosed. His cords were cut, and the
+smuggler said to him, "You can't get away now, and may as well make
+yourself handy for the present. Give a haul on that rope."
+
+The _Lucy_ was, in fact, short-handed, two of the six men who composed
+her crew being absent. She was a lugger of some twenty-five tons'
+burden, built something like an ordinary fishing-boat, but longer and
+lower, and was, in fact, used for fishing when her crew were not
+engaged upon other adventures. She was a remarkably fast craft, and
+had more than once showed her heels with success when chased by the
+revenue cutters. She owed her immunity from capture, however, chiefly
+to her appearance, as from her size and build she generally passed
+unsuspected as an innocent fisherman.
+
+The storm increased in violence, and the little lugger, although a
+good sea-boat, had difficulty in making her way almost in the teeth of
+the gale. She was bound, Harry gained from a word or two dropped by
+the captain, for the mouth of the Loire, off which she was to be met
+by the _Chasse Maree_. Long before morning the coast of England was
+out of sight, and the lugger was struggling down Channel bravely
+holding her way in the sou'westerly gale.
+
+"Will she be zere true to her time?" the Frenchman asked the smuggler.
+
+"Aye, she will do it," Black Jack said, "if the wind holds as at
+present. Two o'clock in the morning is the time named, and if your
+people are as punctual as I shall be, the five hundred pounds will be
+gained. There's one thing--in such a gale as is blowing to-day none of
+our cruisers who may be off the coast are likely to trouble themselves
+about a boat like ours. They may wonder what we are doing at sea, but
+are scarcely likely to chase us."
+
+Once or twice in the course of the day large vessels were seen in the
+distance, which Harry knew, by the cut of their sails, to be English
+cruisers. All were, however, lying-to under the smallest canvas, and
+Harry knew that any assistance from them was out of the question.
+Towards evening the gale moderated, but the sea was still very high.
+During the day Harry had turned over in his mind every possible plan
+by which he might destroy the tin case which contained, as he knew,
+such important documents. From what he had gathered he learned that
+the success of some great undertaking upon which the British fleet
+were about to embark would be marred if these papers were to find
+their way into the hands of the French authorities. His own life he
+regarded as absolutely forfeited, for he was sure that no sooner was
+he fairly on board the French _Chasse Maree_ than he would, at the
+orders of the French spy, be thrown overboard, and that his life had
+been so preserved, not from any feeling of mercy, but in order that
+his death might be accomplished with less risk to those whose safety
+demanded it.
+
+He was determined, if opportunity presented, to seize the little case
+and to leap overboard with it. The French spy never for one moment put
+it down. It was a small tin case, with a handle at the top, and some
+eight inches long by three inches wide, and the same deep. Sometimes
+the Frenchman put it in his pocket, beyond which it projected, but
+even then he took the precaution always to keep his hand upon it.
+During the day Harry was constantly employed in work on board the
+lugger, hauling at ropes and acting as if he were one of the regular
+crew. He had shared in the meals with the men, but beyond a curse now
+and then not a word had been addressed to him by any on board. The
+night came on; the wind was still going down, but the sea was very
+heavy. From the occasional rifts in the clouds the stars could be seen
+shining brightly, and once or twice the moon broke through and spread
+a light over the angry sea. As time went on the smuggler became
+anxious, and kept a keen lookout ahead.
+
+"It is past two," he exclaimed presently to the Frenchman, "and we are
+nearly off the mouth of the river. When the moon shone out just now I
+thought I caught sight of a vessel coming out, and I believe to
+windward an English cruiser is lying. However, I will get ready the
+lanterns."
+
+The next time the moon came out a vessel was clearly seen. The
+smuggler raised the lantern above the bulwarks, held it there for half
+a minute, and then lowered it. This he repeated three times. A moment
+later a similar signal was made on the bows of the vessel.
+
+"That's her," the smuggler exclaimed exultingly, "and the five hundred
+pounds is as good as in my pocket!"
+
+As he spoke a bright flash was seen to windward.
+
+"Confound it!" the smuggler said, "that cruiser has caught sight of
+the Frenchman. However, we shall be on board in plenty of time, and
+whether she gets safe to shore or not matters not much to me. I shall
+have done my part of the work, and you, mounseer, will give me the
+order for payment on London."
+
+"It's done, my friend," the Frenchman said; "you've done your work
+well. Here's the order."
+
+By this time the French craft was within a distance of a quarter of a
+mile, running down at a great pace under her reefed sails.
+
+"It'll be no easy matter to get on board," the smuggler said, "for the
+sea is running tremendously. They will have to throw a rope, and you
+will have to catch it, mounseer, and jump overboard. I suppose your
+dispatch-box is water-tight?"
+
+"And the boy?" the Frenchman asked.
+
+"Let them throw another rope," the smuggler said, "and you can haul
+him on board too. It won't make much matter whether I slip the noose
+round his body or his neck. The last will be the easiest plan perhaps,
+for then, if he happens not to be alive when you pull him out, it
+would be an accident; and even if anyone chooses to peach, they can't
+swear that it was purposely done."
+
+Harry was standing near, and heard the words. He was close to the helm
+at the time, and watched with intense anxiety as the _Chasse Maree_
+ran rapidly down to them. It was clear that what had to be done must
+be done quickly, for another flash came up from the cruiser; and
+although in the din of the wind and the toss of the waves it could not
+be seen where her shot had fallen, the brightness of the flash showed
+that she had come up since the last shot was discharged. The _Chasse
+Maree_ ran down, and as she came her captain stood upon the bulwarks
+and shouted at the top of his voice "Keep her steady, and as I run
+past I will throw a rope."
+
+"Throw two," Black Jack shouted. "There are two to come on board."
+
+The course taken by the _Chasse Maree_ would bring her along at a
+distance of some ten yards from the side of the lugger. At the moment
+a squall came, and the lugger's head turned a little towards the
+approaching craft. When she was just upon them Harry saw that his one
+chance of escape had come. With a sudden rush he knocked the man at
+the helm from his footing, and put the tiller up hard. The lugger paid
+off instantly. Black Jack, with an oath, turned round and sprang at
+Harry. The lad leaped beneath his uplifted hand, sprang at the
+Frenchman, who was standing with his back to him, and snatching the
+tin box from his hand leaped overboard.
+
+Momentary as had been his hold upon the tiller it had been sufficient.
+The vessel had paid off from the wind, and before the helmsman could
+regain his feet, or Black Jack could seize the tiller, she lay across
+the course of the _Chasse Maree_; and in another moment the French
+craft plunged down upon her, and with a crash the _Lucy_ sank under
+her bows, and went down with all on board.
+
+As Harry sank beneath the waves he heard a shout of dismay from those
+on board the _Lucy_. When he came up a minute later he saw the _Chasse
+Maree_ plowing her way from him, but no sign of the _Lucy_ was to be
+seen. Harry was a good swimmer, and fortunately the dispatch-box which
+he grasped was water-tight, and buttoning it within his jacket he felt
+that it kept his head easily above the water. He swam as well as he
+could away from the spot where the Lucy had disappeared, for he knew
+that if Black Jack or the Frenchman had escaped being run down and
+should see him, his death was certain--not indeed that his chances
+were in any case good, but with the natural hopefulness of boyhood he
+clung to life, and resolved to make a fight for it as long as
+possible. Had it not been for the dispatch-box he must have speedily
+succumbed, for in so heavy a sea it was difficult in the extreme to
+swim. However, after a short time he turned his back to the wind, and
+suffered himself quietly to drift.
+
+Hour passed after hour, and at last, to his intense delight, morning
+began to break. He saw on his right the low shores of the French
+coast, and looking round beheld seaward the British cruiser which had
+fired at the _Chasse Maree_. She was running quietly along the coast,
+and was evidently on guard at the mouth of the river. The sea had now
+gone down much, and the sun rose bright in an almost cloudless sky.
+
+Invigorated by the sight of the vessel Harry at once swam towards her.
+She was farther out by a mile than the spot where he was swimming, and
+was some two miles astern of him. She was sailing but slowly, and he
+hoped that by the time she came along he would be able to get within
+a distance whence he might be seen. His fear was that she might run
+back before she reached the spot where she would be nearer to him.
+
+With all his strength he swam steadily out, keeping his eye fixed
+steadily on the ship. Still she came onward, and was within half a
+mile when she was abreast of him. Then raising himself as high as he
+could from the water, he shouted at the top of his voice. Again and
+again he splashed with his hands to make as much spray and commotion
+as possible in order to attract attention. His heart almost stood
+still with joy as he heard an answering hail, and a moment later he
+saw the vessel come round into the wind, and lay there with her sails
+back. Then a boat was lowered, and five minutes later he was hauled
+in, his senses almost leaving him now that the time for exertion had
+passed. It was not until he had been lifted onto the deck of the
+_Viper_, and brandy had been poured down his throat, that he was able
+to speak. As soon as he was sufficiently recovered he was sent for to
+the captain's cabin.
+
+"And who are you, boy, and whence do you come?" the captain asked. "Do
+you belong to the _Chasse Maree_, which we chased in the night?"
+
+The officer spoke in French, supposing that Harry had fallen overboard
+from that craft.
+
+"I am English, sir," Harry said, "and escaped from a lugger which was
+run down by the French craft just as you were firing at her."
+
+"I thought," exclaimed the captain, "that my eyes had not been wrong.
+I was sure that I saw a small fishing-boat close to the _Chasse
+Maree_. We lost sight of her when a cloud came over the moon, and
+thought we must have been mistaken. How came you there in an English
+fishing-boat?"
+
+Harry modestly told the story, and produced the dispatch-box.
+
+"This is important news indeed," the officer said, "and your conduct
+has been in every way most gallant. What is your name, lad?"
+
+"Harry Langley," he replied. "I am an apprentice on board the Indiaman
+_Dundas Castle_, and was to have sailed this week in the convoy for
+the West Indies."
+
+"You will not be able to do that now," the captain said. "This is most
+important. However, the steward will take charge of you, and I will
+talk to you again presently."
+
+The steward was called, and was told to put Harry into a cot slung for
+him, and to give him a bowl of warm soup; and in a few minutes the lad
+was asleep.
+
+The _Viper_ shortly afterwards hauled her wind, and ran down to a
+consort who was keeping watch with her over the mouth of the Loire.
+The captain repaired on board the other ship, whose commander was his
+senior officer, and a consultation was held between them, after which
+the _Viper_ was again got under sail and shaped her course for
+Portsmouth.
+
+The wind was fair, and the next morning the _Viper_ passed through
+the Needles, and soon afterwards anchored at Spithead. Here a large
+number of men-of-war and frigates were at anchor, and above two of the
+largest floated the flags of admirals. The _Viper_ had made her signal
+as she came in sight of the fleet, and a reply was instantly run up
+from the masthead of the admiral's ship, directing the captain to come
+on board immediately the anchor was dropped. The moment this was done
+the captain's gig was lowered, and calling to Harry to follow him the
+captain took his seat in the stern-sheets, and rowed for the admiral's
+ship. Directing the lad to remain on deck, the captain at once entered
+the admiral's cabin, and a few minutes later the admiral's orderly
+summoned Harry to enter.
+
+Admiral Sir Hyde Parker had evidently had a breakfast party, for a
+number of naval officers, including Admiral Nelson and most of the
+captains of the men-of-war, were seated round the table. The admiral
+turned to Harry.
+
+"So you are the lad who has brought this box of dispatches?"
+
+"Yes, sir," Harry said modestly.
+
+"Tell us your story over again," the admiral said. "It's a strange
+one."
+
+Harry again repeated the account of his adventures from the time of
+leaving his father's cottage. When he had done Admiral Nelson
+exclaimed:
+
+"Very well, my lad. You could not have acted with more presence of
+mind had you been a captain of the fleet. You showed great bravery
+and did your duty nobly."
+
+"There wasn't much bravery, sir," Harry said modestly, "for I knew
+that they were going to kill me anyhow, so that it made no difference.
+But I was determined, if possible, that the dispatches should be
+destroyed."
+
+The admiral smiled. He was not accustomed to hear his dicta even so
+slightly questioned by a lad.
+
+"You are an apprentice in the merchant service, Captain Skinner tells
+me," Sir Hyde Parker said, "and have been two years at sea."
+
+"Yes, sir," Harry said.
+
+"Would you like to be on the quarter-deck of one of his majesty's
+vessels, instead of that of a merchantman?"
+
+Harry's eyes glistened at the question.
+
+"I should indeed, sir," he said.
+
+"Then you shall be, my boy," the admiral answered. "Have any of you
+gentlemen a vacancy in the midshipmen's berth? If not, I'll have him
+ranked as a supernumerary on board my ship."
+
+"I am short of a midshipman, Sir Hyde," one of the captains said.
+"Poor little De Lisle fell overboard the night before last as we came
+round from Plymouth. He was about the size of this lad, and I'll
+arrange for him to have his togs. I like his look, and I should be
+glad to have him with me. I am sure he will be a credit to the
+service."
+
+"That's settled, then," the admiral said. "You are now, sir," he said,
+turning to Harry again, "an officer in his majesty's service, and, as
+Captain Ball remarks, I am sure you will do credit to the service. A
+lad who does his duty when death is staring him in the face, and
+without a hope that the act of devotion will ever be known or
+recognized, is sure to make a brave and worthy officer."
+
+Harry's new captain wrote a few words on a piece of paper, and said to
+the admiral's servant, "Will you tell the midshipman of my gig to come
+here?"
+
+A minute afterwards the midshipman entered. The captain gave him the
+slip of paper and said, "Take this young gentleman on board the ship
+with you at once, and present him to Mr. Francis, and with him give
+this note. He will be your shipmate in future. See that he's made
+comfortable."
+
+The midshipman then beckoned to Harry to follow him, gazing askance,
+and with no slight astonishment in his face, at the appearance of his
+new messmate. Harry's attire, indeed, was not in accordance with the
+received ideas of that of a midshipman freshly joining a ship. His
+clothes were all so much shrunk that his ankles showed below his
+trousers, and his wrists below his coat-sleeves. Without a word the
+midshipman took his place in the stern-sheets, and beckoned Harry to
+sit beside him.
+
+"Where have you sprung from?" he said shortly.
+
+"I hail last from the admiral's cabin," Harry said with a laugh.
+"Before that from his majesty's ship _Viper_, and before that from the
+sea."
+
+"You look like the sea," said the midshipman. "But what have you been
+doing? Have you served before?"
+
+"Not in a king's ship," Harry said; "I have only just been appointed."
+
+The midshipman was too surprised at Harry's appearance to question him
+further. He felt that there was some mystery in the affair, and that
+it would be better for him to wait until he saw the footing upon which
+Harry was placed. He had little doubt from the fact of his appointment
+being made under such circumstances that there must be something at
+once singular and noteworthy about it.
+
+Upon reaching the ship Harry's new messmate at once led him up to the
+first lieutenant, and presented the captain's note. The lieutenant
+opened it and glanced at the contents. They were brief:
+
+"Harry Langley has been appointed midshipman on board the _Caesar_, and
+has been promoted by Sir Hyde Parker himself. He has performed a most
+gallant action, and one of the greatest importance. Make him at home
+at once, and let him have poor De Lisle's kit. I will arrange about
+it."
+
+The senior midshipman was at once sent for by Mr. Francis, and Harry
+handed over to him. The first lieutenant intimated to him briefly the
+contents of the captain's letter, telling the midshipman to make him
+as comfortable as possible.
+
+Harry was led below to the cockpit, where his arrival was greeted with
+a storm of questions, as his appearance on the quarter-deck had
+naturally excited a great deal of observation. The midshipman who had
+come with him could, of course, furnish no information, and beyond the
+brief fact mentioned by the captain and repeated by the first
+lieutenant, his new conductor could say no more.
+
+"Just wait," the midshipman said, "till he's got into his new clothes
+and looks presentable. He's in my charge, and I am to make him
+comfortable. As he has been put on the quarter-deck by Sir Hyde
+himself you may be sure he has done something out of the way."
+
+In a few minutes Harry was rigged out in full midshipman's dress, and
+being a very good-looking and gentlemanly lad, his appearance
+favorably impressed his new messmates, who had at first been disposed
+to resent the intrusion among themselves of a youngster whose
+appearance was at least the reverse of reputable.
+
+"Now," said one of the passed mates, "this meeting will resolve itself
+into a committee. Let everyone who can, sit down; and let those who
+can't, stand quiet. I am the president of the court. Now, prisoner at
+the bar," he said, "what is your name?"
+
+"Harry Langley."
+
+"And how came you here?"
+
+"I was brought in the captain's gig."
+
+"No equivocation, prisoner. I mean what brought you onto the
+quarter-deck?"
+
+"I had the good luck," Harry said, "to prevent a very important
+dispatch falling into the hands of the French."
+
+"The deuce you had!" the president said; "and how was that? That is to
+say," he said, "if there's no secret about it?"
+
+"None at all," Harry said, "the matter was very simple;" and for the
+second time that morning he told the story.
+
+When he had done there was a general exclamation of approval among
+those present, and the midshipmen crowded round him, shaking his hand,
+patting him on the back, and declaring that he was a trump.
+
+"The prisoner is acquitted," the president said, "and is received as a
+worthy member of this noble body. Boy!"
+
+"Yes, sir."
+
+"Go to the purser and ask him to send in two bottles of rum for this
+honorable mess to drink the health of a new comrade."
+
+Presently the boy returned.
+
+"The purser says, sir, who is going to pay for the rum?"
+
+There was a roar of laughter among the middies, for the master's mate,
+who had acted as president, was notoriously in the purser's books to
+the full amount of his credit. However, a midshipman, who happened
+that morning to have received a remittance, undertook to stand the
+liquor to the mess, and Harry's health was drunk with all honors.
+
+"I suppose," one of the midshipmen said, "that the contents of the
+dispatch were with reference to the point to which we are all bound. I
+wonder where it can be?"
+
+Here an animated discussion arose as to the various points against
+which the attack of the fleet, now rapidly assembling at Spithead,
+might be directed. So far no whisper of its probable course had been
+made public, and it was believed indeed that even the captains of the
+fleet were ignorant of its object.
+
+Upon the following day Harry at once obtained leave to go on shore for
+twenty-four hours. Immediately he reached the Head he chartered a
+wherry, and was on the point of sailing when he heard a well-known
+voice among a group of sailors standing near him.
+
+"I can't make head or tail of it," Peter Langley said. "My boy left me
+merely to go down to the village, and was to have returned the first
+thing in the morning to join his ship in London. Well, he never came
+back no more. What he did with himself, unless he sailed in a
+smuggling lugger which put out an hour or two afterwards, I can't make
+out. The boy would never have shipped in that craft willingly, and I
+can see no reason why he should have gone otherwise. He didn't cross
+the ferry, and I can't help suspecting there was some foul play. When
+Black Jack returns I will have it out of him if I kill him for it. He
+has a strong party there, and I want half a dozen good tight hands to
+come with me to Hayling. He will probably be back in a couple of days,
+and if we tackle him directly he lands we may find out something about
+him. Who will go with me?"
+
+Half a dozen voices exclaimed that they were willing to assist their
+old mate, when suddenly Harry stepped in among them, saying, "There's
+no occasion for that. I can tell them all about him."
+
+Peter Langley stepped backwards in his astonishment, and stared
+open-mouthed at Harry.
+
+"Dash my buttons!" he exclaimed; "why, if it isn't Harry himself, and
+in a midshipman's rig. What means this, my boy?"
+
+"It means, father, that I am a midshipman on board his majesty's ship
+_Caesar_."
+
+Peter stood for a moment as one stupefied with astonishment, and then
+threw his tarpaulin high in the air with a shout of delight. It fell
+into the water, and the tide carried it away; Peter gave it no further
+thought, but, seizing Harry's hand, wrung it with enthusiastic
+delight.
+
+"This is news indeed, my boy," he said. "To think of seeing you on the
+quarter-deck, and that so soon!"
+
+It was some minutes before Harry could shake himself free from his
+friends, all of whom were old chums of the boatswain, and had known
+him in his childhood. Drawing Peter aside at last he took him to a
+quiet hotel, and there, to the intense astonishment of the veteran, he
+related to him the circumstances which had led to his elevation. The
+old sailor was alternately filled with wrath and admiration, and it
+was only the consideration that beyond doubt Black Jack and the
+Frenchman had both perished in the _Lucy_ that restrained him from
+instantly rushing off to take vengeance upon them.
+
+An hour later the pair took a wherry and sailed to Hayling, where the
+joy of Peter was rivaled by that of Harry's foster-mother. That
+evening Peter went out and so copiously ordered grog for all the
+seafaring population in honor of the event that the village was a
+scene of rejoicing and festivity such as was unknown in its quiet
+annals.
+
+The next day Harry rejoined his ship, and commenced his regular duties
+as a midshipman on board.
+
+A week later the whole of the ships destined to take part in it had
+arrived. The "Blue Peter" was hoisted at the ship's head, and on a gun
+firing from the admiral's ship the anchors were weighed, and the fleet
+soon left Spithead behind them. It consisted of eighteen sail of the
+line, with a number of frigates and gunboats. The expedition was
+commanded by Sir Hyde Parker, with Admiral Nelson second in command.
+Contrary to the general expedition they sailed eastward instead of
+passing through the Solent, and, coasting along the south of England,
+passed through the Straits of Dover and stood out into the North Sea.
+
+Harry had had an interview with his captain four days after he had
+joined. The latter told him that the dispatch-box which he had taken
+had been sent up to London, and that its contents proved to be of the
+highest importance, and that the Lords of the Admiralty had themselves
+written to the admiral expressing their extreme satisfaction at the
+capture, saying that the whole of their plans would have been
+disconcerted had the papers fallen into the hands of the enemy. They
+were pleased to express their strong approval of the conduct of Harry
+Langley, and gave their assurance that when the time came his claim
+for promotion should not be ignored.
+
+"So, my lad," the captain said, "you may be sure that when you have
+passed your cadetship you will get your epaulette without loss of
+time, and if you are steady and well conducted you may look out for a
+brilliant position. It is not many lads who enter the navy under such
+favorable conditions. I should advise you to study hard in order to
+fit yourself for command when the time should come. From what you tell
+me your education has not been neglected, and I have no doubt you know
+as much as the majority of my midshipmen as to books. But books are
+not all. An officer in his majesty's service should be a gentleman.
+That you are that in manner, I am happy to see. But it is desirable
+also that an officer should be able in all society to hold his own in
+point of general knowledge with other gentlemen. Midshipmen, as a
+class, are too much given to shirking their studies, and to think that
+if an officer can handle and fight a ship it is all that is required.
+It may be all that is absolutely necessary, but you will find that the
+men who have most made their mark are all something more than rough
+sailors. I need say nothing to you as to the necessity of at all times
+and hazards doing your duty. That is a lesson that you have clearly
+already learned."
+
+As the fleet still kept east, expectation rose higher and higher as to
+the object of the expedition. Some supposed that a dash was to be made
+on Holland. Others conceived that the object of the expedition must be
+one of the North German or Russian forts, and the latter were
+confirmed in their ideas when one fine morning the fleet were found to
+be entering the Sound. Instead of passing through, however, the fleet
+anchored here, out of gunshot of the forts of Copenhagen; and great
+was the astonishment of the officers and men alike of the fleet when
+it became known that an ultimatum had been sent on shore, and that the
+Danes (who had been regarded as a neutral power) were called upon at
+once to surrender their fleet to the English.
+
+Upon the face of facts known to the world at large, this was indeed a
+most monstrous breach of justice and right. The Danes had taken no
+part in the great struggle which had been going on, and their
+sympathies were generally supposed to be with the English rather than
+the French. Thus, for a fleet to appear before the capital of Denmark,
+and to summon its king to surrender his fleet, appeared a high-handed
+act of brute force.
+
+In fact, however, the English government had learned that negotiations
+had been proceeding between the Danish government and the French; and
+that a great scheme had been agreed upon, by which the Danes should
+join the French at a given moment, and the united fleets being
+augmented by ships of other powers, a sudden attack would be made upon
+England. Had this secret confederation not been interfered with, the
+position of England would have been seriously threatened. The fleet
+which the allies would have been able to put onto the scene would have
+greatly exceeded that which England could have mustered to defend her
+coast, and although peace nominally prevailed between England and
+Denmark the English ministry considered itself justified--and
+posterity has agreed in the verdict--in taking time by the forelock,
+and striking a blow before their seeming ally had time to throw off
+the mask and to join in the projected attack upon them.
+
+It was the news of this secret resolve on the part of the cabinet
+that, having in some way been obtained by a heavy bribe from a
+subordinate in the admiralty, was being carried over in cipher to
+France in the _Lucy_, and had it reached its destination the Danes
+would have been warned in time, and the enterprise undertaken by
+Parker and Nelson would have been impossible, for the forts of
+Copenhagen, aided by the fleet in the harbor, were too strong to have
+been attacked had they been thoroughly prepared for the strife. As all
+these matters were unknown to the officers of the fleet, great was the
+astonishment when the captains of the ships assembled in the admiral's
+cabin, and each received orders as to the position which his vessel
+was to take up, and the part it was to bear in the contest. This being
+settled, the captains returned to their respective ships.
+
+Several days were spent in negotiations, but as the Danes finally
+refused compliance with the English demands the long-looked-for signal
+was hoisted and the fleet stood in through the Sound. It was a fine
+sight as the leading squadron, consisting of twelve line-of-battle
+ships and a number of frigates under Admiral Nelson, steered on
+through the Sound, followed at a short distance by Sir Hyde Parker
+with the rest of the fleet. The Danish forts on the Sound cannonaded
+them, but their fire was very ineffectual, and the fleet without
+replying steered on until they had attained the position intended for
+them. The Danes were prepared for action. Their fleet of thirteen
+men-of-war and a number of frigates, supported by floating batteries
+mounting seventy heavy guns, was moored in a line four miles long in
+front of the town, and was further supported by the forts on shore.
+
+This great force was to be engaged by the squadron of Admiral Nelson
+alone, as that of Sir Hyde Parker remained outside menacing the
+formidable Crown Batteries and preventing these from adding their fire
+to that of the fleet and other shore batteries upon Nelson's squadron.
+
+The _Caesar_, the leading ship of the fleet, had been directed to sail
+right past the line of ships and to operate against a detached fort
+standing on a spit of land on the right flank of the Danish position.
+This fort mounted many guns, much superior to those of the Caesar in
+weight, but the crew were in high spirits at the prospect of a fight,
+little as they understood the cause for which they were engaged.
+Stripping to the waist, they clustered round the guns, each officer at
+his post, Harry, with two other midshipmen, being upon the
+quarter-deck near the captain to carry orders from him as might be
+required to different parts of the ship. As the _Caesar_ passed along
+the line of ships to take up her position she was saluted by a storm
+of fire from the Danish vessels, to which she made no reply. She
+suffered, however, but little injury, although shot and shell whistled
+between the masts and struck the water on all sides of her, several
+striking the hull with a dull, crashing sound, while her sails were
+pierced with holes. Harry felt that he was rather pale, and was
+disgusted with himself at the feeling of discomfort which he
+experienced. But there is nothing that tries the nerves more than
+standing the fire of an enemy before it is time to set to work to
+reply. As soon as orders were given for the _Caesar's_ fire to be
+opened, directly the guns could be brought to bear, and the roar of
+her cannon answered those of the fort, the feeling of uneasiness on
+Harry's part disappeared, and was succeeded by that of the excitement
+of battle. The din was prodigious. Along the whole line the British
+fleet was engaged, and the boom of the heavy guns of the ships, forts,
+and batteries, and the rattle of musketry from the tops of the ships,
+kept up a deep roar like that of incessant thunder.
+
+"The water is very shallow, sir," the first lieutenant reported to the
+captain. "There are but two fathoms under her foot. The wind, too, is
+dropping so much that we have scarcely steerage-way, and the current
+is sweeping us along fast."
+
+"Prepare to anchor, Mr. Francis," the captain said.
+
+He had scarcely spoken, however, when there was a slight shivering
+sensation in the ship, and it was known by all on board that she was
+aground, and that on a falling tide. While the starboard guns were
+kept at work the men were called off from those of the port side,
+boats were lowered and hawsers were got out, and every effort was made
+to tow the ship off the shoal. The sailors pulled hard in spite of the
+storm of shot and shell which fell round them from the fort and the
+nearest Danish ships. But the _Caesar_ was fast. Calling the men on
+board again, the captain requested the first lieutenant to go aloft
+and see what was going on in other parts of the line. He returned with
+the news that four or five other ships were plainly aground, and that
+things appeared to be going badly. In the meantime the _Caesar_ was
+suffering heavily. The fire of the fort was well directed, and the
+gunners, working their pieces under comparative shelter, were able to
+pour their fire steadily into the _Caesar_, while a floating battery
+and two frigates also kept up an incessant fire.
+
+The number of killed and wounded was already large, but as only the
+guns of the starboard side could be worked the fire was kept up with
+unabated zeal, and the fort bore many signs of the accuracy of the
+fire. The parapet was in many places shot away and several of the guns
+put out of action. But the _Caesar_ was clearly overmatched, and the
+captain hastily wrote a note to the admiral, stating that the ship was
+aground and was altogether overmatched, and begging that another
+vessel might be dispatched to his aid, if one could be spared, in
+order to partially relieve her of the enemy's fire.
+
+"Here, Mr. Langley, take the gig and row off to the flagship
+instantly."
+
+Harry obeyed orders. Through the storm of shot and shell which was
+flying, striking up the water in all directions, he made his way to
+the admirals ship, which was lying nearly a mile away.
+
+Admiral Nelson opened the note and read it through.
+
+"Tell Captain Ball," he said, "that I haven't a ship to spare.
+Several are aground, and all hard pressed. He must do the best he can.
+Ah! you are the lad whom I saw in Sir Hyde Parker's cabin, are you
+not?"
+
+"Yes, sir."
+
+The Admiral nodded in token of approval, and Harry prepared to leave.
+Suddenly a thought struck him, and running into the captain's cabin he
+asked the steward for a small tablecloth.
+
+"What on earth d'you want it for?" he exclaimed.
+
+"Never mind. Give it me at once."
+
+Seizing the tablecloth he ran down into the boat. As they returned
+towards the _Caesar_ they could see how hardly matters were going with
+her. One of her masts was down. Her sides were battered and torn, and
+several of her port-holes were knocked into one. Still her fire
+continued unabated, but it was clear that she could not much longer
+resist.
+
+"Do you think she must haul down her flag?" Harry said to the coxswain
+of the boat.
+
+"Aye, aye, sir," the coxswain said. "Wood and iron can't stand such a
+pounding as that much longer. Most captains would have hauled down the
+flag long before this, and even our skipper can't stand out much
+longer. There won't be a man alive to fight her."
+
+"Will you do as I order?" Harry said.
+
+"Aye, sir," the coxswain said in surprise, "I will do what you like;"
+for the story of the conduct by which Harry had gained his
+midshipman's promotion had been repeated through the ship, and the men
+were all proud of the lad who had behaved so pluckily.
+
+"At least," Harry said, "it may do good, and it can't do harm. Where's
+the boat-hook? Fasten this tablecloth to it and pull for the fort."
+
+The coxswain gave an exclamation of surprise, but did as Harry told
+him, and with the white flag flying the boat pulled straight towards
+the fort. As he was seen to do so the fire of the latter, which had
+been directed towards the boat, ceased, although the duel between the
+battery and the _Caesar_ continued with unabated vigor. Harry steered
+direct to the steps on the sea face and mounted to the interior of the
+fort, where, on saying that he brought a message from the captain, he
+was at once conducted to the commandant.
+
+"I am come, sir," Harry said, "from the captain to beg of you to
+surrender at once. Your guns have been nobly fought, but two more
+ships are coming down to engage with you, and the captain would fain
+save further effusion of life. You have done all that brave men could
+do, but the fight everywhere goes against you, and further resistance
+is vain. In a quarter of an hour a fire will be centered upon your
+guns that will mean annihilation, and the captain therefore begs you
+to spare the brave men under your orders from further sacrifice."
+
+Taken by surprise by this sudden demand, which was fortunately at the
+moment backed up by two ships of the squadron which had hitherto taken
+no part in the action being seen sailing in, the governor, after a
+hasty consultation with his officers, resolved to surrender, and two
+minutes afterwards the Danish flag was hauled down in the fort and the
+white flag run up. One of the Danish officers was directed to return
+with Harry to the ship to notify the captain of the surrender of the
+fort.
+
+The astonishment of Captain Ball at seeing the course of his boat
+suddenly altered, a white flag hoisted, and the gig proceeding direct
+to the fort, had been extreme, and he could only suppose that Harry
+had received some orders direct from the admiral and that a general
+cessation of hostilities was ordered. His surprise became astonishment
+when he saw the Danish flag disappear and the white flag hoisted in
+its place; and a shout of relief and exultation echoed from stem to
+stern of the _Caesar_, for all had felt that the conflict was hopeless
+and that in a few minutes the _Caesar_ must strike her flag. All sorts
+of conjectures were rife as to the sudden and unexpected surrender of
+the fort, and expectation was at its highest when the gig was seen
+rowing out again with a Danish officer by the side of the midshipman.
+
+On reaching the ship's side Harry ascended the ladder with the Danish
+officer, and advancing to Captain Ball said:
+
+"This officer, sir, has, in compliance with the summons which I took
+to the commander of the fort in your name, come off to surrender."
+
+The Danish officer advanced and handed his sword to the captain,
+saying:
+
+"In the name of the commander of the fort I surrender."
+
+The captain handed him back his sword, and ordering Harry to follow
+him at once entered his cabin. His astonishment was unbounded when the
+latter informed him what he had done, with many apologies for having
+taken the matter into his own hands.
+
+"I saw," he said, "that the _Caesar_ was being knocked to pieces, and
+the coxswain told me that it was impossible she could much longer
+resist. I therefore thought that I could do no harm by calling upon
+the governor to surrender, and that it was possible that I might
+succeed, as you see that I have."
+
+"You certainly have saved the _Caesar_," Captain Ball said warmly, "and
+we are all indeed indebted to you. It was a piece of astounding
+impudence indeed for a midshipman to convey a message with which his
+captain had not charged him; but success in the present case a
+thousand times condones the offense. You have indeed done well, young
+sir, and I and the ship's company are vastly indebted to you. I will
+report the matter to the admiral."
+
+A hundred men speedily took their places in the boats. Lieutenant
+Francis was sent ashore to take possession, and a few minutes later
+the British flag was flying upon the fort.
+
+Ordering Harry to accompany him, Captain Ball at once took his place
+in his gig and rowed to the flagship. The battle was still raging, and
+to the practiced eye there was no doubt that the English fleet was
+suffering very severely. Captain Ball mounted the quarter-deck, and
+saluting the admiral reported that the fort with which he was engaged
+had struck, but that the _Caesar_ being aground was unable to render
+any assistance to the general attack.
+
+"A good many of us are aground, Ball," Admiral Nelson said, "but I
+congratulate you on having caused the fort to haul down its colors.
+Several of the Danish men-of-war have struck, but we cannot take
+possession, and fresh boat-loads of men came off from shore, and their
+fire has reopened. Our position is an unpleasant one. Sir Hyde Parker
+has signaled to me to draw off, but so far I have paid no attention. I
+fear that we shall have to haul off and leave some four or five ships
+to the enemy."
+
+"The fact is," Captain Ball said, "it wasn't I who made the fort haul
+down its flag, but this midshipman of mine."
+
+"Ha!" said the admiral, glancing at Harry, who, at Captain Ball's
+order, had left the boat and was standing a short distance off. "How
+on earth did he do that?"
+
+"When you told him, sir, that you could give us no aid he took upon
+himself, instead of returning to the ship, to row straight to the
+fort with one of your tablecloths fastened to the boat-hook, and
+summoned the commander in my name to surrender at once so as to save
+all further effusion of life, seeing that more ships were bearing down
+and that he had done all that a brave man could, and should now think
+of the lives of his troops."
+
+"An impudent little rascal!" the admiral exclaimed. "Midshipmen were
+impudent enough in my days, but this boy beats everything. However,
+his idea was an excellent one, and, by Jupiter! I will adopt it
+myself. A man should never be above learning, and we are in such a
+sore strait that one catches at a straw."
+
+So saying, the admiral, calling to his own captain, entered his cabin,
+and at once indited a letter to the King of Denmark begging him to
+surrender in order to save the blood of his subjects, expressing
+admiration at the way in which they had fought, and saying that they
+had done all that was possible to save honor, and might now surrender
+with a full consciousness of having done their duty. This missive was
+at once dispatched to shore, and the admiral awaited with anxiety its
+result.
+
+A half-hour elapsed, the firing continuing with unabated fury.
+
+"By Jove, Ball," the admiral suddenly exclaimed, "there's the white
+flag!" and a tremendous cheer broke along the whole of the British
+ships as the flag of truce waved over the principal fort of
+Copenhagen. Instantly the fire on both sides ceased. Boats passed
+between the shore and the flagship with the proposals for surrender
+and conditions. Nelson insisted that the Danish fleet should be
+surrendered, in so firm and decisive a tone as to convince the king
+that he had it in his power completely to destroy the town, and had
+only so far desisted from motives of humanity. At length, to the
+intense relief of the admiral and his principal officers, who knew how
+sore the strait was, and to the delight of the sailors, the
+negotiations were completed, and the victory of Copenhagen won.
+
+"Where's that boy?" the admiral asked.
+
+"That boy" was unfortunately no longer on the quarter-deck. One of the
+last shots fired from the Danish fleet had struck him above the knee,
+carrying away his leg. He had at once been carried down to the
+cockpit, and was attended to by the surgeons of the flagship. In the
+excitement of an action men take but little heed of what is happening
+around them, and the fall of the young midshipman was unnoticed by his
+captain. Now, however, that the battle was over, Captain Ball looked
+round for his midshipman, and was filled with sorrow upon hearing what
+had happened. He hurried below to the wounded boy, whose leg had
+already been amputated, above the point at which the ball had severed
+it, by the surgeon.
+
+"The white flag has been hoisted, my lad," he said, "and Copenhagen
+has been captured, and to you more than to anyone is this great
+victory due. I am sorry, indeed, that you should have been shot."
+
+Harry smiled faintly.
+
+"It is the fortune of war, sir. My career in the navy has not been a
+long one. It is but a fortnight since I got my commission, and now I
+am leaving it altogether."
+
+"Leaving the navy, perhaps," the captain said cheerfully, "but not
+leaving life, I hope. I trust there's a long one before you; but
+Admiral Nelson will, I am sure, be as grieved as I am that the career
+of a young officer, who promised to rise to the highest honors of his
+profession and be a credit and glory to his country, has been cut
+short."
+
+A short time later the admiral himself came down and shook hands with
+the boy, and thanked him for his services, and cheered him up by
+telling him that he would take care that his presence of mind and
+courage should be known.
+
+For some days Harry lay between life and death, but by the time that
+the ship sailed into Portsmouth harbor the doctors had considerable
+hope that he would pull round. He was carried at once to the Naval
+Hospital, and a few hours later Peter Langley was by his bedside. His
+captain frequently came to see him, and upon one occasion came while
+his foster-father was sitting by his bedside.
+
+"Ah, Peter, is it you?" he said. "Your son told me that you had served
+his majesty; but I didn't recognize the name as that of my old
+boatswain on board the _Cleopatra_."
+
+"I am glad to see your honor," Peter said; "but I wish it had been on
+any other occasion. However, I think that the lad will not slip his
+wind this time; but he's fretting that his career on blue water is at
+an end."
+
+"It is sad that it should be so," Captain Ball said; "but there are
+many men who may live to a good age and will have done less for their
+country than this lad in the short time he was at sea. First, he
+prevented the dispatch, which would have warned the enemy of what was
+coming, from reaching them; and, in the second place, his sharpness
+and readiness saved no small portion of Admiral Nelson's fleet, and
+converted what threatened to be a defeat into a victory. You must be
+proud of your son, old salt."
+
+"Has not the boy told you, sir, that he's not my son?" the boatswain
+said.
+
+"No, indeed!" Captain Ball exclaimed, surprised; "on the contrary, he
+spoke of you as his father."
+
+In a few words Peter Langley related the circumstances of the finding
+of Harry when a baby. Captain Ball was silent for a while, and then
+said, "Do you know, Peter, that I have been greatly struck by the
+resemblance of that lad to an old friend and school-fellow of mine, a
+Mr. Harper? They are as like as two peas--that is, he is exactly what
+my friend was at his age. My friend never was married; but I remember
+hearing a good many years ago--I should say some fifteen years ago,
+which would be about in accordance with this lad's age--that he had
+lost a sister at sea. The ship she was in was supposed to have
+foundered, and was never heard of again. She was the wife of the
+captain, and was taking her first voyage with him. Of course it may be
+a mere coincidence; still the likeness is so strong that it would be
+worth while making some inquiries. Have you anything by which the
+child can be identified?"
+
+"There are some trinkets, sir, of Indian workmanship for the most
+part, and a locket. I will bring them over to your honor to-morrow if
+you will let me."
+
+"Do so," Captain Ball said; "I am going up to London to-morrow, and
+shall see my friend. Don't speak to the boy about it, for it's a
+thousand to one against its being more than a coincidence. Still I
+hope sincerely for his sake that it may be so."
+
+The next evening Captain Ball went up by coach to London, and the
+following day called upon his friend, who was a rich retired
+East-Indian director. He told the story as Peter had told it to him.
+
+"The dates answer," he said; "and, curiously, although the ship was
+lost in the West Indies, it's likely enough that the ornaments of my
+poor sister would have been Indian, as I was in the habit of often
+sending her home things from Calcutta."
+
+"I have them with me," Captain Ball said, and produced the little
+packet which Peter had given him.
+
+The old gentleman glanced at the ornaments, and then, taking the
+locket, pressed the spring. He gave a cry as he saw the portrait
+within it, and exclaimed, "Yes, that's the likeness of my sister as
+she was when I last saw her! What an extraordinary discovery! Where is
+the lad of whom you have been speaking? for surely he is my nephew,
+the son of my sister Mary and Jack Peters."
+
+Captain Ball then related the story of Harry's doings from the time he
+had known him, and the old gentleman was greatly moved at the tale of
+bravery. The very next day he went down to Portsmouth with Captain
+Ball, and Harry, to his astonishment, found himself claimed as nephew
+by the friend of his captain.
+
+When Harry was well enough to be moved he went up to London with his
+uncle, and a fortnight later received an official letter directing him
+to attend at the Board of Admiralty.
+
+Donning his midshipman uniform he proceeded thither in his uncle's
+carriage, and walked with crutches--for his wound was not as yet
+sufficiently healed to allow him to wear an artificial leg--to the
+board-room. Here were assembled the first lord and his colleagues.
+Admiral Nelson was also present, and at once greeted him kindly.
+
+A seat was placed for him, and the first lord then addressed him. "Mr.
+Peters, Admiral Nelson has brought to our notice the clever stratagem
+by which, on your own initiation and without instruction, you obtained
+the surrender of the Danish fort, and saved the _Caesar_ at a time when
+she was aground and altogether overmatched. Admiral Nelson has also
+been good enough to say that it was the success which attended your
+action which suggested to him the course that he took which brought
+the battle to a happy termination. Thus we cannot but feel that the
+victory which has been won is in no small degree due to you. Moreover,
+we are mindful that it was your bravery and quickness which prevented
+the news of the intended sailing of the fleet from reaching the
+Continent, in which case the attack could not have been carried out.
+Under such extraordinary and exceptional circumstances we feel that an
+extraordinary and exceptional acknowledgment is due to you. We all
+feel very deep regret that the loss of your leg will render you unfit
+for active service at sea, and has deprived his majesty of the loss of
+so meritorious and most promising a young officer. We are about,
+therefore, to take a course altogether without precedent. You will be
+continued on the full-pay list all your life, you will at once be
+promoted to the rank of lieutenant, three years hence to that of
+commander, and again in another three years to the rank of post
+captain. The board are glad to hear from Captain Ball that you are in
+good hands, and wish you every good fortune in life."
+
+Harry was so overcome with pleasure that he could only stammer a word
+or two of thanks, and the first lord, his colleagues, and Admiral
+Nelson having warmly shaken hands with him, he was taken back to the
+carriage, still in a state of bewilderment at the honor which had been
+bestowed upon him.
+
+There is little more to tell. Having no other relations his uncle
+adopted him as his heir, and the only further connection that Harry
+had with the sea was that when he was twenty-one he possessed the
+fastest and best-equipped yacht which sailed out of an English port.
+Later on he sat in Parliament, married, and to the end of his life
+declared that, after all, the luckiest point in his career was the
+cutting off of his leg by the last shot fired by the Danish batteries,
+for that, had this not happened, he should never have known who he
+was, would never have met the wife whom he dearly loved, and would
+have passed his life as a miserable bachelor. Peter Langley, when not
+at sea with Harry in his yacht, lived in a snug cottage at Southsea,
+and had never reason to the end of his life to regret the time when he
+sighted the floating box from the tops of the _Alert_.
+
+
+
+
+SURLY JOE.
+
+
+"You wonder why I am called Surly Joe, sir? No, as you say, I hope I
+don't deserve the title now; but I did once, and a name like that
+sticks to a man for life. Well, sir, the fish are not biting at
+present, and I don't mind if I tell you how I got it."
+
+The speaker was a boatman, a man some fifty years old, broad and
+weather-beaten; he had but one arm. I had been spending a month's
+well-earned holiday at Scarborough, and had been making the most of
+it, sailing or fishing every day. Upon my first arrival I had gone out
+with the one-armed boatman, and as he was a cheery companion, and his
+boat, the _Grateful Mary_, was the best and fastest on the strand, I
+had stuck to him throughout. The boatmen at our watering-places soon
+learn when a visitor fixes upon a particular boat, and cease to
+importune him with offers of a sail; consequently it became an
+understood thing after a day or two that I was private property, and
+as soon as I was seen making my way across the wet, soppy sand, which
+is the one drawback to the pleasure of Scarborough, a shout would at
+once be raised for Surly Joe. The name seemed a singularly
+inappropriate one; but it was not until the very day before I was
+returning to town that I made any remark on the subject. By this time
+we had become great allies; for what with a bathe in the morning
+early, a sail before lunch, and a fishing expedition afterwards, I had
+almost lived on board the _Grateful Mary_. The day had been too clear
+and bright for fishing; the curly-headed, barefooted boy who assisted
+Joe had grown tired of watching us catch nothing, and had fallen
+asleep in the bow of the boat; and the motion, as the boat rose and
+fell gently on the swell, was so eminently provocative of sleep that I
+had nodded once or twice as I sat with my eyes fixed on my line. Then
+the happy idea had occurred to me to remark that I wondered why my
+companion was called by a nickname which seemed so singularly
+inappropriate. Joe's offer to tell me how he obtained it woke me at
+once. I refilled my pipe,--an invariable custom, I observe, with
+smokers when they are sitting down to listen to a story,--passed my
+pouch to Joe, who followed my example; and when we had "lighted up"
+Joe began:
+
+"Well, sir, it's about twelve years ago. I was a strong, active chap
+then--not that I aint strong now, for I can shove a boat over the
+sandbar with any man on the shore--but I aint as active as I were. I
+warn't called Surly Joe then, and I had my two arms like other men. My
+nickname then was Curly; 'cause, you see, my hair won't lay straight
+on my head, not when it gets as wet as seaweed. I owned my own boat,
+and the boys that worked with me warn't strangers, like Dick there,
+but they were my own flesh and blood. I was mighty proud of the two
+boys: fine straight tough-built lads was they, and as good-plucked uns
+as any on the shore. I had lost their mother ten years, maybe, before
+that, and I never thought of giving them another. One of 'em was about
+twelve, just the size of Dick there; the other was a year older. Full
+of tricks and mischief they was, but good boys, sir, and could handle
+the boat nigh as well as I could. There was one thing they couldn't
+do, sir--they couldn't swim. I used to tell 'em they ought to learn;
+but there, you see, I can't swim myself, and out of all the men and
+boys on this shore I don't suppose one in twenty on 'em can swim. Rum,
+aint it, sir? All their lives in the water or on the water, seeing all
+these visitors as comes here either swimming or learning to swim, and
+yet they won't try. They talks about instinks; I don't believe in
+instinks, else everybody who's got to pass his life on the water would
+learn to swim, instead of being just the boys as never does learn.
+That year, sir, I was doing well. There was a gentleman and his wife
+and darter used to use my boat regular; morning and afternoon they'd
+go out for a sail whenever it warn't too rough for the boat to put
+out. I don't think the old gentleman and lady cared so much for it;
+but they was just wrapped up in the girl, who was a pale, quiet sort
+o' girl, who had come down to the sea for her health. She was
+wonderful fond of the sea, and a deal o' good it did her; she warn't
+like the same creature after she had been here two months.
+
+"It was a roughish sort of afternoon, with squalls from the east, but
+not too rough to go out: they was to go out at four o'clock, and they
+came down punctual; but the gentleman says, when he gets down:
+
+"'We have just got a telegram, Joe, to say as a friend is coming down
+by the five-o'clock train, and we must be at the station to meet her,
+she being an invalid; but I don't want Mary to lose her sail, so will
+trust her with you.'
+
+"'You'll take great care of her, Joe, and bring her back safe,' the
+mother says, half laughing like; but I could see she were a little
+anxious about lettin' her go alone, which had never happened before.
+
+"'I'll take care of her, ma'am,' I says; 'you may take your oath I'll
+bring her back if I comes back myself.'
+
+"'Good-by, mamma,' the girl says as she steps on the plank; 'don't you
+fidget: you know you can trust Joe; and I'll be back at half-past six
+to dinner.'
+
+"Well, sir, as we pushed off I felt somehow responsible like, and
+although I'd told the boys before that one reef would be enough, I
+made 'em put in another before I hoisted the sail. There warn't many
+boats out, for there was more sea on than most visitors care to face;
+but once fairly outside we went along through it splendid. When we got
+within a mile of Fley, I asks her if we should turn, or go on for a
+bit farther.
+
+"'We shall go back as quick as we've come, shan't we, Joe?'
+
+"'Just about the same, miss; the wind's straight on the shore.'
+
+"'We haven't been out twenty minutes,' she says, looking at her watch;
+'I'd rather go a bit farther.'
+
+"Well, sir, we ran till we were off the brig. The wind was freshening,
+and the gusts coming down strong; it was backing round rather to the
+north too, and the sea was getting up.
+
+"'I a'most think, miss, we'd better run into Filey,' I says; 'and you
+could go across by the coach.'
+
+"'But there's no danger, is there, Joe?'
+
+"'No, miss, there aint no danger; but we shall get a ducking before we
+get back; there's rain in that squall to windward.'
+
+"'Oh, I don't care a bit for rain, Joe; and the coach won't get in
+till half-past seven, and mamma would be in a dreadful fright. Oh, I'd
+so much rather go on!'
+
+"I did not say no more, but I put her about, and in another few
+minutes the squall was down upon us. The rain came against us as if it
+wanted to knock holes in the boat, and the wind just howled again. A
+sharper squall I don't know as ever I was put in. It was so black you
+couldn't have seen two boats' length. I eased off the sheet, and put
+the helm up; but something went wrong, and--I don't know rightly how
+it was, sir. I've thought it over hundreds and hundreds of times, and
+I can't reason it out in any sort of form. But the 'sponsibility of
+that young gal weighed on me, I expect, and I must somehow ha' lost my
+head--I don't know, I can't account for it; but there it was, and in
+less time than it takes me to tell you we were all in the water.
+Whatever I'd ha' been before, I was cool enough now. I threw one arm
+round the gal, as I felt her going, and with the other I caught hold
+of the side of the boat. We was under water for a moment, and then I
+made shift to get hold of the rudder as she floated bottom upwards.
+The boys had stuck to her too, but they couldn't get hold of the keel;
+for you know how deep them boats are forward, drawing nigh a foot of
+water there more than they does astern. However, after a bit, they
+managed to get down to'rds the stern, and get a hand on the keel about
+halfway along. They couldn't come no nigher, because, as you know, the
+keel of them boats only runs halfway along. 'Hould on, lads!' I
+shouted; 'hould on for your lives! They'll have seen us from the
+cliff, and 'll have a lugger out here for us in no time.'
+
+"I said so to cheer them up; but I knew in my heart that a lugger, to
+get out with that wind on, would have to run right into t'other side
+o' the bay before she could get room enough to weather the brig. The
+girl hadn't spoken a word since the squall struck us, except that she
+gave a little short cry as the boat went over; and when we came up she
+got her hands on the rudder, and held on there as well as she could
+with my help. The squall did not last five minutes; and when it
+cleared off I could look round and judge of our chances. They weren't
+good. There was a party of people on the cliff, and another on the
+brig, who were making their way out as far as they could on the brig,
+for it were about half-tide. They must have seen us go over as we went
+into the squall, for as we lifted I could see over the brig, and there
+was a man galloping on horseback along the sands to'rds Filey as hard
+as he could go. We were, maybe, a quarter of a mile off the brig, and
+I saw that we should drift down on it before a boat could beat out of
+the bay and get round to us. The sea was breaking on it, as it always
+does break if there's ever so little wind from the east, and the spray
+was flying up fifty feet in places where the waves hit the face of the
+rock. There aint a worse place on all the coast than this, running as
+it do nigh a mile out from the head, and bare at low water. The waves
+broke over the boat heavy, and I had as much as I could do to hold on
+by one hand to the rudder, which swung backwards and forwards with
+every wave. As to the boys, I knew they couldn't hold on if they
+couldn't get onto the bottom of the boat; so I shouted to 'em to try
+to climb up. But they couldn't do it, sir; they'd tried already, over
+and over again. It would ha' been easy enough in calm water; but with
+the boat rolling and such waves going over her, and knocking them back
+again when they'd half got up, it was too much for 'em. If I'd ha'
+been free I could have got 'em up by working round to the side
+opposite 'em, and given them a hand to haul them up; but as it was,
+with only one hand free, it took me all my time to hold on where I
+was. The girl saw it too, for she turned her face round to me, and
+spoke for the first time.
+
+"'Let me go, please,' says she, 'and help your boys.'
+
+"'I can't do it,' said I. 'I've got to hold you till we're both
+drowned together.'
+
+"I spoke short and hard, sir; for, if you'll believe me, I was
+actually beginning to hate that gal. There was my own two boys
+a-struggling for their lives, and I couldn't lend a hand to help 'em,
+because I was hampered by that white-faced thing. She saw it in my
+face, for she gave a sort of little cry, and said:
+
+"'Oh, do--do let me go!'
+
+"I didn't answer a word, but held on all the harder. Presently
+Bill--he was my youngest boy--sang out:
+
+"'Father, can't you get round and lend us a hand to get up? I can't
+hold on much longer.'
+
+"'I can't help you, Bill,' says I. 'I've given my promise to take this
+young woman back, and I must keep my word. Her life's more precious to
+her father than yours is to me, no doubt, and she's got to be saved.'
+
+"It was cruel of me, sir, and altogether unjust, and I knew it was
+when I said it, but I couldn't help it. I felt as if I had a devil in
+me. I was just mad with sorrow and hopelessness, and yet each word
+seemed to come as cold and hard from me as if it was frozen. For a
+moment she didn't move, and then, all of a sudden like, she gave a
+twist out of my arms and went straight down. I grabbed at her, and
+just got hold of her cloak and pulled her up again. She never moved
+after that, but just lay quiet on my arm as if she was dead. Her head
+was back, half in, half out of the water; and it was only by the tears
+that run down sometimes through her eyelids, and by a little sob in
+her breast, that I knew that she was sensible.
+
+"Presently Bill says, 'Good-by, father. God bless you!' and then he
+let go his hold and went down. Five minutes afterwards, maybe, though
+it seemed a week to me, Jack did the same.
+
+"There we was--the girl and I--alone.
+
+"I think now, sir, looking back upon it, as I was mad then. I felt
+somehow as that the gal had drowned my two boys; and the devil kept
+whispering to me to beat her white face in, and then to go with her to
+the bottom. I should ha' done it too, but my promise kept me back. I
+had sworn she should get safe to shore if I could, and it seemed to me
+that included the promise that I would do my best for us both to get
+there. I was getting weak now, and sometimes I seemed to wander, and
+my thoughts got mixed up, and I talked to the boys as if they could
+hear me. Once or twice my hold had slipped, and I had hard work enough
+to get hold again. I was sensible enough to know as it couldn't last
+much longer, and, talking as in my sleep, I had told the boys I would
+be with 'em in a minute or two, when a sound of shouting quite close
+roused me up sudden.
+
+"Then I saw we had drifted close to the brig. Some men had climbed
+along, taking hold hand-in-hand when they passed across places where
+the sea was already breaking over, and bringing with them the rope
+which, as I afterwards heard, the man on horseback had brought back
+from Filey. It was a brave deed on their part, sir, for the tide was
+rising fast. When they saw I lifted my head and could hear them they
+shouted that they would throw me the rope, and that I must leave go of
+the boat, which would have smashed us to pieces, as I knew, if she had
+struck the rocks with us. Where they were standing the rock was full
+six feet above the sea; but a little farther it shelved down, and each
+wave ran three feet deep across the brig. They asked me could I swim;
+and when I shook my head, for I was too far gone to speak now, one of
+'em jumped in with the end of the rope. He twisted it round the two of
+us, and shouted to his friends to pull. It was time, for we weren't
+much above a boat's length from the brig. Three of the chaps as had
+the rope run down to the low part of the rock and pulled together,
+while another two kept hold of the end of the rope and kept on the
+rock, so as to prevent us all being washed across the brig together. I
+don't remember much more about it. I let go the boat, sank down at
+once, as if the girl and I had been lead, felt a tug of the rope, and
+then, just as the water seemed choking me, a great smash, and I
+remember nothing else. When I came to my right senses again I was in a
+bed at Filey. I had had a bad knock on the head, and my right arm,
+which had been round the girl, was just splintered. They took it off
+that night. The first thing as they told me when I came round was that
+the gal was safe. I don't know whether I was glad or sorry to hear it.
+I was glad, because I had kept my promise and brought her back alive.
+I was sorry, because I hated her like pison. Why should she have been
+saved when my two boys was drowned? She was well-plucked, was that
+gal, for she had never quite lost her senses; and the moment she had
+got warm in bed with hot blankets, and suchlike she wanted to get dry
+clothes and to go straight on to Scarborough in a carriage. However,
+the doctor would not hear of it, and she wrote a little letter saying
+as she was all right; and a man galloped off with it on horseback, and
+got there just as they had got a carriage to the door to drive over to
+Filey to ask if there was any news there about the boat. They came
+over and slept there, and she went back with them next day. I heard
+all this afterwards, for I was off my head, what with the blow I had
+got and one thing and another, before I had been there an hour. And I
+raved and cussed at the girl, they tell me, so that they wouldn't let
+her father in to see me.
+
+"It was nigh a fortnight before I came to myself, to find my arm gone,
+and then I was another month before I was out of bed. They came over
+to Filey when I was sensible, and I hear they had got the best doctor
+over from Scarborough to see me, and paid everything for me till I was
+well, but I wouldn't see them when they came. I was quite as bitter
+against her as I had been when I was in the sea drowning; and I was so
+fierce when they talked of coming in that the doctor told them it
+would make me bad again if they came. So they went up to London, and
+when I could get about they sent me a letter, the gal herself and her
+father and mother, thanking me, I suppose; but I don't know, for I
+just tore 'em into pieces without reading them. Then a lawyer of the
+town here came to me and said he'd 'struction to buy me a new boat,
+and to buy a 'nuity for me. I told him his 'nuity couldn't bring my
+boys back again, and that I warn't going to take blood-money; and as
+to the boat, I'd knock a hole in her and sink her if she came. A year
+after that lawyer came to me again, and said he'd more 'structions;
+and I told him though I'd only one arm left I was man enough still to
+knock his head off his shoulders, and that I'd do it if he came to me
+with his 'structions or anything else.
+
+"By this time I'd settled down to work on the shore, and had got the
+name of Surly Joe. Rightly enough, too. I had one of them planks with
+wheels that people use to get in and out of the boats; and as the
+boatmen on the shore was all good to me, being sorry for my loss, and
+so telling my story to people as went out with them, I got enough to
+live on comfortable, only there was nothing comfortable about me. I
+wouldn't speak a word, good or bad, to a soul for days together,
+unless it was to swear at anyone as tried to talk to me. I hated
+everyone, and myself wuss nor all. I was always cussing the rocks that
+didn't kill me, and wondering how many years I'd got to go on at this
+work before my turn came. Fortunately I'd never cared for drink; but
+sometimes I'd find my thoughts too hard for me, and I'd go and drink
+glass after glass till I tumbled under the table.
+
+"At first my old mates tried to get me round, and made offers to me to
+take a share in their boats, or to make one in a fishing voyage; but I
+would not hear them, and in time they dropped off one by one, and left
+me to myself, and for six years there wasn't a surlier,
+wuss-conditioned, lonelier chap, not in all England, than I was. Well,
+sir, one day--it was just at the beginning of the season, but was too
+rough a day for sailing--I was a-sitting down on the steps of a
+machine doing nothing, just wondering and wondering why things was as
+they was, when two little gals cum up. One was, maybe, five, and the
+other a year younger. I didn't notice as they'd just cum away from the
+side of a lady and gentleman. I never did notice nothing that didn't
+just concern me; but I did see that they had a nurse not far off. The
+biggest girl had great big eyes, dark and soft, and she looked up into
+my face, and held out a broken wooden spade and a bit of string, and
+says she, 'Sailor-man, please mend our spade.' I was struck all of a
+heap like; for though I had been mighty fond of little children in the
+old days, and was still always careful of lifting them into boats, my
+name and my black looks had been enough, and none of them had spoken
+to me for years. I felt quite strange like when that child spoke out
+to me, a'most like what I've read Robinson Crusoe, he as was wrecked
+on the island, felt when he saw the mark of a foot.
+
+"I goes to hold out my hand, and then I draws it back, and says,
+gruff, 'Don't you see I aint got but one hand? Go to your nurse.'
+
+"I expected to see her run right off; but she didn't, but stood as
+quiet as may be, with her eyes looking up into my face.
+
+"'Nurse can't mend spade; break again when Nina digs. Nina will hold
+spade together, sailor-man tie it up strong.'
+
+"I didn't answer at once; but I saw her lip quiver, and it was plain
+she had been crying just before; so I put my hand into my pocket and
+brings out a bit of string, for the stuff she'd got in her hand was
+of no account; and I says, in a strange sort of voice, as I hardly
+knew as my own, 'All right, missy, I'll tie it.'
+
+"So she held the broken pieces together, and I ties 'em up with the
+aid of my hand and my teeth, and makes a strong, ship-shape job of it.
+I did it sitting on the bottom step, with a child standing on each
+side watching me. When I had done it the eldest took it, and felt it.
+
+"'That is nice and strong,' she said; 'thank you. Annie, say thank
+you.'
+
+"'T'ank you,' she said; and, with a little pat on my arm as a good-by,
+the little ones trotted away to a nurse sitting some little distance
+off.
+
+"It may seem a little thing to you, sir, just a half-minute's talk to
+a child; but it warn't a little thing to me. It seemed regularly to
+upset me like; and I sat there thinking it over and wondering what was
+come over me, till an hour afterwards they went past me with their
+nurse; and the little things ran up to me and said, 'The spade's quite
+good now--good-by, sailor-man!' and went on again. So I shook it off
+and went to my work; for as the tide rose the wind dropped, and a few
+boats went out; and thinking what a fool I was, was gruffer and
+surlier than ever.
+
+"Next morning I was lending a mate a hand painting a boat, when I saw
+the two children coming along the sand again, and I wondered to
+myself whether they would know me again, or think any more of me, and
+though I wanted them to do so I turned my back to the way they was
+coming, and went on with my painting. Somehow I felt wonderful glad
+when I heard their little feet come, pattering along the sand, and
+they sang out:
+
+"'Good-morning, sailor-man!'
+
+"'Good-morning!' says I, short-like, as if I didn't want no talk; and
+I goes on with my work without turning round.
+
+"Just then one of the men at the boats hails me.
+
+"'Joe, there's a party coming down.'
+
+"'I'm busy,' shouts I back; 'shove the plank out yourself.'
+
+"The children stopped quiet by me for a minute or two, watching me at
+work, and then the eldest says:
+
+"'May we get inside the boat, Joe? we've never been inside a boat, and
+we do want to so much.'
+
+"'My hand is all covered with paint,' says I, making a fight with
+myself against giving in.
+
+"Then the little one said:
+
+"'Oo stoop down, Joe; sissy and me take hold round oor neck; then oo
+stand up and we det in.'
+
+"Well, sir, the touch of their little arms and those soft little faces
+against my cheeks as they got in fairly knocked me over, and it was
+some time before I could see what I was doing.
+
+"Once in, they never stopped talking. They asked about everything, and
+I had to answer them; and as I got accustomed to it the words came
+freer, till I was talking away with them as if I had known 'em all my
+life. Once I asked them didn't their papa and mamma ever take 'em out
+for a sail, and they shook their heads and said mammy hated the sea,
+and said it was a cruel sea; by which I judged as she must have lost
+someone dear to her by it.
+
+"Well, sir, I must cut a long story short. Those children used to come
+every day down to talk with me, and I got to look for it regular; and
+if it was a wet day and they couldn't come I'd be regular put out by
+it; and I got to getting apples and cakes in my pockets for them.
+After a fortnight I took to carrying them across the wet sands and
+putting them on the stand as I wheeled it out and back with people to
+the boats. I didn't do it till they'd asked their mother, and brought
+back the message that she knew she could trust them with me.
+
+"All this time it never once struck me as strange that their nurse
+should sit with a baby-brother of theirs at a distance, and let them
+play with me by the hour together, without calling them away, for I
+wondered so much at myself, and to find myself telling stories to 'em
+just as I'd do with children who came out sailing with me in the old
+time, and in knowing as I was so wrapped up in 'em that I couldn't
+wonder at anything else. Natural like, I changed a good deal in other
+respects, and I got to give a good-morning to mates as I had scarce
+spoken with for years; and the moment the children turned down onto
+the sands there'd be sure to be a shout of 'There's your little
+ladies, Joe.'
+
+"I don't know why my mates should ha' been pleased to see me coming
+round, for I had made myself onpleasant enough on the shore; but
+they'd made 'lowances for me, and they met me as kindly as if I'd cum
+back from a vyage. They did it just quiet like, and would just say,
+natural, 'Lend us a hand here, Joe, boy,' or 'Give us a shoulder over
+the bank, Joe,' and ask me what I thought o' the weather. It was a
+hard day for me when, after staying nigh two months, the little ladies
+came to say good-by. It warn't as bad as might have been, though, for
+they were going to stay with some friends near York, and were to come
+back again in a fortnight before they went back to London. But they
+kissed me, and cried, and gave me a pipe and a lot o' 'bacca, and I
+was to think of them whenever I smoked it, and they would be sure to
+think of me, for they loved me very much.
+
+"That very afternoon, sir, as I was standing by my stage, Jim
+Saunders--he'd been mate with me before I owned a boat of my own--says
+out loud:
+
+"'Lor', here's my party a-coming down, and I've jammed my hand so as I
+can't hoist a sail. Who'll come out and lend me a hand?'
+
+"Well, everyone says they were busy, and couldn't come; but I believe
+now as the whole thing was a got-up plan to get me afloat again; and
+then Jim turns to me as if a sudden idea had struck him.
+
+"'Come, Joe, lend us a hand for the sake o' old times; come along, old
+chap.'
+
+"I was taken aback like, and could only say something about my stage;
+but half a dozen chaps volunteers to look after my stage, and afore I
+scarce knew what I was after I was bundled aboard the boat; and as the
+party got in I'm blest if I don't think as every chap on the shore
+runs in to help shove her off, and a score of hands was held out just
+to give me a shake as we started.
+
+"I don't think I was much good on that vyage, for I went and sat up in
+the bow, with my back to the others, and my eyes fixed far ahead.
+
+"I needn't tell you, sir, when I'd once broken the ice I went regular
+to the sea again, and handed my stage over to a poor fellow who had
+lost his craft and a leg the winter before.
+
+"One day when I came in from a sail I saw two little figures upon the
+sands, and it needed no word from anyone to tell me my little ladies
+had come back. They jumped and clapped their hands when they saw me,
+and would have run across the water to meet me hadn't I shouted to
+them to wait just a minute till I should be with them.
+
+"'We've been waiting a long time, Joe. Where have you been?'
+
+"'I've been out sailing, missy.'
+
+"'Joe, don't you know it's wicked to tell stories? You told us you
+should never go on sea any more.'
+
+"'No more I didn't think I should, missy; and I don't suppose I ever
+should if I hadn't met you, though you won't understand that. However,
+I've give up the stage, and have taken to the sea again.'
+
+"'I'm glad of that, Joe,' the eldest said, 'and mamma will be glad
+too.'
+
+"'Why should mamma be glad, little one?' I asked.
+
+"'Mamma will be glad,' she said positively. 'I know she will be glad
+when I tells her.'
+
+"We'd sat down by this time, and I began to talk to them about their
+mamma. Mamma very good, very kind, very pretty, they both agreed; and
+then they went on telling me about their home in London, and their
+carriage and amusements. Presently they stopped, and I could see the
+eldest wanted to say something particular, for she puckered up her
+forehead as she always did when she was very serious; and then she
+said, with her hands folded before her, almost as if she was saying a
+lesson:
+
+"'Mamma very happy woman. She's got two little girls and baby-brother,
+and papa love her so much; but there's one thing keeps her from being
+quite happy.'
+
+"'Is there, missy?' I asked. 'She ought to be happy with all these
+things. What is it?'
+
+"'Mamma once had someone do a great thing for her. If it hadn't been
+for him Nina and sissy and little baby-brother could never have been
+born, and papa would never have had dear mamma to love; but it cost
+the man who did it a great deal--all he cared for; and now he won't
+let mamma and papa and us love him and help him; and it makes mamma
+unhappy when she thinks of it.'
+
+"Here she had evidently finished what she had heard her mamma say, for
+her forehead got smooth again, and she began to fill my pockets with
+sand.
+
+"'It don't sound likely, missy, that doesn't,' I says. 'It don't stand
+to reason nohow. You can't have understood what mamma said.'
+
+"'Mamma said it over and over again, lots of time,' Nina said. 'Nina
+quite sure she said right.'
+
+"We didn't say no more about it then, though after the children had
+gone I wondered to myself how a chap could go on so foolish as that.
+Well, sir, three days after come round from Whitby this very boat, the
+_Grateful Mary_. She was sent care of Joe Denton; and as that was me,
+I had her hauled up on the beach till I should hear whose she was.
+Several visitors that had been out with me had said, promiscuous like,
+that they should like to have a boat of their own, and I supposed they
+had bought her at Whitby and sent her down, though why they should
+have sent her to my care I couldn't quite see.
+
+"Two days afterwards them children come down, and says:
+
+"'We want you to go through the town to the other cliff with us, Joe.'
+
+"'I can't,' says I. 'I'm all right talking to you here, missies; but I
+shouldn't be a credit to you in the town, and your pa wouldn't be
+best pleased if he was to see you walking about in the streets with a
+boatman.'
+
+"'Papa said we might ask you, Joe.'
+
+"I shook my head, and the little ladies ran off to their nurse, who
+come back with them and says:
+
+"'Master told me to say he should be pertickler glad if you would go
+with the young ladies.'
+
+"'Oh, very well,' I says; 'if their pa don't object, and they wishes
+it, I'd go with 'em anywheres. You wait here a quarter of an hour,
+while I goes and cleans myself, and I'll go with you.'
+
+"When I comes back the youngest takes my hand, and the oldest holds by
+my jacket, and we goes up into High Street, and across to the other
+cliff. We goes along till we comes to a pretty little cottage looking
+over the sea. There was a garden in front, new planted with flowers.
+
+"'Are you sure you are going right?' says I, when they turned in.
+
+"They nodded, and ran up to the door and turned the handle.
+
+"'Come in, Joe,' they said; and they dragged me into a parlor, where a
+lady and gentleman was sitting.
+
+"The gentleman got up.
+
+"'My little girls have spoken so much to me about you, Joe, that I
+feel that we know each other already.'
+
+"'Yes, sir, surely,' says I.
+
+"'Well, Joe, do you know that I owe you a great deal as to these
+little girls?'
+
+"'Bless you, sir, it's I as owe a great deal to the little missies;
+they have made a changed man of me, they have; you ask anyone on the
+shore.'
+
+"'I hope they have, Joe; for had they not got round your heart, and
+led you to your better self, I could never have done what I have done,
+for you would have rendered it useless.'
+
+"I didn't say nothing, sir, for I could make neither head nor tail of
+what he was saying, and, I dessay, looked as surprised as might be.
+Then he takes a step forward, and he puts a hand on my shoulder, and
+says he:
+
+"'Joe, have you never guessed who these little girls were?'
+
+"I looked first at the children, and then at him, and then at the
+lady, who had a veil down, but was wiping her eyes underneath it. I
+was downright flummuxed.
+
+"'I see you haven't,' the gentleman went on. 'Well, Joe, it is time
+you should know now. I owe to you all that is dear to me in this
+world, and our one unhappiness has been that you would not hear us,
+that you had lost everything and would not let us do anything to
+lighten your blow.'
+
+"Still, sir, I couldn't make out what he meant, and began to think
+that I was mad, or that he was. Then the lady stood up and threw back
+her veil, and come up in front of me with the tears a-running down
+her face; and I fell back a step, and sits down suddenly in a chair,
+for, sure enough, it was that gal. Different to what I had seen her
+last, healthy-looking and well--older, in course; a woman now, and the
+mother of my little ladies.
+
+"She stood before me, sir, with her hands out before her, pleading
+like.
+
+"'Don't hate me any more, Joe. Let my children stand between us. I
+know what you have suffered, and, in all my happiness, the thought of
+your loneliness has been a trouble, as my husband will tell you. I so
+often thought of you--a broken, lonely man. I have talked to the
+children of you till they loved the man that saved their mother's
+life. I cannot give you what you have lost, Joe--no one can do that;
+but you may make us happy in making you comfortable. At least, if you
+cannot help hating me, let the love I know you bear my children weigh
+with you.'
+
+"As she spoke the children were hanging on me; and when she stopped
+the little one said:
+
+"'Oh, Joe, oo must be dood; oo mustn't hate mamma, and make her cry!'
+
+"Well, sir, I know as I need tell you more about it. You can imagine
+how I quite broke down, like a great baby, and called myself every
+kind of name, saying only that I thought, and I a'most think so now,
+that I had been somehow mad from the moment the squall struck the
+_Kate_ till the time I first met the little girls.
+
+"When I thought o' that, and how I'd cut that poor gal to her drowning
+heart with my words, I could ha' knelt to her if she'd ha' let me. At
+last, when I was quiet, she explained that this cottage and its
+furniture and the _Grateful Mary_ was all for me; and we'd a great
+fight over it, and I only gave in when at last she says that if I
+didn't do as she wanted she'd never come down to Scarborough with the
+little ladies no more; but that if I 'greed they'd come down regular
+every year, and that the little girls should go out sailing with me
+regular in the _Grateful Mary_.
+
+"Well, sir, there was no arguing against that, was there? So here I
+am; and next week I expect Miss Mary that was, with her husband, who's
+a Parliament man, as she was engaged to be married to at the time of
+the upset, and my little ladies, who is getting quite big girls too.
+And if you hadn't been going away I'd ha' sailed round the castle
+tower, and I'd ha' pointed out the cottage to you. Yes, sir, I see
+what you are going to ask. I found it lonely there; and I found the
+widow of a old mate of mine who seemed to think as how she could make
+me comfortable; and comfortable I am, sir--no words could say how
+comfortable I am; and do you know, sir, I'm blest if there aint a Joe
+up there at this identical time, only he's a very little one, and has
+got both arms. So you see, sir, I have got about as little right as
+has any chap in this mortial world to the name of Surly Joe."
+
+
+
+
+A FISH-WIFE'S DREAM.
+
+
+Falmouth is not a fashionable watering-place. Capitalists and
+speculative builders have somehow left it alone, and, except for its
+great hotel, standing in a position, as far as I know, unrivaled,
+there have been comparatively few additions to it in the last quarter
+of a century. Were I a yachtsman I should make Falmouth my
+headquarters: blow high, blow low, there are shelter and plenty of
+sailing room, while in fine weather there is a glorious coast along
+which to cruise--something very different from the flat shores from
+Southampton to Brighton. It is some six years since that I was lying
+in the harbor, having sailed round in a friend's yacht from Cowes.
+Upon the day after we had come in my friend went into Truro, and I
+landed, strolled up, and sat down on a bench high on the seaward face
+of the hill that shelters the inner harbor.
+
+An old coastguardsman came along. I offered him tobacco, and in five
+minutes we were in full talk.
+
+"I suppose those are the pilchard boats far out there?"
+
+"Aye, that's the pilchard fleet."
+
+"Do they do well generally?"
+
+"Sometimes they do, sometimes they don't; it's an uncertain fish the
+pilchard, and it's a rough life is fishing on this coast. There aint a
+good harbor not this side of the Lizard; and if they're caught in a
+gale from the southeast it goes hard with them. With a southwester
+they can run back here."
+
+"Were you ever a fisherman yourself?"
+
+"Aye, I began life at it; I went a-fishing as a boy well-nigh fifty
+year back, but I got a sickener of it, and tramped to Plymouth and
+shipped in a frigate there, and served all my time in queen's ships."
+
+"Did you get sick of fishing because of the hardships of the life, or
+from any particular circumstance?"
+
+"I got wrecked on the Scillys. There was fifty boats lost that night,
+and scarce a hand was saved. I shouldn't have been saved myself if it
+had not been for a dream of mother's."
+
+"That's curious," I said. "Would you mind telling me about it?"
+
+The old sailor did not speak for a minute or two; and then, after a
+sharp puff at his pipe, he told me the following story, of which I
+have but slightly altered the wording:
+
+I lived with mother at Tregannock. It's a bit of a village now, as it
+was then. My father had been washed overboard and drowned two years
+before. I was his only son. The boat I sailed in was mother's, and
+four men and myself worked her in shares. I was twenty-one, or maybe
+twenty-two, years old then. It was one day early in October. We had
+had a bad season, and times were hard. We'd agreed to start at eight
+o'clock in the morning. I was up at five, and went down to the boats
+to see as everything was ready. When I got back mother had made
+breakfast; and when we sat down I saw that the old woman had been
+crying, and looked altogether queer like.
+
+"My boy," says she, "I want you not to go out this trip."
+
+"Not go out!" said I; "not go out, mother! Why? What's happened? Your
+share and mine didn't come to three pounds last month, and it would be
+a talk if I didn't go out in the _Jane_. Why, what is it?"
+
+"My boy," says she, "I've had a dream as how you was drowned."
+
+"Drowned!" said I; "I'm not going to be drowned, mother."
+
+But what she said made me feel creepy like, for us Cornishmen goes a
+good deal on dreams and tokens; and sure enough mother had dreamed
+father was going to be drowned before he started on that last trip of
+his.
+
+"That's not all, Will," she said. "I dreamed of you in bed, and a chap
+was leaning over you cutting your throat."
+
+I didn't care much for going on with my breakfast after that; but in a
+minute or two I plucks up and says:
+
+"Well, mother, you're wrong, anyhow; for if I be drowned no one has no
+call to cut my throat."
+
+"I didn't see you downright drowned in my dream," she said. "You was
+in the sea--a terribly rough sea--at night, and the waves were
+breaking down on you."
+
+"I can't help going, mother," I says, after a bit. "It's a fine day,
+and it's our boat. All the lads and girls in the village would laugh
+at me if I stayed at home."
+
+"That's just what your father said; and he went to his death."
+
+And my mother, as she says this, puts her apron over her head and
+began to cry again. I'd more than half a mind to give way; but you
+know what young chaps are. The thought of what the girls of the place
+would say about my being afraid to go was too much for me.
+
+At last, when mother saw I was bent on going, she got up and said:
+
+"Well, Will, if my prayers can't keep you back, will you do something
+else I ask you?"
+
+"I will, mother," said I--"anything but stay back."
+
+She went off without a word into her bedroom, and she came back with
+something in her arms.
+
+"Look here, Will, I made this for your father, and he wouldn't have
+it; now I ask you to take it, and put it on if a storm comes on. You
+see, you can put it on under your dreadnaught coat, and no one will
+be any the wiser."
+
+The thing she brought in was two flat Dutch spirit-bottles, sewn
+between two pieces of canvas. It had got strings sewed on for tying
+round the body, and put on as she did to show me how, one bottle each
+side of the chest, it lay pretty flat.
+
+"Now, Will, these bottles will keep you up for hours. A gentleman who
+was staying in the village before you was born was talking about
+wrecks, and he said that a couple of empty bottles, well corked, would
+keep up a fair swimmer for hours. So I made it; but no words could get
+your father to try it, though he was willing enough to say that it
+would probably keep him afloat. You'll try it, won't you, Will?"
+
+I didn't much like taking it, but I thought there wasn't much chance
+of a storm, and that if I put it under my coat and hid it away down in
+the forecastle, no one would see it; and so to please her I said I'd
+take it, and that if a bad storm came on I would slip it on.
+
+"I will put a wineglass of brandy into one of the bottles," mother
+said. "It may be useful to you; who can say?"
+
+I got the life-preserver, as you call it nowadays, on board without
+its being seen, and stowed it away in my locker. I felt glad now I'd
+got it, for mother's dream had made me feel uneasy; and on my way down
+old Dick Tremaine said to me:
+
+"I don't like the look of the sky, lad."
+
+"No!" says I; "why, it looks fine enough."
+
+"Too fine, lad. I tell ye, boy, I don't like the look of it. I think
+we're going to have a bad blow."
+
+I told the others what he had said; but they didn't heed much. Two
+boats had come in that morning with a fine catch, and after the bad
+time we'd been having it would have taken a lot to keep them in after
+that.
+
+We thought no more about it after we had once started. The wind was
+light and puffy; but we had great luck, and were too busy to watch the
+weather. What wind there was, was northerly; but towards sunset it
+dropped suddenly, and as the sails flapped we looked round at the sky.
+
+"I fear old Dick was right, lads," Jabez Harper, who was skipper,
+said, "and I wish we had taken more heed to his words. That's about as
+wild a sunset as may be; and look how that drift is nearing our boat."
+
+Even I, who was the youngest of them, was old enough to read the signs
+of a storm--the heavy bank of dark clouds, the pale-yellow broken
+light, the horse-tails high up in the sky, and the small broken
+irregular masses of cloud that hurried across them. Instinctively we
+looked round towards the coast. It was fully fifteen miles away, and
+we were to the east of it. The great change in the appearance of the
+sky had taken place in the last half-hour; previous to that time there
+had been nothing which would have struck any but a man grown old upon
+the coast like Dick Tremaine.
+
+"Reef the mainsail," Jabez said, "and the foresail too; take in the
+mizzen. Like enough it will come with a squall, and we'd best be as
+snug as may be. What do you say? shall we throw over some of the
+fish?"
+
+It was a hard thing to agree to; but every minute the sky was
+changing. The scud was flying thicker and faster overhead, and the
+land was lost in a black cloud that seemed to touch the water.
+
+"We needn't throw 'em all out," Jabez said; "if we get rid of half
+she'll be about in her best trim; and she's as good a sea-boat as
+there is on the coast. Come, lads, don't look at it."
+
+It was, as he said, no use looking at it, and in five minutes half our
+catch of the day was overboard. The _Jane_ was a half-decked boat,
+yawl-rigged; she wasn't built in our parts, but had been brought round
+from somewhere east by a gentleman as a fishing-craft. He had used her
+for two years, and had got tired of the sport, and my father had
+bought her of him. She wasn't the sort of boat generally used about
+here, but we all liked her, and swore by her.
+
+"It will be a tremendous blow for the first few minutes, I reckon,"
+Jabez said after a while. "Lower down her sails altogether; get her
+head to it with a sweep. I'll take the helm; Harry, you stand ready to
+hoist the foresail a few feet; and, Will, you and John stand by the
+hoists of the mainsail. We must show enough to keep her laying-to as
+long as we can. You'd best get your coats out and put 'em on, and
+batten down the hatch."
+
+I let the others go down first, and when they came up I went in, tied
+the life-belt round me, and put on my oilskin. I fetched out a bottle
+of hollands from my locker, and then came out and fastened the hatch.
+
+"Here comes the first puff," Jabez said.
+
+I stowed away the bottle among some ropes for our future use, and took
+hold of the throat halyard.
+
+"Here it comes," Jabez said, as a white line appeared under the cloud
+of mist and darkness ahead, and then with a roar it was upon us.
+
+I have been at sea, man and boy, for forty years, and I never remember
+in these latitudes such a squall as that. For a few minutes I could
+scarcely see or breathe. The spray flew in sheets over us, and the
+wind roared so that you wouldn't have heard a sixty-eight-pounder ten
+yards off. At first I thought we were going down bodily. It was lucky
+we had taken every stitch of canvas off her, for, as she spun round,
+the force of the wind against the masts and rigging all but capsized
+her. In five minutes the first burst was over, and we were running
+before it under our close-reefed foresail only. There was no occasion
+for us to stand by the halyards now, and we all gathered in the stern,
+and crouched down in the well. Although the sun had only gone down
+half an hour it was pitch-dark, except that the white foam round us
+gave a sort of dim light that made the sky look all the blacker. The
+sea got up in less time than it takes in telling, and we were soon
+obliged to hoist the foresail a bit higher to prevent the waves from
+coming in over the stern. For three hours we tore on before the gale,
+and then it lulled almost as suddenly as it had come on. There had
+scarcely been a word spoken between us during this time. I was half
+asleep in spite of the showers of spray. Jim Hackers, who was always
+smoking, puffed away steadily; Jabez was steering still, and the
+others were quite quiet. With the sudden lull we were all on our feet.
+
+"Is it all over, Jabez?" I asked.
+
+"It's only begun," he said. "I scarce remember such a gale as this
+since I was a boy. Pass that bottle of yours round, Will; we shall be
+busy again directly. One of you take the helm; I'm stiff with the wet.
+We shall have it round from the south in a few minutes."
+
+There was scarce a breath of wind now, and she rolled so I thought she
+would have turned turtle.
+
+"Get out a sweep," Jabez said, "and bring her head round."
+
+We had scarcely done so ere the first squall from behind struck us,
+and in five minutes we were running back as fast as we had come. The
+wind was at first south, but settled round to southeast. We got up a
+little more sail now, and made a shift to keep her to the west, for
+with this wind we should have been ashore long before morning if we
+had run straight before it. The sea had been heavy--it was tremendous
+now; and, light and seaworthy as the _Jane_ was, we had to keep baling
+as the sea broke into her. Over and over again I thought that it was
+all over with us as the great waves towered above our stern, but they
+slipped under us as we went driving on at twelve or fourteen knots an
+hour. I stood up by the side of Jabez, and asked him what he thought
+of it.
+
+"I can't keep her off the wind," he said; "we must run, and by
+midnight we shall be among the Scillys. Then it's a toss-up."
+
+Jabez's calculations could not have been far out, for it was just
+midnight, as far as I could tell, when we saw a flash right ahead.
+
+"That's a ship on one of the Scillys," Jabez said. "I wish I knew
+which it was."
+
+He tried to bring her a little more up into the wind, but she nearly
+lay over onto her beam-ends, and Jabez let her go ahead again. We saw
+one more flash, and then a broad faint light. The ship was burning a
+blue light. She was not a mile ahead now, and we could see she was a
+large vessel. I had often been to the Scillys before, and knew them as
+well as I did our coast, but I could not see the land. It was as Jabez
+had said--a toss-up. If we just missed one of them we might manage to
+bring up under its lee; but if we ran dead into one or other of them
+the _Jane_ would break up like an egg-shell.
+
+We were rapidly running down upon the wreck when the glare of a fire
+on shore shone up. It was a great blaze, and we could faintly see the
+land and a white cottage some hundred yards from the shore.
+
+"I know it," Jabez shouted; "we are close to the end of the island; we
+may miss it yet. Hoist the mainsail a bit."
+
+I leapt up with another to seize the halyards, when a great wave
+struck us; she gave a roll, and the next moment I was in the water.
+
+After the first wild efforts I felt calm like. I knew the shore was
+but half a mile ahead, and that the wind would set me dead upon it. I
+loosened my tarpaulin coat and shook it off, and I found that with
+mother's belt I could keep easily enough afloat, though I was half
+drowned with the waves as they swept in from behind me. My mother's
+dream cheered me up, for, according to that, it did not seem as I was
+to be drowned, whatever was to come afterwards. I drifted past the
+wreck within a hundred yards or so. They were still burning blue
+lights; but the sea made a clean sweep over her, and I saw that in a
+very few minutes she would go to pieces. Many times as the seas broke
+over me I quite gave up hope of reaching shore; but I was a fair
+swimmer, and the bottles buoyed me up, and I struggled on.
+
+I could see the fire on shore, but the surf that broke against the
+rocks showed a certain death if I made for it, and I tried hard to
+work to the left, where I could see no breaking surf. It seemed to me
+that the fire was built close to the end of the island. As I came
+close I found that this was so. I drifted past the point of land not
+fifty feet off, where the waves were sending their spray a hundred
+feet up; then I made a great struggle, and got in under the lee of the
+point. There was a little bay with a shelving shore, and here I made a
+shift to land. Five minutes to rest, and then I made my way towards
+the fire. There was no one there, and I went to the edge of the rocks.
+Here four or five men with ropes were standing, trying to secure some
+of the casks, chests, and wreckage from the ship. The surf was full of
+floating objects, but nothing could stand the shock of a crash against
+those rocks. The water was deep alongside, and the waves, as they
+struck, flew up in spray, which made standing almost impossible.
+
+The men came round me when they saw me. There was no hearing one speak
+in the noise of the storm; so I made signs I had landed behind the
+point, and that if they came with their ropes to the point they might
+get something as it floated past. They went off, and I sat down by the
+fire, wrung my clothes as well as I could,--I thought nothing of the
+wet, for one is wet through half the time in a fishing-boat,--took off
+mother's belt, and found one of the bottles had broke as I got ashore;
+but luckily it was the one which was quite empty. I got the cork out
+of the other, and had a drink of brandy, and then felt pretty right
+again. I had good hopes the boat was all right, for she would get
+round the point easy, and Jabez would bring her up under the lee of
+the island. I thought I would go and see if I could help the others,
+and perhaps save someone drifting from the wreck; but I did not think
+there was very much chance, for she lay some little distance to the
+right, and I hardly thought a swimmer could keep off the shore.
+
+Just as I was going to move I saw two of them coming back. They had a
+body between them, and they put it down a little distance from the
+fire. I was on the other side, and they had forgotten all about me.
+They stooped over the figure, and I could not see what they were
+doing. I got up and went over, and they gave a start when they saw me.
+"Is he alive?" says I. "Dunno," one of 'em growled; and I could see
+pretty well that if I had not been there it would have gone hard with
+the chap. He was a foreign, Jewish-looking fellow, and had around him
+one of the ship's life-buoys. There were lots of rings on his fingers,
+and he had a belt round his waist that looked pretty well stuffed out.
+I put my hand to his heart, and found he still breathed; and then I
+poured a few drops of brandy which remained in my bottle down his
+throat.
+
+While I was doing this the two men had talked to each other aside.
+"He's alive, all right," says I. "That's a good job," one of 'em said;
+but I knew he didn't think so. "We'll carry him up to our cottage.
+You'll be all the better for a sleep; it must be past two o'clock by
+this time."
+
+They took the chap up, and carried him to the cottage, and put him on
+a bed. He was moaning a little, and between us we undressed him and
+got him into bed. "I doubt he'll come round," I said.
+
+"I don't believe he will. Will you have a drink of whisky?"
+
+I was mighty glad to do so, and then, throwing off my wet clothes, I
+got into the other bed, for there were two in the room.
+
+The men said they were going down again to see what they could get.
+They left the whisky bottle on the table, and as soon as I was alone I
+jumped out and poured a little into the other chap's teeth, so as to
+give him as good a chance as I could; but I didn't much think he'd get
+round, and then I got into bed and shut my eyes. I was just going off,
+when, with a sudden jump, I sat straight up. Mother's dream came right
+across me. I was out of bed in a moment, and looked at the door. There
+was no bolt, so I put a couple of chairs against it. Then I took my
+clasp-knife out of my pocket and opened it. I gave the other chap a
+shake, but there was no sense in him, and I got into bed again. I
+thought to myself they would never risk a fight when they saw me armed
+and ready. But I soon found that I couldn't keep awake; so I got up
+and dressed in my wet clothes, and went to the door. I found it was
+fastened on the outside. I soon opened the window and got out, but
+before I did that I rolled up some clothes and put 'em in the bed, and
+made a sort of likeness of a man there. The poor fellow in bed was
+lying very still now, and I felt pretty sure that he would not live
+till morning. The candle was a fresh one when they had first lighted
+it, and I left it burning.
+
+When I had got out I shut the window, and went away fifty yards or so,
+where I could hear them come back. Presently I heard some footsteps
+coming from the opposite direction. Then I heard a voice I knew say,
+"There is the fire; we shall soon know whether the poor lad has got
+ashore."
+
+"Here am I, Jabez," I said. "Hush!" as he and the other were going to
+break into a shout of welcome, "hush! Some wreckers are coming up
+directly to cut my throat and that of another chap in that cottage."
+
+In a word or two I told them all about it; and they agreed to wait
+with me and see the end of it. Jabez had brought the _Jane_ up under
+the lee of the island, and, leaving two of the men on board, had come
+on shore in the cobble with the other to look for me, but with very
+faint hopes of finding me.
+
+"You had best get hold of something to fight with, if you mean to take
+these fellows, Jabez."
+
+"A good lump of rock is as good a weapon as another," Jabez said.
+
+Our plan was soon arranged, and half an hour later we heard footsteps
+coming up from the shore again. Two men passed us, went into the
+cottage, and shut the door. Jabez and I made round to the window,
+where we could see in, and John Redpath stood at the door. He was to
+open it and rush in when he heard us shout. We stood a little back,
+but we could see well into the room. Presently we saw the door open
+very quietly, little by little. A hand came through and moved the
+chairs, and then it opened wide. Then the two men entered. One, a big
+fellow, had a knife in his hand, and drew towards the bed, where, as
+it seemed, I was sleeping, with my head covered up by the clothes. The
+other had no knife in his hand, and came towards the other bed.
+
+"Get ready, lad," Jabez said to me.
+
+The big fellow raised his knife and plunged it down into the figure,
+throwing his weight onto it at the same moment, while the smaller man
+snatched the pillow from under the other's head and clapped it over
+his face, and threw his weight on it. As they did so we pushed the
+casement open and leapt in. I seized the smaller man, who was
+suffocating the other chap, and before he could draw his knife I had
+him on the ground and my knee on his chest. The big fellow had leapt
+up. He gave a howl of rage as Jabez rushed at him, and stood at bay
+with his knife. Jabez stopped, however, and threw his lump of rock, as
+big as a baby's head, right into his stomach. It just tumbled him over
+like a cannon-shot. John burst in through the door, and we had 'em
+both tied tightly before five minutes was over. Then we lit a big fire
+in the kitchen, and with warm clothes and some hot whisky and water
+we got the foreign chap pretty well round.
+
+In the morning I went off and found a village on the other side of the
+island. I woke them up and told my story, and, to do 'em justice,
+though there were some who would have shielded the fellows we had
+caught, the best part were on our side. Some of 'em told me there had
+been suspicion upon these men, and that they bore a bad name. There
+was no magistrate in the island, and no one objected when I said we
+would take them across to Penzance and give them in charge there.
+
+So we did; and they were tried and got transportation for life for
+attempting to murder the foreign chap, who, it turned out, was a
+Brazilian Jew, with diamonds. He offered us all sorts of presents, but
+we would have none; but that's neither here nor there.
+
+So you see, master, mother's dream saved me from drowning and from
+having my throat cut. I gave up fishing after that and went into the
+queen's service. Mother sold the boat, and went to live with a sister
+of hers at Truro. The Scilly Islands have changed since those times,
+and you'll meet as much kindness there if you're wrecked as you will
+anywhere else; but they were a rough lot in those days, and I had a
+pretty close shave of it, hadn't I?
+
+
+
+
+Boys' Own Library.
+
+
+ BOUND IN CLOTH.
+
+ Large Type, Fine Book Paper. Illustrated. Printed Wrappers.
+
+ A selection of the Best Books for Boys, by the most popular
+ Authors.
+
+ Handsome Cloth Binding. Covers Stamped in Inks and Gold.
+
+ THESE BOOKS ARE ALL COPYRIGHTED.
+
+ Price, 75 Cents Each, Postpaid.
+
+#Horatio Alger, Jr.#
+
+ Adventures of a Telegraph Boy.
+ Dean Dunham.
+ Erie Train Boy.
+ Five Hundred Dollar Check.
+ From Canal Boy to President.
+ From Farm Boy to Senator.
+ Mark Stanton.
+ Ned Newton.
+ New York Boy.
+ Tom Brace.
+ Tom Tracy.
+ Walter Griffith.
+ Young Acrobat.
+
+#C. B. Ashley.#
+
+ Gilbert, the Trapper
+
+#Annie Ashmore.#
+
+ Smuggler's Cave, The.
+
+#Capt. Ralph Bonehill.#
+
+ Neka, the Boy Conjurer.
+ Tour of the Zero Club.
+
+#Walter F. Burns.#
+
+ In the Sunk Lands.
+
+#Frank H. Converse.#
+
+ Gold of Flat Top Mountain.
+ Happy-Go-Lucky Jack.
+ Heir to a Million.
+ In Search of an Unknown Race.
+ In Southern Seas.
+ Mystery of a Diamond.
+ That Treasure.
+ Voyage to the Gold Coast.
+
+#Harry Collingwood.#
+
+ Pirate Island.
+
+#George H. Coomer.#
+
+ Boys In the Forecastle.
+ Old Man of the Mountain.
+
+#William Dalton.#
+
+ Tiger Prince.
+ War Tiger.
+ White Elephant.
+
+#Edward S. Ellis.#
+
+ Arthur Helmuth.
+ Check Number 2134.
+ From Tent to White House.
+ Golden Rock.
+ Land of Mystery.
+ On the Trail of Geronimo.
+ Perils of the Jungle.
+ White Mustang.
+
+#George Manville Fenn.#
+
+ Commodore Junk.
+ Dingo Boys.
+ Golden Magnet.
+ Grand Chaco.
+ Weathercock.
+
+#Ensign Clarke Fitch, U. S. N.#
+
+ Bound for Annapolis.
+ Cliff, the Naval Cadet.
+ Cruise of the Training Ship.
+ From Port to Port.
+ Strange Cruise, A.
+
+#William Murray Graydon.#
+
+ Butcher of Cawnpore, The.
+ Camp In the Snow, The.
+ Campaigning with Braddock.
+ Cryptogram, The.
+ From Lake to Wilderness.
+ In Barracks and Wigwam.
+ In Fort and Prison.
+ Jungles and Traitors.
+ Rajah's Fortress, The.
+ White King of Africa, The.
+ With Boer and Britisher.
+
+#Lieut. Frederick Garrison, U. S. A.#
+
+ Cadet's Honor, A.
+ Off for West Point.
+ On Guard.
+ West Point Treasure, A.
+ West Point Rivals, The.
+
+#Headon Hill.#
+
+ Spectre Gold.
+
+#Henry Harrison Lewis.#
+
+ Centerboard Jim.
+ Ensign Merrill.
+ King of the Island.
+ Midshipman Merrill.
+ Sword and Pen.
+ Valley of Mystery, The.
+ Yankee Boys In Japan.
+
+#Lieut. Lionel Lounsberry.#
+
+ Cadet Kit Carey.
+ Capt. Carey.
+ Kit Carey's Protege.
+ Lieut. Carey's Luck.
+ Out with Commodore Decatur.
+ Randy, the Pilot.
+ Tom Truxton's Ocean Trip.
+ Tom Truxton's School Days.
+ Treasure of the Golden Crater.
+ Won at West Point.
+
+#Victor St. Clair.#
+
+ Cast Away in the Jungle.
+ Comrades Under Castro.
+ For Home and Honor.
+ From Switch to Lever.
+ Little Snap, the Postboy.
+ Zig-Zag, the Boy Conjuror.
+ Zip, the Acrobat.
+
+#Arthur M. Winfield.#
+
+ Mark Dale's Stage Venture.
+ Young Bank Clerk, The.
+ Young Bridge Tender, The.
+
+#Matthew White, Jr.#
+
+ Adventures of a Young Athlete.
+ Eric Dane.
+ Guy Hammersley.
+ My Mysterious Fortune.
+ Tour of a Private Car.
+ Young Editor, The.
+
+#Gayle Winterton.#
+
+ Young Actor, The.
+
+#Ernest A. Young.#
+
+ Boats, Bats and Bicycles.
+
+
+
+
+Splendid Books for Girls.
+
+
+ HANDSOMELY BOUND IN CLOTH, ILLUSTRATED.
+
+ Price, 60 Cents Each, Postpaid.
+
+#EVELYN RAYMOND'S delightful stories:#
+
+ #Breakneck Farm.#
+
+ The trials and triumphs of Faith Merriman and her brothers, on
+ an old abandoned country place.
+
+ #Jessica Trent.#
+
+ Her Adventures on a Ranch.
+
+ #Jessica, the Heiress.#
+
+ This is Evelyn Raymond's new book, just published. A Charming
+ Story.
+
+#KATE TANNATT WOODS:#
+
+ #A Fair Maid of Marblehead.#
+
+ A book to please both young and old.
+
+
+ THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY, New York.
+
+
+
+
+BOYS' OWN LIBRARY
+
+
+ Bound in Cloth.
+ Price, 75 Cents Each, Postpaid.
+
+#Brooks McCormick.#
+
+ Giant Islanders, The.
+ How He Won.
+ Nature's Young Noblemen.
+ Rival Battalions.
+
+#Walter Morris.#
+
+ Bob Porter at Lakeview Academy.
+
+#Stanley Norris.#
+
+ Phil, the Showman.
+ Young Showman's Rivals, The.
+ Young Showman's Pluck, The.
+ Young Showman's Triumph, The.
+
+#Lieut. James K. Orton.#
+
+ Beach Boy Joe.
+ Last Chance Mine.
+ Secret Chart, The.
+ Tom Havens with the White Squadron.
+
+#James Otis.#
+
+ Chased Through Norway.
+ Inland Waterways.
+ Reuben Green's Adventures at Yale.
+ Unprovoked Mutiny, An.
+ Wheeling for Fortune.
+
+#Gilbert Patten.#
+
+ Boy Boomers.
+ Boy Cattle King.
+ Boy from the West.
+ Don Kirk's Mine.
+ Jud and Joe.
+
+#St. George Rathborne.#
+
+ Canoe and Camp Fire.
+ Chums of the Prairie.
+ Gulf Cruisers, The.
+ Paddling Under Palmettos.
+ Rival Canoe Boys.
+ Shifting Winds.
+ Sunset Ranch.
+ Young Range Riders.
+
+#Arthur Sewell.#
+
+ Gay Dashleigh's Academy Days.
+
+#Capt. David Southwick.#
+
+ Jack Wheeler.
+
+#Burt L. Standish.#
+
+ Frank Merriwell's Bravery.
+ Frank Merriwell Down South.
+ Frank Merriwell's School Days.
+ Frank Merriwell's Chums.
+ Frank Merriwell's Foes.
+ Frank Merriwell's Trip West.
+
+
+
+
+The New "Henty" Series.
+
+
+ With large INLAID PANEL IN THREE COLORS on each book. The
+ Illustrations are reproductions of paintings representing
+ scenes in the Stories. The elegant cover design is done in
+ Inks and Gold, on a fine quality of Cloth. These books are all
+ by G. A. Henty. Illustrated. Printed Wrappers.
+
+ AMONG MALAY PIRATES. A Story of Adventure and Peril.
+ BONNIE PRINCE CHARLIE. A Tale of Fontenoy and Culloden.
+ BOY KNIGHT, THE. A Tale of the Crusades.
+ BRAVEST OF THE BRAVE, THE. With Peterborough in Spain.
+ BY ENGLAND'S AID; or, The Freeing of the Netherlands (1585-1604).
+ BY PIKE AND DYKE. A Tale of the Rise of the Dutch Republic.
+ BY RIGHT OF CONQUEST; or, With Cortez in Mexico.
+ BY SHEER PLUCK. A Tale of the Ashanti War.
+ CAPTAIN BAYLEY'S HEIR. A Tale of the Gold Fields of California.
+ CAT OF BUBASTES, THE. A Story of Ancient Egypt.
+ CORNET OF HORSE, THE. A Tale of Marlborough's Wars.
+ DRAGON AND THE RAVEN; or, The Days of King Alfred.
+ FACING DEATH. A Tale of the Coal Mines.
+ FINAL RECKONING, A. A Tale of Bush Life in Australia.
+ FOR NAME AND FAME; or, Through Afghan Passes.
+ FOR THE TEMPLE. A Tale of the Fall of Jerusalem.
+ FRIENDS, THOUGH DIVIDED. A Tale of the Civil War in England.
+ GOLDEN CANON, THE. A Tale of Gold Hunting in Mexico.
+ IN FREEDOM'S CAUSE. A Story of Wallace and Bruce.
+ IN THE REIGN OF TERROR. Adventures of a Westminster Boy.
+ IN TIMES OF PERIL. A Tale of India.
+ JACK ARCHER. A Tale of the Crimea.
+ LION OF ST. MARK, THE. A Story of Venice in the 14th Century.
+ LION OF THE NORTH, THE. A Tale of Gustavus Adolphus and Wars of
+ Religion.
+ LOST HEIR, THE. A Tale of Kidnapping in India.
+ MAORI AND SETTLER. A Story of the New Zealand War.
+ ONE OF THE 28TH. A Tale of Waterloo.
+ ORANGE AND GREEN. A Tale of the Boyne and Limerick.
+ OUT ON THE PAMPAS. A Tale of South America.
+ ST. GEORGE FOR ENGLAND. A Tale of Cressy and Poitiers.
+ STURDY AND STRONG; or, How George Andrews Made his Way.
+ THROUGH THE FRAY. A Story of the Luddite Riots.
+ TRUE TO THE OLD FLAG. A Tale of the American War of Independence.
+ UNDER DRAKE'S FLAG. A Tale of the Spanish Main.
+ WITH CLIVE IN INDIA; or, The Beginnings of an Empire.
+ WITH LEE IN VIRGINIA. A Story of the American Civil War.
+ WITH WOLFE IN CANADA; or, The Winning of a Continent.
+ YOUNG BUGLERS, THE. A Tale of the Peninsular War.
+ YOUNG CARTHAGINIAN, THE. A Story of the Times of Hannibal.
+ YOUNG COLONISTS, THE. A Story of War in South Africa.
+ YOUNG FRANC-TIREURS. A Tale of the Franco-Prussian War.
+ YOUNG MIDSHIPMAN, THE. A Tale of the Siege of Alexandria.
+
+ _Any of the above books will be sent postpaid, upon receipt of
+ price, 50 cents._
+
+ THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY, New York.
+
+
+
+
+Boys' Popular Library.
+
+
+ BOUND IN CLOTH.
+
+ An excellent series of books for boys by such popular authors
+ as Optic, Kingston and other well-known writers.
+
+ These books are Bound in Cloth, with very attractive cover
+ designs stamped in colors. The are all well printed from large
+ type, on good paper. Printed wrappers.
+
+ Price, 50 Cents Each, Postpaid.
+
+#Walter Aimwell.#
+
+ Jerry.
+ Whistler.
+
+#Horatio Alger, Jr.#
+
+ Brave and Bold.
+ Only an Irish Boy.
+ Paul, the Peddler.
+ Phil, the Fiddler.
+ Slow and Sure.
+ Strive and Succeed.
+ Strong and Steady.
+ Tom, the Bootblack.
+ Try and Trust.
+
+#Z. R. Bennett.#
+
+ Young Vagabond, A.
+
+#Daniel Defoe.#
+
+ Robinson Crusoe.
+
+#John De Morgan.#
+
+ Always on Duty.
+
+#Richard Dowling.#
+
+ Catmur's Cave.
+
+#George Manville Fenn.#
+
+ In the Wilds of New Mexico.
+
+#Blanche Willis Howard.#
+
+ Battle and a Boy, A.
+
+#W. H. G. Kingston.#
+
+ Dick Cheveley.
+ From Powder Monkey to Admiral.
+ Hendricks, the Hunter.
+ Mark Seaworth's Voyage on the Indian Ocean.
+ Peter Trawl.
+ Peter, the Whaler.
+ Shore and Ocean.
+ The Midshipman, Marmaduke Merry.
+
+#Leon Lewis.#
+
+ Diamond Seekers of Brazil.
+ Kit Carson's Last Trail.
+ Silver Ship, The.
+ Young Castaways, The.
+
+#Montleau & Wyse.#
+
+ Swiss Family Robinson.
+
+#Alfred Oldfellow.#
+
+ Joe Nichols.
+ Uncle Nat.
+ Way to Success.
+
+#Oliver Optic#
+
+ All Aboard (Sequel to "Boat Club").
+ Boat Club, The.
+ Little by Little.
+ Now or Never.
+ Try Again.
+
+#Capt. Mayne Reid.#
+
+ Boy Tar, The.
+ Cliff Climber, The.
+ Lone Ranch, The.
+ Ran Away to Sea.
+
+#Gordon Stables.#
+
+ Cruise of the Snowbird.
+ Life at Sea.
+ Wild Adventures 'Round the Pole.
+ Young Explorer, The.
+
+#Jefferys Taylor.#
+
+ Boy Crusoes, The.
+
+#A Wolvertonian.#
+
+ Three Years at Wolverton.
+
+#Ernest A. Young.#
+
+ Toss Up for Luck.
+
+
+ THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY, New York.
+
+
+
+
+Girls' Popular Library.
+
+
+ ELEGANTLY BOUND IN CLOTH.
+
+ LARGE TYPE. GOOD PAPER. Printed Wrappers. Very attractive
+ cover design stamped in colors. Just the books that girls
+ delight to read--and can read with profit as well as pleasure.
+ Note the list of Authors--all well-known writers of the best
+ books for girls.
+
+ Price, 50 Cents Each, Postpaid.
+
+#Walter Aimwell.#
+
+ Ella.
+ Jessie.
+ Marcus.
+
+#Mary D. Brine.#
+
+ Echoes from Story Land.
+ Stories Grandma Told.
+
+#Alice Carey.#
+
+ Clovernook Children.
+ Clovernook Tales. Vol. I.
+ Clovernook Tales. Vol. II.
+
+#Rosa Nouchette Carey.#
+
+ Averil.
+ Our Bessie.
+
+#Cousin Virginia.#
+
+ Cricket's Friends, The.
+ Dolls' Club, The.
+ 3 Vols. in 1.
+ Jo's Doll.
+ Katy's Christmas.
+ Patty's Pranks.
+
+#Lewis Carroll.#
+
+ Alice's Adventures In Wonderland.
+ Through the Looking-Glass.
+
+#Maria S. Cummins.#
+
+ Lamplighter, The.
+
+#Mary A. Denison.#
+
+ Barbara's Triumphs.
+ Frenchman's Ward, The.
+ Guardian's Trust, The.
+
+#Maria Edgeworth.#
+
+ Simple Susan.
+
+#Juliana Horatia Ewing.#
+
+ Flat-Iron for a Farthing, A.
+ Great Emergency, A.
+ Jackanapes.
+ Jan of the Windmill.
+ Six to Sixteen.
+ We and the World.
+
+#Julia Goddard.#
+
+ Fairy Tales In Other Lands.
+
+#Virginia F. Townsend.#
+
+ Amy Deane.
+ While it Was Morning.
+
+
+ THE FEDERAL BOOK COMPANY. New York.
+
+
+
+
+TRANSCRIBER'S NOTE: All apparent printer's errors retained.
+
+
+
+
+
+End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of Sturdy and Strong, by G. A. Henty
+
+*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK STURDY AND STRONG ***
+
+***** This file should be named 33939.txt or 33939.zip *****
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+ http://www.gutenberg.org/3/3/9/3/33939/
+
+Produced by David Edwards and the Online Distributed
+Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This file was
+produced from images generously made available by The
+Internet Archive)
+
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+http://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS' WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need, are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at http://www.pglaf.org.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Its 501(c)(3) letter is posted at
+http://pglaf.org/fundraising. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at http://pglaf.org
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit http://pglaf.org
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
+To donate, please visit: http://pglaf.org/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ http://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
diff --git a/33939.zip b/33939.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e29dcfd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/33939.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ff79778
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #33939 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/33939)